0408 742 PDF
0408 742 PDF
0408 742 PDF
2 (2000-09)
European Standard (Telecommunications series)
Reference
REN/SMG-030408Q7R1
Keywords
Digital celluar telecommunications system, Global
System for Mobile communications (GSM)
ETSI
650 Route des Lucioles
F-06921 Sophia Antipolis Cedex - FRANCE
Tel.: +33 4 92 94 42 00 Fax: +33 4 93 65 47 16
Siret N 348 623 562 00017 - NAF 742 C
Association but non lucratif enregistre la
Sous-Prfecture de Grasse (06) N 7803/88
Important notice
Individual copies of the present document can be downloaded from:
http://www.etsi.org
The present document may be made available in more than one electronic version or in print. In any case of existing or
perceived difference in contents between such versions, the reference version is the Portable Document Format (PDF).
In case of dispute, the reference shall be the printing on ETSI printers of the PDF version kept on a specific network drive
within ETSI Secretariat.
Users of the present document should be aware that the document may be subject to revision or change of status.
Information on the current status of this and other ETSI documents is available at http://www.etsi.org/tb/status/
If you find errors in the present document, send your comment to:
[email protected]
Copyright Notification
No part may be reproduced except as authorized by written permission.
The copyright and the foregoing restriction extend to reproduction in all media.
European Telecommunications Standards Institute 2000.
All rights reserved.
ETSI
Contents
Intellectual Property Rights .............................................................................................................................. 27
Foreword .......................................................................................................................................................... 27
Introduction ...................................................................................................................................................... 28
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.6.1
0.7
0.7.1
0.7.2
Scope ...................................................................................................................................................... 29
Scope of the Technical Specification ................................................................................................................. 29
Application to the interface structures ................................................................................................................ 29
Structure of layer 3 procedures ........................................................................................................................... 29
Test procedures ................................................................................................................................................... 29
Use of logical channels ....................................................................................................................................... 30
Overview of control procedures ......................................................................................................................... 30
List of procedures .......................................................................................................................................... 30
Applicability of implementations ....................................................................................................................... 32
Voice Group Call Service (VGCS) and Voice Broadcast Service (VBS) ................................................... 33
General Packet Radio Service (GPRS) ......................................................................................................... 33
References .............................................................................................................................................. 34
2.1
2.2
3.1
Overview/General ............................................................................................................................................... 39
3.1.1
General........................................................................................................................................................... 39
3.1.2
Services provided to upper layers ................................................................................................................. 39
3.1.2.1
Idle mode ................................................................................................................................................. 39
3.1.2.2
Dedicated mode ....................................................................................................................................... 40
3.1.2.3
Group receive mode ................................................................................................................................ 40
3.1.2.4
Group transmit mode ............................................................................................................................... 40
3.1.2.5
Packet idle mode...................................................................................................................................... 41
3.1.2.6
Packet transfer mode ............................................................................................................................... 41
3.1.3
Services required from data link and physical layers ................................................................................... 41
3.1.4
Change of dedicated channels ....................................................................................................................... 41
3.1.4.1
Change of dedicated channels using SAPI = 0 ....................................................................................... 41
3.1.4.2
Change of dedicated channels using other SAPIs than 0 ....................................................................... 41
3.1.4.3
Sequenced message transfer operation ................................................................................................... 42
3.1.4.3.1
Variables and sequence numbers ...................................................................................................... 42
3.1.4.3.1.1
Send state variable V(SD)............................................................................................................ 42
3.1.4.3.1.2
Send sequence number N(SD) ..................................................................................................... 42
3.1.4.3.2
Procedures for the initiation, transfer execution and termination of the sequenced message
transfer operation ............................................................................................................................... 42
3.1.4.3.2.1
Initiation ....................................................................................................................................... 42
3.1.4.3.2.2
Transfer Execution ....................................................................................................................... 42
3.1.4.3.2.3
Termination .................................................................................................................................. 42
3.1.5
Procedure for Service Request and Contention Resolution ......................................................................... 42
3.2
Idle mode procedures and general procedures in packet idle and packet transfer modes ................................. 44
3.2.1
Mobile Station side........................................................................................................................................ 44
3.2.2
Network side.................................................................................................................................................. 45
3.2.2.1
System information broadcasting ............................................................................................................ 45
3.2.2.2
Paging ...................................................................................................................................................... 46
3.3
RR connection establishment.............................................................................................................................. 46
3.3.1
RR connection establishment initiated by the mobile station ...................................................................... 46
3.3.1.1
Entering the dedicated mode : immediate assignment procedure .......................................................... 46
3.3.1.1.1
Permission to access the network ...................................................................................................... 46
3.3.1.1.2
Initiation of the immediate assignment procedure ............................................................................ 47
3.3.1.1.3
Answer from the network .................................................................................................................. 47
ETSI
3.3.1.1.3.1
On receipt of a CHANNEL REQUEST message ....................................................................... 47
3.3.1.1.3.2
Assignment rejection ................................................................................................................... 48
3.3.1.1.4
Assignment completion ..................................................................................................................... 49
3.3.1.1.4.1
Early classmark sending .............................................................................................................. 49
3.3.1.1.4.2
GPRS suspension procedure ........................................................................................................ 49
3.3.1.1.5
Abnormal cases .................................................................................................................................. 50
3.3.1.2
Entering the group transmit mode: uplink access procedure.................................................................. 50
3.3.1.2.1
Mobile station side ............................................................................................................................. 50
3.3.1.2.1.1
Uplink investigation procedure.................................................................................................... 50
3.3.1.2.1.2
Uplink access procedure .............................................................................................................. 51
3.3.1.2.2
Network side ...................................................................................................................................... 51
3.3.1.2.3
Abnormal cases .................................................................................................................................. 51
3.3.1.3
Dedicated mode and GPRS ..................................................................................................................... 52
3.3.2
Paging procedure for RR connection establishment .................................................................................... 52
3.3.2.1
Paging initiation by the network ............................................................................................................. 52
3.3.2.1.1
Paging initiation using paging subchannel on CCCH....................................................................... 52
3.3.2.1.2
Paging initiation using paging subchannel on PCCCH .................................................................... 54
3.3.2.1.3
Paging initiation using PACCH......................................................................................................... 54
3.3.2.2
Paging response ....................................................................................................................................... 54
3.3.2.3
Abnormal cases........................................................................................................................................ 54
3.3.3
Notification procedure................................................................................................................................... 54
3.3.3.1
Notification of a call ................................................................................................................................ 55
3.3.3.2
Joining a VGCS or VBS call ................................................................................................................... 55
3.3.3.3
Reduced NCH monitoring mechanism ................................................................................................... 55
3.4
Procedures in dedicated mode and in group transmit mode .............................................................................. 56
3.4.1
SACCH procedures ....................................................................................................................................... 56
3.4.1.1
General ..................................................................................................................................................... 56
3.4.1.2
Measurement report ................................................................................................................................. 57
3.4.1.3
Extended measurement report $(MAFA)$ ............................................................................................. 57
3.4.2
Transfer of messages and link layer service provision................................................................................. 58
3.4.3
Channel assignment procedure ..................................................................................................................... 58
3.4.3.1
Channel assignment initiation ................................................................................................................. 58
3.4.3.2
Assignment completion ........................................................................................................................... 60
3.4.3.3
Abnormal cases........................................................................................................................................ 60
3.4.4
Handover procedure ...................................................................................................................................... 61
3.4.4.1
Handover initiation .................................................................................................................................. 61
3.4.4.2
Physical channel establishment ............................................................................................................... 63
3.4.4.2.1
Finely synchronized cell case ............................................................................................................ 63
3.4.4.2.2
Non synchronized cell case ............................................................................................................... 63
3.4.4.2.3
Pseudo-synchronized cell case .......................................................................................................... 64
3.4.4.2.4
Pre-synchronized cell case................................................................................................................. 64
3.4.4.3
Handover completion .............................................................................................................................. 64
3.4.4.4
Abnormal cases........................................................................................................................................ 64
3.4.5
Frequency redefinition procedure ................................................................................................................. 65
3.4.5.1
Abnormal cases........................................................................................................................................ 66
3.4.6
Channel mode modify procedure .................................................................................................................. 66
3.4.6.1
Normal channel mode modify procedure ............................................................................................... 66
3.4.6.1.1
Initiation of the channel mode modify procedure ............................................................................. 66
3.4.6.1.2
Completion of channel mode modify procedure............................................................................... 67
3.4.6.1.3
Abnormal cases .................................................................................................................................. 67
3.4.6.2
Channel mode modify procedure for a voice group call talker .............................................................. 67
3.4.6.2.1
Initiation of the channel mode modify procedure ............................................................................. 67
3.4.6.2.2
Completion of mode change procedure ............................................................................................ 67
3.4.6.2.3
Abnormal cases .................................................................................................................................. 67
3.4.7
Ciphering mode setting procedure ................................................................................................................ 67
3.4.7.1
Ciphering mode setting initiation ............................................................................................................ 68
3.4.7.2
Ciphering mode setting completion ........................................................................................................ 68
3.4.8
Additional channel assignment procedure .................................................................................................... 68
3.4.8.1
Additional assignment procedure initiation ............................................................................................ 69
3.4.8.2
Additional assignment procedure completion ........................................................................................ 69
3.4.8.3
Abnormal cases........................................................................................................................................ 69
3.4.9
Partial channel release procedure.................................................................................................................. 69
ETSI
3.4.9.1
Partial release procedure initiation .......................................................................................................... 69
3.4.9.2
Abnormal cases........................................................................................................................................ 69
3.4.10
Classmark change procedure ........................................................................................................................ 70
3.4.11
Classmark interrogation procedure ............................................................................................................... 70
3.4.11.1
Classmark interrogation initiation ........................................................................................................... 70
3.4.11.2
Classmark interrogation completion ....................................................................................................... 70
3.4.12
Indication of notifications and paging information ...................................................................................... 70
3.4.13
RR connection release procedure.................................................................................................................. 70
3.4.13.1
Normal release procedure ........................................................................................................................ 70
3.4.13.1.1
Channel release procedure initiation in dedicated mode and in group transmit mode .................... 71
3.4.13.1.2
Abnormal cases .................................................................................................................................. 72
3.4.13.2
Radio link failure in dedicated mode ...................................................................................................... 72
3.4.13.2.1
Mobile side......................................................................................................................................... 72
3.4.13.2.2
Network side ...................................................................................................................................... 72
3.4.13.3
RR connection abortion in dedicated mode ............................................................................................ 73
3.4.13.4
Uplink release procedure in group transmit mode .................................................................................. 73
3.4.13.5
Radio link failure in group transmit mode .............................................................................................. 73
3.4.13.5.1
Mobile side......................................................................................................................................... 73
3.4.13.5.2
Network side ...................................................................................................................................... 73
3.4.14
Receiving a RR STATUS message by a RR entity ...................................................................................... 74
3.4.15
Group receive mode procedures ................................................................................................................... 74
3.4.15.1
Mobile station side .................................................................................................................................. 74
3.4.15.1.1
Reception of the VGCS or VBS channel .......................................................................................... 74
3.4.15.1.2
Monitoring of downlink messages and related procedures .............................................................. 74
3.4.15.1.2.1
Spare ............................................................................................................................................. 74
3.4.15.1.2.2
Spare ............................................................................................................................................. 74
3.4.15.1.2.3
Channel mode modify procedure ................................................................................................ 74
3.4.15.1.2.4
Notification and paging information ........................................................................................... 74
3.4.15.1.2.4.1
Use of Reduced NCH monitoring .......................................................................................... 75
3.4.15.1.2.5
Uplink status messages ................................................................................................................ 75
3.4.15.1.2.6
Channel release message ............................................................................................................. 75
3.4.15.1.2.7
Information on paging channel restructuring .............................................................................. 75
3.4.15.1.3
Uplink reply procedure ...................................................................................................................... 75
3.4.15.1.4
Leaving the group receive mode ....................................................................................................... 76
3.4.15.2
Network side ............................................................................................................................................ 76
3.4.15.2.1
Provision of messages on the VGCS or VBS channel downlink ..................................................... 76
3.4.15.2.2
Release of the VGCS or VBS Channels............................................................................................ 77
3.4.15.3
Failure cases............................................................................................................................................. 77
3.4.16
Configuration change procedure ................................................................................................................... 77
3.4.16.1
Configuration change initiation............................................................................................................... 78
3.4.16.2
Configuration change completion ........................................................................................................... 78
3.4.16.3
Abnormal cases........................................................................................................................................ 78
3.4.17
Mapping of user data substreams onto timeslots in a multislot configuration ............................................ 78
3.4.18
Handling of classmark information at band change ..................................................................................... 78
3.4.19
Assignment to a Packet Data channel ........................................................................................................... 79
3.4.19.1
Assignment to PDCH initiation .............................................................................................................. 79
3.4.19.2
Completion of the Assignment to PDCH procedure .............................................................................. 80
3.4.19.3
Abnormal cases........................................................................................................................................ 80
3.4.20
RR-Network Commanded Cell Change Order ............................................................................................. 81
3.4.20.1
RR-network commanded cell change order initiation ............................................................................ 81
3.4.20.2
Network controlled cell reselection completion ..................................................................................... 82
3.4.20.3
Abnormal cases........................................................................................................................................ 82
3.5
RR procedures on CCCH related to temporary block flow establishment ........................................................ 82
3.5.1
Packet paging procedure using CCCH ......................................................................................................... 82
3.5.1.1
Packet paging initiation by the network.................................................................................................. 83
3.5.1.2
On receipt of a packet paging request ..................................................................................................... 83
3.5.2
Packet access procedure using CCCH .......................................................................................................... 83
3.5.2.1
Entering the packet transfer mode: packet access procedure ................................................................. 83
3.5.2.1.1
Permission to access the network ...................................................................................................... 84
3.5.2.1.2
Initiation of the packet access procedure: channel request ............................................................... 84
3.5.2.1.3
Packet immediate assignment............................................................................................................ 85
3.5.2.1.4
Packet access completion .................................................................................................................. 87
ETSI
3.5.2.1.5
3.5.2.2
3.5.3
3.5.3.1
3.5.3.1.1
3.5.3.1.2
3.5.3.1.3
3.5.3.1.4
3.5.3.2
4.1
General ................................................................................................................................................................ 90
4.1.1
MM and GMM procedures ........................................................................................................................... 91
4.1.1.1
Types of MM and GMM procedures ...................................................................................................... 91
4.1.1.2
MM-GMM co-ordination for GPRS MSs ............................................................................................. 92
4.1.1.2.1
GPRS MS operating in mode A or B in a network that operates in mode I..................................... 92
4.1.1.2.2
GPRS MS operating in mode A or B in a network that operates in mode II or III .......................... 93
4.1.2
MM sublayer states ....................................................................................................................................... 93
4.1.2.1
MM sublayer states in the mobile station ............................................................................................... 93
4.1.2.1.1
Main states ......................................................................................................................................... 93
4.1.2.1.2
Substates of the MM IDLE state ....................................................................................................... 97
4.1.2.2
The update Status..................................................................................................................................... 98
4.1.2.3
MM sublayer states on the network side................................................................................................. 99
4.1.3
GPRS mobility management (GMM) sublayer states ................................................................................ 100
4.1.3.1
GMM states in the MS .......................................................................................................................... 100
4.1.3.1.1
Main states ....................................................................................................................................... 100
4.1.3.1.1.1
GMM-NULL .............................................................................................................................. 100
4.1.3.1.1.2
GMM-DEREGISTERED .......................................................................................................... 100
4.1.3.1.1.3
GMM-REGISTERED-INITIATED .......................................................................................... 100
4.1.3.1.1.4
GMM-REGISTERED ................................................................................................................ 101
4.1.3.1.1.5
GMM-DEREGISTERED-INITIATED ..................................................................................... 101
4.1.3.1.2.5
GMM-DEREGISTERED.NO-IMSI.......................................................................................... 101
4.1.3.1.2.6
GMM-DEREGISTERED.NO-CELL-AVAILABLE ............................................................... 101
4.1.3.1.2.7
GMM-DEREGISTERED.PLMN-SEARCH ............................................................................. 101
4.1.3.1.2.8
GMM-DEREGISTERED.SUSPENDED .................................................................................. 102
4.1.3.1.3
Substates of state GMM-REGISTERED ........................................................................................ 102
4.1.3.1.3.1
GMM-REGISTERED.NORMAL-SERVICE ........................................................................... 102
4.1.3.1.3.2
GMM-REGISTERED.SUSPENDED ....................................................................................... 102
4.1.3.1.3.3
GMM-REGISTERED.UPDATE-NEEDED ............................................................................. 102
4.1.3.1.3.4
GMM-REGISTERED.ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE ............................................................. 102
4.1.3.1.3.5
GMM-REGISTERED.NO-CELL-AVAILABLE ..................................................................... 102
4.1.3.1.3.6
GMM-REGISTERED.LIMITED-SERVICE ............................................................................ 103
4.1.3.1.3.7
GMM-REGISTERED.ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE-MM .................................................... 103
4.1.3.1.3.8
GMM-REGISTERED.IMSI-DETACH-INITIATED ............................................................... 103
4.1.3.2
GPRS update status ............................................................................................................................... 103
4.1.3.3
GMM mobility management states on the network side ...................................................................... 104
4.1.3.3.1
Main States....................................................................................................................................... 104
4.1.3.3.1.1
GMM-DEREGISTERED .......................................................................................................... 104
4.1.3.3.1.2
GMM-COMMON-PROCEDURE-INITIATED ....................................................................... 104
4.1.3.3.1.3
GMM-REGISTERED ................................................................................................................ 104
4.1.3.3.1.4
GMM-DEREGISTERED-INITIATED ..................................................................................... 104
4.1.3.3.2
Substates of state GMM-REGISTERED ........................................................................................ 105
4.1.3.3.2.1
GMM-REGISTERED.NORMAL-SERVICE ........................................................................... 105
4.1.3.3.2.2
GMM-REGISTERED.SUSPENDED ....................................................................................... 105
4.2
Behaviour of the MS in MM Idle state, GMM-DEREGISTERED state and GMM-REGISTERED state .... 105
4.2.1
Primary Service State selection................................................................................................................... 106
4.2.1.1
Selection of the Service State after Power On ...................................................................................... 106
4.2.1.2
Other Cases ............................................................................................................................................ 106
4.2.2
Detailed Description of the MS behaviour in MM IDLE State ................................................................. 107
4.2.2.1
Service State, NORMAL SERVICE ..................................................................................................... 107
4.2.2.2
Service State, ATTEMPTING TO UPDATE ....................................................................................... 107
4.2.2.3
Service State, LIMITED SERVICE...................................................................................................... 108
ETSI
4.2.2.4
Service State, NO IMSI ......................................................................................................................... 108
4.2.2.5
Service State, SEARCH FOR PLMN, NORMAL SERVICE ............................................................. 109
4.2.2.6
Service State, SEARCH FOR PLMN ................................................................................................... 109
4.2.2.7
Service State, RECEIVING GROUP CALL (NORMAL SERVICE) ................................................. 109
4.2.2.8
Service State, RECEIVING GROUP CALL (LIMITED SERVICE).................................................. 110
4.2.3
Service state when back to state MM IDLE from another state ................................................................ 110
4.2.4
Behaviour in state GMM-DEREGISTERED ............................................................................................. 111
4.2.4.1
Primary substate selection ..................................................................................................................... 111
4.2.4.1.1
Selection of the substate after power on or enabling the MSs GPRS capability .......................... 111
4.2.4.1.2
Other Cases ...................................................................................................................................... 111
4.2.4.2
Detailed description of the MS behaviour in state GMM-DEREGISTERED ..................................... 112
4.2.4.2.1
Substate, NORMAL-SERVICE ...................................................................................................... 112
4.2.4.2.2
Substate, ATTEMPTING-TO-ATTACH........................................................................................ 112
4.2.4.2.3
Substate, LIMITED-SERVICE ....................................................................................................... 112
4.2.4.2.4
Substate, NO-IMSI .......................................................................................................................... 112
4.2.4.2.5
Substate, NO-CELL ......................................................................................................................... 112
4.2.4.2.6
Substate, PLMN-SEARCH ............................................................................................................. 113
4.2.4.2.7
Substate, ATTACH-NEEDED ........................................................................................................ 113
4.2.4.2.8
Substate, SUSPENDED................................................................................................................... 113
4.2.4.3
Substate when back to state GMM-DEREGISTERED from another GMM state .............................. 113
4.2.5
Behaviour in state GMM-REGISTERED .................................................................................................. 113
4.2.5.1
Detailed description of the MS behaviour in state GMM-REGISTERED .......................................... 114
4.2.5.1.1
Substate, NORMAL-SERVICE ...................................................................................................... 114
4.2.5.1.2
Substate, SUSPENDED................................................................................................................... 114
4.2.5.1.3
Substate, UPDATE-NEEDED ........................................................................................................ 114
4.2.5.1.4
Substate, ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE ........................................................................................ 114
4.2.5.1.5
Substate, NO-CELL-AVAILABLE ................................................................................................ 114
4.2.5.1.6
Substate, LIMITED-SERVICE ....................................................................................................... 115
4.2.5.1.7
Substate, ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE-MM ............................................................................... 115
4.3
MM common procedures .................................................................................................................................. 115
4.3.1
TMSI reallocation procedure ...................................................................................................................... 115
4.3.1.1
TMSI reallocation initiation by the network ......................................................................................... 115
4.3.1.2
TMSI reallocation completion by the mobile station ........................................................................... 116
4.3.1.3
TMSI reallocation completion in the network ...................................................................................... 116
4.3.1.4
Abnormal cases...................................................................................................................................... 116
4.3.2
Authentication procedure ............................................................................................................................ 117
4.3.2.1
Authentication request by the network ................................................................................................. 117
4.3.2.2
Authentication response by the mobile station ..................................................................................... 117
4.3.2.3
Authentication processing in the network............................................................................................. 117
4.3.2.4
Ciphering key sequence number ........................................................................................................... 117
4.3.2.5
Unsuccessful authentication .................................................................................................................. 117
4.3.2.6
Abnormal cases...................................................................................................................................... 118
4.3.3
Identification procedure .............................................................................................................................. 118
4.3.3.1
Identity request by the network ............................................................................................................. 119
4.3.3.2
Identification response by the mobile station ....................................................................................... 119
4.3.3.3
Abnormal cases...................................................................................................................................... 119
4.3.4
IMSI detach procedure ................................................................................................................................ 119
4.3.4.1
IMSI detach initiation by the mobile station......................................................................................... 119
4.3.4.2
IMSI detach procedure in the network.................................................................................................. 120
4.3.4.3
IMSI detach completion by the mobile station ..................................................................................... 120
4.3.4.4
Abnormal cases...................................................................................................................................... 120
4.3.5
Abort procedure ........................................................................................................................................... 120
4.3.5.1
Abort procedure initiation by the network ............................................................................................ 120
4.3.5.2
Abort procedure in the mobile station................................................................................................... 120
4.3.6
MM information procedure ......................................................................................................................... 120
4.3.6.1
MM information procedure initiation by the network .......................................................................... 121
4.3.6.2
MM information procedure in the mobile station................................................................................. 121
4.4
MM specific procedures ................................................................................................................................... 121
4.4.1
Location updating procedure ...................................................................................................................... 121
4.4.2
Periodic updating......................................................................................................................................... 122
4.4.3
IMSI attach procedure ................................................................................................................................. 123
4.4.4
Generic Location Updating procedure ........................................................................................................ 123
ETSI
4.4.4.1
Location updating initiation by the mobile station ............................................................................... 123
4.4.4.1a
Network Request for Additional mobile station Capability Information............................................. 123
4.4.4.2
Identification request from the network ................................................................................................ 123
4.4.4.3
Authentication by the network .............................................................................................................. 123
4.4.4.4
Ciphering mode setting by the network ................................................................................................ 123
4.4.4.5
Attempt Counter .................................................................................................................................... 124
4.4.4.6
Location updating accepted by the network ......................................................................................... 124
4.4.4.7
Location updating not accepted by the network ................................................................................... 125
4.4.4.8
Release of RR connection after location updating ............................................................................... 125
4.4.4.9
Abnormal cases on the mobile station side ........................................................................................... 125
4.4.4.10
Abnormal cases on the network side..................................................................................................... 126
4.5
Connection management sublayer service provision ....................................................................................... 127
4.5.1
MM connection establishment .................................................................................................................... 127
4.5.1.1
MM connection establishment initiated by the mobile station............................................................. 127
4.5.1.2
Abnormal cases...................................................................................................................................... 130
4.5.1.3
MM connection establishment initiated by the network ...................................................................... 131
4.5.1.3.1
Mobile Terminating CM Activity ................................................................................................... 131
4.5.1.3.2
Mobile Originating CM Activity $(CCBS)$................................................................................... 131
4.5.1.4
Abnormal cases...................................................................................................................................... 132
4.5.1.5
MM connection establishment for emergency calls ............................................................................. 132
4.5.1.6
Call re-establishment ............................................................................................................................. 133
4.5.1.6.1
Call re-establishment, initiation by the mobile station ................................................................... 133
4.5.1.6.2
Abnormal cases ................................................................................................................................ 134
4.5.1.7
Forced release during MO MM connection establishment .................................................................. 135
4.5.2
MM connection information transfer phase ............................................................................................... 136
4.5.2.1
Sending CM messages........................................................................................................................... 136
4.5.2.2
Receiving CM messages ....................................................................................................................... 136
4.5.2.3
Abnormal cases...................................................................................................................................... 136
4.5.3
MM connection release ............................................................................................................................... 136
4.5.3.1
Release of associated RR connection.................................................................................................... 136
4.5.3.2
Uplink release in a voice group call ...................................................................................................... 137
4.6
Receiving a MM STATUS message by a MM entity ...................................................................................... 137
4.7
Elementary mobility management procedures for GPRS services .................................................................. 137
4.7.1
General......................................................................................................................................................... 137
4.7.1.1
Lower layer failure ................................................................................................................................ 137
4.7.1.2
Ciphering of messages........................................................................................................................... 137
4.7.1.3
P-TMSI signature .................................................................................................................................. 138
4.7.1.4
Radio resource sublayer address handling ............................................................................................ 138
4.7.1.5
P-TMSI handling ................................................................................................................................... 139
4.7.1.6
Change of network mode of operation .................................................................................................. 139
4.7.2
GPRS Mobility management timers ........................................................................................................... 140
4.7.2.1
READY timer behaviour ....................................................................................................................... 140
4.7.2.2
Periodic routing area updating .............................................................................................................. 141
4.7.3
GPRS attach procedure ............................................................................................................................... 142
4.7.3.1
GPRS attach procedure for GPRS services .......................................................................................... 143
4.7.3.1.1
GPRS attach procedure initiation .................................................................................................... 143
4.7.3.1.2
GMM common procedure initiation................................................................................................ 143
4.7.3.1.3
GPRS attach accepted by the network ............................................................................................ 143
4.7.3.1.4
GPRS attach not accepted by the network ...................................................................................... 144
4.7.3.1.5
Abnormal cases in the MS ............................................................................................................... 145
4.7.3.1.6
Abnormal cases on the network side ............................................................................................... 146
4.7.3.2
Combined GPRS attach procedure for GPRS and non-GPRS services ............................................... 147
4.7.3.2.1
Combined GPRS attach procedure initiation .................................................................................. 147
4.7.3.2.2
GMM Common procedure initiation............................................................................................... 148
4.7.3.2.3
Combined GPRS attach accepted by the network .......................................................................... 148
4.7.3.2.3.1
Combined attach successful for GPRS and non-GPRS services .............................................. 148
4.7.3.2.3.2
Combined attach successful for GPRS services only ............................................................... 148
4.7.3.2.4
Combined GPRS attach not accepted by the network .................................................................... 149
4.7.3.2.5
Abnormal cases in the MS ............................................................................................................... 150
4.7.4
GPRS detach procedure .............................................................................................................................. 150
4.7.4.1
MS initiated GPRS detach procedure ................................................................................................... 151
4.7.4.1.1
MS initiated GPRS detach procedure initiation .............................................................................. 151
ETSI
4.7.4.1.2
4.7.4.1.3
4.7.4.1.4
4.7.4.2
4.7.4.2.1
4.7.4.2.2
4.7.4.2.3
4.7.4.2.4
4.7.5
4.7.5.1
4.7.5.1.1
4.7.5.1.2
4.7.5.1.3
4.7.5.1.4
4.7.5.1.5
4.7.5.1.6
4.7.5.2
4.7.5.2.1
4.7.5.2.2
4.7.5.2.3
4.7.5.2.3.1
4.7.5.2.3.2
4.7.5.2.4
4.7.5.2.5
4.7.5.2.6
4.7.6
4.7.6.1
4.7.6.2
4.7.6.3
4.7.6.4
4.7.7
4.7.7.1
4.7.7.2
4.7.7.3
4.7.7.4
4.7.7.5
4.7.7.6
4.7.8
4.7.8.1
4.7.8.2
4.7.8.3
4.7.8.4
4.7.9
4.7.9.1
4.7.9.1.1
4.7.9.1.2
4.7.9.2
4.7.10
4.7.11
4.7.11.1
4.7.11.2
4.7.12
4.7.12.1
4.7.12.2
MS initiated GPRS detach procedure completion for GPRS services only ................................... 151
MS initiated combined GPRS detach procedure completion ......................................................... 151
Abnormal cases in the MS ............................................................................................................... 151
Network initiated GPRS detach procedure ........................................................................................... 153
Network initiated GPRS detach procedure initiation...................................................................... 153
Network initiated GPRS detach procedure completion by the MS ................................................ 153
Network initiated GPRS detach procedure completion by the network......................................... 154
Abnormal cases on the network side ............................................................................................... 154
Routing area updating procedure ................................................................................................................ 155
Normal and periodic routing area updating procedure ......................................................................... 156
Normal and periodic routing area updating procedure initiation.................................................... 156
GMM Common procedure initiation............................................................................................... 156
Normal and periodic routing area updating procedure accepted by the network........................... 157
Normal and periodic routing area updating procedure not accepted by the network .................... 157
Abnormal cases in the MS ............................................................................................................... 158
Abnormal cases on the network side ............................................................................................... 159
Combined routing area updating procedure.......................................................................................... 160
Combined routing area updating procedure initiation .................................................................... 160
GMM Common procedure initiation............................................................................................... 161
Combined routing area updating procedure accepted by the network ........................................... 161
Combined routing area updating successful .............................................................................. 161
Combined routing are updating successful for GPRS services only ........................................ 162
Combined routing area updating not accepted by the network ...................................................... 162
Abnormal cases in the MS ............................................................................................................... 163
Abnormal cases on the network side ............................................................................................... 164
P-TMSI reallocation procedure ................................................................................................................... 164
P-TMSI reallocation initiation by the network ..................................................................................... 164
P-TMSI reallocation completion by the MS ......................................................................................... 164
P-TMSI reallocation completion by the network ................................................................................. 164
Abnormal cases on the network side..................................................................................................... 164
Authentication and ciphering procedure ..................................................................................................... 165
Authentication and ciphering initiation by the network ....................................................................... 166
Authentication and ciphering response by the MS ............................................................................... 166
Authentication and ciphering completion by the network.................................................................... 167
GPRS ciphering key sequence number ................................................................................................. 167
Unsuccessful authentication and ciphering ........................................................................................... 167
Abnormal cases on the network side..................................................................................................... 168
Identification procedure .............................................................................................................................. 169
Identification initiation by the network................................................................................................. 169
Identification response by the MS......................................................................................................... 169
Identification completion by the network ............................................................................................. 169
Abnormal cases on the network side..................................................................................................... 169
Paging procedure ......................................................................................................................................... 170
Paging for GPRS services ..................................................................................................................... 170
Paging for GPRS services using P-TMSI ....................................................................................... 170
Paging for GPRS services using IMSI ............................................................................................ 171
Paging for non-GPRS services .............................................................................................................. 171
Receiving a GMM STATUS message by a GMM entity .......................................................................... 171
GMM support for anonymous access ......................................................................................................... 171
MS side .................................................................................................................................................. 171
Network side .......................................................................................................................................... 172
GMM Information procedure...................................................................................................................... 172
GMM information procedure initiation by the network ....................................................................... 172
GMM information procedure in the mobile station .............................................................................. 172
5.1
Overview ........................................................................................................................................................... 172
5.1.1
General......................................................................................................................................................... 172
5.1.2
Call Control States ...................................................................................................................................... 177
5.1.2.1
Call states at the mobile station side of the interface............................................................................ 177
5.1.2.1.1
Null (State U0) ................................................................................................................................. 177
5.1.2.1.2
MM Connection pending (U0.1) ..................................................................................................... 177
ETSI
10
5.1.2.1.2a
CC prompt present (U0.2) $(CCBS)$ ............................................................................................. 178
5.1.2.1.2b
Wait for network information (U0.3) $(CCBS)$ ............................................................................ 178
5.1.2.1.2c
CC-Establishment present (U0.4) $(CCBS)$ ................................................................................. 178
5.1.2.1.2d
CC-Establishment confirmed (U0.5) $(CCBS)$ ............................................................................ 178
5.1.2.1.2e
Recall present (U0.6) $(CCBS)$ ..................................................................................................... 178
5.1.2.1.3
Call initiated (U1) ............................................................................................................................ 178
5.1.2.1.4
Mobile originating call proceeding (U3) ......................................................................................... 178
5.1.2.1.5
Call delivered (U4) .......................................................................................................................... 178
5.1.2.1.6
Call present (U6) .............................................................................................................................. 178
5.1.2.1.7
Call received (U7) ............................................................................................................................ 178
5.1.2.1.8
Connect Request (U8)...................................................................................................................... 178
5.1.2.1.9
Mobile terminating call confirmed (U9) ......................................................................................... 179
5.1.2.1.10
Active (U10) .................................................................................................................................... 179
5.1.2.1.11
Disconnect request (U11) ................................................................................................................ 179
5.1.2.1.12
Disconnect indication (U12)............................................................................................................ 179
5.1.2.1.13
Release request (U19) ...................................................................................................................... 179
5.1.2.1.14
Mobile originating modify (U26) .................................................................................................... 179
5.1.2.1.15
Mobile terminating modify (U27) ................................................................................................... 179
5.1.2.2
Network call states ................................................................................................................................ 179
5.1.2.2.1
Null (State N0) ................................................................................................................................. 179
5.1.2.2.2
MM connection pending (N0.1) ...................................................................................................... 179
5.1.2.2.2a
CC connection pending (N0.2) $(CCBS)$...................................................................................... 179
5.1.2.2.2b
Network answer pending (N0.3) $(CCBS)$ ................................................................................... 179
5.1.2.2.2c
CC-Establishment present (N0.4) $(CCBS)$ ................................................................................. 180
5.1.2.2.2d
CC-Establishment confirmed (N0.5) $(CCBS)$ ............................................................................ 180
5.1.2.2.3
Call initiated (N1) ............................................................................................................................ 180
5.1.2.2.4
Mobile originating call proceeding (N3) ......................................................................................... 180
5.1.2.2.5
Call delivered (N4) .......................................................................................................................... 180
5.1.2.2.6
Call present (N6) .............................................................................................................................. 180
5.1.2.2.7
Call received (N7) ............................................................................................................................ 180
5.1.2.2.8
Connect request (N8) ....................................................................................................................... 180
5.1.2.2.9
Mobile terminating call confirmed (N9) ......................................................................................... 180
5.1.2.2.10
Active (N10) .................................................................................................................................... 180
5.1.2.2.11
Not used ........................................................................................................................................... 180
5.1.2.2.12
Disconnect indication (N12)............................................................................................................ 180
5.1.2.2.13
Release request (N19) ...................................................................................................................... 181
5.1.2.2.14
Mobile originating modify (N26) .................................................................................................... 181
5.1.2.2.15
Mobile terminating modify (N27) ................................................................................................... 181
5.1.2.2.16
Connect Indication (N28) ................................................................................................................ 181
5.2
Call establishment procedures .......................................................................................................................... 181
5.2.1
Mobile originating call establishment......................................................................................................... 181
5.2.1.1
Call initiation ......................................................................................................................................... 182
5.2.1.2
Receipt of a setup message.................................................................................................................... 182
5.2.1.3
Receipt of a CALL PROCEEDING message ....................................................................................... 183
5.2.1.4
Notification of progressing mobile originated call ............................................................................... 184
5.2.1.4.1
Notification of interworking in connection with mobile originated call establishment ................ 184
5.2.1.4.2
Call progress in the PLMN/ISDN environment .............................................................................. 184
5.2.1.5
Alerting .................................................................................................................................................. 184
5.2.1.6
Call connected ....................................................................................................................................... 185
5.2.1.7
Call rejection .......................................................................................................................................... 186
5.2.1.8
Transit network selection ...................................................................................................................... 186
5.2.1.9
Traffic channel assignment at mobile originating call establishment .................................................. 186
5.2.1.10
Call queuing at mobile originating call establishment ......................................................................... 186
5.2.2
Mobile terminating call establishment ........................................................................................................ 186
5.2.2.1
Call indication........................................................................................................................................ 186
5.2.2.2
Compatibility checking ......................................................................................................................... 187
5.2.2.3
Call confirmation ................................................................................................................................... 187
5.2.2.3.1
Response to SETUP ......................................................................................................................... 187
5.2.2.3.2
Receipt of CALL CONFIRMED and ALERTING by the network ............................................... 188
5.2.2.3.3
Call failure procedures..................................................................................................................... 188
5.2.2.3.4
Called mobile station clearing during mobile terminating call establishment ............................... 188
5.2.2.4
Notification of interworking in connection with mobile terminating call establishment .................... 188
ETSI
11
5.2.2.5
Call accept ............................................................................................................................................. 189
5.2.2.6
Active indication.................................................................................................................................... 189
5.2.2.7
Traffic channel assignment at mobile terminating call establishment ................................................. 189
5.2.2.8
Call queuing at mobile terminating call establishment ........................................................................ 189
5.2.2.9
User connection attachment during a mobile terminating call ............................................................. 190
5.2.3
Network initiated MO call $(CCBS)$ ........................................................................................................ 190
5.2.3.1
Initiation ................................................................................................................................................. 190
5.2.3.2
CC-Establishment present ..................................................................................................................... 190
5.2.3.2.1
Recall Alignment Procedure............................................................................................................ 191
5.2.3.3
CC-Establishment confirmation ............................................................................................................ 192
5.2.3.4
Recall present ........................................................................................................................................ 192
5.2.3.5
Traffic channel assignment during network initiated mobile originating call establishment .............. 193
5.3
Signalling procedures during the "active" state ............................................................................................... 193
5.3.1
User notification procedure ......................................................................................................................... 193
5.3.2
Call rearrangements..................................................................................................................................... 193
5.3.3
Not used ....................................................................................................................................................... 194
5.3.4
Support of Dual Services ............................................................................................................................ 194
5.3.4.1
Service Description ............................................................................................................................... 194
5.3.4.2
Call establishment ................................................................................................................................. 194
5.3.4.2.1
Mobile Originating Establishment .................................................................................................. 194
5.3.4.2.2
Mobile Terminating Establishment ................................................................................................. 195
5.3.4.3
Changing the Call Mode........................................................................................................................ 195
5.3.4.3.1
Initiation of in-call modification ..................................................................................................... 196
5.3.4.3.2
Successful completion of in-call modification................................................................................ 196
5.3.4.3.3
Change of the channel configuration .............................................................................................. 196
5.3.4.3.4
Failure of in-call modification ......................................................................................................... 196
5.3.4.3.4.1
Network rejection of in-call modification ................................................................................. 196
5.3.4.3.4.2
Mobile station rejection of in-call modification ........................................................................ 197
5.3.4.3.4.3
Time-out recovery ...................................................................................................................... 197
5.3.4.4
Abnormal procedures ............................................................................................................................ 197
5.3.5
User initiated service level up- and downgrading ...................................................................................... 197
5.3.5.1
Initiation of service level up- and downgrading ................................................................................... 197
5.3.5.2
Successful completion of service level up- and downgrading ............................................................. 198
5.3.5.3
Rejection of service level up- and downgrading .................................................................................. 198
5.3.5.4
Time-out recovery ................................................................................................................................. 198
5.4
Call clearing ...................................................................................................................................................... 198
5.4.1
Terminology ................................................................................................................................................ 198
5.4.2
Exception conditions ................................................................................................................................... 199
5.4.3
Clearing initiated by the mobile station ...................................................................................................... 199
5.4.3.1
Initiation of call clearing ....................................................................................................................... 199
5.4.3.2
Receipt of a DISCONNECT message from the mobile station. .......................................................... 199
5.4.3.3
Receipt of a RELEASE message from the network ............................................................................. 200
5.4.3.4
Receipt of a RELEASE COMPLETE message from the mobile station ............................................. 200
5.4.3.5
Abnormal cases...................................................................................................................................... 200
5.4.4
Clearing initiated by the network ................................................................................................................ 200
5.4.4.1
Clearing initiated by the network: mobile does not support "Prolonged Clearing Procedure" ........... 200
5.4.4.1.1
Clearing when tones/announcements provided............................................................................... 200
5.4.4.1.2
Clearing when tones/announcements not provided ........................................................................ 201
5.4.4.1.3
Completion of clearing .................................................................................................................... 201
5.4.4.2
Clearing initiated by the network: mobile supports "Prolonged Clearing Procedure" ........................ 201
5.4.4.2.1
Clearing when tones/announcements provided and the network does not indicate that "CCBS
activation is possible" ...................................................................................................................... 202
5.4.4.2.2
Clearing when the network indicates that "CCBS activation is possible" ..................................... 202
5.4.4.2.3
Clearing when tones/announcements are not provided and the network does not indicate that
"CCBS activation is possible" ......................................................................................................... 203
5.4.4.2.4
Receipt of a RELEASE message from the mobile station.............................................................. 204
5.4.4.2.5
Completion of clearing .................................................................................................................... 204
5.4.5
Clear collision.............................................................................................................................................. 205
5.5
Miscellaneous procedures ................................................................................................................................. 205
5.5.1
In-band tones and announcements .............................................................................................................. 205
5.5.2
Call collisions .............................................................................................................................................. 205
5.5.3
Status procedures ......................................................................................................................................... 205
ETSI
5.5.3.1
5.5.3.2
5.5.3.2.1
5.5.3.2.2
5.5.4
5.5.4.1
5.5.4.2
5.5.4.3
5.5.4.4
5.5.5
5.5.5.1
5.5.6
5.5.7
5.5.7.1
5.5.7.2
5.5.7.3
5.5.7.4
5.5.7.5
12
6.1
GPRS Session management .............................................................................................................................. 209
6.1.1
General......................................................................................................................................................... 209
6.1.1.1
Radio resource sublayer address handling for anonymous access ....................................................... 209
6.1.2
Session management states ......................................................................................................................... 209
6.1.2.1
Session management states in the MS .................................................................................................. 209
6.1.2.1.1
PDP-INACTIVE .............................................................................................................................. 210
6.1.2.1.2
PDP-ACTIVE-PENDING ............................................................................................................... 210
6.1.2.1.3
PDP-INACTIVE-PENDING ........................................................................................................... 210
6.1.2.1.4
PDP-ACTIVE .................................................................................................................................. 210
6.1.2.2
Session management states on the network side .................................................................................. 210
6.1.2.2.1
PDP-INACTIVE .............................................................................................................................. 210
6.1.2.2.2
PDP-ACTIVE-PENDING ............................................................................................................... 211
6.1.2.2.3
PDP-INACTIVE-PENDING ........................................................................................................... 211
6.1.2.2.4
PDP-ACTIVE .................................................................................................................................. 211
6.1.2.2.5
PDP-MODIFY-PENDING .............................................................................................................. 211
6.1.3
Session Management procedures ................................................................................................................ 211
6.1.3.1
PDP context activation .......................................................................................................................... 211
6.1.3.1.1
Successful PDP context activation initiated by the mobile station ................................................ 212
6.1.3.1.2
Successful PDP context activation requested by the network ........................................................ 212
6.1.3.1.3
Unsuccessful PDP context activation initiated by the MS ............................................................. 212
6.1.3.1.4
Unsuccessful PDP context activation requested by the network .................................................... 212
6.1.3.1.5
Abnormal cases ................................................................................................................................ 213
6.1.3.2
PDP context modification procedure .................................................................................................... 214
6.1.3.2.1
Abnormal cases ................................................................................................................................ 215
6.1.3.3
PDP context deactivation procedure ..................................................................................................... 215
6.1.3.3.1
PDP context deactivation initiated by the MS ................................................................................ 215
6.1.3.3.2
PDP context deactivation initiated by the network ......................................................................... 215
6.1.3.3.3
Abnormal cases ................................................................................................................................ 216
6.1.3.4
AA PDP context activation ................................................................................................................... 216
6.1.3.4.1
Successful AA PDP context activation initiated by the mobile station.......................................... 216
6.1.3.4.2
Unsuccessful AA PDP context activation ....................................................................................... 217
6.1.3.4.3
Abnormal cases ................................................................................................................................ 217
6.1.3.5
AA PDP context deactivation ............................................................................................................... 217
6.1.3.5.1
Implicit AA PDP context deactivation ............................................................................................ 217
6.1.3.5.2
Explicit AA PDP context deactivation ............................................................................................ 218
6.1.3.5.3
Abnormal cases ................................................................................................................................ 218
6.1.3.6
Receiving a SM STATUS message by a SM entity ............................................................................. 218
7
7.1
7.1.1
7.1.2
ETSI
7.1.3
7.1.4
7.1.5
7.1.6
7.1.6.1
7.1.7
7.2
7.3
7.3.1
7.3.2
7.3.3
7.3.4
7.3.5
7.3.6
7.3.7
7.3.8
7.3.9
8
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.3.1
8.3.2
8.4
8.5
8.5.1
8.5.2
8.5.3
8.5.4
8.5.5
8.6
8.6.1
8.6.2
8.6.3
8.7
8.7.1
8.7.2
8.8
13
9.1
Messages for Radio Resources management ................................................................................................... 245
9.1.1
Additional assignment ................................................................................................................................. 247
9.1.1.1
Mobile Allocation .................................................................................................................................. 248
9.1.1.2
Starting Time ......................................................................................................................................... 248
9.1.2
Assignment command ................................................................................................................................. 248
9.1.2.1
Mode of the First Channel (Channel Set 1) and Mode of Channel Set "X" (2=<X=<8) .................... 249
9.1.2.2
Description of the Second Channel ....................................................................................................... 250
9.1.2.3
Mode of the Second Channel ................................................................................................................ 250
9.1.2.4
Mobile Allocation and Frequency List, after the starting time ............................................................ 250
9.1.2.5
Starting Time ......................................................................................................................................... 250
9.1.2.6
Reference cell frequency list ................................................................................................................. 251
9.1.2.7
Cell Channel Description ...................................................................................................................... 251
9.1.2.8
Cipher Mode Setting.............................................................................................................................. 251
9.1.2.9
VGCS target mode Indication ............................................................................................................... 251
9.1.2.10
Description of the multislot allocation .................................................................................................. 251
9.1.2.11
Multi Rate configuration ....................................................................................................................... 251
9.1.3
Assignment complete .................................................................................................................................. 252
9.1.4
Assignment failure ...................................................................................................................................... 252
9.1.5
Channel mode modify ................................................................................................................................. 253
9.1.5.1
Channel Description .............................................................................................................................. 253
9.1.5.2
VGCS target mode Indication ............................................................................................................... 253
ETSI
9.1.5.3
9.1.6
9.1.7
9.1.7.1
9.1.7.2
9.1.8
9.1.9
9.1.10
9.1.10.1
9.1.11
9.1.11.1
9.1.11.2
9.1.12
9.1.12a
9.1.12b
9.1.12b.1
9.1.12b.2
9.1.12c
9.1.12d
9.1.13
9.1.13.1
9.1.13a
9.1.13a.1
9.1.13a.2
9.1.13a.3
9.1.13a.4
9.1.13a.5
9.1.13b
9.1.14
9.1.15
9.1.15.1
9.1.15.2
9.1.15.3
9.1.15.4
9.1.15.5
9.1.15.6
9.1.15.7
9.1.15.8
9.1.15.9
9.1.15.10
9.1.15.11
9.1.15.12
9.1.15.13
9.1.16
9.1.16.1
9.1.17
9.1.18
9.1.18.0a
9.1.18.0b
9.1.18.0c
9.1.18.0d
9.1.18.0e
9.1.18.1
9.1.18.2
9.1.18.3
9.1.18.4
9.1.19
9.1.19.1
9.1.19.2
9.1.19.3
9.1.19.4
14
ETSI
9.1.19.5
9.1.20
9.1.20.1
9.1.20.2
9.1.20.3
9.1.20.4
9.1.21
9.1.21a
9.1.21a.1
9.1.21a.2
9.1.21a.3
9.1.21a.4
9.1.21b
9.1.21b.1
9.1.21b.2
9.1.21d
9.1.21e
9.1.22
9.1.22.1
9.1.22.2
9.1.22.3
9.1.22.4
9.1.23
9.1.23.1
9.1.23.2
9.1.23.3
9.1.24
9.1.24.1
9.1.24.2
9.1.25
9.1.25.1
9.1.26
9.1.26.1
9.1.27
9.1.28
9.1.28.a
9.1.29
9.1.30
9.1.31
9.1.32
9.1.33
9.1.34
9.1.35
9.1.36
9.1.36.1
9.1.36.2
9.1.36.3
9.1.37
9.1.38
9.1.39
9.1.40
9.1.40.1
9.1.40.2
9.1.40.3
9.1.40.4
9.1.41
9.1.42
9.1.43
9.1.43a
9.1.43b
9.1.43c
9.1.43d
15
ETSI
16
9.1.43e
System information type 17 ........................................................................................................................ 295
9.1.44
Talker indication.......................................................................................................................................... 296
9.1.45
Uplink access ............................................................................................................................................... 296
9.1.46
Uplink busy ................................................................................................................................................. 297
9.1.47
Uplink free ................................................................................................................................................... 297
9.1.48
Uplink release .............................................................................................................................................. 298
9.1.49
VGCS uplink grant ...................................................................................................................................... 298
9.1.50
System information type 10 $(ASCI)$ ....................................................................................................... 299
9.1.51
EXTENDED MEASUREMENT ORDER ................................................................................................. 299
9.1.52
Extended measurement report ..................................................................................................................... 300
9.2
Messages for mobility management ................................................................................................................. 300
9.2.1
Authentication reject ................................................................................................................................... 301
9.2.2
Authentication request................................................................................................................................. 301
9.2.3
Authentication response .............................................................................................................................. 302
9.2.4
CM Re-establishment request ..................................................................................................................... 302
9.2.4.1
Location area identification ................................................................................................................... 303
9.2.4.2
Mobile Station Classmark ..................................................................................................................... 303
9.2.5
CM service accept ....................................................................................................................................... 303
9.2.5a
CM service prompt $(CCBS)$.................................................................................................................... 303
9.2.6
CM service reject......................................................................................................................................... 304
9.2.7
CM service abort ......................................................................................................................................... 304
9.2.8
Abort ............................................................................................................................................................ 305
9.2.9
CM service request ...................................................................................................................................... 305
9.2.9.1
Mobile Station Classmark ..................................................................................................................... 305
9.2.9.2
Priority ................................................................................................................................................... 306
9.2.10
Identity request ............................................................................................................................................ 306
9.2.11
Identity response.......................................................................................................................................... 306
9.2.12
IMSI detach indication ................................................................................................................................ 307
9.2.12.1
Mobile Station Classmark ..................................................................................................................... 307
9.2.13
Location updating accept ............................................................................................................................ 307
9.2.13.1
Follow on proceed ................................................................................................................................. 308
9.2.13.2
CTS permission ..................................................................................................................................... 308
9.2.14
Location updating reject .............................................................................................................................. 308
9.2.15
Location updating request ........................................................................................................................... 308
9.2.15.1
Location area identification ................................................................................................................... 309
9.2.15.2
Mobile Station Classmark ..................................................................................................................... 309
9.2.15a
MM information .......................................................................................................................................... 309
9.2.15a.1
Full name for network ........................................................................................................................... 310
9.2.15a.2
Short name for network ......................................................................................................................... 310
9.2.15a.3
Network time zone ................................................................................................................................ 310
9.2.15a.4
Network time zone and time ................................................................................................................. 310
9.2.15a.5
LSA Identity .......................................................................................................................................... 310
9.2.16
MM Status ................................................................................................................................................... 310
9.2.17
TMSI reallocation command ...................................................................................................................... 310
9.2.18
TMSI reallocation complete........................................................................................................................ 311
9.2.19
MM Null ...................................................................................................................................................... 311
9.2.20
Notification response................................................................................................................................... 312
9.3
Messages for circuit-switched call control ....................................................................................................... 312
9.3.1
Alerting ........................................................................................................................................................ 313
9.3.1.1
Alerting (network to mobile station direction) ..................................................................................... 313
9.3.1.1.1
Facility ............................................................................................................................................. 314
9.3.1.1.2
Progress indicator ............................................................................................................................ 314
9.3.1.1.3
User-user .......................................................................................................................................... 314
9.3.1.2
Alerting (mobile station to network direction) ..................................................................................... 314
9.3.1.2.1
Facility ............................................................................................................................................. 315
9.3.1.2.2
User-user .......................................................................................................................................... 315
9.3.1.2.3
SS version ........................................................................................................................................ 315
9.3.2
Call confirmed ............................................................................................................................................. 315
9.3.2.1
Repeat indicator ..................................................................................................................................... 315
9.3.2.2
Bearer capability 1 and bearer capability 2........................................................................................... 315
9.3.2.3
Cause ...................................................................................................................................................... 316
9.3.2.4
CC Capabilities ...................................................................................................................................... 316
ETSI
9.3.3
9.3.3.1
9.3.3.2
9.3.3.3
9.3.3.4
9.3.3.5
9.3.4
9.3.4.1
9.3.5
9.3.5.1
9.3.5.1.1
9.3.5.1.2
9.3.5.1.3
9.3.5.2
9.3.5.2.1
9.3.5.2.2
9.3.5.2.3
9.3.6
9.3.7
9.3.7.1
9.3.7.1.1
9.3.7.1.2
9.3.7.1.3
9.3.7.1.4
9.3.7.2
9.3.7.2.1
9.3.7.2.2
9.3.7.2.3
9.3.8
9.3.8.1
9.3.9
9.3.9.1
9.3.9.2
9.3.9.2.1
9.3.10
9.3.11
9.3.12
9.3.13
9.3.13.1
9.3.13.2
9.3.13.3
9.3.14
9.3.14.1
9.3.14.2
9.3.14.3
9.3.15
9.3.15.1
9.3.15.2
9.3.16
9.3.17
9.3.17.1
9.3.17a
9.3.17a.1
9.3.17a.2
9.3.17b
9.3.17b.1
9.3.17b.2
9.3.17b.3
9.3.17b.4
9.3.17b.5
9.3.17b.6
9.3.17b.7
17
ETSI
9.3.17b.8
9.3.17b.9
9.3.18
9.3.18.1
9.3.18.1.1
9.3.18.1.2
9.3.18.1.3
9.3.18.1.4
9.3.18.2
9.3.18.2.1
9.3.18.2.2
9.3.18.2.3
9.3.18.2.4
9.3.18.2.5
9.3.18a
9.3.18a.1
9.3.18a.2
9.3.19
9.3.19.1
9.3.19.1.1
9.3.19.1.2
9.3.19.1.3
9.3.19.2
9.3.19.2.1
9.3.19.2.2
9.3.19.2.3
9.3.19.2.4
9.3.20
9.3.21
9.3.22
9.3.23
9.3.23.1
9.3.23.1.1
9.3.23.1.2
9.3.23.1.3
9.3.23.1.4
9.3.23.1.4a
9.3.23.1.5
9.3.23.1.6
9.3.23.1.7
9.3.23.1.8
9.3.23.1.9
9.3.23.1.10
9.3.23.1.11
9.3.23.1.12
9.3.23.1.13
9.3.23.1.14
9.3.23.1.15
9.3.23.1.16
9.3.23.2
9.3.23.2.1
9.3.23.2.2
9.3.23.2.3
9.3.23.2.4
9.3.23.2.5
9.3.23.2.6
9.3.23.2.7
9.3.23.2.8
9.3.23.2.9
9.3.23.2.10
9.3.23.2.11
9.3.23.2.12
18
ETSI
19
9.3.23.2.13
CC Capabilities ................................................................................................................................ 341
9.3.23a
Start CC $(CCBS)$ ..................................................................................................................................... 341
9.3.23a.1
CC Capabilities ...................................................................................................................................... 341
9.3.24
Start DTMF ................................................................................................................................................. 341
9.3.25
Start DTMF Acknowledge .......................................................................................................................... 342
9.3.25.1
Keypad facility ...................................................................................................................................... 342
9.3.26
Start DTMF reject ....................................................................................................................................... 342
9.3.27
Status ........................................................................................................................................................... 343
9.3.27.1
Auxiliary states ...................................................................................................................................... 343
9.3.28
Status enquiry .............................................................................................................................................. 343
9.3.29
Stop DTMF.................................................................................................................................................. 344
9.3.30
Stop DTMF acknowledge ........................................................................................................................... 344
9.3.31
User information.......................................................................................................................................... 344
9.3.31.1
User-user ................................................................................................................................................ 345
9.3.31.2
More data ............................................................................................................................................... 345
9.4
GPRS Mobility Management Messages ........................................................................................................... 345
9.4.1
Attach request .............................................................................................................................................. 345
9.4.1.1
Old P-TMSI signature ........................................................................................................................... 346
9.4.1.2
Requested READY timer value ............................................................................................................ 346
9.4.1.3
TMSI status ............................................................................................................................................ 346
9.4.2
Attach accept ............................................................................................................................................... 346
9.4.2.1
P-TMSI signature .................................................................................................................................. 347
9.4.2.2
Negotiated READY timer ..................................................................................................................... 347
9.4.2.3
Allocated P-TMSI.................................................................................................................................. 347
9.4.2.4
MS identity ............................................................................................................................................ 347
9.4.2.5
GMM cause ........................................................................................................................................... 347
9.4.3
Attach complete ........................................................................................................................................... 348
9.4.4
Attach reject................................................................................................................................................. 348
9.4.5
Detach request ............................................................................................................................................. 348
9.4.5.1
Detach request (mobile terminated detach) .......................................................................................... 348
9.4.5.1.1
GMM cause ...................................................................................................................................... 349
9.4.5.2
Detach request (mobile originating detach) .......................................................................................... 349
9.4.6
Detach accept............................................................................................................................................... 349
9.4.6.1
Detach accept (mobile terminated detach) ............................................................................................ 349
9.4.6.2
Detach accept (mobile originating detach) ........................................................................................... 350
9.4.7
P-TMSI reallocation command ................................................................................................................... 350
9.4.7.1
P-TMSI signature .................................................................................................................................. 351
9.4.8
P-TMSI reallocation complete .................................................................................................................... 351
9.4.9
Authentication and ciphering request ......................................................................................................... 351
9.4.9.1
Authentication Parameter RAND ......................................................................................................... 352
9.4.9.2
GPRS ciphering key sequence number ................................................................................................. 352
9.4.10
Authentication and ciphering response ....................................................................................................... 352
9.4.10.1
Authentication Parameter SRES ........................................................................................................... 353
9.4.10.2
IMEISV .................................................................................................................................................. 353
9.4.11
Authentication and ciphering reject ............................................................................................................ 353
9.4.12
Identity request ............................................................................................................................................ 353
9.4.13
Identity response.......................................................................................................................................... 354
9.4.14
Routing area update request ........................................................................................................................ 354
9.4.14.1
Old P-TMSI signature ........................................................................................................................... 355
9.4.14.2
Requested READY timer value ............................................................................................................ 355
9.4.14.3
DRX parameter ...................................................................................................................................... 355
9.4.14.4
TMSI status ............................................................................................................................................ 355
9.4.15
Routing area update accept ......................................................................................................................... 355
9.4.15.1
P-TMSI signature .................................................................................................................................. 355
9.4.15.2
Allocated P-TMSI.................................................................................................................................. 356
9.4.15.3
MS identity ............................................................................................................................................ 356
9.4.15.4
List of Receive N-PDU Numbers ......................................................................................................... 356
9.4.15.5
Negotiated READY timer value ........................................................................................................... 356
9.4.15.6
GMM cause ........................................................................................................................................... 356
9.4.16
Routing area update complete ..................................................................................................................... 356
9.4.16.1
List of Receive N-PDU Numbers ......................................................................................................... 356
9.4.17
Routing area update reject........................................................................................................................... 356
ETSI
20
9.4.18
GMM Status ................................................................................................................................................ 357
9.4.19
GMM Information ....................................................................................................................................... 357
9.4.19.1
Full name for network ........................................................................................................................... 358
9.4.19.2
Short name for network ......................................................................................................................... 358
9.4.19.3
Network time zone ................................................................................................................................ 358
9.4.19.4
Network time zone and time ................................................................................................................. 358
9.4.19.5
LSA Identity .......................................................................................................................................... 358
9.5
GPRS Session Management Messages ............................................................................................................ 358
9.5.1
Activate PDP context request ..................................................................................................................... 358
9.5.1.1
Access point name ................................................................................................................................. 359
9.5.1.2
Protocol configuration options .............................................................................................................. 359
9.5.2
Activate PDP context accept ....................................................................................................................... 359
9.5.2.1
PDP address ........................................................................................................................................... 360
9.5.2.2
Protocol configuration options .............................................................................................................. 360
9.5.3
Activate PDP context reject ........................................................................................................................ 360
9.5.3.1
Protocol configuration options .............................................................................................................. 360
9.5.4
Request PDP context activation .................................................................................................................. 360
9.5.5
Request PDP context activation reject ........................................................................................................ 361
9.5.6
Modify PDP context request ....................................................................................................................... 361
9.5.7
Modify PDP context accept ........................................................................................................................ 362
9.5.8
Deactivate PDP context request .................................................................................................................. 362
9.5.9
Deactivate PDP context accept ................................................................................................................... 363
9.5.10
Activate AA PDP context request............................................................................................................... 363
9.5.10.1
Access point name ................................................................................................................................. 363
9.5.10.2
Protocol configuration options .............................................................................................................. 364
9.5.10.3
Requested AA-READY timer value ..................................................................................................... 364
9.5.11
Activate AA PDP context accept ................................................................................................................ 364
9.5.11.1
Protocol configuration options .............................................................................................................. 364
9.5.11.2
Negotiated AA-Ready timer value ........................................................................................................ 364
9.5.12
Activate AA PDP context reject ................................................................................................................. 364
9.5.12.1
Protocol configuration options .............................................................................................................. 365
9.5.13
Deactivate AA PDP context request ........................................................................................................... 365
9.5.14
Deactivate AA PDP context accept ............................................................................................................ 365
9.5.15
SM Status..................................................................................................................................................... 366
10
10.1
Overview ........................................................................................................................................................... 367
10.2
Protocol Discriminator ...................................................................................................................................... 368
10.3
Skip indicator and transaction identifier........................................................................................................... 368
10.3.1
Skip indicator .............................................................................................................................................. 368
10.3.2
Transaction identifier .................................................................................................................................. 368
10.4
Message Type.................................................................................................................................................... 368
10.5
Other information elements .............................................................................................................................. 374
10.5.1
Common information elements................................................................................................................... 375
10.5.1.1
Cell identity ........................................................................................................................................... 375
10.5.1.2
Ciphering Key Sequence Number ......................................................................................................... 375
10.5.1.3
Location Area Identification ................................................................................................................. 376
10.5.1.4
Mobile Identity ...................................................................................................................................... 378
10.5.1.5
Mobile Station Classmark 1 .................................................................................................................. 379
10.5.1.6
Mobile Station Classmark 2 .................................................................................................................. 380
10.5.1.7
Mobile Station Classmark 3 .................................................................................................................. 383
10.5.1.8
Spare Half Octet .................................................................................................................................... 387
10.5.1.9
Descriptive group or broadcast call reference ...................................................................................... 387
10.5.1.10
Group Cipher Key Number ................................................................................................................... 389
10.5.1.10a
PD and SAPI $(CCBS)$........................................................................................................................ 390
10.5.1.11
Priority Level ......................................................................................................................................... 390
10.5.2
Radio Resource management information elements .................................................................................. 391
10.5.2.1a
BA Range............................................................................................................................................... 391
10.5.2.1b
Cell Channel Description ...................................................................................................................... 393
10.5.2.1b.1
General description .......................................................................................................................... 394
10.5.2.1b.2
Bit map 0 format .............................................................................................................................. 395
10.5.2.1b.3
Range 1024 format........................................................................................................................... 396
ETSI
10.5.2.1b.4
10.5.2.1b.5
10.5.2.1b.6
10.5.2.1b.7
10.5.2.1c
10.5.2.2
10.5.2.3
10.5.2.3a
10.5.2.4
10.5.2.4a
10.5.2.5
10.5.2.5a
10.5.2.6
10.5.2.7
10.5.2.8
10.5.2.8a
10.5.2.9
10.5.2.10
10.5.2.11
10.5.2.12
10.5.2.13
10.5.2.13.1
10.5.2.13.2
10.5.2.13.3
10.5.2.13.4
10.5.2.13.5
10.5.2.13.6
10.5.2.13.7
10.5.2.14
10.5.2.14a
10.5.2.14b
10.5.2.14c
10.5.2.15
10.5.2.16
10.5.2.17
10.5.2.18
10.5.2.19
10.5.2.20
10.5.2.20a
10.5.2.21
10.5.2.21a
10.5.2.21aa
10.5.2.21b
10.5.2.21c
10.5.2.22
10.5.2.22a
10.5.2.22b
10.5.2.22c
10.5.2.23
10.5.2.24
10.5.2.25
10.5.2.25a
10.5.2.25b
10.5.2.25c
10.5.2.25d
10.5.2.26
10.5.2.26a
10.5.2.26b
10.5.2.26c
10.5.2.26d
10.5.2.27
10.5.2.28
21
ETSI
10.5.2.28a
10.5.2.29
10.5.2.30
10.5.2.31
10.5.2.32
10.5.2.33
10.5.2.33a
10.5.2.34
10.5.2.35
10.5.2.35a
10.5.2.36
10.5.2.37
10.5.2.37a
10.5.2.37b
10.5.2.37c
10.5.2.37d
10.5.2.37e
10.5.2.37f
10.5.2.38
10.5.2.39
10.5.2.40
10.5.2.41
10.5.2.41a
10.5.2.42
10.5.2.42a
10.5.2.43
10.5.2.44
10.5.2.45
10.5.2.46
10.5.2.47
10.5.3
10.5.3.1
10.5.3.2
10.5.3.3
10.5.3.4
10.5.3.5
10.5.3.5a
10.5.3.6
10.5.3.7
10.5.3.8
10.5.3.9
10.5.3.10
10.5.3.11
10.5.4
10.5.4.1
10.5.4.2
10.5.4.3
10.5.4.4
10.5.4.5
10.5.4.5.1
10.5.4.5a
10.5.4.6
10.5.4.7
10.5.4.8
10.5.4.9
10.5.4.10
10.5.4.11
10.5.4.11a
10.5.4.11b
10.5.4.12
10.5.4.13
10.5.4.14
22
ETSI
10.5.4.15
10.5.4.16
10.5.4.16.1
10.5.4.17
10.5.4.18
10.5.4.19
10.5.4.20
10.5.4.21
10.5.4.21a
10.5.4.21b
10.5.4.21c
10.5.4.22
10.5.4.22a
10.5.4.22b
10.5.4.23
10.5.4.24
10.5.4.25
10.5.4.26
10.5.4.27
10.5.5
10.5.5.1
10.5.5.2
10.5.5.3
10.5.5.4
10.5.5.5
10.5.5.6
10.5.5.7
10.5.5.8
10.5.5.9
10.5.5.10
10.5.5.11
10.5.5.12
10.5.5.12a
10.5.5.13
10.5.5.14
10.5.5.15
10.5.5.16
10.5.5.17
10.5.5.18
10.5.5.19
10.5.6
10.5.6.1
10.5.6.2
10.5.6.3
10.5.6.4
10.5.6.5
10.5.6.6
10.5.6.7
10.5.6.8
10.5.6.9
10.5.7
10.5.7.1
10.5.7.2
10.5.7.3
11
11.1
11.1.1
11.1.2
11.1.3
11.2
11.2.1
23
ETSI
11.2.2
11.2.3
11.3
24
Annex A (informative):
Annex B (normative):
B.1
B.2
B.2.1
B.2.2
B.3
B.3.1
B.3.2
B.3.3
B.4
Annex C (normative):
C.1
C.2
C.2.1
C.2.2
C.2.3
C.2.4
C.2.5
Annex D (informative):
D.1
D.1.1
D.1.2
D.2
D.2.1
D.2.2
D.3
D.3.1
D.3.2
Coding for speech for a full rate support only mobile station .............................................................. 590
Mobile station to network direction.................................................................................................................. 590
Network to mobile station direction ................................................................................................................. 590
An example of a coding for modem access with V22-bis, 2,4 kbit/s, 8 bit no parity .......................... 591
Mobile station to network direction, data compression allowed ..................................................................... 591
Network to mobile station direction, data compression possible .................................................................... 592
An example of a coding for group 3 facsimile (9,6 kbit/s, transparent) ............................................... 593
Mobile station to network direction.................................................................................................................. 593
Network to mobile station direction ................................................................................................................. 594
Annex E (informative):
Annex F (informative):
GSM specific cause values for radio resource management .................... 599
Annex G (informative):
G.1
G.2
G.3
Causes related to PLMN specific network failures and congestion ..................................................... 602
G.4
G.5
G.6
Annex H (informative):
H.1
H.1.1
ETSI
H.1.2
H.1.3
H.1.4
H.1.5
H.1.6
H.1.7
H.1.8
H.1.9
H.1.10
H.1.11
H.1.12
H.1.13
H.1.14
H.1.15
H.1.16
H.2
H.2.1
H.2.2
H.2.3
H.2.4
H.2.5
H.2.6
H.2.7
H.3
H.3.1
H.3.2
H.3.3
H.3.4
H.3.5
H.3.6
H.3.7
H.4
H.4.1
H.4.2
H.4.3
H.4.4
H.5
H.5.1
H.5.2
H.5.3
H.5.4
H.5.5
H.6
H.6.1
H.6.2
H.6.3
H.6.4
H.6.5
H.6.6
H.6.7
H.6.8
H.7
H.7.1
25
ETSI
Annex I (informative):
26
I.1
I.2
Annex J (informative):
J.1
J.2
J.3
J.4
J.5
J.6
Annex K (informative):
K.1
K.2
K.3
K.4
Annex M (normative):
Annex N (informative):
ETSI
27
Foreword
This European Standard (Telecommunications series) has been produced by the Special Mobile Group (SMG).
The present document specifies the procedures used at the radio interface (Reference Point Um, see GSM 04.02) for
Call Control (CC), Mobility Management (MM) and Radio Resource (RR) management within the digital cellular
telecommunications system.
The contents of the present document are subject to continuing work within SMG and may change following formal
SMG approval. Should SMG modify the contents of the present document it will then be re-submitted for OAP with an
identifying change of release date and an increase in version number as follows:
Version 7.x.y
where:
7 indicates GSM Release 1998 of Phase 2+.
x the second digit is incremented for all changes of substance, i.e. technical enhancements, corrections,
updates, etc.
y the third digit is incremented when editorial only changes have been incorporated in the specification.
12 May 2000
31 August 2000
28 February 2001
28 February 2001
ETSI
28
Introduction
The present document includes references to features which are not part of the Phase 2+ Release 96 of the GSM
Technical specifications. All subclauses which were changed as a result of these features contain a marker (see table
below) relevant to the particular feature.
The following table lists all features that were introduced after Release 96.
Feature
BA Range IE handling
Advanced Speech Call Item
Call Completion Busy Subscriber
Mobile Assisted Frequency Allocation
Network Indication of Alerting in MS
Designator
$(impr-BA-range-handling)$
$(ASCI)$
$(CCBS)$
$(MAFA)$
$(NIA)$
ETSI
29
Scope
The present document specifies the procedures used at the radio interface (Reference Point Um, see GSM 04.02) for
Call Control (CC), Mobility Management (MM), Radio Resource (RR) management and Session Management (SM).
When the notations for "further study" or "FS" or "FFS" are present in the present document they mean that the
indicated text is not a normative portion of the present document.
These procedures are defined in terms of messages exchanged over the control channels of the radio interface. The
control channels are described in GSM 04.03.
The structured functions and procedures of this protocol and the relationship with other layers and entities are described
in general terms in GSM 04.07.
0.1
The procedures currently described in the present document are for the call control of circuit-switched connections,
session management for GPRS services, mobility management and radio resource management for circuit-switched and
GPRS services.
GSM 04.10 contains functional procedures for support of supplementary services.
GSM 04.11 contains functional procedures for support of point-to-point short message services.
GSM 04.12 contains functional description of short message - cell broadcast.
GSM 04.60 contains procedures for radio link control and medium access control (RLC/MAC) of packet data physical
channels.
GSM 04.71 contains functional descriptions and procedures for support of location services.
NOTE:
0.2
"layer 3" includes the functions and protocols described in the present document. The terms "data link
layer" and "layer 2" are used interchangeably to refer to the layer immediately below layer 3.
The layer 3 procedures apply to the interface structures defined in GSM 04.03. They use the functions and services
provided by layer 2 defined in GSM 04.05 and GSM 04.06. GSM 04.07 gives the general description of layer 3
including procedures, messages format and error handling.
0.3
0.4
Test procedures
Test procedures of the GSM radio interface signalling are described in GSM 11.10 and GSM 11.2x series.
ETSI
0.5
30
The logical control channels are defined in GSM 05.02. In the following those control channels are considered which
carry signalling information or specific types of user packet information:
i) Broadcast Control CHannel (BCCH): downlink only, used to broadcast Cell specific information;
ii) Synchronization CHannel (SCH): downlink only, used to broadcast synchronization and BSS identification
information;
iii) Paging CHannel (PCH): downlink only, used to send page requests to Mobile Stations (MSs);
iv) Random Access CHannel (RACH): uplink only, used to request a Dedicated Control CHannel;
v) Access Grant CHannel (AGCH): downlink only, used to allocate a Dedicated Control CHannel;
vi) Standalone Dedicated Control CHannel (SDCCH): bi-directional;
vii)Fast Associated Control CHannel (FACCH): bi-directional, associated with a Traffic CHannel;
viii)
Slow Associated Control CHannel (SACCH): bi-directional, associated with a SDCCH or a Traffic CHannel;
ix) Cell Broadcast CHannel (CBCH): downlink only used for general (not point to point) short message information.
x) Notification CHannel (NCH): downlink only, used to notify mobile stations of VBS (Voice Broadcast Service)
calls or VGCS (Voice Group Call Service) calls.
Two service access points are defined on signalling layer 2 which are discriminated by their Service Access Point
Identifiers (SAPI) (see GSM 04.06):
i) SAPI 0: supports the transfer of signalling information including user-user information;
ii) SAPI 3: supports the transfer of user short messages.
Layer 3 selects the service access point, the logical control channel and the mode of operation of layer 2
(acknowledged, unacknowledged or random access, see GSM 04.05 and GSM 04.06) as required for each individual
message.
0.6
0.6.1
List of procedures
ETSI
31
specific RR procedures for voice broadcast channels and voice group call channels (subclause 3.4.15)
ETSI
32
c) Clause 5 specifies elementary procedures for circuit switched Call Control comprising the following elementary
procedures:
-
miscellaneous procedures
-
The elementary procedures can be combined to form structured procedures. Examples of such structured procedures are
given in clause 7. This part of the Technical Specification is only provided for guidance to assist implementations.
Clause 8 specifies actions to be taken on various error conditions and also provides rules to ensure compatibility with
future enhancements of the protocol.
0.7
Applicability of implementations
The applicability of procedures of this technical specification for the mobile station is dependent on the services and
functions which are to be supported by a mobile station.
ETSI
0.7.1
33
For mobile stations supporting the Voice Group Call Service or the Voice Broadcast Service, it is explicitly mentioned
throughout this technical specification if a certain procedure is applicable only for such a service and, if necessary, how
mobile stations not supporting such a service shall behave.
For VGCS and VBS, the following possible mobile station implementations exist:
-
support of talking in voice group calls (VGCS talking. This always includes the implementation for VGCS
listening)
support of originating a voice group call (VGCS originating. This always includes the implementation for VGCS
talking)
Apart from the explicitly mentioned combinations, all possible combinations are optional and supported by this
technical specification.
The related terms are used in this technical specification, if information on these implementation options is required.
0.7.2
For mobile stations supporting the General Packet Radio Service (GPRS), it is explicitly mentioned throughout the
technical specification if a certain procedure is applicable only for such a service and, if necessary, how mobile stations
not supporting such a service shall behave.
A GPRS MS may operate in one of the following MS operation modes, see 03.60 [74]:
-
MS operation mode A;
MS operation mode B; or
MS operation mode C.
The MS operation mode depends on the services that the MS is attached to, i.e., only GPRS or both GPRS and nonGPRS services, and upon the MS's capabilities to operate GPRS and other GSM services simultaneously. Mobile
stations that are capable to operate GPRS services are referred to as GPRS MSs.
NOTE:
Other GSM technical specifications may refer to the MS operation modes A, B, and C as GPRS class-A
MS, GPRS class-B MS, and GPRS class-C MS.
It should be noted that it is possible that for a GPRS MS, the GMM procedures currently described in the ETS do not
support combinations of VGCS, VBS and GPRS. The possible interactions are not studied yet.
ETSI
34
References
The following documents contain provisions which, through reference in this text, constitute provisions of the present
document.
References are either specific (identified by date of publication, edition number, version number, etc.) or
non-specific.
For a specific reference, subsequent revisions do not apply.
For a non-specific reference, the latest version applies.
A non-specific reference to an ETS shall also be taken to refer to later versions published as an EN with the same
number.
For this Release 1998 document, references to GSM documents are for Release 1998 versions (version 7.x.y).
[1]
GSM 01.02: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); General description of a
GSM Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN)".
[2]
GSM 01.04: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Abbreviations and
acronyms".
[3]
GSM 02.02: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Bearer Services (BS)
supported by a GSM Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN)".
[4]
GSM 02.03: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Teleservices supported by a
GSM Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN)".
[5]
GSM 02.09: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Security aspects".
[6]
GSM 02.11: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Service accessibility".
[7]
GSM 02.17: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Subscriber identity modules
Functional characteristics".
[8]
GSM 02.40: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Procedures for call progress
indications".
[9]
GSM 03.01: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Network functions".
[10]
GSM 03.03: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Numbering, addressing and
identification".
[11]
GSM 03.13: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Discontinuous Reception
(DRX) in the GSM system".
[12]
GSM 03.14: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Support of Dual Tone MultiFrequency signalling (DTMF) via the GSM system".
[12a]
GSM 03.71: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Location Services;
Functional description Stage 2".
[13]
GSM 03.20: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Security related network
functions".
[14]
GSM 03.22: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Functions related to Mobile
Station (MS) in idle mode".
[15]
GSM 04.02: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); GSM Public Land Mobile
Network (PLMN) access reference configuration".
[16]
GSM 04.03: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Mobile Station - Base
Station System (MS - BSS) interface Channel structures and access capabilities".
ETSI
35
[17]
GSM 04.04: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); layer 1 General
requirements".
[18]
GSM 04.05: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Data Link (DL) layer
General aspects".
[19]
GSM 04.06: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Mobile Station - Base
Station System (MS - BSS) interface Data Link (DL) layer specification".
[20]
GSM 04.07: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Mobile radio interface
signalling layer 3 General aspects".
[21]
GSM 04.10: "Digital cellular telecommunications system ; Mobile radio interface layer 3
Supplementary services specification General aspects".
[22]
GSM 04.11: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2); Point-to-Point (PP) Short
Message Service (SMS) support on mobile radio interface".
[23]
GSM 04.12: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Short Message Service Cell
Broadcast (SMSCB) support on the mobile radio interface".
[23a]
GSM 04.71: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Mobile radio interface layer
3 location services specification.
[23b]
[24]
GSM 04.80: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Mobile radio interface layer
3 supplementary services specification Formats and coding".
[25]
GSM 04.81: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Line identification
supplementary services - Stage 3".
[26]
GSM 04.82: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Call Forwarding (CF)
supplementary services - Stage 3".
[27]
GSM 04.83: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Call Waiting (CW) and Call
Hold (HOLD) supplementary services - Stage 3".
[28]
GSM 04.84: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); MultiParty (MPTY)
supplementary services - Stage 3".
[29]
GSM 04.85: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Closed User Group (CUG)
supplementary services - Stage 3".
[30]
GSM 04.86: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Advice of Charge (AoC)
supplementary services - Stage 3".
[31]
GSM 04.88: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Call Barring (CB)
supplementary services - Stage 3".
[32]
GSM 05.02: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Multiplexing and multiple
access on the radio path".
[33]
GSM 05.05: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Radio transmission and
reception".
[34]
GSM 05.08: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Radio subsystem link
control".
[35]
GSM 05.10: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Radio subsystem
synchronization".
[36]
GSM 07.01: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); General on Terminal
Adaptation Functions (TAF) for Mobile Stations (MS)".
ETSI
36
[37]
GSM 09.02: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Mobile Application Part
(MAP) specification".
[38]
GSM 09.07: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); General requirements on
interworking between the Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN) and the Integrated Services
Digital Network (ISDN) or Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN)".
[39]
GSM 11.10: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); Mobile Station (MS)
conformity specification".
[40]
GSM 11.21: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2); The GSM Base Station
System (BSS) equipment specification".
[41]
ISO/IEC 646 (1991): "Information technology - ISO 7-bit coded character set for information
interchange".
[42]
ISO/IEC 6429: "Information technology - Control functions for coded character sets".
[43]
ISO 8348 (1987): "Information processing systems - Data communications - Network service
definition".
[44]
CCITT Recommendation E.163: "Numbering plan for the international telephone service".
[45]
[46]
[47]
[48]
[49]
CCITT Recommendation I.440 (1989): "ISDN user-network interface data link layer - General
aspects".
[50]
CCITT Recommendation I.450 (1989): "ISDN user-network interface layer 3 General aspects".
[51]
[52]
[53]
CCITT Recommendation Q.931: ISDN user-network interface layer 3 specification for basic
control".
[54]
CCITT Recommendation V.21: "300 bits per second duplex modem standardized for use in the
general switched telephone network".
[55]
CCITT Recommendation V.22: "1200 bits per second duplex modem standardized for use in the
general switched telephone network and on point-to-point 2-wire leased telephone-type circuits".
[56]
CCITT Recommendation V.22bis: "2400 bits per second duplex modem using the frequency
division technique standardized for use on the general switched telephone network and on pointto-point 2-wire leased telephone-type circuits".
[57]
CCITT Recommendation V.23: "600/1200-baud modem standardized for use in the general
switched telephone network".
[58]
CCITT Recommendation V.26ter: "2400 bits per second duplex modem using the echo
cancellation technique standardized for use on the general switched telephone network and on
point-to-point 2-wire leased telephone-type circuits".
[59]
CCITT Recommendation V.32: "A family of 2-wire, duplex modems operating at data signalling
rates of up to 9600 bit/s for use on the general switched telephone network and on leased
telephone-type circuits".
[60]
CCITT Recommendation V.110: "Support of data terminal equipments (DTEs) with V-Series
interfaces by an integrated services digital network".
ETSI
37
[61]
CCITT Recommendation V.120: "Support by an ISDN of data terminal equipment with V-Series
type interfaces with provision for statistical multiplexing".
[62]
CCITT Recommendation X.21: "Interface between data terminal equipment (DTE) and data
circuit-terminating equipment (DCE) for synchronous operation on public data networks".
[63]
CCITT Recommendation X.25: "Interface between data terminal equipment (DTE) and data
circuit-terminating equipment (DCE) for terminals operating in the packet mode and connected to
public data networks by dedicated circuit".
[64]
CCITT Recommendation X.28: "DTE/DCE interface for a start-stop mode data terminal
equipment accessing the packet assembly/disassembly facility (PAD) in a public data network
situated in the same country".
[65]
CCITT Recommendation X.30: "Support of X.21, X.21 bis and X.20 bis based data terminal
equipments (DTEs) by an integrated services digital network (ISDN)".
[66]
[67]
CCITT Recommendation X.32: "Interface between data terminal equipment (DTE) and data
circuit-terminating equipment (DCE) for terminals operating in the packet mode and accessing a
packet switched public data network through a public switched telephone network or an integrated
services digital network or a circuit switched public data network".
[68]
[69]
CCITT Recommendation X.121: "International numbering plan for public data networks".
[70]
ETS 300 102-1: "Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN); User-network interface layer 3
Specifications for basic call control".
[71]
ETS 300 102-2: "Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN); User-network interface layer 3
Specifications for basic call control".
[72]
ISO/IEC10646: "Universal Multiple-Octet Coded Character Set (UCS)"; UCS2, 16 bit coding.
[73]
GSM 02.60: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); General Packet Radio
Service (GPRS); Service Description; Stage 1".
[74]
GSM 03.60: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); General Packet Radio
Service (GPRS); Service Description; Stage 2".
[75]
GSM 03.64: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); General Packet Radio
Service (GPRS); Overall description of the GPRS radio interface; Stage 2".
[76]
GSM 04.60: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); General Packet Radio
Service (GPRS); Mobile Station - Base Station System (MS-BSS) interface; Radio Link Control
and Medium Access Control (RLC/MAC) layer specification".
[77]
IETF RFC 1034: "Domain names - Concepts and Facilities " (STD 7).
[78]
GSM 04.65: "Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+); General Packet Radio
Service (GPRS); Subnetwork Dependent Convergence Protocol (SNDCP)".
2.1
Random values
In a number of places in this Technical Specification, it is mentioned that some value must take a "random" value, in a
given range, or more generally with some statistical distribution. Such cases interest only the Mobile Station.
ETSI
38
It is required that there is a low probability that two MSs in the same conditions (including the case of two MSs of the
same type from the same manufacturer) will choose the same value. Moreover, it is required that, if it happens that two
MSs in similar conditions choose the same value, the probability of their choices being identical at the next occasion is
the same as if their first choices had been different.
The meaning of such a specification is that any statistical test for these values, done on a series of similar events, will
obtain a result statistically compatible with the specified distribution. This shall hold even in the cases where the tests
are conducted with a subset of possible events, with some common parameters. Moreover, basic tests of independence
of the values within the series shall pass.
Data against which correlation with the values shall not be found are the protocol state, or the IMSI, or identities or
other unrelated information broadcast by the network, or the current TDMA frame number.
2.2
Vocabulary
idle mode: In this mode, the mobile station is not allocated any dedicated channel; it listens to the CCCH and the
BCCH;
group receive mode: (only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening) In this
mode, the mobile station is not allocated a dedicated channel with the network; it listens to the downlink of a
voice broadcast channel or voice group call channel allocated to the cell. Occasionally, the mobile station has to
listen to the BCCH of the serving cell as defined in GSM 03.22 and 05.08;
dedicated mode: In this mode, the mobile station is allocated at least two dedicated channels, only one of them
being a SACCH;
group transmit mode: (only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS talking) In this mode, one mobile
station of a voice group call is allocated two dedicated channels, one of them being a SACCH. These channels
can be allocated to one mobile station at a time but to different mobile stations during the voice group call;
packet idle mode: (only applicable for mobile stations supporting GPRS) In this mode, mobile station is not
allocated any radio resource on a packet data physical channel; it listens to the PBCCH and PCCCH or, if those
are not provided by the network, to the BCCH and the CCCH, see GSM 04.60.
packet transfer mode: (only applicable for mobile stations supporting GPRS) In this mode, the mobile station is
allocated radio resource on one or more packet data physical channels for the transfer of LLC PDUs.
main DCCH: In Dedicated mode and group transmit mode, only two channels are used as DCCH, one being a
SACCH, the other being a SDCCH or a FACCH; the SDCCH or FACCH is called here "the main DCCH";
A channel is activated if it can be used for transmission, in particular for signalling, at least with UI frames. On
the SACCH, whenever activated, it must be ensured that a contiguous stream of layer 2 frames is sent;
A TCH is connected if circuit mode user data can be transferred. A TCH cannot be connected if it is not
activated. A TCH which is activated but not connected is used only for signalling, i.e. as a DCCH;
The data link of SAPI 0 on the main DCCH is called the main signalling link. Any message specified to be sent
on the main signalling link is sent in acknowledged mode except when otherwise specified;
The term "to establish" a link is a short form for "to establish the multiframe mode" on that data link. It is
possible to send UI frames on a data link even if it is not established as soon as the corresponding channel is
activated. Except when otherwise indicated, a data link layer establishment is done without an information field.
"channel set" is used to identify TCHs that carry related user information flows, e.g., in a multislot
configuration used to support circuit switched connection(s), which therefore need to be handled together.
A temporary block flow (TBF) is a physical connection used by the two RR peer entities to support the unidirectional transfer of LLC PDUs on packet data physical channels, see GSM 04.60.
RLC/MAC block: A RLC/MAC block is the protocol data unit exchanged between RLC/MAC entities, see
GSM 04.60.
ETSI
39
Anonymous access refers to limited service provisioning to an MS whose identity is unknown in the network.
3.1
Overview/General
3.1.1
General
Radio Resource management procedures include the functions related to the management of the common transmission
resources, e.g. the physical channels and the data link connections on control channels.
The general purpose of Radio Resource procedures is to establish, maintain and release RR connections that allow a
point-to-point dialogue between the network and a mobile station. This includes the cell selection/reselection and the
handover procedures. Moreover, Radio Resource management procedures include the reception of the uni-directional
BCCH and CCCH when no RR connection is established. This permits automatic cell selection/reselection.
If VGCS listening or VBS listening are supported, the radio resource management also includes the functions for the
reception of the voice group call channel or the voice broadcast channel, respectively, and the automatic cell reselection
of the mobile station in Group receive mode.
If VGCS talking is supported, the radio resource management also includes the functions for the seizure and release of
the voice group call channel.
If GPRS point-to-point services are supported, the radio resource management procedures includes functions related to
the management of transmission resources on packet data physical channels. This includes the broadcast of system
information to support a mobile station in packet idle and packet transfer modes, see also GSM 04.60.
NOTE 1: This chapter includes some procedures used for multislot operation and for the TCH/H + TCH/H
configuration which need not be supported by simple mobile stations.
NOTE 2: The procedures and the information content relating to the TCH/H + TCH/H configuration in RR
messages is for further study.
3.1.2
A RR connection is a physical connection used by the two peer entities to support the upper layers exchange of
information flows.
3.1.2.1
Idle mode
ETSI
40
3.1.2.2
Dedicated mode
In dedicated mode, the RR connection is a physical point-to-point bi-directional connection, and includes a SAPI 0 data
link connection operating in multiframe mode on the main DCCH. If dedicated mode is established, RR procedures
provide the following services:
-
establishment/release of multiframe mode on data link layer connections other than SAPI 0, on the main DCCH
or on the SACCH associated with the channel carrying the main signalling link;
setting/change of the transmission mode on the physical channels, including change of type of channel, change
of the coding/decoding/transcoding mode and setting of ciphering;
release of an RR connection.
3.1.2.3
Only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening.
In this mode, the RR procedures on the mobile station side provide the services:
-
local connection to the voice broadcast channel or voice group call channel;
automatic cell reselection for the mobile station in Group receive mode;
local disconnection from the received voice group call or broadcast call channels.
For mobile stations supporting both VGCS listening and VGCS transmit, in addition, the RR procedures on the mobile
station side provide the service
-
3.1.2.4
setting of the transmission mode on the physical channels, change of type of channel and setting of ciphering;
ETSI
3.1.2.5
41
3.1.2.6
Depending on the GPRS mode of operation (class A or B), the mobile station may leave both packet idle mode and
packet transfer mode before entering dedicated mode, group receive mode or group transmit mode.
Cell reselection in packet idle and packet transfer modes is specified in GSM 05.08. The RR entity on the mobile station
side indicates to the upper layers the availability of a cell and a cell change when decided by the RR sublayer. Upper
layers are advised of system information broadcast in the cell when a new cell has been selected, or when a relevant part
of this information changes.
3.1.3
The RR sublayer uses the services provided by the data link layer as defined in GSM 04.05.
Moreover, the RR sublayer directly uses services provided by the physical layer such as BCCH searching and transfer
of RLC/MAC blocks, as defined in GSM 04.04.
3.1.4
3.1.4.1
In case a change of dedicated channels is required using a dedicated assignment and handover procedure, respectively,
the RR sublayer will request the data link layer to suspend multiple frame operation before the mobile station leaves the
old channel. When the channel change has been completed, layer 3 will request the data link layer to resume multiple
frame operation again. The layer 2 suspend/resume procedures are described in GSM 04.05 and 04.06.
These procedures are specified in such a way that a loss of a layer 3 message cannot occur on the radio interface.
However, messages sent from the mobile station to the network may be duplicated by the data link layer if a message
has been transmitted but not yet completely acknowledged before the mobile station leaves the old channel (see
GSM 04.06).
As the RR sublayer is controlling the channel change, a duplication of RR messages does not occur. However, there are
some procedures for which a duplication is possible, e.g. DTMF procedures. For all upper layer procedures using the
transport service of the RR sub-layer (e.g., MM and CM procedures), the request messages sent by the mobile station
contain a sequence number in order to allow the network to detect duplicated messages, which are then ignored by the
network. The procedures for sequenced transmission on layer 3 are described in subclause 3.1.4.2.
3.1.4.2
For SAPIs other than 0, the data link procedures described in GSM 04.06 do not provide any guarantee against message
loss or duplication.
ETSI
42
Therefore, if an application uses a SAPI other than 0 and if this application is sensitive to message loss or duplication,
then it has to define its own protection mechanism. No general protection mechanism is provided by the protocol
defined in this Technical Specification.
3.1.4.3
Upper layer messages sent using the RR sub-layer transport service from the mobile station to the network can be
duplicated by the data link layer in the following case:
-
a channel change of dedicated channels is required (assignment or handover procedure) and the last layer 2
frame has not been acknowledged by the peer data link layer before the mobile station leaves the old channel.
In this case, the mobile station does not know whether the network has received the message correctly. Therefore, the
mobile station has to send the message again after the new dedicated channel is established (see GSM 04.06).
The network must be able to detect the duplicated received message. Therefore, each concerned upper layer message
must be marked with a send sequence number.
To allow for different termination points in the infrastructure of the messages of different PDs, the sequence numbering
is specific to each PD. For historical reasons, an exception is that messages sent with the CC, SS and MM PDs share the
same sequence numbering. In the following, the phrase upper layer message flow refers to a flow of messages sharing
the same sequence numbering. The different upper layer flows are MM+CC+SS, GCC, BCC, PDSS1 and PDSS2.
3.1.4.3.1
3.1.4.3.1.1
The RR sublayer of the mobile station shall have one associated send state variable V(SD) ("Send Duplicated") for each
upper layer message flow. The send state variable denotes the sequence number of the next in sequence numbered
message in the flow to be transmitted. The value of the corresponding send state variable shall be incremented by one
with each numbered message transmission. Arithmetic operations on V(SD) are performed modulo 2.
3.1.4.3.1.2
At the time when such a message to be numbered is designated for transmission, the value of N(SD) for the message to
be transferred is set equal to the value of the send state variable V(SD). See GSM 04.07.
3.1.4.3.2
3.1.4.3.2.1
Procedures for the initiation, transfer execution and termination of the sequenced
message transfer operation
Initiation
The sequenced message transfer operation is initiated by establishing a RR connection. The send state variables V(SD)
are set to 0.
3.1.4.3.2.2
Transfer Execution
The network must compare the send sequence numbers of pairs of subsequent messages in the same upper layer
messages flow. In case the send sequence numbers of two subsequent messages in a flow are not identical, no
duplication has occurred. In case the send sequence numbers are identical, the network must ignore the second one of
the received messages.
3.1.4.3.2.3
Termination
The sequenced message transfer operation is terminated by the RR connection release procedure.
3.1.5
Upon seizure of the assigned dedicated channel, the mobile station establishes the main signalling link on this channel
by sending a layer 2 SABM frame containing a layer 3 service request message. The data link layer will store this
ETSI
43
message to perform the contention resolution. The service request message will be returned by the network in the UA
frame.
The data link layer in the mobile station compares the content of the information field (i.e. the layer 3 service request
message) received in the UA frame with the stored message and leaves the channel in case they do not match. This
procedure resolves contentions in the case where several mobile stations have accessed at the same random access slot
and with the same random reference and one has succeeded due to capture. The full description of the procedure is
given in GSM 04.06.
The purpose of the service request message is to indicate to the network which service the mobile station is requesting.
This then allows the network to decide how to proceed (e.g. to authenticate or not).
The service request message must contain the identity of the mobile station and may include further information which
can be sent without encryption.
ETSI
44
3.2
3.2.1
In idle mode, the MS listens to the BCCH and to the paging sub-channel for the paging group the MS belongs to in idle
mode (cf. GSM 03.13); it measures the radio propagation for connection with other cells.
In packet idle and packet transfer modes (applicable only to a GPRS mobile station), the mobile station listens to either
the PBCCH, if that is present in the cell, or BCCH. The requirements for the monitoring of system information is
further specified in GSM 04.60. Moreover, the mobile station measures the radio propagation for connection with other
cells.
In packet idle mode (applicable only to a GPRS mobile station), the mobile station listens to the paging sub-channels on
the PCCCH or CCCH. Paging sub-channels are monitored according to the paging group determined for the mobile
station and its current discontinuous reception (DRX) mode. The determination of paging group for the mobile station is
defined in GSM 05.02. The DRX procedures are defined in GSM 04.60 and GSM 05.02.
Measurements are treated to assess the need of a cell change as specified in GSM 05.08. When the decision to change
cells is made, the mobile station switches to the BCCH or PBCCH of the new cell. The broadcast information is then
checked to verify the allowance to camp on this cell (cf. section 3.2.2). Dependent on the mobile station type and
configuration, the mobile station may be required to try to read further BCCH and PBCCH information. If allowed, the
cell change is confirmed, and the broadcast information is then treated for Mobility Management actions (cf. section 4).
Similarly, physical contexts are updated (list of neighbouring cells frequencies, thresholds for some actions, etc. (cf.
GSM 05.08 and section 3.2.2)).
ETSI
3.2.2
3.2.2.1
45
Network side
System information broadcasting
SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 2 to 4 messages, and optionally TYPE 1, 2bis, 2ter, 7, 8, 13, 16 and 17 and further
types are regularly broadcast by the network on the BCCH. Based on this information the mobile station is able to
decide whether and how it may gain access to the system via the current cell. The SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE
2bis message shall be sent if and only if the EXT-IND bit in the Neighbour Cells Description IE in both the TYPE 2 and
TYPE 2bis messages indicates that each IE only carries part of the BA. SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 2ter message
shall be sent if and only if this is indicated in SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3 message.
A GSM 900 mobile station which only supports the primary GSM band P-GSM 900 (cf. GSM 05.05) may consider the
EXT-IND bit in the Neighbour Cells Description IE in the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 2 message as a spare bit.
If it does so it shall assume that the information element carries the complete BA and it shall ignore any SYSTEM
INFORMATION TYPE 2bis and 2ter messages.
If the additional cell reselection parameters are broadcast then SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3 message shall
always contain these parameters. In addition to SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3 at least either SYSTEM
INFORMATION TYPE 4 or SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 7 and 8 messages shall contain these parameters too.
If additional SoLSA specific parameters are broadcast then SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 16 and 17 messages,
shall always contain these parameters. In addition to SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 16 and 17 messages at least
either SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 4 or SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 7 and 8 messages shall contain these
SoLSA specific parameters too.
The support of GPRS shall be indicated in SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3 message. In addition, the support of
GPRS shall be indicated in either SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 4 or SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 7 and 8
messages. If GPRS is supported, SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 13 message shall be sent. SI 13 message shall not
be sent if GPRS is not supported. Additional requirements for the broadcast of system information in a cell supporting
GPRS are specified in GSM 04.60.
NOTE 1: The allowed scheduling of SYSTEM INFORMATION messages on the BCCH are specified in
GSM 05.02.
NOTE 2: The network should take into account limitations of certain mobile stations to understand SYSTEM
INFORMATION TYPE 2bis, TYPE 2ter, the EXT-IND bit in the Neighbour Cells Description, the
indication of 2ter in SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3 and formats used in the Neighbour Cells
Description IE and Cell Channel Description IE used in SYSTEM INFORMATION messages, see this
section, section 10.5.2.1b, and section 10.5.2.22.
NOTE 3: The network should take into account the limitations of earlier version of mobile equipments to
understand the 3-digit MNC format of the location area identification, see section 10.5.1.3.
The information broadcast may be grouped in the following classes:
-
information giving unique identification of the current network, location area and cell;
information used for candidate cell measurements for handover and cell selection procedures;
information about the length of the part of the message belonging to the phase 1 protocol.
The network may send to the mobile station BCCH scheduling information as specified below:
1) The BCCH scheduling information may be contained in the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 9 messages. If
so, SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3 specifies where to find SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 9 messages
carrying BCCH scheduling information.
ETSI
46
2) If the mobile station has received BCCH scheduling information, it shall assume that this BCCH scheduling
information is valid in the location area until new scheduling information is received. It may store the
information in the ME and assume its validity after switch on in the same location area.
3) The network need not indicate the schedule of all SYSTEM INFORMATION messages in SYSTEM
INFORMATION 9. For any System Information message, the MS shall monitor all blocks specified in GSM
05.02 for that System Information message and all blocks specified in the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 9
message for that System Information message.
4) When the mobile station detects that the BCCH information is not scheduled as defined in the last received SI 9
message, it shall read the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3 message. If presence of BCCH scheduling
information in SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 9 message is indicated, it shall try to read the information and
continue as in 2 above. If presence of BCCH scheduling information in SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 9
message is not indicated, it shall assume that there is no valid BCCH scheduling information.
3.2.2.2
Paging
The network is required to send valid layer 3 messages continuously on all paging subchannels on CCCH.
3.3
RR connection establishment
3.3.1
The purpose of the immediate assignment procedure is to establish an RR connection between the mobile station and
the network.
3.3.1.1
The immediate assignment procedure can only be initiated by the RR entity of the mobile station. Initiation is triggered
by request from the MM sublayer or LLC layer to enter the dedicated mode or by the RR entity in response to a
PAGING REQUEST message. Upon such a request,
-
if access to the network is allowed (as defined in 3.3.1.1.1), the RR entity of the mobile station initiates the
immediate assignment procedure as defined in section 3.3.1.1.2;
The request from the MM sublayer to establish an RR connection specifies an establishment cause. Similarly, the
request from the RR entity to establish a RR connection in response to a PAGING REQUEST 1, 2 or 3 message
specifies one of the establishment causes "answer to paging".
3.3.1.1.1
All mobile stations with an inserted SIM are members of one out of 10 access classes numbered 0 to 9. The access class
number is stored in the SIM. In addition, mobile stations may be members of one or more out of 5 special access classes
(access classes 11 to 15) (see GSM 02.11), this is also held on the SIM card.
The system information messages on the BCCH broadcast the list of authorized access classes and authorized special
access classes in the system information messages, and whether emergency calls are allowed in the cell to all mobile
stations or only to the members of authorized special access classes.
If the establishment cause for the request of the MM sublayer is not "emergency call", access to the network is allowed
if and only if the mobile station is a member of at least one authorized:
-
access class; or
If the establishment cause for the request of the MM sublayer is "emergency call", access to the network is allowed if
and only if:
-
ETSI
47
the mobile station is a member of at least one authorized special access class.
3.3.1.1.2
The RR entity of the mobile station initiates the immediate assignment procedure by scheduling the sending on the
RACH and leaving idle mode (in particular, the mobile station shall ignore PAGING REQUEST messages).
It then sends maximally M + 1 CHANNEL REQUEST messages on the RACH in a way such that:
-
the number of slots belonging to the mobile station's RACH between initiation of the immediate assignment
procedure and the first CHANNEL REQUEST message (excluding the slot containing the message itself) is a
random value drawn randomly for each new initial assignment initiation with uniform probability distribution in
the set {0, 1, ..., max (T,8) - 1};
the number of slots belonging to the mobile station's RACH between two successive CHANNEL REQUEST
messages (excluding the slots containing the messages themselves) is a random value drawn randomly for each
new transmission with uniform probability distribution in the set
{S, S + 1, ..., S + T - 1};
an establishment cause which corresponds to the establishment cause given by the MM sublayer and the
broadcast NECI value, or which corresponds to one of the establishment causes "answer to paging" given by the
RR entity in response to a PAGING REQUEST message including the Channel Needed information;
a random reference which is drawn randomly from a uniform probability distribution for every new
transmission.
After sending the first CHANNEL REQUEST message, the mobile station shall start listening to the BCCH; it shall
also listen to the full downlink CCCH timeslot corresponding to its CCCH group.
Having sent M + 1 CHANNEL REQUEST messages, the RR entity of the mobile station starts timer T3126. At expiry
of timer T3126, the immediate assignment procedure is aborted; if the immediate assignment procedure was triggered
by a request from the MM sublayer, a random access failure is indicated to the MM sublayer.
Table 3.1/GSM 04.08: Values of parameter S
+-----------------------------------------------------+
| TX-integer | non combined CCCH | combined CCH/SDCCH |
+------------+-------------------+--------------------|
| 3,8,14,50 |
55
|
41
|
| 4,9,16
|
76
|
52
|
| 5,10,20
|
109
|
58
|
| 6,11,25
|
163
|
86
|
| 7,12,32
|
217
|
115
|
+-----------------------------------------------------+
3.3.1.1.3
3.3.1.1.3.1
The network may allocate a dedicated channel to the mobile station by sending an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
message or IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT EXTENDED message in unacknowledged mode on the same CCCH
timeslot on which it has received the CHANNEL REQUEST. There is no further restriction on what part of the
downlink CCCH an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message or IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT EXTENDED message
can be sent. The type of channel allocated (SDCCH or TCH; the channel mode shall be set to signalling only) is a
network operator decision. Timer T3101 is then started on the network side.
NOTE:
ETSI
48
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message, containing assignment information for one mobile station
only;
the information field of the CHANNEL REQUEST message and the frame number of the frame in which the
CHANNEL REQUEST message was received;
If frequency hopping is applied, the mobile station uses the last CA received on the BCCH to decode the Mobile
Allocation.
On receipt of an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT or IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT EXTENDED message corresponding
to one of its 3 last CHANNEL REQUEST messages, the mobile station stops T3126 (if running), stops sending
CHANNEL REQUEST messages, switches to the assigned channels, sets the channel mode to signalling only and
activates the assigned channels. It then establishes the main signalling link with an SABM containing an information
field (see section 3.1.5).
An IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT or IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT EXTENDED message may indicate a frequency
change in progress, with a starting time and possibly alternative channel descriptions.
In the case of the reception of an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT EXTENDED message, or of an IMMEDIATE
ASSIGNMENT message which contains only the description of a channel to be used after the starting time, the mobile
station shall wait up to the starting time before accessing the channel. If the starting time has already elapsed, the
mobile shall access the channel as an immediate reaction to the reception of the message (see GSM 05.10 for the timing
constraints).
If the message contains both the description of a channel to be used after the indicated time and of a channel to be used
before, the mobile station accesses a channel as an immediate reaction to the reception of the message. If the moment
the mobile station is ready to access is before the indicated time, the mobile station accesses the channels described for
before the starting time. The mobile station then changes to the channel described for after the starting time at the
indicated time. New parameters can be frequency list and MAIO. Other parameters describing the channel to be used
before the starting time are taken from the description of the channel defined for use after the starting time. If the
moment the mobile station is ready to access is after the starting time, the mobile station accesses the channel described
for after the starting time.
If frequency hopping is applied, the mobile station uses the last CA received on the BCCH.
3.3.1.1.3.2
Assignment rejection
If no channel is available for assignment, the network may send to the mobile station an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
REJECT message in unacknowledged mode on the same CCCH timeslot on which the channel request message was
received. There is no further restriction on what part of the downlink CCCH timeslot an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
REJECT message can be sent. This message contains the request reference and a wait indication.
On receipt of an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT message corresponding to one of its 3 last CHANNEL
REQUEST messages, the mobile station, stops sending CHANNEL REQUEST messages, starts timer T3122 with the
indicated value, ("wait indication" information element), starts T3126 if it has not already been started, and listens to the
downlink CCCH until T3126 expires. During this time, additional IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT messages
are ignored, but any immediate assignment corresponding to any other of its 3 last CHANNEL REQUEST messages
make the mobile station follow the procedure in section 3.3.1.2. If no such immediate assignment is received, the
mobile station returns to CCCH idle mode (listening to its paging channel).
As an option the mobile station may return to CCCH idle mode as soon as it has received responses from the network
on all, or in case more than 3 were sent the last 3, of its CHANNEL REQUEST messages.
ETSI
49
The mobile station is not allowed to make a new attempt to establish a non emergency RR connection in the same cell
until T3122 expires. Provided that an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT message has not been received for an
emergency RR connection attempt, the mobile station may attempt to enter the dedicated mode for an emergency call in
the same cell before T3122 has expired.
The Wait Indication IE (i.e. T3122) relates to the cell from which it was received.
The mobile station in packet idle mode (only applicable to mobile station supporting GPRS) may initiate packet access
in the same cell before T3122 has expired, see GSM 04.60 and section 3.5.2.1.3.4.
After T3122 expiry, no CHANNEL REQUEST message shall be sent as a response to a page until a PAGING
REQUEST message for the mobile station is received.
3.3.1.1.4
Assignment completion
The immediate assignment procedure is terminated on the network side when the main signalling link is established.
Timer T3101 is stopped and the MM sublayer on the network side is informed that the RR entity has entered the
dedicated mode.
On the mobile station side, the procedure is terminated when the establishment of the main signalling link is confirmed.
The MM sublayer is informed that the RR entity has entered the dedicated mode.
3.3.1.1.4.1
Early classmark sending consists in the mobile station sending as early as possible after access a CLASSMARK
CHANGE message to provide the network with additional classmark information.
A mobile station which implements the Controlled Early Classmark Sending option shall perform the early
classmark sending if and only if explicitly accepted by the network, as indicated in the last reception in the accessed cell
of the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3 message.
A mobile station which implements one or more of the multiple band support options shall also implement the
Controlled Early Classmark Sending option.
A mobile station which implements the multislot capability option shall also implement the Controlled Early
Classmark Sending option.
A mobile station that implements some form of treatment of UCS2 alphabet (see TS GSM 03.38) encoded character
string (e.g., in short message, or in USSD string) may indicate so in the classmark. (An example is a Mobile Equipment
able to display UCS2 encoded character string.) In such a case, it should also implement the Controlled Early
Classmark Sending option. It is the mobile station responsibility to provide the UCS2 support information in due time.
If the network needs this information and the mobile station did not provide it, the network may assume that the Mobile
Equipment does not support UCS2.
A mobile station which implements the R-GSM band (see GSM 05.05) shall also implement the Controlled Early
Classmark Sending option.
A mobile station which implements the extended measurement function shall also implement the Controlled Early
Classmark Sending option.
A mobile station which implements the GPRS option shall also implement the Controlled Early Classmark
Sending option.
A mobile station which implements the SoLSA option shall also implement the Controlled Early Classmark
Sending option.
A mobile station which implements the Controlled Early Classmark Sending option shall indicate it in the
classmark (ES IND bit).
3.3.1.1.4.2
This procedure enables the network to suspend GPRS services packet flow in the downlink direction.
ETSI
50
The GPRS suspension procedure is initiated by the mobile station by sending a GPRS SUSPENSION REQUEST
message. This can be done as early as possible after access but shall be done after sending a CLASSMARK CHANGE
message. The RR sublayer of the mobile station shall indicate a RR GPRS suspend condition to the MM sublayer, see
section 4.
When a mobile station which is IMSI attached for GPRS services (section 4) enters the dedicated mode, and when the
mobile station limitations make it unable to handle both dedicated mode and either packet idle mode or packet transfer
mode simultaneously, the mobile station shall perform the GPRS suspension procedure.
3.3.1.1.5
Abnormal cases
If a lower layer failure occurs on the mobile station side on the new channel before the successful establishment of the
main signalling link, the allocated channels are released; the subsequent behaviour of the mobile station depends on the
type of failure and previous actions.
-
If the failure is due to information field mismatch in the contention resolution procedure, see section 3.1.5, and
no repetition as described in this paragraph has been performed, the immediate assignment procedure shall be
repeated.
If the failure is due to any other reason or if a repetition triggered by a contention resolution failure has been
performed. The mobile station returns to idle mode (RR connection establishment failure), transactions in
progress are aborted and cell reselection then may take place.
If the information available in the mobile station, after the reception of an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message does
not satisfactorily define a channel, an RR connection establishment failure has occurred.
If the Mobile Allocation IE indexes frequencies in more than one frequency band then a RR connection establishment
failure has occurred.
If an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message indicates (a) channel(s) in a different frequency band to which the
CHANNEL REQUEST message was sent then, if the frequency band is supported by the mobile station, the mobile
station shall access the indicated channel(s) with the same power control level as used for the CHANNEL REQUEST
message.
If an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message indicates a channel in non-supported frequency band then a RR
connection establishment failure has occurred.
On the network side, if timer T3101 elapses before the main signalling link is established, the newly allocated channels
are released and the request is forgotten. Note that the network has no means to distinguish repeated attempts from
initial attempts from a mobile station.
3.3.1.2
3.3.1.2.1
3.3.1.2.1.1
The mobile station in group receive mode shall consider the uplink as free if the last message indicating the uplink as
being free was received less than 480 ms ago and if no UPLINK BUSY message has been received since the last
message indicating the uplink as free.
On receipt of a request from the upper layer to access the uplink and if the uplink is not free, the mobile station starts
the timer T3128.
ETSI
51
If the uplink is free or becomes free before expiry of timer T3128, then the uplink investigation procedure is terminated,
the mobile station shall stop T3128, and start the uplink access procedure.
NOTE:
The start of the uplink access procedure is not subject to the access class of the mobile station.
If the uplink is not indicated free before the timer expires, the mobile station shall remain in the group receive mode and
indicate a reject of the uplink request to the upper layer.
3.3.1.2.1.2
The mobile station shall send UPLINK ACCESS messages on the voice group call channel with the appropriate
establishment cause. The first UPLINK ACCESS message shall be transmitted by the mobile station with a random
delay between 0 and 20ms. The UPLINK ACCESS messages shall be repeated after a further period of 100ms plus a
random delay between 0 and 20ms.
If an uplink identity code (UIC) of the current cell has been provided by the network in the UPLINK FREE message,
the mobile station shall use this UIC IE for the coding of the UPLINK ACCESS messages (see GSM 05.03). If no UIC
is provided, the mobile station shall use the BSIC received from the current cell, for instance from the initial
synchronization.
Having sent the first UPLINK ACCESS message, the mobile station starts timer T3130. At expiry of timer T3130, the
mobile station shall repeat the same procedure if the uplink is free. A maximum of three attempts is allowed and after
that a rejection of the uplink request is indicated to the upper layers.
If no VGCS UPLINK GRANT or UPLINK BUSY message is received by the mobile station 480 ms after having sent
the first UPLINK ACCESS message, the mobile station shall stop sending UPLINK ACCESS messages and wait in
order to receive a VGCS UPLINK GRANT or UPLINK BUSY message.
On receipt of an VGCS UPLINK GRANT message corresponding to one of its UPLINK ACCESS messages, the
mobile station stops T3130, stops sending UPLINK ACCESS messages, and establishes the main signalling link with
an SABM containing the TALKER INDICATION message in the information field. Early classmark sending shall be
performed if applicable. If a UA is received containing the message sent, the mobile station enters the group transmit
mode and indicates the successful seizure of the uplink to the upper layer. If a UA is received with a message different
from the message sent, the mobile station shall remain in the group receive mode and indicate the rejection of the uplink
request to the upper layers.
When receiving an UPLINK BUSY message or a VGCS UPLINK GRANT message aimed to another mobile station
(i.e., not corresponding to one of its UPLINK ACCESS messages), the mobile station stops T3130 and stops sending
UPLINK ACCESS messages. The mobile shall remain in the group receive mode and shall indicate a rejection of the
uplink request to the upper layers.
3.3.1.2.2
Network side
On receipt of an UPLINK ACCESS message the network shall perform, if necessary, contention resolution and grant
the uplink to one mobile station by sending a VGCS UPLINK GRANT message to the mobile station in
unacknowledged mode on the main signalling link. Furthermore, the network shall provide UPLINK BUSY messages
on the main signalling link in all cells of the group call area. After having sent the first message, the network starts
T3115. If the timer expires before the reception of a correctly decoded frame from the MS, the network repeats the
VGCS UPLINK GRANT message to the mobile station. If the VGCS UPLINK GRANT message has been repeated
Ny2 times without a correctly decoded frame being received from the MS, the network shall stop sending VGCS
UPLINK GRANT messages and provide an UPLINK FREE message on the main signalling channel and wait for a new
UPLINK ACCESS message. The correct decoding of a frame means that the decoding algorithm and the error detection
tests, if any, indicate no error.
After the data link layer is established, the RR entity of the network shall analyse the TALKER INDICATION message
received from the mobile station, adapt the RR procedures to the new classmark if necessary and provide the mobile
subscriber identity to the upper layer.
3.3.1.2.3
Abnormal cases
If a lower link failure has occurred or an indication of the release of the data link layer was provided by the lower layer
and no RR release request was previously received from the upper layer, the network shall provide an UPLINK FREE
message on the main signalling channel and wait for a new UPLINK ACCESS message.
ETSI
3.3.1.3
52
A mobile station whose Channel Request message contained a packet access establishment cause may receive an
Immediate Assignment message to a Channel which is to be used in dedicated mode. A mobile station supporting the
<<GPRS>> option shall obey this command. When establishing the main signalling link the information field in the
SABM shall contain an RR INITIALISATION REQUEST message.
This message contains:
TLLI,
MS Classmark type 2
Ciphering Key Sequence Number
MAC Mode and Channel Coding Requested
Channel Request Description
Following a successful contention resolution procedure, the mobile station shall implement the Early Classmark
Sending option. Then, the upper layers in the mobile station shall wait for commands from the network, eg for the
allocation of a GPRS resource.
While on the dedicated channel the mobile station shall obey the RR management procedures of 04.08, in particular the
mobile station shall send measurement reports on the SACCH.
3.3.2
The network can initiate the establishment of an RR connection by the paging procedure for RR connection
establishment. Such a procedure can only be initiated by the network.
3.3.2.1
The network initiates the paging procedure to trigger RR connection establishment by broadcasting a paging request
message on the appropriate paging subchannel on CCCH or PCCCH, and starts timer T3113. The paging subchannels
on CCCH and PCCCH are specified in GSM 05.02 and GSM 03.13.
The network may also send paging related information on PACCH to a mobile station in packet transfer mode, see
section 3.3.2.1.3.
The network may also broadcast paging related information on any voice broadcast or voice group call channel
downlink.
3.3.2.1.1
Paging initiation using the paging subchannel on CCCH is used when sending paging information to a mobile station in
idle mode. It is also used when sending paging information to a mobile station in packet idle mode, if PCCCH is not
present in the cell.
NOTE 1: There are 3 types of paging messages which may be used on CCCH:
-
In a PAGING REQUEST message on CCCH to trigger RR connection establishment, the mobile station shall be
identified by the TMSI (non-GPRS TMSI) or its IMSI. If the mobile station is identified by the TMSI, it shall proceed
as specified in section 3.3.2.2.
If the mobile station in packet idle mode is identified by its IMSI, it shall parse the message for a corresponding Packet
Page Indication field:
ETSI
53
if the Packet Page Indication field indicates a paging procedure for RR connection establishment, or the field
is not present in the message, the mobile station shall proceed as specified in section 3.3.2.2;
if the Packet Page Indication field indicates a packet paging procedure, the mobile station shall proceed as
specified in section 3.5.1.2.
A PAGING REQUEST message on CCCH includes for each mobile station that is paged to trigger RR connection
establishment an indication which defines how mobiles of different capabilities shall code the establishment cause field
in the CHANNEL REQUEST message. The information received in the CHANNEL REQUEST can be used by the
network to assign a suitable channel.
A PAGING REQUEST message on CCCH may include more than one mobile station identification.
A PAGING REQUEST TYPE 1 message on CCCH may have additionally a notification message coded in the P1 rest
octets information element.
A PAGING REQUEST message on CCCH may also include priority levels related to the mobile station identifications.
A mobile station in group receive mode supporting eMLPP shall take into account this information to decide whether to
respond to this PAGING REQUEST and, if the call is answered, the mobile station shall store the priority level for the
duration of the call. A mobile station not supporting eMLPP shall ignore this information element when received in a
PAGING REQUEST message.
NOTE 2: A mobile station not supporting VGCS or VBS may ignore this information element when received in a
PAGING REQUEST message, since the priority level is also provided in the SETUP message.
If VGCS or VBS is supported by the network and the network supports reduced NCH monitoring, messages sent on the
PCH may also include an indication of the change of the information sent on the NCH (see section 3.3.3.2).
The choice of the message type depends on the number of mobile stations to be paged and of the types of identities that
are used. The maximum number of paged mobile stations per message is 4 when using only TMSIs for identification of
the mobile stations.
The mobile station in idle mode is required to receive and analyse the paging messages and immediate assignment
messages sent on the paging subchannel corresponding to its paging subgroup, as specified in GSM 05.02.
NOTE 3: The possible immediate assignment messages are: the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT, the IMMEDIATE
ASSIGNMENT EXTENDED and the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT messages.
The paging and immediate assignment type messages contain a page mode information element. This information
element controls possible additional requirements on mobile stations belonging to the paging subgroup corresponding to
the paging subchannel the message was sent on. This implies that a given mobile station shall take into account the page
mode information element of any message sent on its own paging subchannel whatever the nature of this message
(paging messages or immediate assignment messages). This further implies that the mobile station does not take into
account page mode information element of messages sent on paging subchannels other than its own paging subchannel.
The requirements yielded by the page mode information element are as follows:
a) normal paging: no additional requirements;
b) extended paging: the mobile station is required in addition to receive and analyse the next but one message on
the PCH;
c) paging reorganization: The mobile station shall receive all messages on the CCCH regardless of the BS-AGBLKS-RES setting. It is required to receive all BCCH messages. When the mobile station receives the next
message to its (possibly new) paging subgroup the subsequent action is defined in the page mode information
element in that message.
d) same as before: No change of page mode from the previous page mode.
Note that a mobile station takes into account the page mode information only in messages of its own paging subchannel
whatever the currently applied requirements (a, b, c or d).
When the mobile station selects a new PCH, the initial page mode in the mobile station shall be set to paging
reorganization. If a message in the paging subchannel is not received correctly, the message is ignored and the previous
page mode is assumed.
ETSI
3.3.2.1.2
54
Paging initiation using a paging subchannel on PCCCH, see GSM 04.60, applies when sending paging information to a
mobile station in packet idle mode and PCCCH is provided in the cell.
The paging initiation procedure and the paging request message used on PCCCH are specified in GSM 04.60.
3.3.2.1.3
Paging initiation using PACCH, see GSM 04.60, applies to a mobile station in packet transfer mode.
The paging initiation procedure and the message used to carry paging related information on PACCH are specified in
GSM 04.60.
3.3.2.2
Paging response
Upon receipt of a paging request message, or other message containing information to trigger the establishment of a RR
connection, and if access to the network is allowed, the addressed mobile station shall, when camped on a cell as
specified in GSM 03.22, initiate the immediate assignment procedure as specified in 3.3.1. The establishment of the
main signalling link is then initiated by use of an SABM with information field containing the PAGING RESPONSE
message (see section 3.1.5). The MM sublayer in the mobile station is informed that the RR entity has entered the
dedicated mode.
Upon receipt of the PAGING RESPONSE message the network stops timer T3113. The MM sublayer in the network is
informed that an RR connection exists.
3.3.2.3
Abnormal cases
Lower layer failure occurring during the immediate assignment procedure is treated as specified for that procedure.
If timer T3113 expires and a PAGING RESPONSE message has not been received, the network may repeat the paging
request message and start timer T3113 again. The number of successive paging attempts is a network dependent choice.
mobile station
network
PAGING REQUEST
<-------------------------
Start T3113
RANDOM ACCESS
------------------------->
IMM ASSIGN
<------------------------SABM (PAGING RESPONSE)
------------------------->
Start T3101
Stop T3101,
T3113
3.3.3
Notification procedure
The support of notification procedure is mandatory for mobile stations supporting VGCS receive and/or VBS
receive .
The network informs the mobile station of starting or on-going voice broadcast calls and voice group calls with the
notification procedure.
In cases where the mobile station has initiated a VGCS call, if the channel mode modify procedure is applied to turn the
dedicated channel into a VGCS channel and ciphering may be applied for that call, in this case the network should
suspend transmission of notification messages until ciphering with the group cipher key has started on the dedicated
channel.
ETSI
3.3.3.1
55
Notification of a call
The mobile station may receive a notification that a voice broadcast call or a voice group call is established.
Notifications may be sent on the NCH, on the PCH, or on the FACCH when in dedicated mode or group receive mode.
The presence of an NCH is indicated on the PCH in the Pi Rest Octets IE. A notification contains the group call
reference and possibly other related information. This notification may be contained:
-
in a NOTIFICATION/NCH message sent on the NCH to notify mobile stations of VBS or VGCS calls in the
current cell, possibly together with a description of the related VBS or VGCS channel;
in a NOTIFICATION/FACCH message sent in unacknowledged mode on the main DCCH to notify mobile
stations in dedicated mode or on the main DCCH of a VGCS or VBS channel, of other VBS or VGCS calls in
the current cell, possibly together with a description of the related VBS or VGCS channel.
A mobile station supporting neither VGCS listening nor VBS listening may ignore the notifications sent on the NCH or
PCH. It may also ignore the notifications sent on the main DCCH except that a RR-STATUS message shall be sent to
the network with cause #97, "message not existent or not implemented".
Upon receipt of every notification message a mobile station supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening shall give an
indication containing the notified group call reference(s) to upper layers in the mobile station which may then decide:
-
join the voice broadcast call or the voice group call, if needed after having stopped on going activities.
3.3.3.2
3.3.3.3
This section applies to mobile stations which read the NCH in idle mode in order to receive the notification messages
for the voice broadcast call and the voice group call, which read the PCH to receive pagings and which aim at reducing
the reception load.
A reduced NCH monitoring mechanism may be used on the NCH. When the mobile station in idle mode enters a cell
and deduces from the BCCH that an NCH is present, it shall read the NCH until it has received at least two messages on
the NCH indicating NLN, with the two last received NLN being identical. Then it may stop reading the NCH until it
receives on the PCH an NLN(PCH) different from the last previously received NLN or on the SACCH an
NLN(SACCH) different from the last previously received NLN..
A mobile is able to determine the reduced NCH monitoring is active in the network if it receives an NLN in any
message. Once received, the mobile shall assume that NCH monitoring is active for a certain period of time which is
not specified.
For this, parameters are provided:
-
ETSI
56
The NLN is a modulo 4 counter which is changed every time a notification for a new VGCS or VBS call is
started on the NCH. If the reduced NCH monitoring is indicated, the NLN provides information on new
notifications provided on the NCH.
-
NLN status :
The NLN status is a single bit field which indicates the status of the content of the NOTIFICATION/NCH
messages for a particular NLN value. A change of the NLN status field indicates a change of information on the
NCH which is not related to new calls (e.g. There may have been a release of a previous notified call or change
of priority, etc ...).
If the reduced NCH monitoring is active in the network, the network has to provide both NLN and NLN status
parameters.
These parameters may be provided on the NCH, PCH and SACCH:
-
A mobile station supporting neither VGCS listening nor VBS listening shall ignore the NLN(NCH),NLN(PCH),
NLN(SACCH) and NLN status fields.
If a mobile station (supporting VGCS listening and/or VBS listening) receives a NLN parameters on the NLN(PCH) or
NLN(SACCH) field different from the last received NLN value it shall read the NCH until it has received at least two
messages on the NCH indicating NLN with the two last received NLN being identical.
If a message in the paging subchannel is not received correctly, or if a paging message does not contain the information
on the notification status, the mobile station shall read the NCH until it has received at least two messages on the NCH
indicating NLN, with the two last received NLN being identical
3.4
Procedures described in this section apply to the dedicated mode and/or the group transmit mode.
Those procedures which are specific for group transmit mode or refer to transitions to the group transmit mode are only
applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS talking.
Direct transition between dedicated mode and group transmit mode is possible in both directions by use of the following
procedures:
-
Handover procedure;
3.4.1
3.4.1.1
SACCH procedures
General
In dedicated mode and group transmit mode, the SACCH is used in signalling layer at least for measurement results
transmission from the mobile station.
The SACCH has the particularity that continuous transmission must occur in both directions at least on the channel
carrying the main signalling link. For that purpose, in the mobile station to network direction, measurement result
messages are sent at each possible occasion when nothing else has to be sent (see section 3.4.1.2). Similarly, SYSTEM
ETSI
57
INFORMATION TYPE 5, 6 and optionally 5bis and 5ter messages are sent in the network to mobile station direction in
UI frames when nothing else has to be sent.
In a multislot configuration the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 5, 6 and optionally 5bis and 5ter messages shall be
sent on the SACCH associated with the channel carrying the main signalling link.
In a multislot configuration the mobile station shall ignore all messages received on the SACCH(s) that are not
associated with the channel carrying the main signalling link.
On a VGCS channel, the network may send additional or alternative system information messages for both mobile
stations in group transmit mode and those in group receive mode (see section 3.4.15.2.1).
A mobile station with extended measurement capabilities which receives EXTENDED MEASUREMENT ORDER
(EMO) messages on the SACCH, shall perform and report extended measurements, see section 3.4.1.3.
The SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 5bis message shall be sent if and only if the EXT IND bit in the Neighbour Cell
Description information element in both the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 5 and TYPE 5bis messages indicates
that each information element only carries part of the BA.
A GSM 900 mobile station which only supports the primary GSM band P-GSM 900 (cf. GSM 05.05) may consider the
EXT-IND bit in the Neighbour Cells Description IE in the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 5 message bit as a spare
bit, assume that the information element carries the complete BA, and ignore any SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE
5bis messages.
NOTE:
The network should take into account limitations of certain mobile stations to understand SYSTEM
INFORMATION TYPE 5ter and TYPE 5bis messages, the EXT-IND bit in the Neighbour Cells
Description, and formats used in the Neighbour Cells Description information element and Cell Channel
Description information element used in SYSTEM INFORMATION messages, see section 10.5.2.1b, and
section 10.5.2.22.
As specified in GSM 05.08, problems occurring in the reception of SACCH frames are interpreted as a loss of
communication means and appropriate procedures are then triggered as specified in section 3.4.13.
3.4.1.2
Measurement report
When in dedicated mode or group transmit mode, the mobile station regularly sends MEASUREMENT REPORT
messages to the network. These messages contain measurement results about reception characteristics from the current
cell and from neighbour cells. The BA (list) which is the basis for the measurements is derived from information
received on the BCCH in System Information 2 and optionally 2bis and/or 2ter and on the SACCH in System
Information 5 and optionally 5bis and/or 5ter.
When the information is received in more than one message the mobile station shall only combine information from
messages received on the same channel and indicating the same value of the BCCH allocation sequence number without
any message indicating a different value of the BCCH allocation sequence number received in between. If neighbouring
cell information for the serving cell is not available, the mobile station indicates this in the MEASUREMENT REPORT
message. These measurement results are obtained as specified in GSM 05.08.
These messages are sent on the slow ACCH, in unacknowledged mode.
If no other message is scheduled on the SACCH at the instant when a layer 2 frame is due to be sent, then the mobile
station shall send a MEASUREMENT REPORT message or an EXTENDED MEASUREMENT REPORT message
(see section 3.4.1.3) in that frame. The interval between two successive layer 2 frames containing MEASUREMENT
REPORT messages shall not exceed one layer 2 frame.
3.4.1.3
ETSI
58
If the mobile station has not started to send its EXTENDED MEASUREMENT REPORT within 10 seconds after the
reception of the EMO message, no EXTENDED MEASUREMENT REPORT shall be sent. The mobile station shall
after a successful channel change abort any pending measurements or reporting related to an EMO message received on
the old channel.
If a mobile station receives an EMO message indicating the same value of the sequence code as an EMO message
received earlier on the same channel without having received any EMO message indicating a different value of the
sequence code in between, that EMO message shall be ignored. If the mobile station, before the reporting related to an
EMO message has started, receives a new EMO message with a different value of the sequence code, any pending
measurements or reporting related to the earlier EMO message shall be aborted and the new message treated.
The EMO message and the EXTENDED MEASUREMENT REPORT message are sent on the SACCH, in
unacknowledged mode.
3.4.2
When in dedicated mode or in group transmit mode, upper layers can send messages in multiframe or unacknowledged
mode on SAPI 0.
Moreover, but only when in dedicated mode, upper layers have access to the full link layer services for SAPIs other
than 0, with the exception of the error indication and local end release that are directly treated by the RR sublayer, as
specified in particular places of section 3.
3.4.3
In dedicated mode or in group transmit mode, an intracell change of channel can be requested by upper layers for
changing the channel type, or decided by the RR sublayer, e.g. for an internal handover. This change may be performed
through the dedicated channel assignment procedure.
The purpose of the channel assignment procedure is to completely modify the physical channel configuration of the
mobile station without frequency redefinition or change in synchronization while staying in the same cell.
This procedure shall not be used for changing between dependent configurations, i.e. those sharing Radio Resource for
the main signalling link. An example of dependent channels is a full rate channel and one of the corresponding half rate
channels. In multislot operation however, it is allowed to use the same timeslots before and after the assignment, as long
as the main signalling link has been changed. The only procedures provided for changing between dependent
configurations for the main signalling link are the additional assignment and the partial release procedures.
The channel assignment procedure happens only in dedicated mode and in group transmit mode. This procedure cannot
be used in the idle mode; in this case the immediate assignment procedure is used.
The channel assignment procedure includes:
-
the release of the main signalling link, and of the other data links as defined in section 3.1.4, and the
disconnection of TCHs if any.
The triggering of the establishment of the data link connections for SAPI = 0.
3.4.3.1
The network initiates the channel assignment procedure by sending an ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message to the
mobile station on the main signalling link. It then starts timer T3107.
ETSI
NOTE:
59
The network should take into account limitations of certain mobile stations to understand formats used in
the Frequency List IE and Cell Channel Description IE used in the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
message, see section 10.5.2.13 and section 10.5.2.1b.
When sending this message on the network side, and when receiving it on the mobile station side, all transmission of
signalling layer messages except for those RR messages needed for this procedure and for abnormal cases is suspended
until resumption is indicated. These RR messages can be deduced from sections 3.4.3 and 8.8 Radio Resource
management.
Upon receipt of the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message, the mobile station initiates a local end release of link layer
connections, disconnects the physical channels, commands the switching to the assigned channels and initiates the
establishment of lower layer connections (this includes the activation of the channels, their connection and the
establishment of the main signalling links).
The ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message contains the description of the new configuration, including for the
multislot configuration and the TCH/H + TCH/H + ACCHs configuration, the exact ACCHs to be used and a power
command. The power level defined in this power command shall be used by the mobile station for the initial power on
the new channel(s). It shall not affect the power used on the old channel(s). The message may also contain definitions of
the channel mode to be applied for one or several channel sets. If a previously undefined channel set is defined by the
ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message, a definition of the channel mode for the new channel set shall be included in the
message.
If the channel mode to be applied corresponds to a multi-rate speech codec, the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message
may contain the MultiRate Configuration IE, which defines the set of codec modes and related information to use on the
new channel. For an initial assignment of a multi-rate speech codec, the MS shall expect in the ASSIGNMENT
COMMAND the MultiRate Configuration IE. After reception of the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND, the mobile station
shall use the Initial Codec Mode specified in the MultiRate Configuration IE, if present, or apply the implicit rule
defined in GSM 05.09.
An ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message may indicate a frequency change in progress, with a starting time and
possibly alternative channel descriptions.
In the case of the reception of an ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message which contains only the description of a
channel to be used after the starting time, the mobile station shall wait up to the starting time before accessing the
channel. If the starting time has already elapsed, the mobile shall access the channel as an immediate reaction to the
reception of the message (see GSM 05.10 for the timing constraints).
If the message contains both the description of a channel to be used after the indicated time and of a channel to be used
before, the mobile station accesses a channel as an immediate reaction to the reception of the message. If the moment
the mobile station is ready to access is before the indicated time, the mobile station accesses the channels described for
before the starting time. The mobile station then changes to the channel described for after the starting time at the
indicated time. New parameters can be frequency list, MAIO and HSN. Other parameters describing the allocated
channels must be identical to the parameters described for before the starting time. If the moment the mobile station is
ready to access is after the starting time, the mobile station accesses the channel described for after the starting time.
If frequency hopping is applied, the cell allocation if present in the message is used to decode the mobile allocation. If
the cell allocation is not included, the mobile station uses its current cell allocation, the current CA is the last CA
received on the BCCH. Afterward, the current CA may be changed by some messages sent on the main signalling link
containing a CA (the possible messages are: ASSIGNMENT COMMAND, HANDOVER COMMAND and
FREQUENCY REDEFINITION). Note that there are cases in which the current CA is undefined, see section 3.4.3.3.
The ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message may contain a cipher mode setting IE. In that case, this ciphering mode has
to be applied on the new channel. If no such information is present, the ciphering mode is the same as on the previous
channel. In either case the ciphering key shall not be changed. The ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message shall not
contain a cipher mode setting IE that indicates "start ciphering" unless a CIPHERING MODE COMMAND message
has been transmitted earlier in the RR connection: if such an ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message is received it shall
be regarded as erroneous, an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE with cause "Protocol error unspecified" message shall be
returned immediately, and no further action taken.
In a voice group call, the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message may contain a VGCS target mode information element
defining which RR mode is to be used on the new channel (i.e. dedicated mode or group transmit mode). If this
information element is not present, the mode shall be assumed to be the same as on the previous channel. The VGCS
target mode information element shall also indicate the group cipher key number for the group cipher key to be used on
the new channel or if the new channel is non ciphered. If the information element is not present, the ciphering mode and
ETSI
60
group cipher key shall be the same as on the previous channel. Mobile stations not supporting VGCS talking shall
ignore the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message if the VGCS target mode information element is included in the
message and shall send an RR STATUS message to the network with cause #96. If a VGCS target mode information
element and a cipher mode setting information element is included in the same message, then a mobile station
supporting VGCS talking mobile shall regard the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message as erroneous, an
ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message with cause "Protocol error unspecified" shall be returned immediately, and no
further action taken.
3.4.3.2
Assignment completion
After the main signalling link is successfully established, the mobile station returns an ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
message, specifying cause "normal event", to the network on the main DCCH.
The sending of this message on the mobile station side and its receipt on the network side allow the resumption of the
transmission of signalling layer messages other than those belonging to RR management.
At the receipt of the ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE message, the network releases the previously allocated resources and
stops timer T3107.
3.4.3.3
Abnormal cases
If the mobile station has no current CA and if it needs a CA to analyse the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message, it
stays on the current channel(s) and sends an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message with cause "no cell allocation
available".
If the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message instructs the mobile station to use a Channel Description or Mode that it
does not support, or if the Channel Mode to use is not defined for all channel sets, then the mobile station shall return an
ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message with cause "channel mode unacceptable", and the mobile station shall remain on
the current channel(s) and uses the old Channel Description or Channel Mode(s).
If the mobile station receives an ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message containing an inconsistent MultiRate
Configuration IE, then the mobile station shall return an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message with cause "channel mode
unacceptable", and the mobile station shall remain on the current channel(s) and uses the old Channel Description or
Channel Mode(s).
If during the initial assignment of the multirate speech the mobile station receives an ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
message and the MultiRate Configuration IE is not present, then the mobile station shall return an ASSIGNMENT
FAILURE message with cause "channel mode unacceptable", and the mobile station shall remain on the current
channel(s) and uses the old Channel Description or Channel Mode(s).
If the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message instructs the mobile station to use a frequency that it is not capable of,
then the mobile station shall return an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message with cause "frequency not implemented",
and the mobile station shall remain on the current channel(s).
If the mobile station receives an ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message with a Frequency List IE indicating frequencies
that are not all in one band, then the mobile station shall stay on the current channel(s) and send an ASSIGNMENT
FAILURE message with cause "frequency not implemented". If the mobile station receives an ASSIGNMENT
COMMAND message with a Mobile Allocation IE indexing frequencies that are not all in one band, then the mobile
station shall stay on the current channel(s) and send an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message with cause "frequency not
implemented".
NOTE:
An ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message sent to a multi band mobile station shall not be considered
invalid because it indicates frequencies that are all in a different frequency band to that of the current
channel.
On the mobile station side, if a lower layer failure happens on the new channel before the ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
message has been sent, the mobile station deactivates the new channels, reactivates the old channels, reconnects the
TCHs if any and triggers the establishment of the main signalling link. It then sends a ASSIGNMENT FAILURE
message, cause "protocol error unspecified" on the main DCCH and resumes the normal operation, as if no assignment
attempt had occurred. The operational parameters (e.g. ciphering mode) when returning on the old channel are those
applied before the procedure.
When receiving the ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message, the network stops T3107.
ETSI
61
If a lower layer failure happens while attempting to connect back to the old channels, the radio link failure procedure is
applied (see section 3.4.13.2 for dedicated mode and 3.4.13.5 for group transmit mode).
On the network side, if timer T3107 elapses before either the ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE message has been received
on the new channels or an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message is received on the old channels, the old channels and the
new channels are released if they both were dedicated channels and, unless the mobile station has re-established the
call, all contexts related to the connections with that mobile station are cleared. If one of the channels was a VGCS
channel, it shall be maintained and the uplink shall be set free. If both channels were VGCS channels, the network shall
maintain one of the channels and the uplink shall be set free.
On the network side, lower layer failure occurring on the old channels after the sending of the ASSIGNMENT
COMMAND message are ignored. Lower layer failures occurring after the receipt of the SABM Frame on the new
main signalling link are treated following the general rules (cf. section 3.5.2).
3.4.4
Handover procedure
In dedicated mode or group transmit mode, an intercell or intracell change of channel(s) can be requested by the
network RR sublayer. This change may be performed through the handover procedure
NOTE:
The decision to do a handover and the choice of the new cell is out of the scope of this technical
specification.
The purpose of the handover procedure is to completely modify the channels allocated to the mobile station e.g. when
the cell is changed. A change in the channel configuration nature is possible. This procedure is used only while in
dedicated mode or group transmit mode.
The handover procedure is also used by Location Services as described in GSM 03.71.
The handover procedure shall not be used for changing between dependent configurations (see section 3.4.3). ). An
exception to this is when the handover procedure is used by Location Services. In this case the mobile may be
commanded to attempt a handover to the same channel as currently assigned to the MS. The MS shall attempt to
perform a handover to this unchanged channel, which includes the transmission of access bursts.
The handover procedure includes:
-
The disconnection of the main signalling link, and of the other links via local end release (layer 2), and the
disconnection of the TCH(s) if any.
The disconnection and the deactivation of previously assigned channels and their release (layer 1).
The triggering of the establishment of data link connection for SAPI = 0 on the new channels.
3.4.4.1
Handover initiation
The network initiates the handover procedure by sending a HANDOVER COMMAND message to the mobile station
on the main DCCH. It then starts timer T3103.
NOTE:
The network should take into account limitations of certain mobile stations to understand formats used in
the Frequency List IE, Frequency Short List IE, and Cell Channel Description IE used in the
HANDOVER COMMAND message, see section 10.5.2.13, section 10.5.2.14, and section 10.5.2.1b.
When sending this message on the network side, and when receiving it on the mobile station side, all transmission of
signalling layer messages except for those RR messages needed for this procedure and for abnormal cases, is suspended
until resuming is indicated. These RR messages can be deduced from section 3.4.3 and 8.5.1 "Radio Resource
management".
Upon receipt of the HANDOVER COMMAND message, the mobile station initiates, as described in section 3.1.4, the
release of link layer connections, disconnects the physical channels, commands the switching to the assigned channels
ETSI
62
and initiates the establishment of lower layer connections (this includes the activation of the channels, their connection
and the establishment of the data links).
The HANDOVER COMMAND message contains:
-
The characteristics of the new channels, including for the multislot configuration and the TCH/H + TCH/H +
ACCHs configuration the exact ACCHs to be used. The message may also contain definitions of the channel
mode to be applied for one or several channel sets. If a previously undefined channel set is defined by the
HANDOVER COMMAND message, a definition of the channel mode for the new channel set shall be included
in the message.
The characteristics of the new cell that are necessary to successfully communicate (e.g. frequency list in the case
of slow frequency hopping), including the data that allows the mobile station to use the pre-knowledge about
synchronization it acquires by the measurement process (i.e. BSIC + BCCH frequency).
A power command (cf. GSM 05.08). The power level defined in this power command shall be used by the
mobile station for the initial power on the new channel(s). It shall not affect the power used on the old
channel(s).
A handover reference, used as specified in the following section. The choice of the handover reference by the
network is out of the scope of this specification and left to the manufacturers.
Optionally a cipher mode setting. In that case, this ciphering mode has to be applied on the new channel. If no
such information is present, the ciphering mode is the same as on the previous channel. In either case the
ciphering key shall not be changed. The HANDOVER COMMAND message shall not contain a cipher mode
setting IE that indicates "start ciphering" unless a CIPHERING MODE COMMAND message has been
transmitted previously in this instance of the dedicated mode: if such a HANDOVER COMMAND message is
received it shall be regarded as erroneous, a HANDOVER FAILURE message with cause "Protocol error
unspecified" shall be returned immediately, and no further action taken.
Optionally, in a voice group call, a VGCS target mode information element defining which RR mode is to be
used on the new channel (i.e. dedicated mode or group transmit mode). If this information element is not present,
the mode shall be assumed to be the same as on the previous channel. The VGCS target mode information
element shall also indicate the group cipher key number for the group cipher key to be used on the new channel
or if the new channel is non ciphered. If the information element is not present, the ciphering mode and ciphering
key shall be the same as on the previous channel. Mobile stations not supporting VGCS talking shall ignore the
HANDOVER COMMAND message if the VGCS target mode information element is included in the message
and shall send an RR STATUS message to the network with cause #96. If a VGCS target mode information
element and a cipher mode setting information element is included in the same message, then a mobile station
supporting VGCS talking shall regard the HANDOVER COMMAND message as erroneous, an HANDOVER
FAILURE message with cause "Protocol error unspecified" shall be returned immediately, and no further action
taken.
Optionally, when the channel mode indicates that a multi-rate speech codec must be applied, the
MultiRateconfiguration to be used in the new cell. The MultiRate Configuration IE defines the set of codec
mode and related information to use after the handover. When accessing the new channel, the mobile station
shall use for the Initial Codec Mode the mode specified in the MultiRate Configuration IE, if present, or apply by
default the implicit rule defined in GSM 05.09.
In addition, a HANDOVER COMMAND message may indicate a frequency change in progress, with a starting time
and possibly alternative channel descriptions.
In the case of the reception of a HANDOVER COMMAND message which contains only the description of a channel
to be used after the starting time, the mobile station shall wait up to the starting time before accessing the channel. If the
starting time has already elapsed, the mobile shall access the channel as an immediate reaction to the reception of the
message (see GSM 05.10 for the timing constraints).
If the message contains both the description of a channel to be used after the indicated time and of a channel to be used
before, the mobile station accesses a channel as an immediate reaction to the reception of the message. If the moment
the mobile station is ready to access is before the indicated time, the mobile station accesses the channels described for
ETSI
63
before the starting time. The mobile station then changes to the channel described for after the starting time at the
indicated time. New parameters can be frequency list, MAIO and HSN. Other parameters describing the allocated
channels must be identical to the parameters described for before the starting time. If the moment the mobile station is
ready to access is after the starting time, the mobile station accesses the channel described for after the starting time.
If the channel mode indicates that a multi-rate speech codec must be applied, and the MultiRateConfiguration IE is not
included in the HANDOVER COMMAND message, then the mobile station shall assume that the
MultiRateconfiguration has not changed. For the Initial Codec Mode, the mobile station shall use the previously
received Initial Codec Mode, if any, or apply by default the implicit rule defined in GSM 05.09.
3.4.4.2
Four procedures are defined. The support of three of them is mandatory in the mobile station. The pseudosynchronization case is optional in the mobile station. A pseudo-synchronized handover can be commanded only to a
mobile station that can support it, as indicated in the classmark.
3.4.4.2.1
If the mobile station knows that the timing advance with the new cell is not out of range, i.e. smaller than or equal to the
maximum timing advance that can be coded as specified in GSM 04.04, or if the new cell does accept out of range
timing advance as indicated in the HANDOVER COMMAND message, the mobile station proceeds as follows.
After having switched to the assigned channels, the mobile station sends four times the HANDOVER ACCESS
message in four successive layer 1 frames on the main DCCH. This message is sent in an access burst. Its content is
reduced to the handover reference information element. The transmission of these four messages is optional if so
indicated by the network in the HANDOVER COMMAND message.
Before completion of the 4 access bursts on the DCCH, additional access bursts may also be sent on the SACCH.
It then activates the channels in sending and receiving mode and connects the channels if need be.
If applicable, ciphering is immediately started . The access bursts are not ciphered.
3.4.4.2.2
After having switched to the assigned channels, the mobile station starts repeating the HANDOVER ACCESS message
in successive layer 1 frames on the main DCCH and optionally on the SACCH. This message is sent in an access burst.
Its content is reduced to the handover reference information element. The mobile station starts timer T3124 at the start
point of the timeslot in which the HANDOVER ACCESS message is sent the first time on the main DCCH.
The mobile station then activates the channels in receiving mode and connects the channels if need be (only for
reception).
If applicable, deciphering is then immediately started . The access bursts are not ciphered.
When the network has the RF characteristics that are necessary, it sends in unacknowledged mode a PHYSICAL
INFORMATION message to the mobile station on the main DCCH. If applicable, ciphering and deciphering is
immediately started (i.e., before even the reception of a correct access burst), and the message is sent enciphered.
The PHYSICAL INFORMATION message contains various physical layer related information, allowing a proper
transmission by the mobile station.
When sending the PHYSICAL INFORMATION message, the network starts timer T3105. If this timer times out before
the reception of a correctly decoded layer 2 frame in format A or B (see GSM 04.06), or a correctly decoded TCH
frame from the mobile station, the network repeats the PHYSICAL INFORMATION message and restarts timer T3105.
The maximum number of repetitions is Ny1.
The correct decoding of a frame means that the decoding algorithm and the error detection tests, if any, indicate no
error.
When the mobile station receives a PHYSICAL INFORMATION message, it stops timer T3124, stops sending access
bursts, activates the physical channels in sending and receiving mode and connects the channels if need be. If the
allocated channel is an SDCCH (+ SACCH), performance of the mobile station must enable the mobile station to accept
a correct PHYSICAL INFORMATION message sent by the network in any block while T3124 is running.
ETSI
3.4.4.2.3
64
The details of the use of this procedure are described in GSM 05.10. The mobile station computes the timing advance to
be used with the new cell from the real time difference value given in the HANDOVER COMMAND message. If the
mobile station knows that the timing advance with the new cell is not out of range , i.e. smaller or equal to the
maximum timing advance that can be coded as specified in GSM 04.04, or if the new cell accepts an out of range
timing advance as indicated in the HANDOVER COMMAND message, the mobile station switches to the new channel
and proceeds as follows.
After having switched to the assigned channels, the mobile station sends in four successive slots on the main DCCH a
HANDOVER ACCESS message. This message is sent in random mode and thus does not follow the basic format. Its
content is reduced to the handover reference information element. The transmission of these four messages is optional if
so indicated by the network in the HANDOVER COMMAND message.
Before completion of the 4 access bursts on the DCCH, additional access bursts may also be sent on the SACCH.
The mobile station then activates the channels in sending and receiving mode and connects the channels if need be. The
mobile station may activate the channels in receiving mode and connect the channels while sending access bursts.
If applicable, ciphering is then immediately started. The access bursts are not ciphered.
3.4.4.2.4
The details of the use of this procedure are described in GSM 05.10. The mobile station switches to the new channel
and proceeds as follows.
After having switched to the assigned channels, the mobile station sends in four successive slots on the main DCCH a
HANDOVER ACCESS message. This message is sent in an access burst and thus does not follow the basic format. Its
content is reduced to the handover reference information element. The transmission of these four messages is optional if
so indicated by the network in the HANDOVER COMMAND message.
Before completion of the 4 access bursts on the DCCH, additional access bursts may also be sent on the SACCH.
The mobile station then activates the channel in sending and receiving mode and connects the channels if need be. The
timing advance value to be used with the new cell is:
-
either the value contained in the HANDOVER COMMAND message if the timing advance information element
is present;
or the default value for pre-synchronized handover as defined in GSM 05.10, if the timing advance information
element is not included in the HANDOVER COMMAND message. The MS may activate the channels in
receiving mode and connect the channels while sending access bursts.
If applicable, ciphering is immediately started. The access bursts are not ciphered.
3.4.4.3
Handover completion
After lower layer connections are successfully established, the mobile station returns a HANDOVER COMPLETE
message, specifying cause "normal event", to the network on the main DCCH.
The sending of this message on the mobile station side and its receipt on the network side allow the resumption of the
transmission of signalling layer messages other than those for RR management.
When receiving the HANDOVER COMPLETE message, the network stops timer T3103 and releases the old channels.
If requested to do so in the HANDOVER COMMAND message, the mobile station includes the observed time
difference it has measured when performing the handover, corrected by half the timing advance, in the HANDOVER
COMPLETE message (detailed specifications are given in GSM 05.10).
3.4.4.4
Abnormal cases
In the case of a synchronous or pseudo-synchronous handover, if the mobile station knows that the timing advance with
the new cell is out of range, i.e. is bigger than the maximum timing advance that can be coded as specified in
GSM 04.04, and if the new cell does not accept out of range timing advance as indicated in the HANDOVER
ETSI
65
COMMAND message, the mobile station sends a HANDOVER FAILURE message, cause "handover impossible,
timing advance out of range", on the main signalling link and does not attempt that handover.
If the HANDOVER COMMAND message instructs the mobile station to use a Channel Description or Mode that it
does not support, or if the Channel Mode to use is not defined for all channel sets, then the MS shall return a
HANDOVER FAILURE message with cause "channel mode unacceptable", and the MS shall remain on the current
channel(s) and uses the old Channel Description or Mode(s).
If the mobile station receives a HANDOVER COMMAND message containing an inconsistent MultiRateConfiguration
IE, then the mobile station shall return a HANDOVER FAILURE message with cause "channel mode unacceptable",
and the mobile station shall remain on the current channel(s) and uses the old Channel Description or Mode(s).
If the HANDOVER COMMAND message instructs the mobile station to use a frequency that it is not capable of, then
the mobile station shall return a HANDOVER FAILURE message with cause "frequency not implemented", and the
mobile station shall remain on the current channel(s).
If the mobile station receives a HANDOVER COMMAND message with a Frequency List IE or Frequency Short List
IE indicating frequencies that are not all in one band, then the mobile station shall stay on the current channel(s) and
send a HANDOVER FAILURE message with cause "frequency not implemented". If the mobile station receives a
HANDOVER COMMAND message with a Mobile Allocation IE indexing frequencies that are not all in one band, then
the mobile station shall stay on the current channel(s) and send a HANDOVER FAILURE message with cause
"frequency not implemented".
NOTE:
A HANDOVER COMMAND message sent to a multi band mobile station shall not be considered invalid
because it indicates target channel frequencies that are all in a different frequency band to that of the
ARFCN in the Cell Description IE.
On the mobile station side, if timer T3124 times out (only in the non- synchronized case) or if a lower layer failure
happens on the new channel before the HANDOVER COMPLETE message has been sent, the mobile station
deactivates the new channels, reactivates the old channels, reconnects the TCHs if any and triggers the establishment of
the main signalling link. It then sends a HANDOVER FAILURE message on the main signalling link and resumes
normal operation as if no handover attempt had occurred. The operational parameters (e.g. ciphering mode) when
returning on the old channel are those applied before the HANDOVER COMMAND message was received.
When the HANDOVER FAILURE message has been received, the network releases the new channels if they were
dedicated channels and stops timers T3105 and stops T3103 in the non-synchronized case. If the new channels were
VGCS channels, they shall be maintained.
If a lower layer failure happens while attempting to connect back to the old channels, the standard rules are applied (cf.
section 3.4.13.2 for dedicated mode and 3.4.13.5 for group transmit mode).
On the network side, if timer T3103 elapses before either the HANDOVER COMPLETE message is received on the
new channels, or a HANDOVER FAILURE message is received on the old channels, or the mobile station has reestablished the call, the old channels are released if they were dedicated channels and all contexts related to the
connections with that mobile station are cleared. If the old channel was a VGCS channel, it shall be maintained and the
uplink shall be set free.
On the network side, if neither a correctly layer 2 frame in format A or B nor a correctly TCH frame have been received
from the mobile station on the new channel, the newly allocated channels are released if they were dedicated channels.
If the new channels were VGCS channels, they shall be maintained and the uplink shall be set free..
On the network side, lower layer failures occurring on the old channels after the sending of the HANDOVER
COMMAND message are ignored. Lower layer failures occurring after the receipt of the SABM frame on the new main
signalling link are treated following a general scheme (cf. section 3.4.13.2 for dedicated mode and 3.4.13.5 for group
transmit mode).
3.4.5
In dedicated mode and group transmit mode, this procedure is used by the network to change the frequencies and
hopping sequences of the allocated channels. This is meaningful only in the case of frequency hopping.
The network sends to the mobile station a FREQUENCY REDEFINITION message containing the new parameters
together with a starting time indication.
ETSI
NOTE:
66
The network should take into account limitations of certain mobile stations to understand formats used in
the Cell Channel Description IE used in the FREQUENCY REDEFINITION message, see section
10.5.2.13.
When receiving such a message, the mobile station modifies the frequencies/hopping sequences it uses at the exact
indicated time slot, i.e. the indicated time slot is the first with new parameters. All other functions are not disturbed by
this change. New parameters can be the cell channel description, the mobile allocation and the MAIO. In case of
multislot configuration, the Channel Description IE shall describe the channel carrying the main signalling link, the new
parameters however, shall be used for all assigned timeslots. Other parameters describing the allocated channels must
be identical to the current parameters.
3.4.5.1
Abnormal cases
If the mobile station receives a FREQUENCY REDEFINITION message with a Mobile Allocation IE indexing
frequencies that are not all in one band and a Starting Time IE indicating a time that has not elapsed, then the mobile
station shall stay on the current channel(s) and send a RR STATUS message with cause "frequency not implemented".
If the mobile station receives a FREQUENCY REDEFINITION message with a Mobile Allocation IE indexing
frequencies that are not all in one band and a Starting Time IE indicating a time that has elapsed, then the mobile station
shall locally abort the radio connection and, if permitted, attempt Call Re-establishment.
If the mobile station receives a FREQUENCY REDEFENITION message on a channel for which it has a pending
redefinition (defined by the immediate assignment, assignment or handover procedure or a previous frequency
redefinition procedure) the frequencies, hopping and starting time parameters defined by the new frequency redefinition
procedure supersedes those of the pending one.
NOTE:
3.4.6
A FREQUENCY REDEFINITION message sent to a multi band mobile station shall not be considered
invalid because it indicates new frequencies that are all in a different frequency band to that of the
ARFCN of the serving cell.
In dedicated mode or group transmit mode, higher layers can request the setting of the channel mode.
The channel mode modify procedure allows the network to request the mobile station to set the channel mode for one
channel or one channel set. The procedure shall not be used if the multislot configuration contains more than one
channel set. The channel mode covers the coding, decoding and transcoding mode used on the indicated channel.
This procedure is always initiated by the network.
NOTE:
3.4.6.1
3.4.6.1.1
Direct transitions between full rate speech coder version 1 and full rate speech coder version 2 (and vice
versa) may cause unpleasant audio bursts.
The network initiates the procedure by sending a CHANNEL MODE MODIFY message to the mobile station. This
message contains:
-
a channel description of the channel(s) on which the mode in the CHANNEL MODE MODIFY message shall be
applied; and
the mode to be used on that channel, or on all the channels of a channel set in a multislot configuration.
Optionally, when the channel mode indicates that a multi-rate speech codec must be applied, the
MultiRateconfiguration to be used. The MultiRateConfiguration IE defines the set of codec mode and related
information to use after the mode modify procedure. When initiating the new mode, the mobile station shall use
for the Initial Codec Mode the mode specified in the MultiRateConfiguration IE, if present, or apply by default
the implicit rule defined in GSM 05.09.
ETSI
3.4.6.1.2
67
When it has received the CHANNEL MODE MODIFY message, the mobile station sets the mode for the indicated
channel, and if that is in a multislot configuration, the whole channel set and then replies by a CHANNEL MODE
MODIFY ACKNOWLEDGE message indicating the ordered channel mode.
This applies whether the mode commanded by the CHANNEL MODE MODIFY is different from the one used by the
mobile station or whether it is already in use.
3.4.6.1.3
Abnormal cases
No specific action for a lower layer failure is specified in this section. If the mobile station does not support the
indicated mode, it shall retain the old mode and return the associated channel mode information in the CHANNEL
MODE MODIFY ACKNOWLEDGE message.
3.4.6.2
3.4.6.2.1
The network initiates the procedure by sending a CHANNEL MODE MODIFY message to the mobile station. This
message contains:
-
a channel description of the channel on which the CHANNEL MODE MODIFY message is sent; and
optionally, the VGCS target mode information element defining which RR mode is to be used with the new
channel mode (i.e. dedicated mode or group transmit mode). If this information element is not present, the RR
mode shall be assumed to be the same as with the previous channel mode. The VGCS target mode information
element shall also indicate the group cipher key number for the group cipher key to be used on the new channel
or if the new channel is non ciphered. If the information element is not present, the ciphering mode and ciphering
key shall be the same as with the previous channel mode. Mobile stations not supporting VGCS talking shall
ignore the CHANNEL MODE MODIFY message if the VGCS target mode information element is included in
the message and shall send an RR STATUS message to the network with cause #96.
The start of ciphering with a group cipher key with the new channel mode is only possible when the mode on the old
channel was not ciphered.
If a VGCS target mode information element indicating a group cipher key number is included in the message and the
previous mode is not non ciphered and the group cipher key number is different to the previous cipher key number, the
mobile station shall behave as if it would not support the indicated channel mode.
3.4.6.2.2
When it has received the CHANNEL MODE MODIFY message, the mobile station changes the mode for the indicated
channel and then replies by a CHANNEL MODE MODIFY ACKNOWLEDGE message indicating the new channel
mode.
3.4.6.2.3
Abnormal cases
No specific action for a lower layer failure is specified in this section. If the mobile station does not support the
indicated mode, it shall retain the old mode and return the associated channel mode information in the CHANNEL
MODE MODIFY ACKNOWLEDGE message.
3.4.7
In dedicated mode, the ciphering mode setting procedure is used by the network to set the ciphering mode, i.e. whether
or not the transmission is ciphered, and if so which algorithm to use. The procedure shall only be used to change from
"not ciphered" mode to "ciphered" mode, or vice-versa, or to pass a CIPHERING MODE COMMAND message to the
mobile station while remaining in the "not ciphered" mode. The ciphering mode setting procedure is always triggered
by the network and it only applies to dedicated resources.
ETSI
68
The cipher mode setting procedure shall not be applied in group transmit mode.
3.4.7.1
The network initiates the ciphering mode setting procedure by sending a CIPHERING MODE COMMAND message to
the mobile station on the main signalling link, indicating whether ciphering shall be used or not, and if yes which
algorithm to use.
Additionally, the network may, by the use of the cipher response information element, request the mobile station to
include its IMEISV in the CIPHERING MODE COMPLETE message.
The new mode is applied for reception on the network side after the message has been sent.
3.4.7.2
Whenever the mobile station receives a valid CIPHERING MODE COMMAND message, it shall, if a SIM is present
and considered valid by the ME and the ciphering key sequence number stored on the SIM indicates that a ciphering
key is available, load the ciphering key stored on the SIM into the ME. A valid CIPHERING MODE COMMAND
message is defined to be one of the following:
-
one that indicates "start ciphering" and is received by the mobile station in the "not ciphered" mode;
one that indicates "no ciphering" and is received by the MS in the "not ciphered" mode; or
one that indicates "no ciphering" and is received by the mobile station in the "ciphered" mode.
Other CIPHERING MODE COMMAND messages shall be regarded as erroneous, an RR STATUS message with
cause "Protocol error unspecified" shall be returned, and no further action taken.
Upon receipt of the CIPHERING MODE COMMAND message indicating ciphering, the mobile station shall start
transmission and reception in the indicated mode.
When the appropriate action on the CIPHERING MODE COMMAND has been taken, the mobile station sends back a
CIPHERING MODE COMPLETE message. If the "cipher response" field of the cipher response information element in
the CIPHERING MODE COMMAND message specified "IMEI must be included" the mobile station shall include its
IMEISV in the CIPHERING MODE COMPLETE message.
Upon receipt of the CIPHERING MODE COMPLETE message or any other correct layer 2 frame which was sent in
the new mode, the network starts transmission in the new mode.
mobile station
network
3.4.8
NOTE:
In dedicated mode, a change of channel configuration to include an additional channel can be requested by upper layers.
The additional channel assignment procedure shall not be applied in group transmit mode,
ETSI
69
The purpose of the additional assignment procedure is to allocate an additional dedicated channel to a mobile station
while keeping the previously allocated channels. In particular the main DCCH and the SACCH are not modified, and
signalling exchanges are not interrupted.
The additional assignment procedure may happen only in dedicated mode. It is used for instance for the transition from
the TCH/H + ACCHs configuration to the TCH/H + TCH/H + ACCHs configuration.
The additional assignment procedure is always initiated by the network.
3.4.8.1
The network initiates the procedure by sending an ADDITIONAL ASSIGNMENT message to the mobile station on the
main DCCH. The ADDITIONAL ASSIGNMENT message contains the description of the newly assigned channel.
On receipt of the message, the mobile station activates the new channel.
3.4.8.2
The mobile station sends an ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE message to the network on the channel, on which it receives
the ADDITIONAL ASSIGNMENT message.
3.4.8.3
Abnormal cases
A lower layer failure occurring during the procedure is treated according to the general case (see section 3. 4.13.2).
The network considers the channel as allocated from the sending of the ADDITIONAL ASSIGNMENT message. As a
consequence, if a re-establishment occurs, the network will consider the context as if the mobile station has received the
message, and the new configuration allocated after the re-establishment may differ from the one the mobile station had
before the re-establishment.
3.4.9
In dedicated mode, a change of channel configuration to release one channel can be requested by upper layers.
The partial channel release procedure shall not be applied in group transmit mode.
The purpose of this procedure is to deactivate part of the dedicated channels in use. The channel configuration remains
dedicated.
NOTE:
In the present state of GSM 04.03, this procedure is only possible for the TCH/H + TCH/H + ACCHs to
TCH/H + ACCHs transition. As a consequence it is not needed for simple mobile stations.
3.4.9.1
The network initiates the partial release by sending a PARTIAL RELEASE message to the mobile station on the main
DCCH.
On receipt of the PARTIAL RELEASE message the mobile station:
-
Initiates the disconnection of all the link layer connections carried by the channel to be released;
Simultaneously initiates the connection on remaining channels of the data link layer connections that have been
released;
Sends a PARTIAL RELEASE COMPLETE to the network on the (possibly new) main signalling link.
3.4.9.2
Abnormal cases
A lower layer failure is treated following the general rules as specified in section 3.4.13.2.
ETSI
70
Moreover, on the network side, the channel configuration nature is set from the sending of the PARTIAL RELEASE
message onward. As a consequence, any new assignment after a re-establishment may concern a different channel
configuration nature from the one known by the mobile station before the re-establishment.
3.4.10
In dedicated mode or in group transmit mode, this procedure allows the mobile station to indicate to the network a
change of characteristics reflected in the classmark (e.g. due to addition of power amplification). Furthermore, a mobile
station which implements the controlled early classmark sending option may also send a CLASSMARK CHANGE
message as described in clause 3.3.1.1.4, even if no change of characteristics has occurred.
The mobile station sends a CLASSMARK CHANGE message to the network. This message contains the new mobile
station classmark 2 information element. It may also contain a Classmark 3 Information Element. There is no
acknowledgement from the network at layer 3.
3.4.11
This procedure allows the network to request additional classmark information from the mobile station (e.g. if the
information initially sent by the mobile station is not sufficient for network decisions).
3.4.11.1
The network initiates the classmark interrogation procedure by sending a CLASSMARK ENQUIRY message to the
mobile station on the main DCCH.
3.4.11.2
On receipt of the CLASSMARK ENQUIRY message the mobile station sends a CLASSMARK CHANGE message to
the network on the main DCCH. This message contains the mobile station classmark 2 information element. It may also
contain a Classmark 3 Information Element.
3.4.12
Only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening:
In dedicated mode or in group transmit mode, the RR entity shall provide indications to the upper layer on all received
notifications for voice group calls or voice broadcast calls according to the VGCS or VBS subscription data stored in
the mobile station. The indication shall include the notified group or broadcast call reference and possibly the related
priority, if provided.
In group transmit mode, if the mobile station has received a paging message with the own mobile station identity on the
PCH or on the voice group call channel downlink, the RR entity shall provide an indication to the upper layers, together
with the related priority, if applicable.
In group transmit mode, if the RR entity receives information on the voice group call channel of the existence of a
paging message in its paging subgroup of the PCH, the RR entity shall pass this information to the upper layers together
with the related priority if provided (see also section 3.3.2 and 3.3.3).
3.4.13
3.4.13.1
ETSI
71
If the mobile station is IMSI attached for GPRS services (section 4) at release of the RR connection, the mobile station
shall return to packet idle mode, or if a temporary block flow is established, continue in packet transfer mode.
3.4.13.1.1
The network initiates the channel release by sending a CHANNEL RELEASE message to the mobile station on the
main DCCH, starts timer T3109 and deactivates the SACCH.
On receipt of a CHANNEL RELEASE message the mobile station starts timer T3110 and disconnects the main
signalling link. When T3110 times out, or when the disconnection is confirmed, the mobile station deactivates all
channels, considers the RR connection as released, and returns to CCCH idle mode.
NOTE:
Data Links other than the main signalling link are disconnected by local end link release.
If case of dedicated mode, on the network side, when the main signalling link is disconnected, the network stops timer
T3109 and starts timer T3111. When timer T3111 times out, the network deactivates the channels, they are then free to
be allocated to another connection.
NOTE:
The sole purpose of timer T3111 is to let some time to acknowledge the disconnection and to protect the
channel in case of loss of the acknowledge frame.
If timer T3109 times out, the network deactivates the channels; they are then free to be allocated to another connection.
The CHANNEL RELEASE message will include an RR cause indication as follows:
#0 if it is a normal release, e.g. at the end of a call or at normal release of a DCCH.
#1 to indicate an unspecified abnormal release.
#2, #3 or #4 to indicate a specific release event.
#5 if the channel is to be assigned for servicing a higher priority call (e.g. an emergency call).
#65
if e.g. a handover procedure is stopped because the call has been cleared.
The CHANNEL RELEASE message may include the information element BA Range which may be used by a mobile
station in its selection algorithm (see GSM 05.08 and GSM 03.22).
Mobile stations not supporting VGCS or VBS listening shall consider Group Channel Description and Group Cipher
Key Number information elements as unnecessary in the message and perform the channel release procedure as normal.
For mobile stations supporting VGCS listening, the following procedures apply:
The CHANNEL RELEASE message may include the information element Group Channel Description. In this case, the
mobile station shall release the layer 2 link, enter the group receive mode and give an indication to the upper layer. If a
CHANNEL RELEASE message with no Group Channel Description is received, the normal behaviour applies.
If ciphering is applied on the VGCS or VBS channel, the network shall provide in the CHANNEL RELEASE message
with the Group Cipher Key Number information element for the group cipher key to be used by the mobile station for
reception of the VGCS or VBS channel. If this information element is not included, no ciphering is applied on the
VGCS or VBS channel.
A mobile station not supporting the GPRS option shall consider the GPRS Resumption information element as an
information element unknown in the message and continue the channel release procedure as normal.
For a mobile station supporting the GPRS option, the following additional procedures also apply:
The CHANNEL RELEASE message may include the information element GPRS Resumption. If the GPRS Resumption
information element indicates that the network has resumed GPRS services, the RR sublayer of the mobile station shall
indicate a RR GPRS resumption complete to the MM sublayer, see section 4. If the GPRS Resumption information
element indicates that the network has not successfully resumed GPRS services, the RR sublayer of the mobile station
shall indicate a RR GPRS resumption failure to the MM sublayer, see section 4.
If the mobile station has performed the GPRS suspension procedure (section 3.3.1.1.4.2) and the GPRS Resumption
information element is not included in the message, the RR sublayer of the mobile station shall indicate a RR GPRS
resumption failure to the MM sublayer, see section 4.
ETSI
72
If the mobile station has not performed the GPRS suspension procedure and the GPRS Resumption information element
is not included in the message, the mobile station shall continue the channel release procedure as normal.
3.4.13.1.2
Abnormal cases
Abnormal cases are taken into account in the main part of the description of the procedure.
3.4.13.2
The main part of these procedures concerns the "normal" cases, i.e. those without any occurrence of loss of
communication means. A separate paragraph at the end of the description of each procedure treats the cases of loss of
communication, called a radio link failure. In dedicated mode, in most of the cases the reaction of the mobile station or
the network is the same. Those reactions are described in this section to avoid repetitions.
A radio link failure can be detected by several ways:
1) By analysis of reception at layer 1, as specified in GSM 05.08 and section 3.4.1.1.
2) By a data link layer failure as specified in GSM 04.06, on the main signalling link. A data link failure on any
other data link shall not be considered as a radio link failure.
3) When a lower layer failure happens while the mobile station attempts to connect back to the old channels in a
channel assignment procedure, handover procedure, PDCH assignment procedure or RR-cell change order
procedure.
4) In some cases where timers are started to detect the lack of answer from the other party, as described in section
3.
The two first cases are known by the term "lower layer failure".
3.4.13.2.1
Mobile side
the MS shall perform a local end release on all signalling links unless otherwise specified;
the RR sublayer of the mobile station shall indicate an RR connection failure to the MM sublayer unless
otherwise specified.
NOTE:
When a mobile station which has performed the GPRS suspension procedure (section 3.3.1.1.4.2) detects a radio link
failure, the RR sublayer of the mobile station shall indicate a RR GPRS resumption failure to the MM sublayer, see
section 4.
3.4.13.2.2
Network side
In dedicated mode, the reaction of the network to a lower layer failure depends on the context. Except when otherwise
specified, it is to release the connection either with the channel release procedure as specified in section 3.5.1, or with
the following procedure. The network starts timer T3109 and deactivates the SACCH (and hence to stop transmission
on the SACCH).
When a radio link failure has been detected, an indication is passed to the upper Mobility Management sublayer on the
network side.
When timer T3109 expires, the network can regard the channels as released and free for allocation.
This procedure relies on the fact that if a mobile station does not receive the SACCH for some time, it completely
releases the channels (cf. GSM 05.08).
NOTE:
The network should maintain for a while the transaction context in order to allow call re-establishment.
The length of timer is for further study.
ETSI
73
When a mobile station which has performed the GPRS suspension procedure (section 3.3.1.1.4.2) detects a radio link
failure, the RR sublayer of the mobile station shall indicate a RR GPRS resumption failure to the MM sublayer, see
clause 4.
3.4.13.3
The mobile station aborts the RR connection by initiating a normal release of the main signalling link, performing local
end releases on all other signalling links and disconnecting all traffic channels, if any.
When a mobile station which has performed the GPRS suspension procedure (section 3.3.1.1.4.2) aborts the RR
connection, the RR sublayer of the mobile station shall indicate a RR GPRS resumption failure to the MM sublayer, see
section 4.
3.4.13.4
If the uplink release is requested by the upper layer the mobile station shall send an UPLINK RELEASE message on
the voice group call channel uplink, perform a release of the main signalling link and go back to the group receive
mode.
If the UPLINK RELEASE message is received from the network on the voice group call channel downlink, the MS
shall perform a release of the main signalling link and go back to the group receive mode.
3.4.13.5
The main part of these procedures concerns the "normal" cases, i.e. those without any occurrence of loss of
communication means. A separate paragraph at the end of the description of each procedure treats the cases of loss of
communication, called a radio link failure. In group transmit mode, in most of the cases the reaction of the mobile
station or the network is the same. Those reactions are described in this section to avoid repetitions.
A radio link failure can be detected by several ways:
1) By analysis of reception at layer 1, as specified in GSM 05.08 and section 3.4.1.1.
2) By a data link layer failure as specified in GSM 04.06, on the main signalling link. A data link failure on any
other data link shall not be considered as a radio link failure.
3) When a lower layer failure happens while the mobile station attempts to connect back to the old channels in a
channel assignment procedure or handover procedure.
4) In some cases where timers are started to detect the lack of answer from the other party, as described in section
3.
The two first cases are known by the term "lower layer failure".
3.4.13.5.1
Mobile side
the mobile station shall go back to idle mode and, when possible, to group receive mode;
the RR sublayer of the mobile station shall indicate an RR connection failure to the MM sublayer unless
otherwise specified.
3.4.13.5.2
Network side
When the uplink has been allocated and the network detects a lower layer failure, the network shall set the uplink free
and provide an UPLINK FREE message on the main signalling channel, when appropriate.
When a radio link failure has been detected, an indication is passed to the upper Mobility Management sublayer on the
network side.
ETSI
3.4.14
74
If the RR entity of the mobile station receives a RR STATUS message no transition and no specific action shall be
taken as seen from the radio interface, i.e. local actions are possible.
The actions to be taken on receiving a RR STATUS message in the network are an implementation dependent option
see also section 8.
3.4.15
3.4.15.1
3.4.15.1.1
In group receive mode, the mobile station receives the downlink of the voice broadcast channel or voice group call
channel for which the channel description was provided within the notification message or in the related command
message. The mobile station should also listen to the CCCH of the serving cell. Moreover, it measures the received
levels on the serving cell and on the neighbour cells to assess the need for a cell reselection as specified in GSM 05.08.
The general cell reselection procedure for the mobile station in group receive mode is described in GSM 03.22.
Information on neighbour cells used for cell reselection and reception of the VGCS or VBS channel in the neighbour
cells may be provided on the downlink messages (see section 3.4.15.1.2). If no such information is provided or
information is missing, the mobile station shall try to read this information on the BCCH and NCH of the neighbour
cells.
3.4.15.1.2
Mobile stations in group receive mode shall monitor messages related to the following procedures on the VGCS or VBS
channel downlink and act appropriately in order to be able to keep receiving the VGCS or VBS channel downlink.
All messages for mobile stations in group receive mode shall be sent in UI format on the VGCS or VBS channel
downlink. Mobile stations in group receive mode shall ignore all messages which are not sent in UI format or which are
not related to the following mentioned procedures.
The mobile should also monitor messages on the PCH or NCH of the current cell.
3.4.15.1.2.1
Spare
3.4.15.1.2.2
Spare
3.4.15.1.2.3
The mobile station shall receive CHANNEL MODE MODIFY messages. The mobile station shall use the new channel
mode but shall not transmit any response to the network.
3.4.15.1.2.4
The mobile station shall monitor messages related to notification and paging procedures.
The RR entity shall provide indications on all received notifications for voice group calls or voice broadcast calls to the
upper layer. The indication shall include the notified group or broadcast call reference and, if provided, and if the
mobile station supports eMLPP the related priority.
On request by the upper layer to join another voice broadcast call or voice group call for which a corresponding
notification has been received on the VGCS or VBS channel downlink, the RR entity shall read the corresponding
notification on the NCH.
ETSI
75
If the mobile station has received a paging message with its own mobile station identity on the PCH or on the voice
broadcast channel or voice group call channel downlink, the RR entity shall provide an indication to the upper layers,
together with the related priority, if applicable.
3.4.15.1.2.4.1
This section applies to mobile stations which are in group receive mode or group transmit mode of dedicated mode and
which in addition want to receive notification messages for other voice broadcast calls or voice group calls and which
aim at reducing the reception load.
If the reduced NCH monitoring mechanism is used on the NCH as defined in section 3.3.3.3, when the MS in group
receive mode or group transmit mode enters a cell, it should read the NCH until it has received at least two messages on
the NCH indicating NLN, with the two last received NLN being identical. Then it should stop reading the NCH until it
receives on the SACCH an NLN(SACCH) different from the last previously received NLN.
For this, a parameter is provided on the SACCH in the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 6 message:
-
If a mobile station receives on the SACCH an NLN(SACCH) different from the last received NLN it may read the NCH
until it has received at least two messages on the NCH indicating NLN with the two last received NLN being identical.
If a message in the SACCH is not received correctly the MS may read the NCH until it has received at least two
messages on the NCH indicating NLN, with the two last received NLN being identical.
NOTE:
3.4.15.1.2.5
If the NLN(SACCH) is not provided on the SACCH, the mobile station, depending on its particular
implementation, may either read the NCH while being in group receive mode or group transmit mode or
may not be able to receive notifications for other voice group calls or voice broadcast calls other than
those notifications provided on the FACCH.
Uplink status messages
Mobile stations supporting VGCS talking shall monitor the VGCS uplink control related messages UPLINK FREE and
UPLINK BUSY.
3.4.15.1.2.6
The mobile station shall receive CHANNEL RELEASE messages. On receipt of a CHANNEL RELEASE message, the
RR entity shall go to idle mode and give an indication to the upper layer. (See also section 3.4.15.1.4.1, 4th paragraph.)
3.4.15.1.2.7
On receipt of a SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 6 message indicating that paging channel restructuring has taken
place, if the mobile station wants to be able to read its paging subchannel while in group receive mode or group transmit
mode, the mobile station should read the related messages on the BCCH to know the position of its paging group.
3.4.15.1.3
ETSI
3.4.15.1.4
3.4.15.1.4.1
76
notifications for the current group or broadcast call are sent; but
no VGCS or VBS channel description for the current group or broadcast call is provided;
the mobile station shall go to idle mode and give an indication to the upper (sub-)layers.
NOTE:
Upper (sub-)layers then can request the establishment of an RR connection in order to be informed about
the channel description by the network.
If the mobile station enters a cell in which notifications for the current group or broadcast call are not sent, the mobile
station shall disconnect locally the TCH, go to idle mode and give an indication to the upper (sub-)layers.
On request by the upper layer in order to respond to a paging message the RR entity shall go to the idle mode in order to
establish a dedicated RR connection.
On receipt of a CHANNEL RELEASE message in UI format from the network the RR entity shall go to idle mode and
give an indication to the upper layer.
If the upper layer requests to abort the group receive mode, the mobile station shall go back to idle mode.
3.4.15.1.4.2
3.4.15.2
3.4.15.2.1
3.4.15.2.1.1
Network side
Provision of messages on the VGCS or VBS channel downlink
General
The network shall provide all messages directed to mobile stations in group receive mode (see section 3.4.15.1.2) in
unacknowledged mode. Those messages which are also sent to the mobile station in group transmit mode in
acknowledged mode have therefore to be repeated in addition as UI messages on the VGCS channel downlink if they
shall also be received by mobile stations in group receive mode.
3.4.15.2.1.2
In the case where the group call area exceeds one cell, the network should provide the SYSTEM INFORMATION
TYPE 6 message on the SACCH related to the voice broadcast channel or voice group call channel.
ETSI
77
In addition, if the group call area exceeds one cell, the network should provide SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 5
(possibly together with TYPE 5bis and 5ter) on the SACCH related to the voice broadcast channel or voice group call
channel.
-
The SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 5, TYPE 5bis and TYPE 5ter messages provide information on the
BCCH frequency of the neighbour cells.
The SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 6 message provides information on the location area of the current cell,
possibly the status of the NCH, and an indication of whether paging channel restructuring has taken place.
$(ASCI)$ Optional messages of the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 10 message type provide information
improving cell re-selection in group receive mode.
The network may also provide layer 3 messages for notification on the VGCS or VBS channel downlink FACCH.
3.4.15.2.1.3
3.4.15.2.2
If a release request for a voice group call is received from the upper layer, the network, after having released the RR
connection with the mobile station in group transmit mode, shall stop the notification procedures for that voice group
call and clear all related voice group call channels.
If a release request for a voice broadcast call is received from the upper layer, the network shall stop the notification
procedures for that voice broadcast call and locally disconnect any channel related to the voice broadcast call.
3.4.15.3
Failure cases
If the mobile station looses the voice group call channel or voice broadcast channel, the mobile station shall search all
possible channel positions on the current cell and the neighbour cells for which a channel description is known for that
call.
3.4.16
ETSI
3.4.16.1
78
The procedure starts when the network sends a CONFIGURATION CHANGE COMMAND to the mobile station on
the main DCCH. The message indicates:
-
The message may also contain definitions of the channel mode to be applied for one or several channel sets. If a
previously undefined channel set is defined by the CONFIGURATION CHANGE COMMAND a definition of the
channel mode for the new channel set shall be included in the message.
3.4.16.2
When the mobile station receives the CONFIGURATION CHANGE COMMAND it changes its configuration in
accordance with the message contents and returns a CONFIGURATION CHANGE ACKNOWLEDGE on the same
channel as the command message was received, confirming the new channel configuration. This applies irrespective of
whether the new configuration is different from the one already in use by the mobile station or if it is the same.
3.4.16.3
Abnormal cases
If the CONFIGURATION CHANGE COMMAND message instructs the mobile station to use a Channel Configuration
or Mode(s) that it does not support, or if the channel mode to use is not defined for all channel sets, the mobile station
shall return a CONFIGURATION CHANGE REJECT message with cause 'channel mode unacceptable', and the mobile
station shall remain on the current channel(s) and use the old Channel Configuration and Channel Mode(s).
3.4.17
For multislot configurations the following rules for mapping of the user data substreams onto timeslots shall apply for
each channel set:
at initial assignment (using assignment procedure), the lowest numbered user data substream shall be mapped to
the lowest numbered timeslot etc. in ascending order (the user data substreams are numbered 0 to (n-1), where n
is the number of substreams)
at channel changes using handover procedure or assignment procedure (where none of the timeslots are present
in both the old and the new configuration), the lowest numbered user data substream shall be mapped to the
lowest numbered timeslot etc. in ascending order (the user data substreams are numbered 0 to (n-1), where n is
the number of substreams)
at channel changes using assignment procedure (where at least one of the timeslots is the same in both the old
and the new configuration) or configuration change procedure:
user data substream(s) mapped to timeslot(s) that are present in both the old and the new configuration shall
continue to be mapped to the same timeslot(s) as before the channel change; and
possibly added timeslot(s) shall carry the lowest numbered available user data substream so that the lowest
numbered data substream among the added is mapped to the lowest numbered added timeslot and so on in
ascending order.
NOTE:
3.4.18
The user data substream number is a number that need not be the same as the inband number used for
transparent services. The user data substream number is only used as a point of reference to a specific
user data substream.
The coding of some fields in the Mobile Station Classmark 1 and in the Mobile Station Classmark 2 information
elements depends on the band in use as described in subclause 10.5.1.5 and subclause 10.5.1.6. When a command to
ETSI
79
change the frequency band (GSM 900, DCS 1800) has been received (by, e.g., an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
message, an ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message, a HANDOVER COMMAND message or a FREQUENCY
REDEFINITION message) the following applies:
-
When an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message is received, "the band used" for the purpose of coding the
classmark information in the service request message, see subclause 3.1.5, shall be understood as the band used
for the CHANNEL REQUEST message or (one of) the band(s) indicated by the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
message.
For other cases "the band used" for the purpose of coding the classmark information shall be understood as one
of the bands used or attempted to be used within the 2 seconds preceding the passing of the layer 3 message
containing the classmark information to the layer 2 send queue as described in GSM 04.06.
NOTE:
3.4.19
This definition means that when a band change is being done the network must take appropriate actions to
handle possible ambiguities in the frequency band related information in the classmark.
This section is only applicable to mobile stations supporting the <<GPRS>> option.
When in dedicated mode or in group transmit mode, the network may wish to change the resources used by a mobile
station that supports the <<GPRS option>>. This change may be performed through the assignment to a Packet Data
Channel procedure.
The purpose of the assignment to PDCH channel procedure is to completely modify the physical channel configuration
of the mobile station without frequency redefinition or change in synchronization while staying in the same cell.
The assignment to PDCH procedure only commences in dedicated mode or in group transmit mode. This procedure
cannot be used in the idle mode.
The assignment to PDCH procedure includes:
-
the release of the main signalling link, and of the other data links as defined in section 3.1.4, and the
disconnection of TCHs if any.
3.4.19.1
The network initiates the assignment to PDCH procedure by sending a PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message to
the mobile station on the main signalling link. It then starts timer T3117.
NOTE:
The network should take into account limitations of certain mobile stations to understand formats used in
the Frequency List IE and Cell Channel Description IE used in the PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
message, see section 10.5.2.13 and section 10.5.2.1b.
When sending this message on the network side, and when receiving it on the mobile station side, all transmission of
signalling layer messages except for those RR messages needed for this procedure and for abnormal cases is suspended
until resumption is indicated. These RR messages can be deduced from sections 3.4.3 and 8.8 Radio Resource
management.
Upon receipt of the PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message, the mobile station initiates a local end release of
dedicated mode link layer connections, disconnects the physical channels, commands the switching to the identified
channels and obeys the procedures relevant to the establishment of the Temporary Block Flow. The mobile station starts
timer T3190.
The PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message contains the description of either the uplink TBF or the downlink
TBF.
ETSI
80
The information on the power to be used on the target TBF shall not affect the power used on the old channel(s).
A PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message may indicate a frequency change in progress, with a starting time and
possibly alternative channel descriptions.
In the case of the reception of a PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message which contains only the description of a
TBF to be used after the starting time, the mobile station shall wait up to the starting time before using the TBF. If the
starting time has already elapsed, the mobile shall use the TBF as an immediate reaction to the reception of the message
(see GSM 05.10 for the timing constraints).
If the message contains both the description of a TBF to be used after the indicated time and of a TBF to be used before,
the mobile station uses the TBF as an immediate reaction to the reception of the message. If the moment the mobile
station is ready to access is before the indicated time, the mobile station uses the TBF described for before the starting
time. The mobile station then changes to the TBF described for after the starting time at the indicated time. New
parameters can be frequency list, MAIO and HSN. Other parameters describing the allocated channels shall be identical
to the parameters described for before the starting time. If the moment the mobile station is ready to access is after the
starting time, the mobile station uses the TBF described for after the starting time.
If frequency hopping is applied, the cell allocation if present in the message is used to decode the mobile allocation. If
the cell allocation is not included, the mobile station uses its current cell allocation, the current CA is the last CA
received on the BCCH. Afterward, the current CA may be changed by some messages sent on the main signalling link
containing a CA (the possible messages are: ASSIGNMENT COMMAND, HANDOVER COMMAND and
FREQUENCY REDEFINITION). Note that there are cases in which the current CA is undefined, see section 3.4.3.3.
The PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND does not contain a cipher mode setting IE. Any RR layer ciphering that may
have been applied in dedicated mode shall not be applied to the target TBF.
3.4.19.2
The network regards the procedure as successfully completed when RLC/MAC blocks are received from the mobile
station on the target TBF. The network then stops timer T3117.
The mobile station regards the procedure as successfully completed when RLC/MAC blocks with any TFI are received
on the new PDCH.
3.4.19.3
Abnormal cases
If the mobile station has no current CA and if it needs a CA to analyse the PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
message, it stays on the current channel(s) and sends an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message with cause "no cell
allocation available".
If the PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message instructs the mobile station to use a Coding Scheme that it does not
support then the mobile station shall return an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message with cause "channel mode
unacceptable", and the mobile station shall remain on the current channel(s) and uses the old Channel Description or
Channel Mode(s).
If the PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message instructs the mobile station to use a frequency that it is not capable
of, then the mobile station shall return an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message with cause "frequency not implemented",
and the mobile station shall remain on the current channel(s).
If the mobile station receives a PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message with a Frequency List IE indicating
frequencies that are not all in one band, then the mobile station shall stay on the current channel(s) and send an
ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message with cause "frequency not implemented". If the mobile station receives a PDCH
ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message with a Mobile Allocation IE indexing frequencies that are not all in one band,
then the mobile station shall stay on the current channel(s) and send an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message with cause
"frequency not implemented".
NOTE:
A PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message sent to a multi band mobile station shall not be
considered invalid because it indicates frequencies that are all in a different frequency band to that of the
current channel.
On the mobile station side, if RLC/MAC blocks are not successfully received within T3190 seconds, the mobile station
reactivates the old channels, reconnects the TCHs if any and triggers the establishment of the main signalling link. It
ETSI
81
then sends an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message, cause "protocol error unspecified" on the main DCCH and resumes
the normal operation, as if no assignment attempt had occurred. The operational parameters (e.g. ciphering mode) when
returning on the old channel are those applied before the procedure.
When receiving the ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message, the network stops T3117.
If a lower layer failure happens while attempting to connect back to the old channels, the radio link failure procedure is
applied (see section 3.4.13.2).
On the network side, if timer T3117 elapses before either the network receives an RLC/MAC block from the mobile
station on the new channel, or, an ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message is received on the old channels, then the old
channels and the new resources are released, except that, if the old channel was a VGCS channel, the old channel shall
be maintained and the uplink shall be set free.
On the network side, lower layer failure occurring on the old channels after the sending of the PDCH ASSIGNMENT
COMMAND message are ignored.
3.4.20
The disconnection of the main signalling link, and of the other links via local end release (layer 2), and the
disconnection of the TCH(s) if any.
The disconnection and the deactivation of previously assigned channels and their release (layer 1).
The complete acquisition of BCCH or PBCCH messages of the target cell.
The RR-network controlled cell change order procedure is always initiated by the network.
3.4.20.1
The network initiates the RR-network controlled cell change order procedure by sending a RR-CELL CHANGE
ORDER message to the mobile station on the main DCCH. The network then starts timer T3119.
When a handover has taken place during dedicated connection, the network shall send a RR-CELL CHANGE ORDER
message to the mobile station in order to establish TBF. In this case the target cell is equal to the old cell.
When sending this message on the network side, and when receiving it on the mobile station side, all transmission of
signalling layer messages except for those RR messages needed for this procedure and for abnormal cases, is suspended
until resuming is indicated. These RR messages can be deduced from section 3.4.3 and 8.5.1 "Radio Resource
management".
Upon receipt of the RR-CELL CHANGE ORDER message, the mobile station initiates, as described in section 3.1.4,
the release of link layer connections, disconnects the physical channels, commands the switching to the identified cell,
performs a complete acquisition of BCCH or PBCCH messages (see GSM 04.60), and obeys the procedures relevant to
the establishment of the Temporary Block Flow. The mobile station starts timer T3134. The mobile station shall obey
the RR-CELL CHANGE ORDER irrespective of whether or not the mobile station has any knowledge of the relative
synchronisation of the target cell to the serving cell.
The RR-CELL CHANGE ORDER message contains:
ETSI
82
The characteristics of the new cell that are necessary to identify it (i.e. BSIC + BCCH frequency);
The RR-CELL CHANGE ORDER does not contain a cipher mode setting IE. Any RR layer ciphering that may have
been applied in dedicated mode shall not be applied to the target TBF or with the target cell.
3.4.20.2
The network regards the procedure as successfully completed when it knows that communication has been established
with that mobile station via the new cell (e.g. the network has received a RLC/MAC Block containing the mobile
stations identity). The network then stops timer T3119.
The mobile station regards the procedure as successfully completed when it has received a response to a (PACKET)
CHANNEL REQUEST message on the new cell which allocates it a resource on the new cell.
3.4.20.3
Abnormal cases
If the RR-CELL CHANGE ORDER message instructs the mobile station to use a frequency that it is not capable of,
then the mobile station shall return a HANDOVER FAILURE message with cause "frequency not implemented", and
the mobile station shall remain on the current channel(s).
On the mobile station side, if timer T3134 times out before a response to the (PACKET) CHANNEL REQUEST
message has been received, or, if an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT message or a PACKET ACCESS
REJECT is received from the new cell, or, if the contention resolution procedure fails on the new cell then the mobile
station shall reactivate the old channels, reconnect the TCHs if any and trigger the establishment of the main signalling
link. It then sends a HANDOVER FAILURE message on the main signalling link and resumes normal operation as if
no handover attempt had occurred. The operational parameters (e.g. ciphering mode) when returning on the old channel
are those applied before the RR-CELL CHANGE ORDER message was received.
When the HANDOVER FAILURE message has been received, the network stops T3119.
If a lower layer failure happens while attempting to connect back to the old channels, the standard rules are applied (cf.
section 3.4.13.2).
On the network side, if timer T3119 elapses before either the mobile station has been recognised on the new cell, or a
HANDOVER FAILURE message is received on the old channels, then the old channels are released, except that, if the
old channel was a VGCS channel, the old channel shall be maintained and the uplink shall be set free.
On the network side, lower layer failures occurring on the old channels after the sending of the RR-CELL CHANGE
ORDER message are ignored.
3.5
The establishment of a temporary block flow (TBF) on a packet data physical channel is supported by procedures on
CCCH when PCCCH is not provided in the cell. The procedures for temporary block flow establishment using CCCH
are only applicable to a mobile station supporting GPRS. The procedures are optional for the network.
These procedures constitute a complement to the corresponding procedures for temporary block flow establishment
using PCCCH, defined in GSM 04.60, and include the procedures using CCCH for packet paging (section 3.5.1), packet
access (section 3.5.2) and packet downlink assignment (section 3.5.3).
3.5.1
The network can initiate the packet paging procedure in order to cause upper layers in the mobile station to respond, see
section 4. The packet paging procedure can only be initiated by the network.
ETSI
3.5.1.1
83
The packet paging procedure is initiated by the RR entity of the network side. It is triggered by a page request from the
MM sublayer, see GSM 04.07.
The network initiates the paging procedure by sending a paging request message on an appropriate paging subchannel
on CCCH or PCCCH. Paging initiation using a paging subchannel on CCCH is used when sending paging information
to a mobile station and PCCCH is not present in the cell.
NOTE 1: There are three types of paging request messages that are applicable:
-
In a PAGING REQUEST message used for the packet paging procedure, the mobile station shall be identified by the PTMSI (GPRS TMSI) or its IMSI. If the mobile station is identified by the P-TMSI, it shall proceed as specified in
section 3.5.1.2.
If the mobile station identified by its IMSI, it shall parse the message for a corresponding Packet Page Indication field:
-
if the Packet Page Indication field indicates a paging procedure for RR connection establishment, or the field
is not present in the message, the mobile station shall proceed as specified in section 3.3.2.2;
if the Packet Page Indication field indicates a packet paging procedure, the mobile station shall proceed as
specified in section 3.5.1.2.
A PAGING REQUEST message may include more than one mobile station identification.
The mobile station in packet idle mode is required to receive and analyse the paging messages and immediate
assignment messages sent on the paging subchannels on CCCH corresponding to the paging groups determined for it in
packet idle mode, as specified in GSM 05.02. These messages contain a page mode information element.
NOTE 2: The possible immediate assignment messages are: the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT, the IMMEDIATE
ASSIGNMENT EXTENDED and the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT messages.
The treatment of page mode information, including the procedure when the mobile station selects a new PCH, and the
procedure if a message in a paging subchannel is not received correctly are defined in section 3.3.2.1.1.
3.5.1.2
On the receipt of a paging request message, the RR sublayer of addressed mobile station indicates the receipt of a
paging request to the MM sublayer, see GSM 04.07;
3.5.2
The packet access procedure using CCCH may be used to establish a temporary block flow to support the transfer of
LLC PDUs in the direction from the mobile station to the network. Establishment using one phase and two phase packet
access, see GSM 04.60, are supported. The two phase packet access is supported by means of the single block packet
access option in this procedure, allowing the transfer of a PACKET RESOURCE REQUEST message to the network.
The single block packet access option in this procedure may also be used by a mobile station in packet idle mode to
transfer an RLC/MAC control message other than the PACKET RESOURCE REQUEST message to the network, see
section 3.5.2.2.
3.5.2.1
The establishment of an uplink temporary block flow may be initiated by the RR entity of the mobile station using the
packet access procedure. The procedure is triggered by a request from upper layers to transfer a LLC PDU, see
GSM 04.07. The request from upper layers specifies radio priority and an RLC mode associated with the packet transfer
or it indicates that the packet to be transferred contains signalling.
Upon such a request,
ETSI
84
if access to the network is allowed (section 3.5.2.1.1), the RR entity of the mobile station initiates the packet
access procedure as defined in section 3.5.2.1.2;
If the request from upper layers indicates signalling, the highest radio priority level shall be used at determination if
access to the network is allowed, and the acknowledged RLC mode shall be used.
3.5.2.1.1
if the mobile station is a member of at least one authorized access class or special access class as defined in
section 3.3.1.1.1, and
if packet access is allowed in the cell for the radio priority level associated with the packet transfer, as indicated
by the PRIORITY_ACCESS_THR parameter broadcast in SI 13 message.
if the cell belongs to one of the allowed LSAs for the mobile station, as indicated on the SIM, in the case where
the mobile station is a LSA only access subscriber.
3.5.2.1.2
The mobile station initiates the packet access procedure by scheduling the sending of CHANNEL REQUEST messages
on RACH and leaving the packet idle mode. In particular, the mobile station shall ignore PAGING REQUEST
messages indicating a packet paging procedure.
A mobile station belonging to GPRS MS class A or B shall continue to monitor its paging subchannel on CCCH for
PAGING REQUEST messages indicating an establishment of RR connection. A mobile station belonging to GPRS MS
class B may abort the packet access procedure at the receipt of a PAGING REQUEST messages indicating an
establishment of RR connection.
The mobile station schedules CHANNEL REQUEST messages on RACH as defined in section 3.3.1.1.2.
The CHANNEL REQUEST messages are sent on RACH and contain the parameters:
-
an establishment cause which indicates packet access, and as applicable, a request for one phase packet access or
single block packet access (section 9.1.8);
a random reference which is drawn randomly from an uniform probability distribution for every new
transmission.
If the requested RLC mode is unacknowledged mode, the mobile station shall request a single block packet access and
attempt a two phase packet access.
If the purpose of the packet access procedure is to send a Page Response, Cell update, for a GPRS Mobility
Management or a GPRS Session Management procedure, (i.e. the access is for Layer 3 signalling only, and not for a
Layer 3 data transfer), the mobile station shall request a one phase packet access.
After sending the first CHANNEL REQUEST message, the mobile station shall start listening to the BCCH; it shall
also listen to the full downlink CCCH timeslot corresponding to its CCCH group.
Having sent the maximum number of CHANNEL REQUEST messages, the mobile station starts timer T3146. At
expiry of timer T3146, the packet access procedure is aborted and a packet access failure is indicated to upper layers.
If the mobile station receives an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message during the packet access procedure indicating
a packet downlink assignment procedure, the mobile station shall abort the packet access procedure and respond to the
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message as specified in section 3.5.3.1.2. The mobile station shall then attempt an
establishment of uplink TBF, using the procedure specified in GSM 04.60 which is applicable in packet transfer mode.
ETSI
3.5.2.1.3
3.5.2.1.3.1
85
On receipt of a CHANNEL REQUEST message indicating a packet access, the network may allocate a temporary flow
identity and assign a packet uplink resource comprising one PDCH for an uplink temporary block flow.
If the establishment cause in the CHANNEL REQUEST message indicates a request for a single block packet access,
the network shall grant only the single block period on the assigned packet uplink resource if the network allocates
resource for the mobile station.
If the establishment cause in the CHANNEL REQUEST message indicates a request for one phase packet access, the
network may grant either a one phase packet access or a single block packet access for the mobile station. If a single
block packet access is granted, it forces the mobile station to perform a two phase packet access.
The packet uplink resource is assigned to the mobile station in an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message sent in
unacknowledged mode on the same CCCH timeslot on which the network has received the CHANNEL REQUEST
message. There is no further restriction on what part of the downlink CCCH timeslot the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
message can be sent. Timer T3141 is started on the network side.
The IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message contains:
-
the information field of the CHANNEL REQUEST message and the frame number of the frame in which the
CHANNEL REQUEST message was received;
If frequency hopping is applied, the network may use the indirect encoding or the direct encoding of the frequency
configuration in the Packet Channel Description information element. If the indirect encoding is used, the mobile
station uses information received in system information or stored from a previous assignment to determine the
frequency parameters, see GSM 04.60. If the direct encoding is used, the mobile station uses the cell allocation defined
for the cell to decode the mobile allocation.
If the indirect encoding is used, the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message may contain a CHANGE_MARK_1 field.
If that is present, the mobile station shall verify the validity of the SI13_CHANGE_MARK associated with the GPRS
mobile allocation to which the message refers, see GSM 04.60. If the CHANGE_MARK_1 field and the
SI13_CHANGE_MARK do not match, the message does not satisfactorily define a PDCH.
If the mobile station receives an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message and the Dedicated mode or TBF information
element indicates that this is the first message in a two-message assignment, the mobile station shall continue to listen
to the full CCCH. The network may send a second IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message to the mobile station within
two multiframe periods following the first IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message, specifying the packet channel
description and, if required, a mobile allocation for the assignment. The two IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT messages in
a two-message assignment shall have the same contents of the Request Reference information elements.
If the mobile station does not receive the second IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT messages in a two-message assignment
within two multiframe periods following the first message, the mobile station shall discard the first IMMEDIATE
ASSIGNMENT message received.
On receipt of an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message or, in case of a two-message assignment, a matching pair of
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT messages corresponding to one of its 3 last CHANNEL REQUEST messages, the
mobile station stops T3146 (if running), stops sending CHANNEL REQUEST messages, and switches to the assigned
PDCH.
The content of the packet uplink assignment construction indicates which type of packet access is granted: one phase
packet access or single block packet access
3.5.2.1.3.2
In the case the one phase packet access is granted, the packet uplink assignment construction contains:
ETSI
86
the polling bit ;- optionally, the timing advance index (see GSM 05.10);
optionally, the TBF starting time (note: TBF starting time is mandatory if medium access method is fixed
allocation).
The medium access method is dynamic allocation or fixed allocation and the RLC mode is acknowledged mode, see
GSM 04.60.
The mobile station shall start timer T3164 and proceed with the contention resolution at one phase access defined in
GSM 04.60.
If the medium access method is fixed allocation, and the number of blocks allocated in the ALLOCATION_BITMAP is
not sufficient to transfer all the RLC/MAC blocks that the MS has to transmit at the time the packet uplink assignment
construction is received, the MS shall request additional resources by sending a PACKET RESOURCE REQUEST on
one of the allocated blocks.
If the timing advance index (TAI) is included in the packet uplink assignment construction, the mobile station shall use
the continuous update timing advance mechanism, see GSM 05.10, using PTCCH in the same timeslot as the assigned
PDCH. If a timing advance index (TAI) field is not included, the continuous update timing advance mechanism shall
not be used.
In case the packet uplink assignment construction contains a TBF starting time and the mobile station receives the
message before the TBF starting time has expired, it shall wait until the frame number indicated by the TBF starting
time before accessing the channel. If the mobile station receives the message after the TBF starting time has expired, it
shall ignore the TBF starting time and may immediately access the channel.
If the Polling bit is set to 1, MS shall send a PACKET CONTROL ACKNOWLEDGEMENT message (see 04.60) on
the assigned PDCH, in the uplink block specified by the TBF Starting Time. In this case the TBF Starting Time is used
both to indicate when the assigned PDCH becomes valid and to specify the uplink block. If the TBF Starting Time is
not present or has expired, the MS shall ignore the polling request.
3.5.2.1.3.3
In the case the single block packet access is granted, the packet uplink resource description contains:
-
If the mobile station receives the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message before the TBF starting time has expired, it
shall wait until the block period indicated by the TBF starting time. The network shall use the TBF starting time to
indicate the first frame number belonging to the single block period granted for packet access. The mobile station may
either use the assigned block period to send a PACKET RESOURCE REQUEST message to initiate the two phase
packet access procedure defined in GSM 04.60, or to send an RLC/MAC control message other than the PACKET
RESOURCE REQUEST message to the network, see section 3.5.2.2.
If the mobile station receives the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message after the TBF starting time has expired, a
failure has occurred.
If a failure occurs and the packet access attempt was due to a request from upper layers to transfer a LLC PDU, a TBF
establishment failure has occurred and the mobile station proceeds as specified in section 3.5.2.1.5. If a failure occurs
and the packet access attempt was due to the sending of an RLC/MAC control message, the packet access is aborted,
the mobile station returns to packet idle mode.
ETSI
3.5.2.1.3.4
87
The network may send to the mobile station an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT message in unacknowledged
mode on the same CCCH timeslot on which the channel request message was received. There is no further restriction
on what part of the downlink CCCH timeslot an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT message can be sent. This
message contains the request reference and a wait indication.
On receipt of an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT message corresponding to one of its 3 last CHANNEL
REQUEST messages, the mobile station stops sending CHANNEL REQUEST messages, starts timer T3142 with the
indicated value, ("wait indication" information element), starts T3146 if it has not already been started, and listens to the
downlink CCCH until T3146 expires. During this time, additional IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT messages
are ignored, but any immediate assignment corresponding to any other of its 3 last CHANNEL REQUEST messages
make the mobile station follow the procedure in section 3.5.2.1.3.1. If no such immediate assignment is received, the
mobile station returns to packet idle mode and notify higher layers (TBF establishment failure).
If the mobile station has received responses from the network on all, or in case more than 3 were sent the last 3, of its
CHANNEL REQUEST messages, it shall immediately return to packet idle mode and notify higher layers.
The mobile station is not allowed to make a new attempt for packet access in the same cell until T3142 expires, but may
attempt packet access in an other cell after successful cell reselection for radio conditions reasons (see GSM 05.08). The
value of the wait indication (i.e. T3142) relates to the cell from which it was received.
The mobile station may initiate RR connection establishment in the same cell before T3142 has expired, see section
3.3.1.1.3.2.
3.5.2.1.4
The one phase packet access procedure is completed at a successful contention resolution. The mobile station has
entered the packet transfer mode. Timer T3141 is stopped on the network side. Timer T3164 is stopped on the mobile
station side.
3.5.2.1.5
Abnormal cases
If a failure occurs on the mobile station side before a successful contention resolution procedure is completed, the
allocated temporary block flow is released; the mobile station returns to packet idle mode, upper layers are notified
(TBF establishment failure), transactions in progress are aborted:
-
If a TLLI mismatch has occurred during the contention resolution procedure, and the repetition of the packet
access has been repeated the maximum number of times as defined in GSM 04.60, a TBF establishment failure
has occurred.
If the information available in the mobile station, after the reception of an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
message or the second IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message of a two-message assignment, does not
satisfactorily define a PDCH, a TBF establishment failure has occurred.
If the mobile allocation indexes frequencies in more than one frequency band then a TBF establishment failure
has occurred.
If an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message indicates a PDCH in a non-supported frequency band then a TBF
establishment failure has occurred.
On the network side, if timer T3141 elapses before a successful contention resolution procedure is completed, the newly
allocated temporary block flow is released as specified in GSM 04.60 and the packet access is forgotten.
3.5.2.2
The sending of an RLC/MAC control message other than the PACKET RESOURCE REQUEST message from a
mobile station in packet idle mode to the network may be initiated by the RR entity on the mobile station side using the
packet access procedure. If access to the network is allowed (section 3.5.2.1.1), the packet access is done according to
the procedures defined in sections 3.5.2.1.2 and 3.5.2.1.3, using the single block packet access option defined in section
3.5.2.1.3.3.
ETSI
88
Further action depends on the RLC/MAC control message sent by the mobile station, see GSM 04.60. Unless otherwise
indicated by the RLC/MAC control message, the mobile station remains in packet idle mode.
3.5.3
The packet downlink assignment procedure using CCCH may be used to establish a temporary block flow to support
the transfer of LLC PDUs in the direction from the network to the mobile station.
This procedure may also be used to assign a single downlink block on a PDCH to support the transfer of an RLC/MAC
control message from the network to a mobile station in packet idle mode, see 3.5.3.2.
3.5.3.1
The establishment of a downlink temporary block flow may be initiated by the RR entity on the network side using the
packet downlink assignment procedure. The procedure is triggered by a request from upper layers to transfer a LLC
PDU, see GSM 04.07. The request from upper layers specifies a QoS profile, an RLC mode, DRX parameters and a MS
classmark associated with the packet transfer.
Upon such a request, the network shall determine whether the mobile station is in packet idle mode or packet transfer
mode. The packet downlink assignment procedure using CCCH is applicable when the mobile station is in packet idle
mode and when there is no PCCCH present in the cell.
The network may allocate a temporary flow identity and assign a packet downlink resource comprising one PDCH for a
downlink temporary block flow.
3.5.3.1.1
Spare
3.5.3.1.2
The network initiates the packet downlink assignment procedure by sending an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message
in unacknowledged mode on the CCCH timeslot corresponding to CCCH group the mobile station belongs to. If the
mobile station does not apply DRX, there is no further restriction on what part of the downlink CCCH timeslot an
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message can be sent. If the mobile station applies DRX, the message shall be sent in a
CCCH block corresponding to a paging group determined for the mobile station in packet idle mode, see GSM 05.02.
The IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message contains:
-
The contents of the packet downlink construction determines the further action. At the establishment of a downlink
temporary block flow, the packet downlink construction shall contain:
-
the TLLI;
If frequency hopping is applied, the network may use the indirect encoding or the direct encoding of the frequency
configuration in the Packet Channel Description information element. If the indirect encoding is used, the mobile
ETSI
89
station uses information received in system information or stored from a previous assignment to determine the
frequency parameters, see GSM 04.60. If the direct encoding is used, the mobile station uses the cell allocation defined
for the cell to decode the mobile allocation.
If the indirect encoding is used, the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message may contain a CHANGE_MARK_1 field.
If that is present, the mobile station shall verify the validity of the SI change mark associated with the GPRS mobile
allocation to which the message refers, see GSM 04.60. If the CHANGE_MARK_1 field and the SI change mark do not
match, the message does not satisfactorily define a PDCH.
If the mobile station receives an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message and the Dedicated mode or TBF information
element indicates that this is the first message in a two-message assignment, the mobile station shall start listen to the
full CCCH. The network may send a second IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message to the mobile station within two
multiframe periods following the first IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message, specifying the packet channel
description and, if required, a mobile allocation for the assignment. The two IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT messages in
a two-message assignment shall have the same contents of the Request Reference information elements.
If the mobile station was operating in DRX mode when it received the first message of a two-message assignment, the
network shall not send the second IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message within the two block periods immediately
following the first message.
If the mobile station does not receive the second IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT messages in a two-message assignment
within two multiframe periods following the first message, the mobile station shall discard the first IMMEDIATE
ASSIGNMENT message received. After the two multiframe periods following the first message, the mobile station may
resume to DRX mode.
On receipt of an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message or, in case of a two-message assignment, a matching pair of
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT messages, the mobile station stops monitoring downlink CCCH and switches to the
assigned PDCH and starts listening for downlink RLC/MAC blocks identified by the assigned TFI; it starts timer
T3190.
The IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message may indicate a TBF starting time. If the mobile station receives the
message before the TBF starting time has expired, it shall wait until the frame number indicated by the TBF starting
time, start timer T3190 and switch to the assigned PDCH. If the mobile station receives the message after the TBF
starting time has expired, it shall ignore the indicated TBF starting time, immediately start timer T3190 and switch to
the assigned PDCH.
If the Polling bit is set to 1, MS shall send a PACKET CONTROL ACKNOWLEDGEMENT message (see 04.60) on
the assigned PDCH, in the uplink block specified by the TBF Starting Time. In this case the TBF Starting Time is used
both to indicate when the assigned PDCH becomes valid and to specify the uplink block. If the TBF Starting Time is
not present or has expired, the MS shall ignore the polling request.
An IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message may indicate a timing advance index (TAI) in the packet timing advance
IE. The mobile station shall then use the continuous update timing advance mechanism, see GSM 05.10, using PTCCH
in the same timeslot as the assigned PDCH. If there is no indication of a timing advance index, the continuous update
timing advance mechanism shall not be used.
The TA_VALID flag indicates if the value of the Timing Advance IE is valid or not.
If the network does not have a valid timing advance value for the mobile station to include in the IMMEDIATE
ASSIGNMENT message, the network shall use the procedures defined in GSM 04.60 on the assigned TBF, or the
polling mechanism defined in the above paragraph if the PACKET CONTROL ACKNOWLEDGEMENT format is set
to four access bursts, to obtain a timing advance value and to update the initially assigned timing advance value before
the mobile station is required to transmit other than access burst on the newly assigned channel.
3.5.3.1.3
After having sent the packet downlink assignment, the network starts sending downlink RLC/MAC blocks on the
assigned packet downlink resource and the packet downlink assignment procedure is completed at the network side.
On the mobile station side, the procedure is completed when the mobile station receives an RLC/MAC block identified
by the assigned temporary flow identity. The mobile station stops timer T3190. The mobile station has entered packet
transfer mode.
ETSI
3.5.3.1.4
90
Abnormal cases
If a failure occurs on the mobile station side before the packet downlink assignment procedure is completed (TBF
establishment failure), the temporary block flow is released; the mobile station returns to packet idle mode:
-
If the mobile station does not receive a RLC/MAC block on the assigned PDCHs before timer T3190 expires,
then a TBF establishment failure has occurred.
If the information available in the mobile station, after the reception of an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
message or the second IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message of a two-message assignment, does not
satisfactorily define a PDCH, then a TBF establishment failure has occurred.
If the mobile allocation in the frequency parameters indexes frequencies in more than one frequency band, then a
TBF establishment failure has occurred.
If an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message indicates a PDCH in a non-supported frequency band, then a TBF
establishment failure has occurred.
3.5.3.2
The sending of an RLC/MAC control message to a mobile station in packet idle mode may be initiated by the RR entity
on network side using the packet downlink assignment procedure. The procedure is used to assign a single downlink
block on a PDCH for the transfer of the RLC/MAC control message.
The single downlink block assignment is done according to the procedure defined in 3.5.3.1.2, with the following
exceptions:
The packet downlink construction in the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message shall contain only:
-
If the mobile station receives the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message before the TBF starting time has expired, it
shall wait until the frame number indicated by the TBF starting time. The network shall use the TBF starting time to
indicate the first frame number belonging to the single block period assigned to the mobile station. The mobile station
shall switch to the assigned PDCH and attempt to decode an RLC/MAC control message in the assigned downlink
block. Further action depends on the RLC/MAC control message sent by the network, see GSM 04.60. Unless
otherwise indicated by the RLC/MAC control message, the mobile station remains in packet idle mode. If the mobile
station remains in packet idle mode, it shall continue to monitor downlink CCCH once the block period indicated by the
TBF starting time has passed.
If the mobile station fails to decode or does not receive an RLC/MAC control message in the assigned downlink block,
it shall remain in packet idle mode and continue to monitor downlink CCCH once the block period indicated by the
TBF starting time has passed.
If the mobile station receives the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message after the TBF starting time has expired, it
shall ignore the assignment.
If a failure occurs on the mobile station side due to any other reason, the mobile station shall ignore the assignment.
4.1
General
This section describes the procedures used for mobility management for non-GPRS services and for GPRS-services at
the radio interface (Reference Point Um).
The main function of the Mobility Management sublayer is to support the mobility of user terminals, such as informing
the network of its present location and providing user identity confidentiality.
ETSI
91
A further function of the MM sublayer is to provide connection management services to the different entities of the
upper Connection Management (CM) sublayer (see GSM 04.07).
There are two sets of procedures defined in this chapter:
-
MM procedures for non-GPRS services (performed by the MM entity of the MM sublayer); and
GMM procedures for GPRS services (performed by the GMM entity and GMM-AA entity of the MM sublayer),
see GSM 04.07 [20].
All the MM procedures described in this section can only be performed if a RR connection has been established
between the MS and the network. Else, the MM sublayer has to initiate the establishment of a RR connection according
to the procedures specified in section 3.3. The GMM procedures described in this section, use services provided by the
RR sublayer without prior RR connection establishment.
GMM procedures are mandatory and applicable only for GPRS MSs and networks supporting those MSs. For GPRS
MSs which are IMSI attached for both GPRS and non-GPRS services, some MM procedures are replaced by GMM
combined procedures provided that the network operates in network operation mode I, i.e. is supporting combined
GMM procedures. GMM combined procedures are not applicable for the GPRS MS operation mode C but are
mandatory for the GPRS MS operation modes A and B and networks supporting network operation mode I, see
GSM 03.60.
4.1.1
4.1.1.1
Depending on how they can be initiated, three types of MM procedures can be distinguished:
1) MM common procedures:
A MM common procedure can always be initiated whilst a RR connection exists. The procedures belonging to
this type are:
Initiated by the network:
-
authentication procedure;
identification procedure;
MM information procedure;
abort procedure.
However, abort procedure is used only if an MM connection is being established or has already been
established i.e. not during MM specific procedures or during IMSI detach procedure, see section 4.3.5.
ETSI
92
These procedures are used to establish, maintain and release a MM connection between the mobile station and the
network, over which an entity of the upper CM layer can exchange information with its peer. A MM connection
establishment can only be performed if no MM specific procedure is running. More than one MM connection may be
active at the same time. Depending on how they can be initiated, two types of GMM procedures can be distinguished:
i) GMM common procedures:
Initiated by the network when a GMM context has been established:
-
GPRS identification;
GPRS information.
GPRS detach.
Initiated by the MS and used to attach or detach the IMSI in the network for GPRS services and/or nonGPRS services and to establish or release a GMM context:
-
4.1.1.2
4.1.1.2.1
If the network operates in mode I, GPRS MSs that operate in mode A or B and wish to be or are simultaneously IMSI
attached for GPRS and non-GPRS services, shall use the combined GPRS attach and the combined and periodic routing
area updating procedures instead of the corresponding MM specific procedures IMSI attach and normal and periodic
location area updating.
NOTE:
A GPRS MS operating in mode A or B in a network that operates in mode I, shall perform the combined
GPRS attach or routing area update procedure regardless the value of the ATT flag.
If a GPRS MS is operating in mode A or B in a network that operates in mode I the IMSI detach shall be performed by
the GMM using the combined GPRS detach procedure
NOTE:
A GPRS MS operating in mode A or B in a network that operates in mode I, shall perform the combined
GPRS detach procedure regardless the value of the ATT flag.
A GPRS MS operating in mode A or B in network that operates in mode I, uses the combined GMM specific
procedures in place of the MM specific procedures, so all conditions describing when to trigger a MM specific
procedure listed in subsections 4.3 and 4.4 shall not apply.
A GPRS MS operating in mode A or B in a network that operates in mode I should not use any MM timers relating to
MM specific procedures, (e.g T3210, T3211, T3212, T3213) except in some error and abnormal cases. If the MM
timers are already running, the MS should not react on the expiration of the timers.
NOTE:
Whenever GMM performs a combined GMM procedure, a GPRS MS enters the MM state MM
LOCATION UPDATING PENDING in order to prevent the MM to perform a location update procedure.
ETSI
93
If the authentication procedure is performed by MM and the authentication is rejected by the network (i.e upon receive
of AUTHENTICATION REJECT), the MS shall in addition set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT
ALLOWED and shall, if available, delete the P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and GPRS ciphering key sequence
number stored. The SIM shall be considered as invalid for GPRS and non-GPRS services until switching off or the SIM
is removed. The MS shall abort any GMM procedure and shall enter state GMM-DEREGISTERED.
4.1.1.2.2
If the network operates in mode II or III, a GPRS MSs that operate in mode A or B and wish to be or are simultaneously
IMSI attached for GPRS and non-GPRS services, shall use the MM specific procedures listed in subsections 4.3 and 4.4
and the GMM specific procedures listed in subsections 4.7.3, 4.7.4 and 4.7.5. The applicability of periodic location
updating is further specified in section 4.4.2 and the periodic routing area updating is specified in section 4.7.2.2.
If the authentication procedure is performed by MM and the authentication is rejected by the network (i.e upon receive
of AUTHENTICATION REJECT), the MS shall in addition set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT
ALLOWED and shall, if available, delete the P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and GPRS ciphering key sequence
number stored. The SIM shall be considered as invalid for GPRS and non-GPRS services until switching off or the SIM
is removed. The MS shall abort any GMM procedure and shall enter state GMM-DEREGISTERED.
4.1.2
MM sublayer states
The description of the states for the MM sublayer is organized as follows. The main states for the MS side, related to
the procedures, are described in section 4.1.2.1.1. The MM IDLE state is subdivided in substates for the description of
the behaviour in idle mode (section 4.1.2.1.2). This behaviour depends on an update status, described in 4.1.2.2. The
states for the network side are described in 4.1.2.3.
4.1.2.1
In this section, the possible states for the MM sublayer in the mobile station is described. In figure 4.1/GSM 04.08 an
overview of the MM sublayer protocol is given.
4.1.2.1.1
Main states
0 NULL
The mobile station is inactive (e.g. power down). Important parameters are stored. Only manual action by the
user may transfer the MM sublayer to another state.
3 LOCATION UPDATING INITIATED
A location updating procedure has been started and the MM awaits a response from the network. The timer
T3210 is running.
5 WAIT FOR OUTGOING MM CONNECTION
The MM connection establishment has been started, and the MM awaits a response from the network. The
timer T3230 is running.
6 MM CONNECTION ACTIVE
The MM sublayer has a RR connection to its peer entity on the network side. One or more MM connections
are active.
7 IMSI DETACH INITIATED
The IMSI detach procedure has been started. The timer T3220 is running.
8 PROCESS CM SERVICE PROMPT
The MM sublayer has a RR connection to its peer entity on the network side. The Mobile Station has
received a CM SERVICE PROMPT message but has not yet responded $(CCBS)$.
9 WAIT FOR NETWORK COMMAND
ETSI
94
The MM sublayer has a RR connection to its peer entity in the network, but no MM connection is
established. The mobile station is passive, awaiting further commands from the network. The timer T3240
may be running.
10 LOCATION UPDATE REJECTED
A location updating procedure has been rejected and RR connection release is awaited. The timer T3240 is
running.
ETSI
ETSI
Send cm service
request
Indicate
MM connection
Last connection
released
CM reestablishment accepted
First message
received
17
WAIT FOR
REESTABLISH
9
WAIT FOR NETWORK
COMMAND
attach allowed
MS deactivated and
update reject
3
Location update
LOCATION UPDATING
accept
INITIATED
15
WAIT FOR
RR CONNECTION
(IMSI DETACH)
Request
RR connection
Send location
update request
RR connection
established
13
WAIT FOR
RR CONNECTION
(LOCATION UPDATE)
Location
10
LOCATION UPDATE
REJECTED
update SIM
RR connection
established
7
IMSI DETACH
INITIATED
Send IMSI
RR connection detach
released
RR connection
established
(paging)
RR connection released
or T3212/T3211 timeout
Request
RR connection
Attach or Location
update needed
18
WAIT FOR
RR ACTIVE
RR connection
released
MS deactivated
and attach
allowed
19
MM-IDLE
Activate RR
SIM
inserted
MS
activated
MS deactivated
and attach NOT
allowed
Update SIM
NULL
95
6
MM CONNECTION
ACTIVE
and reestablish
Send cm
reestablish
request
Reestablish
not possible
no reestablish
info !!
system
request
low layer
failure
Delete
MM-connection
Request
RR connection
MM connection
request
Low layer failure
Confirm
MM connection
OUTGOING
WAIT FOR
ADDITIONAL
20
States 6,
20
States 3, 5, 9,
10, 13, 14, 15
MM CONNECTION
Ciphering started
or CM service
CM service
accept
accept
5
WAIT FOR
OUTGOING
MM CONNECTION
Send cm service
request
RR connection
established
14
WAIT FOR
RR CONNECTION
(MM CONNECTION)
96
RR Connection
established
Uplink
release
RR gone to
Group Transmit
mode
6
MM CONNECTION
ACTIVE
Uplink
access
rejected
RR gone to
Dedicated
mode
Uplink
access
requested
19
MM-IDLE
RR connection
released, gone
to Group Receive
mode
RR connection
released, gone
to group receive
Mode
5
WAIT FOR
OUTGOING
MM CONNECTION
Send CM service
request
or
Notification Response
ETSI
97
4.1.2.1.2
For the description of the behaviour of the MS the MM IDLE state is subdivided in several substates, also called the
service states. The service state pertains to the whole MS (ME alone if no SIM is inserted, or ME plus SIM.). The
service state depends on the update status (see 4.1.2.2) and on the selected cell.
19.1 NORMAL SERVICE
Valid subscriber data are available, update status is U1, a cell is selected that belongs to the LA where the
subscriber is registered.
In this state, all requests from the CM layers are treated normally.
19.2 ATTEMPTING TO UPDATE
Valid subscriber data are available, update status is U2 and a cell is selected. Requests from upper layers are
accepted. Emergency call requests are treated normally, otherwise the request triggers first a location
updating attempt in the selected cell, and then triggers the needed procedure only in case of successful
location updating, otherwise the request is rejected.
19.3 LIMITED SERVICE
Valid subscriber data are available, update status is U3, and a cell is selected, which is known not to be able
to provide normal service. Only emergency services are offered.
ETSI
98
19.4 NO IMSI
No valid subscriber data (no SIM, or the SIM is not considered valid by the ME), and a cell is selected. Only
emergency services are offered.
19.5 NO CELL AVAILABLE
No cell can be selected. This state is entered after a first intensive search failed (state 19.7). Cells are
searched at a low rhythm. No services are offered.
19.6 LOCATION UPDATE NEEDED
Valid subscriber data are available, and for some reason a location updating must be done as soon as possible
(for instance update status is U1 but the selected cell is not in the registered LA, or the timer has expired, ...).
This state is usually of no duration, but can last, e.g., in the case of access class blocking.
19.7 PLMN SEARCH
The mobile station is searching for PLMNs, and the conditions for state 19.8 are not met. This state is ended
when either a cell is selected (the new state is 19.1, 19.3 or 19.6), or when it is concluded that no cell is
available for the moment (the new state is 19.5).
19.8 PLMN SEARCH, NORMAL SERVICE
Valid subscriber data are available, update status is U1, a cell is selected which belongs to the LA where the
subscriber is registered, and the mobile station is searching for PLMNs. This state is ended when either a cell
is selected (the new state is 19.1, 19.3 or 19.6), or when it is concluded that no cell is available for the
moment (the new state is 19.5).
19.9 RECEIVING GROUP CALL (NORMAL SERVICE)
Only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening. Valid subscriber data are
available, update status is U1, a VGCS channel or VBS channel is received in a cell that belongs to the LA
where the subscriber is registered.
In this state, only requests from the GCC or BCC layers are treated.
19.10 RECEIVING GROUP CALL (LIMITED SERVICE)
Only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening. Valid subscriber data are
available, update status is U3, a VGCS channel or VBS channel is received in a cell which is known not to be
able to provide normal service.
In this state, only requests from the GCC or BCC layers for the reception of VGCS or VBS calls are treated
and group call emergency services are offered.
4.1.2.2
In parallel with the sublayer states described in section 4.1.2.1 and which control the MM sublayer protocol, an update
status exists.
The update status pertains to a specific subscriber embodied by a SIM. This status is defined even when the subscriber
is not activated (SIM removed or connected to a switched-off ME). It is stored in a non volatile memory in the SIM.
The update status is changed only as a result of a location updating procedure attempt (with the exception of an
authentication failure and of some cases of CM service rejection). In some cases, the update status is changed as a result
of a GPRS attach, GPRS routing area update, or network initiated GPRS detach procedure.
U1 UPDATED
The last location updating attempt was successful (correct procedure outcome, and the answer was
acceptance from the network). With this status, the SIM contains also the LAI of the LA where the subscriber
is registered, and possibly valid TMSI, ciphering key and ciphering key sequence number. The "Location
update status" stored on the SIM shall be "updated".
ETSI
99
U2 NOT UPDATED
The last location updating attempt made failed procedurally (no significant answer was received from the
network, including the cases of failures or congestion inside the network).
For this status, the SIM does not contain any valid LAI, TMSI, ciphering key or ciphering key sequence
number. For compatibility reasons, all these fields must be set to the "deleted" value at the moment the status
is set to NOT UPDATED. However the presence of other values shall not be considered an error by the
mobile station. The "Location update status" stored on the SIM shall be "not updated".
U3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED
The last location updating attempt run correctly, but the answer from the network was negative (because of
roaming or subscription restrictions).
For this status, the SIM does not contain any valid LAI, TMSI, ciphering key or ciphering key sequence
number. For compatibility reasons, all these fields must be set to the "deleted" value at the moment the status
is set to ROAMING NOT ALLOWED. However the presence of other values shall not be considered an
error by the mobile station. The "Location update status" stored on the SIM shall be "Location Area not
allowed".
4.1.2.3
1. IDLE
The MM sublayer is not active except possibly when the RR sublayer is in Group Receive mode.
2. WAIT FOR RR CONNECTION
The MM sublayer has received a request for MM connection establishment from the CM layer. A RR
connection to the mobile station is requested from the RR sublayer (i.e. paging is performed).
3. MM CONNECTION ACTIVE
The MM sublayer has a RR connection to a mobile station. One or more MM connections are active.
4. IDENTIFICATION INITIATED
The identification procedure has been started by the network. The timer T3270 is running.
5. AUTHENTICATION INITIATED
The authentication procedure has been started by the network. The timer T3260 is running.
6. TMSI REALLOCATION INITIATED
The TMSI reallocation procedure has been started by the network. The timer T3250 is running.
7. CIPHERING MODE INITIATED
The cipher mode setting procedure has been requested to the RR sublayer.
8a. WAIT FOR MOBILE ORIGINATED MM CONNECTION
A CM SERVICE REQUEST message is received and processed, and the MM sublayer awaits the "opening
message" of the MM connection.
8b. WAIT FOR NETWORK ORIGINATED MM CONNECTION
A CM SERVICE PROMPT message has been sent by the network and the MM sublayer awaits the "opening
message" of the MM connection $(CCBS)$.
9. WAIT FOR REESTABLISHMENT
The RR connection to a mobile station with one or more active MM connection has been lost. The network
awaits a possible re-establishment request from the mobile station.
ETSI
100
4.1.3
In this section, the GMM protocol of the MS and the network are described by means of two different state machines. In
section 4.1.3.1, the states of the GMM entity in the MS are introduced. The behaviour of the MS depends on a GPRS
update status that is described in section 4.1.3.2. The states for the network side are described in section 4.1.3.3.
4.1.3.1
In this section, the possible GMM states are described of a GMM entity in the mobile station. Section 4.1.3.1.1
summarises the main states of a GMM entity, see figure 4.1b/GSM 04.08. The substates that have been defined are
described in section 4.1.3.1.2 and section 4.1.3.1.3.
However, it should be noted that this section does not include a description of the detailed behaviour of the MS in the
single states and does not cover abnormal cases. Thus, figure 4.1b/GSM 04.08 is rather intended to give an overview of
the state transitions than to be a complete state transition diagram. A detailed description of the behaviour of the MS is
given in section 4.2. Especially, with respect to the behaviour of the MS in abnormal cases it is referred to section 4.7.
4.1.3.1.1
4.1.3.1.1.1
Main states
GMM-NULL
The GPRS capability is disabled in the MS. No GPRS mobility management function shall be performed in this state.
4.1.3.1.1.2
GMM-DEREGISTERED
The GPRS capability has been enabled in the MS, but no GMM context has been established. In this state, the MS may
establish a GMM context by starting the GPRS attach or combined GPRS attach procedure.
4.1.3.1.1.3
GMM-REGISTERED-INITIATED
A GPRS attach or combined GPRS attach procedure has been started and the MS is awaiting a response from the
network.
ETSI
4.1.3.1.1.4
101
GMM-REGISTERED
A GMM context has been established, i.e. the GPRS attach or combined GPRS attach procedure has been successfully
performed. In this state, the MS may activate PDP contexts, may send and receive user data and signalling information
and may reply to a page request. Furthermore, cell and routing area updating are performed.
4.1.3.1.1.5
GMM-DEREGISTERED-INITIATED
The MS has requested release of the GMM context by starting the GPRS detach or combined GPRS detach procedure.
This state is only entered if the MS is not being switched off at detach request.
4.1.3.1.1.6
GMM-ROUTING-AREA-UPDATING-INITIATED
A routing area updating procedure has been started and the MS is awaiting a response from the network.
4.1.3.1.2
The GMM-DEREGISTERED state is subdivided into several substates as explained below. The substates pertain to the
whole MS (ME alone if no SIM is inserted, or ME plus SIM). The selection of the appropriate substate depends on the
GPRS update status, see section 4.1.3.2, and on the selected cell.
4.1.3.1.2.1
GMM-DEREGISTERED.NORMAL-SERVICE
Valid subscriber data is available, the GPRS update status is GU1 or GU2, a cell has been selected. In this state, a
request for GPRS attach is performed using the stored temporary mobile subscriber identity for GPRS (P-TMSI),
routing area identification (RAI) and GPRS ciphering key sequence number in case of GU1. If the GPRS update status
is GU2, the IMSI shall be used to attach for GPRS services.
4.1.3.1.2.2
GMM-DEREGISTERED.LIMITED-SERVICE
Valid subscriber data is available, GPRS update status is GU3, and a cell is selected, which is known not to be able to
provide normal service.
4.1.3.1.2.3
GMM-DEREGISTERED.ATTACH-NEEDED
Valid subscriber data is available and for some reason a GPRS attach must be performed as soon as possible. This state
is usually of no duration, but can last, e.g. if the access class is blocked.
4.1.3.1.2.4
GMM-DEREGISTERED.ATTEMPTING-TO-ATTACH
The GPRS update status is GU2, a cell is selected, a previous GPRS attach was rejected. The execution of further attach
procedures depends on the GPRS attach attempt counter. No GMM procedure except GPRS attach shall be initiated by
the MS in this substate.
4.1.3.1.2.5
GMM-DEREGISTERED.NO-IMSI
No valid subscriber data is available (no SIM, or the SIM is not considered valid by the ME) and a cell has been
selected.
4.1.3.1.2.6
GMM-DEREGISTERED.NO-CELL-AVAILABLE
No cell can be selected. This substate is entered after a first intensive search failed (substate PLMN SEARCH). Cells
are searched for at a low rhythm. No services are offered.
4.1.3.1.2.7
GMM-DEREGISTERED.PLMN-SEARCH
The mobile station is searching for PLMNs. This substate is left either when a cell has been selected (the new substate
is NORMAL-SERVICE or LIMITED-SERVICE) or when it has been concluded that no cell is available at the moment
(the new substate is NO-CELL-AVAILABLE).
ETSI
4.1.3.1.2.8
102
GMM-DEREGISTERED.SUSPENDED
The MS shall enter this substate when entering dedicated mode and the MS limitations make it unable to communicate
on GPRS channels. The MS shall leave this substate when leaving dedicated mode.
4.1.3.1.3
The state GMM-REGISTERED is subdivided into several substate as explained below. The substates pertain to the
whole MS (ME alone if no SIM is inserted, or ME plus SIM.).
4.1.3.1.3.1
GMM-REGISTERED.NORMAL-SERVICE
GMM-REGISTERED.SUSPENDED
The MS shall enter this substate when entering dedicated mode and when the MS limitations makes it unable to
communicate on GPRS channels... In this substate, no user data should be sent and no signalling information shall be
sent. The MS shall leave this substate when leaving dedicated mode.
4.1.3.1.3.3
GMM-REGISTERED.UPDATE-NEEDED
The MS has to perform a routing area updating procedure, but its access class is not allowed in the cell. The procedure
will be initiated as soon as access is granted (this might be due to a cell-reselection or due to change of the access class
of the current cell). No GMM procedure except routing area updating shall be initiated by the MS in this substate. In
this substate, no user data and no signalling information shall be sent.
4.1.3.1.3.4
GMM-REGISTERED.ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE
A routing area updating procedure failed due to a missing response from the network. The MS retries the procedure
controlled by timers and a GPRS attempt counter. No GMM procedure except routing area updating shall be initiated by
the MS in this substate. No data shall be sent or received.
4.1.3.1.3.5
GMM-REGISTERED.NO-CELL-AVAILABLE
GPRS coverage has been lost. In this substate, the MS shall not initiate any GMM procedures except of cell (and
PLMN) reselection.
ETSI
103
GMM-ROUTINGAREA-UPDATINGINITIATED
GMM-NULL
GMMDEREGISTEREDINITIATED
- enable
GPRS mode
- RAU accepted
- RAU failed
- DETACH accepted
- Lower layer failure
- disable
GPRS mode
- DETACH requested
(not power off)
- RAU rejected
- Network init. DETACH requested
- implicit DETACH
GMMDEREGISTERED
- ATTACH
requested
DETACH requested
(power off)
- RAU
requested
GMMREGISTERED
- ATTACH rejected
- Network init. DETACH requested
- Lower layer failure
Any state
- ATTACH
accepted
GMMREGISTEREDINITIATED
GMM-REGISTERED.LIMITED-SERVICE
A cell is selected, which is known not to be able to provide normal service. The MS will remain in this sub-state until a
cell is selected which is able to provide normal service.
4.1.3.1.3.7
GMM-REGISTERED.ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE-MM
A combined routing area updating procedure or a combined GPRS attach procedure was successful for GPRS services
only. The MS retries the procedure controlled by timers and a GPRS attempt counter. User data and signalling
information may be sent and received.
4.1.3.1.3.8
GMM-REGISTERED.IMSI-DETACH-INITIATED
The MS performs a combined GPRS detach procedure for non-GPRS services only (detach type "IMSI Detach"). This
state is entered if the MS is attached for GPRS and non-GPRS services in a network that operates in network mode I
and wants to detach for non-GPRS services only. User data and signalling information may be sent and received.
4.1.3.2
In addition to the GMM sublayer states described so far, a GPRS update status exists.
The GPRS update status pertains to a specific subscriber embodied by a SIM. This status is defined even when the
subscriber is not activated (SIM removed or connected to a switched off ME). It is stored in a non volatile memory in
the SIM. The GPRS update status is changed only after execution of a GPRS attach, network initiated GPRS detach,
authentication procedure, or routing area updating procedure.
ETSI
104
GU1: UPDATED
The last GPRS attach or routing area updating attempt was successful (correct procedure outcome, and the
answer was accepted by the network). The SIM contains the RAI of the routing area (RA) to which the
subscriber was attached, and possibly a valid P-TMSI, GPRS ciphering key and GPRS ciphering key sequence
number.
GU2: NOT UPDATED
The last GPRS attach or routing area updating attempt failed procedurally, i.e. no response was received from
the network. This includes the cases of failures or congestion inside the network.
In this case, the SIM may contain the RAI of the routing area (RA) to which the subscriber was attached, and
possibly also a valid P-TMSI, GPRS ciphering key and GPRS ciphering key sequence number. For compatibility
reasons, all these fields shall be set to the "deleted" value if the RAI is deleted. However, the presence of other
values shall not be considered an error by the MS.
GU3: ROAMING NOT ALLOWED
The last GPRS attach or routing area updating attempt was correctly performed, but the answer from the network
was negative (because of roaming or subscription restrictions).
For this status, the SIM does not contain any valid RAI, P-TMSI, GPRS ciphering key or GPRS ciphering key
sequence number. For compatibility reasons, all these fields must be set to the value "deleted" at the moment the
status is set to ROAMING NOT ALLOWED. However, the presence of other values shall not be considered an
error by the MS.
4.1.3.3
In this subsection, the possible states are described for the GMM on the network side. Section 4.1.3.3.1 summarises the
main states. The corresponding substates are described in section 4.1.3.3.2.
However, it should be noted that this section does not include a description of the detailed behaviour of the network in
the single states and does not cover abnormal cases. Thus, figure 4.1c/GSM 04.08 is rather intended to give an overview
of the state transitions than to be a complete state transition diagram. A detailed description of the behaviour of the MS
is given in section 4.2. Especially, with respect to the behaviour of the MS in abnormal cases it is referred to section 4.7.
4.1.3.3.1
4.1.3.3.1.1
Main States
GMM-DEREGISTERED
The network has no GMM context or the GMM context is marked as detached, the MS is detached. In this state, the
network may answer to a GPRS attach or combined GPRS attach procedure initiated by the MS.
4.1.3.3.1.2
GMM-COMMON-PROCEDURE-INITIATED
A common GMM procedure, as defined in section 4.1.1, has been started. The network is awaiting the answer from the
MS.
4.1.3.3.1.3
GMM-REGISTERED
The GMM context has been established and the GPRS attach procedure has been successfully performed.
4.1.3.3.1.4
GMM-DEREGISTERED-INITIATED
The network has started a GPRS detach procedure and is awaiting the answer from the MS.
ETSI
105
GMMDE-REGISTEREDINITIATED
- DETACH accepted
- Lower layer failure
GMMDE-REGISTERED
- Network initiated
DETACH requested
- MS initiated
DETACH requested
RAU rejected
implicit DETACH
GMMREGISTERED
- ATTACH procedure
successful
- COMMON procedure
requested
- COMMON procedure
requested
- COMMON procedure
failed
- Lower layer failure
- COMMON procedure
successful
- ATTACH procedure
successful
GMM-COMMONPROCEDURE-INITIATED
4.1.3.3.2
GMM-REGISTERED.NORMAL-SERVICE
GMM-REGISTERED.SUSPENDED
In this substate, the lower layers shall be prevented of sending user data or signalling information.
4.2
In this section, the detailed behaviour of the MS in the main states MM IDLE, GMM-DEREGISTERED and GMMREGISTERED is described. Sections 4.2.1 to 4.2.3 refer to the state MM IDLE, whereas section 4.2.4 and section 4.2.5
refer to the states GMM-DEREGISTERED and GMM-REGISTERED, respectively.
The MM IDLE state is entered when none of the MM procedures are running and no RR connection exists. It is left
when one of the MM procedures are triggered or a RR connection is established.
The specific behaviour in the MM IDLE state depends on the service state of the mobile station as described in section
4.1.2.1.2. The service state depends in particular on the update status which is defined in section 4.1.2.2.
How an appropriate service state is chosen after power on is described in section 4.2.1, and the specific behaviour of the
mobile station in MM IDLE state is described in section 4.2.2. The service state chosen when the MM IDLE state is
returned to from any state except NULL state is described in 4.2.3.
ETSI
106
It should be noted that transitions between the various MM idle states are caused by (e.g.):
-
PLMN search;
loss of coverage.
How various MM procedures affects the service state and the update status is described in the detailed descriptions of
the procedures in sections 4.3 to 4.5.
4.2.1
4.2.1.1
When mobility management is activated after power-on, the service state is 19.7 PLMN SEARCH. The detailed
processing in this state is described in detail in GSM 03.22 and 05.08, where procedures for power on and selection of
PLMN is described in detail. If the "Location update status" stored on the SIM is different from "updated", then the
mobile shall act as if the "Location update status" stored on the SIM is "not updated".
The service state when the PLMN SEARCH state is left depends on the outcome of the search and on the presence of
the SIM:
-
if no cell has been found, the state is NO CELL AVAILABLE, until a cell is found;
if the mobile station has been continuously activated since loosing coverage and then returns to coverage, and if
the selected cell is in the location area where the mobile station is registered and the timer T3212 has not
expired, then the state is NORMAL SERVICE;
if the selected cell is in the location area where the mobile station is registered and IMSI ATTACH is not
required and timer T3212 has not expired, then the state is NORMAL SERVICE;
if the mobile station is in automatic network selection mode and the selected cell is in a forbidden PLMN or a
forbidden LA, then the mobile station enters the LIMITED SERVICE state;
if the mobile station is in manual network selection mode and no cell of the selected PLMN has been found, then
the mobile station enters the LIMITED SERVICE state;
otherwise, the mobile station enters the LOCATION UPDATE NEEDED state.
4.2.1.2
Other Cases
In any state except NO IMSI, NO CELL AVAILABLE, NORMAL SERVICE and RECEIVING GROUP CALL
(NORMAL SERVICE) after the user has asked for a PLMN selection;
Roaming is denied;
optionally, when the mobile station is in the ATTEMPTING TO UPDATE state and is in Automatic Network
Selection mode and location update attempt counter is greater than or equal to 4.
The service state when the PLMN SEARCH is left depends on the outcome of the search and on the presence of the
SIM as specified in paragraph 4.2.1.1.
ETSI
4.2.2
107
In the MM IDLE state the mobile station shall behave according to the service state. In the following sections the
behaviour is described for the non transient service states. It should be noted that after procedures in RR connected
mode, e.g. location updating procedures, section 4.2.3 applies which specifies the selection of the MM idle state.
Furthermore when in sub-state NORMAL SERVICE, if a PLMN selection is requested, the MS enters sub-state
SEARCH FOR PLMN, NORMAL SERVICE.
4.2.2.1
When in state MM IDLE and service state NORMAL SERVICE, the mobile station shall:
-
respond to paging.
respond to notification if the GCC or BCC sublayer requests the reception of a voice group or broadcast call for
which no channel description has been received in the notification by the RR sublayer;
request the RR sublayer to receive a voice group or broadcast call if the GCC or BCC sublayer requests the
reception of a voice group or broadcast call for which a channel description has been received in the notification
by the RR sublayer and then go to the service state RECEIVING GROUP CALL (NORMAL SERVICE).
4.2.2.2
When in state MM IDLE and service state ATTEMPTING TO UPDATE the mobile station shall:
-
perform normal location updating when the location area identification of the serving cell changes;
if entry into this state was caused by c) or d) or f) (with cause different from "abnormal release, unspecified") or
g) (with cause "retry upon entry into a new cell") of section 4.4.4.9, then location updating shall be performed
when a new cell is entered;
if entry into this state was caused by e) or f) (with cause "abnormal release, unspecified") or g) (with cause
different from "retry upon entry into a new cell") of section 4.4.4.9, then location updating shall not be
performed because a new cell is entered;
use other request from CM layer as triggering of normal location updating procedure (if the location updating
procedure is successful, then the request for MM connection is accepted, see section 4.5.1);
ETSI
108
indicate notifications to the GCC or BCC sublayer for which a channel description has been received in the
notification by the RR sublayer;
reject requests of the GCC or BCC sublayer to respond to notifications for which no channel description has
been received in the notification by the RR sublayer;
request the RR sublayer to receive a voice group or broadcast call if the GCC or BCC sublayer requests the
reception of a voice group or broadcast call for which a channel description has been received in the notification
by the RR sublayer and then go to the service state RECEIVING GROUP CALL (LIMITED SERVICE).
4.2.2.3
When in state MM IDLE and service state LIMITED SERVICE the mobile station shall:
-
reject any requests from CM entities for MM connections except for emergency calls;
perform normal location updating when a cell is entered which may provide normal service (e.g. location area
not in one of the forbidden LAI lists.);
indicate notifications to the GCC or BCC sublayer for which a channel description has been received in the
notification by the RR sublayer;
reject requests of the GCC or BCC sublayer to respond to notifications for which no channel description has
been received in the notification by the RR sublayer;
request the RR sublayer to receive a voice group or broadcast call if the GCC or BCC sublayer requests the
reception of a voice group or broadcast call for which a channel description has been received in the notification
by the RR sublayer and then go to the service state RECEIVING GROUP CALL (LIMITED SERVICE).
4.2.2.4
When in state MM IDLE and service state NO IMSI the mobile station shall (see section 3.2, GSM 03.22 and
GSM 05.08):
-
reject any request from CM entities for MM connections except for emergency calls;
ETSI
4.2.2.5
109
When in state MM IDLE and service state SEARCH FOR PLMN, NORMAL SERVICE the mobile station shall:
-
if timer T3211 or T3213 expires in this state perform a location updating procedure at the latest if and when back
to NORMAL SERVICE state and if the cell is not changed;
if timer T3212 expires in this state perform a periodic location updating procedure at the latest if and when back
to NORMAL SERVICE state;
listen as far as possible to notifications and indicate notifications to the GCC or BCC layer;
respond to notification if the GCC or BCC sublayer requests the reception of a voice group or broadcast call for
which no channel description has been received in the notification by the RR sublayer;
request the RR sublayer to receive a voice group or broadcast call if the GCC or BCC sublayer requests the
reception of a voice group or broadcast call for which a channel description has been received in the notification
by the RR sublayer.
4.2.2.6
When in state MM IDLE and service state SEARCH FOR PLMN the mobile station shall:
-
reject any request from CM entities for MM connections except emergency calls;
4.2.2.7
Only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening:
When in state MM IDLE and service state RECEIVING GROUP CALL (NORMAL SERVICE), the mobile station
shall:
-
respond to notification if the GCC or BCC sublayer requests the reception of a voice group or broadcast call for
which no channel description has been received in the notification by the RR sublayer;
request the RR sublayer to receive another voice group or broadcast call if the GCC or BCC sublayer requests
the reception of a voice group or broadcast call for which a channel description has been received in the
notification by the RR sublayer.
ETSI
4.2.2.8
110
Only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening:
When in state MM IDLE and service state RECEIVING GROUP CALL (LIMITED SERVICE), the mobile station
shall:
-
reject any requests from CM entities for MM connections except for emergency calls;
perform normal location updating when a cell is entered which may provide normal service (e.g. location area
not in one of the forbidden LAI lists.);
indicate notifications to the GCC or BCC sublayer for which a channel description has been received in the
notification by the RR sublayer;
reject requests of the GCC or BCC sublayer to respond to notifications for which no channel description has
been received in the notification by the RR sublayer;
request the RR sublayer to receive a voice group or broadcast call if the GCC or BCC sublayer requests the
reception of a voice group or broadcast call for which a channel description has been received in the notification
by the RR sublayer and then go to the service state RECEIVING GROUP CALL (LIMITED SERVICE).
4.2.3
When returning to MM IDLE, e.g., after a location updating procedure, the mobile station selects the cell as specified in
GSM 03.22. With one exception, this is a normal cell selection.
If this return to idle state is not subsequent to a location updating procedure terminated with reception of cause
"Roaming not allowed in this location area" the service state depends on the result of the cell selection procedure, on the
update status of the mobile station, on the location data stored in the mobile station and on the presence of the SIM:
-
if no cell has been found, the state is NO CELL AVAILABLE, until a cell is found;
if no SIM is present, or if the inserted SIM is considered invalid by the MS, the state is NO IMSI;
if the selected cell is in the location area where the MS is registered, then the state is NORMAL SERVICE; it
shall be noted that this also includes an abnormal case described in paragraph 4.4.4.9;
(Only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening.) if the mobile stations was in
the service state RECEIVING GROUP CALL (NORMAL SERVICE) or RECEIVING GROUP CALL
(LIMITED SERVICE) before the location updating procedure and the selected cell is in the location area where
the mobile station is registered, then the state is RECEIVING GROUP CALL (NORMAL SERVICE);
if the selected cell is in a location area where the mobile station is not registered but in which the MS is allowed
to attempt a location update, then the state is LOCATION UPDATE NEEDED;
if the selected cell is in a location area where the mobile station is not allowed to attempt a location update, then
the state is LIMITED SERVICE;
(Only applicable for MSs supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening.) if the MSs was in the service state
RECEIVING GROUP CALL (NORMAL SERVICE) or RECEIVING GROUP CALL (LIMITED SERVICE)
before the location updating procedure and the selected cell is in the location area where the MS is not allowed
to attempt a location update, then the state is RECEIVING GROUP CALL (LIMITED SERVICE);
after some abnormal cases occurring during an unsuccessful location updating procedure, as described in
paragraph 4.4.4.9, the state is ATTEMPTING TO UPDATE.
In case of a return from a location updating procedure to which was answered "Roaming not allowed in this location
area", the service state PLMN SEARCH is entered as specified in section 4.2.1.2.
ETSI
4.2.4
111
a GMM procedure has failed (except routing area updating, see 4.7.5).
The selection of the appropriate substate of GMM-DEREGISTERED after switching on is described in section 4.2.4.1.
The specific behaviour of the MS in state GMM-DEREGISTERED is described in section 4.2.4.2. The substate chosen
when the GMM-DEREGISTERED state is returned to from another state except state GMM-NULL is described in
section 4.2.4.3.
It should be noted that transitions between the various substates of GMM-DEREGISTERED are caused by (e.g.):
-
PLMN search;
loss/regain of coverage; or
change of RA.
How various GMM procedures affect the GMM-DEREGISTERED substates and the GPRS update status is described
in the detailed description of the GMM procedures in section 4.7.
4.2.4.1
4.2.4.1.1
When the MS is switched on, the substate shall be PLMN-SEARCH in case the SIM is inserted and valid. See
GSM 03.22 [14] and 05.08 [34] for further details.
When the GPRS capability in an activated MS has been enabled, the selection of the GMM-DEREGISTERED substate
depends on the MM state and the GPRS update status.
The substate chosen after PLMN-SEARCH, in case of power on or after enabling of the GPRS capability is:
-
if a cell supporting GPRS has been found and the PLMN or LA is not in the forbidden list, then the substate shall
be NORMAL-SERVICE;
if the selected cell supporting GPRS is in a forbidden PLMN or a forbidden LA, then the MS shall enter the
substate LIMITED-SERVICE;
if the MS is in manual network selection mode and no cell supporting GPRS of the selected PLMN has been
found, the MS shall enter the substate NO-CELL-AVAILABLE.
4.2.4.1.2
Other Cases
When the MM state is IDLE, the GMM substate PLMN-SEARCH shall also be entered in the following cases:
-
when the user has asked for a PLMN selection in any substate except NO IMSI and NO CELL AVAILABLE ;
ETSI
112
when coverage is lost in any substate except NO IMSI and NO CELL AVAILABLE ;
Roaming is denied;
optionally, when the MS is in automatic network selection mode and the maximum allowed number of
subsequently unsuccessful attach attempts controlled by the GPRS attach attempt counter (section 4.7.3) have
been performed.
optionally, when the MS is in automatic network selection mode and the maximum allowed number of
subsequently unsuccessful routing area update attempts controlled by the GPRS routing area update attempt
counter (section 4.7.5) have been performed.
4.2.4.2
In state GMM-DEREGISTERED, the MS shall behave according to the substate. In the following sections, the
behaviour is described for the non transient substates.
4.2.4.2.1
Substate, NORMAL-SERVICE
The MS shall:
-
4.2.4.2.2
Substate, ATTEMPTING-TO-ATTACH
The MS shall:
-
perform GPRS attach when the routing area of the serving cell has changed and the location area this cell is
belonging to is not in the list of forbidden LAs;
if entry into this state was caused by b) or d) with cause "Retry upon entry into a new cell"," of section 4.7.3.1.5 ,
GPRS attach shall be performed when a new cell is entered; and
if entry into this state was caused by c) or d) with cause different from "Retry upon entry into a new cell" of
section 4.7.3.1.5, GPRS attach shall not be performed when a new cell is entered.
use requests from CM layers to trigger the combined GPRS attach procedure, if the network operates in network
operation mode I. Depending on which of the timers T3311 or T3302 is running the MS shall stop the relevant
timer and act as if the stopped timer has expired.
4.2.4.2.3
Substate, LIMITED-SERVICE
The MS shall:
-
perform GPRS attach when a cell is entered which may provide normal service (e.g. location area is not in one of
the forbidden lists);
4.2.4.2.4
Substate, NO-IMSI
The MS shall:
-
4.2.4.2.5
Substate, NO-CELL
The MS shall:
-
perform cell selection according to GSM 03.22 [14] and shall choose an appropriate substate.
ETSI
4.2.4.2.6
113
Substate, PLMN-SEARCH
4.2.4.2.7
Substate, ATTACH-NEEDED
The MS shall start a GPRS attach procedure if still needed as soon as the access class allows network contact in the
selected cell.
4.2.4.2.8
Substate, SUSPENDED
The MS :
-
4.2.4.3
When returning to state GMM-DEREGISTERED, the MS shall select a cell as specified in GSM 03.22 [14].
The substate depends on the result of the cell selection procedure, the outcome of the previously performed GMM
specific procedures , on the GPRS update status of the MS, on the location area data stored in the MS and on the
presence of the SIM:
-
if no cell has been found, the substate is NO-CELL-AVAILABLE, until a cell is found;
if no SIM is present or if the inserted SIM is considered invalid by the MS, the substate shall be NO-IMSI;
if the selected cell is in a location area where the MS is allowed to roam, the substate shall be NORMALSERVICE;
if a GPRS attach shall be performed (e.g. network requested reattach), the substate shall be ATTEMPTING-TOATTACH
if a PLMN reselection (according to GSM 03.22 [14] ) is needed , the substate shall be PLMN SEARCH
if the selected cell is in a location area where the MS is not allowed to roam, the state shall be LIMITEDSERVICE.
4.2.5
a GMM context is established, i.e. the MS is IMSI attached for GPRS services only or for GPRS and non-GPRS
services.
The specific behaviour of the MS in state GMM-REGISTERED is described in section 4.2.5.1. The primary substate
when entering the state GMM-REGISTERED is always NORMAL-SERVICE.
It should be noted that transitions between the various substates of GMM-REGISTERED are caused by (e.g.):
-
change of RA;
loss/regain of coverage.
How various GMM procedures affect the GMM-REGISTERED substates is described in the detailed description of the
procedures in section 4.7.
ETSI
4.2.5.1
114
In state GMM-REGISTERED, the MS shall behave according to the substate as explained below.
4.2.5.1.1
Substate, NORMAL-SERVICE
The MS shall:
-
4.2.5.1.2
Substate, SUSPENDED
The MS:
-
4.2.5.1.3
Substate, UPDATE-NEEDED
The MS shall:
-
chose the appropriate new substate depending on the GPRS update status as soon as the access class allows
network contact in the selected cell.
4.2.5.1.4
Substate, ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE
The MS:
-
shall perform routing area update on the expiry of timers T3311 or T3302;
shall perform routing area update when the routing area of the serving cell has changed and the location area this
cell is belonging to is not in the list of forbidden LAs;
shall if entry into this state was caused by b) or d) with cause "Retry upon entry into a new cell", of section
4.7.5.1.5, perform routing area updating when a new cell is entered; and
shall if entry into this state was caused by c) or d) with cause different from "Retry upon entry into a new cell" of
section 4.7.5.1.5, not perform routing area updating when a new cell is entered.
shall use request from CM layers as triggering the combined routing area update procedure, if the network
operates in network operation mode I. Depending which of the timers T3311 or T3302 is running the MS shall
stop the relevant timer and act as if the stopped timer has expired
4.2.5.1.5
Substate, NO-CELL-AVAILABLE
ETSI
4.2.5.1.6
115
Substate, LIMITED-SERVICE
4.2.5.1.7
Substate, ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE-MM
The MS shall:
-
perform routing area update indicating "combined RA/LA updating with IMSI attach" on the expiry of timers
T3311 or T3302;
perform routing area update indicating "combined RA/LA updating with IMSI attach" when the routing area of
the serving cell has changed and the location area this cell is belonging to is not in the list of forbidden LAs;
4.3
MM common procedures
As described in section 4.1.1, a MM common procedure can be initiated at any time whilst a RR connection exists
between the network and the mobile station.
4.3.1
The purpose of the TMSI reallocation procedure is to provide identity confidentiality , i.e. to protect a user against
being identified and located by an intruder (see GSM 02.09 and 03.20).
If the identity confidentiality service is applied for an IMSI, a Temporary Mobile Subscriber Identity (TMSI) is used for
identification within the radio interface signalling procedures.
The structure of the TMSI is specified in GSM 03.03. The TMSI has significance only within a location area. Outside
the location area it has to be combined with the Location Area Identifier (LAI) to provide for an unambiguous identity.
Usually the TMSI reallocation is performed at least at each change of a location area. (Such choices are left to the
network operator).
The reallocation of a TMSI can be performed either by a unique procedure defined in this section or implicitly by a
location updating procedure using the TMSI. The implicit reallocation of a TMSI is described together with that
procedure.
If a TMSI provided by a mobile station is unknown in the network e.g. due to a data base failure, the network may
require the mobile station to provide its International Mobile Subscriber Identity (IMSI). In this case the identification
procedure (see section 4.3.3) should be used before the TMSI reallocation procedure may be initiated.
The TMSI reallocation can be initiated by the network at any time whilst a RR connection exists between the network
and the mobile station.
NOTE 1: Usually the TMSI reallocation is performed in ciphered mode.
NOTE 2: Normally the TMSI reallocation will take place in conjunction with another procedure, e.g. at location
updating or at call setup (see GSM 09.02).
4.3.1.1
The network initiates the TMSI reallocation procedure by sending a TMSI REALLOCATION COMMAND message to
the mobile station and starts the timer T3250.
ETSI
116
The TMSI REALLOCATION COMMAND message contains a new combination of TMSI and LAI allocated by the
network or a LAI and the IMSI if the used TMSI shall be deleted. Usually the TMSI-REALLOCATION COMMAND
message is sent to the mobile station using a RR connection in ciphered mode (see GSM 03.20).
4.3.1.2
Upon receipt of the TMSI REALLOCATION COMMAND message the mobile station stores the Location Area
Identifier (LAI) in the SIM. If the received identity is the IMSI of the relevant mobile station, the mobile station deletes
any TMSI. If the received identity is a TMSI the mobile station stores the TMSI in the SIM. In both cases the mobile
station sends a TMSI REALLOCATION COMPLETE message to the network.
4.3.1.3
Upon receipt of the TMSI REALLOCATION COMPLETE message, the network stops the timer T3250 and either
considers the new TMSI as valid or, if an IMSI was sent to the mobile station, considers the old TMSI as deleted.
If the RR connection is no more needed, then the network will request the RR sublayer to release it (see section 3.5).
4.3.1.4
Abnormal cases
use the IMSI for paging in the case of network originated transactions on the CM layer. Upon response
from the mobile station the TMSI reallocation is restarted;
consider the new TMSI as valid if it is used by the mobile station in mobile originated requests for RR
connection;
use the Identification procedure followed by a new TMSI reallocation if the mobile station uses the old
TMSI.
network
Start T3250
Stop T3250
ETSI
4.3.2
117
Authentication procedure
4.3.2.1
The network initiates the authentication procedure by transferring an AUTHENTICATION REQUEST message across
the radio interface and starts the timer T3260. The AUTHENTICATION REQUEST message contains the parameters
necessary to calculate the response parameters (see GSM 03.20). It also contains the ciphering key sequence number
allocated to the key which may be computed from the given parameters.
4.3.2.2
The mobile station shall be ready to respond upon an AUTHENTICATION REQUEST message at any time whilst a
RR connection exists. It shall process the challenge information and send back an AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE
message to the network. The new ciphering key calculated from the challenge information shall overwrite the previous
one and be stored on the SIM before the AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE message is transmitted. The ciphering key
stored in the SIM shall be loaded in to the ME when any valid CIPHERING MODE COMMAND is received during an
RR connection (the definition of a valid CIPHERING MODE COMMAND message is given in section 3.4.7.2). The
ciphering key sequence number shall be stored together with the calculated key.
4.3.2.3
Upon receipt of the AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE message, the network stops the timer T3260 and checks the
validity of the response (see GSM 03.20).
4.3.2.4
The security parameters for authentication and ciphering are tied together in sets, i.e. from a challenge parameter
RAND both the authentication response SRES and the ciphering key can be computed given the secret key associated to
the IMSI.
In order to allow start of ciphering on a RR connection without authentication, the ciphering key sequence numbers are
introduced. The sequence number is managed by the network in the way that the AUTHENTICATION REQUEST
message contains the sequence number allocated to the key which may be computed from the RAND parameter carried
in that message.
The mobile station stores this number with the key, and indicates to the network in the first message (LOCATION
UPDATING REQUEST, CM SERVICE REQUEST, PAGING RESPONSE, CM RE-ESTABLISHMENT REQUEST)
which sequence number the stored key has. When the deletion of the sequence number is described this also means that
the associated key shall be considered as invalid.
The network may choose to start ciphering with the stored key (under the restrictions given in GSM 02.09) if the stored
sequence number and the one given from the mobile station are equal.
4.3.2.5
Unsuccessful authentication
If authentication fails, i.e. if the response is not valid, the network may distinguish between the two different ways of
identification used by the mobile station:
-
ETSI
118
If the TMSI has been used, the network may decide to initiate the identification procedure. If the IMSI given by the
mobile station then differs from the one the network had associated with the TMSI, the authentication should be
restarted with the correct parameters. If the IMSI provided by the MS is the expected one (i.e. authentication has really
failed), the network should proceed as described below.
If the IMSI has been used, or the network decides not to try the identification procedure, an AUTHENTICATION
REJECT message should be transferred to the mobile station.
After having sent this message, all MM connections in progress (if any) are released and the network should initiate the
RR connection release procedure described in section 3.5.
Upon receipt of an AUTHENTICATION REJECT message, the mobile station shall set the update status in the SIM to
U2 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED, delete from the SIM the stored TMSI, LAI and ciphering key sequence number. The
SIM shall be considered as invalid until switching off or the SIM is removed.
If the AUTHENTICATION REJECT message is received in the state IMSI DETACH INITIATED the mobile station
shall follow section 4.3.4.3.
If the AUTHENTICATION REJECT message is received in any other state the mobile station shall abort any MM
specific, MM connection establishment or call re-establishment procedure, stop any of the timers T3210 or T3230 (if
running), release all MM connections (if any), start timer T3240 and enter the state WAIT FOR NETWORK
COMMAND, expecting the release of the RR connection. If the RR connection is not released within a given time
controlled by the timer T3240, the mobile station shall abort the RR connection. In both cases, either after a RR
connection release triggered from the network side or after a RR connection abort requested by the MS-side, the MS
enters state MM IDLE, substate NO IMSI.
4.3.2.6
Abnormal cases
mobile station
network
AUT REQ
<-----------------AUT RES
------------------>
(a)
AUT REJ
< - - - - - - - - (b)
Start T3260
Stop T3260
Figure 4.2/GSM 04.08: Authentication sequence: (a) authentication; (b) authentication rejection
4.3.3
Identification procedure
The identification procedure is used by the network to request a mobile station to provide specific identification
parameters to the network e.g. International Mobile Subscriber Identity, International Mobile Equipment Identity (cf.
GSM 03.03). For the presentation of the IMEI, the requirements of GSM 02.09 apply.
ETSI
4.3.3.1
119
The network initiates the identification procedure by transferring an IDENTITY REQUEST message to the mobile
station and starts the timer T3270. The IDENTITY REQUEST message specifies the requested identification
parameters in the identity type information element.
4.3.3.2
The mobile station shall be ready to respond to an IDENTITY REQUEST message at any time whilst a RR connection
exists.
Upon receipt of the IDENTITY REQUEST message the mobile station sends back an IDENTITY RESPONSE
message. The IDENTITY RESPONSE message contains the identification parameters as requested by the network.
Upon receipt of the IDENTITY RESPONSE the network shall stop timer T3270.
4.3.3.3
Abnormal cases
network
ID REQ
<----------------------Start T3270
ID RES
----------------------->
Stop T3270
4.3.4
The IMSI detach procedure may be invoked by a mobile station if the mobile station is deactivated or if the Subscriber
Identity Module (see GSM 02.17) is detached from the mobile station. A flag (ATT) broadcast in the SYSTEM
INFORMATION TYPE 3 message on the BCCH is used by the network to indicate whether the detach procedure is
required. The value of the ATT flag to be taken into account shall be the one broadcast when the mobile station was in
MM idle.
The procedure causes the mobile station to be indicated as inactive in the network.
4.3.4.1
The IMSI detach procedure consists only of the IMSI DETACH INDICATION message sent from the mobile station to
the network. The mobile station then starts timer T3220 and enters the MM sublayer state IMSI DETACH INITIATED.
If no RR connection exists, the MM sublayer within the mobile station will request the RR sublayer to establish a RR
connection. If establishment of the RR connection is not possible because a suitable cell is not (or not yet) available
then, the mobile station shall try for a period of at least 5 seconds and for not more than a period of 20 seconds to find a
suitable cell. If a suitable cell is found during this time then, the mobile station shall request the RR sublayer to establish
an RR connection, otherwise the IMSI detach is aborted.
If a RR connection exists, the MM sublayer will release locally any ongoing MM connections before the IMSI
DETACH INDICATION message is sent.
The IMSI detach procedure may not be started if a MM specific procedure is active. If possible, the IMSI detach
procedure is then delayed until the MM specific procedure is finished, else the IMSI detach is omitted.
ETSI
4.3.4.2
120
When receiving an IMSI DETACH INDICATION message, the network may set an inactive indication for the IMSI.
No response is returned to the mobile station. After reception of the IMSI DETACH INDICATION message the
network shall release locally any ongoing MM connections, and start the normal RR connection release procedure (see
section 3.5).
Only applicable for a network supporting VGCS: If an IMSI DETACH INDICATION message is received from the
talking mobile station in a group call while the network is in service state MM CONNECTION ACTIVE (GROUP
TRANSMIT MODE), the network shall release locally the ongoing MM connection and then go to the service state
GROUP CALL ACTIVE.
4.3.4.3
Timer T3220 is stopped when the RR connection is released. The mobile station should, if possible, delay the local
release of the channel to allow a normal release from the network side until T3220 timeout. If this is not possible (e.g.
detach at power down) the RR sublayer on the mobile station side should be aborted.
4.3.4.4
Abnormal cases
If the establishment of an RR connection is unsuccessful, or the RR connection is lost, the IMSI detach is aborted by the
mobile station.
mobile station
network
IMSI DET IND
--------------------->
Figure 4.4/GSM 04.08: IMSI detach sequence
4.3.5
Abort procedure
The abort procedure may be invoked by the network to abort any on-going MM connection establishment or already
established MM connection. The mobile station shall treat ABORT message as compatible with current protocol state
only if it is received when at least one MM connection exists or an MM connection is being established.
4.3.5.1
The abort procedure consists only of the ABORT message sent from the network to the mobile station. Before the
sending of the ABORT message the network shall locally release any ongoing MM connection. After the sending the
network may start the normal RR connection release procedure.
The Cause information element indicates the reason for the abortion. The following cause values may apply:
# 6:
Illegal ME
#17:
Network failure
4.3.5.2
At the receipt of the ABORT message the mobile station shall abort any MM connection establishment or call reestablishment procedure and release all MM connections (if any). If cause value #6 is received the mobile station shall
delete any TMSI, LAI and ciphering key sequence number stored in the SIM, set the update status to ROAMING NOT
ALLOWED (and store it in the SIM according to section 4.1.2.2) and consider the SIM invalid until switch off or the
SIM is removed. As a consequence the mobile station enters state MM IDLE, substate NO IMSI after the release of the
RR connection.
The mobile station shall then wait for the network to release the RR connection - see section 4.5.3.1.
4.3.6
MM information procedure
ETSI
121
The MM information procedure may be invoked by the network at any time during an RR connection.
4.3.6.1
The MM information procedure consists only of the MM INFORMATION message sent from the network to the
mobile station. During an RR connection, the network shall send none, one, or more MM INFORMATION messages to
the mobile station. If more than one MM INFORMATION message is sent, the messages need not have the same
content.
NOTE:
4.3.6.2
The network may be able to select particular instants where it can send the MM INFORMATION
message without adding delay to, or interrupting, any CM layer transaction, e.g. immediately after the
AUTHENTICATION REQUEST message.
When the mobile station (supporting the MM information message) receives an MM INFORMATION message, it shall
accept the message and optionally use the contents to update appropriate information stored within the mobile station.
If the mobile station does not support the MM information message the mobile station shall ignore the contents of the
message and return an MM STATUS message with cause #97.
4.4
MM specific procedures
A MM specific procedure can only be started if no other MM specific procedure is running or no MM connection exists
between the network and the mobile station. The end of the running MM specific procedure or the release of all MM
connections have to be awaited before a new MM specific procedure can be started.
During the lifetime of a MM specific procedure, if a MM connection establishment is requested by a CM entity, this
request will either be rejected or be delayed until the running MM specific procedure is terminated (this depends on the
implementation).
Any MM common procedure (except IMSI detach) may be initiated during a MM specific procedure.
Unless it has specific permission from the network (follow-on proceed) the mobile station side should await the release
of the RR connection used for a MM specific procedure before a new MM specific procedure or MM connection
establishment is started.
NOTE:
4.4.1
The network side may use the same RR connection for MM connection management.
The location updating procedure is a general procedure which is used for the following purposes:
-
The normal location updating procedure is used to update the registration of the actual Location Area of a mobile
station in the network. The location updating type information element in the LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST
message shall indicate normal location updating. The conditions under which the normal location updating procedure is
used by a mobile station in the MM IDLE state are defined for each service state in section 4.2.2.
Only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening: A mobile station in RR group receive
mode is in the MM IDLE state, substate RECEIVING GROUP CALL (NORMAL SERVICE) or RECEIVING GROUP
CALL (LIMITED SERVICE). To perform a location updating, the MS in RR group receive mode shall leave the group
receive mode, establish an independent dedicated RR connection to perform the location updating as described above
and return to the RR group receive mode afterwards.
The normal location updating procedure shall also be started if the network indicates that the mobile station is unknown
in the VLR as a response to MM connection establishment request.
ETSI
122
To limit the number of location updating attempts made, where location updating is unsuccessful, an attempt counter is
used. The attempt counter is reset when a mobile station is switched on or a SIM card is inserted.
Upon successful location updating the mobile station sets the update status to UPDATED in the SIM, and stores the
received Location Area Identification in the SIM. The attempt counter shall be reset.
The detailed handling of the attempt counter is described in 4.4.4.6 to 4.4.4.9.
The Mobile Equipment shall contain a list of "forbidden location areas for roaming", as well as a list of "forbidden
location areas for regional provision of service". These lists shall be erased when the MS is switched off or when the
SIM is removed, and periodically (with period in the range 12 to 24 hours). The location area identification received on
the BCCH that triggered the location updating request shall be added to the suitable list whenever a location update
reject message is received with the cause "Roaming not allowed in this location area" or with the cause "Location Area
not allowed". The lists shall accommodate each 10 or more location area identifications. When the list is full and a new
entry has to be inserted, the oldest entry shall be deleted.
The cell selection processes in the different states are described in GSM 03.22 and GSM 05.08.
The location updating procedure is always initiated by the mobile station.
4.4.2
Periodic updating
Periodic updating may be used to notify periodically the availability of the mobile station to the network. Periodic
updating is performed by using the location updating procedure. The location updating type information element in the
LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST message shall indicate periodic updating.
The procedure is controlled by the timer T3212 in the mobile station. If the timer is not already started, the timer is
started each time the mobile station enters the MM IDLE substate NORMAL SERVICE or ATTEMPTing TO
UPDATE. When the MS leaves the MM Idle State the timer T3212 shall continue running until explicitly stopped.
The timer is stopped (shall be set to its initial value for the next start) when:
-
the first MM message is received, or ciphering mode setting is completed in the case of MM connection
establishment, except when the most recent service state is LIMITED SERVICE;
the mobile station has responded to paging and thereafter has received the first correct layer 3 message except
RR message;
the mobile station is deactivated (i.e. equipment powered down or SIM removed).
When the timer T3212 expires, the location updating procedure is started and the timer shall be set to its initial value for
the next start. If the mobile station is in other state than MM Idle when the timer expires the location updating
procedure is delayed until the MM Idle State is entered.
The conditions under which the periodic location updating procedure is used by a mobile station in the MM IDLE state
are defined for each service state in section 4.2.2.
If the mobile station is in service state NO CELL AVAILABLE, LIMITED SERVICE, PLMN SEARCH or PLMN
SEARCH-NORMAL SERVICE when the timer expires the location updating procedure is delayed until this service
state is left. The (periodic) location updating procedure is not started if the BCCH information at the time the procedure
is triggered indicates that periodic location shall not be used. The timeout value is broadcasted in the SYSTEM
INFORMATION TYPE 3 message on the BCCH, in the Control channel description IE, see section 10.5.2.11.
The T3212 timeout value shall not be changed in the NO CELL AVAILABLE, LIMITED SERVICE, PLMN SEARCH
and PLMN SEARCH-NORMAL SERVICE states.
When a change of the T3212 timeout value has to be taken into account and the timer is running (at change of the
serving cell or, change of the broadcast value of T3212), the MS shall behave as follows:
Let t1 be the new T3212 timeout value and let t be the current timer value at the moment of the change to the
new T3212 timeout value; then the timer shall be restarted with the value t modulo t1.
ETSI
123
When the mobile station is activated, or when a change of the T3212 timeout value has to be taken into account and the
timer is not running, the mobile station shall behave as follows:
Let t1 be the new T3212 timeout value, the new timer shall be started at a value randomly, uniformly drawn
between 0 and t1.
4.4.3
The IMSI attach procedure is the complement of the IMSI detach procedure (see section 4.3.4). It is used to indicate the
IMSI as active in the network. A flag (ATT) is broadcast in the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3 message. It
indicates whether the attach and detach procedures are required to be used or not.
The IMSI attach procedure is invoked if the detach/attach procedures are required by the network and an IMSI is
activated in a mobile station (i.e. activation of a mobile station with plug-in SIM, insertion of a card in a card-operated
mobile station etc.) within coverage area from the network or a mobile station with an IMSI activated outside the
coverage area enters the coverage area. The IMSI attach procedure is used only if the update status is UPDATED and if
the stored Location Area Identification is the same as the one which is actually broadcasted on the BCCH of the current
serving cell. Otherwise a normal location updating procedure (see section 4.4.1) is invoked independently of the ATT
flag indication.
IMSI attach is performed by using the location updating procedure. The location updating type information element in
the LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST message shall in this case indicate IMSI attach.
4.4.4
4.4.4.1
Any timer used for triggering the location updating procedure (e.g. T3211, T3212) is stopped if running.
As no RR connection exists at the time when the location updating procedure has to be started, the MM sublayer within
the mobile station will request the RR sublayer to establish a RR connection and enter state WAIT FOR RR
CONNECTION (LOCATION UPDATE). The procedure for establishing an RR connection is described in section 3.3.
The mobile station initiates the location updating procedure by sending a LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST
message to the network, starts the timer T3210 and enters state LOCATION UPDATING INITIATED. The location
updating type information element shall indicate what kind of updating is requested.
4.4.4.1a
The network may initiate the classmark interrogation procedure, for example, to obtain further information on the
mobile station's encryption capabilities.
4.4.4.2
The network may initiate the identification procedure, e.g. if the network is unable to get the IMSI based on the TMSI
and LAI used as identification by the mobile station (see section 4.3.3).
4.4.4.3
The authentication procedure (see section 4.3.2) may be initiated by the network upon receipt of the LOCATION
UPDATING REQUEST message from the mobile station. (See the cases defined in GSM 02.09).
4.4.4.4
The ciphering mode setting procedure (see section 3.4.7) may be initiated by the network, e.g., if a new TMSI has to be
allocated.
ETSI
4.4.4.5
124
Attempt Counter
To limit the number of location updating attempts made, where location updating is unsuccessful, an attempt counter is
used. It counts the number of consecutive unsuccessful location update attempts.
The attempt counter is incremented when a location update procedure fails. The specific situations is specified in
section 4.4.4.9.
The attempt counter is reset when:
-
a SIM is inserted;
location update completed with cause #11, #12 or #13 (see section 4.4.4.7).
The attempt counter is used when deciding whether to re-attempt a location update after timeout of timer T3211.
4.4.4.6
If the location updating is accepted by the network a LOCATION UPDATING ACCEPT message is transferred to the
mobile station.
In case the identity confidentiality service is active (see section 4.3.1 and 4.4.4.4), the TMSI reallocation may be part of
the location updating procedure. The TMSI allocated is then contained in the LOCATION UPDATING ACCEPT
message together with the location area identifier LAI. The network shall in this case start the supervision timer T3250
as described in section 4.3.1.
If the network wishes to prolong the RR connection to allow the mobile station to initiate MM connection establishment
(for example if the mobile station has indicated in the LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST that it has a follow-on
request pending) the network shall send "follow on proceed" in the LOCATION UPDATING ACCEPT and start timer
T3255.
The mobile station receiving a LOCATION UPDATING ACCEPT message shall store the received location area
identification LAI, stop timer T3210, reset the attempt counter and set the update status in the SIM to UPDATED. If the
message contains an IMSI, the mobile station is not allocated any TMSI, and shall delete any TMSI in the SIM
accordingly. If the message contains a TMSI, the mobile station is allocated this TMSI, and shall store this TMSI in the
SIM and a TMSI REALLOCATION COMPLETE shall be returned to the network. If neither IMSI nor TMSI is
received in the LOCATION UPDATING ACCEPT message, the old TMSI if any available shall be kept.
If the LAI or PLMN identity contained in the LOCATION UPDATING ACCEPT message is a member of any of the
"forbidden lists" then any such entries shall be deleted.
After that, the mobile station shall act according to the presence of the "Follow-on proceed" information element in the
LOCATION UPDATING ACCEPT; if this element is present and the mobile station has a CM application request
pending, it shall send a CM SERVICE REQUEST to the network and proceed as in section 4.5.1.1. Otherwise, it shall
start timer T3240 and enter state WAIT FOR NETWORK COMMAND.
Furthermore, the network may grant authorisation for the mobile station to use GSM-Cordless Telephony System (CTS)
in the Location Area and its immediate neighbourhood. The mobile should memorise this permission in non-volatile
memory. If the "CTS permission" IE is not present in the message, the mobile is not authorised to use GSM-CTS, and
shall accordingly delete any memorised permission.
NOTE:
the interaction between CTS and GPRS procedures are not yet defined.
ETSI
4.4.4.7
125
If the location updating cannot be accepted the network sends a LOCATION UPDATING REJECT message to the
mobile station. The mobile station receiving a LOCATION UPDATING REJECT message shall stop the timer T3210,
store the reject cause, start T3240, enter state LOCATION UPDATING REJECTED await the release of the RR
connection triggered by the network. Upon the release of the RR connection the mobile station shall take the following
actions depending on the stored reject cause:
# 2:
# 3:
Illegal MS; or
# 6:
Illegal ME.
The mobile station shall set the update status to ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and store it in the SIM according
to section 4.1.2.2), and delete any TMSI, stored LAI and ciphering key sequence number and shall consider the
SIM as invalid until switch-off or the SIM is removed.
# 11: PLMN not allowed;
# 12: Location Area not allowed; or
# 13: Roaming not allowed in this location area.
The mobile station shall delete any LAI, TMSI and ciphering key sequence number stored in the SIM, reset the
attempt counter, set the update status to ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and store it in the SIM according to
section 4.1.2.2). The mobile station shall store the LAI or the PLMN identity in the suitable forbidden list, i.e. in
the "forbidden PLMN list" for cause #11, in the list of "forbidden location areas for regional provision of
service" for cause #12, and in the list of "forbidden location areas for roaming" for cause #13. In addition, the
MS will memorize if cause #13 was received, so to perform a PLMN selection instead of a cell selection when
back to the MM IDLE state.
Other values are considered as abnormal cases and the specification of the mobile station behaviour in those cases is
given in section 4.4.4.9.
4.4.4.8
When the Location updating procedure is finished (see sections 4.4.4.6 and 4.4.4.7) the mobile station shall (except in
the case where the mobile has a follow-on CM application request pending and has received the follow-on proceed
indication, see 4.4.4.6) set timer T3240 and enter the state WAIT FOR NETWORK COMMAND, expecting the release
of the RR connection. The network may decide to keep the RR connection for network initiated establishment of a MM
connection, or to allow for mobile initiated MM connection establishment.
Any release of the RR connection shall be initiated by the network according to section 3.5. If the RR connection is not
released within a given time controlled by the timer T3240, the mobile station shall abort the RR connection. In both
cases, either after a RR connection release triggered from the network side or after a RR connection abort requested by
the MS-side, the MS shall return to state MM IDLE.
At transition to state MM IDLE, substates NORMAL SERVICE or RECEIVING GROUP CALL (NORMAL
SERVICE) or ATTEMPTING TO UPDATE either timer T3212 or timer T3211 is started as described in section
4.4.4.9.
4.4.4.9
The different abnormal cases that can be identified are the following:
a) Access barred because of access class control
The location updating procedure is not started. The mobile station stays in the current serving cell and applies
normal cell reselection process. The procedure is started as soon as possible and if still necessary (when the
barred state is ended or because of a cell change)
b) The answer to random access is an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT message
ETSI
126
The location updating is not started. The mobile station stays in the chosen cell and applies normal cell selection
process. The waiting timer T3122 is reset when a cell change occurs. The procedure is started as soon as possible
after T3122 timeout if still necessary.
c) Random access failure
Timer T3213 is started. When it expires the procedure is attempted again if still necessary.
NOTE:
As specified in GSM 05.08, a cell reselection then takes place, with return to the cell inhibited for 5
seconds if there is at least one other suitable cell. Typically the selection process will take the mobile
station back to the cell where the random access failed after 5 seconds.
If at the expiry of timer T3213 a new cell has not been selected due to the lack of valid information (see
GSM 05.08), the mobile station may as an option delay the repeated attempt for up to 8 seconds to allow cell reselection to take place. In this case the procedure is attempted as soon as a new cell has been selected or the
mobile station has concluded that no other cell can be selected.
If random access failure occurs for two successive random access attempts for location updating the mobile
station proceeds as specified below.
d) RR connection failure
The procedure is aborted and the mobile station proceeds as specified below.
e) T3210 timeout
The procedure is aborted, the RR connection is aborted and the MS proceeds as specified below.
f) RR release before the normal end of procedure
The procedure is aborted and the mobile station proceeds as specified below.
g) Location updating reject, other causes than those treated in section 4.4.4.7
The MS waits for release of the RR connection as specified in section 4.4.4.8, and then proceeds as specified
below.
In cases d) to g) above and for repeated failures as defined in c) above the mobile station proceeds as follows. Timer
T3210 is stopped if still running. The RR Connection is aborted in case of timer T3210 timeout. The attempt counter is
incremented. The next actions depend on the Location Area Identities (stored and received from the BCCH of the
current serving cell) and the value of the attempt counter.
the update status is UPDATED, and the stored LAI is equal to the one received on the BCCH from the current
serving cell and the attempt counter is smaller than 4:
The mobile station shall keep the update status to UPDATED, the MM IDLE sub-state after the RR connection
release is NORMAL SERVICE. The mobile station shall memorize the location updating type used in the
location updating procedure. It shall start timer T3211 when the RR connection is released. When timer T3211
expires the location updating procedure is triggered again with the memorized location updating type;
either the update status is different from UPDATED, or the stored LAI is different from the one received on the
BCCH from the current serving cell, or the attempt counter is greater or equal to 4:
The mobile station shall delete any LAI, TMSI, ciphering key sequence number stored in the SIM, set the update
status to NOT UPDATED and enter the MM IDLE sub-state ATTEMPTING TO UPDATE when the RR
connection is released (See section 4.2.2.2 for the subsequent actions). If the attempt counter is smaller than 4,
the mobile station shall memorize that timer T3211 is to be started when the RR connection is released,
otherwise it shall memorize that timer T3212 is to be started when the RR connection is released.
4.4.4.10
a) RR connection failure
If a RR connection failure occurs during a common procedure integrated with the location updating procedure,
the behaviour of the network should be according to the description of that common procedure.
ETSI
127
If a RR connection failure occurs when a common procedure does not exist, the location updating procedure towards
the mobile station should be aborted.
b) protocol error
If the LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST message is received with a protocol error, the network should, if
possible, return a LOCATION UPDATING REJECT message with one of the following Reject causes:
#96:
#99:
network
LOC UPD REQ
Start T3210
----------------------->
LOC UPD ACC
Stop T3210
<---------------------LOC UPD REJ
"
<- - - - - - - - - - - Figure 4.5/GSM 04.08: Location updating sequence
4.5
The concept of MM connection is introduced in this section. This concept is mainly a descriptive tool: The
establishment of an MM connection by the network can be local (i.e. it is achieved by the transmission of the first CM
layer message and without the transmission of any MM layer messages) or can be achieved by the transmission of a CM
SERVICE PROMPT message (eg. in the case of certain ring back services). The release of an MM connection by the
network or by the mobile station is always local, i.e. these purposes can be achieved without sending any MM messages
over the radio interface. (On the contrary, establishment of an MM connection by the mobile station requires the
sending of MM messages over the radio interface. An exception is VGCS, where an MM connection will be established
as result of an uplink access procedure (see section 3.7.2.1.1).)
The Mobility Management (MM) sublayer is providing connection management services to the different entities of the
upper Connection management (CM) sublayer (see GSM 04.07). It offers to a CM entity the possibility to use an MM
connection for the exchange of information with its peer entity. An MM connection is established and released on
request from a CM entity. Different CM entities communicate with their peer entity using different MM connections.
Several MM connections may be active at the same time.
An MM connection requires an RR connection. All simultaneous MM connections for a given mobile station use the
same RR connection.
In the following sections, the procedures for establishing, re-establishing, maintaining, and releasing an MM connection
are described, usually separately for the mobile station and the network side.
4.5.1
4.5.1.1
MM connection establishment
MM connection establishment initiated by the mobile station
Upon request of a CM entity to establish an MM connection the MM sublayer first decides whether to accept, delay, or
reject this request:
-
An MM connection establishment may only be initiated by the mobile station when the following conditions are
fulfilled:
-
The MM sublayer is in one of the states MM IDLE or MM connection active but not in MM connection
active (Group call).
ETSI
128
An exception from this general rule exists for emergency calls (see section 4.5.1.5). A further exception is
defined in the following clause.
-
If an MM specific procedure is running at the time the request from the CM sublayer is received, and the
LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST message has been sent, the request will either be rejected or delayed,
depending on implementation, until the MM specific procedure is finished and, provided that the network has
not sent a "follow-on proceed" indication, the RR connection is released. If the LOCATION UPDATING
REQUEST message has not been sent, the mobile station may include a "follow-on request" indicator in the
message. The mobile station shall then delay the request until the MM specific procedure is completed, when it
may be given the opportunity by the network to use the RR connection: see section 4.4.4.6.
If an RR connection exists but the mobile station is in the state WAIT FOR NETWORK COMMAND then
any requests from the CM layer that are received will either be rejected or delayed until this state is left.
CM service type identifying the requested type of transaction (e.g. mobile originating call establishment,
emergency call establishment, short message service, supplementary service activation), location services)
A MS supporting eMLPP may optionally include a priority level in the CM SERVICE REQUEST message.
ETSI
129
Only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening:
The NOTIFICATION RESPONSE message is used if a mobile station has received a notification message on the NCH
for a VGCS or VBS call without a description of the respective VGCS or VBS channel. The mobile station therefore
establishes an MM connection with a NOTIFICATION RESPONSE in order to obtain the necessary details from the
network. The NOTIFICATION RESPONSE message contains the
-
A collision may occur when a CM layer message is received by the mobile station in MM sublayer state WAIT FOR
OUTGOING MM CONNECTION or in WAIT FOR ADDITIONAL OUTGOING MM CONNECTION. In this case
the MM sublayer in the MS shall establish a new MM connection for the incoming CM message as specified in 4.5.1.3.
Upon receiving a CM SERVICE REQUEST or NOTIFICATION RESPONSE message, the network shall analyse its
content. The type of semantic analysis may depend on other on going MM connection(s). Depending on the type of
request and the current status of the RR connection, the network may start any of the MM common procedures and RR
procedures.
The network may initiate the classmark interrogation procedure, for example, to obtain further information on the
mobile station's encryption capabilities.
The identification procedure (see section 4.3.3) may be invoked for instance if a TMSI provided by the mobile station is
not recognized.
The network may invoke the authentication procedure (see section 4.3.2) depending on the CM service type.
The network decides also if the ciphering mode setting procedure shall be invoked (see section 3.4.7).
NOTE:
If the CM_SERVICE_REQUEST message contains a priority level the network may use this to perform
queuing and pre-emption as defined in GSM 03.67.
An indication from the RR sublayer that the ciphering mode setting procedure is completed, or reception of a CM
SERVICE ACCEPT message, shall be treated as a service acceptance indication by the mobile station. The MM
connection establishment is completed, timer T3230 shall be stopped, the CM entity that requested the MM connection
shall be informed, and MM sublayer state MM CONNECTION ACTIVE is entered. The MM connection is considered
to be active.
If the service request cannot be accepted, the network returns a CM SERVICE REJECT message to the mobile station.
The reject cause information element (see 10.5.3.6 and Annex G) indicates the reason for rejection. The following cause
values may apply:
#4 : IMSI unknown in VLR
#6 : Illegal ME
#17 : Network failure
#22 : Congestion
#32 : Service option not supported
#33 : Requested service option not subscribed
#34 : Service option temporarily out of order
If no other MM connection is active, the network may start the RR connection release (see section 3.5) when the CM
SERVICE REJECT message is sent.
If a CM SERVICE REJECT message is received by the mobile station, timer T3230 shall be stopped, the requesting
CM sublayer entity informed. Then the mobile station shall proceed as follows:
ETSI
130
If the cause value is not #4 or #6 the MM sublayer returns to the previous state (the state where the request was
received). Other MM connections shall not be affected by the CM SERVICE REJECT message.
If cause value #4 is received, the mobile station aborts any MM connection, deletes any TMSI, LAI and
ciphering key sequence number in the SIM, changes the update status to NOT UPDATED (and stores it in the
SIM according to section 4.1.2.2), and enters the MM sublayer state WAIT FOR NETWORK COMMAND. If
subsequently the RR connection is released or aborted, this will force the mobile station to initiate a normal
location updating). Whether the CM request shall be memorized during the location updating procedure, is a
choice of implementation.
If cause value #6 is received, the mobile station aborts any MM connection, deletes any TMSI, LAI and
ciphering key sequence number in the SIM, changes the update status to ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and
stores it in the SIM according to section 4.1.2.2), and enters the MM sublayer state WAIT FOR NETWORK
COMMAND. The mobile station shall consider the SIM as invalid until switch-off or the SIM is removed.
4.5.1.2
Abnormal cases
b)
T3230 expiry
If T3230 expires (i.e. no response is given but a RR connection is available) the MM connection establishment is
aborted and the requesting CM sublayer is informed. If no other MM connection exists then the mobile station
shall proceed as described in section 4.5.3.1 for release of the RR connection. Otherwise the mobile station shall
return to the MM sublayer state where the request of an MM connection was received, i.e. to MM sublayer state
MM connection active. Other ongoing MM connections (if any) shall not be affected.
c)
Reject cause values #95, #96, #97, #99, #100, #111 received
The same actions as on timer expiry shall be taken by the mobile station.
d)
NOTE:
Further actions of the mobile station depend on the RR procedures and MM specific procedures during
which the abnormal situation has occurred and are described together with those procedures.
Network side:
a)
RR connection failure
The actions to be taken upon RR connection failure within a MM common procedure are described together with
that procedure. A RR connection failure occurring outside such MM common procedures, shall trigger the
release of all active MM connections if any.
b)
ETSI
131
4.5.1.3
4.5.1.3.1
When a CM sublayer entity in the network requests the MM sublayer to establish a MM connection, the MM sublayer
will request the establishment of an RR connection to the RR sublayer if no RR connection to the desired mobile station
exists. The MM sublayer is informed when the paging procedure is finished (see section 3.3.2) and the mobile station
shall enter the MM state WAIT FOR NETWORK COMMAND.
When an RR connection is established (or if it already exists at the time the request is received), the MM sublayer may
initiate any of the MM common procedures (except IMSI detach); it may request the RR sublayer to perform the RR
classmark interrogation procedure, and/or the ciphering mode setting procedure.
When all MM and RR procedures are successfully completed which the network considers necessary, the MM sublayer
will inform the requesting mobile terminating CM sublayer entity on the success of the MM connection establishment.
If an RR connection already exists and no MM specific procedure is running, the network may also establish a new
mobile terminating MM connection by sending a CM message with a new PD/TI combination.
If the establishment of an RR connection is unsuccessful, or if any of the MM common procedures or the ciphering
mode setting fail, this is indicated to the CM layer with an appropriate error cause.
If an RR connection used for a MM specific procedure exists to the mobile station, the CM request may be rejected or
delayed depending on implementation. When the MM specific procedure has been completed, the network may use the
same RR connection for the delayed CM request.
Only applicable in case of VGCS talking:
In the MM CONNECTION ACTIVE (GROUP TRANSMIT MODE) the mobile station is in RR Group transmit mode.
There shall be only one MM connection active.
When in MM CONNECTION ACTIVE (GROUP TRANSMIT MODE) state, the MM sublayer in the network shall
reject the request for the establishment of another MM connection by any CM layer.
If the RR sublayer in the network indicates a request to perform a transfer of the mobile station from RR connected
mode to RR Group transmit mode which will result in a transition from MM CONNECTION ACTIVE state to MM
CONNECTION ACTIVE (GROUP TRANSMIT MODE) state in the MM sublayer, the MM sublayer shall not allow
the transition if more than one MM connection is active with the mobile station.
4.5.1.3.2
When a CM sublayer entity in the network requests the MM sublayer to establish a MM connection, the MM sublayer
will request the establishment of an RR connection to the RR sublayer if no RR connection to the desired mobile station
exists. The MM sublayer is informed when the paging procedure is finished (see section 3.3.2) and the mobile station
shall enter the MM state WAIT FOR NETWORK COMMAND.
When an RR connection is established (or if it already exists at the time the request is received), the MM sublayer may
initiate any of the MM common procedures (except IMSI detach), it may request the RR sublayer to perform the RR
classmark interrogation procedure and/or the ciphering mode setting procedure.
The network should use the information contained in the Mobile Station Classmark Type 2 IE on the mobile stations
support for "Network Initiated MO CM Connection Request" to determine whether to:
not start this procedure (eg if an RR connection already exists), or,
ETSI
132
4.5.1.4
Abnormal cases
The behaviour upon abnormal events is described together with the relevant RR procedure or MM common procedure.
4.5.1.5
A MM connection for an emergency call may be established in all states of the mobility management sublayer which
allow MM connection establishment for a normal originating call. In addition, establishment may be attempted in all
service states where a cell is selected (see 4.2.2) but not in the MM CONNECTION ACTIVE state (GROUP
TRANSMIT MODE) state. However, as a network dependent option, a MM connection establishment for emergency
call may be rejected in some of the states.
When a user requests an emergency call establishment the mobile station will send a CM SERVICE REQUEST
message to the network with a CM service type information element indicating emergency call establishment. If the
network does not accept the emergency call request, e.g., because IMEI was used as identification and this capability is
not supported by the network, the network will reject the request by returning a CM SERVICE REJECT message to the
mobile station.
The reject cause information element indicates the reason for rejection. The following cause values may apply:
#3
"Illegal MS"
ETSI
#4
#5
#6
"Illegal ME"
#17
"Network failure"
#22
"Congestion"
#32
#34
133
With the above defined exceptions, the procedures described for MM connection establishment in 4.5.1.1 and 4.5.1.2
shall be followed.
NOTE:
Normally, the mobile station will be identified by an IMSI or a TMSI. However, if none of these
identifiers is available in the mobile station, then the mobile station shall use the IMEI for identification
purposes. The network may in that case reject the request by returning a CM SERVICE REJECT message
with reject cause:
4.5.1.6
Call re-establishment
The re-establishment procedure allows a MS to resume a connection in progress after a radio link failure, possibly in a
new cell and possibly in a new location area. The conditions in which to attempt call re-establishment or not depend on
the call control state, see section 5.5.4 and, whether or not a cell allowing call re-establishment has been found (as
described in GSM 05.08). MM connections are identified by their protocol discriminators and transaction identifiers:
these shall not be changed during call re-establishment.
The re-establishment takes place when a lower layer failure occurs and at least one MM connection is active (i.e.. the
mobile station's MM sublayer is either in state 6 "MM CONNECTION ACTIVE" or state 20 "WAIT FOR
ADDITIONAL OUTGOING MM CONNECTION").
NOTE:
During a re-establishment attempt the mobile station does not return to the MM IDLE state; thus no
location updating is performed even if the mobile is not updated in the location area of the selected cell.
No call re-establishment shall be performed for voice group and broadcast calls.
4.5.1.6.1
NOTE:
If at least one request to re-establish an MM connection is received from a CM entity as a response to the indication that
the MM connection is interrupted (see 4.5.2.3.) the mobile station initiates the call re-establishment procedure. If
several CM entities request re-establishment only one re-establishment procedure is initiated. If any CM entity requests
re-establishment, then re-establishment of all transactions belonging to all Protocol Discriminators that permit Call Reestablishment shall be attempted.
Upon request of a CM entity to re-establish an MM connection the MM sublayer requests the RR sublayer to establish
an RR connection and enters MM sublayer state WAIT FOR REESTABLISH. This request contains an establishment
cause and a CM RE-ESTABLISHMENT REQUEST message. When the establishment of an RR connection is
indicated by the RR sublayer (this indication implies that the CM RE-ESTABLISHMENT REQUEST message has
been successfully transferred via the radio interface, see section 2.2), the MM sublayer of the mobile station starts timer
T3230, gives an indication to all CM entities that are being re-established, and remains in the MM sublayer state WAIT
FOR REESTABLISH.
The CM RE-ESTABLISHMENT REQUEST message contains the
-
ETSI
134
NOTE:
Whether or not a CM entity can request re-establishment depends upon the Protocol Discriminator. The
specifications for Short Message Service (GSM 04.11), Call Independent Supplementary Services
(GSM 04.10) and Location Services (GSM 04.71) do not currently specify any re-establishment
procedures.
Upon receiving a CM RE-ESTABLISHMENT REQUEST message, the network shall analyse its content. Depending
on the type of request, the network may start any of the MM common procedures and RR procedures.
The network may initiate the classmark interrogation procedure, for example, to obtain further information on the
mobile station's encryption capabilities.
The identification procedure (see section 4.3.3) may be invoked.
The network may invoke the authentication procedure (see section 4.3.2).
The network decides if the ciphering mode setting procedure shall be invoked (see section 3.4.7).
An indication from the RR sublayer that the ciphering mode setting procedure is completed, or reception of a CM
SERVICE ACCEPT message, shall be treated as a service acceptance indication by the mobile station. The MM
connection re-establishment is completed, timer T3230 shall be stopped, all CM entities associated with the reestablishment shall be informed, and MM sublayer state MM CONNECTION ACTIVE is re-entered. All the MM
connections are considered to be active.
If the network cannot associate the re-establishment request with any existing call for that mobile station, a CM
SERVICE REJECT message is returned with the reject cause:
#38
If call re-establishment cannot be performed for other reasons, a CM SERVICE REJECT is returned, the appropriate
reject cause may be any of the following (see annex G):
#4
#6
"illegal ME";
#17
"network failure";
#22
"congestion";
#32
#34
Whatever the reject cause a mobile station receiving a CM SERVICE REJECT as a response to the CM REESTABLISHMENT REQUEST shall stop T3230, release all MM connections and proceed as described in section
4.5.3.1. In addition:
-
if cause value #4 is received, the mobile station deletes any TMSI, LAI and ciphering key sequence number in
the SIM, changes the update status to NOT UPDATED (and stores it in the SIM according to section 4.1.2.2),
and enters the MM sublayer state WAIT FOR NETWORK COMMAND. If subsequently the RR connection is
released or aborted, this will force the mobile station to initiate a normal location updating). The CM reestablishment request shall not be memorized during the location updating procedure.
if cause value #6 is received, the mobile station deletes any TMSI, LAI and ciphering key sequence number in
the SIM, changes the update status to ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and stores it in the SIM according to
section 4.1.2.2), and enters the MM sublayer state WAIT FOR NETWORK COMMAND. The MS shall
consider the SIM as invalid until switch-off or the SIM is removed.
4.5.1.6.2
Abnormal cases
ETSI
135
If the mobile station detects a random access failure or RR connection establishment failure during the reestablishment of an MM connection, the re-establishment is aborted and all MM connections are released.
b) RR connection failure
If a RR connection failure occurs, timer T3230 is stopped, the re-establishment is aborted and all active MM
connections are released.
c) IMSI deactivation
If the IMSI deactivated during the re-establishment attempt then timer T3230 is stopped, the re-establishment is
aborted and all MM connections are released.
d) T3230 expires
If T3230 expires (i.e. no response is given but a RR connection is available) the re-establishment is aborted, all
active MM connections are released and the mobile station proceeds as described in section 4.5.3.1.
e) Reject causes #96, #97, #99, #100, #111 received
The mobile station shall perform the same actions as if timer T3230 had expired.
Network side:
a) RR connection failure
If a RR connection failure occurs after receipt of the CM RE-ESTABLISHMENT REQUEST the network shall
release all MM connections.
b) Invalid message content
Upon reception an invalid initial of message or a CM RE-ESTABLISHMENT REQUEST message with invalid
content, a CM SERVICE REJECT message shall be returned with one of the following appropriate Reject cause
indications:
#96:
#99:
4.5.1.7
If the mobile station's CM layer initiated the MM connection establishment but the CM layer wishes to abort the
establishment prior to the completion of the establishment phase, the mobile station shall send a CM SERVICE
ABORT message any time after the completion of the RR connection and not after the first CM message (e.g. SETUP)
is sent.
If the first CM message has already been sent, the normal release procedure defined by the appropriate CM protocol
applies and the CM SERVICE ABORT shall not be sent.
Sending of the CM SERVICE ABORT message is only allowed during the establishment of the first MM connection,
where no other MM connection exists in parallel. If parallel MM connections exist already, a new connection
establishment cannot be aborted and normal MM connection release according to 4.5.3 applies after MM connection
establishment.
Upon transmission of the CM SERVICE ABORT message the mobile station shall set timer T3240 and enter the state
WAIT FOR NETWORK COMMAND, expecting the release of the RR connection.
Upon receipt of the CM SERVICE ABORT message the network shall abort ongoing processes, release the appropriate
resources, and unless another MM connection establishment is pending, initiate a normal release of the RR connection.
ETSI
136
If the RR connection is not released within a given time controlled by timer T3240, the mobile station shall abort the
RR connection. In both cases, either after a RR connection release triggered from the network side or after a RR
connection abort requested by the mobile station side the mobile station shall return to state MM IDLE; the service state
depending upon the current update status as specified in section 4.2.3.
4.5.2
After the MM connection has been established, it can be used by the CM sublayer entity for information transfer.
According to the protocol architecture described in GSM 04.07, each CM entity will have its own MM connection.
These different MM connections are identified by the protocol discriminator PD and, additionally, by the transaction
identifier TI.
All MM common procedures may be initiated at any time while MM connections are active. Except for Short Message
Control which uses a separate layer 2 low priority data link, no priority mechanism is defined between the CM, MM
and RR sublayer messages.
4.5.2.1
Sending CM messages
A CM sublayer entity, after having been advised that a MM connection has been established, can request the transfer of
CM messages. The CM messages passed to the MM sublayer are then sent to the other side of the interface with the PD
and TI set according to the source entity.
4.5.2.2
Receiving CM messages
Upon receiving a CM message, the MM sublayer will distribute it to the relevant CM entity according to the PD value
and TI value. However, if the received CM message is the first for the MM connection (identified by PD and TI), the
MM sublayer will in addition indicate to the CM entity that a new MM connection has been established.
4.5.2.3
Abnormal cases
RR connection failure:
If the RR connection failure occurs during a RR or MM common procedure, the consequent actions are
described together with that procedure.
In other cases, the following applies:
Mobile station:
The MM sublayer shall indicate to all CM entities associated with active MM connections that the MM
connection is interrupted, the subsequent action of the MM sublayer (call re-establishment, see 4.5.1.6, or local
release) will then depend on the decisions by the CM entities.
Network:
The MM sublayer shall locally release all active MM connections. As an option the network may delay the
release of all or some of the MM connections to allow the mobile station to initiate call re-establishment
4.5.3
MM connection release
An established MM connection can be released by the local CM entity. The release of the CM connection will then be
done locally in the MM sublayer, i.e. no MM message are sent over the radio interface for this purpose.
4.5.3.1
If all MM connections are released by their CM entities, the mobile station shall set timer T3240 and enter the state
WAIT FOR NETWORK COMMAND, expecting the release of the RR connection.
In the network, if the last MM connection is released by its user, the MM sublayer may decide to release the RR
connection by requesting the RR sublayer according to section 3.5. The RR connection may be maintained by the
network, e.g. in order to establish another MM connection.
ETSI
137
If the RR connection is not released within a given time controlled by the timer T3240, the mobile station shall abort the
RR connection. In both cases, either after a RR connection release triggered from the network side or after a RR
connection abort requested by the MS-side, the MS shall return to MM IDLE state; the service state depending upon the
current update status as specified in section 4.2.3.
4.5.3.2
4.6
If the MM entity of the mobile station receives a MM STATUS message no state transition and no specific action shall
be taken as seen from the radio interface, i.e. local actions are possible.
With the exceptions described for the responses to the CM SERVICE PROMPT message, the actions to be taken on
receiving a MM STATUS message in the network are an implementation dependent option.
4.7
4.7.1
General
This section describes the basic functions offered by the mobility management (GMM) sublayer at the radio interface
(reference point Um). The functionality is described in terms of timers and procedures. During GMM procedures,
session management procedures, see chapter 6, are suspended.
4.7.1.1
The LLC sublayer shall indicate a logical link failure or an RR sublayer failure to the GMM sublayer. The failure
indicates an error that cannot be corrected by the lower layers.
4.7.1.2
Ciphering of messages
If ciphering is to be applied on a GMM context, all GMM messages shall be ciphered except the following messages:
-- ATTACH REQUEST;
-- ATTACH REJECT;
-- AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REQUEST;
-- AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING RESPONSE;
-- AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REJECT;
-- IDENTITY REQUEST;
-- IDENTITY RESPONSE;
-- ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST; and
-- ROUTING AREA UPDATE REJECT.
ETSI
4.7.1.3
138
P-TMSI signature
The network may assign a P-TMSI signature to an MS in an attach, routing area update, or P-TMSI reallocation
procedure. Only in combination with a valid P-TMSI, this P-TMSI signature is used by the MS for authentication and
identification purposes in the subsequent attach or routing area update procedure. If the MS has no valid P-TMSI it shall
not use the P-TMSI signature in the subsequent attach or routing area update procedure. Upon successful completion of
the subsequent attach or routing area update procedure the used P-TMSI signature shall be deleted.
4.7.1.4
While a packet TMSI (P-TMSI) is used in the GMM sublayer for identification of an MS, a temporary logical link
identity (TLLI) is used for addressing purposes at the RR sublayer. This section describes how the RR addressing is
managed by GMM. For the detailed coding of the different TLLI types and how a TLLI can be derived from a P-TMSI,
see GSM 03.03 [10].
Two cases can be distinguished:
-
NOTE:
For anonymous access, the RR address assignment is handled by the SM sublayer as described in section
6.1.1.1.
Any other GMM message is transmitted using a local TLLI derived from the stored P-TMSI. This includes a
ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST message that is sent within a periodic routing area update procedure.
ii) no valid P-TMSI available
When the MS has not stored a valid P-TMSI, i.e. the MS is not attached to GPRS, the MS shall use a randomly
selected random TLLI for transmission of the:
-
The same randomly selected random TLLI value shall be used for all message retransmission attempts and for the
cell updates within one attach attempt.
Upon receipt of an ATTACH REQUEST message, the network assigns a P-TMSI to the MS, derives a local TLLI
from the assigned P-TMSI, and transmits the assigned P-TMSI to the MS.
Upon receipt of the assigned P-TMSI, the MS shall derive the local TLLI from this P-TMSI and shall use it for
addressing at lower layers.
In both cases, the MS shall acknowledge the reception of the assigned P-TMSI to the network. After receipt of the
acknowledgement, the network shall use the local TLLI for addressing at lower layers.
ETSI
4.7.1.5
139
P-TMSI handling
If a new P-TMSI is assigned by the network the MS and the network shall handle the old and the new P-TMSI as
follows:
Upon receipt of a GMM message containing a new P-TMSI the MS shall consider the new P-TMSI and new RAI and
also the old P-TMSI and old RAI as valid in order to react to paging requests and downlink transmission of LLC
frames. For uplink transmission of LLC frames the new P-TMSI shall be used.
The MS shall consider the old P-TMSI and old RAI as invalid as soon as an LLC frame is received with the local TLLI
derived from the new P-TMSI.
Upon the transmission of a GMM message containing a new P-TMSI the network shall consider the new P-TMSI and
new RAI and also the old P-TMSI and old RAI as valid in order to be able to receive LLC frames from the MS.
The network shall consider the old P-TMSI and old RAI as invalid as soon as an LLC frame is received with the local
TLLI derived from the new P-TMSI.
4.7.1.6
Whenever an MS moves to a new RA, the procedures executed by the MS depend on the network mode of operation
in the old and new routing area.
In case the MS is in state GMM-REGISTERED or GMM-ROUTING-AREA-UPDATING-INITIATED and is in
operation mode:
a) A or B (with the exceptions in b and c below), the MS shall execute:
Table 4.7.1.6.1/GSM 04.08: Mode A or B
Network operation mode
change
Procedure to execute
I II or I III
II III or III II
II I or III I
b) B which reverts to operation mode C in network operation mode III, the MS shall execute:
Table 4.7.1.6.2/GSM 04.08: Mode B which reverts into mode C in network operation mode III
Network operation mode
change
Procedure to execute
I II
I III or II III
II I or III I
III II
ETSI
c)
140
B which reverts to IMSI attached for CS services only in network operation mode III, the MS shall execute:
Table 4.7.1.6.3/GSM 04.08: Mode B which reverts into IMSI attached for CS services only in network
operation mode III
Network operation mode
change
Procedure to execute
I II
I III
II III
II I
III I
III II
4.7.2
4.7.2.1
The READY timer, T3314 is used in the MS and in the network per each assigned P-TMSI to control the cell updating
procedure.
When the READY timer is running or has been deactivated the MS shall perform cell update each time a new cell is
selected (see GSM 03.22 [14]). If a routing area border is crossed, a routing area updating procedure shall be performed
instead of a cell update.
When the READY timer has expired the MS shall:
-
perform the routing area updating procedure when a routing area border is crossed;
All other GMM procedures are not affected by the READY timer.
The READY timer is started:
-
in the MS when the GMM entity receives an indication from lower layers that an LLC frame has been
transmitted on the radio interface; and
in the network when the GMM entity receives an indication from lower layers that an LLC frame has been
successfully received by the network.
Within GMM signalling procedures the network includes a force to standby information element, in order to indicate
whether or not the READY timer shall be stopped when returning to the GMM-REGISTERED state. If the force to
standby information element is received within more than one message during a ongoing GMM specific procedure, the
last one received shall apply. If the READY timer is deactivated and the network indicates 'force to standby' with the
force to standby information element, this shall not cause a modification of the READY timer.
ETSI
141
The READY timer is not affected by state transitions to and from the GMM-REGISTERED.SUSPENDED sub-state.
The value of the READY timer may be negotiated between the MS and the network using the GPRS attach or GPRS
routing area updating procedure.
-
If the MS wishes to indicate its preference for a READY timer value it shall include the preferred values into the
ATTACH REQUEST and/or ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST messages. The preferred values may be
smaller, equal to or greater than the default values or may be equal to the value requesting the READY Timer
function to be deactivated.
Regardless of whether or not a timer value has been received by the network in the ATTACH REQUEST or
ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST messages, the network may include a timer value for the READY timer
(different or not from the default value) into the ATTACH ACCEPT or ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT
messages, respectively. If the READY Timer value was included, it shall be applied for the GMM context by the
network and by the MS.
When the MS proposes a READY Timer value and the Network does not include any READY Timer Value in
its answer, then the value proposed by the MS shall be applied for the GMM context by the Network and by the
MS.
When neither the MS nor the Network proposes a READY Timer value into the ATTACH ACCEPT or
ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message, then the default value shall be used.
If the negotiated READY timer value indicates that the ready timer function is deactivated, the READY timer shall
always run without expiry. If the negotiated READY timer value indicates that the ready timer function is deactivated,
and within the same procedure the network indicates 'force to standby' with the force to standby information element,
the READY timer shall always run without expiry. If the negotiated READY timer value is set to zero, READY timer
shall be stopped immediately.
To account for the LLC frame uplink transmission delay, the READY timer value should be slightly shorter in the
network than in the MS. This is a network implementation issue.
If a new READY timer value is negotiated, the MS shall upon the reception of the ATTACH ACCEPT or ROUTING
AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message perform a initial cell update (either by transmitting a LLC frame or, if required, a
ATTACH COMPLETE or ROUTING AREA UPDATE COMPLETE message), in order to apply the new READY
timer value immediately. If the new READY timer value is set to zero or if the network indicates 'force to standby' with
the 'force to standby' IE, the initial cell update should not be done.
4.7.2.2
Periodic routing area updating is used to periodically notify the availability of the MS to the network. The procedure is
controlled in the MS by the periodic RA update timer, T3312. The value of timer T3312 is sent by the network to the
MS in the messages ATTACH ACCEPT and ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT. The value of the timer T3312
shall be unique within a RA.
The timer T3312 is reset and started with its the initial value, when the READY timer is stopped or expires. The timer
T3312 is stopped and shall be set to its initial value for the next start when the READY timer is started. If after a
READY timer negotiation the READY timer value is set to zero, timer T3312 is reset and started with its the initial
value .If the initial READY timer value is zero, the timer T3312 is reset and started with its the initial value, when the
ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST message is transmitted.
When timer T3312 expires, the periodic routing area updating procedure shall be started and the timer shall be set to its
initial value for the next start.
If the MS is in other state than GMM-REGISTERED.NORMAL-SERVICE when the timer expires the periodic routing
area updating procedure is delayed until the MS returns to GMM-REGISTERED.NORMAL-SERVICE. If the MS in
MS operation mode B is in the state GMM-REGISTERED.SUSPENDED when the timer expires the periodic routing
area updating procedure is delayed until the state is left.
The network supervises the periodic routing area updating procedure by means of the Mobile Reachable timer. The
Mobile Reachable timer shall be longer than the periodic RA update timer. When the Mobile Reachable timer expires,
typically the network stops sending paging messages to the mobile and may take other appropriate actions.
ETSI
142
The Mobile Reachable timer is reset and started with its the initial value, when the READY timer is stopped or expires.
The Mobile Reachable timer is stopped and shall be set to its initial value for the next start when the READY timer is
started.
If after a READY timer negotiation the READY timer value is set to zero the Mobile Reachable timer is reset and
started with its the initial value. If the initial READY timer value is zero, the Mobile Reachable is reset and started with
its the initial value, when the ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST message is received.
If the MS is both IMSI attached for GPRS and non-GPRS services , and if the MS lost coverage of the registered PLMN
and timer T3312 expires, then:
a) if the MS returns to coverage in a cell that supports GPRS and that indicates that the network is in network
operation mode I, then the MS shall either perform the combined routing area update procedure indicating
"combined RA/LA updating with IMSI attach"; or
b) if the MS returns to coverage in a cell in the same RA that supports GPRS and that indicates that the network is
in network operation mode II or III, then the MS shall perform the periodic routing area updating procedure
indicating "Periodic updating" and shall perform the periodic location updating procedure ; or
c) if the MS returns to coverage in a cell that does not support GPRS, then, depending upon the LA of the cell, the
MS shall either perform the periodic location updating procedure or a normal location updating procedure. In
addition, the MS shall perform a combined routing area update procedure indicating "combined RA/LA updating
with IMSI attach" when the MS enters a cell that supports GPRS and that indicates that the network is in
network operation mode I; or
d) if the MS returns to coverage in a new RA the description given in section 4.7.5 applies.
If the MS is both IMSI attached for GPRS and non-GPRS services in a network that operates in network operation
mode I, and if the MS has camped on a cell that does not support GPRS, and timer T3312 expires, then the MS shall
start an MM location updating procedure. In addition, the MS shall perform a combined routing area update procedure
indicating "combined RA/LA updating with IMSI attach" when the MS enters a cell that supports GPRS and indicates
that the network is in operation mode I.
Timer T3312 shall not be stopped when a GPRS MS enters state GMM-REGISTERED.SUSPENDED.
4.7.3
normal GPRS attach, performed by the MS to IMSI attach for GPRS services only. The normal GPRS attach
procedure shall be used by GPRS MSs in MS operation mode C, independent of the network operation mode. It
shall also be used by GPRS MSs in MS operation modes A or B if the network operates in network operation
mode II or III .
combined GPRS attach procedure, used by GPRS MSs in MS operation modes A or B to attach the IMSI for
GPRS and non-GPRS services provided that the network operates in network operation mode I.
a SIM is inserted;
ETSI
143
a combined GPRS attach procedure is completed for GPRS services only with cause #2, #16, #17 or #22
The mobile equipment shall contain a list of "forbidden location areas for roaming", as well as a list of "forbidden
location areas for regional provision of service". The handling of these lists is described in section 4.4.1; the same lists
are used by GMM and MM procedures.
4.7.3.1
The GPRS attach procedure is a GMM procedure used by GPRS MSs to IMSI attach for GPRS services.
The attach type information element shall indicate "GPRS attach".
4.7.3.1.1
In state GMM-DEREGISTERED, the MS initiates the GPRS attach procedure by sending an ATTACH REQUEST
message to the network, starts timer T3310 and enters state GMM-REGISTERED-INITIATED.
The MS shall include a valid P-TMSI, if any is available, the P-TMSI signature associated with the P-TMSI and the
routing area identity associated with the P-TMSI in the ATTACH REQUEST message. If there is no valid P-TMSI
available, the IMSI shall be included instead of the P-TMSI and P-TMSI signature.
The MS shall also indicate within the DRX parameters whether it supports the split pg cycle option on CCCH. The
optional support of the split pg cycle on CCCH by the network is indicated in SI13 or PSI1. Split pg cycle on CCCH is
applied by both the network and the MS when the split pg cycle option is supported by both (see GSM 05.02).
4.7.3.1.2
The network may initiate GMM common procedures, e.g. the GMM identification and GMM authentication and
ciphering procedure, depending on the received information such as IMSI, CKSN, old RAI, P-TMSI and P-TMSI
signature.
4.7.3.1.3
If the GPRS attach request is accepted by the network, an ATTACH ACCEPT message is sent to the MS.
The P-TMSI reallocation may be part of the GPRS attach procedure. The P-TMSI that shall be allocated is then
included in the ATTACH ACCEPT message together with the routing area identifier. The network shall, in this case,
change to state GMM-COMMON-PROCEDURE-INITIATED and shall start timer T3350 as described in section 4.7.6.
Furthermore, the network may assign a P-TMSI signature for the GMM context which is then also included in the
ATTACH ACCEPT message. If the LAI or PLMN identity that has been transmitted in the ATTACH ACCEPT
message is a member of any of the "forbidden" lists, any such entry shall be deleted. Additionally, the network shall
include the radio priority level to be used by the MS for mobile originated SMS transfer in the ATTACH ACCEPT
message.
The MS, receiving an ATTACH ACCEPT message, stores the received routing area identification, stops timer T3310,
reset the GPRS attach attempt counter, reset the routing area updating attempt counter, enters state GMMREGISTERED and sets the GPRS update status to GU1 UPDATED.
If the message contains a P-TMSI, the MS shall use this P-TMSI as the new temporary identity for GPRS services. In
this case, an ATTACH COMPLETE message is returned to the network. The MS shall delete its old P-TMSI and shall
store the new one. If no P-TMSI has been included by the network in the ATTACH ACCEPT message, the old P-TMSI,
if any available, shall be kept.
ETSI
144
If the message contains a P-TMSI signature, the MS shall use this P-TMSI signature as the new temporary signature for
the GMM context. The MS shall delete its old P-TMSI signature, if any is available, and shall store the new one. If the
message contains no P-TMSI signature, the old P-TMSI signature, if available, shall be deleted.
The network receiving an ATTACH COMPLETE message stops timer T3350, changes to GMM-REGISTERED state
and considers the P-TMSI sent in the ATTACH ACCEPT message as valid.
4.7.3.1.4
If the attach request cannot be accepted by the network, an ATTACH REJECT message is transferred to the MS. The
MS receiving the ATTACH REJECT message stops timer T3310 and takes one of the following actions depending
upon the reject cause:
# 3 (Illegal MS); or
# 6 (Illegal ME)
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according
to section 4.1.3.2) and shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and GPRS ciphering key sequence
number. The new GMM state is GMM-DEREGISTERED. The SIM shall be considered as invalid for GPRS
services until switching off or the SIM is removed.
If the MS is IMSI attached via MM procedures, the MS shall in addition set the update status to U3
ROAMING NOT ALLOWED, shall delete any TMSI, LAI and ciphering key sequence number. The new
MM state is MM IDLE. The SIM shall be considered as invalid also for non-GPRS services until switching
off or the SIM is removed.
# 7 (GPRS services not allowed)
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according
to section 4.1.3.2) and shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and GPRS ciphering key sequence
number. The SIM shall be considered as invalid for GPRS services until switching off or the SIM is removed.
The new state is GMM-DEREGISTERED.
#8
# 11
# 12
# 13
ETSI
145
Other values are considered as abnormal cases. The specification of the MS behaviour in those cases is specified in
section 4.7.3.1.5.
4.7.3.1.5
ETSI
146
the MS shall delete any RAI, P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, and GPRS ciphering key sequence number, shall set
the GPRS update status to GU2 NOT UPDATED, shall start timer T3302. The state is changed to GMMDEREGISTERED..ATTEMPTING-TO-ATTACH or optionally to GMM-DEREGISTERED.PLMN-SEARCH
(see 4.2.4.1.2).
4.7.3.1.6
use the identification procedure followed by a P-TMSI reallocation procedure if the old P-TMSI is used by
the MS in a subsequent message.
b) Protocol error
If the ATTACH REQUEST message is received with a protocol error, the network shall return an ATTACH
REJECT message with one of the following reject causes:
#96:
#99:
If one or more of the information elements in the ATTACH REQUEST message differ from the ones received
within the previous ATTACH REQUEST message, the previously initiated GPRS attach procedure shall be
aborted and the new GPRS attach procedure shall be progressed, or
If no information element differ, then the ATTACH ACCEPT message shall be resent.
d.2) More than one ATTACH REQUEST received and no ATTACH ACCEPT or ATTACH REJECT message
has been sent
-
If one or more of the information elements in the ATTACH REQUEST message differs from the ones received
within the previous ATTACH REQUEST message, the previously initiated GPRS attach procedure shall be
aborted and the new GPRS attach procedure shall be progressed ;
If the information elements do not differ, then the network shall continue with the previous attach procedure and
shall not treat any further this ATTACH REQUEST message.
ETSI
147
Network
ATTACH REQUEST
Start T3310
Stop T3310
If P-TMSI and/or
TMSI allocated
ATTACH ACCEPT
ATTACH COMPLETE
If P-TMSI and/or
TMSI allocated
Start T3350
Stop T3350
or
Start T3310
Stop T3310
ATTACH REQUEST
ATTACH REJECT
Figure 4.7.3/1 GSM 04.08: GPRS attach procedure and combined GPRS attach procedure
4.7.3.2
The combined GPRS attach procedure is a GMM procedure used by a GPRS MS operating in MS operation modes A or
B for IMSI attach for GPRS and non-GPRS services if the network operates in network operation mode I:.
If a GPRS MS operating in MS operation modes A or B is already attached for non-GPRS services by use of the MM
specific IMSI attach procedure, but additionally wishes to perform an IMSI attach for GPRS services, the combined
GPRS attach procedure shall also be used.
The attach type information element shall indicate "combined GPRS attach". In this case, the messages ATTACH
ACCEPT, ATTACH COMPLETE, and ATTACH REJECT used by the combined GPRS attach procedure carry
information for both the GPRS and the non-GPRS services.
4.7.3.2.1
If the MS is in GMM state GMM-DEREGISTERED and in MM state MM IDLE, the MS initiates the combined GPRS
attach procedure by sending an ATTACH REQUEST message to the network, starts timer T3310 and enters state
GMM-REGISTERED-INITIATED and MM LOCATION UPDATING PENDING.
The MS shall include a valid P-TMSI, if available, the P-TMSI signature associated with the P-TMSI and the routing
area identity associated with the P-TMSI in the ATTACH REQUEST message. If there is no valid P-TMSI available,
the IMSI shall be included instead of the P-TMSI and P-TMSI signature. Furthermore the MS shall include the TMSI
status IE if no valid TMSI is available.
ETSI
4.7.3.2.2
148
The network may initiate GMM common procedures, e.g. the GMM identification and GMM authentication and
ciphering procedure, depending on the received information such as IMSI, CKSN, old RAI, P-TMSI and P-TMSI
signature.
4.7.3.2.3
Depending on the value of the attach result IE received in the ATTACH ACCEPT message, two different cases can be
distinguished:
Case 1) The attach result IE value indicates "combined GPRS attach": IMSI attach for GPRS and non-GPRS
services have been successful.
Case 2) The attach result IE value indicates "GPRS only": IMSI attach for GPRS services has been successful but
IMSI attach for non-GPRS services has not been successful.
4.7.3.2.3.1
The description for IMSI attach for GPRS services as specified in section 4.7.3.1.3 shall be followed. In addition, the
following description for IMSI attach for non-GPRS services applies.
The TMSI reallocation may be part of the combined GPRS attach procedure. The TMSI allocated is then included in the
ATTACH ACCEPT message together with the location area identification (LAI). The network shall, in this case,
change to state GMM-COMMON-PROCEDURE-INITIATED and shall start timer T3350 as described in section 4.7.6.
The MS, receiving an ATTACH ACCEPT message, stores the received location area identification, stops timer T3310,
reset the location update attempt counter and sets the update status to U1 UPDATED. If the message contains an IMSI,
the mobile station is not allocated any TMSI, and shall delete any TMSI accordingly. If the message contains a TMSI,
the MS shall use this TMSI as the new temporary identity. The MS shall delete its old TMSI and shall store the new
TMSI. In this case, an ATTACH COMPLETE message is returned to the network. If neither a TMSI nor an IMSI has
been included by the network in the ATTACH ACCEPT message, the old TMSI, if any available, shall be kept. The
new MM state is MM IDLE, the new GMM state is GMM-REGISTERED.
Any timer used for triggering the location update procedure (e.g T3211, T3212) shall be stopped if running.
The network receiving an ATTACH COMPLETE message stops timer T3350, changes to state GMM-REGISTERED
and considers the new TMSI as valid.
4.7.3.2.3.2
The description for IMSI attach for GPRS services as specified in section 4.7.3.1.3 shall be followed. In addition, the
following description for IMSI attach for non-GPRS services applies.
The MS receiving the ATTACH ACCEPT message takes one of the following actions depending on the reject cause:
# 2 (IMSI unknown in HLR)
The MS shall set the update status to U3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED and shall delete any TMSI, LAI and
ciphering key sequence number. The new MM state is MM IDLE. The SIM shall be considered as invalid for
non-GPRS services until switching off or the SIM is removed.
# 16
# 17
(Network failure); or
# 22
(Congestion)
ETSI
149
If the routing area updating attempt counter is less than 5, and the stored RAI is equal to the RAI of the current
serving cell and the GMM update status is equal to GU1 UPDATED:
-
the MS shall keep the GMM update status GU1 UPDATED and changes state to GMMREGISTERED.ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE-MM. The MS shall start timer T3311. When timer T3311
expires the combined routing area update procedure indicating "combined RA/LA updating with IMSI
attach" is triggered again.
the MS shall start timer T3302 and shall change to state GMM-REGISTERED.ATTEMPTING-TOUPDATE-MM;
a GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode A shall then proceed with appropriate MM specific procedure;
a GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode B may then proceed with appropriate MM specific procedures.
The MM sublayer shall act as in network operation mode II as long as the combined GMM procedures are
not successful and no new RA is entered. The new MM state is MM IDLE.
Other values are considered as abnormal cases. The combined attach procedure shall be considered as failed for GPRS
and non-GPRS services. The behaviour of the MS in those cases is specified in section 4.7.3.2.5.
4.7.3.2.4
If the attach request can neither be accepted by the network for GPRS nor for non-GPRS services, an ATTACH
REJECT message is transferred to the MS. The MS receiving the ATTACH REJECT message stops timer T3310 and
takes one of the following actions depending upon the reject cause:
#3
(Illegal MS);
#6
(Illegal ME); or
#8
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (shall store it according to
section 4.1.3.2) and shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and GPRS ciphering key sequence
number. The new GMM state is GMM-DEREGISTERED. The new MM state is MM IDLE.
The MS shall set the update status to U3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED, shall delete any TMSI, LAI and
ciphering key sequence number. The SIM shall be considered as invalid for GPRS and non-GPRS services until
switching off or the SIM is removed.
#7
# 11
# 12
# 13
The MS shall delete any RAI, P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature and GPRS ciphering key sequence number stored,
shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according to section
4.1.3.2), shall reset the routing area updating attempt counter and reset the GPRS attach attempt counter and
changes to state GMM-DEREGISTERED. The MS shall set the update status to U3 ROAMING NOT
ALLOWED, reset the location update attempt counter and shall delete any TMSI, LAI and ciphering key
sequence number. The new MM state is MM IDLE.
ETSI
150
The MS shall store the LAI or the PLMN identity in the appropriate forbidden list, i.e. in the "forbidden PLMN
list" for cause #11, in the list of "forbidden location areas for regional provision of service" for cause #12 or in
the list of "forbidden location areas for roaming" for cause #13. If cause #11 or #13 was received, the MS shall
perform a PLMN selection instead of a cell selection.
Other values are considered as abnormal cases. The specification of the MS behaviour in those cases is specified in
section 4.7.3.2.5.
4.7.3.2.5
The abnormal cases specified in section 4.7.3.1.5 apply with the following modification:
If the GPRS attach attempt counter is less than 5, the MM state remains MM LOCATION UPDATING PENDING.
If the GPRS attach attempt counter is incremented according to section 4.7.3.1.5 the next actions depend on the
Location Area Identities (stored on SIM and the one of the current serving cell) and the value of the attach attempt
counter:
if the update status is U1 UPDATED, and the stored LAI is equal to the one of the current serving cell and the
attach attempt counter is smaller than 5, then the mobile station shall keep the update status to U1 UPDATED,
the new MM state is MM IDLE substate NORMAL SERVICE; or
-
if the update status is different from U1 UPDATED, or the stored LAI is different from the one of the current
serving cell, or the attach attempt counter is greater or equal to 5, then the mobile station shall delete any LAI,
TMSI, ciphering key sequence number stored in the SIM and set the update status to U2 NOT UPDATED. The
new MM state is MM IDLE substate ATTEMPTING TO UPDATE.4.7.3.2.6 Abnormal cases on the network
side.
The abnormal cases specified in section 4.7.3.1.6 apply with the exceptions for cases a and c in which in addition to the
P-TMSI and P-TMSI signature the old TMSI shall be considered occupied until the new TMSI is used by the MS in a
subsequent message.
4.7.4
to detach the IMSI for GPRS services only. Independent of the network operation mode, this procedure is used
by all kind of GPRS MSs;
as a combined GPRS detach procedure used by GPRS MSs operating in MS operation mode A or B to detach the
IMSI for GPRS and non-GPRS services or for non-GPRS services only, if the network operates in network
operation mode I; or
in the case of a network failure condition to indicate to the MS that a re-attach with successive activation of
previously active PDP contexts shall be performed.
After completion of a GPRS detach procedure or combined GPRS detach procedure for GPRS and non-GPRS services
the GMM context is released.
The GPRS detach procedure shall be invoked by the MS if the MS is switched off, the SIM card is removed from the
MS or if the GPRS or non-GPRS capability of the MS is disabled. The procedure may be invoked by the network to
detach the IMSI for GPRS services. The GPRS detach procedure causes the MS to be marked as inactive in the network
for GPRS services, non-GPRS services or both services.
If the GPRS detach procedure is performed, the PDP contexts are deactivated locally without peer to peer signalling
between the SM and LLC entities in the MS and the network.
ETSI
4.7.4.1
151
4.7.4.1.1
The GPRS detach procedure is initiated by the MS by sending a DETACH REQUEST message. The detach type
information element may indicate "GPRS detach with switching off", "GPRS detach without switching off", "IMSI
detach", "GPRS/IMSI detach with switching off" or "GPRS/IMSI detach without switching off". If the MS is not
switched off, timer T3321 shall be started after the DETACH REQUEST message has been sent. If the detach type
information element value indicates "IMSI Detach" the MS shall enter GMM-REGISTERED.IMSIDETACH_INITIATED, otherwise the MS shall enter the state GMM-DEREGISTERED-INITIATED. If the detach
type information element value indicates "IMSI Detach" or "GPRS/IMSI Detach", state MM IMSI DETACH
PENDING is entered.
If the detach type information element value indicates "GPRS detach without switching off " and the MS is attached for
GPRS and non-GPRS services and the network operates in network operation mode I, then if in the MS the timer T3212
is not already running, the timer T3212 shall be set to its initial value and restarted after the DETACH REQUEST
message has been sent.
4.7.4.1.2
When the DETACH REQUEST message is received by the network, the network shall send a DETACH ACCEPT
message to the MS, if the detach cause IE value indicates that the detach request has not been sent due to switching off.
If switching off was indicated, the procedure is completed when the network receives the DETACH REQUEST
message. The network and the MS shall deactivate the PDP contexts and deactivate the logical link(s), if any.
The MS is marked as inactive in the network for GPRS services; state GMM-DEREGISTERED is entered in the MS
and the network.
NOTE:
4.7.4.1.3
When the DETACH REQUEST message is received by the network, and if the detach cause IE value
indicates that the detach is not due to power off, the authentication and ciphering procedure as well as the
identification procedure may be performed.
When the DETACH REQUEST message is received by the network, a DETACH ACCEPT message shall be sent to the
MS, if the detach cause IE value indicates that the detach request has not been sent due to switching off. Depending on
the value of the detach type IE the following applies:
GPRS/IMSI detach:
The MS is marked as inactive in the network for GPRS and for non-GPRS services. The network and the MS shall
deactivate the PDP contexts and deactivate the logical link(s), if any. The States GMM-DEREGISTERED and MM
NULL are entered in both the MS and the network.
IMSI detach:
The MS is marked as inactive in the network for non-GPRS services. State MM NULL is entered in the MS and the
network.
4.7.4.1.4
ETSI
152
If the MS receives a message used in a GMM common procedure before the GPRS detach procedure has
been completed, this message shall be ignored and the GPRS detach procedure shall continue.
If a cell change occurs within the same RA before a DETACH ACCEPT message has been received, then the
cell update procedure shall be performed before completion of the detach procedure.
MS
Start T3321
Stop T3321
Network
DETACH REQUEST
DETACH ACCEPT
ETSI
4.7.4.2
4.7.4.2.1
153
The network initiates the GPRS detach procedure by sending a DETACH REQUEST message to the MS. The network
shall start timer T3322, shall deactivate the PDP contexts and deactivate the logical link(s), if any, and shall change to
state GMM-DEREGISTERED-INITIATED. The DETACH REQUEST message shall include a detach type IE. In
addition, the network may include a cause IE to specify the reason for the detach request.
If the detach type IE indicates "re-attach required", the MS shall perform a new attach procedure. The MS should also
activate PDP context(s) to replace any previously active PDP contexts.
NOTE: In some cases, user interaction may be required and then the MS cannot activate the PDP context(s)
automatically.
4.7.4.2.2
When receiving the DETACH REQUEST message and the detach type IE indicates "re-attach not required" or "reattach required", the MS shall deactivate the PDP contexts and deactivate the logical link(s), if any. The MS shall then
send a DETACH ACCEPT message to the network and shall change state to GMM-DEREGISTERED. The MS shall,
after the completion of the GPRS detach procedure, initiate a GPRS attach procedure if indicated by the network in the
detach type IE.A GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode A or B in network operation mode I, which receives an
DETACH REQUEST message with detach type indicating "re-attach required" or "re-attach not required" and no cause
code, is only detached for GPRS services in the network.
When receiving the DETACH REQUEST message and the detach type IE indicates "IMSI detach", the MS shall send a
DETACH ACCEPT message to the network.
If the detach type information element value indicates "re-attach required" or "re-attach not required" and the MS is
attached for GPRS and non-GPRS services and the network operates in network operation mode I, then if in the MS the
timer T3212 is not already running, the timer T3212 shall be set to its initial value and restarted.
Depending on the received cause code, the MS shall act as follows:
# 2 (IMSI unknown in HLR)
The MS shall set the update status to U3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED and shall delete any TMSI, LAI and
ciphering key sequence number. The new MM state is MM IDLE. The SIM shall be considered as invalid for
non-GPRS services until switching off or the SIM is removed.
A GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode A or B in network operation mode I, is still IMSI attached for
GPRS services in the network.
ETSI
154
# 3 (Illegal MS); or
# 6 (Illegal ME)
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according to
section 4.1.3.2) and shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and GPRS ciphering key sequence
number. The new GMM state is GMM-DEREGISTERED. The SIM shall be considered as invalid for GPRS
services until switching off or the SIM is removed.
A GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode A or B shall in addition set the update status to U3 ROAMING
NOT ALLOWED, shall delete any TMSI, LAI and ciphering key sequence number. The new MM state is MM
idle. The SIM shall be considered as invalid also for non-GPRS services until switching off or the SIM is
removed.
# 7 (GPRS services not allowed)
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according to
section 4.1.3.2) and shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and GPRS ciphering key sequence
number. The SIM shall be considered as invalid for GPRS services until switching off or the SIM is removed.
The new state is GMM-DEREGISTERED.
A GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode A or B in network operation mode I, is still IMSI attached for CS
services in the network.
# 8 (GPRS services and non-GPRS services not allowed)
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED and the update status to U3
ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according to section 4.1.3.2). Furthermore, it shall delete any PTMSI, P-TMSI signature, TMSI, RAI, LAI, ciphering key sequence number and GPRS ciphering key sequence
number and shall consider the SIM as invalid for GPRS and non-GPRS services until switching off or the SIM is
removed.
# 11
# 12
# 13
The MS shall delete any RAI or LAI, P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature and GPRS ciphering key sequence number,
shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according to section
4.1.3.2).
A GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode A or B shall in addition set the update status to U3 ROAMING
NOT ALLOWED and shall delete any TMSI, LAI and ciphering key sequence number. The new MM state is
MM IDLE.
The MS shall store the LAI or the PLMN identity in the appropriate forbidden list, i.e. in the "forbidden PLMN
list" for cause #11, in the list of "forbidden location areas for regional provision of service" for cause #12 or in
the list of "forbidden location areas for roaming" for cause #13. If #11or #13 was received, the MS shall
perform a PLMN selection instead of a cell selection.
Other cause values shall not impact the update status. Further actions of the MS are implementation dependent.
4.7.4.2.3
The network shall, upon receipt of the DETACH ACCEPT message, stop timer T3322 and shall change state to GMMDEREGISTERED.
4.7.4.2.4
ETSI
155
On the first expiry of the timer, the network shall retransmit the DETACH REQUEST message and shall start
timer T3322. This retransmission is repeated four times, i.e. on the fifth expiry of timer T3322, the GPRS detach
procedure shall be aborted and the network changes to state GMM-DEREGISTERED.
b) Low layer failure
The GPRS detach procedure is aborted and the network changes to state GMM-DEREGISTERED.
c) GPRS detach procedure collision
If the network receives a DETACH REQUEST message with "switching off" indicated, before the network
initiated GPRS detach procedure has been completed, both procedures shall be considered completed.
If the network receives a DETACH REQUEST message without "switching off" indicated, before the network
initiated GPRS detach procedure has been completed, the network shall send a DETACH ACCEPT message to
the MS.
d) GPRS detach and GPRS attach procedure collision
If the network receives an ATTACH REQUEST message before the network initiated GPRS detach procedure
has been completed, the network shall ignore the ATTACH REQUEST message, except when the detach type IE
value, sent in the DETACH REQUEST message, indicated that the MS shall perform a GPRS attach procedure.
In this case, the detach procedure is aborted and the GPRS attach procedure shall be progressed after the PDP
contexts have been deleted.
e) GPRS detach and routing area updating procedure collision
GPRS detach containing detach type "re-attach required" or "re-attach not required" ":
If the network receives a ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST message before the network initiated GPRS
detach procedure has been completed, the detach procedure shall be progressed, i.e. the ROUTING AREA
UPDATE REQUEST message shall be ignored.
GPRS detach containing detach type "IMSI detach":
If the network receives a ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST message before the network initiated GPRS
detach procedure has been completed, the network shall abort the detach procedure and shall progress the routing
area update procedure.
MS
Network
DETACH REQUEST
DETACH ACCEPT
Start T3322
Stop T3322
4.7.5
normal routing area updating to update the registration of the actual routing area of an MS in the network. This
procedure is used by GPRS MSs in MS operation mode C and by GPRS MSs in MS operation modes A or B that
are IMSI attached for GPRS and non-GPRS services if the network operates in network operation mode II or III;
combined routing area updating to update the registration of the actual routing and location area of an MS in the
network. This procedure is used by GPRS MSs in MS operation modes A or B that are IMSI attached for GPRS
and non-GPRS services provided that the network operates in network operation mode I; or
ETSI
156
periodic routing area updating. This procedure is used by GPRS MSs in MS operation mode C and by GPRS
MSs in MS operation modes A or B that are IMSI attached for GPRS or for GPRS and non-GPRS services
independent of the network operation mode;
IMSI attach for non-GPRS services when the MS is IMSI attached for GPRS services. This procedure is used by
GPRS MSs in MS operation modes A or B, if the network operates in network operation mode I.
resuming GPRS services when the RR sublayer indicated a resumption failure after dedicated mode was left, see
section 3.4.13.1.1.
Section 4.7.5.1 describes the routing area updating procedures for updating the routing area only. The combined routing
area updating procedure used to update both the routing and location area is described in section 4.7.5.2.
The routing area updating procedure is always initiated by the MS. It is only invoked in state GMM-REGISTERED.
To limit the number of subsequently rejected routing area update attempts, a routing area updating attempt counter is
introduced. The routing area updating attempt counter shall be incremented as specified in section 4.7.5.1.5. Depending
on the value of the routing area updating attempt counter, specific actions shall be performed. The routing area updating
attempt counter shall be reset when:
-
The mobile equipment shall contain a list of "forbidden location areas for roaming", as well as a list of "forbidden
location areas for regional provision of service". The handling of these lists is described in section 4.4.1.
User data transmission in the MS shall be suspended during the routing area updating procedure; user data reception
shall be possible. User data transmission in the network shall be suspended during the routing area updating procedure,
if a new P-TMSI is assigned.
4.7.5.1
Periodic routing area updating is used to periodically notify the availability of the MS to the network. The value of the
update type IE in the ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST message shall indicate "periodic updating". The
procedure is controlled in the MS by timer T3312. When timer T3312 expires, the periodic routing area updating
procedure is started. Start and reset of timer T3312 is described in section 4.7.2.2.
The normal routing area updating procedure is initiated when the MS detects a change of the routing area in state
GMM-REGISTERED or when the MS determines that GPRS resumption shall be performed. The ROUTING AREA
UPDATE REQUEST message shall always be the first data sent by the MS when a routing area border is crossed. The
routing area identification is broadcast on the broadcast channel(s). A normal routing area updating shall abort any
ongoing GMM procedure. Aborted GMM procedures shall be repeated after the normal routing area updating procedure
has been successfully performed. The value of the update type IE included in the message shall indicate "normal routing
area updating".
4.7.5.1.1
To initiate the normal routing area updating procedure, the MS sends the message ROUTING AREA UPDATE
REQUEST to the network, starts timer T3330 and changes to state GMM-ROUTING-AREA-UPDATINGINITIATED. The message ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST shall contain the P-TMSI signature when received
within a previous ATTACH ACCEPT or ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message.
4.7.5.1.2
The network may initiate GMM common procedures, e.g. the GMM authentication and ciphering procedure.
ETSI
4.7.5.1.3
157
Normal and periodic routing area updating procedure accepted by the network
If the routing area updating request has been accepted by the network, a ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT
message shall be sent to the MS. The network may assign a new P-TMSI and/or a new P-TMSI signature for the MS. If
a new P-TMSI and/or P-TMSI signature have been assigned to the MS, it/they shall be included in the ROUTING
AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message together with the routing area identification. The network shall change to state
GMM-COMMON-PROCEDURE-INITIATED and shall start the supervision timer T3350 as described in section 4.7.6.
If the LAI or PLMN identity contained in the ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message is a member of any of
the "forbidden" lists then any such entry shall be deleted.
Upon receipt of a ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message, the MS stores the received routing area
identification, stops timer T3330, shall reset the routing area updating attempt counter and sets the GPRS update status
to GU1 UPDATED. If the message contains a P-TMSI, the MS shall use this P-TMSI as new temporary identity for
GPRS services and shall store the new P-TMSI. If no P-TMSI was included by the network in the ROUTING AREA
UPDATING ACCEPT message, the old P-TMSI shall be kept. Furthermore, the MS shall store the P-TMSI signature if
received in the ROUTING AREA UPDATING ACCEPT message. If no P-TMSI signature was included in the
message, the old P-TMSI signature, if available, shall be deleted.
A ROUTING AREA UPDATE COMPLETE message shall be returned to the network if the ROUTING AREA
UPDATE ACCEPT message contained:
-
a P-TMSI; and/or
In this case the Receive N-PDU Numbers values valid in the MS, shall be included in the ROUTING AREA UPDATE
COMPLETE message.
4.7.5.1.4
Normal and periodic routing area updating procedure not accepted by the
network
If the routing area updating cannot be accepted, the network sends a ROUTING AREA UPDATE REJECT message to
the MS. An MS that receives a ROUTING AREA UPDATE REJECT message stops timer T3330 . The MS shall then
take different actions depending on the received reject cause value:
#3
(Illegal MS); or
#6
(Illegal ME)
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according to
section 4.1.3.2) and enter the state GMM-DEREGISTERED. Furthermore, it shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI
signature, RAI and GPRS ciphering key sequence number and shall consider the SIM as invalid for GPRS
services until switching off or the SIM is removed.
If the MS is IMSI attached via MM procedures, the MS shall in addition set the update status to U3 ROAMING
NOT ALLOWED, shall delete any TMSI, LAI and ciphering key sequence number. The new MM state is MM
IDLE. The SIM shall be considered as invalid also for non-GPRS services until switching off or the SIM is
removed.
#7
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according to
section 4.1.3.2.9) and shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and GPRS ciphering key sequence
number. The SIM shall be considered as invalid for GPRS services until switching off or the SIM is removed.
The new state is GMM-DEREGISTERED.
#9
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU2 NOT UPDATED (and shall store it according to section
4.1.3.2), enter the state GMM-DEREGISTERED, and shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and
GPRS ciphering key sequence number. Subsequently, the MS may automatically initiate the GPRS attach
procedure.
# 10
(Implicitly detached)
ETSI
158
The MS shall change to state GMM-DEREGISTERED.NORMAL-SERVICE. The MS shall then perform a new
attach procedure. The MS should also activate PDP context(s) to replace any previously active PDP contexts.
NOTE: In some cases, user interaction may be required and then the MS cannot activate the PDP context(s)
automatically.
# 11
# 12
# 13
The MS shall delete any RAI, P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature and GPRS ciphering key sequence number, shall set
the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according to section 4.1.3.2)
and enter the state GMM-DEREGISTERED.
If the MS is IMSI attached via MM procedures, the MS shall in addition set the update status to U3 ROAMING
NOT ALLOWED shall delete any TMSI, LAI and ciphering key sequence number and shall reset the location
update attempt counter. The new MM state is MM IDLE.
The MS shall store the LAI or the PLMN identity in the appropriate forbidden list, i.e. in the "forbidden PLMN
list" for cause #11, in the list of "forbidden location areas for regional provision of service" for cause #12 or in
the list of "forbidden location areas for roaming" for cause #13. If #11or #13 was received, the MS shall
perform a PLMN selection instead of a cell selection.
Other values are considered as abnormal cases. The specification of the MS behaviour in those cases is described in
section 4.7.5.1.5.
4.7.5.1.5
ETSI
159
the MS shall keep the GMM update status to GU1 UPDATED and changes state to GMMREGISTERED.NORMAL-SERVICE. The MS shall start timer T3311. When timer T3311 expires the routing
area updating procedure is triggered again.
If the routing area updating attempt counter is less than 5, and the stored RAI is different to the RAI of the current
serving cell or the GMM update status is different to GU1 UPDATED:
-
the MS shall start timer T3311, shall set the GPRS update status to GU2 NOT UPDATED and changes state to
GMM-REGISTERED.ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE.
the MS shall start timer T3302, shall set the GPRS update status to GU2 NOT UPDATED and shall change to
state GMM-REGISTERED.ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE or optionally to GMM-REGISTERED.PLMNSEARCH(see 4.2.4.1.2).
4.7.5.1.6
use the identification procedure followed by a P-TMSI reallocation procedure if the old P-TMSI is used
by the MS in a subsequent message.NOTE: Optionally, paging with IMSI may be used if paging with
old and new P-TMSI fails. Paging with IMSI causes the MS to re-attach as described in section 4.7.9.1.
b) Protocol error
If the ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST message has been received with a protocol error, the network
shall return a ROUTING AREA UPDATE REJECT message with one of the following reject causes:
#96:
#99:
ETSI
160
corresponding P-TMSI signatures shall be considered as valid until the old P-TMSI can be considered as invalid
by the network(see section 4.7.1.5). During this period the network acts as described for case a above.
MS
Start T3330
Stop T3330
If P-TMSI or
TMSI allocated,
or Receive N-PDU
Number needed
Network
ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST
If P-TMSI or
TMSI allocated,
or Receive N-PDU
Number needed
Start T3350
Start T3330
ROUTING AREA UPDATE REJECT
Stop T3330
Figure 4.7.5/1 GSM 04.08: Routing and combined routing area updating procedure
4.7.5.2
Within a combined routing area updating procedure the messages ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT and
ROUTING AREA UPDATE COMPLETE carry information for the routing area updating and the location area
updating.
4.7.5.2.1
The combined routing area updating procedure is initiated only by a GPRS MS operating in MS operation modes A or
B, if the MS is in state GMM-REGISTERED and if the network operates in network operation mode I:
-
when a GPRS MS that is IMSI attached for GPRS and non-GPRS services detects a change of the routing area in
state GMM-REGISTERED and MM-IDLE; or
when a GPRS MS that is IMSI attached for GPRS services wants to perform an IMSI attach for non-GPRS
services; or
after termination of a non-GPRS service via non-GPRS channels to update the association if the MS has changed
the LA during that non-GPRS service transaction.
The routing and location area identification are broadcast on the broadcast channel(s). A combined routing area
updating procedure shall abort any ongoing GMM procedure. Aborted GMM procedures shall be repeated after the
combined routing area updating procedure has been successfully performed. The ROUTING AREA UPDATE
REQUEST message shall always be the first message sent from the MS in the new routing area after routing area
change.
To initiate a combined routing area updating procedure the MS sends the message ROUTING AREA UPDATE
REQUEST to the network, starts timer T3330 and changes to state GMM-ROUTING-UPDATING-INITIATED and
MM LOCATION UPDATING PENDING. The value of the update type IE in the message shall indicate "combined
RA/LA updating". If for the last attempt to update the registration of the location area a MM specific procedure was
performed, the value of the update type IE in the ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST message shall indicate
"combined RA/LA updating with IMSI attach". Furthermore the MS shall include the TMSI status IE if no valid TMSI
is available.
ETSI
161
A GPRS MS in MS operation modes A or B that is in an ongoing circuit-switched transaction, shall initiate the
combined routing area updating procedure after the circuit-switched transaction has been released, if the MS has
changed the RA during the circuit-switched transaction and if the network operates in network operation mode I.
A GPRS MS in MS operation mode A shall initiate the combined routing area updating procedure with IMSI attach
after the circuit-switched transaction has been released if a GPRS attach was performed during the circuit-switched
transaction and provided that the network operates in network operation mode I.
A GPRS MS in MS operation mode A shall perform the normal routing area update procedure during an ongoing
circuit-switched transaction.
4.7.5.2.2
The network may initiate GMM common procedures, e.g. the GMM authentication and ciphering procedure.
4.7.5.2.3
Depending on the value of the update result IE received in the ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message, two
different cases can be distinguished:
Case 1) The update result IE value indicates "combined RA/LA": Routing and location area updating is
successful;
Case 2) The update result IE value indicates "RA only": Routing area updating is successful, but
updating is not successful.
location area
A ROUTING AREA UPDATE COMPLETE message shall be returned to the network if the ROUTING AREA
UPDATE ACCEPT message contains:
-
In the latter case, the Receive N-PDU Numbers that are valid in the MS shall be included in the ROUTING AREA
UPDATE COMPLETE message.
4.7.5.2.3.1
The description for normal routing area update as specified in section 4.7.5.1.3 shall be followed. In addition, the
following description for location area updating applies.
The handling at the receipt of the ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT depends on the value received in the update
result IE as specified below.
The TMSI reallocation may be part of the combined routing area updating procedure. The TMSI allocated is then
included in the ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message together with the location area identification (LAI).
The network shall, in this case, change to state GMM-COMMON-PROCEDURE-INITIATED and shall start the timer
T3350 as described in section 4.7.6.
The MS, receiving a ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message, stores the received location area identification,
stops timer T3330, enters state MM IDLE, reset the location update attempt counter and sets the update status to U1
UPDATED. If the ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message contains an IMSI, the mobile station is not allocated
any TMSI, and shall delete any TMSI accordingly. If the ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message contains a
TMSI, the MS shall use this TMSI as new temporary identity. The MS shall delete its old TMSI and shall store the new
TMSI. In this case, a ROUTING AREA UPDATE COMPLETE message is returned to the network. If neither a TMSI
nor an IMSI has been included by the network in the ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message, the old TMSI, if
any is available, shall be kept.
Any timer used for triggering the location updating procedure (e.g. T3211, T3212) shall be stopped if running.
The network receiving a ROUTING AREA UPDATE COMPLETE message stops timer T3350, changes to GMMREGISTERED state and considers the new TMSI as valid.
ETSI
4.7.5.2.3.2
162
The description for normal routing area update as specified in section 4.7.5.1.3 shall be followed. In addition, the
following description for location area updating applies.
The MS receiving the ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message takes one of the following actions depending on
the reject cause:
#2
#16
#17
#22
the MS shall keep the GMM update status GU1 UPDATED and changes state to GMMREGISTERED.ATTEMPTING-TO-UPDATE-MM. The MS shall start timer T3311. When timer T3311
expires the combined routing area update procedure indicating "combined RA/LA updating with IMSI
attach" is triggered again.
the MS shall start timer T3302 and shall change to state GMM-REGISTERED.ATTEMPTING-TOUPDATE-MM;
a GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode A shall then proceed with appropriate MM specific procedure;
a GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode B may then proceed with appropriate MM specific procedures.
The MM sublayer shall act as in network operation mode II as long as the combined GMM procedures are
not successful and no new RA is entered. The new MM state is IDLE.
Other values are considered as abnormal cases. The combined routing area updating shall be considered as failed for
GPRS and non-GPRS services. The specification of the MS behaviour in those cases is specified in section 4.7.5.2.5.
4.7.5.2.4
If the combined routing area updating cannot be accepted, the network sends a ROUTING AREA UPDATE REJECT
message to the MS. An MS that receives a ROUTING AREA UPDATE REJECT message stops timer T3330 and enters
state MM IDLE. The MS shall then take different actions depending on the received reject cause:
#3
(Illegal MS);
#6
#8
(Illegal ME); or
(GPRS services and non GPRS services not allowed)
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED and the update status to U3
ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according to section 4.1.3.2) and enter the state GMMDEREGISTERED. Furthermore, it shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, TMSI, RAI, LAI, ciphering key
sequence number and GPRS ciphering key sequence number and shall consider the SIM as invalid for GPRS and
non GPRS services until switching off or the SIM is removed.
#7
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according to
section 4.1.3.2) and shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and GPRS ciphering key sequence
number. The SIM shall be considered as invalid for GPRS services until switching off or the SIM is removed.
The new state is GMM-DEREGISTERED. If in the MS the timer T3212 is not already running, the timer shall
be set to its initial value and restarted.
ETSI
163
A GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode A or B in network operation mode I, is still IMSI attached for CS
services in the network.
#9
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU2 NOT UPDATED (and shall store it according to section
4.1.3.2), enter the state GMM-DEREGISTERED, and shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and
GPRS ciphering key sequence number. Subsequently, the MS may automatically initiate the GPRS attach
procedure.
A GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode A or B in network operation mode I, is still IMSI attached for CS
services in the network.
# 10
(Implicitly detached)
A GPRS MS operating in MS operation mode A or B in network operation mode I, is IMSI detached for both
GPRS and CS services in the network.
The MS shall change to state GMM-DEREGISTERED.NORMAL-SERVICE. The MS shall then perform a new
attach procedure. The MS should also activate PDP context(s) to replace any previously active PDP contexts.
NOTE: In some cases, user interaction may be required and then the MS cannot activate the PDP context(s)
automatically.
# 11
# 12
# 13
The MS shall set the GPRS update status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED and the update status to U3
ROAMING NOT ALLOWED (and shall store it according to section 4.1.3.2) and enter the state GMMDEREGISTERED. Furthermore, it shall delete any P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, TMSI, RAI, LAI, ciphering key
sequence number GPRS ciphering key sequence number and reset the location update attempt counter.
The MS shall store the LAI or the PLMN identity in the appropriate forbidden list, i.e. in the "forbidden PLMN
list" for cause #11, in the list of "forbidden location areas for regional provision of service" for cause #12 or in
the list of "forbidden location areas for roaming" for cause #13. If #11 or #13 was received, the MS shall then
perform a PLMN selection instead of a cell selection.
Other values are considered as abnormal cases. The specification of the MS behaviour in those cases is described in
section 4.7.5.2.5.
4.7.5.2.5
The abnormal cases specified in section 4.7.5.1.5 apply with the following modification:
If the GPRS routing area updating counter is less than 5, the MM state remains MM LOCATION UPDATING
PENDING.
If the GPRS routing area updating attempt counter is incremented according to section 4.7.5.1.5 the next actions depend
on the Location Area Identities (stored on SIM and the one of the current serving cell) and the value of the routing area
updating attempt counter.
if the update status is U1 UPDATED, and the stored LAI is equal to the one of the current serving cell and the
routing area updating attempt counter is smaller than 5, then the mobile station shall keep the update status to
U1 UPDATED, the new MM state is MM IDLE substate NORMAL SERVICE, or
if the update status is different from U1 UPDATED, or the stored LAI is different from the one of the current
serving cell, or the routing area updating attempt counter is greater or equal to 5, the mobile station shall delete
any LAI, TMSI, ciphering key sequence number stored in the SIM and set the update status to U2 NOT
UPDATED. The new MM state is MM IDLE substate ATTEMPTING TO UPDATE.
ETSI
4.7.5.2.6
164
The abnormal cases specified in section 4.7.5.1.6 apply with the exceptions for cases a and c in which in addition to the
P-TMSI and P-TMSI signature the old TMSI shall be considered occupied until the new TMSI is used by the MS in a
subsequent message.
4.7.6
A temporary mobile station identity for GPRS services, the Packet-TMSI (P-TMSI), is used for identification within the
radio interface signalling procedures. The structure of the P-TMSI is specified in GSM 03.03 [10]. The P-TMSI has
significance only within a routing area. Outside the routing area it has to be combined with the routing area
identification (RAI) to provide for an unambiguous identity.
The purpose of the P-TMSI reallocation procedure is to provide identity confidentiality, i.e. to protect a user against
being identified and located by an intruder (see GSM 02.09 [5] and 03.20 [34]).
Usually, P-TMSI reallocation is performed at least at each change of a routing area. (Such choices are left to the
network operator).
The reallocation of a P-TMSI is performed by the unique procedure defined in this section. This procedure can only be
initiated by the network in state GMM-REGISTERED.
P-TMSI can also be implicitly reallocated in the attach or routing area updating procedures. The implicit reallocation of
a P-TMSI is described in the corresponding sections.
NOTE:
4.7.6.1
Normally, the P-TMSI reallocation will take place in conjunction with another GMM procedure, e.g. at
routing area updating (see GSM 09.02 [37]).
The network initiates the P-TMSI reallocation procedure by sending a P-TMSI REALLOCATION COMMAND
message to the MS and starts the timer T3350.
The P-TMSI REALLOCATION COMMAND message contains a new combination of P-TMSI, RAI and optionally a
P-TMSI signature allocated by the network.
The network shall not send any user data during the P-TMSI reallocation procedure.
4.7.6.2
Upon receipt of the P-TMSI REALLOCATION COMMAND message, the MS stores the Routing Area Identifier
(RAI) and the P-TMSI and sends a P-TMSI REALLOCATION COMPLETE message to the network.
If a P-TMSI signature is present in the P-TMSI REALLOCATION COMMAND message, the MS shall store the new
P-TMSI signature and shall if available delete the old P-TMSI signature. If no P-TMSI signature is present in the PTMSI REALLOCATION COMMAND message, the old P-TMSI signature, if available, shall be kept.
4.7.6.3
Upon receipt of the P-TMSI REALLOCATION COMPLETE message, the network stops the timer T3350 and
considers the new P-TMSI as valid and the old one as invalid.
The GMM layer shall notify the LLC layer that the P-TMSI has been changed (see GSM 04.64 [76]).
4.7.6.4
ETSI
165
shall consider the new P-TMSI as valid if it is used by the MS (see section 4.7.1.5); or
may use the identification procedure followed by a new P-TMSI reallocation if the MS uses the old P-TMSI.
Network
P-TMSI REALLOCATION COMMAND
P-TMSI REALLOCATION COMPLETE
Start T3350
Stop T3350
4.7.7
to permit the network to check whether the identity provided by the MS is acceptable or not, see GSM 03.20
[13]);
to provide parameters enabling the MS to calculate a new GPRS ciphering key; and
ETSI
166
to let the network set the ciphering mode (ciphering/no ciphering) and algorithm.
authentication only;
authentication and the setting of the ciphering mode and the ciphering algorithm.
The cases in which the authentication and ciphering procedure shall be used are defined in GSM 02.09 [5].
The authentication and ciphering procedure is always initiated and controlled by the network. It shall be performed in a
non ciphered mode because of the following reasons:
-
the network cannot decipher a ciphered AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING RESPONSE from an
unauthorised MS and put it on the black list; and
to be able to define a specific point in time from which on a new GPRS ciphering key should be used instead of
the old one.
The network should not send any user data during the authentication and ciphering procedure.
4.7.7.1
The network initiates the authentication and ciphering procedure by transferring an AUTHENTICATION AND
CIPHERING REQUEST message across the radio interface and starts timer T3360. The AUTHENTICATION AND
CIPHERING REQUEST message shall contain all parameters necessary to calculate the response parameters when
authentication is performed (see GSM 03.20 [13]).
If authentication is requested, then the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REQUEST message shall contain the
GPRS ciphering key sequence number, allocated to the GPRS ciphering key and the RAND. If authentication is not
requested, then the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REQUEST message shall contain neither the GPRS
ciphering key sequence number nor the RAND.
If ciphering is requested, then the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REQUEST message shall indicate the
GPRS ciphering algorithm.
The network includes the A&C reference number information element in the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING
REQUEST message. Its value is chosen in order to link an AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REQUEST in a
RA with its RESPONSE. The A&C reference number value might be based on the RA Colour Code value.
Additionally, the network may request the MS to include its IMEISV in the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING
RESPONSE message.
4.7.7.2
An MS that is attached to GPRS shall be ready to respond upon an AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING
REQUEST message at any time. If the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REQUEST message includes the
authentication parameters RAND and GPRS CKSN, then upon receipt of the message, the MS processes the challenge
information and sends an AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING RESPONSE message to the network. The value of
the received A&C reference number information element shall be copied into the A&C reference number information
element in the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING RESPONSE message.The new GPRS ciphering key calculated
from the challenge information shall overwrite the previous one. It shall be stored and shall be loaded into the ME
before the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING RESPONSE message is transmitted. The GPRS ciphering key
sequence number shall be stored together with the calculated key.
If the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REQUEST message does not include the authentication parameters
RAND and GPRS CKSN, then upon receipt of the message, the MS replies by sending an AUTHENTICATION AND
CIPHERING RESPONSE message to the network.
The GMM layer shall notify the LLC layer if ciphering shall be used or not and if yes which algorithm and GPRS
ciphering key that shall be used (see GSM 04.64 [76]).
ETSI
4.7.7.3
167
Upon receipt of the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING RESPONSE message, the network stops the timer T3360
and checks the validity of the response (see GSM 03.20 [13]). For this, it may use the A&C reference number
information element within the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING RESPONSE message to determine whether
the response is correlating to the last request that was sent.
The GMM layer shall notify the LLC sublayer if ciphering shall be used or not and if yes which algorithm and GPRS
ciphering key that shall be used (see GSM 04.64 [76]).
4.7.7.4
The security parameters for authentication and ciphering are tied together in sets, i.e. from a challenge parameter
RAND both the authentication response SRES and the GPRS ciphering key can be computed given the secret key
associated to the IMSI.
In order to allow start of ciphering on a logical link without authentication, GPRS ciphering key sequence numbers are
introduced. The sequence number is managed by the network such that the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING
REQUEST message contains the sequence number allocated to the key which may be computed from the RAND
parameter carried in that message.
The MS stores this number with the key, and includes the corresponding sequence number in the ROUTING AREA
UPDATE REQUEST and ATTACH REQUEST messages. If the sequence number is deleted, the associated key shall
be considered as invalid.
The network may choose to start ciphering with the stored key (under the restrictions given in GSM 02.09) if the stored
sequence number and the one given from the MS are equal and the previously negotiated ciphering algorithm is known
and supported in the network. When ciphering is requested at GPRS attach, the authentication and ciphering procedure
shall be performed since the MS does not store the ciphering algorithm at detach.
Upon GPRS attach, if ciphering is to be used, an AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REQUEST message shall
be sent to the MS to start ciphering.
If the GPRS ciphering key sequence number stored in the network does not match the GPRS ciphering key sequence
number received from the MS in the ATTACH REQUEST message, then the network should authenticate the MS.
The MS starts ciphering after sending the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING RESPONSE message. The SGSN
starts ciphering when a valid AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING RESPONSE is received from the MS.
As an option, the network may decide to continue ciphering without sending an AUTHENTICATION AND
CIPHERING REQUEST message after receiving a ROUTING AREA UPDATE REQUEST message with a valid
GPRS ciphering key sequence number. Both the MS and the network shall use the latest ciphering parameters. The
SGSN starts ciphering when sending the ciphered ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message to the MS. The MS
starts ciphering after receiving a valid ciphered ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message from the network.
4.7.7.5
If authentication and ciphering fails, i.e. if the response is not valid, the network considers whether the MS has used the
P-TMSI or the IMSI for identification.
-
If the P-TMSI has been used, the network may decide to initiate the identification procedure. If the IMSI given
by the MS differs from the one the network had associated with the P-TMSI, the authentication should be
restarted with the correct parameters. If the IMSI provided by the MS is the expected one (i.e. authentication has
really failed), the network should proceed as described below.
If the IMSI has been used, or the network decides not to try the identification procedure, an
AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REJECT message should be transferred to the MS.
Upon receipt of an AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REJECT message, the MS shall set the GPRS update
status to GU3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED and shall delete the P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature, RAI and GPRS
ciphering key sequence number stored. If available, also the TMSI, LAI, ciphering key sequence number shall be
deleted and the update status shall be set to U3 ROAMING NOT ALLOWED. The SIM shall be considered as
invalid until switching off or the SIM is removed.
ETSI
168
If the AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REJECT message is received, the MS shall abort any GMM
procedure, shall stop the timers T3310 and T3330 (if running) and shall enter state GMM-DEREGISTERED.
4.7.7.6
If one or more of the information elements in the ATTACH REQUEST message differs from the ones received
within the previous ATTACH REQUEST message, the network shall not treat the authentication any further and
proceed with the GPRS attach procedure ; or
If the information elements do not differ, then the network shall not treat any further this new ATTACH
REQUEST.
ETSI
MS
169
Network
AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING REQUEST
Start T3360
AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING RESPONSE
Stop T3360
4.7.8
Identification procedure
The identification procedure is used by the network to request an MS to provide specific identification parameters to the
network e.g. International Mobile Subscriber Identity, International Mobile Equipment Identity (see GSM 03.03). For
the presentation of the IMEI, the requirements of GSM 02.09 apply.
4.7.8.1
The network initiates the identification procedure by transferring an IDENTITY REQUEST message to the MS and
starts the timer T3370. The IDENTITY REQUEST message specifies the requested identification parameters in the
identity type information element.
4.7.8.2
An MS that has been attached to GPRS shall be ready to respond to an IDENTITY REQUEST message at any time.
Upon receipt of the IDENTITY REQUEST message the MS sends back an IDENTITY RESPONSE message. The
IDENTITY RESPONSE message shall contain the identification parameters as requested by the network.
4.7.8.3
Upon receipt of the IDENTITY RESPONSE the network shall stop timer T3370.
4.7.8.4
ETSI
170
d) Collision of an identification procedure with a GPRS attach procedure when the identification procedure has
been caused by a GPRS attach procedure
If the network receives an ATTACH REQUEST message before the ongoing identification procedure has been
completed and a GPRS attach procedure is pending (i.e. an ATTACH ACCEPT/REJECT message has to be sent as
an answer to an earlier ATTACH REQUEST message), then:
-
If one or more of the information elements in the ATTACH REQUEST message differs from the ones received
within the previous ATTACH REQUEST message, the network shall proceed with the GPRS attach procedure;
or
If the information elements do not differ, then the network shall not treat any further this new ATTACH
REQUEST.
Network
IDENTITY REQUEST
IDENTITY RESPONSE
Start T3370
Stop T3370
4.7.9
4.7.9.1
Paging procedure
Paging for GPRS services
Paging is used by the network to identify the cell the MS has currently selected, or to prompt the mobile to re-attach if
necessary as a result of network failure. If the MS is not GPRS attached when it receives a paging for GPRS services,
the MS shall ignore the paging.
4.7.9.1.1
The network shall initiate the paging procedure for GPRS services using P-TMSI when GMM signalling messages or
user data is pending to be sent to the MS while the Mobile Reachable timer is running. The network may page only
GPRS MSs which are GMM-REGISTERED and identified by a local P-TMSI.
To initiate the procedure the GMM entity requests the RR sublayer to start paging (see chapter 3 and GSM 04.60 [75])
and starts timer T3313. Upon reception of a paging indication, the MS shall respond to the paging (see GSM 04.07 [20]
and GSM 03.60 [74]).
The network shall stop timer T3313 when a response is received from the MS. When the timer T3313 expires the
network may reinitiate paging.
ETSI
171
The network shall stop timer T3313 when a response is received from the MS and shall start the READY timer. When
the timer T3313 expires the network may reinitiate paging.
4.7.9.1.2
Paging for GPRS services using IMSI is an abnormal procedure used for error recovery in the network.
The network may initiate paging using IMSI if the P-TMSI is not available due to a network failure.
To initiate the procedure the GMM entity in the network requests the RR sublayer to start paging (see chapter 3 and
GSM 04.60 [75]).
Upon reception of a paging indication for GPRS services using IMSI, the MS shall locally deactivate any active PDP
contexts and locally detach from GPRS. The local detach includes deleting any RAI, P-TMSI, P-TMSI signature and
GPRS ciphering key sequence number stored, setting the GPRS update status to GU2 NOT UPDATED and changing
state to GMM-DEREGISTERED.
After performing the local detach, the MS shall then perform a GPRS attach or combined GPRS attach procedure.
After performing the attach, a MS should activate PDP context(s) to replace any previously active PDP context(s).
NOTE 1: In some cases, user interaction may be required and then the MS cannot activate the PDP context(s)
automatically.
NOTE 2: The MS does not respond to the paging except with the Attach Request. Hence timer T3313 in the
network is not used when paging with IMSI.
NOTE 3: Paging without DRX parameters may require a considerable extension of the paging duration.
4.7.9.2
The network may initiate the paging procedure for non-GPRS services when the MS is IMSI attached for non-GPRS
services. To initiate the procedure the GMM entity requests the RR sublayer to initiate paging (see chapter 3 and GSM
04.60 [75]) for non-GPRS services. The MS identity used for paging shall be the allocated TMSI if acknowledged by
the MS, otherwise the IMSI.
4.7.10
If the MS receives a GMM STATUS message no state transition and no specific action shall be taken as seen from the
radio interface, i.e. local actions are possible. The actions to be taken on receiving a GMM STATUS message in the
network are an implementation dependent option.
4.7.11
The GMM-AA entity within the MM sublayer (see GSM 04.07) supports SM message routing for anonymous PDP
context handling independently of the GMM procedures described throughout section 4.7 as described in section
6.1.1.1. There are no dedicated signalling procedures specified for the GMM-AA entity.
An AA-READY timer is implemented in the GMM-AA entity. This timer is used to supervise the time an anonymous
access may be active without user data transfer.
4.7.11.1
MS side
The AA-READY timer value shall either be the default value or a value set by the network and sent to the MS by means
of an SM message. The AA-READY timer shall be reset and restarted in the MS when the GMM-AA entity receives
an indication from lower layers that an LLC frame has been transmitted on the radio interface. When the AA-READY
timer expires or a routing area border is crossed, the MS shall deactivate the anonymous access locally, i.e. no
signalling messages are exchanged between the MS and the network.
While the AA-READY timer is running, the MS shall perform cell updates when a new cell is selected within the same
RA.
ETSI
4.7.11.2
172
Network side
The AA-READY timer value shall either be the default value or a value received from the MS and possibly modified by
the network and sent to the MS by means of an SM message. The AA-READY timer shall be reset and restarted by the
network when the GMM-AA entity receives an indication from lower layers that an LLC frame has been successfully
received by the network. When the AA-READY timer expires, the network shall deactivate the anonymous access
locally, i.e. no signalling messages are exchanged between the network and the MS.
To account for the LLC frame uplink transmission delay, the AA-READY timer value should be slightly shorter in the
network than in the MS. This is a network implementation issue.
4.7.12
The GMM information message support is optional in the network. The MM information procedure may be invoked by
the network at any time during an established GMM context.
4.7.12.1
The GMM information procedure consists only of the GMM INFORMATION message sent from the network to the
mobile station. During an established GMM context, the network may send none, one, or more GMM INFORMATION
messages to the mobile station. If more than one GMM INFORMATION message is sent, the messages need not have
the same content.
4.7.12.2
When the mobile station (supporting the GMM information message) receives an GMM INFORMATION message, it
shall accept the message and optionally use the contents to update appropriate information stored within the mobile
station.
If the mobile station does not support the GMM information message the mobile station shall ignore the contents of the
message and return an GMM STATUS message with cause #97.
5.1
Overview
5.1.1
General
This section describes the call control (CC) protocol, which is one of the protocols of the Connection Management
(CM) sublayer (see GSM 04.07).
Every mobile station must support the call control protocol. If a mobile station does not support any bearer capability at
all then it shall respond to a SETUP message with a RELEASE COMPLETE message as specified in section 5.2.2.2.
In the call control protocol, more than one CC entity are defined. Each CC entity is independent from each other and
shall communicate with the correspondent peer entity using its own MM connection. Different CC entities use different
transaction identifiers.
With a few exceptions this Technical Specification describes the call control protocol only with regard to two peer
entities. The call control entities are described as communicating finite state machines which exchange messages across
the radio interface and communicate internally with other protocol (sub)layers. This description is only normative as far
as the consequential externally observable behaviour is concerned.
Certain sequences of actions of the two peer entities compose "elementary procedures" which are used as a basis for the
description in this section. These elementary procedures may be grouped into the following classes:
-
ETSI
miscellaneous procedures.
173
The terms "mobile originating" or "mobile originated" (MO) are used to describe a call initiated by the mobile station.
The terms "mobile terminating" or "mobile terminated" (MT) are used to describe a call initiated by the network.
Figure 5.1a/GSM 04.08 gives an overview of the main states and transitions on the mobile station side.
The MS side extension figure 5.1a.1/GSM 04.08 shows how for the Network Initiated MO call the MS reaches state
U1.0 from state U0 $(CCBS)$.
Figure 5.1b/GSM 04.08 gives an overview of the main states and transitions on the network side.
The Network side extension figure 5.1b.1/GSM 04.08 shows for Network Initiated MO Calls the Network reaches state
N1.0 from state N0 $(CCBS)$.
ETSI
ETSI
U3 MO CALL
PROCEEDING
MNCC-SYNC. IND
(res. ass)
(res. ass)
MMCC.SYNC.IND
(*)
MNCCPROGRESS. IND
DI (PROGRESS)
MNCC-CALL.
PROC.IND.
DI (CALL PROC)
U1
CALL INIT
DI (CONN)
DI (ALERT)
DI (CONN)
U19 RELEASE
REQUEST
U10
ACTIVE
U7 CALL
RECEIVED
DR (ALERT)
MNCC-ALERT.REQ.
U6
CALL PRESENT
MNCC-SYNC-IND
(res.ass)
(*)
MMCC.SYNC.IND.
(res.ass.)
NOTE:
DR(MESSAGE) = MMCC_DATA_REQ(MESSAGE)
DI (MESSAGE) = MMCC_DATA_IND (MESSAGE)
DR (CONN)
U9 MT CALL
CONFIRMED
DR (CALL CONF)
MNCC-CALL.CONF.REQ.
DI (CONN ACK)
U8 CONNECT
REQUEST
DI (DISC)
MNCC-SETUP
COMPL. IND
STATES
U3,4,7,8,9,10
MNCC-DISC-IND
U12 DISCONNECT
INDICATION
MNCC. REL.REQ.
DR (REL)
MNCC-SETUP-IND
DI (REL COM)
MNCC. DISC.REQ.
DR (DISC)
U11 DISCONNECT
REQUEST
DI (DISC)
DR (REL)
MNCC-DISC-IND
MNCC-SETUP-CNF
DR (CONN ACK)
DI (REL)
DR (REL. COM)
MNCC-REL-IND
MMCC-REL-REQ
MNCC-REL-CNF
MMCC-REL-REQ
U0
NULL
174
DI (CONN)
U4 CALL
DELIVERED
MNCC-ALERT-IND
DI (ALERT)
DR (SETUP)
MNCC.EST.CNF
MMCC-EST-REQ
MNCC-SETUP.REQ.
175
U0
NULL
MMCC.PROMPT.IND
MNCC.PROMPT.IND
U0.2
PROMPT PRESENT
DR (START_CC)
U0.3
WAIT FOR NW INFO
DI (CC ESTABLISHMENT)
U0.4
CC-EST. PRESENT
U0.5
CC_EST. CONFIRMED
DI (RECALL)
MNCC.RECALL.IND
U0.6
RECALL_PRESENT
MNCC.SETUP.REQ
DR (SETUP)
U1
CALL INITIATED
Figure5.1a.1/GSM 04.08:
Overview call control protocol/MS side, extension:
ETSI
N3 MO CALL
ETSI
DR (CONN)
N28 CONNECT
INDICATION
DR (CONN)
STATES N1, 3, 4,
7, 8, 9; 10, 28
MNCC. SETUP.
COMPL. IND.
DI (DISC)
DI (CONN ACK)
N4 CALL
DELIVERED
DR (ALERT)
DR (REL)
N10
ACTIVE
N19 RELEASE
REQUEST
DI (REL COM)
MNCC.REL.CNF.
MMCC.REL.REQ.
N0
NULL
N8 CONNECT
REQUEST
MNCC.SETUP.CNF.
MNCC. SETUP.
COMPL. REQ.
DR (CONN ACK)
DI (CONN)_
MNCC.CALL.
CONF.IND
DI (CONN)
N7 CALL
RECEIVED
MNCC.ALERT.IND
DI (ALERT)
MNCC.SETUP.CNF
N9 MT CALL
CONFIRMED
DI (CALL CONF)
N6
CALL PRESENT
DR (SETUP)
DI (REL)
DR (DISC)
DI (DISC)
DR (REL)
MNCC.DISC.IND
DR (REL COM),
MNCC.REL.IND,
MMCC.REL.REQ.
MMCC.EST.REQ.
(mobile ID)
176
NOTE:
DR(MESSAGE) = MMCC_DATA_REQ(MESSAGE)
DI (MESSAGE) = MMCC_DATA_IND (MESSAGE)
DR (PROGRESS)
PROCEEDING
MNCC.
PROGRESS.
REQ.
MNCC.
SETUP. RSP
DR (CALL PROC)
N1
CALL INIT
MNCC.SETUP.IND.
MMCC.EST.IND (SETUP)
177
N0
NULL
MNCC.CC_CONN.REQ
MMCC.CC_CONN.REQ
N0.2
CC_CONN_PENDING
MMCC.EST.IND (START CC)
N0.3
NW_ANSWER_PENDING
DR (CC_ESTABLISH)
N0.4
CC-EST.PESENT
DI (CC_EST_CONF)
N0.5
CC_EST. CONFIRMED
DR (RECALL)
N0.6
RECALL_PRESENT
DI (SETUP)
N1
CALL_INITIATED
5.1.2
5.1.2.1
The states which may exist on the mobile station side of the radio interface are defined in this section.
NOTE:
States U0.1, U0.2, U0.3, U0.4, U0.5, U0.6, U26, and U27 are GSM specific. All other states are ITU-T
defined.
5.1.2.1.1
No call exists.
5.1.2.1.2
This state exists for a mobile originating call, when the mobile station requests the establishment of a MM connection.
ETSI
5.1.2.1.2a
178
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the network has prompted the mobile station to establish a CC
connection but the mobile station has not yet responded.
NOTE:
5.1.2.1.2b
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the mobile station has responded to the prompt from the network to
establish a CC connection and the mobile station is waiting for further information from the network.
5.1.2.1.2c
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the mobile station has received a CC-establishment request but has
not yet responded.
NOTE:
5.1.2.1.2d
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the mobile station has sent the acknowledgement that the mobile
station has received all the CC information that is needed.
5.1.2.1.2e
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the mobile station has received a recall request but has not yet
responded.
NOTE:
5.1.2.1.3
This state exists for a mobile originating call, when the MS requests call establishment from the network.
5.1.2.1.4
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the mobile station has received acknowledgement that the network
has received all call information necessary to effect call establishment.
5.1.2.1.5
This state exists for a mobile originating call, when the calling mobile station has received an indication that remote
user alerting has been initiated.
5.1.2.1.6
This state exists for a mobile terminating call when the mobile station has received a call establishment request but has
not yet responded.
5.1.2.1.7
This state exists for a mobile terminating call when the mobile station has indicated alerting but has not yet answered.
5.1.2.1.8
This state exists for a mobile terminating call, when the mobile station has answered the call and is waiting to be
awarded the call.
ETSI
5.1.2.1.9
179
This state exists for a mobile terminating call when the mobile station has sent acknowledgement that the mobile station
has received all call information necessary to effect call establishment.
5.1.2.1.10
Active (U10)
This state exists for a mobile terminating call when the MS has answered the call. This state exists for a mobile
originating call when the MS has received an indication that the remote user has answered the call.
5.1.2.1.11
This state exists when the mobile station has requested the network to clear the end-to-end connection (if any) and is
waiting for a response.
5.1.2.1.12
This state exists when the mobile station has received an invitation to disconnect because the network has disconnected
the end-to-end connection (if any).
5.1.2.1.13
This state exists when the MS has requested the network to release and is waiting for a response.
5.1.2.1.14
This state exists when the mobile station has sent a request to the network for a new mode but has not yet received an
answer.
5.1.2.1.15
This state exists when the mobile station has received a request from the network for a new mode and has not yet sent a
response to this request.
5.1.2.2
NOTE:
The call states that may exist on the network side of the radio interface are defined in this section.
5.1.2.2.1
No call exists.
5.1.2.2.2
This state exists for a mobile terminating call, when the network requests the establishment of a MM connection.
5.1.2.2.2a
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the network has requested the mobile station to establish a CC
connection.
5.1.2.2.2b
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the mobile station has established a CC connection upon the request
of the network, but the network has not yet informed the mobile station of the reason for the networks action.
ETSI
5.1.2.2.2c
180
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the network has sent a CC establishment request but has not yet
received a satisfactory response.
5.1.2.2.2d
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the network has received acknowledgement that the mobile station
has received all call information necessary to effect call establishment.5.1.2.2.2e Recall present (N0.6) $(CCBS)$
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the network has sent a recall request but has not yet received a
satisfactory response.
5.1.2.2.3
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the network has received a call establishment request but has not yet
responded.
5.1.2.2.4
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the network has sent acknowledgement that the network has
received all call information necessary to effect call establishment.
5.1.2.2.5
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the network has indicated that remote user alerting has been
initiated.
5.1.2.2.6
This state exists for a mobile terminating call when the network has sent a call establishment request but has not yet
received a satisfactory response.
5.1.2.2.7
This state exists for a mobile terminating call when the network has received an indication that the mobile station is
alerting but has not yet received an answer.
5.1.2.2.8
This state exists for a mobile terminating call when the network has received an answer but the network has not yet
awarded the call.
5.1.2.2.9
This state exists for a mobile terminating call when the network has received acknowledgement that the mobile station
has received all call information necessary to effect call establishment.
5.1.2.2.10
Active (N10)
This state exists for a mobile terminating call when the network has awarded the call to the called mobile station. This
state exists for a mobile originating call when the network has indicated that the remote user has answered the call.
5.1.2.2.11
Not used
5.1.2.2.12
This state exists when the network has disconnected the end- to-end connection (if any) and has sent an invitation to
disconnect the mobile station to network connection.
ETSI
5.1.2.2.13
181
This state exists when the network has requested the MS to release and is waiting for a response.
5.1.2.2.14
This state exists when the network has received a request from the mobile station for a new mode but has not yet sent a
response.
5.1.2.2.15
This state exists when the network has sent a request to the mobile station for a new mode but has not yet received an
answer.
5.1.2.2.16
This state exists for a mobile originating call when the network has indicated that the remote user has answered the call
and the network is waiting for acknowledgement by the mobile station.
5.2
Establishment of a call is initiated by request of upper layer in either the mobile station or the network; it consists of:
-
the establishment of a CC connection between the mobile station and the network;
Whenever it is specified in GSM 04.08, section 5 that the mobile station shall attach the user connection, this means that
the mobile station shall activate the codec or interworking function as soon as an appropriate channel is available. The
mobile station shall de-activate the codec or interworking function whenever an appropriate channel is no longer
available. As soon as an appropriate channel is (again) available, the codec or interworking function shall be reactivated. If a new order to attach the user connection is received, the new order shall supersede the previous one.
A channel shall be considered as appropriate if it is consistent with the possibly negotiated bearer capability applicable
for the actual phase of the call. The mobile station shall not consider a channel as not appropriate because the type of
the channel (full rate/half rate) is not the preferred one. If:
-
the user connection has to be attached but no appropriate channel is available for a contiguous time of 30
seconds; or if
5.2.1
The call control entity of the mobile station initiates establishment of a CC connection by requesting the MM sublayer
to establish a mobile originating MM connection and entering the "MM connection pending" state. There are two kinds
of a mobile originating call: basic call and emergency call. The request to establish an MM connection shall contain a
parameter to specify whether the call is a basic or an emergency call. This information may lead to specific qualities of
services to be provided by the MM sublayers. Timer T303 is started when the CM SERVICE REQUEST message is
sent.
For mobile stations supporting eMLPP basic calls may optionally have an associated priority level as defined in
GSM 03.67. This information may also lead to specified qualities of service to be provided by the MM sublayers.
ETSI
182
While being in the "MM connection pending" state, the call entity of the mobile station may cancel the call prior to
sending the first call control message according to the rules given in section 4.5.1.7.
Having entered the "MM connection pending" state, upon MM connection establishment, the call control entity of the
mobile station sends a setup message to its peer entity. This setup message is
-
It then enters the "call initiated" state. Timer T303 is not stopped.
The setup message shall contain all the information required by the network to process the call. In particular, the
SETUP message shall contain the called party address information.
If timer T303 elapses in the "MM connection pending" state, the MM connection in progress shall be aborted and the
user shall be informed about the rejection of the call.
5.2.1.1
Call initiation
The "call initiated" state is supervised by timer T303.For normal MO calls, this timer will have already been started
after entering the "MM connection pending" state. For network-initiated MO calls this timer will be started in the recall
present state as defined in section 5.2.3.4
When the call control entity of the mobile station is in the "call initiated" state and if it receives:
i) a CALL PROCEEDING message, it shall proceed as described in section 5.2.1.3;
ii) an ALERTING message, it shall proceed as described in section 5.2.1.5;
iii) a CONNECT message, it shall proceed as described in section 5.2.1.6;
iv) a RELEASE COMPLETE message it shall proceed as described in section 5.2.1.2.
Abnormal case:
-
If timer T303 elapses in the "call initiated" state before any of the CALL PROCEEDING, ALERTING,
CONNECT or RELEASE COMPLETE messages has been received, the clearing procedure described in
section 5.4 is performed.
5.2.1.2
In the "null" or "recall present" states, upon receipt of a setup message (a SETUP message or an EMERGENCY
SETUP message, see section 5.2.1.1), the call control entity of the network enters the "call initiated" state. It shall then
analyse the call information contained in the setup message.
i) If, following the receipt of the setup message, the call control entity of the network determines that the call
information received from the mobile station is invalid (e.g. invalid number), then the network shall initiate call
clearing as defined in section 5.4 with one of the following cause values:
#1
#3
# 22
"number changed"
# 28
ii) If, following the receipt of the setup message, the call control entity of the network determines that a requested
service is not authorized or is not available, it shall initiate call clearing in accordance with section 5.4.2 with
one of the following cause values:
#8
# 57
ETSI
183
# 58
# 63
# 65
iii) Otherwise, the call control entity of the network shall either:
-
send a CALL PROCEEDING message to its peer entity to indicate that the call is being processed; and enter
the "mobile originating call proceeding" state.
or: send an ALERTING message to its peer entity to indicate that alerting has been started at the called user
side; and enter the "call received" state.
or: send a CONNECT message to its peer entity to indicate that the call has been accepted at the called user
side; and enter the "connect request" state.
The call control entity of the network may insert bearer capability information element(s) in the CALL
PROCEEDING message to select options presented by the mobile station in the Bearer Capability information
element(s) of the SETUP message. The bearer capability information element(s) shall contain the same
parameters as received in the SETUP except those presenting a choice. Where choices were offered, appropriate
parameters indicating the results of those choices shall be included.
The CALL_PROCEEDING message may also contain the priority of the call in the case where eMLPP is
applied and where the network has assigned a different priority to the call than that requested by the user, or
where the user has not requested a priority and the network has assigned a default priority. Mobile stations
supporting eMLPP shall indicate this priority level to higher sublayers and store this information for the duration
of the call for further action. Mobile stations not supporting eMLPP shall ignore this information element if
provided in a CALL PROCEEDING message.
The call control entity of the network having entered the "mobile originating call proceeding" state, the network may
initiate the assignment of a traffic channel according to section 5.2.1.9 (early assignment).
MS
Network
+-----------------------------+
|
|
|
(EMERGENCY) SETUP
|
|
----------------------> |
|
|
+-----------------------------+
CALL_PROCEEDING
< - - - - - - - - - - ALERTING
< - - - - - - - - - - CONNECT
< - - - - - - - - - - RELEASE COMPLETE
< - - - - - - - - - - -
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
-
Figure 5.2/GSM 04.08: Mobile originated call initiation and possible subsequent responses
5.2.1.3
Having entered the "call initiated" state, when the call control entity of the mobile station receives a CALL
PROCEEDING message, it shall stop timer T303; start timer T310 unless
-
the CALL PROCEEDING message contains a progress indicator IE specifying progress description #1, #2, or
#64; or
it has received a PROGRESS message containing a progress indicator IE specifying progress description #1, #2,
or #64 prior to the CALL PROCEEDING message
ETSI
184
Abnormal case:
If timer T310 elapses before any of the ALERTING, CONNECT or DISCONNECT messages has been received,
the mobile station shall perform the clearing procedure described in section 5.4.
MS
Network
+---------------------------+
|
|
|
CALL PROCEEDING
|
|
<-------------------|
|
|
+---------------------------+
Figure 5.3/GSM 04.08: Call proceeding sequence at mobile originating call establishment
5.2.1.4
In this section, the term "interworking" is used only in the meaning of interworking with a network other than PLMN or
ISDN, not as interworking between PLMN and ISDN since this is the normal case. In this sense, PLMN and ISDN are
seen within the same environment, called the PLMN/ISDN environment.
5.2.1.4.1
During call establishment, the call may leave a PLMN/ISDN environment; e.g., because of interworking with another
network, with a non-PLMN/ISDN user, or with non-PLMN/ISDN equipment within the called user's premises; the call
may also return to a PLMN/ISDN environment. When such situations occur, the network may send a progress indicator
information element to the calling mobile station either:
a) in an appropriate call control message, if a state change is required (e.g. ALERTING or CONNECT); or,
b) in the PROGRESS message, if no state change is appropriate.
This progress indicator information element shall contain one of the following progress description values:
a) #1 "call is not end-to-end PLMN/ISDN; further call progress information may be available in-band".
b) #2 "destination address is non-PLMN/ISDN".
c) #4 "call has returned to PLMN/ISDN.
See also sections 5.5.1 and 5.5.6 for further reactions of the mobile station.
5.2.1.4.2
In order to inform the mobile station that the call is progressing in the PLMN/ISDN environment the network may send
a progress indicator information element to the calling mobile station either:
a) in an appropriate call control message, if a state change is required (e.g., ALERTING or CONNECT); or
b) in the PROGRESS message, if no state change is appropriate.
This progress indicator information element shall contain progress description value #32 "Call is end-to-end
ISDN/PLMN". See also section 5.5.6 for further reactions of the mobile station.
5.2.1.5
Alerting
Having entered the "mobile originating call proceeding" state, upon receiving an indication that user alerting has been
initiated at the called address, the call control entity of the network shall: send an ALERTING message to its peer
entity at the calling mobile station and enter the "call delivered" state.
ETSI
185
When the call control entity of the mobile station in the "call initiated" state or "mobile originating call proceeding"
state receives an ALERTING message then, the call control entity of the mobile station shall stop timer T303 and T310
(if running) and shall enter the "call delivered" state. In this state, for speech calls:
-
an alerting indication should be given to the user. If the mobile station has not attached the user connection then
the mobile station shall internally generate an alerting indication. If the mobile station has attached the user
connection then the network is responsible for generating the alerting indication and the mobile station need not
generate one.
Abnormal cases:
On the mobile station side, if timer T310 expires, the call control entity of the mobile station shall initiate call
clearing as described in section 5.4.
MS
Network
+---------------------+
|
|
|
ALERTING
|
|
<-------------|
|
|
+---------------------+
5.2.1.6
Call connected
Upon receiving an indication that the call has been accepted, the call control entity of the network shall: through
connect the traffic channel (including the connection of an interworking function, if required) and send a CONNECT
message to its peer entity at the calling mobile station; start timer T313 and enter the "connect indication" state.
This message indicates to the call control entity of the calling mobile station that a connection has been established
through the network.
The call control entity of the mobile station in the "call initiated" state, in the "mobile originating call proceeding" state
or in the "call delivered" state, shall, upon receipt of a CONNECT message:
-
Abnormal cases:
On the mobile station side, if timer T303 or T310 expires, the call control entity of the mobile station shall
initiate call clearing as described in section 5.4.
NOTE:
The mobile station may have applied an additional internal alerting supervision which causes initiation of
call clearing prior to the expiry of T303 or T310.
The call control of the network in the "connect indication" state, shall, upon receipt of a CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
message:
-
Abnormal cases:
On the network side, if timer T313 elapses before a CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE message has been received,
the network shall perform the clearing procedure as described in section 5.4.
ETSI
186
MS
Network
+-----------------------------+
|
CONNECT
|
|
<---------------------|
|
CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
|
|
---------------------->
|
+-----------------------------+
Figure 5.5/GSM 04.08: Call acceptance sequence at mobile originating call establishment
5.2.1.7
Call rejection
Upon receiving an indication that the network or the called user is unable to accept the call, the network shall initiate
call clearing at the radio interface to the mobile which originated the call, as described in section 5.4 using the cause
provided by the terminating network or the called user.
5.2.1.8
NOTE:
5.2.1.9
It is a network dependent decision when to initiate the assignment of an appropriate traffic channel during the mobile
originating call establishment phase. Initiation of a suitable RR procedure to assign an appropriate traffic channel does
neither change the state of a call control entity nor affect any call control timer.
NOTE:
The assignment procedure does not affect any call control timer.
5.2.1.10
5.2.2
Before call establishment can be initiated in the mobile station, the MM connection must be established by the network.
5.2.2.1
Call indication
After the arrival of a call from a remote user, the corresponding call control entity in the network shall: initiate the MM
connection establishment according to section 4 and enter the "MM connection pending" state. The request to establish
the MM connection is passed from the CM sublayer to the MM sublayer. It contains the necessary routing information
derived from the SETUP message.
Upon completion of the MM connection, the call control entity of the network shall: send the SETUP message to its
peer entity at the mobile station, start timer T303 and enter the "call present" state.
ETSI
187
Upon receipt of a SETUP message, the mobile station shall perform compatibility checking as described in 5.2.2.2. If
the result of the compatibility checking was compatibility, the call control entity of the mobile station shall enter the
"call present" state. An incompatible mobile station shall respond with a RELEASE COMPLETE message in
accordance with section 5.2.2.3.4.
If no response to the SETUP message is received by the call control entity of the network before the expiry of timer
T303, the procedures described in section 5.2.2.3.3 shall apply.
MS
Network
+---------------------+
|
|
|
SETUP
|
|
<-------------|
|
|
+---------------------+
CALL_CONFIRMED
- - - - - - - - - - - - >
RELEASE COMPLETE
- - - - - - - - - - - - >
(i)
(ii)
Figure 5.6/GSM 04.08: Mobile terminating call initiation and possible subsequent responses
5.2.2.2
Compatibility checking
The mobile station receiving a SETUP message shall perform compatibility checking before responding to that SETUP
message. Annex B defines compatibility checking to be performed by the mobile station upon receiving a SETUP
message.
5.2.2.3
5.2.2.3.1
Call confirmation
Response to SETUP
Having entered the "call present state" the call control entity of the mobile station shall - with the exception of the cases
described below - acknowledge the SETUP message by a CALL CONFIRMED message, and enter the "mobile
terminating call confirmed" state.
The call control entity of the mobile station may include in the CALL CONFIRMED message to the network one or
two bearer capability information elements to the network, either preselected in the mobile station or corresponding to a
service dependent directory number (see GSM 09.07). The mobile station may also include one or two bearer
capabilities in the CALL CONFIRMED message to define the radio channel requirements. In any case the rules
specified in section 9.3.2.2 shall be followed.
NOTE:
The possibility of alternative responses (e.g., in connection with supplementary services) is for further
study.
A busy MS which satisfies the compatibility requirements indicated in the SETUP message shall respond either with a
CALL CONFIRMED message if the call setup is allowed to continue or a RELEASE COMPLETE message if the call
setup is not allowed to continue, both with cause #17 "user busy".
If the mobile user wishes to refuse the call, a RELEASE COMPLETE message shall be sent with the cause #21 "call
rejected" .
In the cases where the mobile station responds to a SETUP message with RELEASE COMPLETE message the mobile
station shall release the MM connection and enter the "null" state after sending the RELEASE COMPLETE message.
The network shall process the RELEASE COMPLETE message in accordance with section 5.4.
ETSI
5.2.2.3.2
188
The call control entity of the network in the "call present" state, shall, upon receipt of a CALL CONFIRMED message:
stop timer T303, start timer T310 and enter the "mobile terminating call confirmed" state.
The call control entity of the mobile station having entered the "mobile terminating call confirmed" state, if the call is
accepted at the called user side, the mobile station proceeds as described in 5.2.2.5. Otherwise, if the signal information
element was present in the SETUP message user alerting is initiated at the mobile station side; if the signal information
element was not present in the SETUP message, user alerting is initiated when an appropriate channel is available.
Here, initiation of user alerting means:
-
sending of an ALERTING message by the call control entity of the MS to its peer entity in the network and
entering the "call received" state.
The call control entity of the network in the "mobile terminated call confirmed" state shall, upon receipt of an
ALERTING message: send a corresponding ALERTING indication to the calling user; stop timer T310; start timer
T301, and enter the "call received" state.
In the "mobile terminating call confirmed" state or the "call received" state, if the user of a mobile station is User
Determined User Busy then a DISCONNECT message shall be sent with cause #17 "user busy". In the "mobile
terminating call confirmed" state, if the user of a mobile station wishes to reject the call then a DISCONNECT message
shall be sent with cause #21 "call rejected".
5.2.2.3.3
initiate clearing procedures towards the calling user with cause #18 "no user responding"; and
initiate clearing procedures towards the called MS in accordance with section 5.4.4 using cause #102
"recovery on timer expiry".
iii. If the network has received an ALERTING message, but does not receive a CONNECT or DISCONNECT
message prior to the expiry of timer T301 (or a corresponding internal alerting supervision timing function), then
the network shall: initiate clearing procedures towards the calling user with cause #19 "user alerting, no answer";
and initiate clearing procedures towards the called mobile station in accordance with section 5.4.4, using cause
#102 "recovery on timer expiry" or using cause #31 "normal, unspecified".
NOTE:
The choice between cause #31 and cause #102 may have consequences on indications generated by the
mobile station, see GSM 02.40.
5.2.2.3.4
5.2.2.4
In this section, the term "interworking" is used only in the meaning of interworking with a network other than PLMN or
ISDN, not as interworking between PLMN and ISDN since this is the normal case. In this sense, PLMN and ISDN are
seen within the same environment, called the PLMN/ISDN environment.
ETSI
189
During call establishment the call may enter an PLMN/ISDN environment, e.g., because of interworking with another
network, with a non-PLMN/ISDN user, or with non-PLMN/ISDN equipment within the calling or called user's
premises. When this occurs, the network may include a progress indicator information element to be included in the
SETUP message to be sent to the called mobile station specifying progress description value
a) #1 "call is not end-to-end PLMN/ISDN; further call progress information may be available in-band" or
b) #3 "origination address is non-PLMN/ISDN".
See also section 5.5.1 for further reactions of the mobile station.
5.2.2.5
Call accept
In the "mobile terminating call confirmed" state or the "call received" state, the call control entity in the mobile station
indicates acceptance of a mobile terminating call by:
- sending a CONNECT message to its peer entity in the network;
- starting Timer T313; and
- entering the "connect request" state.
5.2.2.6
Active indication
In the "mobile terminated call confirmed" state or in the "call received" state, the call control entity of the network shall,
upon receipt of a CONNECT message: through connect the traffic channel (including the connection of an
interworking function, if required), stop timers T310, T303 or T301 (if running); send a CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
message to its peer entity at the mobile station of the called user; initiate procedures to send a CONNECT message
towards the calling user and enter the "active" state.
In the "connect request" state, the call control entity of the mobile station shall, upon receipt of a CONNECT
ACKNOWLEDGE message: stop timer T313 and enter the "active" state.
When timer T313 expires prior to the receipt of a CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE message, the mobile station shall
initiate clearing in accordance with section 5.4.3.
MS
Network
+------------------------+
|
CONNECT
|
| ---------------------> |
|
CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE |
| <-------------------- |
+------------------------+
Figure 5.7/GSM 04.08: Call acceptance and active indication at mobile terminating call establishment
5.2.2.7
It is a network dependent decision when to initiate the assignment of a traffic channel during the mobile terminating call
establishment phase.
Initiation of the assignment phase does not directly change the state of a CC entity nor affect any call control timer, but
may have some secondary effects (see e.g. clause 5.2.2.3.2).
5.2.2.8
The interworking to the fixed network has to fulfil the network specific requirements.
ETSI
5.2.2.9
190
5.2.3
The procedures of section 5.2.3 are mandatory for mobile stations supporting "Network initiated MO call".
NOTE:
5.2.3.1
The behaviour of a mobile station that does not support "Network initiated MO call" is described in
section 4.
Initiation
Before call establishment can be initiated in the mobile station, the MM connection shall be established by the network.
After the arrival of an appropriate stimulus (for example a Remote User Free Indication), the corresponding call control
entity in the network shall initiate the MM connection establishment according to section 4, enter the "CC connection
pending" state and start timer T331. The request to establish the MM connection is passed from the CM sublayer to the
MM sublayer. It contains the necessary routing information derived from the received stimulus.
Upon completion of the MM connection, the call control entity of the mobile station shall send a START CC message
to its peer entity in the network. The mobile station shall then enter the "Wait for network information" state and start
timer T332.
If the network receives a START CC message while in the "CC connection pending" state, the network stops T331,
sends the CC-ESTABLISHMENT message, starts timer T333 and enters the "CC-establishment present" state.
The MM connection establishment may be unsuccessful for a variety of reasons, in which case the MM sublayer in the
network will inform the CC entity in the network with an indication of the reason for the failure. The CC entity shall
then stop all running timers, enter the "Null" state and inform all appropriate entities within the network.
If timer T331 expires, the network shall abort the MM connection establishment attempt, stop all running CC timers,
enter the "Null" state and inform all appropriate entities within the network.
5.2.3.2
CC-Establishment present
In the "CC establishment present" state, the mobile station, upon receipt of the CC-ESTABLISHMENT message, shall
stop timer T332.
The CC-ESTABLISHMENT message contains information which the mobile station shall use for the subsequent
SETUP message (if any) related to this CC-ESTABLISHMENT.
The CC-ESTABLISHMENT message shall contain the Setup Container IE.
If no CC-ESTABLISHMENT message is received by the call control entity of the mobile station before the expiry of
timer T332, then the mobile station shall initiate clearing procedures towards the network using a RELEASE
COMPLETE message with cause #102 "recovery on timer expiry" and proceed in accordance with section 5.4.2.
Upon receipt of a CC-ESTABLISHMENT message the mobile station shall perform checks on the Setup Container IE
in order to align the contained information with the mobiles present capabilities and configuration. The "recall
alignment procedure" is defined later on in this section.
If the recall alignment procedure has succeeded, the call control entity of the Mobile Station shall:
-
form and store the SETUP message for sending later in the "Recall present" state,
ETSI
191
Exception:
A busy mobile station which has successfully performed the recall alignment procedure shall respond with a CCESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED message with cause #17 "user busy", and proceed as stated above.
A mobile station, for which the recall alignment procedure failed, shall respond with a RELEASE COMPLETE
message in accordance with section 5.4.2 with the appropriate cause code as indicated in the description of the recall
alignment procedure.
The SETUP message is constructed from the Setup Container IE received in the CC ESTABLISHMENT MESSAGE.
The mobile station shall assume that the Setup Container IE contains an entire SETUP message with the exception of
the Protocol Discriminator, Transaction ID and Message Type elements. The mobile station may assume that the
contents of the Setup Container IE are the same as were sent from the subscriber in a previous SETUP message of the
mobile originating call establishment attempt. The mobile station shall copy the Setup Container to the SETUP message
and not modify the contents except as defined in the recall alignment procedure and as defined in exceptions below. The
mobile station shall not add other Information Elements to the end of the SETUP message.
Exceptions:
Bearer Capability IE(s), HLC IE(s) and LLC (s) IE(s) (including Repeat Indicator(s), if there are 2 bearer
capabilities) require handling as described in the recall alignment procedure below.
If the CC Capabilities in the Setup Container IE is different to that supported by the mobile station, the mobile
station shall modify the CC Capabilities in the SETUP message to indicate the true capabilities of the mobile
station.
Facility IE(s) and SS Version IE(s) require handling as described in the recall alignment procedure.
If no response to the CC-ESTABLISHMENT message is received by the call control entity of the network before the
expiry of timer T333, then the network shall initiate clearing procedures towards the called mobile station using a
RELEASE COMPLETE message with cause #102 "recovery on timer expiry" and inform all appropriate entities within
the network, proceeding in accordance with section 5.4.2.
MS
Network
+---------------------------+
|
|
|
CC-ESTABLISHMENT
|
|
<-------------|
|
|
| CC-ESTABLISHMENT_CONFIRMED|
| - - - - - - - - - - - - > |
|
RELEASE COMPLETE
|
| - - - - - - - - - - - - > |
+---------------------------+
(i)
(ii)
5.2.3.2.1
facility alignment.
ETSI
192
Otherwise, the mobile station is allowed to alter the content within the Bearer Capability, HLC and LLC Information
Elements (e.g. the speech coder version(s), the data rate, the radio channel requirement) provided that the basic service
group is not changed. The result shall be that the mobile station has derived Bearer Capability, HLC and LLC
Information Elements, which it can use for a later call setup according to its configuration and capabilities.
Facility alignment:
This only applies if the Setup Container contains 1 or more Facility IEs. Each Facility IE within the Setup
Container will be associated with the common SS Version IE, if present. The handling for each Facility IE is
defined below. The mobile station shall align each facility IE contained in the Setup Container. The rules
defined in GSM 04.10 also apply.
The Facility IE is encoded as simple recall alignment, advanced recall alignment or recall alignment not essential
(see GSM 04.10). If the encoding indicates, that
-
a simple recall alignment is required, the mobile station shall copy the Facility IE and the common SS version IE
from the Setup Container to the SETUP message without modifying the content.
an advanced recall alignment is required, the mobile station must recognise and support the operation defined in
the facility. If the mobile station does not recognise or support the operation, then the recall alignment procedure
has failed and the mobile station shall use the cause #29 "facility rejected" in the subsequent rejection of the CC
establishment request.
the recall alignment is not essential, then the facility operation is not an essential part of the SETUP. If the MS
does not recognise the operation then the SS Version IE and Facility IE are discarded, and NOT copied into the
SETUP message.
NOTE: A mobile station may include a Facility IE without an associated SS Version IE. This would indicate that the
SS operation is encoded using Phase 1 protocols.
Further details on Facility handling are given in GSM 04.10
5.2.3.3
CC-Establishment confirmation
The call control entity of the network in the "CC-establishment present" state, shall, upon receipt of a CCESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED message, stop timer T333 and enter the "CC-establishment confirmed" state.
In the "CC-establishment confirmed" state, the network sends a RECALL message. This message initiates user alerting
and also shall include the Facility IE (providing additional information to be presented to the user for notification). The
network starts timer T334 and enters the recall present state.
Upon reception of the RECALL message the Mobile station stops T335 and enters the "recall present" state.
MS
Network
+---------------------+
|
|
|
RECALL
|
|
<-------------|
|
|
+---------------------+
Figure 5.7b/GSM 04.08: Recall
5.2.3.4
Recall present
In the "recall present" state, the call control entity in the mobile station waits for acceptance of the Recall by the user.
Once confirmation is received, the mobile station indicates acceptance of a recall by
-
entering the "call initiated" state and proceeding as described in section 5.2.1.1.
ETSI
193
The MS shall ensure that the contents of the Bearer Capability IE(s) sent in the SETUP message are the same as the
Bearer Capability IE(s) in the previous CC-ESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED message related to this Network
Initiated MO Call.
In the "recall-present" state, if the user of a mobile station is User Determined User Busy then a RELEASE
COMPLETE message shall be sent with cause #17 "user busy" In the "recall-present" state. If the user of a mobile
station wishes to reject the recall then a RELEASE COMPLETE message shall be sent with cause #21 "call rejected".
In either case, the mobile shall release the connection in accordance with section 5.4.2
On receipt of the SETUP message in the "recall present" state, the network shall stop timer T334 and proceed as
specified in section 5.2.1.2.
If the call control entity of the network does not receive a SETUP message before the expiry of timer T334, then the
network shall send a RELEASE COMPLETE message to the mobile using cause #102 "recovery on timer expiry",
release the MM connection, enter the "null" state and shall inform all appropriate entities within the network.
MS
Network
+------------------------+
SETUP
--------------------->
RELEASE COMPLETE
-------------------->
+------------------------+
Figure 5.7b/GSM 04.08 Recall acceptance or rejection by user
5.2.3.5
It is a network dependent decision whether or not to initiate the assignment of a traffic channel during the "CCestablishment confirmed" state.
5.3
5.3.1
The mobile terminating user notification procedure allows the network to notify a mobile station of any appropriate
call-related event during the "active" state of a call. The procedure consists in the network sending a NOTIFY message
to the mobile station. No state change occurs at any of the interface sides following the sending or the receipt of this
message (but an appropriate indication may optionally be generated in the mobile station).
The mobile originating notification procedure allows the mobile station to notify the remote user of any appropriate
call-related event during the "active" state of a call by sending a NOTIFY message containing a notification indicator to
the network; upon receipt of this message, the network sends a NOTIFY message containing the same notify indicator
to the other user involved in the call. No state change occurs at any of the interface sides following the sending or the
receipt of this message.
5.3.2
Call rearrangements
Call rearrangements on the radio interface are not supported by explicit messages (e.g. SUSPEND and RESUME
messages as defined in ETS 300 102-1). However if a remote non-PLMN user initiates call rearrangements, the network
shall inform the mobile station by means of a NOTIFY message. In a similar way the mobile station can inform the
network about rearrangements by sending a NOTIFY message (e.g. change of user equipment connected to the mobile
station).
ETSI
5.3.3
Not used
5.3.4
194
The behaviour described in this section is used to realize the following required services throughout section 5.3.4. The
mobile station is not obliged to support the network originated in-call modification procedure. In that case, the mobile
station shall, when receiving a MODIFY message, treat the message as unknown and react as described in section 8.4.
If the mobile station is already prepared to support the procedure in both directions, it shall act as described in this
section.
a) Alternate Speech/Data (BS 61 according to GSM 02.02);
b) Speech followed by Data (BS 81 according to GSM 02.02);
c) Alternate Speech/Group 3 fax (Teleservice 61 according to GSM 02.03).
5.3.4.1
Service Description
This circuit switched service allows the two users on a point-to-point connection to use the connection between them
for different information transfer during the same call, but not at the same time.
If the negotiation during call establishment leads to the recognition of the above mentioned services, the in-call
modification procedure is allowed to be executed within the current call by changing from one call mode to the other.
In some cases the in-call modification procedure makes it necessary to change the channel configuration by allocating a
new channel and in other cases to change channel configuration parameters while keeping the previously allocated
channel. This change is determined by the network, which initiates either the channel assignment procedure, handover
procedure or channel mode modify procedure (see section 3).
The capability and the initial mode desired must be identified by the mobile station by identifying each mode of
operation with a separate information element during call establishment. Further the type of change between the modes
must be identified by means of the repeat indicator:
mode 1 "alternate" mode 2; or
mode 1 "and then" mode 2.
5.3.4.2
Call establishment
For both mobile originating and mobile terminating calls, the normal call establishment procedures apply.
5.3.4.2.1
The service is requested by the originating mobile station by transferring a SETUP message to the network containing
the BC repeat indicator IE, the bearer capability 1 information element, and the bearer capability 2 information
element. The first mode of operation ("call mode") shall be indicated by the bearer capability 1 information element
and the second call mode by the bearer capability 2 information element.
A low layer compatibility may optionally be specified for each call mode in a low layer compatibility I and low layer
compatibility II information element. In that case:
-
the SETUP message shall contain the LLC repeat indicator IE and both low layer compatibility I and low layer
compatibility II information elements. The low layer compatibility I information element then corresponds to the
bearer capability 1 information element and the low layer compatibility II information element to the bearer
capability 2 information element;
if no low layer compatibility specification applies for one of the two call modes, the corresponding low layer
compatibility IE (low layer compatibility I or low layer compatibility II) shall indicate "not applicable";
the LLC repeat indicator shall specify the same repeat indication as the BC repeat indicator IE.
ETSI
195
Similarly, a high layer compatibility may optionally be specified for each call mode in a high layer compatibility i and
high layer compatibility ii information element. In that case:
-
the SETUP message shall contain the HLC repeat indicator IE and both high layer compatibility i and high layer
compatibility ii information elements. The high layer compatibility i information element then corresponds to the
bearer capability 1 information element and the high layer compatibility ii information element to the bearer
capability 2 information element;
if no high layer compatibility specification applies for one of the two call modes, the corresponding high layer
compatibility IE (high layer compatibility i or high layer compatibility ii) shall indicate "not applicable";
the HLC repeat indicator shall specify the same repeat indication as the BC repeat indicator IE.
The receiving entity shall ignore whether the LLC repeat indicator IE or HLC repeat indicator are contained in the
message or not; it shall also ignore the repeat indication of an LLC repeat indicator IE or HLC repeat indicator IE. If
the low layer compatibility II IE is not contained in the message and the low layer compatibility I IE is contained in the
message, the receiving entity shall relate it to a call mode indicated in the message that does not specify speech (if any).
If the high layer compatibility ii IE is not contained in the message and the high layer compatibility i IE is contained in
the message, the receiving entity shall relate it to a call mode indicated in the message that does not specify speech (if
any).
The specific part of the network which is sensitive to the call mode shall examine each mode described in the bearer
capabilities included in the SETUP message by performing compatibility checking as defined in Annex B. If as a result
of this compatibility checking the network decides to reject the call, then the network shall initiate call clearing as
specified in section 5.4 with the following causes:
a) #57 "bearer capability not authorized"
b) #58 "bearer capability not presently available"
c) #65 "bearer service not implemented"
d) #70 "only restricted digital information bearer capability is available"
5.3.4.2.2
The service is indicated to the called mobile station by a SETUP message coded in the same manner as in the mobile
originating call establishment. As specified for normal terminating call establishment, the service may be indicated by
the called mobile station in the CALL CONFIRMED message.
The destination mobile station shall perform the compatibility checking as defined in Annex B for both required modes
if indicated in the SETUP message. If as a result of compatibility checking the mobile station decides to reject the call,
the mobile station shall initiate call clearing according to the procedures of section 5.4 with one of the following causes:
a) #57 "bearer capability not authorized"
b) #58 "bearer capability not presently available"
c) #65 "bearer service not implemented"
d) #88 "incompatible destination"
The mobile station may accept the call if the first mode indicated is free irrespective of whether the other mode is free
or busy.
5.3.4.3
In order to change the call mode, the following in-call modification procedures shall be used.
Either side of the radio interface may act as the requesting user to invoke the in-call modification.
Upon each successful completion of the in-call modification procedure, the call changes to the next mode negotiated
and agreed during the establishment phase of the call.
The in-call modification procedures are completely symmetrical at the radio interface.
ETSI
NOTE:
5.3.4.3.1
196
The procedure is initiated by the requesting originating side in the "active" state of the call. It shall send a MODIFY
message including the new mode to be changed to; start timer T323; and enter the "mobile originating modify" state
(mobile station side) or the "mobile terminating modify" state (network side). Any internal resources necessary to
support the next call mode shall be reserved. The new mode given in the MODIFY message shall be one of those
already negotiated and agreed during the establishment phase of the call. If the data call direction is different from the
direction of the call setup a reverse call setup direction IE shall be included in the MODIFY message; otherwise this IE
shall not be included. The MODIFY originating side shall stop sending Bm-channel information; and stop interpreting
received Bm-channel information according to the old call mode.
Upon receipt of the MODIFY message, the destination side shall check to ensure that the requested call mode can still
be supported and if so, it shall initiate the reservation of any resources necessary to support the next call mode and enter
the "mobile originating modify" (network side) or "mobile terminating modify" state (mobile station side).
5.3.4.3.2
If the destination network/mobile station receives a MODIFY message with a new mode which is already the actual one
of the call the network/mobile station shall remain in the "active" state; send a MODIFY COMPLETE message with
the actual mode; and shall not initiate anything else.
If the requested mode is not the actual one and can be supported by the destination interface it shall change the channel
configuration, if required, and step on to any internal resources necessary to support the next call mode. If the requested
mode is a data or facsimile mode, it shall also perform the appropriate means to take the direction of the data call into
account. After successful change of the channel configuration it shall start sending user information according to the
next call mode and start interpreting received user channel information according to the next call mode; send a
MODIFY COMPLETE message with the new call mode included and enter the "active" state (mobile station or
network side). If the MODIFY message had contained a reverse call setup direction IE, the same IE shall be included in
the MODIFY COMPLETE message.
In case of an alternate speech/data or alternate speech/facsimile group 3 service (refer to section 5.3.4) the old resources
may still be kept reserved, in case of speech followed by data service they may be released.
Upon receipt of the MODIFY COMPLETE message the originating side shall: initiate the alternation to those resources
necessary to support the next call mode; stop timer T323; and enter the "active" state (mobile station or network side).
The reaction of the originating side if it had included a reverse call setup direction IE in the MODIFY message, but the
destination side did not include the IE in the MODIFY COMPLETE message is implementation dependent.
5.3.4.3.3
In case the requested bearer capability cannot be supported by the current channel configuration the network shall
initiate the assignment procedure and change the channel configuration accordingly.
5.3.4.3.4
5.3.4.3.4.1
If the network cannot support the change to the requested call mode or if the change of the channel configuration fails
the network shall: release the resources which had been reserved for the alternation: send a MODIFY REJECT message
with the old bearer capability and with cause # 58 "bearer capability not presently available" to the initiating mobile
station; and enter the "active" state. If the change of the channel configuration fails, the network shall return to the
internal resources required for the old call mode.
Upon receipt of the MODIFY REJECT message with the old bearer capability the initiating mobile station shall: stop
timer T323; release any resources which had been reserved for the alternation; resume sending user channel information
according to the present call mode; resume interpreting received user channel information according to the present call
mode; and enter the "active" state.
ETSI
5.3.4.3.4.2
197
If the mobile station cannot support the change to the requested call mode, the mobile station shall: release any
resources which had been reserved for the alternation; send a MODIFY REJECT message with the old bearer capability
and cause # 58 "bearer capability not presently available", and enter the "active" state.
Upon receipt of the MODIFY REJECT message the network shall: stop timer T323, release any resources which had
been reserved for the alternation.
5.3.4.3.4.3
Time-out recovery
Upon expiration of T323 in either the mobile station or the network the procedures for call clearing shall be initiated
with cause # 102 "recovery on timer expiry".
5.3.4.4
Abnormal procedures
If a MODIFY, MODIFY COMPLETE or MODIFY REJECT message is received in the "disconnect indication",
"disconnect request" (mobile station side only) or "release request" state then the received message shall be discarded
and no action shall be taken.
If a MODIFY COMPLETE message indicating a call mode which does not correspond to the requested one is received
or if a MODIFY REJECT message indicating a call mode which does not correspond to the actual one is received then
the received message shall be discarded and no action shall be taken.
If a MODIFY message indicating a call mode which does not belong to those negotiated and agreed during the
establishment phase of the call, is received, then a MODIFY REJECT message with the actual call mode and with cause
# 57 "bearer capability not authorized" shall be sent back.
MS
Network
+-----------------------------------+
|
MOD
|
| -------------------------------> |
|
|------------|
|
|
| assignment or channel mode modify
|
|------------|
|
|
MOD COMP
|
| <------------------------------ |
|
MOD REJ
|
| <-- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- |
+-----------------------------------+
Figure 5.10a/GSM 04.08 In-call modification sequence initiated by MS
MS
Network
+-----------------------------------+
|
MOD
|
| <------------------------------ |
|
MOD COMP
|
| ------------------------------> |
|
MOD REJ
|
|
-- -- -- -- -- -- -- -> |
|
|------------|
|
|
| assignment or channel mode modify
|
|------------|
|
+-----------------------------------+
Figure 5.10b/GSM 04.08 In-call modification sequence initiated by network
5.3.5
The user initiated service level up- and downgrading is applicable for non-transparent multislot data services, only. By
means of this procedure the user can request a change of the "maximum number of traffic channels" and/or "wanted air
interface user rate" parameters, to be assigned by the network.
5.3.5.1
The procedure is initiated by the mobile station in the "active" state of the call. It shall:
ETSI
198
send a MODIFY message including the wanted value of the "maximum number of traffic channels" and/or the
"wanted air interface user rate" parameters;
not change any of the other, possibly negotiated, parameters of the bearer capability information element;
Any internal resources necessary to support the next service parameters shall be reserved. If a dual service was
negotiated at call setup, the mobile station shall initiate the service level up- or down-grading only during the data phase
of the dual service.
Upon receipt of the MODIFY message, the network shall check if the indicated maximum number of traffic channels
can be supported and enter the "mobile originating modify" state.
5.3.5.2
The network may upon reception of the MODIFY message initiate a change of the channel configuration assigned to
the mobile station.
As a response to the MODIFY message the network sends a MODIFY COMPLETE message including the bearer
capability negotiated at call setup and enters the "active" state.
Upon receipt of the MODIFY COMPLETE message the mobile station shall stop timer T323 and enter the "active"
state.
5.3.5.3
If a change of bearer service is requested together with a change of the "maximum number of traffic channels" and/or
the "wanted air interface user rate", or if the current used service is not a data service where up- and downgrading is
applicable, or if the receiver chooses not to grant the request, the network shall:
-
send a MODIFY REJECT message with bearer capability negotiated at call setup and with cause #58 "bearer
capability not presently available";
Upon receipt of the MODIFY REJECT message with the bearer capability negotiated at call setup, the mobile station
shall: stop timer T323 and enter the "active" state.
5.3.5.4
Time-out recovery
Upon expiration of T323 in the mobile station the procedures for call clearing shall be initiated with cause #102
"recovery on timer expiry".
5.4
Call clearing
5.4.1
Terminology
The following terms are used in this Technical Specification in the description of clearing procedures:
-
A traffic channel (see GSM 04.03) is "connected" when the channel is part of a circuit-switched connection
established according to this Technical Specification.
A traffic channel is "disconnected" when the channel is no longer part of a circuit-switched connection, but is not
yet available for use in a new connection.
ETSI
5.4.2
199
Exception conditions
Under normal conditions, the call control entity of the mobile station or of the network initiates call clearing by sending
a DISCONNECT message to its peer entity; then both entities follow the procedures defined in sections 5.4.3 and 5.4.4
respectively.
As an exception to the above rule, the call control entity of the mobile station or of the network, in response to a SETUP
or START CC or CC-ESTABLISHMENT CCESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED or RECALL message, can reject a call by stopping all running call control timers,
responding with a RELEASE COMPLETE message, releasing the MM connection, and returning to the "null" state,
provided no other response has previously been sent.
As a further exception, the call control entity of the network may initiate call clearing by stopping all running call
control timers, sending a RELEASE message, starting timer T308, and entering the "release request" state.
NOTE:
This way to initiate call clearing by sending a RELEASE message should not be used by the network:
-
if in-band tones/announcements are provided and the network decides to use the procedure described
in section 5.4.4.1.1.1 or 5.4.4.2.1;
if the network wants to have the opportunity to respond to information sent by the mobile station
during call clearing, e.g. when the network indicates that "CCBS activation is possible".
A call control entity shall accept an incoming RELEASE COMPLETE message used to initiate the call clearing even
though the cause information element is not included.
A control entity shall accept an incoming RELEASE message used to initiate the call clearing even though the cause
information element is not included.
Furthermore, a call control entity shall regard an incoming RELEASE COMPLETE message as consistent with any of
its states; a call control entity shall regard an incoming RELEASE message as consistent with any of its states except
the null state: a call control entity of the mobile station shall regard an incoming DISCONNECT message as consistent
with any of its call control states except the "null" state, the "release request" state, and the "disconnect indication" state;
a call control entity of the network shall regard an incoming DISCONNECT message as consistent with any of its call
control states except the "null" state and the "release request" state.
NOTE:
5.4.3
5.4.3.1
This allows the introduction of shorter call clearing procedures in the future.
Apart from the exceptions identified in section 5.4.2, the call control entity of the mobile station shall initiate clearing
by: stopping all running call control timers, sending a DISCONNECT message; starting timer T305; and entering the
"disconnect request" state.
5.4.3.2
The call control entity in the network in any state except the "null" state and the "release request" state shall, upon
receipt of a DISCONNECT message:
-
initiate procedures to clear the network connection and the call to the remote user;
NOTE:
The RELEASE message has only local significance and does not imply an acknowledgement of clearing
from the remote user.
ETSI
5.4.3.3
200
The call control entity of the mobile station in any state except the "null" state and the "release request" state, shall,
upon receipt of a RELEASE message: stop all running call control timers; send a RELEASE COMPLETE message;
release the MM connection; and return to the "null" state.
5.4.3.4
A call control entity of the network in any call control state shall, upon receipt of a RELEASE COMPLETE message
from its peer entity in the mobile station: stop all running call control timers; release the MM connection; and return to
the "null" state.
5.4.3.5
Abnormal cases
The call control entity of the mobile station in the "disconnect request" state, shall upon expiry of timer T305: send a
RELEASE message to the network with the cause number originally contained in the DISCONNECT message and
optionally, a second cause information element with cause #102 "recovery on timer expiry", start timer T308, and enter
the "release request" state.
The call control entity of the network in the "release request" state, shall, at first expiry of timer T308, retransmit the
RELEASE message, start timer T308, and stay in the "release request" state. At second expiry of timer T308, the call
control entity of the network shall: release the MM connection; and return to the "null" state.
5.4.4
Apart from the exception conditions identified in section 5.4.2, the call control entity of the network shall initiate
clearing by: sending a DISCONNECT message; and entering the "disconnect indication" state. The DISCONNECT
message is a local invitation to clear the call.
NOTE:
When the network initiates clearing by sending a RELEASE message, the procedures described in
sections 5.4.3., 5.4.3.4 and 5.4.3.5 are followed.
A mobile station that does not support the "Prolonged Clearing Procedure" shall comply with the requirements of
section 5.4.4.1 and shall ignore section 5.4.4.2. A mobile station that supports the "Prolonged Clearing Procedure" shall
comply with the requirements of sections 5.4.4.2 and shall ignore section 5.4.4.1.
5.4.4.1
Section 5.4.4.1 only applies to mobile stations that do not support the "Prolonged Clearing Procedure" option.
5.4.4.1.1
When in-band tones/announcements are provided (see section 5.5.1), the call control entity of the network may initiate
clearing by sending a DISCONNECT message containing progress indicator #8 "in-band information or appropriate
pattern now available", starting timer T306, and entering the "disconnect indication" state.
5.4.4.1.1.1
The call control entity of the MS in any state except the "null" state, the "disconnect indication" state, and the "release
request" state, shall, upon receipt of a DISCONNECT message with progress indicator #8:
i) if an appropriate speech traffic channel is not connected, continue clearing as defined in section 5.4.4.1.2.1
without connecting to the in-band tone/announcement;
ii) if an appropriate speech traffic channel is connected, attach the user connection for speech if it is not yet attached
and enter the "disconnect indication" state. In that state, if upper layers request the clearing of the call, the call
control entity of the MS shall proceed as defined in section 5.4.4. 1.2.1.
ETSI
5.4.4.1.1.2
201
The call control entity of the network, having entered the "disconnect indication" state after sending a disconnect
message with the progress indicator #8, shall, upon expiry of timer T306, continue clearing by sending a RELEASE
message with the cause number originally contained in the DISCONNECT message; starting timer T308; and entering
the "release request" state.
5.4.4.1.2
When in-band tones and announcements are not provided, the call control entity of the network shall initiate call
clearing by stopping all running call control timers, sending a DISCONNECT message without progress indicator,
starting timer T305 and entering the "disconnect indication" state.
5.4.4.1.2.1
The call control entity of the mobile station in any state except the "null" state, the "disconnect indication" state, and the
"release request" state, shall, upon the receipt of a DISCONNECT message without progress indicator information
element or with progress indicator different from #8:
-
5.4.4.1.2.2
The call control entity of the network in any state except the "null" state and the "release request" state, shall, upon
receipt of a RELEASE message: stop all running call control timers; send a RELEASE COMPLETE message; release
the MM connection; and return to the "null" state.
5.4.4.1.2.3
Abnormal cases
The call control entity of the network, having entered the "disconnect indication" state after sending a DISCONNECT
message without progress indicator or with progress indicator different from #8, shall upon expiry of timer T305: send a
RELEASE message to the mobile station with the cause number originally contained in the DISCONNECT message;
start timer T308; and enter the "release request" state. In addition to the original clearing cause, the RELEASE message
may contain a second cause information element with cause #102 "recovery on timer expiry".
5.4.4.1.3
Completion of clearing
A call control entity of the mobile station in any call control state shall, upon receipt of a RELEASE COMPLETE
message from its peer entity in the network: stop all running call control timers ; release the MM connection; and return
to the "null" state.
5.4.4.1.3.1
Abnormal cases
The call control entity of the mobile station in the "release request" state shall at first expiry of timer T308 retransmit
the RELEASE message and restart timer T308. At second expiry of timer T308, the call control entity of the mobile
station shall: release the MM connection; and return to the "null" state.
5.4.4.2
Section 5.4.4.2 only applies to mobile stations that support the "Prolonged Clearing Procedure" option.
ETSI
5.4.4.2.1
202
Clearing when tones/announcements provided and the network does not indicate
that "CCBS activation is possible"
When in-band tones/announcements are provided (see section 5.5.1) and CCBS is not applicable, the call control entity
of the network may initiate clearing by sending a DISCONNECT message containing progress indicator #8 "in-band
information or appropriate pattern now available", either not containing an Allowed Actions IE or containing an Allowed
Actions IE indicating "CCBS activation is not possible", starting timer T306, and entering the "disconnect indication"
state.
5.4.4.2.1.1
The call control entity of the MS in any state except the "null" state, the "disconnect indication" state, and the "release
request" state, shall, upon receipt of a DISCONNECT message with progress indicator #8 and, either not containing an
Allowed Actions IE or containing an Allowed Actions IE indicating "CCBS activation is not possible":
i) if an appropriate speech traffic channel is not connected,
-
ii) if an appropriate speech traffic channel is connected, attach the user connection for speech if it is not yet attached
and enter the "disconnect indication" state. In that state, if upper layers request the clearing of the call, the call
control entity of the MS shall:
-
5.4.4.2.1.2
The call control entity of the network, having entered the "disconnect indication, shall, upon expiry of timer T306,
continue clearing by sending a RELEASE message with the cause number originally contained in the DISCONNECT
message; starting timer T308; and entering the "release request" state.
5.4.4.2.2
When Activation of CCBS is possible, the call control entity of the network may initiate clearing by sending a
DISCONNECT message containing the Allowed Actions IE with an indication that "Activation of CCBS is possible"
and starting T338. Optionally, progress indicator #8 "in-band information or appropriate pattern now available" may
also be contained in the DISCONNECT message (in which case, T338 shall not be greater than T306).
5.4.4.2.2.1
Receipt of a DISCONNECT
The call control entity of the MS in the "disconnect request" state, shall, upon receipt of a DISCONNECT
message:
- stop all running call control timers;
-
ETSI
203
- The call control entity of the MS in any other states, shall, upon receipt of a DISCONNECT message with an
Allowed Actions IE indicating "Activation of CCBS is possible" pass the "Activation of CCBS is possible" indication to
the upper layer, enter the "disconnect indication" state, stop all running call control timers and await a response from the
upper layers.
If the DISCONNECT message contained the progress indicator #8 "in-band information or appropriate pattern now
available" and an appropriate speech traffic channel is connected, then the MS shall attach the user connection for
speech if it is not yet attached. If the DISCONNECT message did not contain the progress indicator #8 "in-band
information or appropriate pattern now available" any connected speech traffic channel shall be disconnected.
Response from the upper layers:
i) If the upper layers request the clearing of the call, the call control entity of the MS shall:
-
ii) If the upper layers request that the "CCBS activation is to be attempted" then the MS shall
-
If an appropriate speech traffic channel is connected, transmission of this RELEASE message shall not cause it
to be disconnected.
5.4.4.2.2.2
The call control entity of the network, having entered the "disconnect indication" state after sending a DISCONNECT
message with an Allowed Actions IE indicating "Activation of CCBS is possible" shall, upon expiry of timer T338,
continue clearing by sending a RELEASE message with the cause number originally contained in the DISCONNECT
message; starting timer T308; and entering the "release request" state.
5.4.4.2.3
Clearing when tones/announcements are not provided and the network does not
indicate that "CCBS activation is possible"
When in-band tones and announcements are not provided, and, the network does not wish to indicate in the Allowed
Actions IE that "CCBS is possible", the call control entity of the network shall initiate call clearing by stopping all
running call control timers, sending a DISCONNECT message without progress indicator, either without the Allowed
Actions IE or with the Allowed Actions IE indicating that "CCBS is not possible", starting timer T305 and entering the
"disconnect indication" state.
5.4.4.2.3.1
The call control entity of the mobile station in any state except the "null" state, the "disconnect indication" state, and the
"release request" state, shall, upon the receipt of a DISCONNECT message either without progress indicator
information element or with progress indicator different from #8, and, either without the Allowed Actions IE or with the
Allowed Actions IE indicating that "CCBS is not possible":
ETSI
5.4.4.2.3.2
204
Abnormal cases
The call control entity of the network, having entered the "disconnect indication", shall upon expiry of timer T305: send
a RELEASE message to the mobile station with the cause number originally contained in the DISCONNECT message;
start timer T308; and enter the "release request" state.
5.4.4.2.4
5.4.4.2.4.1
For a network that does not support the "CCBS activation" option:
The call control entity of the network in any state except the "null" state and the "release request" state, shall,
upon receipt of a RELEASE message: stop all running call control timers; send a RELEASE COMPLETE
message; release the MM connection; and return to the "null" state.
For a network that does support the "CCBS activation" option:
The call control entity of the network in any state except the "null" state and the "release request" state, shall,
upon receipt of a RELEASE message without a Facility IE including an Invoke=CCBSRequest: stop all running
call control timers; send a RELEASE COMPLETE message; release the MM connection; and return to the "null"
state.
5.4.4.2.4.2
For a network that does not support the "CCBS activation" option:
The call control entity of the network in any state except the "null" state and the "release request" state, shall,
upon receipt of a RELEASE message: stop all running call control timers; send a RELEASE COMPLETE
message; release the MM connection; and return to the "null" state.
For a network that does support the "CCBS activation" option:
The call control entity of the network in any state except the "null" state and the "release request" state, shall,
upon receipt of a RELEASE message containing a Facility IE including an Invoke=CCBSRequest: stop all
running call control timers; then attempt to activate the recall; then send a RELEASE COMPLETE message
indicating the success or failure of the recall activation attempt; release the MM connection; and return to the
"null" state.
5.4.4.2.5
Completion of clearing
A call control entity of the mobile station in any call control state shall, upon receipt of a RELEASE COMPLETE
message from its peer entity in the network: stop all running call control timers ; release the MM connection; and return
to the "null" state.
5.4.4.2.5.1
Abnormal cases
The call control entity of the mobile station in the "release request" state shall at first expiry of timer T308 retransmit
the RELEASE message and restart timer T308. At second expiry of timer T308, the call control entity of the mobile
station shall: release the MM connection; and return to the "null" state.
The retransmitted RELEASE message need not contain the Facility IE including an Invoke=CCBSRequest, even if the
original RELEASE message did contain this IE.
ETSI
5.4.5
205
Clear collision
Clear collision occurs when both the mobile station and the network simultaneously transfer DISCONNECT messages
specifying the same call.
The behaviour of the network call control entity receiving a DISCONNECT message whilst in the "disconnect
indication" state is specified in section 5.4.3. The behaviour of the MS call control entity receiving a DISCONNECT
message whilst in the "disconnect request" state is defined in section 5.4.4.
Clear collision can also occur when both sides simultaneously transfer RELEASE messages related to the same call.
The entity receiving such a RELEASE message whilst within the "release request" state shall: stop timer T308; release
the MM connection; and enter the "null" state (without sending a RELEASE COMPLETE message).
5.5
Miscellaneous procedures
5.5.1
When the network wants to make the mobile station attach the user connection (e.g. in order to provide in-band
tones/announcement) before the mobile station has reached the "active" state of a call, the network may include a
progress indicator IE indicating user attachment in a suitable CC message:
-
Either it includes the IE in a SETUP, CALL PROCEEDING, ALERTING, or CONNECT message that is send
during call establishment
A progress indicator IE indicates user attachment if it specifies a progress description in the set {1, 2, 3} or in the set
{6, 7, 8, ..., 20}.
On reception of a SETUP, CALL PROCEEDING, ALERTING, CONNECT, or PROGRESS message the mobile
station shall proceed as specified elsewhere in section 5; if the progress indicator IE indicated user attachment and a
speech mode traffic channel is appropriate for the call the mobile station shall in addition: attach the user connection for
speech as soon as an appropriate channel in speech mode is available. (If a new order to attach the user connection is
received before the attachment has been performed, the new order shall supersede the previous one.)
Under certain conditions the MS will have to attach the user connection before the CONNECT message. It is up to the
network to ensure that no undesired end-to-end through connection takes place during the establishment of a MT call.
NOTE:
5.5.2
This allows the use of progress indicator IEs independently from the channel modes appropriate for the
call.
Call collisions
Call collisions as such cannot occur at the network. Any simultaneous mobile originating or mobile terminating calls
are dealt with separately assigned and different transaction identifiers.
5.5.3
5.5.3.1
Status procedures
Status enquiry procedure
Whenever a call control entity wishes to check the call state of its peer entity, it may initiate the status enquiry
procedure.
NOTE:
A call control entity initiates the status enquiry procedure by sending the STATUS ENQUIRY message and starting
timer T322. While timer T322 is running, the call control entity shall not send further STATUS ENQUIRY messages.
Upon receipt of a STATUS ENQUIRY message, the receiver shall respond with a STATUS message, reporting the
current call state and cause value #30 "response to STATUS ENQUIRY". Receipt of the STATUS ENQUIRY shall not
result in a state change relating to any protocol and connection of the receiver.
ETSI
206
If a STATUS message is received that contains cause value #30 "response to status enquiry", timer T322 shall be
stopped and further appropriate actions taken, based on the information in that STATUS message, relative to the current
state of the receiver of the STATUS message. These further "appropriate actions" are implementation dependent.
However, the actions prescribed in section 5.5.3.2 shall apply.
If a clearing message is received while timer T322 is running, timer T322 shall be stopped, and call clearing shall
continue.
If timer T322 expires, the STATUS ENQUIRY message may be retransmitted maximally once. If T322 expires after
the STATUS ENQUIRY has been transmitted the maximum number of times, clearing of the call shall be initiated with
cause value #41, "temporary failure", in the first call clearing message.
5.5.3.2
5.5.3.2.1
On receipt of a STATUS message reporting an incompatible call control state, the receiving entity shall clear the call by
sending a RELEASE COMPLETE message with cause # 101 "message not compatible with protocol state". The
reported call control state is incompatible if the combination of call control states at the sender and receiver side cannot
occur, do not match or cannot be aligned by actions of the receiver; the exact definition is implementation dependent.
5.5.3.2.2
A STATUS message may be received indicating a compatible call state but containing one of the following
causes:
# 95 "semantically incorrect message"; or
# 96 "invalid mandatory information"; or
# 97 "message type non-existent or not implemented"; or
# 98 "message type not compatible with protocol state"; or
# 99 "information element non-existent or not implemented"; or
# 100 "conditional IE error".
This indicates that the transmitter of the STATUS message was unable to accept some information sent by the recipient
of the STATUS message. This allow the recipient to retransmit some or all of the information. Other actions are
possible and are implementation dependent; they may include releasing the call.
5.5.4
This section describes the internal handling in the mobile station as far as call control is concerned.
5.5.4.1
When a MM connection is active, an indication may be given by the MM sublayer to the call control entity to announce
that the current MM connection has been interrupted but might be re-established on request of call control.
5.5.4.2
Depending whether call re-establishment is allowed or not and on its actual state, call control shall decide to either
request re-establishment or to release the MM connection.
a) Re-establishment not required
If the call is in the call establishment or call clearing phase, i.e. any state other than the "active" state or the
"mobile originating modify" state, call control shall release the MM connection
b) Re-establishment required
ETSI
207
If the call is in the "active" state or "mobile originating modify" state, the indication from MM that reestablishment is possible shall cause call control to request re-establishment from the MM connection,
suspend any further message to be sent and await the completion of the re-establishment procedure.
5.5.4.3
Completion of re-establishment
Call Control is notified when the MM connection is re-established and shall then resume the transmission of possibly
suspended messages and resume user data exchange when an appropriate channel is available.
5.5.4.4
Unsuccessful outcome
If the attempt to re-establish the connection was unsuccessful, the MM connection will be released and a release
indication will be given to call control, see 4.5.1.6.
5.5.5
This section describes the handling in the network as far as call control is concerned.
5.5.5.1
State alignment
After a successful call re-establishment it is a network responsibility to identify (e.g. by using the status enquiry
procedure, if needed, and resolve, if possible, any call state or auxiliary state mismatch between the network and the
mobile station.
5.5.6
Progress
At any time during the establishment or release of a call and during an active call the network may send a PROGRESS
message to the mobile station.
On receipt of a PROGRESS message during the establishment or release of a call the mobile station shall stop all call
control timers related to that call.
NOTE:
If the PROGRESS has been received before the receipt of a CALL PROCEEDING message, the mobile
station will not start timer T310 on receipt of a CALL PROCEEDING message, see section 5.2.1.1.3.
MS
Network
PROGRESS
<--------------
5.5.7
Dual Tone Multi Frequency (DTMF) is an inband one out of four plus one out of four signalling system primarily used
from terminal instruments in telecommunication networks. The support of DTMF in the network is described in
GSM 03.14.
The mobile station shall be capable of transmitting DTMF messages if and only if the mobile station has the user
connection for speech attached and an appropriate channel is available.
The transaction identifier used by the DTMF messages shall be that of the attached speech call.
NOTE 1: This specification means that DTMF messages can generally be sent in the active state of a call in speech
transmission mode or when a traffic channel is available during setup or release and the progress
indicator IE has been received.
NOTE 2: Since the DTMF protocol messages are sent in a store and forward mode on the signalling channels the
control of the device at the far end may be delayed dependent on the load or quality of the channels.
NOTE 3: The procedures described in this paragraph support DTMF only in the direction mobile station to
network.
ETSI
5.5.7.1
208
A user may cause a DTMF tone to be generated e.g. by depression of a key in the mobile station. The relevant action is
interpreted by the mobile station as a requirement for a DTMF digit to be sent in a START DTMF message on an
established FACCH. This message contains the value of the digit to be transmitted (0, 1, ..., 9, A, B, C, D, *, #).
Only a single digit will be transferred in each START DTMF message.
5.5.7.2
Upon receiving the START DTMF message the network will reconvert the received digit back into a DTMF tone which
is applied toward the remote user and returns a START DTMF ACKNOWLEDGE message to the mobile station. This
acknowledgement may be used in the mobile station to generate an indication as a feedback for a successful
transmission.
If the network cannot accept the START DTMF message a START DTMF REJECT message will be sent to the mobile
station.
5.5.7.3
When the user indicates that the DTMF sending should cease e.g. by releasing the key the mobile station will send a
STOP DTMF message to the network.
5.5.7.4
Upon receiving the STOP DTMF message the network will stop sending the DTMF tone and return a STOP DTMF
ACKNOWLEDGE message to the mobile station.
5.5.7.5
The minimum length of tone generated by the network should be according to CEPT recommendation T/CS 46-02.
The minimum gap between two subsequent tones should be according to CEPT recommendation T/CS 46-02.
There is no defined maximum length to the tone, which will normally cease when a STOP DTMF message is received
from the MS. However, the operator may choose to put a pre-defined time limit on the duration of tones sent.
The appropriate sequencing of DTMF control messages is shown in figures 5.8 and 5.9.
NOTE 1: The network may implement the time limit option where the DTMF tone duration is controlled by the
network irrespective of the receipt of a STOP DTMF message from the mobile station.
NOTE 2: The transmission time of the messages over the radio interface on FACCH/F or FACCH/H, see
GSM 05.02, ensures that the minimum length of tones and minimum gap between tones according to
T/CS 46-02 are fulfilled.
Mobile Station
Network
START DTMF
----------------------------------->
START DTMF ACK
<----------------------------------STOP DTMF
----------------------------------->
STOP DTMF ACK
<----------------------------------Figure 5.8/GSM 04.08: Single DTMF transmission
ETSI
209
Mobile Station
Network
This chapter contains the description of the procedures for the session management of GPRS point-to-point data
services at the radio interface (Reference point Um).
6.1
6.1.1
General
The main function of the session management (SM) is to support PDP context handling of the user terminal. The SM
comprises procedures for
-
SM procedures for identified access can only be performed if a GMM context has been established between the MS and
the network. If no GMM context has been established, the MM sublayer has to initiate the establishment of a GMM
context by use of the GMM procedures as described in chapter 4. After GMM context establishment, SM uses services
offered by GMM (see GSM 04.07 [20]). Ongoing SM procedures are suspended during GMM procedure execution.
For anonymous access no GMM context is established.
6.1.1.1
In the case of anonymous access, no P-TMSI shall be used by the MS or by the network. The MS shall use a randomly
selected random TLLI for transmission of the ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message in order to
activate the AA PDP context.
Upon receipt of the ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message, the network assigns an auxiliary TLLI (ATLLI) to the AA PDP context and transmits the assigned A-TLLI to the MS. After receipt of the assigned A-TLLI, the
MS shall use it for further data transmission to the network for the lifetime of the AA PDP context.
6.1.2
In this section, the SM states are described for one SM entity (see GSM 04.07 [20]). Each SM entity is associated with
one PDP context. Section 6.1.2.1 describes the SM states in the MS and section 6.1.2.2 describes the SM states on the
network side.
6.1.2.1
In this section, the possible states of an SM entity in the mobile station are described. As illustrated in figure 6.1/GSM
04.08 there are four SM states in the MS.
ETSI
6.1.2.1.1
210
PDP-INACTIVE
6.1.2.1.2
PDP-ACTIVE-PENDING
This state exists when PDP context activation was requested by the MS.
6.1.2.1.3
PDP-INACTIVE-PENDING
This state exists when deactivation of the PDP contexts was requested by the MS.
6.1.2.1.4
PDP-ACTIVE
PDP-INACTIVE
DR (DEACTIV. PDP
CONTX. ACC)
PDP-ACTIVEPENDING
PDP-INACTIVEPENDING
PDP-ACTIVE
6.1.2.2
In this section, the possible states of an SM entity on the network side are described. As illustrated in figure 6.2/GSM
04.08 there are five SM states on the network side.
6.1.2.2.1
PDP-INACTIVE
ETSI
6.1.2.2.2
211
PDP-ACTIVE-PENDING
This state exists when the PDP context activation was initiated by the network.
6.1.2.2.3
PDP-INACTIVE-PENDING
This state exists when deactivation of the PDP context was requested by the network.
6.1.2.2.4
PDP-ACTIVE
6.1.2.2.5
PDP-MODIFY-PENDING
This state exists when modification of the PDP context was requested by the network.
PDP-ACTIVEPEND
DR (ACTIV. PDP
CONTX. ACC)
DR (ACTIV. PDP
CONTX. ACC)
PDP ACTIVE
PDP-INACTIVE
PDP-INACTIVEPEND
PDP-MODIFYPEND
Figure 6.2/GSM 04.08: Session management states on the network side (overview)
6.1.3
6.1.3.1
The purpose of this procedure is to establish a PDP context between the MS and the network for a specific QoS on a
specific NSAPI. The PDP context activation may be initiated by the MS or the initiation may be requested by the
network.
ETSI
6.1.3.1.1
212
In order to request a PDP context activation, the MS sends an ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message to the
network, enters the state PDP-ACTIVE-PENDING and starts timer T3380. The message contains the selected NSAPI,
PDP type and, if the MS requests a static address, the PDP address. The MS shall ensure that the selected NSAPI is not
currently being used by another Session Management entity in the MS.
Upon receipt of an ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message, the network selects a radio priority level based
on the QoS negotiated and may reply with an ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message. Upon receipt of the
message ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT the MS shall stop timer T3380, shall enter the state PDP-ACTIVE and
shall initiate establishment of the logical link for the LLC SAPI indicated by the network with the offered QoS and
selected radio priority level if no logical link has been already established for that SAPI. If the offered QoS parameters
received from the network differ from the QoS requested by the MS, the MS shall either accept the negotiated QoS or
initiate the PDP context deactivation procedure. If the LLC SAPI indicated by the network can not be supported by the
MS, the MS shall initiate the PDP context deactivation procedure.
6.1.3.1.2
In order to request a PDP context activation, the network sends a REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION message
to the MS and starts timer T3385. If available, the APN shall be included in the REQUEST PDP CONTEXT
ACTIVATION message.
Upon receipt of a REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION message, the MS shall than either initiate the PDP
context activation procedure as described in the previous section or shall reject the activation request by sending a
REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION REJECT message as described in section 6.1.3.1.4. The value of the reject
cause IE of the REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION REJECT message shall indicate the reason for rejection,
e.g. "insufficient resources to activate another context".
The ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message sent by the MS in order to initiate the PDP context activation
procedure shall contain the PDP address, PDP Type and APN requested by the network in the REQUEST PDP
CONTEXT ACTIVATION message.
Upon receipt of the ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message, the network shall stop timer T3385.
The same procedures then apply as described for MS initiated PDP context activation.
6.1.3.1.3
Upon receipt of an ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message the network may reject the MS initiated PDP
context activation by sending an ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REJECT message to the MS. The message shall contain
a cause code that typically indicates one of the following causes:
# 26: insufficient resources;
# 27: missing or unknown APN;
# 28: unknown PDP address or PDP type;
# 29: user authentication failed;
# 30: activation rejected by GGSN;
# 31: activation rejected, unspecified;
# 32: service option not supported;
# 33: requested service option not subscribed;
# 34: service option temporarily out of order;
# 35: NSAPI already used; or
# 95 - 111: protocol errors.
Upon receipt of an ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REJECT message, the MS shall stop timer T3380 and enter/remain in
state PDP-INACTIVE.
6.1.3.1.4
Upon receipt of the REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION message, the MS may reject the network requested
PDP context activation by sending the REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION REJECT message to the network.
The message contains all parameters of the REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION and an additional cause code
that typically indicates one of the following causes:
ETSI
213
6.1.3.1.5
Abnormal cases
In general, the MS is unable to test if the PDP type, PDP address and APN in the REQUEST PDP
CONTEXT ACTIVATION message are the same as those for the PDN to which it is attempting to
activate a context. This is because the MS may have omitted one or more of the parameters in the
ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message, since it is relying on default values to be
provided by the network.
In the case of such a collision, the MS initiated PDP context activation shall take precedence over the
network requested PDP context activation. If the MS is able to compare the PDP type, PDP address and APN
requested in the ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message with those requested in the REQUEST
PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION message and these parameters are equal, then the MS shall discard the
REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION message and shall wait for the network response to its
ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message. Otherwise the MS shall send a REQUEST PDP
CONTEXT ACTIVATION REJECT message with the cause insufficient resources to the network, and wait
for an ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message.
Static PDP address collision detected on the network side:
A collision is detected by the network in the case where the PDP address, PDP type and APN derived
(according to 23.060 annex A) from the ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message received from the
MS match those in the REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION message sent to the MS.
In the case of such a collision, the MS initiated PDP context activation shall take precedence over the
network requested PDP context activation. The network shall terminate the network requested PDP context
activation procedure,and proceed with the MS initiated PDP context activation procedure.
ETSI
214
MS
Network
ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST
Start T3380
ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT
Stop T3380
or
ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REJECT
Stop T3380
Network
Stop T3385
ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT
Stop T3380
or
ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REJECT
Stop T3380
or
REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION REJECT
Stop T3385
6.1.3.2
The PDP context modification procedure is invoked by the network in order to change the QoS negotiated during the
PDP context activation procedure or at previously performed PDP context modification procedures. The procedure can
be initiated by the network at any time when a PDP context is active.
In order to initiate the procedure, the network sends the MODIFY PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message to the MS and
starts timer T3386. The message shall contain the new QoS and the radio priority level that shall be used by the MS at
the lower layers for the transmission of data related to the PDP context.
Upon receipt of this message the MS shall reply with the MODIFY PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message, if the MS
accepts the new QoS and the indicated LLC SAPI.
If the MS does not accept the new QoS or the indicated LLC SAPI, the MS shall initiate the PDP context deactivation
procedure for the PDP context - the reject cause IE value of the DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message
shall indicate "QoS not accepted".
The network shall upon receipt of the MODIFY PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message stop timer T3386 and shall
establish, reconfigure or continue using the logical link with the new QoS for the LLC SAPI indicated in the MODIFY
PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message.
ETSI
6.1.3.2.1
215
Abnormal cases
On the first expiry of timer T3386, the network shall resend the MODIFY PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message reset
and restart timer T3386. This retransmission is repeated four times, i.e. on the fifth expiry of timer T3386, the network
may continue to use the previously negotiated QoS or it may initiate the PDP context deactivation procedure.
MS
Network
MODIFY PDP CONTEXT REQUEST
Start T3386
MODIFY PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT
Stop T3386
6.1.3.3
The purpose of this procedure is to deactivate an existing PDP context between the MS and the network. The PDP
context deactivation may be initiated by the MS or by the network.
6.1.3.3.1
In order to deactivate a PDP context, the MS sends a DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message to the
network, enters the state PDP-INACTIVE-PENDING and starts timer T3390. The message contains the transaction
identifier in use for the PDP context to be deactivated and a cause code that typically indicates one of the following
causes:
# 25: LLC or SNDCP failure;
# 26: insufficient resources;
# 36: regular PDP context deactivation; or
# 37: QoS not accepted.
The network shall reply with the DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message. Upon receipt of the
DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message, the MS shall stop timer T3390. Both the MS and the network shall
initiate local release of the logical link if it is not used by another PDP context.
6.1.3.3.2
In order to deactivate a PDP context, the network sends a DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message to the
MS and starts timer T3395. The message contains the transaction identifier in use for the PDP context to be deactivated
and a cause code that typically indicates one of the following causes:
# 25: LLC or SNDCP failure;
# 36: regular PDP context deactivation;
# 38: network failure; or
# 39: reactivation requested.
The MS shall, upon receipt of this message, reply with a DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message. Upon
receipt of the DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message, the network shall stop the timer T3395. Both the MS
and the network shall initiate local release of the logical link if it is not used by another PDP context.
ETSI
6.1.3.3.3
216
Abnormal cases
MS
Network
DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST
Start T3390
DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT
Stop T3390
MS
Network
DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST
Start T3395
DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT
Stop T3395
6.1.3.4
The purpose of this procedure is to anonymously establish a PDP context between the MS and the network for a
specific QoS on a specific NSAPI. The AA PDP context activation shall only be initiated by the MS.
6.1.3.4.1
In order to activate an anonymous PDP context, the MS sends an ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST
message to the network, enters the state PDP-ACTIVE-PENDING and starts timer T3380. As long as no auxiliary TLLI
is allocated to the MS, a random TLLI is used for addressing on lower layers.
ETSI
217
Upon receipt of an ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message, the network selects a radio priority level
based on the QoS negotiated, assigns a AA-TID to the PDP context and sends an ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT
ACCEPT message to the MS. The message shall contain a the selected radio priority level and negotiated QoS allocated
by the network. If the offered QoS parameters received from the network differ from the QoS requested by the MS, the
MS shall accept the QoS offered by the network. If the LLC SAPI indicated by the network can not be supported by the
MS, the MS shall initiate the implicit AA PDP context deactivation procedure. Upon receipt of the message
ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT, the MS shall stop timer T3380, shall enter the state PDP-ACTIVE and
shall initiate establishment of the logical link for the LLC SAPI indicated by the network with the negotiated QoS.
6.1.3.4.2
Upon receipt of the ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message the network may indicate the failure of the
MS initiated AA PDP context activation by sending the ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REJECT message to the MS.
The message contains a cause code that typically indicates one of the following causes:
# 32: service option not supported;
# 34: service option temporarily out of order;
# 90 - 111: protocol errors.
The MS shall stop the timer T3380.
6.1.3.4.3
Abnormal cases
a) Expiry of timers
On the first expiry of timer T3380, the MS shall retransmit the ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST
message and shall reset and restart timer T3380.
This retransmission is repeated four times, i.e. on the fifth expiry of timer T3380, the MS shall indicate the failure
of the AA PDP context activation procedure to the register functions, shall release all resources possibly allocated
for this invocation and shall abort the procedure; no automatic AA PDP context activation re-attempt shall be
performed.
MS
Network
ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST
Start T3380
Stop T3380
Stop T3380
6.1.3.5
6.1.3.5.1
The implicit deactivation is performed without signalling message exchange as specified below.
ETSI
218
the LLC SAPI indicated by the network can not be supported by the MS during activation, or
user requested.
6.1.3.5.2
An explicit AA PDP context deactivation shall only be initiated by the network. The procedure shall be performed when
a misuse of the anonymous PDP context has been detected.
In order to deactivate the AA PDP context, the network sends the message DEACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT
REQUEST and starts timer T3397. The message shall contain the transaction identifier in use for the AA PDP context
to be deactivated. After sending the message the network initiates the release of the logical link.
The MS shall, upon receipt of this message, reply with the DEACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message
after the logical link has been released.
Upon receipt of the DEACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message, the network shall stop the timer T3397.
6.1.3.5.3
Abnormal cases
a) Expiry of timers
On the first expiry of timer T3397, the network shall retransmit the message DEACTIVATE AA PDP
CONTEXT REQUEST and shall reset and restart timer T3397.
This retransmission is repeated four times, i.e. on the fifth expiry of timer T3397, the network shall release all
remaining resources allocated for that MS and shall erase the AA PDP context related data for that MS.
MS
Network
DEACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST
Start T3397
DEACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT
Stop T3397
6.1.3.6
If the SM entity of the MS receives a SM STATUS message no state transition and no specific action shall be taken as
seen from the radio interface, i.e. local actions are possible.
ETSI
219
The actions to be taken on receiving a SM STATUS message in the network are an implementation dependent option.
Section 7 is informative.
7.1
General
Section 7 contains examples of how the network may group together the elementary procedures (i.e. the procedures
defined in sections 3 to 5) in order to provide normal service.
The layer 3 signalling at the radio interface may be divided into so-called structured procedures which consist of
specific combinations of elementary procedures. In section 7.3, selected examples of structured procedures are
described. A structured procedure consists of (not necessarily all) components shown in figure 7.1. These components
are characterized by the purpose of their use in structured procedures and their message flow in the following sections
7.1.1 to 7.1.7.
+|
|
++|
|
++|
++|
++|
++|
+-
Paging request
Immediate assignment
Service request and
Contention resolution
Authentication
Ciphering mode setting
Transaction phase
Channel release
-+
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
-+
-+
|
-+
-+
|
-+
-+
|
-+
-+
|
-+
RR connection
establishment
RR connection
release
7.1.1
Paging request
The paging procedure is used to locate a mobile station to which a connection shall be established.
Upon receipt of a PAGING REQUEST message the addressed mobile station initiates the immediate assignment
procedure.
Mobile Station
Network
PAGING REQUEST
<------------------Figure 7.2/GSM 04.08: Paging request
7.1.2
Immediate assignment
The immediate assignment procedure is always initiated by the mobile station. It may be triggered by a paging request
or by a mobile originating service request.
The mobile station sends a CHANNEL REQUEST message on the Random Access Channel. The network responds
with an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message which causes the mobile station to seize the indicated dedicated
channel.
ETSI
220
Mobile Station
Network
CHANNEL REQUEST
------------------------->
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
<-----------------------Figure 7.3/GSM 04.08: Immediate assignment
7.1.3
The initial service request message (a PAGING RESPONSE, LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST, IMSI DETACH,
CM SERVICE REQUEST, or CM RE-ESTABLISHMENT REQUEST message) is sent by the mobile station to the
network piggy-backed in the L2 SABM frames establishing the main signalling link. Its purpose is
-
to provide non-confidential information relevant to the service requested for the RR and MM sublayer in the
network;
in particular to identify the user in the network without jeopardising the confidentiality of the user's identity; this
is achieved by using as mobile identity the TMSI, which was never before transmitted un-encrypted over the
radio interface;
optionally, in the CM SERVICE REQUEST message to inform the network of the priority level associated with
the call.
Contention resolution provides a resolution process when more than one MS try to seize a channel allocated during the
immediate assignment procedure (because they happened to use the same random reference at the same time during
random access). This is achieved by the network including in a L2 UA frame the same information field as that one
received in the L2 SABM frame to which the UA frame responds. By comparing the two information fields the MS can
verify whether it was the originator of the L2 establishment, because the service request contains the mobile identity.
Mobile Station
Network
SABM(service request)
------------------------->
UA(service request)
<-----------------------Figure 7.4/GSM 04.08: Service request and contention resolution
7.1.4
Authentication
The purpose of authentication is to validate the identity provided by the mobile station . It is initiated by the network.
The authentication procedure also provides the mobile station with information from which a new ciphering key can be
derived. The network decides whether or not to use authentication. This may depend on the context.
Mobile Station
Network
AUTHentication REQuest
<-------------------------AUTHentication RESponse
--------------------------->
Figure 7.5/GSM 04.08: Authentication
7.1.5
Ciphering mode setting is initiated by the network. Its purpose is to instruct the mobile station whether or not to use
ciphering and which algorithm to use.
Where ciphering is used, this procedure synchronizes the start of ciphering at the mobile station and in the network.
ETSI
221
Mobile Station
Network
7.1.6
Transaction phase
A variety of elementary procedures described in sections 3 to 5 may be performed during the transaction phase. In this
section, only the channel mode modify procedure is characterized.
7.1.6.1
The channel mode modify procedure may be used when a traffic channel has been assigned e.g.:
-
during the in-call modification procedure in order that the channel mode of the TCH be changed to that one
requested by call control;
during call establishment with very early assignment in order that the channel mode of the TCH be changed from
signalling only to the mode requested by call control;
during the active phase of a data call in order that the speed of the data transmission be changed.
The channel mode modify procedure is initiated by the network sending a CHANNEL MODE MODIFY message and
completed by the mobile station changing the mode of the TCH and sending back a CHANNEL MODE MODIFY
ACKNOWLEDGE message.
Mobile Station
Network
7.1.7
Channel release
Once the transaction phase has been completed, the channel is released by the channel release procedure. The data link
layer is released explicitly as described in GSM 04.06. After the channel release is completed, the radio resources which
were in use may be reallocated by the network.
Mobile Station
Network
CHANNEL RELEASE
<---------------------Figure 7.8/GSM 04.08: Channel release
7.2
Abnormal cases
Abnormal cases are not described in the examples of section 7. They may arise from:
a) failure at a lower layer (e.g. loss of radio connection);
b) failure of an elementary procedure;
c) errors in an elementary procedure.
ETSI
7.3
222
Selected examples
location updating
call clearing:
a) network initiated
b) mobile initiated
handover:
a) between finely synchronized cells
b) between non-synchronized cells
c) handover failure, where reconnection of the old channel is possible
in-call modification
call re-establishment
7.3.1
Location updating
The location updating procedure is always initiated by the mobile station e.g. when it finds itself in a different location
area from the one in which it was registered before. The cases where the procedure is triggered are described in
section 4.
The procedure is shown in figure 7.9/GSM 04.08. The network may decide whether to allocate a new TMSI during
location updating, and this option is reflected in this example.
The mobile station initiates immediate assignment, service request using the LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST
message, and contention resolution.
The network requires authentication (this again is an option).
ETSI
223
As the network intends to allocate a new TMSI, it should activate ciphering. The network includes the new TMSI in the
LOCATION UPDATING ACCEPT message (it could also use the explicit TMSI reallocation procedure, see section 4).
The mobile station sends a TMSI REALLOCATION COMPLETE message to the network to acknowledge the receipt
of the new TMSI. Upon receipt of the TMSI REALLOCATION COMPLETE message the network initiates the channel
release if no further transactions are scheduled.
release if no further transactions are scheduled.
Mobile Station
+|
|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
+-
Network
-+
|
|
|
|
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
|
<-------------------------------------|
-+
-+
|
LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST
|
----------------------------------------> |
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
AUTHENTICATION REQUEST
|
<--------------------------------------- |
|
AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE
|
----------------------------------------> |
-+
-+
|
CIPHER MODE COMMAND
|
<--------------------------------------- |
|
CIPHER MODE COMPLETE
|
----------------------------------------->|
-+
-+
LOCATION UPDATING ACCEPT
|
<--------------------------------------- |
|
TMSI REALLOCATION COMPLETE
|
---------------------------------------> |
-+
-+
CHANNEL RELEASE
|
<--------------------------------------- |
|
-+
CHANNEL REQUEST
--------------------------------------->
RR connection
establishment
(MO)
Service request
Authentication
Ciphering mode
setting
RR connection
release
7.3.2
The mobile station initiates immediate assignment, service request using the CM SERVICE REQUEST message, and
contention resolution. The network may initiate authentication and may start the ciphering mode setting.
After sending the CIPHERING MODE COMPLETE message, the mobile station initiates call establishment by sending
the SETUP message to the network. The network answers with a CALL PROCEEDING message.
a) Non-OACSU option (early assignment)
With this option the network allocates a traffic channel to the mobile station before it initiates call establishment
in the fixed network.
If call queuing is applied, it may cause variable delay in the traffic channel assignment.
ETSI
224
When user alerting has been initiated at the called side, an ALERTING message is sent to the mobile station.
The network may optionally instruct the MS to attach the user connection at this stage of the call, by means of
the progress indicator information element set to the value #1 or #8(if the ringing tone will be sent by the remote
end) in the ALERTING message. In that case, an alerting ringing tone has to be generated by the network.
NOTE:
A CONNECT message and its acknowledgement CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE complete the call
establishment when the called party has answered.
The mobile originating call setup with early assignment is shown in figure 7.10a/GSM 04.08.
b) OACSU option (late assignment)
The network determines when the traffic channel is to be assigned. The assignment may be performed at any
time after call establishment has been initiated in the fixed network. In the following the case is considered
where the network will only allocate a traffic channel after the called party has answered the call (late
assignment).
As in a) an ALERTING message is sent to the mobile station when user alerting has been initiated at the called
side. If the ringing tone is needed, it has to be generated locally at the mobile station as no traffic channel is
allocated. When the called party has answered, the network will initiate the channel assignment procedure in
order to allocate a traffic channel to the mobile station. If call queuing is applied, it may cause variable delay in
the traffic channel assignment. Once the channel assignment has been completed the network will send a
CONNECT message to the mobile station. The MS attaches then the user connection. The CONNECT
ACKNOWLEDGE message will complete the call setup.
The mobile originating call setup with late assignment is shown in figure 7.10b/GSM 04.08.
c) Very early assignment
The network assigns the traffic channel at the earliest possible moment, i.e. in the immediate assignment
procedure. The mode of the traffic channel is changed from signalling only to the mode necessary for the call by
means of the channel mode change procedure. An appropriate moment for that change is after the network has
sent the CALL PROCEEDING message, when the call is established towards the called user.
With this option, call queuing is never applied.
The further establishment of the call is as in a).
ETSI
225
Network
Mobile Station
+|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
+-
CHANNEL REQUEST
------------------------->
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
<-----------------------CM SERVICE REQUEST
------------------------->
AUTHENTICATION REQUEST
<------------------------AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE
-------------------------->
CIPHER MODE COMMAND
<------------------------CIPHER MODE COMPLETE
-------------------------->
SETUP
-------------------------->
CALL PROCEEDING
<------------------------ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
<-------------------------ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
-------------------------->
ALERTING
<-------------------------CONNECT
<-------------------------CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
-------------------------->
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
RR connection
establishment
(MO)
Service request
Authentication
Ciphering
mode setting
Call initiation
Assignment of
a traffic
channel
User alerting
Call accepted
Figure 7.10a/GSM 04.08: Mobile originating call establishment without OACSU (early assignment)
ETSI
226
Mobile Station
+|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
+-
Network
CHANNEL REQUEST
------------------------->
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
<-----------------------CM SERVICE REQUEST
------------------------->
AUTHENTICATION REQUEST
<------------------------AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE
-------------------------->
CIPHER MODE COMMAND
<------------------------CIPHER MODE COMPLETE
-------------------------->
SETUP
-------------------------->
CALL PROCEEDING
<------------------------ALERTING
<-------------------------ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
<------------------------ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
-------------------------->
CONNECT
<-------------------------CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
-------------------------->
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
RR connection
establishment
(MO)
Service indication
Authentication
Ciphering
mode setting
Call initiation
User alerting
Assignment of
a traffic
channel
Call accepted
Figure 7.10b/GSM 04.08: Mobile originating call establishment with OACSU (late assignment)
ETSI
227
Mobile Station
Network
+-+
|
CHANNEL REQUEST
|
|
-------------------------->
|
|
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT(TCH)
|
|
<------------------------|
+-+
+-+
|
CM SERVICE REQUEST
|
|
-------------------------->
|
|
|
+-+
+-+
|
AUTHentication REQuest
|
|
<-------------------------|
|
AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE
|
|
---------------------------> |
+-+
+-+
|
CIPHER MODE COMMAND
|
|
<-------------------------|
|
CIPHer MODe COMplete
|
|
---------------------------> |
+-+
+-+
|
SETUP
|
|
-------------------------->
|
|
CALL PROCeeding
|
|
<-------------------------|
+-+
+-+
|
CHANNEL MODE MODIFY
|
|
<--------------------------- |
| CHANNEL MODE MODIFY ACKNOWLEDGE |
|
---------------------------> |
+-+
+-+
|
ALERTING
|
|
<---------------------------- |
+-+
+-+
|
CONNect
|
|
<--------------------------- |
|
CONNect ACKnowledge
|
|
---------------------------> |
+-+
RR connection
establishment
(MO)
Service request
Authentication
Ciphering
mode setting
Call initiation
Transmission
mode
change
User alerting
Call accepted
Figure 7.10c/GSM 04.08: Mobile originating call establishment with very early assignment
7.3.3
Mobile terminating call establishment is initiated by the network sending a PAGING REQUEST message (see figure
7.11a/GSM 04.08). Upon receiving this message the mobile station initiates the immediate assignment procedure and
responds to the network by sending the PAGING RESPONSE message within a layer 2 SABM frame. The network
returns a layer 2 UA frame containing the same information field as was sent in the SABM frame.
Authentication and ciphering are treated by the network in the same way as defined for the mobile originating call
establishment (section 7.3.2). After ciphering has been started, the network sends a SETUP message to the mobile
station. The capability of the mobile station (at that time) to accept the call is confirmed when the mobile station returns
a CALL CONFIRMED message to the network.
a) Non-OACSU option (early assignment)
With this option the network initiates the assignment of a traffic channel upon receiving the CALL
CONFIRMED message.
The signal IE is not included in the SETUP message, therefore user alerting is initiated only after a traffic
channel has been allocated. An ALERTING message will be sent to the network.
ETSI
228
When the called user answers, the mobile station sends a CONNECT message to the network. Upon receiving
the CONNECT message the network completes the through connection of the communication path and sends a
CONNECT ACK message to the mobile station.
b) OACSU option (late assignment)
In that option, the signalling IE is included in the SETUP message. Consequently, user alerting is initiated as
soon as the MS has accepted the call.
The network determines when the traffic channel is to be assigned. The assignment may be performed at any
time after user alerting has been initiated. In the following the case is considered where the network will only
allocate a traffic channel to the mobile station after having received the CONNECT message sent from the
mobile station (see figure 7.11b).
Upon receiving the ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE message from the mobile station, the network completes the
through connection of the communication path and sends a CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE message to the
mobile station.
Mobile Station
+|
|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
+-
Network
PAGING REQUEST
<------------------------CHANNEL REQUEST
------------------------->
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
<-----------------------PAGING RESPONSE
------------------------->
AUTHENTICATION REQUEST
<------------------------AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE
-------------------------->
CIPHer MODe COMMAND
<------------------------CIPHER MODE COMPLETE
-------------------------->
SETUP
<-------------------------CALL CONFIRMED
-------------------------->
ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
<-------------------------ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
-------------------------->
ALERTING
------------------------->
CONNECT
-------------------------->
CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
<--------------------------
-+
|
|
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
RR connection
establishment
(MT)
Service request
Authentication
Ciphering
mode setting
Call initiation
Assignment of
a traffic
channel
User alerting
information
Call accepted
Figure 7.11a/GSM 04.08: Mobile terminating: call establishment without OACSU (early assignment)
ETSI
229
Mobile Station
+|
|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
+-
Network
PAGING REQUEST
<------------------------CHANNEL REQUEST
------------------------->
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
<-----------------------PAGING RESPONSE
------------------------->
AUTHENTICATION REQUEST
<------------------------AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE
-------------------------->
CIPHer MODe COMMAND
<------------------------CIPHER MODE COMPLETE
-------------------------->
SETUP
<-------------------------CALL CONFIRMED
-------------------------->
ALERTING
------------------------->
CONNECT
------------------------->
-+
|
|
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
-+
-+
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
|
<-------------------------- |
-+
ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
<-------------------------ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
-------------------------->
RR connection
establishment
(MT)
Service request
Authentication
Ciphering
mode setting
Call initiation
User alerting
information
Assignment of
a traffic
channel
Figure 7.11b/GSM 04.08: Mobile terminating: call establishment with OACSU (late assignment)
7.3.4
Call clearing
ETSI
230
Network
+-+
|
DISCONNECT
|
| <------------------------ |
|
RELEASE
|
| -----------------------> |
|
RELEASE COMPLETE
|
| <----------------------- |
+-+
+-+
|
CHANNEL RELEASE
|
| <------------------------ |
+-+
Call clearing
RR connection
release
Network
+-+
|
DISCONNECT
|
| ------------------------> |
|
RELEASE
|
| <------------------------ |
|
RELEASE COMPLETE
|
| -----------------------> |
+-+
+-+
|
CHANNEL RELEASE
|
| <------------------------ |
+-+
b) Call clearing initiated by the MS
Figure 7.12b/GSM 04.08: Call clearing
7.3.5
Figure 7.13 shows the structured procedure for DTMF protocol control.
ETSI
Call clearing
RR connection
release
231
Mobile Station
Network
+|
|
+-
-+
|
|
-+
.
+-+
|
START DTMF
|
| ------------------------------> |
|
START DTMF ACKNOWLEDGE
|
| <----------------------------- |
+-+
active call
DTMF generation
started
+-+
|
STOP DTMF
| DTMF generation
|
| stopped
| -------------------------------> |
|
STOP DTMF ACKNOWLEDGE
|
| <------------------------------- |
+:
-+
:
+-+
|
| active call
|
|
+-+
Figure 7.13/GSM 04.08: DTMF protocol control
7.3.6
Handover
Figure 7.14 shows the structured procedure for handover to a finely synchronized cell, successful case.
Figure 7.15 shows the structured procedure for handover to a non-synchronized cell, successful case.
Figure 7.16 shows the structured procedure for handover failure, and reconnection to the old traffic channel.
Mobile Station
Network
+-+
|
|
|
| RR connection
|
| established
|
|
+-+
+-+ handover
|
HANDOVER COMMAND
|
old channel,
| <------------------------ |
old cell
-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - -|-- - - - - - - - - |
HANDOVER ACCESS
|
new channel,
| ------------------------>|
new cell
|
|
|
HANDOVER ACCESS
|
| ------------------------>|
|
|
|
HANDOVER ACCESS
|
| ------------------------>|
|
|
|
HANDOVER ACCESS
|
| ------------------------>|
|
|
|
HANDOVER COMPLETE
|
| ------------------------>|
+-+
Figure 7.14/GSM 04.08: Handover to a finely synchronized cell, successful case
ETSI
232
Mobile Station
Network
+-+
|
|
|
| RR connection
|
| established
|
|
+-+
+-+ handover
|
HANDOVER COMMAND
|
old channel,
| <------------------------ |
old cell
-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - -|-- - - - - - - - - |
HANDOVER ACCESS
|
new channel,
| ------------------------>|
new cell
|
.
|
|
.
|
|
.
|
|
HANDOVER ACCESS
|
new channel,
| ------------------------>|
new cell
|
|
|
PHYSICAL INFORMATION
|
| <----------------------- |
|
HANDOVER COMPLETE
|
| ------------------------>|
+-+
+-+
|
.
|
|
.
|
|
.
|
+-+
Figure 7.15/GSM 04.08: Handover to a non-synchronized cell, successful case
Mobile Station
Network
+-+
|
|
|
| RR connection
|
|established
|
|
+-+
+-+ handover
|
HANDOVER COMMAND
|
old channel,
| <------------------------ |
old cell
-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - -|- - - - - - - |
T3124 expiry or
|
new channel,
|
lower layer failure
|
new cell
-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - -|- - - - - - - - |
HANDOVER FAILURE
|
old channel,
| ------------------------>|
old cell
+-+
+-+
|
.
|
|
.
|
|
.
|
+-+
Figure 7.16/GSM 04.08: Handover failure, reconnection to the old traffic channel
7.3.7
In-call modification
Figure 7.17/GSM 04.08 shows the structured procedure for in-call modification.
ETSI
233
Mobile Station
Network
+|
|
+-
-+
|
|
-+
.
+-+
|
MODIFY
|
| ------------------------------> |
|
|
|
|
+|
|
+-
-+
|
|
-+
active call
in-call modification
e.g. from speech
to data
channel
mode modify
|
|
|
MODIFY COMPLETE
|
| <----------------------------- |
+-+
+|
|
+-
-+
|
|
-+
active call
7.3.8
Call re-establishment
Figure 7.18/GSM 04.08 shows the structured procedure for call re-establishment.
Mobile Station
Network
+-+
|
| active call
|
|
+-+
------------------------------------- radio link failure
+-+
|
CHANNEL REQUEST
| RR connection
|
------------------------->
| establishment
|
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
| (MO)
|
<-----------------------|
+-+
+-+
|
CM RE-ESTABLISHMENT REQUEST
|
|
------------------------->
| Service request
+-+
+-+
|
CIPHer MODe COMMAND
|
|
<------------------------| Ciphering
|
CIPHER MODE COMPLETE
| mode setting
|
------------------------->
|
+-+
+-+
|
ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
|
|
<------------------------| assignment of
|
ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
| a traffic channel
|
------------------------->
|
+-+
+-+
|
| active call
|
|
+-+
Figure 7.18/GSM 04.08: Call re-establishment
ETSI
7.3.9
234
Network initiated mobile originating call establishment (which is used, for example, for CCBS Service) is initiated by
the network sending a PAGING REQUEST message. Upon receiving this message the mobile station initiates the
immediate assignment procedure and responds to the network by sending the PAGING RESPONSE message within a
layer 2 SABM frame. The network returns a layer 2 UA frame containing the same information field as was sent in the
SABM frame.
Authentication and ciphering are treated by the network in the same way as defined for the mobile originating call
establishment (section 7.3.2). After ciphering has been started, the network sends a CM SERVICE PROMPT message,
indicating that the CM protocol is to be started, to the mobile station. The basic capability of the mobile station to
accept any form of recall service is confirmed when the mobile station returns a START CC message to the network.
a) assignment before A party alerting
With this option the network allocates a traffic channel to the mobile station before the mobile station alerts its
user.
The network responds to the START CC message with a CC-ESTABLISHMENT message. The MS answers
with a CC-ESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED message indicating the wanted channel characteristics. The
network then initiates traffic channel assignment.
When the traffic channel has been assigned, the network indicates a pending recall by sending a RECALL
message.
If the calling user accepts the recall, a SETUP message is sent to the network. The network responds with a
CALL PROCEEDING message and initiates call establishment in the fixed network.
When user alerting has been initiated at the called side, an ALERTING message is sent to the mobile station.
The network may optionally instruct the MS to attach the user connection at this stage of the call, by means of
the progress indicator information element set to the value #1 or #8(if the ringing tone will be sent by the remote
end) in the ALERTING message. In that case, an alerting ringing tone has to be generated by the network.
NOTE:
A CONNECT message and its acknowledgement CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE complete the call
establishment when the called party has answered.
The network initiated mobile originating call establishment with assignment before A part alerting is shown in
figure 7.19/GSM 04.08.
b) assignment before B party alerting
With this option the network allocates a traffic channel to the mobile station after the mobile station has alerted
its user and after its user has accepted the recall but before the network initiates call establishment in the fixed
network.
The network responds to the START CC message with a CC-ESTABLISHMENT message. The MS answers
with a CC-ESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED message indicating the wanted channel characteristics.
The network indicates a pending recall by sending a RECALL message. If the calling user accepts the recall, a
SETUP message is sent to the network. The network responds with a CALL PROCEEDING message and
initiates traffic channel assignment.
When the traffic channel has been assigned, the network initiates call establishment in the fixed network.
When user alerting has been initiated at the called side, an ALERTING message is sent to the mobile station.
The network may optionally instruct the MS to attach the user connection at this stage of the call, by means of
the progress indicator information element set to the value #1 or #8(if the ringing tone will be sent by the remote
end) in the ALERTING message. In that case, an alerting ringing tone has to be generated by the network.
NOTE:
A CONNECT message and its acknowledgement CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE complete the call
establishment when the called party has answered.
ETSI
235
The network initiated mobile originating call establishment with assignment before B party alerting is shown in
figure 7.20/GSM 04.08.
c) assignment after A and B party alerting
With this option, the network determines when the traffic channel is to be assigned. The assignment may be
performed at any time after call establishment has been initiated in the fixed network. In the following, the case
is considered where the network will only allocate a traffic channel after the called party has answered the call
(late assignment).
The network responds to the START CC message with a CC-ESTABLISHMENT. The MS answers with a CCESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED message indicating the wanted channel characteristics.
The network indicates a pending recall by sending a RECALL message. If the calling user accepts the recall, a
SETUP message is sent to the network. The network responds with a CALL PROCEEDING message and
initiates call establishment in the fixed network.
As in a) and b) an ALERTING message is sent to the mobile station when user alerting has been initiated at the
called side. If the ringing tone is needed, it has to be generated locally at the mobile station as no traffic channel
is allocated. When the called party has answered, the network will initiate the channel assignment procedure in
order to allocate a traffic channel to the mobile station. Once the channel assignment has been completed the
network will send a CONNECT message to the mobile station. The MS attaches then the user connection. The
CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE message will complete the call setup.
The network initiated mobile originating call establishment with assignment after A and B party alerting is
shown in figure 7.21/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
236
Mobile Station
+|
|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
+-
Network
-+
|
|
| RR connection
| establishment
| (MT)
|
-+
-+
PAGING RESPONSE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
AUTHENTICATION REQUEST
| Authentication
<------------------------|
AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
CIPHer MODe COMMAND
|
<------------------------| Ciphering
CIPHER MODE COMPLETE
| mode setting
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
CM SERVICE PROMPT
|
<------------------------| Service Request
START CC
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
CC-ESTABLISHMENT
|
<-------------------------_ | Recall initiation
CC-ESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
|
<------------------------| Assignment of
ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
| a traffic channel.
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
RECALL
|
<------------------------| User notified about
| recall
SETUP
|
------------------------->
| Recall accepted and
CALL PROCEEDING
| call initiation
<------------------------|
-+
-+
ALERTING
|
<------------------------| Called user alerting
-+ information
-+
CONNECT
|
<------------------------| Call accepted
CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
PAGING REQUEST
<------------------------CHANNEL REQUEST
------------------------->
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
<-------------------------
ETSI
237
Mobile Station
+|
|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
+-
Network
-+
|
|
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
PAGING RESPONSE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
AUTHENTICATION REQUEST
|
<------------------------|
AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
CIPHer MODe COMMAND
|
<------------------------|
CIPHER MODE COMPLETE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
CM SERVICE PROMPT
|
<------------------------|
START CC
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
CC-ESTABLISHMENT
|
<-------------------------_ |
CC-ESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
RECALL
|
<------------------------|
|
SETUP
|
------------------------->
|
CALL PROCEEDING
|
<------------------------|
-+
-+
ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
|
<------------------------|
ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
ALERTING
|
<------------------------|
-+
-+
CONNECT
|
<------------------------|
CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
PAGING REQUEST
<------------------------CHANNEL REQUEST
------------------------->
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
<-------------------------
RR connection
establishment
(MT)
Authentication
Ciphering
mode setting
Service Request
Recall initiation
Assignment of
a traffic
channel
ETSI
238
Mobile Station
+|
|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
|
|
|
++|
|
++|
|
|
|
++|
|
|
|
+-
Network
-+
|
|
|
|
|
|
-+
-+
PAGING RESPONSE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
AUTHENTICATION REQUEST
|
<------------------------|
AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
CIPHer MODe COMMAND
|
<------------------------|
CIPHER MODE COMPLETE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
CM SERVICE PROMPT
|
<------------------------|
START CC
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
CC-ESTABLISHMENT
|
<-------------------------_ |
CC-ESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
RECALL
|
<------------------------|
|
SETUP
|
------------------------->
|
CALL PROCEEDING
|
<------------------------|
-+
-+
ALERTING
|
<------------------------|
-+
-+
ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
|
<------------------------|
ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
-+
CONNECT
|
<------------------------|
CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
|
------------------------->
|
-+
PAGING REQUEST
<------------------------CHANNEL REQUEST
------------------------->
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
<-------------------------
RR connection
establishment
(MT)
Authentication
Ciphering
mode setting
Service Request
Recall initiation
Call accepted
ETSI
239
8.1
General
The procedures specified in GSM 04.08 and call-related supplementary service handling in GSM 04.10 apply to those
messages which pass the checks described in this section.
This section also specifies procedures for the handling of unknown, unforeseen, and erroneous protocol data by the
receiving entity. These procedures are called "error handling procedures", but in addition to providing recovery
mechanisms for error situations they define a compatibility mechanism for future extensions of the protocols.
Error handling concerning the value part of the Facility IE and of the SS Version Indicator IE are not in the scope of this
technical specification. It is defined in GSM 04.10 and the GSM 04.8x series.
Subsections 8.1 to 8.8 shall be applied in order of precedence.
Most error handling procedures are mandatory for the mobile station.
Detailed error handling procedures in the network are implementation dependent and may vary from PLMN to PLMN.
However, when extensions of this protocol are developed, networks will be assumed to have the error handling that is
indicated in this section as mandatory ("shall") and that is indicated as strongly recommended ("should"). Sections 8.2,
8.3, 8.4, 8.5 and 8.7.2 do not apply to the error handling in the network applied to the receipt of initial layer 3 message:
If the network diagnoses an error described in one of these sections in the initial layer 3 message received from the
mobile station, it shall either:
-
try to recognize the classmark and then take further implementation dependent actions; or
Also, the error handling of the network is only considered as mandatory or strongly recommended when certain
thresholds for errors are not reached during a dedicated connection.
In this section the following terminology is used:
-
An IE is defined to be syntactically incorrect in a message if it contains at least one value defined as "reserved"
in section 10, or if its value part violates rules of section 10. However it is not a syntactical error that a type 4 IE
specifies in its length indicator a greater length than defined in section 10.
A message is defined to have semantically incorrect contents if it contains information which, possibly
dependent on the state of the receiver, is in contradiction to the resources of the receiver and/or to the procedural
part (i.e. sections 3, 4, 5) of GSM 04.08, GSM 04.10, or relevant GSM 04.8X series.
8.2
When a message is received that is too short to contain a complete message type information element, that message
shall be ignored, cf. GSM 04.07.
8.3
8.3.1
Call Control
The mobile station and network shall ignore a call control message received with TI value "111". For a call control
message received with TI different from "111", the following procedures shall apply:
a) For a network that does not support the "Network initiated MO call" option and for all mobile stations:
Whenever any call control message except EMERGENCY SETUP, SETUP or RELEASE COMPLETE is
received specifying a transaction identifier which is not recognized as relating to an active call or to a call in
ETSI
240
progress, the receiving entity shall send a RELEASE COMPLETE message with cause #81 "invalid transaction
identifier value" using the received transaction identifier value and remain in the Null state.
For a network that does support the "Network initiated MO call" option $(CCBS)$:
Whenever any call control message except EMERGENCY SETUP, SETUP, START CC or RELEASE
COMPLETE is received specifying a transaction identifier which is not recognized as relating to an active call or
to a call in progress, the receiving entity shall send a RELEASE COMPLETE message with cause #81 "invalid
transaction identifier value" using the received transaction identifier value and remain in the Null state.
b) When a RELEASE COMPLETE message is received specifying a transaction identifier which is not recognized
as relating to an active call or to a call in progress, the MM connection associated with that transaction identifier
shall be released.
c) For a network that does not support the "Network initiated MO call" option and for all mobile stations:
When an EMERGENCY SETUP or, a SETUP message is received specifying a transaction identifier which is
not recognized as relating to an active call or to a call in progress, and with a transaction identifier flag
incorrectly set to "1", this message shall be ignored.
For a network that does support the "Network initiated MO call" option $(CCBS)$:
When an EMERGENCY SETUP, a START CC or, a SETUP message is received specifying a transaction
identifier which is not recognised as relating to an active call or to a call in progress, and with a transaction
identifier flag incorrectly set to "1", this message shall be ignored.
d) When a SETUP message is received by the mobile station specifying a transaction identifier which is recognized
as relating to an active call or to a call in progress, this SETUP message shall be ignored.
e) For a network that does not support the "Network initiated MO call" option:
When an EMERGENCY SETUP message or a SETUP message is received by the network specifying a
transaction identifier which is recognized as relating to an active call or to a call in progress, this message need
not be treated and the network may perform other actions.
For a network that does support the "Network initiated MO call" option $(CCBS)$:
When an EMERGENCY SETUP message or a START CC message is received by the network specifying a
transaction identifier which is recognised as relating to an active call or to a call in progress, this message need
not be treated and the network may perform other actions.
The same applies to a SETUP message unless the transaction has been established by a START_CC message
and the network is in the "recall present" state (N0.6).
8.3.2
Session Management
The mobile station and network shall reject a session management message other than SM-STATUS received with TI
value "111" by immediately sending an SM-STATUS message with TI value "111". For a session management message
received with TI different from "111", the following procedures shall apply:
a) Whenever any session management message except ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST, ACTIVATE AA
PDP CONTEXT REQUEST or SM-STATUS is received by the network specifying a transaction identifier
which is not recognized as relating to an active context or to a context that is in the process of activation or
deactivation or has been [recently] deactivated, the network should send a SM-STATUS message with cause #81
"invalid transaction identifier value" using the received transaction identifier value and remain in the PDPINACTIVE state.
b) Whenever any session management message except REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION or SMSTATUS is received by the MS specifying a transaction identifier which is not recognized as relating to an
active context or to a context that is in the process of activation or deactivation or has been [recently]
deactivated, the MS shall send a SM-STATUS message with cause #81 "invalid transaction identifier value"
using the received transaction identifier value and remain in the PDP-INACTIVE state.
c) When an ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST or REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION message
is received with a transaction identifier flag set to "1", this message shall be ignored.
ETSI
241
d) When an ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message is received specifying a transaction identifier which
is not recognized as relating to a context that is in the process of activation, and with a transaction identifier flag
set to "1", this message shall be ignored.
e) Whenever an ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST or ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST
message is received by the network specifying a transaction identifier relating to a PDP context not in state
PDP-INACTIVE, the network shall deactivate the old PDP context relating to the received transaction identifier
without notifying the MS. Furthermore, the network shall continue with the activation procedure of a new PDP
context as indicated in the received message.
f) Whenever a REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION message is received by the MS specifying a transaction
identifier relating to a PDP context not in state PDP-INACTIVE, the MS shall locally deactivate the old PDP
context relating to the received transaction identifier. Furthermore, the MS shall continue with the activation
procedure of a new PDP context as indicated in the received message.
8.4
If a mobile station receives an RR, MM or CC message with message type not defined for the PD or not implemented
by the receiver in unacknowledged mode, it shall ignore the message.
If a mobile station receives an RR, MM or CC message with message type not defined for the PD or not implemented
by the receiver in acknowledged mode, it shall return a status message (STATUS, RR STATUS or MM STATUS
depending on the protocol discriminator) with cause # 97 "message type non-existent or not implemented".
If a mobile station receives a GMM message or SM message with message type not defined for the PD or not
implemented by the receiver, it shall return a status message (GMM STATUS or SM STATUS depending on the
protocol discriminator) with cause # 97 "message type non-existent or not implemented".
If the network receives an RR message or MM message with message type not defined for the PD or not implemented
by the receiver in a protocol state where reception of an unsolicited message with the given PD from the mobile station
is not foreseen in the protocol, the network actions are implementation dependent. Otherwise, if the network receives a
message with message type not defined for the PD or not implemented by the receiver, it shall ignore the message
except that it should return a status message (STATUS, RR STATUS, MM STATUS, GMM STATUS or SM STATUS
depending on the protocol discriminator) with cause #97 "message type non-existent or not implemented".
NOTE 1: A message type not defined for the PD in the given direction is regarded by the receiver as a message
type not defined for the PD, see GSM 04.07 [20].
If the mobile station receives a message not compatible with the protocol state, the mobile station shall ignore the
message except for the fact that, if an RR connection exists, it returns a status message (STATUS, RR STATUS or MM
STATUS depending on the protocol discriminator) with cause #98 "Message type not compatible with protocol state".
When the message was a GMM message the GMM-STATUS message with cause #98 "Message type not compatible
with protocol state" shall be returned. When the message was a SM message the SM-STATUS message with cause #98
"Message type not compatible with protocol state" shall be returned.
If the network receives a message not compatible with the protocol state, the network actions are implementation
dependent.
NOTE 2: The use by GMM and SM of unacknowledged LLC may lead to messages "not compatible with the
protocol state".
8.5
ETSI
242
an IE unknown in the message, but encoded as "comprehension required" (see section GSM 04.07); or
is received,
-
8.5.1
try to treat the message (the exact further actions are implementation dependent), or
ignore the message except that it should return a status message (STATUS, RR STATUS, MM STATUS
(depending on the protocol discriminator), GMM STATUS, or SM STATUS) with cause # 96 "Invalid
mandatory information".
8.5.2
Mobility management
8.5.3
Call control
a) If the message is a SETUP message, a RELEASE COMPLETE message with cause # 96 "invalid mandatory
information" shall be returned.
b) If the message is a DISCONNECT message, a RELEASE message shall be returned with cause value # 96
"invalid mandatory information" and section 5.4. "call clearing" applies as normal.
c) If the message is a RELEASE message, a RELEASE COMPLETE message shall be returned with cause value #
96 "invalid mandatory information".
d) If the message is a RELEASE COMPLETE message, it shall be treated as a normal RELEASE COMPLETE
message.
e) If the message is a HOLD REJECT or RETRIEVE REJECT message, it shall be treated as a normal HOLD
REJECT or RETRIEVE REJECT message.
f) If the message is a STATUS message and received by the network, a RELEASE COMPLETE message may be
returned with cause value # 96 "invalid mandatory information".
8.5.4
ETSI
8.5.5
243
Session management
a) If the message is a DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST, a DEACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT
message shall be returned. All resources allocated for that context shall be released.
b) If the message is a DEACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST, a DEACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT
ACCEPT message shall be returned. All resources allocated for that context shall be released.
c)
If the message is a REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION, a REQUEST PDP CONTEXT REJECT
message with cause # 96 "Invalid mandatory information" shall be returned.
d) If the message is an ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST, an ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REJECT
message with cause # 96 "Invalid mandatory information" shall be returned.
e) If the message is an ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT REQUEST, an ACTIVATE AA PDP CONTEXT
REJECT message with cause # 96 "Invalid mandatory information" shall be returned.
8.6
8.6.1
The MS shall ignore all IEs unknown in a message which are not encoded as "comprehension required" (see
GSM 04.07).
The network shall take the same approach.
8.6.2
The MS shall ignore all out of sequence IEs in a message which are not encoded as "comprehension required" (see
GSM 04.07).
The network should take the same approach.
8.6.3
Repeated IEs
If an information element with format T, TV, or TLV is repeated in a message in which repetition of the information
element is not specified in section 9 of this technical specification, only the contents of the information element
appearing first shall be handled and all subsequent repetitions of the information element shall be ignored. When
repetition of information elements is specified, only the contents of specified repeated information elements shall be
handled. If the limit on repetition of information elements is exceeded, the contents of information elements appearing
first up to the limit of repetitions shall be handled and all subsequent repetitions of the information element shall be
ignored.
The network should follow the same procedures.
8.7
conditional IE errors.
8.7.1
The MS shall treat all optional IEs that are syntactically incorrect in a message as not present in the message.
The network shall take the same approach.
ETSI
8.7.2
244
Conditional IE errors
When the MS upon receipt of an RR, MM or CC message diagnoses a "missing conditional IE" error or an "unexpected
conditional IE" error or when it receives an RR, MM or CC message containing at least one syntactically incorrect
conditional IE, it shall ignore the message except for the fact that, if an RR connection exists, it shall return a status
message (STATUS, RR STATUS, or MM STATUS depending on the PD) with cause value # 100 "conditional IE
error".
When the MS upon receipt of a GMM or SM message diagnoses a "missing conditional IE" error or an "unexpected
conditional IE" error or when it receives a GMM or SM message containing at least one syntactically incorrect
conditional IE, it shall ignore the message and it shall return a status message (GMM STATUS or SM STATUS
depending on the PD) with cause value # 100 "conditional IE error".
When the network receives a message and diagnose a "missing conditional IE" error or an "unexpected conditional IE"
error or when it receives a message containing at least one syntactically incorrect conditional IE, the network shall
either
-
try to treat the message (the exact further actions are implementation dependent), or
ignore the message except that it should return a status message (STATUS, RR STATUS, MM STATUS, GMM
STATUS or SM STATUS depending on the protocol discriminator) with cause # 100 "conditional IE error".
8.8
When a message with semantically incorrect contents is received, the foreseen reactions of the procedural part of
GSM 04.08 (i.e. of sections 3, 4, 5) are performed. If however no such reactions are specified, the MS shall ignore the
message except for the fact that, if an RR connection exists, it returns a status message (STATUS, RR STATUS, or
MM STATUS depending on the PD) with cause value # 95 "semantically incorrect message".
The network should follow the same procedure except that a status message is not normally transmitted.
Semantic checking of the Facility information element value part (defined in GSM 04.80) is the subject of the technical
specifications GSM 04.10 and the GSM 04.8x series.
This section defines the structure of the messages of those layer 3 protocols defined in GSM 04.08. These are standard
L3 messages as defined in GSM 04.07 with the exception of those sent on the SCH, RACH, and the HANDOVER
ACCESS message.
Each definition given in the present section includes:
a) a brief description of the message direction and use, including whether the message has:
1. Local significance, i.e. relevant only on the originating or terminating access;
2. Access significance, i.e. relevant in the originating and terminating access, but not in the network;
3. Dual significance, i.e. relevant in either the originating or terminating access and in the network; or
4. Global significance, i.e. relevant in the originating and terminating access and in the network.
b) a table listing the information elements known in the message and their order of their appearance in the message.
In messages for circuit-switched call control also a shift information element shall be considered as known even
if not included in the table. All information elements that may be repeated are explicitly indicated. ( V and LV
formatted IEs, which compose the imperative part of the message, occur before T, TV, and TLV formatted IEs
which compose the non-imperative part of the message, cf. GSM 04.07.) In a (maximal) sequence of consecutive
information elements with half octet length, the first information element with half octet length occupies bits 1 to
4 of octet N, the second bits 5 to 8 of octet N, the third bits 1 to 4 of octet N+1 etc. Such a sequence always has
an even number of elements.
For each information element the table indicates:
ETSI
245
1. the information element identifier, in hexadecimal notation, if the IE has format T, TV, or TLV. Usually,
there is a default IEI for an information element type; default IEIs of different IE types of the same protocol
are different. If the IEI has half octet length, it is specified by a notation representing the IEI as a
hexadecimal digit followed by a "-" (example: B-).
NOTE The same IEI may be used for different information element types in different messages of the same
protocol.2. the name of the information element (which may give an idea of the semantics of the element).
The name of the information element (usually written in italics) followed by "IE" or "information element" is
used in GSM 04.08 as reference to the information element within a message.
3. the name of the type of the information element (which indicates the coding of the value part of the IE), and
generally, the referenced subsection of section 10 of GSM 04.08 describing the value part of the information
element.
4. the presence requirement indication (M, C, or O) for the IE as defined in GSM 04.07.
5. The format of the information element (T, V, TV, LV, TLV) as defined in GSM 04.07.
6. The length of the information element (or permissible range of lengths), in octets, in the message, where "?"
means that the maximum length of the IE is only constrained by link layer protocol, and in the case of the
Facility IE by possible further conditions specified in GSM 04.10. This indication is non-normative.
c) subsections specifying, where appropriate, conditions for IEs with presence requirement C or O in the relevant
message which together with other conditions specified in GSM 04.08 define when the information elements
shall be included or not, what non-presence of such IEs means, and - for IEs with presence requirement C - the
static conditions for presence and/or non-presence of the IEs (cf. GSM 04.07).
9.1
Table 9.1/GSM 04.08 summarizes the messages for Radio Resources management.
ETSI
246
(continued...)
ETSI
Reference
9.1.1
9.1.18
9.1.19
9.1.20
Reference
9.1.9
9.1.10
Reference
9.1.2
9.1.3
9.1.4
9.1.13a
9.1.14
9.1.15
9.1.16
9.1.17
9.1.21e
9.1.28
9.1.28a
9.1.14
9.1.15
9.1.16
9.1.17
9.1.28
Reference
9.1.7
9.1.26
9.1.27
Reference
9.1.22
9.1.23
9.1.24
9.1.25
247
9.1.1
Reference
9.1.31
9.1.32
9.1.33
9.1.34
9.1.35
9.1.36
9.1.37
9.1.38
9.1.39
9.1.40
9.1.41
9.1.42
9.1.43
9.1.43a
9.1.43d
9.1.43e
Reference
9.1.21a
9.1.21b
TALKER INDICATION
UPLINK ACCESS
UPLINK BUSY
UPLINK FREE
UPLINK RELEASE
VGCS UPLINK GRANT
9.1.44
9.1.45
9.1.46
9.1.47
9.1.48
9.1.49
9.1.51
9.1.52
Reference
9.1.5
9.1.6
9.1.8
9.1.11
9.1.12
9.1.13
9.1.21
9.1.30
9.1.29
9.1.13b
Reference
9.1.12b
9.1.12c
9.1.12d
Additional assignment
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the network to the mobile station to allocate an additional dedicated
channel while keeping the previously allocated channels. See table 9.2/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
ADDITIONAL ASSIGNMENT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
248
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Additional Assignment
Message Type
Channel Description
72
Mobile Allocation
7C
Starting Time
9.1.1.1
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Channel Description
10.5.2.5
Mobile Allocation
10.5.2.21
Starting Time
10.5.2.38
Presence
M
Format
V
length
TLV
3-10
TV
Mobile Allocation
This information element shall appear if the Channel Description information element indicates frequency hopping.
If the Channel Description IE does not indicate frequency hopping and the information element is present it shall be
considered as an IE unnecessary in the message.
9.1.1.2
Starting Time
9.1.2
Assignment command
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the network to the mobile station to change the channel configuration to
another independent dedicated channel configuration, when no timing adjustment is needed. See table 9.3/GSM 04.08
Message type:
ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Assignment command
Message Type
Description of the
First Channel, after time
Power Command
05
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Channel Description 2
10.5.2.5a
Power Command
10.5.2.28
Frequency List
10.5.2.13
(continued)
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
length
TLV
4-132
249
11
Cell Channel
Description
Description of the
multislot configuration
Mode of the First
Channel (Channel Set 1)
Mode of Channel Set 2
13
14
15
16
17
18
64
7C
Description of the
Second Channel, after time
Mode of the Second
Channel
Mobile Allocation,
after time
Starting Time
19
1C
Description of the
First Channel, before time
Description of the
Second Channel, before time
Frequency channel sequence
10
63
66
72
1D
1E
9-
before time
Mobile Allocation,
before time
Cipher Mode Setting
01
03
Multi-Rate
configuration
21
9.1.2.1
TV
17
TLV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TLV
3-10
TV
TLV
4-132
TV
TV
TV
10
TLV
3-10
TV
TLV
TLV
4-8
3-12
Mode of the First Channel (Channel Set 1) and Mode of Channel Set "X"
(2=<X=<8)
If this information element is not present the channel mode of the previously allocated channel or channels for Channel
Set "X" (1=<X<=8) shall be assumed.
If Channel Set "X" is not defined for the configuration, the Mode of Channel Set "X" IE shall be considered as an IE
unnecessary in the message.
NOTE:
Clause 3.4.3.1 defines cases when one or several Mode of Channel Set "X" IEs shall be included in the
message.
ETSI
9.1.2.2
250
These information elements appear in the case of an assignment occurring if the mobile station carries two connections
(on two dedicated channels, for the TCH/H + TCH/H configuration).
The connection using the channel previously defined in the Description of the First Channel IEs of an ASSIGNMENT
COMMAND or HANDOVER COMMAND message shall use the channel defined in the Description of the First
Channel IEs of the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message defining the new configuration.
The channel described in the Description of the First Channel IEs carries the main DCCH. The SACCH used is the one
associated with that channel.
9.1.2.3
If no Description of the Second Channel IE is present but the information element is present it shall be considered as an
IE unnecessary in the message.
This information element appears at least when the channel mode is changed for the channel defined in the second
channel description information elements.
9.1.2.4
If at least one of the channel descriptions for the starting time indicates frequency hopping, one and only one of the
following information elements shall be present and apply to all assigned channels
-
If neither of the Channel Description IEs for after time indicate frequency hopping, if decoding of Channel Description
IEs for before time does not require a frequency list for after time (see next section), and one or both of the two
information elements are present they shall be considered as IEs unnecessary in the message.
9.1.2.5
Starting Time
The starting time information element is included when the network wants the mobile station to change the frequency
parameters of the channels more or less at the moment a change of channel occurs. In this case a number of information
elements may be included to give the frequency parameters to be used before the starting time.
If the starting time information element is present and none of the information elements referring to before the starting
time are present, the mobile station waits and accesses the channels at the indicated time.
If the starting time information element is present and at least one of the information elements referring to before the
starting time is present, the mobile station does not wait for the indicated time and accesses the channel using the
frequency parameters for before the starting time.
If the starting time information element is not present and at some of the information elements referring to before the
starting time is present, these information elements shall be considered as IEs unnecessary in the message.
If the description of the first channel, before time IE is not present, the channel description to apply for before the time,
if needed, is given by the description of the first channel, after time IE.
If the description of the second channel, after time IE is present, the description of the second channel, before time IE
not present, and a description of the configuration for before the time needed, the channel configuration before the
starting time is nevertheless of two traffic channels, and the channel description to apply to the second channel before
the starting time is given by the description of the second channel, after time IE.
If the starting time IE is present and at least one of the channel descriptions for before the starting time indicates
frequency hopping, one and only one of the following information elements may be present and applies before the
starting time to all assigned channels
-
ETSI
251
If the starting time IE is present and at least one of the channel descriptions for before the starting time indicates
frequency hopping, and none of the above mentioned IE is present, a frequency list for after the starting time must be
present (see 9.1.2.4), and this list applies also for the channels before the starting time.
9.1.2.6
If any of the mobile allocation information elements is present, then the network must ensure that either the mobile
station has received in a previous message the proper reference cell frequency list (CA), or that the cell channel
description IE is present.
If the cell channel description IE is present, it is used to decode the mobile allocation IEs in the message, as well as in
later messages until reception of a new reference cell frequency list or the cell is left.
9.1.2.7
If present, this information element shall be used to decode the Mobile Allocation IE in the same message and in
subsequent messages.
9.1.2.8
If this information element is omitted, the mode of ciphering is not changed after the mobile station has switched to the
assigned channel.
9.1.2.9
This information element is identified as "comprehension required". Only mobile stations supporting VGCS talking
are required to accept the presence of the element. The presence of the element shall trigger an exception handling if
received by a mobile station not supporting VGCS talking .
This IE indicates which mode is to be used on the new channel (i.e. dedicated mode or group transmit mode). If this
information element is not present, the mode shall be the same as on the previous channel.
The IE also indicates the group cipher key number for the group cipher key to be used on the new channel or if the new
channel is non ciphered. If the information element is not present, the ciphering mode shall be the same as on the
previous channel.
NOTE:
9.1.2.10
A mobile station supporting VGCS talking shall not consider a syntactical error when this IE is present
and the channel mode is not speech.
This information element is included if so indicated by the channel type and TDMA offset field in the Channel
Description information element and is used to assign channels that do not carry a main signalling link in a multislot
configuration. It indicates how the used timeslots are divided into separate channel sets.
If the Channel Description IE does not require the presence of the information element the Description of the multislot
allocation IE shall be considered as an IE unnecessary in the message.
If multislot configuration is indicated by the Channel Description IE but the Multislot Allocation IE is not present, all
channels in the configuration belong to one channel set, "Channel Set 1".
NOTE:
9.1.2.11
As a change of timeslot number cannot occur for the channel described after the starting time, the
Multislot Allocation IE does not have to be included more than once.
This information element appears if the Mode of the First Channel indicates a multi-rate speech codec, and if the
assigned configuration is new, i.e. it is different from the MultiRateconfiguration of a previously allocated channel in
the cell.
ETSI
9.1.3
252
Assignment complete
This message is sent on the main DCCH from the mobile station to the network to indicate that the mobile station has
established the main signalling link successfully. See table 9.4/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Assignment Complete
Message Type
RR Cause
9.1.4
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
RR Cause
10.5.2.31
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
Assignment failure
This message is sent on the main DCCH on the old channel from the mobile station to the network to indicate that the
mobile station has failed to seize the new channel. See table 9.5/GSM 04.08
Message type:
ASSIGNMENT FAILURE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Assignment Failure
Message Type
RR cause
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
RR Cause
10.5.2.31
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
9.1.5
253
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the network to the mobile station to request the setting of the mode for the
indicated channel(s). The message can be used to change the channel mode of a Multislot Configuration which only
contains one channel set. See table 9.6/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Channel Mode Modify
Message Type
Channel Description
Channel Mode
01
03
Multi-Rate
configuration
9.1.5.1
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Channel Description 2
10.5.2.5a
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
VGCS target mode Indication
10.5.2.42a
MultiRate configuration
10.5.2.21aa
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
TLV
TLV
4-8
Channel Description
This is sufficient to identify the channel in the case of a TCH/H + TCH/H configuration. If used for a multislot
configuration, the IE shall describe the present channel configuration with TN indicating the main channel. The IE shall
not indicate a new channel configuration when included in the Channel Mode Modify message.
9.1.5.2
This information element is identified as "comprehension required". Only mobile stations supporting VGCS talking
are required to accept the presence of the element. The presence of the element shall trigger an exception handling if
received by a mobile station not supporting VGCS talking .
This IE indicates which RR mode is to be used with the new channel mode (i.e. dedicated mode or group transmit
mode). If this information element is not present, the RR mode shall be the same as with the previous channel mode.
The IE also indicates the group cipher key number for the group cipher key to be used on the new channel or if the new
channel is non ciphered. If the information element is not present, the ciphering mode shall be the same as with the
previous channel mode.
NOTE:
9.1.5.3
A mobile station supporting VGCS Talking shall not consider a syntactical error if this IE is present and
the channel mode is not speech.
This information element appears if the Channel Mode IE indicates a multi-rate speech codec.
9.1.6
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the mobile station to the network to indicate the successful or unsuccessful
execution of a channel mode modify request. See table 9.7/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
ETSI
254
Significance:
local
Direction:
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Channel Mode Modify
Acknowledge Message Type
Channel Description
Channel Mode
9.1.7
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Channel Description 2
10.5.2.5a
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
Channel release
This message is sent on the main DCCH from the network to the mobile station to initiate deactivation of the dedicated
channel used. See table 9.8/GSM 04.08
Message type:
CHANNEL RELEASE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
255
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Channel Release
Message Type
RR Cause
73
BA Range
74
8x
Cx
GPRS Resumption
75
BA List Pref
9.1.7.1
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
RR Cause
10.5.2.31
BA Range
10.5.2.1a
Group Channel Description
10.5.2.14b
Group Cipher Key Number
10.5.1.10
GPRS Resumption
10.5.2.14c
BA List Pref
10.5.2.1c
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
TLV
6-?
TLV
4-13
TV
TV
TLV
3-?
If a CHANNEL RELEASE is send to a mobile station which is in dedicated mode and which is involved in a voice
group call or has responded to a notification to a voice group call or voice broadcast call, a group channel description
may be included, describing the voice group call channel or voice broadcast channel to which the mobile station shall
go after the channel release procedure.
Mobile stations not supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening shall consider this information element as unnecessary.
9.1.7.2
This IE may be present only if the Group channel description IE is provided. The presence of this IE indicates that the
mobile station shall use the Group Cipher Key indicated by the Group Cipher Key Number IE for deciphering on the
VGCS or VBS channel. If this IE is not present, no ciphering is applied on the VGCS or VBS channel.
Mobile stations not supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening shall ignore this information element.
9.1.8
Channel request
This message is sent in random mode on the RACH. It does not follow the basic format. The possible formats are
presented directly below, without reference to information fields. The order of bit transmission is defined in
GSM 04.04.
The message is only one octet long, coded as shown in figure 9.1/GSM 4.08 and table 9.9/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
| ESTABLISHMENT |
RANDOM
|
|
+ - - - - - - - - +
|octet 1
|
CAUSE
| REFERENCE |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 9.1/GSM 04.08: CHANNEL REQUEST message content
ESTABLISHMENT CAUSE (octet 1)
This information field indicates the reason for requesting the establishment of a connection. This field has a variable
length (from 3 bits up to 6 bits).
RANDOM REFERENCE (octet 1)
This is an unformatted field with variable length (from 5 bits down to 2 bits).
ETSI
256
101xxxxx
Emergency call
110xxxxx
011010xx
011011xx
100xxxxx
0010xxxx
0011xxxx
0001xxxx
Answer to paging
111xxxxx
0100xxxx
NECI bit to 1
0101xxxx
bit to 1
note 1
sets
NECI
000xxxxx
Location updating and the network does not set NECI bit to 1
0000xxxx
0001xxxx
011110xx
01111x0x
01111xx0
One phase packet access with request for single timeslot uplink
transmission; one PDCH is needed.
01110xxx
Single block packet access; one block period on a PDCH is needed for
two phase packet access or other RR signalling purpose.
01100xxx
note 2
01111111
note 2a
note 1
NOTE 1: Examples of these procedures are: IMSI detach, Short Message Service (SMS), Supplementary Service
management, Location Services.
NOTE 2: If such messages are received by a network, an SDCCH may be allocated.
NOTE 2a: This value shall not be used by the mobile station on RACH. If such message is received by the network,
it may be ignored.
ETSI
257
9.1.9
This message is sent on the main DCCH from the network to the mobile station to indicate that the network has started
deciphering and that enciphering and deciphering shall be started in the mobile station, or to indicate that ciphering will
not be performed. See table 9.10/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Cipher Mode Command
Message Type
Ciphering Mode Setting
Cipher Response
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Cipher Mode Setting
10.5.2.9
Cipher Response
10.5.2.10
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
1/2
1/2
9.1.10
258
This message is sent on the main DCCH from the mobile station to the network to indicate that enciphering and
deciphering has been started in the MS. See table 9.11/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Cipher Mode Complete
Message Type
Mobile Equipment
Identity
17
9.1.10.1
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Mobile Identity
10.5.1.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
TLV
3-11
This information element is included if and only if the mobile station shall include its IMEISV (see section 3.4.7). This
information element shall only refer to IMEISV.
9.1.11
Classmark change
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the mobile station to the network to indicate a classmark change or as a
response to a classmark enquiry. See table 9.12/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CLASSMARK CHANGE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Classmark Change
Message Type
Mobile Station
Classmark
20
Additional Mobile
Station Classmark
Information
9.1.11.1
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Mobile Station
Classmark 2
10.5.1.6
Mobile Station
Classmark 3
10.5.1.7
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
1/2
LV
TLV
3-14
This IE shall be included if and only if the CM3 bit in the Mobile Station Classmark IE is set to 1.
ETSI
length
9.1.11.2
259
This IE shall include for multiband MS the Classmark 2 corresponding to the frequency band in use.
9.1.12
Classmark enquiry
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the network to the mobile station to request classmark information. See
table 9.12a/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CLASSMARK ENQUIRY
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Classmark Enquiry
Message Type
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
9.1.12a Spare
9.1.12b Configuration change command
This message is sent on the main DCCH from the network to the mobile station to change the channel configuration of a
multislot configuration. See table 9.12b/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
260
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
63
Configuration change
Message Type
Description of the
multislot configuration
Mode of Channel Set 1
11
13
14
15
16
17
18
9.1.12b.1
Type/Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Multislot Allocation
10.5.2.21b
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
LV
2-11
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
This information element is used to assign channels that do not carry the main signalling link in a multislot
configuration. It indicates if multiple channel sets are used.
9.1.12b.2
If this information element is not present the channel mode of the previously allocated channel or channels for Channel
Set "X" shall be assumed.
If Channel Set "X" is not defined for the configuration, the Mode of Channel Set "X" IE shall be considered as an IE
unnecessary in the message.
NOTE:
Clause 3.4.16.1 defines cases when one or several Mode of Channel Set "X" IEs shall be included in the
message.
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
261
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Configuration Change
Acknowledge Message Type
Type/Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
Significance:
dual
Direction:
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Configuration Change
Reject Message Type
RR Cause
9.1.13
Type/Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
RR Cause
10.5.2.31
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
Frequency redefinition
This message is sent on the main DCCH from the network to the MS to indicate that the frequencies and the hopping
sequence of the allocated channels shall be changed. See table 9.13/GSM 04.08
Message type:
FREQUENCY REDEFINITION
Significance:
dual
Direction:
network to MS
ETSI
262
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Frequency Redefinition
Message Type
Channel Description
Mobile Allocation
Starting Time
62
Cell Channel
Description
9.1.13.1
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Channel Description
10.5.2.5
Mobile Allocation
10.5.2.21
Starting Time
10.5.2.38
Cell Channel Description
10.5.2.1b
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
LV
1-9
TV
17
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
263
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
PDCH Assignment command
Message Type
Description of the
Channel, after time
Cell Channel
Description
Frequency List, after time
62
05
72
7C
Mobile Allocation,
after time
Starting Time
19
1C
Description of the
Channel, before time
Frequency channel sequence
1E
before time
Mobile Allocation,
before time
RR Packet Uplink
Assignment
21
22
23
RR Packet Downlink
Assignment
9.1.13a.1
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Channel Description
10.5.2.5
Cell Channel Description
10.5.2.1b
Frequency List
10.5.2.13
Mobile Allocation
10.5.2.21
Starting Time
10.5.2.38
Frequency List
10.5.2.13
Channel Description
10.5.2.5
Frequency channel
sequence
10.5.2.12
Mobile Allocation
10.5.2.21
RR Packet Uplink
Assignment
10.5.2.25a
RR Packet Downlink
Assignment
10.5.2.25b
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
TV
17
TLV
4-132
TLV
3-10
TV
TLV
4-132
TV
TV
10
TLV
3-10
TLV
3-?
TLV
3-?
If the channel description for after the starting time indicates frequency hopping, one and only one of the following
information elements shall be present
-
If the Channel Description IE for after time does not indicate frequency hopping, if decoding of Channel Description IE
for before time does not require a frequency list for after time (see next section), and one or both of the two information
elements are present they shall be considered as IEs unnecessary in the message.
9.1.13a.2
Starting Time
The starting time information element is included when the network wants the mobile station to change the frequency
parameters of the channels more or less at the moment the change to a TBF occurs. In this case a number of information
elements may be included to give the frequency parameters to be used before the starting time.
If the starting time information element is present and none of the information elements referring to before the starting
time are present, the mobile station waits and uses the TBFfrom the indicated time.
If the starting time information element is present and at least one of the information elements referring to before the
starting time is present, the mobile station does not wait for the indicated time and uses the TBF using the frequency
parameters for before the starting time.
If the starting time information element is not present and some of the information elements referring to before the
starting time is present, these information elements shall be considered as IEs unnecessary in the message.
ETSI
264
If the description of the channel, before time IE is not present, the channel description to apply for before the time, if
needed, is given by the description of the channel, after time IE.
If the starting time IE is present and the channel description for before the starting time indicates frequency hopping,
one and only one of the following information elements may be present and applies before the starting time
-
If the starting time IE is present and the channel description for before the starting time indicates frequency hopping,
and none of the above mentioned IE is present, a frequency list for after the starting time must be present (see 9.1.2.4),
and this list applies also for the TBF before the starting time.
9.1.13a.3
If any of the mobile allocation information elements are present, then the network shall ensure that either the mobile
station has received in a previous message the proper reference cell frequency list (CA), or that the cell channel
description IE is present.
If the cell channel description IE is present, it is used to decode the mobile allocation IEs in the message, as well as in
later dedicated mode messages until reception of a new reference cell frequency list or the cell is left.
9.1.13a.4
If present, this information element shall be used to decode the Mobile Allocation IE in the same message and in
subsequent messages.
9.1.13a.5
Packet Assignment
One and only one of the following information elements shall be present:
-
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
265
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
GPRS Suspension Request
Message Type
Temporary Logical Link
Identity
Routeing Area Identification
Suspension cause
9.1.14
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
TLLI
10.5.2.41a
Routeing Area Identification
10.5.5.15
Suspension cause
10.5.2.47
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
Handover access
This message is sent in random mode on the main DCCH during a handover procedure. It does not follow the basic
format. The format is presented directly below without reference to information elements. The order of bit transmission
is defined in GSM 04.04.
This message is only one octet long, coded as shown in figure 9.2/GSM 04.08 and table 9.14/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
handover reference
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 9.2/GSM 04.08: HANDOVER ACCESS message content
9.1.15
Handover command
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the network to the mobile station to change the dedicated channel
configuration, timing adjustment needed. See table 9.15/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
HANDOVER COMMAND
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
266
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
7C
Mobile Allocation,
after time
Starting Time
7B
7D
Timing Advance
12
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Cell description
10.5.2.2
Channel Description 2
10.5.2.5a
Handover Reference
10.5.2.15
Power Command and Access
type
10.5.2.28a
Synchronization
Indication
10.5.2.39
Frequency Short List
10.5.2.14
Frequency List
10.5.2.13
Cell Channel Description
10.5.2.1b
Multislot Allocation
10.5.2.21b
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
10.5.2.6
Channel Description
10.5.2.5
Channel Mode 2
10.5.2.7
Frequency Channel
Sequence
10.5.2.12
Mobile Allocation
10.5.2.21
Starting Time
10.5.2.38
Time Difference
10.5.2.41
Timing Advance
10.5.2.40
Frequency Short List
10.5.2.14
Frequency List
10.5.2.13
Description of the
Channel Description 2
Handover Command
Message Type
Cell Description
Description of the
first channel, after time
Handover Reference
Power Command and Access
type
D-
Synchronization
Indication
02
11
13
14
15
16
17
18
64
Description of the
Second Channel, after time
Mode of the Second
Channel
Frequency Channel
Sequence, after time
05
62
10
63
66
69
72
19
1C
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
TV
TV
10
TLV
4-131
TV
17
TLV
3-12
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
10
TLV
3-10
TV
TLV
TV
TV
10
TLV
4-131
TV
9-
Information element
First Channel, before time
Description of the
Second Channel, before time
Frequency channel sequence
before time
Mobile Allocation,
before time
Cipher Mode Setting
01
03
Multi-Rate
configuration
1D
1E
21
9.1.15.1
267
Type / Reference
10.5.2.5a
Channel Description
10.5.2.5
Frequency channel sequence
10.5.2.12
Mobile Allocation
10.5.2.21
Cipher Mode Setting
10.5.2.9
VGCS target mode Indication
10.5.2.42a
MultiRate configuration
10.5.2.21aa
Format
length
TV
TV
10
TLV
3-10
TV
TLV
TLV
4-8
Synchronization Indication
If this information element does not appear, the assumed value is "non-synchronized".
9.1.15.2
Mode of the First Channel (Channel Set 1) and Mode of Channel Set "X"
(2=<X<=8)
If this information element is not present the channel mode of the previously allocated channel or channels for Channel
Set "X" (1=<X<=8) shall be assumed.
If Channel Set "X" is not defined for the configuration, the Mode of Channel Set "X" IE shall be considered as an IE
unnecessary in the message.
NOTE:
9.1.15.3
Subclause 3.4.4.1 defines cases when one or several Mode of Channel Set "X" IEs shall be included in the
message.
These information element appear if the mobile station carries two connections (on two dedicated channels, for the
TCH/H+TCH/H configuration).
The connection using the channel previously defined in the Description of the First Channel IE of an ASSIGNMENT
COMMAND or HANDOVER COMMAND message shall use the channel defined in the first channel description IE of
the HANDOVER COMMAND message defining the new configuration.
The channel described in the Description of the First Channel IE carries the main DCCH. The SACCH used is the one
associated with that channel.
9.1.15.4
If the Description of the Second Channel IE is not present and the information element is present it shall be considered
as an IE unnecessary in the message.
This element appears at least when the channel mode is changed for the channel defined in the Description of the
Second Channel information element.
9.1.15.5
If at least one of the channel descriptions for after time indicates frequency hopping, one and only one of the following
information elements shall be present:
-
ETSI
268
If neither of the Channel Description IEs indicate frequency hopping, if they are not required for the decoding of
Channel Description IEs for before time, and if any of the four information elements are present they shall be
considered as IEs unnecessary in the message.
The Frequency Channel Sequence information element shall not be used unless all the ARFCNs that it indicates are in
the P-GSM band.
9.1.15.6
Starting Time
The starting time information element is included when the network wants the mobile station to change the frequency
parameters of the channels more or less at the moment a change of channel occurs. In this case a number of information
elements may be included to give the frequency parameters to be used before the starting time.
The starting time information element refers to the new cell time.
If the starting time information element is present and none of the information elements referring to before the starting
time are present, the mobile station waits and accesses the channels at the indicated time.
If the starting time information element is present and at least one of the information elements referring to before the
starting time is present, the mobile station does not wait for the indicated time and accesses the channel using the
frequency parameters for before the starting time.
If the starting time information element is not present and some of the information elements referring to before the
starting time is present, these information elements shall be considered as IEs unnecessary in the message.
If the description of the first channel, before time IE is not present, the channel description to apply for before the time,
if needed, is given by the description of the first channel, after time IE.
If the description of the second channel, after time IE is present, the description of the second channel, before time IE
not present, and a description of the configuration for before the time needed, the channel configuration before the
starting time is nevertheless of two traffic channels, and the channel description to apply to the second channel before
the starting time is given by the description of the second channel, after time IE.
If the starting time IE is present and at least one of the channel descriptions for before the starting time indicates
frequency hopping, one and only one of the following information elements may be present and applies before the
starting time to all assigned channels:
-
If the starting time IE is present and at least one of the channel descriptions for before the starting time indicates
frequency hopping, and none of the above mentioned IE is present, a frequency list for after the starting time must be
present (see 9.1.2.4), and this list applies also for the channels before the starting time.
9.1.15.7
If any of the mobile allocation information elements is present, then the cell channel description IE must be present. It
is used to decode the mobile allocation IEs in the message.
In addition, if no information elements pertaining to before the starting time is present in the message, the frequency list
defined by the cell channel description IE is used to decode the mobile allocation IEs in later messages received in the
new cell until reception of a new reference cell frequency list or the new cell is left.
ETSI
9.1.15.8
269
This information element shall appear if the Synchronization Indication information element indicates a pseudosynchronous handover otherwise it shall be considered as an unnecessary information element.
9.1.15.9
Timing Advance
This information element shall appear if the "synchronization indication" element indicates a presynchronized
handover. If not included for a presynchronized handover, then the default value as defined in GSM 05.10 shall be used.
For other types of handover it shall be considered as an unnecessary information element.
9.1.15.10
If this information element is omitted, the mode of ciphering is not changed after the mobile station has switched to the
assigned channel.
Only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS talking:
The cipher mode setting IE shall not be included if a HANDOVER COMMAND message is sent on a VGCS channel or
in a HANDOVER COMMAND message on a dedicated channel for a handover to a VGCS channel.
9.1.15.11
This information element is identified as "comprehension required". Only mobile stations supporting VGCS talking
are required to accept the presence of the element. The presence of the element shall trigger an exception handling if
received by a mobile station not supporting VGCS talking .
This IE indicates which mode is to be used on the new channel (i.e. dedicated mode or group transmit mode). If this
information element is not present, the mode shall be the same as on the previous channel.
The IE also indicates the group cipher key number for the group cipher key to be used on the new channel or if the new
channel is non ciphered. If the information element is not present, the ciphering mode shall be the same as on the
previous channel.
NOTE:
9.1.15.12
A mobile station supporting VGCS Talking shall not consider a syntactical error if this IE is present and
the channel mode is not speech.
This information element is included if so indicated by the channel type and TDMA offset field in the Channel
Description information element and is used to assign channels that do not carry a main signalling link in a multislot
configuration. It indicates how the used timeslots are divided into separate channel sets.
If the Channel Description IE does not require the presence the information element it shall be considered as an IE
unnecessary in the message.
If multislot configuration is indicated by the Channel Description IE but the Multislot Allocation IE is not present, all
channels in the configuration belong to one channel set, "Channel Set 1".
NOTE:
9.1.15.13
As a change of timeslot number cannot occur for the channel described for after the starting time, the
Multislot Allocation IE does not have to be included more than once.
MultiRateconfiguration
This information element appears if the Mode of the First Channel indicates a multi-rate speech codec, and if the
assigned configuration is new, i.e. it is different from the MultiRateconfiguration used in the serving cell. If the Mode of
the First Channel indicates a multi-rate speech codec, and this IE is not included, then the mobile station shall assume
that the MultiRateconfiguration has not changed.
ETSI
9.1.16
270
Handover complete
This message is sent on the main DCCH from the mobile station to the network to indicate that the mobile station has
established the main signalling link successfully. See table 9.16/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
HANDOVER COMPLETE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Handover Complete
Message Type
RR Cause
77
9.1.16.1
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
RR Cause
10.5.2.31
Mobile Time Difference
10.5.2.21a
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
TLV
This information element is included if and only if the Synchronization Indication IE in the HANDOVER COMMAND
message requests it to be sent.
9.1.17
Handover failure
This message is sent on the main DCCH on the old channel from the mobile station to the network to indicate that the
mobile station has failed to seize the new channel. See table 9.17/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
HANDOVER FAILURE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Handover Failure
Message Type
RR Cause
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
RR Cause
10.5.2.31
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
9.1.18
271
Immediate assignment
This message is sent on the CCCH by the network to the mobile station in idle mode to change the channel
configuration to a dedicated configuration while staying in the same cell or to the mobile station in packet idle mode to
change the channel configuration to either an uplink or a downlink packet data channel configuration in the cell. See
table 9.18/GSM 04.08.
The L2 pseudo length of this message is the sum of lengths of all information elements present in the message except
the IA Rest Octets and L2 Pseudo Length information elements.
Message type:
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Immediate Assignment
Message Type
Page Mode
Dedicated mode or TBF
Channel Description
Packet Channel Description
Request Reference
Timing Advance
Mobile Allocation
7C
Starting Time
IA Rest Octets
9.1.18.0a
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Page Mode
10.5.2.26
Dedicated mode or TBF
10.5.2.25b
Channel Description
10.5.2.5
Packet Channel Description
10.5.2.25a
Request Reference
10.5.2.30
Timing Advance
10.5.2.40
Mobile Allocation
10.5.2.21
Starting Time
10.5.2.38
IA Rest Octets
10.5.2.16
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
LV
1-9
TV
0-11
A mobile station not supporting GPRS may ignore the contents of this information element and regard it as an
unnecessary IE. Such mobile station shall assume that this message assigns a dedicated mode resource.
9.1.18.0b
Channel Description
If the Dedicated mode or TBF IE indicates that the message assigns a dedicated mode resource, the mobile station shall
consider this information element present in the message.
ETSI
9.1.18.0c
272
If the Dedicated mode or TBF IE indicates that the message assigns a Temporary Block Flow (TBF), the mobile station
shall consider this information element present in the message. If the Dedicated mode or TBF IE indicates that this
message is the first of two in a two-message assignment of an uplink or downlink TBF, the mobile station shall ignore
the contents of this information element and regard it as an unnecessary IE.
9.1.18.0d
Request Reference
If this message is used in an assignment of a downlink TBF, the network shall code this information element, e.g. by
using a suitably offset frame number, such that the resource reference cannot be confused with any CHANNEL
REQUEST message sent by a mobile station.
If the IA Rest Octets IE indicates that this message is the second message of a two-message assignment of an uplink or
downlink TBF, this information element shall have the same contents as the first message of the assignment.
9.1.18.0e
Timing Advance
If the IA Rest Octets IE indicates that this message is the second message of a two-message assignment of an uplink or
downlink TBF, the mobile station shall ignore the contents of this information element and regard it as an unnecessary
IE.
9.1.18.1
Mobile Allocation
If this message assigns a dedicated mode resource and the Channel Description IE does not indicate frequency hopping
, the length indicator of this information element shall be set to zero, and the mobile station shall consider the IE as an
unnecessary IE.
If this message assigns a TBF and the Packet Channel Description IE does not indicate frequency hopping or if it uses
indirect encoding of a hopping RF channel configuration, the length indicator of this information element shall be set to
zero, and the mobile station shall consider the IE as an unnecessary IE.
9.1.18.2
Starting Time
9.1.18.3
The sum of the length of this IE and the L2 Pseudo Length of the message equals 22.
If the starting time IE is present but not the frequency parameters, before time construction, the mobile stations must
wait until the starting time before accessing the channel.
If the starting time IE is present and the Channel Description IE does not indicate frequency hopping the mobile station
shall consider the frequency parameters, before time construction as unnecessary in the message and the mobile must
wait until the starting time before accessing the channel.
If the starting time IE is not present, the mobile station shall consider the frequency parameters, before time
construction as unnecessary in the message.
9.1.18.4
If the Dedicated mode or TBF IE indicates that this message is used in an assignment of a TBF, this information
element shall contain a Packet Uplink Assignment, Packet Downlink Assignment or Second Part Packet Assignment
construction.
ETSI
273
If the Dedicated mode or TBF IE indicates that this message assigns a dedicated mode resource, but not that the mobile
station is identified in the IA Rest Octets IE information element, the mobile station shall consider the Packet Uplink
Assignment, Packet Downlink Assignment and Second Part Packet Assignment constructions as unnecessary in the
message.
9.1.19
This message is sent on the CCCH by the network to two mobile stations in idle mode to change their channel
configurations to different dedicated configurations while they stay in the same cell. See table 9.19/GSM 04.08
The L2 pseudo length of this message is the sum of lengths of all information elements present in the message except
the IAX Rest Octets and L2 Pseudo Length information elements.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Immediate Assignment Ex
tended Message Type
Page Mode
Spare Half Octet
Channel Description 1
Request Reference 1
Timing Advance 1
Channel Description 2
Request Reference 2
Timing Advance 2
Mobile Allocation
7C
Starting Time
IAX Rest Octets
NOTE:
9.1.19.1
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Page Mode
10.5.2.26
Spare Half Octet
10.5.1.8
Channel Description
10.5.2.5
Request Reference
10.5.2.30
Timing Advance
10.5.2.40
Channel Description
10.5.2.5
Request Reference
10.5.2.30
Timing Advance
10.5.2.40
Mobile Allocation
10.5.2.21
Starting Time
10.5.2.38
IAX Rest Octets
10.5.2.18
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
LV
1-5
TV
0-4
Index 1 refers to the first mobile station, index 2 refers to the second mobile station.
Unnecessary IEs
A mobile station which reacts on the request reference 1 shall consider all information elements as unnecessary IEs
except for Requests Reference 1, Channel Description 1, Timing advance 1, Starting Time and if Channel Description 1
IE indicates frequency hopping mobile allocation.
ETSI
274
A mobile station which reacts on the request reference 2 shall consider all information elements as unnecessary IE
except Requests Reference 2, Channel Description 2, Timing advance 2, Starting Time and if channel description 2 IE
indicates frequency hopping mobile allocation.
A mobile station in idle mode shall consider all information elements as unnecessary IEs except for the Page Mode IE.
9.1.19.2
Mobile Allocation
If both channel description IE do not indicate frequency hopping, the length indicator shall be set to zero.
9.1.19.3
Starting Time
This information element appears if a frequency change is in progress. If included the starting time is common to the
two referenced mobile stations.
9.1.19.4
As the maximum length of the resulting layer 3 data cannot exceed 22 octets, it is not possible to use this message type
if the total length of the value part of the Mobile Allocation plus, optionally, the length of the Starting Time IE exceeds
5 octets. In this case it is necessary to use the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message.
9.1.19.5
The sum of the length of this IE and the L2 Pseudo Length of the message equals 22.
9.1.20
This message is sent on the CCCH by the network to up to four mobile stations to indicate that no channel is available
for assignment. See table 9.20/GSM 04.08. This message has L2 pseudo length 19.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
275
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Immediate Assignment
Reject Message Type
Page Mode
Spare Half Octet
Request Reference 1
Wait Indication 1
Request Reference 2
Wait Indication 2
Request Reference 3
Wait Indication 3
Request Reference 4
Wait Indication 4
IAR Rest Octets
NOTE:
9.1.20.1
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Page Mode
10.5.2.26
Spare Half Octet
10.5.1.8
Request Reference
10.5.2.30
Wait Indication
10.5.2.43
Request Reference
10.5.2.30
Wait Indication
10.5.2.43
Request Reference
10.5.2.30
Wait Indication
10.5.2.43
Request Reference
10.5.2.30
Wait Indication
10.5.2.43
IAR Rest Octets
10.5.2.17
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
Index 1 refers to the first mobile station, index 2 refers to the second MS and so on.
A request reference information element and the following wait indication information element refer to the same mobile
station. So it is possible to reject up to four channel requests with this message.
9.1.20.2
If necessary the request reference information element and the wait indication information element should be duplicated
to fill the message.
9.1.20.3
Wait Indication
When IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT message is for RR connection establisment then this IE contains timeout
value for T3122. If IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT message is for TBF establisment for GPRS MS then this
IE contain timeout value for T3142.
9.1.20.4
The sum of the length of this IE and the L2 Pseudo Length of the message equals 22.
ETSI
9.1.21
276
Measurement report
This message is sent on the SACCH by the mobile station to the network to report measurement results about the
dedicated channel and about neighbour cells. See table 9.21/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
MEASUREMENT REPORT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Measurement Report
Message Type
Measurement Results
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Measurement Results
10.5.2.20
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
16
9.1.21a Notification/FACCH
The understanding of this message is only required for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening.
This message is sent on the main DCCH, in unacknowledged mode using the RR short protocol discriminator by the
network to notify the mobile stations in dedicated mode or in on-going voice broadcast calls or voice group calls on
other voice broadcast calls or voice group calls in that cell.
Notification/FACCH messages for VBS or VGCS calls are differentiated by a flag in the call reference.
The message shall not exceed a maximum length of 20 octets.
Mobile stations not supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening shall ignore this message.
See table 9.21a/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
NOTIFICATION/FACCH
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
277
The <Group Channel Description> field is optionally present. When present only the Channel description is provided in
the case of non hopping channels. In the case where the channel is hopping then either a mobile allocation or a
frequency short list is provided.
<Group Channel Description> : :=
<Channel Description : bit(24)>
{0
-- Non hopping case
|1 {0 <Mobile Allocation : <bit string>>
|1 <Frequency Short List : bit(64)>}} ;
<bit string> ::= null | bit <bit string> ;
<Channel Description>
This field is syntactically and semantically equivalent to octets 2-4 of the Channel Description information element. See
10.5.2.5
<Frequency Short List>
This field is syntactically and semantically equivalent to octets 1-8 of the Frequency Short List 2 information element.
See 10.5.2.14a
<Mobile Allocation>
This field is syntactically and semantically equivalent to octet 2 to n+2 of the Mobile Allocation information element.
See 10.5.2.21
The <Paging Information> field may be used to inform the mobile station in Group Receive or in Group Transmit mode
that the corresponding mobile identity is paged in that cell.
<Paging Information> ::= <mobile identity : <bit string>>
<channel first: bit(2)>
{0|1 <eMLPP priority : bit(3)>} ;
<bit string> ::= null | bit <bit string> ;
<mobile identity>
This field is syntactically and semantically equivalent to octet 2-n of the Mobile Identity information element. See
10.5.1.4
<channel first>
This field is syntactically and semantically equivalent to bits 1 and 2 of the Channel Needed information element. See
10.5.2.8
<eMLPP priority>
This field is coded as the <Priority1> field in the P1 Rest Octets information element. See 10.5.2.23
9.1.21a.1
Spare
9.1.21a.2
Spare
9.1.21a.3
Spare
9.1.21a.4
Spare
9.1.21b Notification/NCH
The understanding of this message is only required for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening.
ETSI
278
This message is sent on the NCH by the network to notify mobile stations of VBS or VGCS calls in the current cell.
The VBS or VGCS calls are identified by their broadcast call reference or group call reference, respectively. For each
reference, the corresponding VBS or VGCS call channel may be indicated. See table 9.21b/GSM 04.08.
Notification/NCH messages for VBS or VGCS calls are differentiated by a flag in the call reference.
The L2 pseudo length of this message has a value one
Mobile stations not supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening shall ignore this message.
Message type:
NOTIFICATION/NCH
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Notification/NCH
Message Type
NT/N Rest Octets
9.1.21b.1
Spare
9.1.21b.2
Spare
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
NT/N Rest Octets
10.5.2.22c
9.1.21d Spare
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
1-20
279
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
RR-Cell Change Order
Message Type
Cell Description
NC mode for target cell
Spare half octet
9.1.22
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Cell description
10.5.2.2
NC mode
10.5.2.21c
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
1/2
1/2
This message is sent on the CCCH by the network to up to two mobile stations. It may be sent to a mobile station in idle
mode to trigger channel access. It may be sent to a mobile station in packet idle mode to transfer MM information (i.e.
trigger of cell update procedure). The mobile stations are identified by their TMSI/P-TMSI or IMSI. See
table 9.22/GSM 04.08.
The L2 pseudo length of this message is the sum of lengths of all information elements present in the message except
the P1 Rest Octets and L2 Pseudo Length information elements.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
280
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Paging Request Type 1
Message Type
Page Mode
Channels Needed for
Mobiles 1 and 2
Mobile Identity 1
17
Mobile Identity 2
P1 Rest Octets
9.1.22.1
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Page Mode
10.5.2.26
Channel Needed
10.5.2.8
Mobile Identity
10.5.1.4
Mobile Identity
10.5.1.4
P1 Rest Octets
10.5.2.23
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
LV
2-9
TLV
3-10
0-17
Unnecessary IE
A mobile station in idle mode shall consider all information elements as unnecessary IEs except for the Page Mode IE.
9.1.22.2
The first CHANNEL field of Channel Needed IE is associated with Mobile Identity 1. The second CHANNEL field of
Channel Needed IE is associated with Mobile Identity 2.
If this message is used in the packet paging procedure, the Channel Needed IE associated with the corresponding
Mobile Identity 1 or 2 shall be coded with the value 00 (any channel) by the network. The mobile station receiving a
packet paging request shall treat this information element as unnecessary in the message.
9.1.22.3
Mobile Identities
9.1.22.4
P1 Rest Octets
The sum of the length of this IE and the L2 Pseudo Length of the message equals 22.
This IE may contain a notification list number field and/or, referring to each one of the Mobile Identity 1 and 2 IEs, a
Priority 1 and 2 field and/or a Packet Page Indication 1 and 2 field.
9.1.23
This message is sent on the CCCH by the network to two or three mobile stations. It may be sent to a mobile station in
idle mode to trigger channel access. It may be sent to a mobile station in packet idle mode to transfer MM information
(i.e. trigger of cell update procedure). Two of the mobile stations are identified by their TMSI/P-TMSI while the third is
identified by its TMSI/P-TMSI or IMSI. See table 9.23/GSM 04.08.
The L2 pseudo length of this message is the sum of lengths of all information elements present in the message except
the P2 Rest Octets and L2 Pseudo Length information elements.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
281
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Paging Request Type 2
Message Type
Page Mode
Channels Needed for
Mobiles 1 and 2
Mobile Identity 1
Mobile Identity 2
17
Mobile Identity 3
P2 Rest Octets
9.1.23.1
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Page Mode
10.5.2.26
Channel Needed
10.5.2.8
TMSI/P-TMSI
10.5.2.42
TMSI/P-TMSI
10.5.2.42
Mobile Identity
10.5.1.4
P2 Rest Octets
10.5.2.24
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
TLV
3-10
1-11
The first CHANNEL field of Channel Needed IE is associated with Mobile Identity 1. The second CHANNEL field of
Channel Needed IE is associated with Mobile Identity 2.
If this message is used in the packet paging procedure, the Channel Needed IE associated with the corresponding
Mobile Identity 1 or 2 shall be coded with the value 00 (any channel) by the network. The mobile station receiving a
packet paging request shall treat this information element as unnecessary in the message.
9.1.23.2
Mobile Identity 3
9.1.23.3
P2 Rest Octets
The sum of the length of this IE and the L2 Pseudo Length of the message equals 22.
This IE contains the channel needed indication related to the paging of Mobile Identity 3. The treatment of this
indication in the case this message is used in a packet paging procedure is specified in section 9.1.23.1.
This IE may further contain a notification list number field and/or, referring to each one of the Mobile Identity 1, 2 and
3 IEs, a Priority 1, 2 and 3 field and/or, referring to the Mobile Identity 3 IE, a Packet Page Indication 3 field.
9.1.24
This message is sent on the CCCH by the network to four mobile stations. It may be sent to a mobile station in idle
mode to trigger channel access. It may be sent to a mobile station in packet idle mode to transfer MM information (i.e.
trigger of cell update procedure). The mobile stations are identified by their TMSIs/P-TMSIs. See
table 9.24/GSM 04.08.
This message has a L2 Pseudo Length of 19.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
282
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Paging Request Type 3
Message Type
Page Mode
Channels Needed for
Mobiles 1 and 2
Mobile Identity 1
Mobile Identity 2
Mobile Identity 3
Mobile Identity 4
P3 Rest Octets
9.1.24.1
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Page Mode
10.5.2.26
Channel Needed
10.5.2.8
TMSI/P-TMSI
10.5.2.42
TMSI/P-TMSI
10.5.2.42
TMSI/P-TMSI
10.5.2.42
TMSI/P-TMSI
10.5.2.42
P3 Rest Octets
10.5.2.25
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
The first CHANNEL field of Channel Needed IE is associated with Mobile Identity 1. The second CHANNEL field of
Channel Needed IE is associated with Mobile Identity 2.
If this message is used in the packet paging procedure, the Channel Needed IE associated with the corresponding
Mobile Identity 1 or 2 shall be coded with the value 00 (any channel) by the network. The mobile station receiving a
packet paging request shall treat this information element as unnecessary in the message.
9.1.24.2
P3 Rest Octets
This IE contains the channel needed indication related to the paging of Mobile Identity 3 and 4. The treatment of these
indications in the case this message is used in a packet paging procedure is specified in section 9.1.24.1.
This IE may further contain a notification list number field and/or, referring to each one of the Mobile Identity 1, 2, 3
and 4 IEs, a Priority 1, 2, 3 and 4 field.
9.1.25
Paging response
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the mobile station to the network in connection with establishment of the
main signalling link as a response to the paging request message. See table 9.25/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
PAGING RESPONSE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
283
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Paging Response
Message Type
Ciphering Key Sequence
Number
Spare Half Octet
Mobile Station
Classmark
Mobile Identity
9.1.25.1
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Ciphering Key Sequence
Number
10.5.1.2
Spare Half Octet
10.5.1.8
Mobile Station
Classmark 2
10.5.1.6
Mobile Identity
10.5.1.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
1/2
1/2
LV
LV
2-9
This IE shall include for multiband mobile station the Classmark 2 corresponding to the frequency band in use.
9.1.26
Partial release
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the network to the mobile station to deactivate part of the dedicated
channels in use. See table 9.26/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
PARTIAL RELEASE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Partial Release
Message Type
Channel Description
9.1.26.1
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Channel Description
10.5.2.5
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
Channel Description
9.1.27
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the mobile station to the network to indicate that a part of the dedicated
channels has been deactivated. See table 9.27/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
284
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Partial release
Complete Message Type
9.1.28
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
Physical information
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the network to the mobile station to stop the sending of access bursts from
the mobile station. See table 9.28/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
PHYSICAL INFORMATION
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Physical Information
Message Type
Timing Advance
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Timing Advance
10.5.2.40
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
RR Initialisation Request
Significance:
local
Direction:
ETSI
285
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
RR Initialisation Request
Message Type
Ciphering Key Sequence
Number
MAC Mode and Channel
Coding Requested
Mobile station classmark
TLLI
Channel Request Description
GPRS Measurement Results
9.1.29
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Ciphering Key sequence
Number
10.5.1.2
Channel Coding Requested
10.5.2.4a
Mobile station classmark 2
10.5.1.6
TLLI
10.5.2.41a
Channel Request Description
10.5.2.8a
GPRS Measurement Results
10.5.2.20a
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
1/2
1/2
LV
RR Status
This message is sent by the mobile station or the network at any time to report certain error conditions as described in
clause 8. See table 9.28a/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
RR STATUS
Significance:
local
Direction:
both
Table 9.28a/GSM 04.08: RR STATUS message content
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
RR Status
Message Type
RR Cause
9.1.30
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
RR Cause
10.5.2.31
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
This message is sent on the SCH, which is one of the broadcast channels (ref. GSM 05.02 section 3.3.2). Its purpose is
to support the synchronization of a mobile station to a BSS. It does not follow the basic format. Its length is 25 bits. The
order of bit transmission is defined in GSM 04.04. See figure 9.3/GSM 04.08 and table 9.29/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
286
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
BSIC
| T1 (high) | octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
T1 (middle)
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------|
| T1 |
T2
|
T3'
| octet 3
|(low)|
| (high)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| T3' |
|(low)|
+-----+
Figure 9.3/GSM 04.08: Frame synchronization information element
9.1.31
This message is sent on the BCCH by the network to all mobile stations within the cell giving information of control of
the RACH and of the cell allocation. See table 9.30/GSM 04.08. Special requirements for the transmission of this
message apply, see GSM 05.02. This message has a L2 Pseudo Length of 21.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 pseudo length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 1 Message Type
Cell Channel
Description
RACH Control Parameter
SI 1 Rest Octets
Type / Reference
L2 pseudo length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Cell Channel Description
10.5.2.1b
RACH Control Parameters
10.5.2.29
SI 1 Rest Octets
10.5.2.32
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
16
9.1.32
287
This message is sent on the BCCH by the network to all mobile stations within the cell giving information of control of
the RACH and of the BCCH allocation in the neighbour cells. See table 9.31/GSM 04.08. Special requirements for the
transmission of this message apply, see GSM 05.02. This message has a L2 Pseudo Length of 22.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 2 Message Type
BCCH Frequency List
NCC Permitted
RACH Control Parameter
9.1.33
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Neighbour Cell Description
10.5.2.22
NCC permitted
10.5.2.27
RACH Control Parameters
10.5.2.29
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
16
This message is sent optionally on the BCCH by the network to all mobile stations within the cell giving information on
control of the RACH and of the extension of the BCCH allocation in the neighbour cells. See table 9.31a/GSM 04.08.
Special requirements for the transmission of this message apply, see GSM 05.02.
A GSM 900 mobile station which only supports the primary GSM band P-GSM 900 (cf. GSM 05.05) may ignore this
message, see section 3.2.2.1.
This message has a L2 pseudo length of 21.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
288
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 2bis Message Type
Extended BCCH
Frequency List
RACH Control Parameters
SI 2bis Rest Octets
9.1.34
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Neighbour Cell
Description
10.5.2.22
RACH Control Parameters
10.5.2.29
SI 2bis Rest Octets
10.5.2.33
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
16
This message is sent optionally on the BCCH by the network to all mobile stations within the cell giving information on
the extension of the BCCH allocation in the neighbour cells. See table 9.31b/GSM 04.08. Special requirements for the
transmission of this message apply, see GSM 05.02.
A mobile station that supports either:
-
only the primary GSM band P-GSM 900 (cf. GSM 05.05); or
This message has a L2 pseudo length of 18. This message may be sent by the network with either a L2 pseudo length of
18 or some other value. A mobile station that does not ignore this message shall not discard the message due to a
received L2 pseudo length different from 18.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 2ter Message Type
Extended BCCH
Frequency List
SI 2ter Rest Octets
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Neighbour Cell
Description 2
10.5.2.22a
SI 2ter Rest Octets
10.5.2.33a
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
16
9.1.35
289
This message is sent on the BCCH by the network giving information of control on the RACH, the location area
identification, the cell identity and various other information about the cell. See table 9.32/GSM 04.08. Special
requirements for the transmission of this message apply, see GSM 05.02. This message has a L2 Pseudo Length of 18.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 3 Message Type
Cell Identity
Location Area
Identification
Control Channel
Description
Cell Options
Cell Selection
Parameters
RACH Control Parameters
SI 3 Rest Octets
9.1.36
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Cell Identity
10.5.1.1
Location Area
Identification
10.5.1.3
Control Channel
description
10.5.2.11
Cell Options (BCCH)
10.5.2.3
Cell Selection Parameters
10.5.2.4
RACH Control Parameters
10.5.2.29
SI 3 Rest Octets
10.5.2.34
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
This message is sent on the BCCH by the network giving information on control of the RACH, the location area
identification, the cell identity and various other information about the cell. See table 9.33/GSM 04.08. Special
requirements for the transmission of this message apply, see GSM 05.02. The L2 pseudo length of this message is the
sum of lengths of all information elements present in the message except the SI 4 Rest Octets and L2 Pseudo Length
information elements.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
290
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 4 Message Type
Location Area
Identification
Cell Selection
Parameters
RACH Control Parameters
64
72
CBCH Channel
Description
CBCH Mobile Allocation
SI 4 Rest Octets
9.1.36.1
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Location Area
Identification
10.5.1.3
Cell Selection Parameters
10.5.2.4
RACH Control Parameters
10.5.2.29
Channel description
10.5.2.5
Mobile Allocation
10.5.2.21
SI 4 Rest Octets
10.5.2.35
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
TV
TLV
3-6
0-10
This information element is present if SMSCB is active in the cell and indicates (together with the CBCH Mobile
Allocation IE) where to find the CBCH.
9.1.36.2
If the CBCH Channel Description Information Element indicates frequency hopping, the CBCH Mobile Allocation IE
shall be present. If the CBCH Channel Description does not indicate frequency hopping, the CBCH Mobile Allocation
IE shall be considered as an unnecessary IE in the message.
9.1.36.3
SI 4 Rest Octets
The sum of the length of this IE and the L2 pseudo length of the message equals 22.
9.1.37
This message is sent on the SACCH by the network to mobile stations within the cell giving information on the BCCH
allocation in the neighbour cells. See table 9.34/GSM 04.08.
When received this information shall be used as the list of BCCH frequencies of the neighbouring cells to be reported
on. Any change in the neighbour cells description must overwrite any old data held by the mobile station. The mobile
station must analyse all correctly received system information type 5 messages. This message has a L2 Pseudo Length
of 18.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
291
Information element
L2 pseudo length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 5 Message Type
BCCH Frequency List
9.1.38
Type / Reference
L2 pseudo length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Neighbour Cell Description
10.5.2.22
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
16
This message is sent optionally on the SACCH by the network to mobile stations within the cell giving information on
the extension of the BCCH allocation in the neighbour cells. See table 9.34a/GSM 04.08.
A GSM 900 mobile station which only supports the primary GSM band P-GSM 900 (cf. GSM 05.05) may ignore this
message, see section 3.2.2.1.
When received (and not ignored) this information must be used as the list of neighbouring cells to be reported on. Any
change in the neighbour cells description must overwrite any old data held by the mobile station. The mobile station
must, with the exception stated above, analyse all correctly received system information type 5 messages. This message
has a L2 Pseudo Length of 18.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 pseudo length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 5 bis Message Type
Extension of the
BCCH Frequency List
Description
9.1.39
Type / Reference
L2 pseudo length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Neighbour Cell
Description
10.5.2.22
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
16
This message is sent optionally on the SACCH by the network to mobile stations within the cell giving information on
the extension of the BCCH allocation in the neighbour cells. See table 9.34b/GSM 04.08.
A mobile station that supports either:
-
only the primary GSM band P-GSM 900 (cf. GSM 05.05); or
When received (and not ignored) this information must be used as part of the list of neighbouring cells to be reported
on. Any change in the neighbour cells description must overwrite this part of any old data held by the mobile station.
ETSI
292
The mobile station shall, with the exception stated above, analyse all correctly received system information type 5ter
messages. This message has a L2 Pseudo Length of 18.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 pseudo length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 5ter Message Type
Extended BCCH
Frequency List
9.1.40
Type / Reference
L2 pseudo length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Neighbour Cell
Description 2
10.5.2.22a
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
16
This message is sent on the SACCH by the network to mobile stations within the cell giving information of location
area identification, of cell identity and various other information. See table 9.35/GSM 04.08. If received correctly by the
mobile station this message is treated as in Sections 9.1.40.1 to 9.1.40.4.
This message has a L2 Pseudo Length of 11.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 pseudo length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 6 Message Type
Cell Identity
Location Area
Identification
Cell Options
NCC Permitted
SI 6 Rest Octets
9.1.40.1
Type / Reference
L2 pseudo length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Cell Identity
10.5.1.1
Location Area Identification
10.5.1.3
Cell Options (SACCH)
10.5.2.3
NCC Permitted
10.5.2.27
SI6 Rest Octets
10.5.2.35a
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
1/2
Cell Identity
Only applicable for mobile stations supporting SIM Application Toolkit class 2 or higher:
ETSI
length
293
if a new Cell Identity is identified, an indication shall be given to the upper layer together with the new identity.
9.1.40.2
Only applicable for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening and VBS listening or SIM Application Toolkit class 2 or
higher:
-
if a new Location Area Identification is identified, an indication shall be given to the upper layer together with
the new identification.
9.1.40.3
Cell Options
When correctly received, this information shall be used as the current Cell Options information. Any change in the Cell
Options shall overwrite any old Cell Options data held by the mobile station.
9.1.40.4
NCC permitted
9.1.41
This message is sent on the BCCH by the network giving information about cell reselection parameters to be used in
that cell. See table 9.36/GSM 04.08. Special requirements for the transmission of this message apply, see GSM 05.02.
The L2 pseudo length of this message has the value 1.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 pseudo length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 7 Message Type
SI 7 Rest Octets
9.1.42
Type / Reference
L2 pseudo length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
SI 7 Rest Octets
10.5.2.36
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
20
This message is sent on the BCCH by the network giving information about cell reselection parameters to be used in
that cell. See table 9.37/GSM 04.08. Special requirements for the transmission of this message apply, see GSM 05.02.
The L2 Pseudo Length of this message has the value 1.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
294
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 8 Message Type
SI 8 Rest Octets
9.1.43
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
SI 8 Rest Octets
10.5.2.37
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
20
This message is sent on the BCCH by the network to all mobile stations within the cell giving some, but not necessarily
all information on the scheduling of information on the BCCH. See table 9.37a/GSM 04.08. Special requirements for
the transmission of this message apply, see subclause 3.2.2.1 and GSM 05.02. This message has a L2 Pseudo Length of
1.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 pseudo length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 9 Message Type
RACH Control Parameter
SI 9 Rest Octets
Type / Reference
L2 pseudo length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
RACH Control Parameters
10.5.2.29
SI 9 Rest Octets
10.5.2.37a
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
17
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
295
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 13 Message Type
SI 13 Rest Octets
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
SI 13 Rest Octets
10.5.2.37b
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1
1/2
1/2
20
9.1.43b [Spare]
9.1.43c [Spare]
9.1.43d System information type 16
This message is sent on the BCCH if indicated in the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3 message. The message is
sent by the network giving information about cell selection and reselection parameters to be used in that cell. See
table 9.37e/GSM 04.08. Special requirements for the transmission of this message applies, see GSM 05.02.
The L2 pseudo length of this message has the value 1.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
L2 pseudo length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 16 Message Type
SI 16 Rest Octets
Type / Reference
L2 pseudo length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
SI 16 Rest Octets
10.5.2.37e
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1
1/2
1/2
20
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
296
Information element
L2 Pseudo Length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
System Information
Type 17 Message Type
SI 17 Rest Octets
9.1.44
Type / Reference
L2 Pseudo Length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
SI 17 Rest Octets
10.5.2.37f
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1
1/2
1/2
20
Talker indication
This message is sent on the main DCCH by the mobile station to the network to give the talker information when a new
layer 2 connection is established on a VGCS channel after an uplink access. See table 9.44/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
TALKER INDICATION
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Talker Indication
Message Type
Mobile Station
Classmark
Mobile Identity
9.1.45
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Mobile Station
Classmark 2
10.5.1.6
Mobile Identity
10.5.1.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
LV
LV
2-9
Uplink access
ETSI
297
9.1.46
Message
8......1
110xxxxx
00100101
other values
Uplink busy
The understanding of this message is only required for mobile stations supporting VGCS talking.
This message is broadcasted on the voice group call channel on the main DCCH, SAPI=0, by the network in
unacknowledged mode to inform the mobile station of the uplink status of the voice group call channel. See
table 9.46/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
UPLINK BUSY
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Uplink busy
Message Type
9.1.47
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
Uplink free
This message is sent on the main DCCH, in unacknowledged mode using the RR short protocol discriminator by the
network to inform the mobile station of the uplink status of the voice group call channel. See table 9.47/GSM 04.08.
The message indicates the uplink as free unless the Uplink Access Request field indicates the uplink as not free.
This message may also be used by the network to request the mobile station to perform an uplink reply procedure.
Message type:
UPLINK FREE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
See 10.4
ETSI
298
9.1.48
Uplink release
UPLINK RELEASE
Significance:
local
Direction:
both
Table 9.48/GSM 04.08: UPLINK RELEASE message content
IEI
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Uplink Release
Message Type
RR Cause
9.1.49
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
RR Cause
10.5.2.31
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
The understanding of this message is only required for mobile stations supporting VGCS talking.
This message is sent in unacknowledged mode on the main signalling channel by the network to the mobile station to
stop the sending of access bursts from the mobile station and to change the channel configuration to a dedicated
configuration. See table 9.49/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
299
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
VGCS Uplink Grant
Message Type
Request Reference
Timing Advance
9.1.50
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Request Reference
10.5.2.30
Timing Advance
10.5.2.40
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
The understanding of messages of this message type is only required for mobile stations supporting VGCS listening and
VBS listening. A mobile station not understanding the message shall treat it as unknown message.
Messages of this message type are optionally sent by the network in unacknowledged mode on the SACCH. SYSTEM
INFORMATION TYPE 10 messages contain information about neighbour cells. When sent on the SACCH of a VGCS
or VBS downlink, SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 10 messages address all mobile stations receiving that downlink
within the cell. There may be different SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 10 messages sent on the same SACCH.
They are not standard layer 3 messages. They shall be transferred using the short header format for SACCH messages
sent in unacknowledged mode specified in GSM 04.07.
Each SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 10 message defines a list of cells and may contain further information for cells
of that list, a cell being identified by the pair of ARFCN and BSIC of the BCCH. Newer information about a cell
received in SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 10 messages shall replace older information.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
9.1.51
This message is sent on the SACCH by the network to the mobile station, to order the mobile station to send one
extended measurement report. See table 9.1.51.1/GSM 04.08.
A mobile station which does not support Extended Measurements shall discard this message.
This message has a L2 Pseudo Length of 18.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
300
Information element
L2 pseudo length
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Extended Measurement
Order
Extended Measurement
Frequency List
9.1.52
Type / Reference
L2 pseudo length
10.5.2.19
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Extended Measurement
Frequency List
10.5.2.46
Presence
M
Format
V
length
1/2
1/2
16
This message is sent on the SACCH by the mobile station to the network to report extended measurement results about
the signal strength on specified carriers. See table 9.1.52.1/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
Information element
RR management
Protocol Discriminator
Skip Indicator
Extended Measurement Report
Message Type
Extended Measurement
Results
9.2
Type / Reference
Protocol Discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message Type
10.4
Extended Measurement
Results
10.5.2.45
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
length
1/2
16
301
9.2.1
Reference
9.2.12
9.2.13
9.2.14
9.2.15
Reference
9.2.1
9.2.2
9.2.3
9.2.10
9.2.11
9.2.17
9.2.18
Reference
9.2.5
9.2.6
9.2.7
9.2.9
9.2.4
9.2.8
9.2.20
Reference
9.2.15a
9.2.16
9.2.19
Authentication reject
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to indicate that authentication has failed (and that the
receiving mobile station shall abort all activities). See table 9.2.2/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
AUTHENTICATION REJECT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
Authentication Reject
message type
9.2.2
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
Authentication request
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to initiate authentication of the mobile station identity. See
table 9.2.3/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
AUTHENTICATION REQUEST
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
302
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
Authentication Request
message type
Ciphering key sequence
number
Spare half octet
Authentication
parameter RAND
9.2.3
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Ciphering key sequence
number
10.5.1.2
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Auth. parameter RAND
10.5.3.1
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
16
Authentication response
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network to deliver a calculated response to the network. See
table 9.2.4/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
Authentication Response
message type
Authentication
parameter SRES
9.2.4
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Auth. parameter SRES
10.5.3.2
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
CM Re-establishment request
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network to request re-establishment of a connection if the previous one
has failed. See table 9.2.5/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CM RE-ESTABLISHMENT REQUEST
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
303
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
CM Re-Establishment
Request message type
Ciphering key sequence
number
Spare half octet
Mobile station
classmark
Mobile identity
13
Location area
identification
9.2.4.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Ciphering key sequence
number
10.5.1.2
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Mobile station
classmark 2
10.5.1.6
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Location area
identification
10.5.1.3
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
LV
LV
2-9
TV
The location area identification information element shall appear when a TMSI is used as mobile identity, to render that
mobile identity non-ambiguous. This is the LAI stored in the SIM.
9.2.4.2
This IE shall include for multiband mobile station the Classmark 2 corresponding to the frequency band in use.
9.2.5
CM service accept
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to indicate that the requested service has been accepted. See
table 9.2.6/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CM SERVICE ACCEPT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
CM Service Accept
message type
9.2.5a
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
A mobile station that does not support the "Network initiated MO call" option shall treat this message as a message with
message type not defined for the PD.
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to request the mobile to establish a service for the specified
CM protocol using the specified SAPI, e.g. circuit switched connection establishment on SAPI 0, supplementary
services activation on SAPI 0, or short message transfer on SAPI 3. See Table 9.2.7/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
304
Message type:
CM SERVICE PROMPT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
CM Service Prompt
message type
PD and SAPI of CM
9.2.6
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
PD and SAPI
10.5.1.10a
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
CM service reject
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to indicate that the requested service cannot be provided. See
table 9.2.8/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CM SERVICE REJECT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
CM Service Reject
message type
Reject cause
9.2.7
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Reject cause
10.5.3.6
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
CM service abort
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network to request the abortion of the first MM connection
establishment in progress and the release of the RR connection. See table 9.2.9/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CM SERVICE ABORT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
CM Service Abort
message type
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
9.2.8
305
Abort
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to initiate the abortion of all MM connections and to indicate
the reason for the abortion. See table 9.2.10/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
ABORT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
Abort
message type
Reject cause
9.2.9
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Reject cause
10.5.3.6
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
CM service request
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network to request a service for the connection management sublayer
entities, e.g. circuit switched connection establishment, supplementary services activation, short message transfer,
location services. See table 9.2.11/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CM SERVICE REQUEST
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
CM Service Request
message type
CM service type
Ciphering key sequence
number
Mobile station
classmark
Mobile identity
8-
Priority
9.2.9.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
CM service type
10.5.3.3
Ciphering key sequence
number
10.5.1.2
Mobile station
classmark 2
10.5.1.6
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Priority Level
10.5.1.11
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
LV
LV
2-9
TV
This IE shall include for multiband mobile station the Classmark 2 corresponding to the frequency band in use.
ETSI
9.2.9.2
306
Priority
May be included by mobile station supporting eMLPP to indicate the priority requested.
This information element is only meaningful when the CM service type is:
-
9.2.10
Identity request
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to request a mobile station to submit the specified identity to
the network. See table 9.2.12/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
IDENTITY REQUEST
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
Identity Request
message type
Identity type
Spare half octet
9.2.11
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Identity type
10.5.3.4
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
Identity response
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network in response to an IDENTITY REQUEST message providing
the requested identity. See table 9.2.13/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
IDENTITY RESPONSE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
Identity Response
message type
Mobile identity
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
LV
2-10
9.2.12
307
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network to set a deactivation indication in the network. See
table 9.2.14/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
IMSI Detach Indication
message type
Mobile station
classmark
Mobile identity
9.2.12.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Mobile station
classmark 1
10.5.1.5
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
LV
2-9
This IE shall include for multiband mobile station the Classmark 1 corresponding to the frequency band in use.
9.2.13
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to indicate that updating or IMSI attach in the network has
been completed. See table 9.2.15/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
Location Updating
Accept message type
Location area
identification
17
Mobile identity
A1
Follow on proceed
A2
CTS permission
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Location area
identification
10.5.1.3
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Follow on proceed
10.5.3.7
CTS permission
10.5.3.10
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
TLV
3-10
9.2.13.1
308
Follow on proceed
The follow on proceed information element appears if the network wishes to indicate that the mobile station may
attempt an MM connection establishment using the same RR connection.
9.2.13.2
CTS permission
The CTS permission information element appears if the network wishes to allow the mobile station to use GSMCordless Telephony System in the Location Area.
9.2.14
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to indicate that updating or IMSI attach has failed. See
table 9.2.16/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
Location Updating
Reject message type
Reject cause
9.2.15
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Reject cause
10.5.3.6
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network either to request update of its location file (normal updating or
periodic updating) or to request IMSI attach. See table 9.2.17/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
309
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
Location Updating
Request message type
Location updating type
Ciphering key sequence
number
Location area
identification
Mobile station
classmark
Mobile identity
9.2.15.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Location updating type
10.5.3.5
Ciphering key sequence
number
10.5.1.2
Location area
identification
10.5.1.3
Mobile station
classmark 1
10.5.1.5
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
LV
2-9
9.2.15.2
This IE shall include for multiband MS the Classmark 1 corresponding to the frequency band in use.
9.2.15a MM information
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to provide the mobile station with subscriber specific
information. See table 9.2.18/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
MM INFORMATION
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
43
MM Information
message type
Full name for network
45
46
47
48
LSA Identity
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Network Name
10.5.3.5a
Network Name
10.5.3.5a
Time Zone
10.5.3.8
Time Zone and Time
10.5.3.9
LSA Identifier
10.5.3.11
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
TLV
3-?
TLV
3-?
TV
TV
TLV
2-5
9.2.15a.1
310
This IE may be sent by the network. If this IE is sent, the contents of this IE indicate the "full length name of the
network" that the network wishes the mobile station to associate with the MCC and MNC contained in the Location
Area Identification of the cell to which the mobile station sent its Channel Request message.
9.2.15a.2
This IE may be sent by the network. If this IE is sent, the contents of this IE indicate the "abbreviated name of the
network" that the network wishes the mobile station to associate with the MCC and MNC contained in the Location
Area Identification of the cell to which the mobile station sent its Channel Request message.
9.2.15a.3
This IE may be sent by the network. The mobile station should assume that this time zone applies to the Location Area
of the cell to which the Channel Request message was sent.
9.2.15a.4
This IE may be sent by the network. The mobile station should assume that this time zone applies to the Location Area
of the cell to which the Channel Request message was sent. The mobile station shall not assume that the time
information is accurate.
9.2.15a.5
LSA Identity
This IE may be sent by the network. The contents of this IE indicate the LSA identity of the serving cell.
9.2.16
MM Status
This message is sent by the mobile station or the network at any time to report certain error conditions listed in clause 8.
See table 9.2.19/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
MM STATUS
Significance:
local
Direction:
both
Table 9.2.19/GSM 04.08: MM STATUS message content
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
MM Status message
type
Reject cause
9.2.17
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Reject cause
10.5.3.6
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to reallocate or delete a TMSI. See table 9.2.20/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
ETSI
311
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
TMSI Reallocation
Command message type
Location area
identification
Mobile identity
9.2.18
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Location area
identification
10.5.1.3
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
LV
2-9
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network to indicate that reallocation or deletion of a TMSI has taken
place. See table 9.2.21/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
TMSI Reallocation
Complete message type
9.2.19
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
MM Null
MM NULL
Table 9.2.22/GSM 04.08: MM NULL message content
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
MM Null message
type
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
Length
1/2
9.2.20
312
Notification response
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network to respond on a notification for a voice group call or voice
broadcast call. See table 9.2.23/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
NOTIFICATION RESPONSE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Mobility management
protocol discriminator
Skip Indicator
Notification response
message type
Mobile station
classmark
Mobile identity
Group or broadcast
call reference
9.3
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip Indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Mobile station
classmark 2
10.5.1.6
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Call reference
10.5.1.9
Presence
M
Format
V
1/2
1/2
LV
LV
2-9
Table 9.54/GSM 04.08 summarizes the messages for circuit-switched call control.
ETSI
Length
313
NOTE:
9.3.1
Reference
9.3.1
9.3.2
9.3.3
9.3.5
9.3.6
9.3.8
9.3.17
9.3.23
Reference
9.3.13
9.3.14
9.3.15
9.3.31
Reference
9.3.7
9.3.18
9.3.19
Reference
9.3.9
9.3.10
9.3.11
9.3.12
9.3.20
9.3.21
9.3.22
Reference
9.3.4
9.3.16
9.3.24
9.3.25
9.3.26
9.3.27
9.3.28
9.3.29
9.3.30
Alerting
9.3.1.1
This message is sent by the network to the calling mobile station to indicate that the called user alerting has been
initiated.
See table 9.55/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
ALERTING
Significance:
global
Direction:
ETSI
314
Table 9.55/GSM 04.08: ALERTING message content (network to mobile station direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
1C
Alerting
message type
Facility
1E
Progress indicator
7E
User-user
9.3.1.1.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Facility
10.5.4.15
Progress indicator
10.5.4.21
User-user
10.5.4.25
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
2-?
TLV
TLV
3-131
Facility
This information element may be used for functional operation of supplementary services.
9.3.1.1.2
Progress indicator
in order to pass information about the call in progress, e.g., in the event of interworking; and/or
to make the mobile station attach the user connection for speech.
9.3.1.1.3
User-user
This information element may be included by the network if the called remote user included a user-user information
element in the ALERTING message.
9.3.1.2
This message is sent by the called mobile station to the network, to indicate that the called user alerting has been
initiated.
See table 9.55a/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
ALERTING
Significance:
global
Direction:
Table 9.55a/GSM 04.08: ALERTING message content (mobile station to network direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
1C
Alerting
message type
Facility
7E
User-user
7F
SS version
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Facility
10.5.4.15
User-user
10.5.4.25
SS version indicator
10.5.4.24
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
2-?
TLV
3-131
TLV
2-3
9.3.1.2.1
315
Facility
This information element may be used for functional operation of supplementary services.
9.3.1.2.2
User-user
This information element may be included when the called mobile station wants to return information to the calling
remote user.
9.3.1.2.3
SS version
This information element shall not be included if the facility information element is not present in this message.
This information element shall be included or excluded as defined in GSM 04.10. This information element should not
be transmitted unless explicitly required by GSM 04.10.
9.3.2
Call confirmed
This message is sent by the called mobile station to confirm an incoming call request.
See table 9.56/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CALL CONFIRMED
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
D-
Call confirmed
message type
Repeat Indicator
04
Bearer capability 1
04
Bearer capability 2
08
Cause
15
CC Capabilities
9.3.2.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Repeat Indicator
10.5.4.22
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Cause
10.5.4.11
Call Control Capabilities
10.5.4.5a
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TV
TLV
3-15
TLV
3-15
TLV
4-32
TLV
Repeat indicator
The repeat indicator information element shall be included if bearer capability 1 information element and bearer
capability 2 IE are both included in the message.
9.3.2.2
The bearer capability 1 information element shall be included if and only if at least one of the following five cases
holds:
-
the mobile station wishes another bearer capability than that given by the bearer capability 1 information
element of the incoming SETUP message;
the bearer capability 1 information element is missing or not fully specified in the SETUP message;
ETSI
316
the bearer capability 1 information element received in the SETUP message is accepted and the "radio channel
requirement" of the mobile station is other than "full rate support only mobile station";
the bearer capability 1 information element received in the SETUP message indicates speech and is accepted
and the mobile station supports other speech versions than GSM version 1;
the bearer capability 1 information element received in the SETUP message included the "fixed network user
rate" parameter.
When the bearer capability 1 information element is followed by the bearer capability 2 IE in the SETUP, the above
rules apply to both bearer capability 1 IE and bearer capability 2 IE. Except those cases identified in GSM 07.01, if
either bearer capability needs to be included, both shall be included.
Furthermore, both bearer capability information elements may be present if the mobile station wishes to reverse the
order of occurrence of the bearer capability information elements (which is referred to in the repeat indicator
information element, see section 10.5.4.22) in cases identified in GSM 07.01.
9.3.2.3
Cause
This information element is included if the mobile station is compatible but the user is busy.
9.3.2.4
CC Capabilities
This information element may be included by the mobile station to indicate its call control capabilities.
9.3.3
Call proceeding
This message is sent by the network to the calling mobile station to indicate that the requested call establishment
information has been received, and no more call establishment information will be accepted.
See table 9.57/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CALL PROCEEDING
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
D-
Call proceeding
message type
Repeat Indicator
04
Bearer capability 1
04
Bearer capability 2
1C
Facility
1E
Progress indicator
8-
Priority granted
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Repeat Indicator
10.5.4.22
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Facility
10.5.4.15
Progress indicator
10.5.4.21
Priority Level
10.5.1.11
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TV
TLV
3-15
TLV
3-15
TLV
2-?
TLV
TV
9.3.3.1
317
Repeat indicator
This information element is included if and only if bearer capability 1 IE and bearer capability 2 IE are both contained
in the message.
9.3.3.2
The bearer capability 1 information element is included if the network has to specify at least one of the negotiable
parameters described in GSM 07.01, or if the bearer capability 1 information element received in the SETUP message
included the "fixed network user rate" parameter.
When the bearer capability 1 information element is followed by the bearer capability 2 IE in the SETUP, the above
rule applies to both bearer capability 1 IE and bearer capability 2 IE. Except those cases identified in GSM 07.01, if
either bearer capability needs to be included, both shall be included.
9.3.3.3
Facility
This information element may be used for functional operation of supplementary services.
9.3.3.4
Progress Indicator
in order to pass information about the call in progress e.g. in the event of interworking; and/or
9.3.3.5
Priority granted
The priority field is provided by the network in the case that eMLPP is used and the priority assigned by the network is
not the same as that requested by the mobile station.
9.3.4
Congestion control
This message is sent by the network to indicate the establishment or termination of flow control on the transmission of
USER INFORMATION messages.
See table 9.58/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CONGESTION CONTROL
Significance:
local (note)
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Congestion control
message type
Congestion level
Spare half octet
08
Cause
NOTE:
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Congestion level
10.5.4.12
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Cause
10.5.4.11
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
TLV
4-32
This message has local significance, but may carry information of global significance.
ETSI
9.3.4.1
318
Cause
This information element is included if the user to user information has been discarded as a result of the congestion
situation.
9.3.5
Connect
9.3.5.1
This message is sent by the network to the calling mobile station to indicate call acceptance by the called user.
See table 9.59/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CONNECT
Significance:
global
Direction:
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
1C
Connect
message type
Facility
1E
Progress indicator
4C
Connected number
4D
Connected subaddress
7E
User-user
9.3.5.1.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Facility
10.5.4.15
Progress indicator
10.5.4.21
Connected number
10.5.4.13
Connected subaddress
10.5.4.14
User-user
10.5.4.25
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
2-?
TLV
TLV
3-14
TLV
2-23
TLV
3-131
Facility
This information element may be used for functional operation of supplementary services.
9.3.5.1.2
Progress indicator
in order to pass information about the call in progress e.g. in the event of interworking; and/or
9.3.5.1.3
User-user
This information element may be included by the network if the remote user awarded the call included a user- user
information element in the CONNECT message.
9.3.5.2
This message is sent by the called mobile station to the network to indicate call acceptance by the called user.
See table 9.59a/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
319
Message type:
CONNECT
Significance:
global
Direction:
Table 9.59a/GSM 04.08: CONNECT message content (mobile station to network direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
1C
Connect
message type
Facility
4D
Connected subaddress
7E
User-user
7F
SS version
9.3.5.2.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Facility
10.5.4.15
Connected subaddress
10.5.4.14
User-user
10.5.4.25
SS version indicator
10.5.4.24
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
2-?
TLV
2-23
TLV
3-131
TLV
2-3
Facility
This information element may be used for functional operation of supplementary services.
9.3.5.2.2
User-user
This information element is included when the answering mobile station wants to return user information to the calling
remote user.
9.3.5.2.3
SS version
This information element shall not be included if the facility information element is not present in this message.
This information element shall be included or excluded as defined in GSM 04.10. This information element should not
be transmitted unless explicitly required by GSM 04.10.
9.3.6
Connect acknowledge
This message is sent by the network to the called mobile station to indicate that the mobile station has been awarded the
call. It shall also be sent by the calling mobile station to the network to acknowledge the offered connection.
See table 9.60/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
Significance:
local
Direction:
both
Table 9.60/GSM 04.08: CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE message content
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Connect acknowledge
message type
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
9.3.7
320
Disconnect
9.3.7.1
This message is sent by the network to indicate that the end-to-end connection is cleared.
See table 9.61/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
DISCONNECT
Significance:
global
Direction:
Table 9.61/GSM 04.08: DISCONNECT message content (network to mobile station direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Disconnect
message type
Cause
1C
Facility
1E
Progress indicator
7E
User-user
7B
9.3.7.1.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Cause
10.5.4.11
Facility
10.5.4.15
Progress indicator
10.5.4.21
User-user
10.5.4.25
Allowed actions
10.5.4.26
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
3-31
TLV
2-?
TLV
TLV
3-131
TLV
Facility
This information element may be used for functional operation of supplementary services, such as the user-user service.
9.3.7.1.2
Progress indicator
This information element is included by the network to make the MS attach the user connection for speech and react in
a specific way during call clearing (see section 5.4.4).
9.3.7.1.3
User-user
This information element may be included by the network when the remote user initiates call clearing and included a
user-user information element in the DISCONNECT message.
9.3.7.1.4
This information element may be included by the network to inform the MS about further possible reactions.
9.3.7.2
This message is sent by the mobile station to request the network to clear an end-to-end connection.
See table 9.61a/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
DISCONNECT
Significance:
global
ETSI
Direction:
321
Table 9.61a/GSM 04.08: DISCONNECT message content (mobile station to network direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Disconnect
message type
Cause
1C
Facility
7E
User-user
7F
SS version
9.3.7.2.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Cause
10.5.4.11
Facility
10.5.4.15
User-user
10.5.4.25
SS version indicator
10.5.4.24
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
3-31
TLV
2-?
TLV
3-131
TLV
2-3
Facility
This information element may be used for functional operation of supplementary services, such as the user-user service.
9.3.7.2.2
User-user
This information element is included when the mobile station initiates call clearing and wants to pass user information
to the remote user at call clearing time.
9.3.7.2.3
SS version
This information element shall not be included if the facility information element is not present in this message.
This information element shall be included or excluded as defined in GSM 04.10. This information element should not
be transmitted unless explicitly required by GSM 04.10.
9.3.8
Emergency setup
This message is sent from the mobile station to initiate emergency call establishment.
See table 9.62/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
EMERGENCY SETUP
Significance:
global
Direction:
IEI
04
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Emergency setup
message type
Bearer capability
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
3-9
9.3.8.1
322
Bearer capability
If the element is not included, the network shall by default assume speech and select full rate speech version 1. If this
information element is included, it shall indicate speech, the appropriate speech version(s) and have the appropriate
value of radio channel requirement field.
9.3.9
Facility
9.3.9.1
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to request or acknowledge a supplementary service. The
supplementary service to be invoked and its associated parameters are specified in the facility information element.
See table 9.62a/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
FACILITY
Significance:
local (NOTE 1)
Direction:
Table 9.62a/GSM 04.08: FACILITY message content (network to mobile station direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Facility
message type
Facility (note 2)
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Facility
10.5.4.15
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
1-?
NOTE 1: This message has local significance; however, it may carry information of global significance.
NOTE 2: The facility information element has no upper length limit except that given by the maximum number of
octets in a L3 message, see GSM 04.06.
ETSI
9.3.9.2
323
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network to request or acknowledge a supplementary service. The
supplementary service to be invoked and its associated parameters are specified in the facility information element.
See table 9.62b/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
FACILITY
Significance:
local (note 1)
Direction:
Table 9.62b/GSM 04.08: FACILITY message content (mobile station to network direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Facility
message type
Facility (note 2)
7F
SS version
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Facility
10.5.4.15
SS version indicator
10.5.4.24
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
1-?
TLV
2-3
NOTE 1: This message has local significance; however, it may carry information of global significance.
NOTE 2: The facility information element has no upper length limit except that given by the maximum number of
octets in a L3 message, see GSM 04.06.
9.3.9.2.1
SS version
This information element shall be included or excluded as defined in GSM 04.10. This information element should not
be transmitted unless explicitly required by GSM 04.10.
9.3.10
Hold
This message is sent by the mobile user to request the hold function for an existing call.
See table 9.62c/GSM 04.08 for the content of the HOLD message.
For the use of this message, see GSM 04.10.
Message type:
HOLD
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Hold
message type
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
9.3.11
324
Hold Acknowledge
This message is sent by the network to indicate that the hold function has been successfully performed.
See table 9.62d/GSM 04.08 for the content of the HOLD ACKNOWLEDGE message.
For the use of this message, see GSM 04.10.
Message type:
HOLD ACKNOWLEDGE
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Hold Acknowledge
message type
9.3.12
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
3-31
Hold Reject
This message is sent by the network to indicate the denial of a request to hold a call.
See table 9.62e/GSM 04.08 for the content of the HOLD REJECT message.
For the use of this message, see GSM 04.10.
Message type:
HOLD REJECT
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Hold Reject
message type
Cause
9.3.13
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
10.5.4.11
Modify
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network or by the network to the mobile station to request a change in
bearer capability for a call.
See table 9.63/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
MODIFY
Significance:
global
Direction:
both
ETSI
325
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Modify
message type
Bearer capability
7C
7D
A3
9.3.13.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Low layer comp.
10.5.4.18
High layer comp.
10.5.4.16
Reverse call setup
direction
10.5.4.22a
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
2-14
TLV
2-15
TLV
2-5
This information element shall be included if it was included in the initial SETUP message.
9.3.13.2
This information element shall be included if it was included in the initial SETUP message.
9.3.13.3
This information element is included or omitted in the mobile to network direction according to the rules defined in
section 5.3.4.3.1.
9.3.14
Modify complete
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network or by the network to the mobile station to indicate completion
of a request to change bearer capability for a call.
See table 9.64/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
MODIFY COMPLETE
Significance:
global
Direction:
both
ETSI
326
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Modify complete
message type
Bearer capability
7C
7D
A3
9.3.14.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Low layer comp.
10.5.4.18
High layer comp.
10.5.4.16
Reverse call setup
direction
10.5.4.22a
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
2-14
TLV
2-15
TLV
2-5
This information element shall be included if it was included in the initial SETUP message.
9.3.14.2
This information element shall be included if it was included in the initial SETUP message.
9.3.14.3
This information element is included or omitted according to the rules defined in section 5.3.4.3.2.
9.3.15
Modify reject
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network or by the network to the mobile station to indicate failure of a
request to change the bearer capability for a call.
See table 9.65/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
MODIFY REJECT
Significance:
global
Direction:
both
Table 9.65/GSM 04.08: MODIFY REJECT message content
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Modify reject
message type
Bearer capability
Cause
7C
7D
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Cause
10.5.4.11
Low layer comp.
10.5.4.18
High layer comp.
10.5.4.16
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
2-14
LV
3-31
TLV
2-15
TLV
2-5
9.3.15.1
327
This information element shall be included if it was included in the initial SETUP message.
9.3.15.2
This information element shall be included if it was included in the initial SETUP message.
9.3.16
Notify
This message is sent either from the mobile station or from the network to indicate information pertaining to a call, such
as user suspended.
See table 9.66/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
NOTIFY
Significance:
access
Direction:
both
Table 9.66/GSM 04.08: NOTIFY message content
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Notify
message type
Notification indicator
9.3.17
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Notification indicator
10.5.4.20
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
Progress
This message is sent from the network to the mobile station to indicate the progress of a call in the event of
interworking or in connection with the provision of in-band information/patterns.
See table 9.67/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
PROGRESS
Significance:
global
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Progress
message type
Progress indicator
7E
User-user
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Progress indicator
10.5.4.21
User-user
10.5.4.25
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
TLV
3-131
9.3.17.1
328
User-user
This information element is included when the PROGRESS message is sent by the network when the call has been
cleared by the remote user before it reached the active state to indicate that the remote user wants to pass user
information at call clearing time.
CC-ESTABLISHMENT
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
CC-Establishment
message type
Setup container
NOTE:
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Container
10.5.4.22a
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
3-n
From the 4th IE onwards the message is coded in the same way as the SETUP message in MS to network
direction from the 4th IE onwards.
9.3.17a.1
Spare
9.3.17a.2
Setup container
This information element contains the contents of a SETUP message (Mobile Station to Network).
CC-ESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED
Significance:
local
Direction:
ETSI
329
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
D-
CC-Establishment
confirmed
message type
Repeat Indicator
04
Bearer capability 1
04
Bearer capability 2
08
Cause
9.3.17b.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
Message type
10.4
Repeat Indicator
10.5.4.22
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Cause
10.5.4.11
TV
TLV
3-10
TLV
3-10
TLV
4-32
Repeat indicator
The repeat indicator information element shall be included if bearer capability 1 information element and bearer
capability 2 IE are both included in the message.
9.3.17b.2
If, in any subsequent SETUP message to be sent on this transaction the bearer capability 1 information element is to be
followed by the bearer capability 2 IE, then the bearer capability 2 IE shall be included in this message.
9.3.17b.3
Spare
9.3.17b.4
Spare
9.3.17b.5
Spare
9.3.17b.6
Spare
9.3.17b.7
Spare
9.3.17b.8
Spare
9.3.17b.9
Cause
This information element is included if the mobile station is compatible but the user is busy.
9.3.18
Release
9.3.18.1
This message is sent, from the network to the mobile station to indicate that the network intends to release the
transaction identifier, and that the receiving equipment shall release the transaction identifier after sending RELEASE
COMPLETE.
See table 9.68/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
RELEASE
Significance:
local (note)
ETSI
Direction:
330
Table 9.68/GSM 04.08: RELEASE message content (network to mobile station direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
08
Release
message type
Cause
08
Second cause
1C
Facility
7E
User-user
NOTE:
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Cause
10.5.4.11
Cause
10.5.4.11
Facility
10.5.4.15
User-user
10.5.4.25
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
4-32
TLV
4-32
TLV
2-?
TLV
3-131
This message has local significance; however, it may carry information of global significance when used
as the first call clearing message.
9.3.18.1.1
Cause
This information element shall be included if this message is used to initiate call clearing.
9.3.18.1.2
Second cause
This information element may be included under the conditions described in section 5.4.4.1.2.3 "Abnormal cases"
(Clearing initiated by the network).
9.3.18.1.3
Facility
This information element may be included for functional operation of supplementary services.
9.3.18.1.4
User-user
This information element may be included in the network to mobile station direction, when the RELEASE message is
used to initiate call clearing, in order to transport user-user information from the remote user.
9.3.18.2
This message is sent from the mobile station to the network to indicate that the mobile station intends to release the
transaction identifier, and that the receiving equipment shall release the transaction identifier after sending RELEASE
COMPLETE.
See table 9.68a/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
RELEASE
Significance:
local (note)
Direction:
ETSI
331
Table 9.68a/GSM 04.08: RELEASE message content (mobile station to network direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
08
Release
message type
Cause
08
Second cause
1C
Facility
7E
User-user
7F
SS version
NOTE:
9.3.18.2.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Cause
10.5.4.11
Cause
10.5.4.11
Facility
10.5.4.15
User-user
10.5.4.25
SS version indicator
10.5.4.24
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
4-32
TLV
4-32
TLV
2-?
TLV
3-131
TLV
2-3
This message has local significance; however, it may carry information of global significance when used
as the first call clearing message.
Cause
This information element shall be included if this message is used to initiate call clearing.
9.3.18.2.2
Second cause
This information element may be included under the conditions described in section 5.4.3.5 "Abnormal cases" (Clearing
initiated by the mobile station).
9.3.18.2.3
Facility
This information element may be included for functional operation of supplementary services.
9.3.18.2.4
User-user
This information element is included when the RELEASE message is used to initiate call clearing and the mobile
station wants to pass user information to the remote user at call clearing time.
9.3.18.2.5
SS version
This information element shall not be included if the facility information element is not present in this message.
This information element shall be included or excluded as defined in GSM 04.10. This information element should not
be transmitted unless explicitly required by GSM 04.10.
ETSI
332
RECALL
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Recall
message type
Recall Type
Facility
9.3.18a.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Recall Type
10.5.4.21a
Facility
10.5.4.15
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
2-n
Recall Type
The purpose of the recall type information element is to describe the reason for the recall.
9.3.18a.2
Facility
The information element shall be included for functional operation of supplementary services.
9.3.19
Release complete
9.3.19.1
This message is sent from the network to the mobile station to indicate that the network has released the transaction
identifier and that the mobile station shall release the transaction identifier.
See table 9.69/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
RELEASE COMPLETE
Significance:
local (note)
Direction:
ETSI
333
Table 9.69/GSM 04.08: RELEASE COMPLETE message content (network to mobile station direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
08
Release complete
message type
Cause
1C
Facility
7E
User-user
NOTE:
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Cause
10.5.4.11
Facility
10.5.4.15
User-user
10.5.4.25
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
4-32
TLV
2-?
TLV
3-131
This message has local significance; however, it may carry information of global significance when used
as the first call clearing message.
9.3.19.1.1
Cause
This information element shall be included if the message is used to initiate call clearing.
9.3.19.1.2
Facility
This information element may be included for functional operation of supplementary services.
9.3.19.1.3
User-user
This information element is included in the network to mobile station direction, when the RELEASE COMPLETE
message is used to initiate call clearing, in order to transport user-user information from the remote user.
9.3.19.2
This message is sent from the mobile station to the network to indicate that the mobile station has released the
transaction identifier and that the network shall release the transaction identifier.
See table 9.69a/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
RELEASE COMPLETE
Significance:
local (note)
Direction:
Table 9.69a/GSM 04.08: RELEASE COMPLETE message content (mobile station to network direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
08
Release complete
message type
Cause
1C
Facility
7E
User-user
7F
SS version
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Cause
10.5.4.11
Facility
10.5.4.15
User-user
10.5.4.25
SS version indicator
10.5.4.24
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
4-32
TLV
2-?
TLV
3-131
TLV
2-3
NOTE:
334
This message has local significance; however, it may carry information of global significance when used
as the first call clearing message.
9.3.19.2.1
Cause
This information element shall be included if the message is used to initiate call clearing.
9.3.19.2.2
Facility
This information element may be included for functional operation of supplementary services.
9.3.19.2.3
User-user
This information element is included in the mobile station to network direction when the RELEASE COMPLETE
message is used to initiate call clearing and the mobile station wants to pass user information to the remote user at call
clearing time.
9.3.19.2.4
SS version.
This information element shall not be included if the facility information element is not present in this message.
This information element shall be included or excluded as defined in GSM 04.10. This information element should not
be transmitted unless explicitly required by GSM 04.10.
9.3.20
Retrieve
This message is sent by the mobile user to request the retrieval of a held call.
See table 9.69b/GSM 04.08 for the content of the RETRIEVE message.
For the use of this message, see GSM 04.10.
Message type:
RETRIEVE
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Retrieve
message type
9.3.21
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
Retrieve Acknowledge
This message is sent by the network to indicate that the retrieve function has been successfully performed.
See table 9.69c/GSM 04.08 for the content of the RETRIEVE ACKNOWLEDGE message.
For the use of this message, see GSM 04.10.
Message type:
RETRIEVE ACKNOWLEDGE
Significance:
local
Direction:
ETSI
335
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Retrieve Acknowledge
message type
9.3.22
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
Retrieve Reject
This message is sent by the network to indicate the inability to perform the requested retrieve function.
See table 9.69d/GSM 04.08 for the content of the RETRIEVE REJECT message.
For the use of this message, see GSM 04.10.
Message type:
RETRIEVE REJECT
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Retrieve Reject
message type
Cause
9.3.23
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
10.5.4.11
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
3-31
Setup
9.3.23.1
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to initiate a mobile terminated call establishment.
See table 9.70/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
SETUP
Significance:
global
Direction:
ETSI
336
Table 9.70/GSM 04.08: SETUP message content (network to mobile station direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
D-
Setup
message type
BC repeat indicator
04
Bearer capability 1
04
Bearer capability 2
1C
Facility
1E
Progress indicator
34
Signal
5C
74
75
D-
7C
Low layer
compatibility I
Low layer
compatibility II
HLC repeat indicator
5D
5E
6D
7C
D7D
7E
High layer
compatibility i
High layer
compatibility ii
User-user
8-
Priority
19
Alert
7D
9.3.23.1.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Repeat indicator
10.5.4.22
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Facility
10.5.4.15
Progress indicator
10.5.4.21
Signal
10.5.4.23
Calling party BCD num.
10.5.4.9
Calling party subaddr.
10.5.4.10
Called party BCD num.
10.5.4.7
Called party subaddr.
10.5.4.8
Redirecting party BCD num.
10.5.4.21a
Redirecting party subaddress.
10.5.4.21b
Repeat indicator
10.5.4.22
Low layer comp.
10.5.4.18
Low layer comp.
10.5.4.18
Repeat indicator
10.5.4.22
High layer comp.
10.5.4.16
High layer comp.
10.5.4.16
User-user
10.5.4.25
Priority Level
10.5.1.11
Alerting Pattern
10.5.4.26
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TV
TLV
3-15
TLV
3-15
TLV
2-?
TLV
TV
TLV
3-14
TLV
2-23
TLV
3-19
TLV
2-23
TLV
3-19
TLV
2-23
TV
TLV
2-15
TLV
2-15
TV
TLV
2-5
TLV
2-5
TLV
3-35
TV
TLV
BC repeat indicator
The BC repeat indicator information element is included if and only if bearer capability 1 information element and
bearer capability 2 IE are both present in the message.
9.3.23.1.2
The bearer capability 1 information element may be omitted in the case where the mobile subscriber is allocated only
one directory number for all services (ref.: GSM 09.07). The bearer capability 2 IE is missing at least if the bearer
capability 1 IE is missing.
ETSI
9.3.23.1.3
337
Facility
This information element may be included for functional operation of supplementary services.
9.3.23.1.4
Progress indicator
in order to pass information about the call in progress e.g. in the event of interworking; and/or
9.3.23.1.4a
For all bands except for PCS1900, the maximum length of this IE sent by the network shall be 13 octets.
9.3.23.1.5
Included in the Network-to-mobile station direction if the calling user includes a called party subaddress information
element in the SETUP message.
9.3.23.1.6
The LLC repeat indicator information element is included if and only if both following conditions hold.
-
If included, the LLC repeat indicator shall specify the same repeat indication as the BC repeat indicator IE.
9.3.23.1.7
Included in the network-to-mobile station direction if the calling user specified a low layer compatibility.
9.3.23.1.8
Included if and only if the LLC repeat indicator information element is contained in the message.
9.3.23.1.9
The HLC repeat indicator information element is included if and only both following conditions hold.
-
If included, the HLC repeat indicator shall specify the same repeat indication as the BC repeat indicator IE.
9.3.23.1.10
Included in the network-to-mobile station direction if the calling user specified a high layer compatibility.
9.3.23.1.11
Included if and only if the HLC repeat indicator information element is contained in the message.
9.3.23.1.12
User-user
May be included in the network to called mobile station direction when the calling remote user included a user-user
information element in the SETUP message.
ETSI
9.3.23.1.13
338
May be included in the network to called mobile station direction when the call has been redirected.
9.3.23.1.14
May be included in the network to called mobile station direction when the calling remote user included a called party
subaddress in the SETUP message and the call has been redirected
9.3.23.1.15
Priority
May be included by the network to indicate the priority of the incoming call if eMLPP is used.
9.3.23.1.16
May be included by the network to give some indication about alerting (category or level). If supported in the MS, this
optional indication is to be used by the MS as specified in GSM 02.07.
9.3.23.2
This message is sent from the mobile station to the network to initiate a mobile originating call establishment.
See table 9.70a/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
SETUP
Significance:
global
Direction:
ETSI
339
Table 9.70a/GSM 04.08: SETUP message content (mobile station to network direction)
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
D-
Setup
message type
BC repeat indicator
04
Bearer capability 1
04
Bearer capability 2
1C
5D
5E
6D
D7C
7C
D7D
Low layer
compatibility I
Low layer
compatibility II
HLC repeat indicator
7E
High layer
compatibility i
High layer
compatibility ii
User-user
7F
SS version
A1
CLIR suppression
A2
CLIR invocation
15
CC capabilities
1D
Facility $(CCBS)$
(advanced recall alignment)
Facility (recall alignment
Not essential) $(CCBS)$
7D
1B
9.3.23.2.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Repeat indicator
10.5.4.22
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Bearer capability
10.5.4.5
Facility
10.5.4.15
Calling party subaddr.
10.5.4.10
Called party BCD num.
10.5.4.7
Called party subaddr.
10.5.4.8
Repeat indicator
10.5.4.22
Low layer comp.
10.5.4.18
Low layer comp.
10.5.4.18
Repeat indicator
10.5.4.22
High layer comp.
10.5.4.16
High layer comp.
10.5.4.16
User-user
10.5.4.25
SS version indicator
10.5.4.24
CLIR suppression
10.5.4.11a
CLIR invocation
10.5.4.11b
Call Control Capabilities
10.5.4.5a
Facility
10.5.4.15
Facility
10.5.4.15
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TV
TLV
3-16
TLV
3-16
TLV
2-
TLV
2-23
TLV
3-43
TLV
2-23
TV
TLV
2-15
TLV
2-15
TV
TLV
2-5
TLV
2-5
TLV
3-35
TLV
2-3
TLV
TLV
2-?
TLV
2-?
BC repeat indicator
The BC repeat indicator information element is included if and only if bearer capability 1 IE and bearer capability 2 IE
are both present in the message.
9.3.23.2.2
Facility
The information element may be included for functional operation of supplementary services.
Three different codings of this IE exist, for further details see 04.10.
ETSI
9.3.23.2.3
340
The LLC repeat indicator information element is included if and only if both following conditions hold.
-
If included, the LLC repeat indicator shall specify the same repeat indication as the BC repeat indicator IE.
9.3.23.2.4
The information element is included in the MS-to-network direction when the calling MS wants to pass low layer
compatibility information to the called user.
9.3.23.2.5
Included if and only if the LLC repeat indicator information element is contained in the message.
9.3.23.2.6
The HLC repeat indicator information element is included if and only if both following conditions hold.
-
If included, the HLC repeat indicator shall specify the same repeat indication as the BC repeat indicator IE.
9.3.23.2.7
The information element is included when the calling MS wants to pass high layer compatibility information to the
called user.
9.3.23.2.8
Included if and only if the HLC repeat indicator information element is contained in the message.
9.3.23.2.9
User-user
The information element is included in the calling mobile station to network direction when the calling mobile station
wants to pass user information to the called remote user.
9.3.23.2.10
SS version
This information element shall not be included if the facility information element is not present in this message.
This information element shall be included or excluded as defined in GSM 04.10. This information element should not
be transmitted unless explicitly required by GSM 04.10.
9.3.23.2.11
CLIR suppression
The information element may be included by the MS (see GSM 04.81). If this information element is included the CLIR
invocation IE shall not be included.
9.3.23.2.12
CLIR invocation
The information element may be included by the MS (see GSM 04.81). If this information element is included the CLIR
suppression IE shall not be included.
ETSI
9.3.23.2.13
341
CC Capabilities
This information element may be included by the mobile station to indicate its call control capabilities.
START CC
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Start CC
message type
CC Capabilities
15
9.3.23a.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Call Control Capabilities
10.5.4.5a
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
CC Capabilities
This information element may be included by the mobile station to indicate its call control capabilities
9.3.24
Start DTMF
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network and contains the digit the network should reconvert back into
a DTMF tone which is then applied towards the remote user.
See table 9.71/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
START DTMF
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
2C
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Start DTMF
message type
Keypad facility
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Keypad facility
10.5.4.17
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TV
9.3.25
342
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to indicate the successful initiation of the action requested by
the START DTMF message (conversion of the digit contained in this message into a DTMF tone).
See table 9.72/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Start DTMF acknowledge
message type
Keypad facility
2C
9.3.25.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Keypad facility
10.5.4.17
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TV
Keypad facility
This information element contains the digit corresponding to the DTMF tone that the network applies towards the
remote user.
9.3.26
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station, if the network can not accept the START DTMF message.
See table 9.73/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Start DTMF reject
message type
Cause
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Cause
10.5.4.11
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
3-31
9.3.27
343
Status
This message is sent by the mobile station or the network at any time during a call to report certain error conditions
listed in section 8. It shall also be sent in response to a STATUS ENQUIRY message.
See table 9.74/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
STATUS
Significance:
local
Direction:
both
Table 9.74/GSM 04.08: STATUS message content
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Status
message type
Cause
Call state
24
Auxiliary states
9.3.27.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Cause
10.5.4.11
Call state
10.5.4.6
Auxiliary states
10.5.4.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
3-31
TLV
Auxiliary states
The information element is included if and only if the call state is "active" or "mobile originating modify" and any
auxiliary state is different from "idle". For the definition of the auxiliary states see GSM 04.83 and GSM 04.84
9.3.28
Status enquiry
This message is sent by the mobile station or the network at any time to solicit a STATUS message from the peer layer
3 entity. Sending of STATUS message in response to a STATUS ENQUIRY message is mandatory.
See table 9.75/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
STATUS ENQUIRY
Significance:
local
Direction:
both
Table 9.75/GSM 04.08: STATUS ENQUIRY message content
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Status enquiry
message type
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
9.3.29
344
Stop DTMF
This message is sent by a mobile station to the network and is used to stop the DTMF tone sent towards the remote user.
See table 9.76/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
STOP DTMF
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Stop DTMF
message type
9.3.30
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
This message is sent by the network to the mobile station to indicate that the sending of the DTMF tone has been
stopped.
See table 9.77/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
local
Direction:
IEI
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Stop DTMF acknowledge
message type
9.3.31
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
User information
This message is sent by the mobile station to the network to transfer information to the remote user. This message is
also sent by the network to the mobile station to deliver information transferred from the remote user. This message is
used if the user-to-user transfer is part of an allowed information transfer as defined in GSM 04.10.
See table 9.78/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
USER INFORMATION
Significance:
access
Direction:
both
ETSI
345
Information element
Call control
protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
User Information
message type
User-user
A0
More data
9.3.31.1
Type / Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
User-user
10.5.4.25
More data
10.5.4.19
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
3-131
User-user
Some networks may only support a maximum length of 35 octets. Procedures for interworking are not currently defined
and are for further study.
9.3.31.2
More data
The information element is included by the sending user to indicate that another USER INFORMATION message
pertaining to the same message block will follow.
9.4
9.4.1
Attach request
This message is sent by the MS to the network in order to perform a GPRS or combined GPRS attach. See
table 9.4.1/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
ATTACH REQUEST
Significance:
dual
Direction:
MS to network
ETSI
346
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Attach request message identity
MS network capability
Attach type
GPRS ciphering key sequence
number
DRX parameter
P-TMSI or IMSI
Old routing area identification
MS Radio Access capability
19
17
9-
9.4.1.1
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
MS network capability
10.5.5.12
Attach type
10.5.5.2
Ciphering key sequence number
10.5.1.2
DRX parameter
10.5.5.6
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Routing area identification
10.5.5.15
MS Radio Access capability
10.5.5.12a
P-TMSI signature
10.5.5.8
GPRS Timer
10.5.7.3
TMSI status
10.5.5.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
LV
LV
6-9
LV
6 - 13
TV
TV
TV
This IE is included if a valid P-TMSI and P-TMSI signature are stored in the MS.
9.4.1.2
This IE may be included if the MS wants to indicate a preferred value for the READY timer.
9.4.1.3
TMSI status
This IE shall be included if the MS performs a combined GPRS attach and no valid TMSI is available.
9.4.2
Attach accept
This message is sent by the network to the MS to indicate that the corresponding attach request has been accepted. See
table 9.4.2/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
ATTACH ACCEPT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
network to MS
ETSI
347
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Attach accept message identity
Attach result
Force to standby
Periodic RA update timer
Radio priority for SMS
Spare half octet
Routing area identification
19
P-TMSI signature
17
18
23
MS identity
25
GMM cause
9.4.2.1
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Attach result
10.5.5.1
Force to standby
10.5.5.7
GPRS Timer
10.5.7.3
Radio priority
10.5.7.2
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Routing area identification
10.5.5.15
P-TMSI signature
10.5.5.8
GPRS Timer
10.5.7.3
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
GMM cause
10.5.5.14
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
TV
TV
TLV
TLV
6-7
TV
P-TMSI signature
9.4.2.2
9.4.2.3
Allocated P-TMSI
This IE may be included to assign a P-TMSI to an MS in case of a GPRS or combined GPRS attach.
9.4.2.4
MS identity
This IE may be included to assign or unassign a TMSI to an MS in case of a combined GPRS attach.
9.4.2.5
GMM cause
This IE shall be included when IMSI attach for non-GPRS services was not successful during a combined GPRS attach
procedure.
ETSI
9.4.3
348
Attach complete
This message is sent by the MS to the network if a P-TMSI and/or a TMSI was included within the attach accept
message. See table 9.4.3/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
ATTACH COMPLETE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
MS to network
Table 9.4.3/GSM 04.08: ATTACH COMPLETE message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Attach complete message identity Message type
10.4
9.4.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
Attach reject
This message is sent by the network to the MS to indicate that the corresponding attach request has been rejected. See
table 9.4.4/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
ATTACH REJECT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
network to MS
Table 9.4.4/GSM 04.08: ATTACH REJECT message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Attach reject message identity
GMM cause
9.4.5
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
GMM cause
10.5.5.14
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
Detach request
9.4.5.1
This message is sent by the network to request the release of a GMM context. See table 9.4.5.1/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
DETACH REQUEST
Significance:
dual
Direction:
network to MS
ETSI
349
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Detach request message identity
Detach type
Force to standby
25
GMM cause
9.4.5.1.1
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Detach type
10.5.5.5
Force to standby
10.5.5.7
GMM cause
10.5.5.14
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
TV
GMM cause
This IE shall be included in case the detach reason has to be indicated to the MS, e.g. due to a failed IMEI check.
9.4.5.2
This message is sent by the MS to request the release of a GMM context. See table 9.4.5.2/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
DETACH REQUEST
Significance:
dual
Direction:
MS to network
Table 9.4.5.2/GSM 04.08: DETACH REQUEST message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Detach request message identity
Detach type
Spare half octet
9.4.6
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Detach type
10.5.5.5
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
Detach accept
9.4.6.1
This message is sent by the MS to indicate that the detach procedure has been completed. See table 9.4.6.1/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
DETACH ACCEPT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
MS to network
ETSI
350
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Detach accept message identity
9.4.6.2
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
This message is sent by the network to indicate that the detach procedure has been completed. See
table 9.4.6.2/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
DETACH ACCEPT
Significance:
dual
Direction:
network to MS
Table 9.4.6.2/GSM 04.08: DETACH ACCEPT message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Detach accept message identity
Force to standby
Spare half octet
9.4.7
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Force to standby
10.5.5.7
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
This message is sent by the network to the MS to reallocate a P-TMSI. See table 9.4.7/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
network to MS
ETSI
351
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
P-TMSI reallocation command
message identity
Allocated P-TMSI
Routing area identification
Force to standby
Spare half octet
19
P-TMSI signature
9.4.7.1
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Routing area identification
10.5.5.15
Force to standby
10.5.5.7
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
P-TMSI signature
10.5.5.8
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
1/2
1/2
TV
P-TMSI signature
9.4.8
This message is sent by the MS to the network to indicate that reallocation of a P-TMSI has taken place. See
table 9.4.8/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
MS to network
Table 9.4.8/GSM 04.08: P-TMSI REALLOCATION COMPLETE message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
P-TMSI reallocation complete
message identity
9.4.9
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
This message is sent by the network to the MS to initiate authentication of the MS identity. Additionally, the ciphering
mode is set, indicating whether ciphering will be performed or not. See table 9.4.9/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
network to MS
ETSI
352
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Authentication and ciphering
request message identity
Ciphering algorithm
IMEISV request
Force to standby
A&C reference number
21
9.4.9.1
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Ciphering algorithm
10.5.5.3
IMEISV request
10.5.5.10
Force to standby
10.5.5.7
A&C reference number
10.5.5.19
Authentication parameter RAND
10.5.3.1
Ciphering key sequence number
10.5.1.2
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
TV
17
TV
9.4.9.2
This IE is included if and only if the Authentication parameter RAND is contained in the message.
9.4.10
This message is sent by the MS to the network in response to an Authentication and ciphering request message. See
table 9.4.10/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
MS to network
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Authentication and ciphering
response message identity
A&C reference number
Spare half octet
22
23
IMEISV
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
GPRS message type
10.4
A&C reference number
10.5.5.19
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Authentication parameter SRES
10.5.3.2
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
TV
TLV
11
9.4.10.1
353
This IE is included if authentication was requested within the corresponding authentication and ciphering request
message.
9.4.10.2
IMEISV
This IE is included if requested within the corresponding authentication and ciphering request message.
9.4.11
This message is sent by the network to the MS to indicate that authentication has failed (and that the receiving MS shall
abort all activities). See table 9.4.11/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
network to MS
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Authentication and ciphering
reject message identity
9.4.12
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
Identity request
This message is sent by the network to the MS to request submission of the MS identity according to the specified
identity type. See table 9.4.12/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
IDENTITY REQUEST
Significance:
dual
Direction:
network to MS
Table 9.4.12/GSM 04.08: IDENTITY REQUEST message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Identity request message identity
Identity type
Force to standby
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Identity type 2
10.5.5.9
Force to standby
10.5.5.7
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
9.4.13
354
Identity response
This message is sent by the MS to the network in response to an identity request message providing the requested
identity. See table 9.4.13/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
IDENTITY RESPONSE
Significance:
dual
Direction:
MS to network
Table 9.4.13/GSM 04.08: IDENTITY RESPONSE message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Identity response message
identity
Mobile identity
9.4.14
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
4 - 10
This message is sent by the MS to the network either to request an update of its location file or to request an IMSI
attach for non-GPRS services. See table 9.4.14/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
MS to network
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Routing area update request
message identity
Update type
GPRS ciphering key sequence
number
Old routing area identification
MS Radio Access capability
19
17
27
DRX parameter
9-
TMSI status
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Update type
10.5.5.18
Ciphering key sequence number
10.5.1.2
Routing area identification
10.5.5.15
MS Radio Access capability
10.5.5.12a
P-TMSI signature
10.5.5.8
GPRS Timer
10.5.7.3
DRX parameter
10.5.5.6
TMSI status
10.5.5.4
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
LV
6 - 13
TV
TV
TV
TV
9.4.14.1
355
This IE is included by the MS if it was received from the network in an ATTACH ACCEPT or ROUTING AREA
UPDATE ACCEPT message.
9.4.14.2
This IE may be included if the MS wants to indicate a preferred value for the READY timer.
9.4.14.3
DRX parameter
9.4.14.4
TMSI status
This IE shall be included if the MS performs a combined routing area update and no valid TMSI is available.
9.4.15
This message is sent by the network to the MS to provide the MS with GPRS mobility management related data in
response to a routing area update request message . See table 9.4.15/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
network to MS
Table 9.4.15/GSM 04.08: ROUTING AREA UPDATE ACCEPT message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Routing area update accept
message identity
Force to standby
Update result
Periodic RA update timer
Routing area identification
19
P-TMSI signature
18
Allocated P-TMSI
23
MS identity
26
17
25
GMM cause
9.4.15.1
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Force to standby
10.5.5.7
Update result
10.5.5.17
GPRS Timer
10.5.7.3
Routing area identification
10.5.5.15
P-TMSI signature
10.5.5.8
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Receive N-PDU Number list
10.5.5.11
GPRS Timer
10.5.7.3
GMM cause
10.5.5.14
P-TMSI signature
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
TV
TLV
TLV
TLV
4 - 17
TV
TV
9.4.15.2
356
Allocated P-TMSI
This IE may be included to assign a P-TMSI to an MS in case of a GPRS or combined routing area updating procedure.
9.4.15.3
MS identity
This IE may be included to assign or unassign a TMSI to a MS in case of a combined routing area updating procedure.
9.4.15.4
This IE shall be included in case of an inter SGSN routing area updating, if there are PDP contexts that have been
activated in acknowledged transfer mode.
9.4.15.5
9.4.15.6
GMM cause
This IE shall be included if IMSI attach was not successful for non-GPRS services during a combined GPRS routing
area updating procedure.
9.4.16
This message shall be sent by the MS to the network in response to a routing area update accept message if a P-TMSI
and/or a TMSI has been assigned and/or if there are established LLC connections. See table 9.4.16/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
MS to network
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
26
9.4.16.1
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Receive N-PDU Number list
10.5.5.11
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
4 - 17
This IE shall be included if the routing area update accept message contained this IE.
9.4.17
This message is sent by the network to the MS in order to reject the routing area update procedure. See
table 9.4.17/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
dual
Direction:
network to MS
ETSI
357
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
Routing area update reject
message identity
GMM cause
Force to standby
Spare half octet
9.4.18
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
GMM cause
10.5.5.14
Force to standby
10.5.5.7
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
GMM Status
This message is sent by the MS or by the network at any time to report certain error conditions listed in section 8. See
table 9.4.18/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
GMM STATUS
Significance:
local
Direction:
both
Table 9.4.18/GSM 04.08: GMM STATUS message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
GMM Status message identity
GMM cause
9.4.19
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
GMM cause
10.5.5.14
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
GMM Information
This message is sent by the network at any time to sent certain information to the MS. See table 9.4.19/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
GMM INFORMATION
Significance:
local
Direction:
network to MS
ETSI
358
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Skip indicator
43
45
46
47
48
LSA Identity
9.4.19.1
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Skip indicator
10.3.1
Message type
10.4
Network name
10.5.3.5a
Network name
10.5.3.5a
Time zone
10.5.3.8
Time zone and time
10.5.3.9
LSA Identifier
10.5.3.11
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
3-?
TLV
3-?
TV
TV
TLV
2-5
This IE may be sent by the network. If this IE is sent, the contents of this IE indicate the "full length name of the
network" that the network wishes the mobile station to associate with the MCC and MNC contained in the routing area
identification of the current cell.
9.4.19.2
This IE may be sent by the network. If this IE is sent, the contents of this IE indicate the "abbreviated name of the
network" that the network wishes the mobile station to associate with the MCC and MNC contained in the routing area
identification of the cell the MS is currently in.
9.4.19.3
This IE may be sent by the network. The mobile station should assume that this time zone applies to the routing area of
the cell the MS is currently in.
9.4.19.4
This IE may be sent by the network. The mobile station should assume that this time zone applies to the routing area the
MS is currently in. The mobile station shall not assume that the time information is accurate.
9.4.19.5
LSA Identity
This IE may be sent by the network. The contents of this IE indicate the LSA identity of the serving cell.
9.5
9.5.1
This message is sent by the MS to the network to request activation of a PDP context. See table 9.5.1/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
MS to network
ETSI
359
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Activate PDP context request
message identity
Requested NSAPI
Requested LLC SAPI
Requested QoS
Requested PDP address
28
27
9.5.1.1
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Network service access point identifier
10.5.6.2
LLC service access point identifier
10.5.6.9
Quality of service
10.5.6.5
Packet data protocol address
10.5.6.4
Access point name
10.5.6.1
Protocol configuration options
10.5.6.3
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
LV
3 - 19
TLV
3 - 102
TLV
3 - 253
This IE is included in the message when the MS selects a specific external network to be connected to.
9.5.1.2
This IE is included in the message when the MS provides protocol configuration options for the external PDN.
9.5.2
This message is sent by the network to the MS to acknowledge activation of a PDP context. See table 9.5.2/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
network to MS
Table 9.5.2/GSM 04.08: ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Activate PDP context accept
message identity
Negotiated LLC SAPI
Negotiated QoS
Radio priority
Spare half octet
2B
PDP address
27
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
LLC service access point identifier
10.5.6.9
Quality of service
10.5.6.5
Radio priority
10.5.7.2
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Packet data protocol address
10.5.6.4
Protocol configuration options
10.5.6.3
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
1/2
1/2
TLV
4 - 20
TLV
3 - 253
9.5.2.1
360
PDP address
If the MS did not request a static address in the corresponding ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message, the
network shall include the PDP address IE in this ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message.
If the MS requested a static address in the corresponding ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REQUEST message, the
network shall not include the PDP address IE in this ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message.
9.5.2.2
This IE is included in the message when the network wishes to transmit protocol configuration options for the external
PDN.
9.5.3
This message is sent by the network to the MS to reject activation of a PDP context. See table 9.5.3/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
network to MS
Table 9.5.3/GSM 04.08: ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT REJECT message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Activate PDP context reject
message identity
SM cause
27
9.5.3.1
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
SM Cause
10.5.6.6
Protocol configuration options
10.5.6.3
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
3 - 253
The protocol configuration options IE may only be inserted by the network (see GSM 09.60) if the SM Cause indicates
"activation rejected by GGSN".
9.5.4
This message is sent by the network to the MS to initiate activation of a PDP context. See table 9.5.4/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
network to MS
ETSI
361
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Request PDP context activation
message identity
Offered PDP address
28
9.5.5
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Packet data protocol address
10.5.6.4
Access point name
10.5.6.1
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
3 - 19
TLV
3 102
This message is sent by the MS to the network to reject initiation of a PDP context activation. See
table 9.5.5/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
MS to network
Table 9.5.5/GSM 04.08: REQUEST PDP CONTEXT ACTIVATION REJECT message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Request PDP context act. reject
message identity
SM cause
28
9.5.6
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
SM cause
10.5.6.6
Access point name
10.5.6.1
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
3-102
This message is sent by the network to the MS to request modification of an active PDP context. See
table 9.5.6/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
network to MS
ETSI
362
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Modify PDP context request
message identity
Radio priority
Spare half octet
Requested LLC SAPI
New QoS
9.5.7
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Radio priority
10.5.7.2
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
LLC service access point identifier
10.5.6.9
Quality of service
10.5.6.5
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
LV
This message is sent by the MS to the network to acknowledge the modification of an active PDP context. See
table 9.5.7/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
MS to network
Table 9.5.7/GSM 04.08: MODIFY PDP CONTEXT ACCEPT message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Modify PDP context accept
message identity
9.5.8
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
This message is sent to request deactivation of an active PDP context. See table 9.5.8/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
both
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Deactivate PDP context request
message identity
SM cause
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
SM cause
10.5.6.6
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
9.5.9
363
This message is sent to acknowledge deactivation of the PDP context requested in the corresponding Deactivate PDP
context request message. See table 9.5.9/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
both
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Deactivate PDP context accept
message identity
9.5.10
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
This message is sent by the MS to the network to initiate activation of an AA PDP context. See
table 9.5.10/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
MS to network
28
27
29
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Activate AA PDP context request Message type
message identity
10.4
Requested NSAPI
Network service access point identifier
10.5.6.2
Requested LLC SAPI
LLC service access point identifier
10.5.6.9
Requested QoS
Quality of service
10.5.6. 5
Requested packet data
Packet data protocol address
protocol address
10.5.6.4
Access point name
Access point name
10.5.6.1
Protocol configuration options
Protocol configuration options
10.5.6.3
Requested AA-READY timer
GPRS Timer
value
10.5.7.3
9.5.10.1
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
LV
3 - 19
TLV
3 - 102
TLV
3 - 253
TV
This IE is included in the message when the MS selects a specific external network to be connected to.
ETSI
9.5.10.2
364
This IE is included in the message when the MS provides protocol configuration options for the external PDN.
9.5.10.3
This IE may be included if the MS wants to indicate a preferred value for the AA-READY timer.
9.5.11
This message is sent by the network to the MS to acknowledge the activation of an AA PDP context. See
table 9.5.11/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
network to MS
27
29
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Activate AA PDP context accept
Message type
message identity
10.4
Negotiated LLC SAPI
LLC service access point identifier
10.5.6.9
Negotiated QoS
Quality of service
10.5.6. 5
Allocated P-TMSI
Mobile identity
10.5.1.4
Packet data protocol address
Packet data protocol address
10.5.6.4
Radio priority
Radio priority
10.5.7.2
Spare half octet
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Protocol configuration options
Protocol configuration options
10.5.6.3
Negotiated AA-Ready timer value GPRS Timer
10.5.7.3
9.5.11.1
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
LV
LV
LV
3 - 19
1/2
1/2
TLV
3 - 253
TV
This IE may be included if the network wishes to transmit protocol configuration options from the external PDN.
9.5.11.2
This IE may be included if the network wants to indicate a value for the AA-READY timer.
9.5.12
This message is sent by the network to the MS to reject the activation of an AA PDP context. See
table 9.5.12/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
ETSI
Direction:
365
network to MS
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Activate AA PDP context reject
message identity
SM Cause
27
9.5.12.1
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
SM Cause
10.5.6.6
Protocol configuration options
10.5.6.3
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
TLV
3 - 253
The protocol configuration options IE may only be inserted by the network (see GSM 09.60) if the SM Cause indicates
"activation rejected by GGSN".
9.5.13
This message is sent to request deactivation of an active AA PDP context. See table 9.5.13/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
network to MS
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Deactivate AA PDP context
request message identity
AA deactivation cause
Spare half octet
9.5.14
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
AA deactivation cause
10.5.6.8
Spare half octet
10.5.1.8
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
This message is sent to acknowledge deactivation of an AA PDP context requested by the corresponding Deactivate AA
PDP context request message. See table 9.5.14/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
Significance:
global
Direction:
MS to network
ETSI
366
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
Deactivate AA PDP context
accept message identity
9.5.15
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
SM Status
This message is sent by the network or the MS to pass information on the status of the indicated context and report
certain error conditions (eg. as listed in section 8). See table 9.5.15/GSM 04.08.
Message type:
SM Status
Significance:
local
Direction:
both
Table 9.5.15/GSM 04.08: SM STATUS message content
IEI
Information Element
Protocol discriminator
Transaction identifier
SM Status message identity
SM Cause
Type/Reference
Protocol discriminator
10.2
Transaction identifier
10.3.2
Message type
10.4
SM Cause
10.5.6.6
ETSI
Presence
M
Format
V
Length
1/2
1/2
10
367
The figures and text in this section describe the Information Elements contents.
10.1
Overview
Within the Layer 3 protocols defined in GSM 04.08, every message with the exception of the messages sent on the
BCCH, downlink CCCH, SCH, RACH, and the HANDOVER ACCESS message, is a standard L3 message as defined
in GSM 04.07 [20]. This means that the message consists of the following parts:
a) protocol discriminator;
b) transaction identifier;
c) message type;
d) other information elements, as required.
This organization is illustrated in the example shown in figure 10.1/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|Transaction identifier | Protocol discriminator| octet 1
| or Skip Indicator
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Message type
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Other information elements as required
| etc...
+----- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -----+
Figure 10.1/GSM 04.08: General message organization example
Unless specified otherwise in the message descriptions of section 9, a particular information element shall not be
present more than once in a given message.
The term "default" implies that the value defined shall be used in the absence of any assignment, or that this value
allows negotiation of alternative values in between the two peer entities.
When a field extends over more than one octet, the order of bit values progressively decreases as the octet number
increases. The least significant bit of the field is represented by the lowest numbered bit of the highest numbered octet
of the field.
ETSI
10.2
368
Protocol Discriminator
The Protocol Discriminator (PD) and its use are defined in GSM 04.07 [20]. GSM 04.08 defines the protocols relating
to the PD values:
bits 4 3 2 1
0 0 1 1 Call Control; call related SS messages
0 1 0 1 Mobility Management messages for non-GPRS services
0 1 1 0 Radio Resource management messages
1 0 0 0 Mobility Management messages for GPRS services
1 0 1 0 Session Management messages
except the call related SS procedures, which are defined in GSM 04.10.
10.3
10.3.1
Skip indicator
Bits 5 to 8 of the first octet of every Radio Resource management message and Mobility Management message and
GPRS MobilityManagement message contains the skip indicator. A message received with skip indicator different from
0000 shall be ignored. A message received with skip indicator encoded as 0000 shall not be ignored (unless it is ignored
for other reasons). A protocol entity sending a Radio Resource management message or a Mobility Management
message or a GPRS Mobility Management message shall encode the skip indicator as 0000.
10.3.2
Transaction identifier
Bits 5 to 8 of the first octet of every message belonging to the protocols "Call Control; call related SS messages" and
"Session Management"contain the transaction identifier (TI). The transaction identifier and its use are defined in
GSM 04.07 [20].
10.4
Message Type
The message type IE and its use are defined in GSM 04.07 [20]. Tables 10.3/GSM 04.08, 10.4/GSM 04.08, and
10.4a/GSM 04.08 define the value part of the message type IE used in the Radio Resource management protocol, the
Mobility Management protocol, the Call Control protocol, and Session management protocol.
ETSI
369
Table 10.1/GSM 04.08 (page 1 of 2): Message types for Radio Resource management
+---------------------------------------------------+
| 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
|
|
|
| 0 0 1 1 1 - - - Channel establishment messages: |
|
1 0 0 - RR INITIALISATION REQUEST
|
|
0 1 1 - ADDITIONAL ASSIGNMENT
|
|
1 1 1 - IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
|
|
0 0 1 - IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT EXTENDED |
|
0 1 0 - IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT
|
|
|
| 0 0 1 1 0 - - - Ciphering messages:
|
|
1 0 1 - CIPHERING MODE COMMAND
|
|
0 1 0 - CIPHERING MODE COMPLETE
|
|
|
| 0 0 1 1 0 - - - Configuration change messages:
|
|
0 0 0 - CONFIGURATION CHANGE COMMAND
|
|
0 0 1 - CONFIGURATION CHANGE ACK.
|
|
0 1 1 - CONFIGURATION CHANGE REJECT
|
|
|
| 0 0 1 0 1 - - - Handover messages:
|
|
1 1 0 - ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
|
|
0 0 1 - ASSIGNMENT COMPLETE
|
|
1 1 1 - ASSIGNMENT FAILURE
|
|
0 1 1 - HANDOVER COMMAND
|
|
1 0 0 - HANDOVER COMPLETE
|
|
0 0 0 - HANDOVER FAILURE
|
|
1 0 1 - PHYSICAL INFORMATION
|
|
|
| 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 - RR-CELL CHANGE ORDER
|
| 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 1 - PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
|
|
|
| 0 0 0 0 1 - - - Channel release messages:
|
|
1 0 1 - CHANNEL RELEASE
|
|
0 1 0 - PARTIAL RELEASE
|
|
1 1 1 - PARTIAL RELEASE COMPLETE
|
|
|
| 0 0 1 0 0 - - - Paging and Notification messages:|
|
0 0 1 - PAGING REQUEST TYPE 1
|
|
0 1 0 - PAGING REQUEST TYPE 2
|
|
1 0 0 - PAGING REQUEST TYPE 3
|
|
1 1 1 - PAGING RESPONSE
|
|
0 0 0 - NOTIFICATION/NCH
|
|
1 0 1 - NOTIFICATION/FACCH
|
|
1 1 0 - Reserved (see NOTE)
|
| 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 - Reserved (see NOTE)
|
+---------------------------------------------------+
(continued...)
NOTE:
This value was allocated but never used in earlier phases of the protocol.
ETSI
370
Table 10.1/GSM 04.08 (page 2 of 2): Message types for Radio Resource management
+---------------------------------------------------+
| 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
|
|
|
| 0 0 0 1 1 - - - System information messages:
|
|
0 0 0 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 8
|
|
0 0 1 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 1
|
|
0 1 0 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 2
|
|
0 1 1 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3
|
|
1 0 0 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 4
|
|
1 0 1 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 5
|
|
1 1 0 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 6
|
|
1 1 1 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 7
|
|
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 - - - System information messages:
|
|
0 1 0 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 2bis
|
|
0 1 1 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 2ter
|
|
1 0 1 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 5bis
|
|
1 1 0 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 5ter
|
|
1 0 0 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 9
|
|
0 0 0 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 13
|
|
|
| 0 0 1 1 1 - - - System information messages:
|
|
1 0 1 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 16
|
|
1 1 0 - SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 17
|
|
|
| 0 0 0 1 0 - - - Miscellaneous messages:
|
|
0 0 0 - CHANNEL MODE MODIFY
|
|
0 1 0 - RR STATUS
|
|
1 1 1 - CHANNEL MODE MODIFY ACKNOWLEDGE|
|
1 0 0 - FREQUENCY REDEFINITION
|
|
1 0 1 - MEASUREMENT REPORT
|
|
1 1 0 - CLASSMARK CHANGE
|
|
0 1 1 - CLASSMARK ENQUIRY
|
| 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 - EXTENDED MEASUREMENT REPORT
|
| 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 - EXTENDED MEASUREMENT ORDER
|
| 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 - GPRS SUSPENSION REQUEST
|
|
|
|
VGCS uplink control messages:
|
|
|
| 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 - VGCS UPLINK GRANT
|
| 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 - UPLINK RELEASE
|
| 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 - UPLINK FREE
|
| 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 - UPLINK BUSY
|
| 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 - TALKER INDICATION
|
+---------------------------------------------------+
Bit 8 is reserved for possible future use as an extension bit, see GSM 04.07.
ETSI
371
ETSI
372
Table 10.3/GSM 04.08: Message types for Call Control and call related SS messages
+---------------------------------------------------+
| 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
|
| 0 x 0 0 0 0 0 0 escape to nationally specific
|
|
message types ; see 1) below
|
|
|
| 0 x 0 0 - - - - Call establishment messages:
|
|
0 0 0 1 - ALERTING
|
|
1 0 0 0 - CALL CONFIRMED
|
|
0 0 1 0 - CALL PROCEEDING
|
|
0 1 1 1 - CONNECT
|
|
1 1 1 1 - CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE
|
|
1 1 1 0 - EMERGENCY SETUP
|
|
0 0 1 1 - PROGRESS
|
|
0 1 0 0 - CC-ESTABLISHMENT
|
|
0 1 1 0 - CC-ESTABLISHMENT CONFIRMED
|
|
1 0 1 1 - RECALL
|
|
1 0 0 1 - START CC
|
|
0 1 0 1 - SETUP
|
|
|
| 0 x 0 1 - - - - Call information phase messages: |
|
0 1 1 1 - MODIFY
|
|
1 1 1 1 - MODIFY COMPLETE
|
|
0 0 1 1 - MODIFY REJECT
|
|
0 0 0 0 - USER INFORMATION
|
|
1 0 0 0 - HOLD
|
|
1 0 0 1 - HOLD ACKNOWLEDGE
|
|
1 0 1 0 - HOLD REJECT
|
|
1 1 0 0 - RETRIEVE
|
|
1 1 0 1 - RETRIEVE ACKNOWLEDGE
|
|
1 1 1 0 - RETRIEVE REJECT
|
|
|
| 0 x 1 0 - - - - Call clearing messages:
|
|
0 1 0 1 - DISCONNECT
|
|
1 1 0 1 - RELEASE
|
|
1 0 1 0 - RELEASE COMPLETE
|
|
|
| 0 x 1 1 - - - - Miscellaneous messages:
|
|
1 0 0 1 - CONGESTION CONTROL
|
|
1 1 1 0 - NOTIFY
|
|
1 1 0 1 - STATUS
|
|
0 1 0 0 - STATUS ENQUIRY
|
|
0 1 0 1 - START DTMF
|
|
0 0 0 1 - STOP DTMF
|
|
0 0 1 0 - STOP DTMF ACKNOWLEDGE
|
|
0 1 1 0 - START DTMF ACKNOWLEDGE
|
|
0 1 1 1 - START DTMF REJECT
|
|
1 0 1 0 - FACILITY
|
+---------------------------------------------------+
1):
When used, the message type is defined in the following octet(s), according to the national specification.
Bit 8 is reserved for possible future use as an extension bit, see GSM 04.07.
Bit 7 is reserved for the send sequence number in messages sent from the mobile station. In messages sent from the
network, bit 7 is coded with a "0". See GSM 04.07.
ETSI
373
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
Attach
Attach
Attach
Attach
Detach
Detach
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Routing
Routing
Routing
Routing
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 1 0 0 0 0 1
request
accept
complete
reject
request
accept
area
area
area
area
update
update
update
update
request
accept
complete
reject
GMM status
GMM information
0 1 0 0 0 0 0 1
0 1 0 0 0 0 1 0
0 1 0 0 0 0 1 1
0 1 0 0 0 1 0 0
0 1 0 0 0 1 0 1
0 1 0 0 0 1 1 0
0 1 0 0 0 1 1 1
0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0
0 1 0 0 1 0 0 1
0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0
0 1 0 1 0 0 0 1
0 1 0 1 0 0 1 0
0 1 0 1 0 0 1 1
0 1 0 1 0 1 0 0
0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
SM Status
ETSI
10.5
374
The different formats (V, LV, T, TV, TLV) and the four categories of information elements (type 1, 2, 3, and 4) are
defined in GSM 04.07.
The first octet of an information element in the non-imperative part contains the IEI of the information element. If this
octet does not correspond to an IEI known in the message, the receiver shall determine whether this IE is of type 1 or 2
(i.e. it is an information element of one octet length) or an IE of type 4 (i.e. that the next octet is the length indicator
indicating the length of the remaining of the information element) (see GSM 04.07).
This allows the receiver to jump over unknown information elements and to analyse any following information
elements.
The information elements which are common for at least two of the three protocols Radio Resources management,
Mobility Management and Call Control, are listed in section 10.5.1.
The information elements for the protocols Radio Resources management, Mobility Management and Call Control are
listed in sections 10.5.2, 10.5.3 and 10.5.4 respectively. Default information element identifiers are listed in annex K.
NOTE:
Different information elements may have the same default information element identifier if they belong to
different protocols.
The descriptions of the information element types in sections 10.5.1, 10.5.2, 10.5.3, and 10.5.4 are organized in
alphabetical order of the IE types. Each IE type is described in one subsection.
The subsection may have an introduction:
-
possibly indicating the length that the information element has if it is either type 5 or if it is used in format TV
(type 1 and 3) or TLV (type 4).
possibly the position and length of the IEI. (However it depends on the message in which the IE occurs whether
the IE contains an IEI.);
possibly the position and length of the length indicator. (However it depends on the IE type whether the IE
contains a length indicator or not.);
possibly octet numbers of the octets that compose the IE (see clause a) below).
Finally, the subsection contains tables defining the structure and value range of the fields that compose the IE value
part. The order of appearance for information elements in a message is defined in section 9.
The order of the information elements within the imperative part of messages has been chosen so that information
elements with 1/2 octet of content (type 1) go together in succession. The first type 1 information element occupies bits
1 to 4 of octet N, the second bits 5 to 8 of octet N, the third bits 1 to 4 of octet N + 1 etc. If the number of type 1
information elements is odd then bits 5 to 8 of the last octet occupied by these information elements contains a spare
half octet IE in format V.
Where the description of information elements in this Technical Specification contains bits defined to be "spare bits",
these bits shall set to the indicated value (0 or 1) by the sending side, and their value shall be ignored by the receiving
side. With few exceptions, spare bits are indicated as being set to "0" in GSM 04.08.
The following rules apply for the coding of type 4 information elements:
a) The octet number of an octet (which is defined in the figure of a subsection) consists of a positive integer,
possibly of an additional letter, and possibly of an additional asterisk, see clause f). The positive integer
identifies one octet or a group of octets.
ETSI
375
b) Each octet group is a self contained entity. The internal structure of an octet group may be defined in alternative
ways.
c) An octet group is formed by using some extension mechanism. The preferred extension mechanism is to extend
an octet (N) through the next octet(s) (Na, Nb, etc.) by using bit 8 in each octet as an extension bit.
The bit value "0" indicates that the octet group continues through to the next octet. The bit value "1" indicates
that this octet is the last octet of the group. If one octet (Nb) is present, the preceding octets (N and Na) shall also
be present.
In the format descriptions appearing in section 10.5.1 to 10.5.4, bit 8 is marked "0/1 ext" if another octet follows.
Bit 8 is marked "1 ext" if this is the last octet in the extension domain.
Additional octets may be defined in later versions of the protocols ("1 ext" changed to "0/1 ext") and equipments
shall be prepared to receive such additional octets; the contents of these octets shall be ignored. However the
length indicated in sections 9 and 10 only takes into account this version of the protocols.
d) In addition to the extension mechanism defined above, an octet (N) may be extended through the next octet(s)
(N+1, N+2 etc.) by indications in bits 7-1 (of octet N).
e) The mechanisms in c) and d) may be combined.
f) Optional octets are marked with asterisks (*).
10.5.1
10.5.1.1
The purpose of the Cell Identity information element is to identify a cell within a location area.
The Cell Identity information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.1/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.1/GSM 04.08.
The Cell Identity is a type 3 information element with 3 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Cell Identity IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
CI value
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
CI value (continued)
| octet 3
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.1/GSM 04.08: Cell Identity information element
Table 10.5.1/GSM 04.08: Cell Identity information element
+------------------------------------------------------+
| CI value, Cell identity value (octet 2 and 3)
|
|
|
| In the CI value field bit 8 of octet 2 is the most |
| significant bit and bit 1 of octet 3 the least |
| significant bit.
|
|
|
| The
coding
of
the
cell
identity is the |
| responsibility
of each administration. Coding |
| using full hexadecimal representation may be used. |
| The cell identity consists of 2 octets.
|
|
|
+------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.1.2
The purpose of the Ciphering Key Sequence Number information element is to make it possible for the network to
identify the ciphering key Kc which is stored in the mobile station without invoking the authentication procedure. The
ETSI
376
ciphering key sequence number is allocated by the network and sent with the AUTHENTICATION REQUEST
message to the mobile station where it is stored together with the calculated ciphering key Kc.
The Ciphering Key Sequence Number information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.2/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.2/GSM 04.08.
The ciphering key sequence number is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|Ciphering Key
|
| key sequence
| octet 1
|
|Sequence Number | 0 |
|
|
|
IEI
|spare|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.2/GSM 04.08: Ciphering Key Sequence Number information element
Table 10.5.2/GSM 04.08: Ciphering Key Sequence Number information element
+-------------------------------------------------+
| Key sequence (octet 1)
|
|
|
| Bits
|
| 3 2 1
|
|
|
| 0 0 0
|
| through Possible values for the ciphering key |
| 1 1 0
sequence number
|
|
|
| 1 1 1
No key is available (MS to network);
|
|
Reserved (network to MS)
|
+-------------------------------------------------+
10.5.1.3
The purpose of the Location Area Identification information element is to provide an unambiguous identification of
location areas within the area covered by the GSM system.
The Location Area Identification information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.3/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.3/GSM 04.08.
The Location Area Identification is a type 3 information element with 6 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Location Area Identification IEI
| octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
|
MCC digit 2
|
MCC digit 1
| octet
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
|
|
|
MNC digit 3
|
MCC digit 3
| octet
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
|
|
|
MNC digit 2
|
MNC digit 1
| octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
LAC
| octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
LAC (continued)
| octet
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.3/GSM 04.08: Location Area Identification information element
ETSI
1
2
3
4
5
6
377
ETSI
10.5.1.4
378
Mobile Identity
The purpose of the Mobile Identity information element is to provide either the international mobile subscriber identity,
IMSI, the temporary mobile subscriber identity, TMSI/P-TMSI, the international mobile equipment identity, IMEI or
the international mobile equipment identity together with the software version number, IMEISV.
The IMSI shall not exceed 15 digits, the TMSI/P-TMSI is 4 octets long, and the IMEI is composed of 15 digits, the
IMEISV is 16 digits (see GSM 03.03).
For packet paging the network shall select the mobile identity type with the following priority:
1- P-TMSI: The P-TMSI shall be used if it is available;
2- IMSI: The IMSI shall be used in cases where no P-TMSI is available.
For all other transactions except emergency call establishment, emergency call re-establishment, mobile terminated call
establishment, the identification procedure, the GMM identification procedure, the GMM authentication and ciphering
procedure and the ciphering mode setting procedure, the mobile station and the network shall select the mobile identity
type with the following priority:
1- TMSI: The TMSI shall be used if it is available;
2- IMSI: The IMSI shall be used in cases where no TMSI is available.
For mobile terminated call establishment the mobile station shall select the same mobile identity type as received from
the network in the PAGING REQUEST message.
For emergency call establishment and re-establishment the mobile station shall select the mobile identity type with the
following priority:
1- TMSI: The TMSI shall be used if it is available;
2- IMSI: The IMSI shall be used in cases where no TMSI is available;
3- IMEI: The IMEI shall be used in cases where no SIM is available or the SIM is considered as not valid by the
mobile station or no IMSI or TMSI is available.
In the identification procedure and in the GMM identification procedure the mobile station shall select the mobile
identity type which was requested by the network.
In the ciphering mode setting procedure and in the GMM authentication and ciphering procedure the mobile shall select
the IMEISV.
The Mobile Identity information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.4/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.4/GSM 04.08.
The Mobile Identity is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 3 octet and 11 octets length maximal.
Further restriction on the length may be applied, e.g. number plans.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Mobile Identity IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of mobile identity contents
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|odd/ |
|
|
Identity digit 1
|even | Type of identity|
|
|indic|
|
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
|
|
|
Identity digit p+1 |
Identity digit p
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.4/GSM 04.08: Mobile Identity information element
ETSI
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4*
379
10.5.1.5
This can be used in the case when a fill paging message without any valid identity has to be sent on the
paging subchannel.
The purpose of the Mobile Station Classmark 1 information element is to provide the network with information
concerning aspects of high priority of the mobile station equipment. This affects the manner in which the network
handles the operation of the mobile station. The Mobile Station Classmark information indicates general mobile station
characteristics and it shall therefore, except for fields explicitly indicated, be independent of the frequency band of the
channel it is sent on.
The Mobile Station Classmark 1 information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.5/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.5/GSM 04.08.
The Mobile Station Classmark 1 is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Mobile Station Classmark 1 IEI
|octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0 | Revision | ES | A5/1|
RF power
|
|spare| level
| IND |
|
capability
|octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.5/GSM 04.08: Mobile Station Classmark 1 information element
ETSI
380
10.5.1.6
The purpose of the Mobile Station Classmark 2 information element is to provide the network with information
concerning aspects of both high and low priority of the mobile station equipment. This affects the manner in which the
network handles the operation of the mobile station. The Mobile Station Classmark information indicates general
mobile station characteristics and it shall therefore, except for fields explicitly indicated, be independent of the
frequency band of the channel it is sent on.
The Mobile Station Classmark 2 information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.6/GSM 04.08,
table 10.5.6a/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.6b/GSM 04.08.
The Mobile Station Classmark 2 is a type 4 information element with 5 octets length.
ETSI
381
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Mobile station classmark 2 IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
| Length of mobile station classmark 2 contents |
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 0 | Revision | ES | A5/1|
RF power
|
|spare| level
| IND |
|
capability
|
+-----+-----------------+-----+-----------------|
| 0 | PS | SS Screen.|SM ca|VBS |VGCS | FC |
|spare|capa.| Indicator |pabi.|
|
|
|
+-----+-----------------+-----+-----+-----+-----|
| CM3 | 0 |LCSVA| 0 |SoLSA|CMSP | A5/3| A5/2|
|
|Spare| Cap |spare|
|
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
Owing to backward compatibility problems, bit 8 of octet 4 should not be used unless it is also checked
that the bits 8, 7 and 6 of octet 3 are not "0 0 0".
ETSI
382
ETSI
383
NOTE:
10.5.1.7
Additional mobile station capability information might be obtained by invoking the classmark
interrogation procedure.
The purpose of the Mobile Station Classmark 3 information element is to provide the network with information
concerning aspects of the mobile station. The contents might affect the manner in which the network handles the
operation of the mobile station. The Mobile Station Classmark information indicates general mobile station
characteristics and it shall therefore, except for fields explicitly indicated, be independent of the frequency band of the
channel it is sent on.
ETSI
384
The 14 octet limit is so that the CLASSMARK CHANGE message will fit in one layer 2 frame.
SEMANTIC RULE : a multiband mobile station shall provide information about all frequency bands it can support. A
single band mobile station shall not indicate the band it supports in the Multiband Supported field in the MS
Classmark 3.
SEMANTIC RULE : a mobile station shall include the MS Measurement Capability field if the Multi Slot Class field
contains a value of 19 or greater (see GSM 05.02).
Typically, the number of spare bits at the end is the minimum to reach an octet boundary. The receiver may add any
number of bits set to "0" at the end of the received string if needed for correct decoding.
<Classmark 3 Value part> ::=
<spare bit>
{ <Multiband supported : {000}>
<A5 bits> |
<Multiband supported : { 101 | 110}>
<A5 bits>
<Associated Radio Capability 2 : bit(4)>
<Associated Radio Capability 1 : bit(4)> |
<Multiband supported : {001 | 010 | 100 }>
<A5 bits>
<spare bit>(4)
<Associated Radio Capability 1 : bit(4)> }
{ 0 | 1 <R Support> }
{ 0 | 1 <Multi Slot Capability>}
<UCS2 treatment: bit>
<Extended Measurement Capability : bit>
{ 0 | 1 <MS measurement capability> }
{ 0 | 1 <MS Positioning Method Capability> }
<spare bit>;
<A5 bits> ::= <A5/7 : bit> <A5/6 : bit> <A5/5 : bit> <A5/4 : bit> ;
<R Support>::=
< R-GSM band Associated Radio Capability : bit(3)>;
<Multi Slot Capability> ::=
<Multi Slot Class : bit(5)> ;
< MS Measurement capability > ::=
< SMS_VALUE : bit (4) >
< SM_VALUE : bit (4) >;
< MS Positioning Method Capability > ::=
< MS Positioning Method : bit(5)>;
Figure 10.5.7/GSM 04.08: Mobile Station Classmark 3 information element
ETSI
385
A5/5
0
1
A5/6
0
1
A5/7
0
1
the coding of the power class for P-GSM, E-GSM, R-GSM and DCS 1800 in
radio capability 1 and/or 2 is different to that used in the Mobile
Station Classmark 1 and Mobile Station Classmark 2 information elements.
(continued...)
ETSI
386
(continued)...
ETSI
387
10.5.1.8
This element is used in the description of messages in section 9 when an odd number of half octet type 1 information
elements are used. This element is filled with spare bits set to zero and is placed in bits 5 to 8 of the octet unless
otherwise specified.
10.5.1.9
The purpose of the Descriptive Group or Broadcast Call Reference is to provide information describing a voice group
or broadcast call. The IE of the Descriptive Group or Broadcast Call Reference is composed of the group or broadcast
call reference together with a service flag, an acknowledgement flag, the call priority and the group cipher key number.
The Descriptive Group or Broadcast Call Reference information element is coded as shown in
figure 10.5.8/GSM 04.08 and Table10.5.8/GSM 04.08
The Descriptive Group or Broadcast Call Reference is a type 3 information element with 6 octets length.
ETSI
388
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
| Group or broadcast call reference IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Binary coding of the group or broadcast
|
|
call reference
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| SF | AF | call priority |
+-----------------------+-----------------------+
|
|
Spare
| Ciphering information | 0
0
0
0
+-----------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
ETSI
389
10.5.1.10
The purpose of the Group Cipher Key Number is to provide information on the group cipher key to be used for
ciphering and deciphering by the mobile station.
The Group Cipher Key Number information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.9/GSM 04.08 and
Table10.5.9/GSM 04.08
The Group Cipher Key Number is a type 1 information element with 1 octet length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+------------------------------------------------+
|Group cipher key number|
|
|
IEI
| Group cipher key number|
+------------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.9/GSM 04.08: Group Cipher Key Number
ETSI
390
10.5.1.10a
The purpose of the PD and SAPI information element is to provide information concerning Protocol Discriminators and
Service Access Point Identifiers.
The PD and SAPI information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.10/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.10/GSM 04.08.
The PD and SAPI is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
PD and SAPI IEI
|octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0 | 0 |
SAPI
|
PD
|
|spare|spare|
|
|octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure10.5.10/GSM 04.08:
PD and SAPI information element
Table 10.5.1.10/GSM 04.08: PD and SAPI information element
SAPI: Service Access Point Identifier (octet 2)
Bits
65
0 0 SAPI 0
0 1 reserved
1 0 reserved
1 1 SAPI 3
PD: Protocol Discriminator (octet 2)
bits 4-1
Encoded as specified in section 11.2.1 of 04.07.
10.5.1.11
Priority Level
The purpose of the Priority Level is to provide information defining the priority level requested or applied. The Priority
Level IE may be included in CM_SERVICE_REQUEST, CALL_PROCEEDING and SETUP messages.
The Priority Level information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.11/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.11/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
391
10.5.2
10.5.2.1a
The purpose of the BA Range information element is to provide the mobile station with ARFCN range information
which can be used in the cell selection procedure.
The BA Range information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.12/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.12/GSM 04.08.
The BA Range is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 6 octets. No upper length limit is specified
except for that given by the maximum number of octets in a L3 message (see GSM 04.06).
ETSI
392
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
BA RANGE IEI
|
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Length of BA Range contents
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Number of Ranges
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RANGE1_LOWER (high part)
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|RANGE1_LOWER|
RANGE1_HIGHER
|
| (low part)|
(high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RANGE1_HIGHER
|
RANGE2_LOWER
|
|
(low part)
|
(high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RANGE2_LOWER
|RANGE2_HIGHER|
|
(low part)
| (high part) |
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RANGE2_HIGHER (low part)
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RANGE3_LOWER (high part)
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|RANGE3_LOWER|
RANGE3_HIGHER
|
| (low part)|
(high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RANGE3_HIGHER
|
RANGE4_LOWER
|
|
(low part)
|
(high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RANGE4_LOWER
|RANGE4_HIGHER|
|
(low part)
| (high part) |
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RANGE4_HIGHER (low part)
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
:
:
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.12/GSM 04.08: BA RANGE information element
ETSI
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 7
octet 8
octet 9
octet 10
octet 11
octet 12
octet 13
octet n
393
10.5.2.1b
The purpose of the Cell Channel Description information element is to provide the reference frequency list to be used to
decode the mobile allocation information element.
The Cell Channel Description is a type 3 information element with 17 octets length.
There are several formats for the Cell Channel Description information element, distinguished by the "format indicator"
subfield. Some formats are frequency bit maps, the others use a special encoding scheme.
NOTE:
No more than 64 RF channels should be encoded in the Cell Allocation since this is the maximum
number of RF channels which can be referenced in the Mobile Allocation IE.
ETSI
10.5.2.1b.1
394
General description
Figure 10.5.13/04.08 shows only a special bit numbering. The different general format is described in
table 10.5.13/04.08.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Cell Channel Description IEI
|octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
|
|
| 0 | 0 |
|
|
|
|
| Bit | Bit |spare|spare| Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | octet 2
| 128 | 127 |
|
| 124 | 123 | 122 | 121 |
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | octet 3
| 120 | 119 | 118 | 117 | 116 | 115 | 114 | 113 |
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit |octet 17
| 008 | 007 | 006 | 005 | 004 | 003 | 002 | 001 |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.13/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element (general format)
ETSI
395
Table 10.5.13/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element, general format
+-----------------------------------------------------+
|
|
| FORMAT-ID, Format Identifier (Bit 128 and next)
|
|
|
| The different formats are distinguished by the bits |
| of higher number. The possible values are the
|
| following:
|
|
|
| Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit
format notation
|
| 128 127 124 123 122
|
|
|
|
0
0
X
X
X
bit map 0
|
|
1
0
0
X
X
1024 range
|
|
1
0
1
0
0
512 range
|
|
1
0
1
0
1
256 range
|
|
1
0
1
1
0
128 range
|
|
1
0
1
1
1
variable bit map |
|
|
|
|
| All other combinations are reserved for future use. |
| A GSM900 mobile station which only supports the
|
| primary GSMband P-GSM900 (cf. GSM05.05)
|
| may consider all values except the value for
|
| bit map 0 as reserved.
|
|
|
| The significance of the remaining bits depends on |
| the FORMAT-ID. The different cases are specified in |
| the next sections.
|
|
|
| Mobile stations shall treat all ARFCNs in the set
|
| {0, 1, 2 ... 1023} as valid ARFCN values even if
|
| the mobile station is unable to transmit or receive |
| on that ARFCN.
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.1b.2
Figure 10.5.14/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element, bit map 0 format
ETSI
396
Table 10.5.14/GSM 04.08: Cell channel Description information element, bit map 0 format
+-----------------------------------------------------+
| CA ARFCN N, Cell Allocation Absolute RF Channel |
| Number N (octet 2 etc.)
|
|
|
| For a RF channel with ARFCN = N belonging to the |
| cell allocation the CA ARFCN N bit is coded with a |
| "1"; N = 1, 2, .. , 124.
|
|
|
| For a RF channel with ARFCN = N not belonging to |
| the cell allocation the CA ARFCN N bit is coded |
| with a "0"; N = 1, 2 .. , 124.
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.1b.3
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 7
octet 8
octet 9
octet 10
octet 11
octet 12
octet 13
octet 14
octet 15
octet 16
octet 17
Figure 10.5.15/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element (1024 range format)
ETSI
397
Table 10.5.15/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element, range 1024 format
+---------------------------------------------------------+
|
|
| F0, frequency 0 indicator (octet 2, bit 3):
|
|
|
| 0
ARFCN 0 is not a member of the set
|
| 1
ARFCN 0 is a member of the set
|
|
|
| W(i), i from 1 to 16 (octet 2 to 17):
|
|
|
| Each W(i) encodes a non negative integer in binary
|
| format.
|
|
|
| If W(k) is null, W(k+1) to W(16) must be null also.
|
|
|
| Each non null W(k) allows to compute, together with
|
| some previous W(i) the ARFCN F(k) of a frequency in
|
| the set. The computation formulas are given in section |
| 10.5.2.13.3.
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.1b.4
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 7
octet 8
octet 9
octet 10
octet 11
octet 12
octet 13
octet 14
octet 15
octet 16
octet 17
Figure 10.5.16/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element (512 range format)
ETSI
398
Table 10.5.16/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element, range 512 format
+---------------------------------------------------------+
| ORIG-ARFCN, origin ARFCN (octet 2, 3 and 4)
|
|
|
| This field encodes the ARFCN of one frequency
|
| belonging to the set. This value is also used to
|
| decode the rest of the element.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| W(i), i from 1 to 17 (octet 4 to 17):
|
|
|
| Each W(i) encodes a non negative integer in binary
|
| format.
|
|
|
| If W(k) is null, W(k+1) to W(17) must be null also.
|
|
|
| Each non null W(k) allows to compute, together with
|
| some previous W(i) the ARFCN F(k) of a frequency in
|
| the set. The computation formulas are given in section |
|
10.5.2.13.4.
|
|
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.1b.5
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 7
octet 8
octet 9
octet 10
octet 11
octet 12
octet 13
octet 14
octet 15
octet 16
octet 17
Figure 10.5.17/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element, range 256 format
ETSI
399
Table 10.5.17/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element, range 256 format
+---------------------------------------------------------+
|
ORIG-ARFCN, origin ARFCN (octet 2, 3 and 4)
|
|
|
|
This field encodes the ARFCN of one frequency
|
|
belonging to the set. This value is also used to
|
|
decode the rest of the element.
|
|
|
|
|
|
W(i), i from 1 to 21 (octet 4 to 17):
|
|
|
|
Each W(i) encodes a non negative integer in binary
|
|
format.
|
|
|
|
If W(k) is null, W(k+1) to W(21) must be null also.
|
|
|
|
Each non null W(k) allows to compute, together with
|
|
some previous W(i) the ARFCN F(k) of a frequency in
|
|
the set. The computation formulas are given in
|
|
section 10.5.2.13.5.
|
|
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.1b.6
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Cell Channel Description IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 1
0 | 0 | 0 | 1
1
0 |ORIG-|
| FORMAT-ID |spare|spare|
FORMAT-ID
|ARFCN|
|
|
|
|
| high|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
ORIG-ARFCN
|
|
(middle part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|ORIG-|
|
|ARFCN|
W(1)
|
| low |
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
W(2)
|
W(3)
|
|
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| W(3) (low part)
| W(4) (high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|W(4) |
W(5)
| W(6)
|
|low |
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| W(6) (low part)|
W(7)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
W(8)
|
W(9)
|
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
W(10)
|
W(11)
|
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
W(12)
|
W(13)
|
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
W(14)
|
W(15)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
W(16)
|
W(17)
|
W(18)
|
|
|
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|W(18)|
W(19)
|
W(20)
|W(21)|
|low |
|
|high |
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
W(21)
|
W(22)
|
W(23)
|
|(low part) |
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
W(24)
| W(25)
|
W(26)
|
|
|
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|W(26)|
W(27)
|
W(28)
| 0 |
|low |
|
|spare|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 7
octet 8
octet 9
octet 10
octet 11
octet 12
octet 13
octet 14
octet 15
octet 16
octet 17
Figure 10.5.18/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element, range 128 format
ETSI
400
Table 10.5.18/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element, range 128 format
+---------------------------------------------------------+
|
ORIG-ARFCN, origin ARFCN (octet 2, 3 and 4)
|
|
|
|
This field encodes the ARFCN of one frequency
|
|
belonging to the set. This value is also used to
|
|
decode the rest of the element.
|
|
|
|
|
|
W(i), i from 1 to 28 (octet 4 to 17):
|
|
|
|
Each W(i) encodes a non negative integer in binary
|
|
format.
|
|
|
|
If W(k) is null, W(k+1) to W(28) must be null also.
|
|
|
|
Each non null W(k) allows to compute, together with
|
|
some previous W(i) the ARFCN F(k) of a frequency in
|
|
the set. The computation formulas are given in
|
|
section 10.5.2.13.6.
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.1b.7
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN|octet 17
| 104 | 105 | 106 | 107 | 108 | 109 | 110 | 111 |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.19/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element, variable bit map format
ETSI
401
Table 10.5.19/GSM 04.08: Cell Channel Description information element, variable bit map format
+---------------------------------------------------------+
| ORIG-ARFCN, origin ARFCN (octet 2, 3 and 4)
|
|
|
| This field encodes the ARFCN of one frequency
|
| belonging to the set. This value is also used as
|
| origin of the bit map to generate all other frequencies.|
|
|
| RRFCN N, relative radio frequency channel number N
|
| (octet 4 etc.)
|
|
|
| For a RF channel with ARFCN = (ORIG-ARFCN + N) mod 1024 |
| belonging to the set, RRFCN N bit is coded with a
|
| "1"; N = 1, 2, .. , 111
|
|
|
| For a RF channel with ARFCN = (ORIG-ARFCN + N) mod 1024 |
| not belonging to the set, RRFCN N bit is coded with a
|
| "0"; N = 1, 2, .. , 111
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.1c
BA List Pref
The purpose of the BA List Pref information element is to provide the mobile station with ARFCN information which
can be used in the cell selection/reselection procedure.
The BA List Pref is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 3 octets. No upper length limit is specified
except for that given by the maximum number of octets in a L3 message (see GSM 04.06).
<BA List Pref>::=
<01110101>
<LENGTH OF BA LIST PREF : bit (8)>
{1 <RANGE LIMITS >}**0
{1 <BA FREQ : bit (10)>}**0
<spare padding>;
<RANGE LIMITS>::=
<RANGE LOWER : bit (10)>
<RANGE UPPER : bit (10)>;
The RANGE LOWER is coded as the binary representation of the ARFCN used as the lower limit of a range of
frequencies to be used by the mobile station in cell selection and reselection (see GSM 05.08 and GSM 03.22).
The RANGE HIGHER is coded as the binary representation of the ARFCN used as the higher limit of a range of
frequencies to be used by the mobile station in cell selection and reselection (see GSM 05.08 and GSM 03.22).
BA FREQ is coded as the binary representation of the ARFCN indicating a single frequency to be used by the mobile
station in cell selection and reselection (see GSM 05.08 and GSM 03.22).
10.5.2.2
Cell Description
The purpose of the Cell Description information element is to provide a minimum description of a cell, e.g. to allow the
mobile station to use its pre-knowledge about synchronization.
The Cell Description information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.20/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.20/GSM 04.08.
The Cell Description is a type 3 information element with 3 octets length.
ETSI
402
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Cell Description IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|BCCH ARFCN |
|
|
|(high part)|
|
| octet 2
|
|
NCC
|
BCC
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
| octet 3
|
BCCH ARFCN (low part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.20/GSM 04.08: Cell Description information element
Table 10.5.20/GSM 04.08: Cell Description information element
+------------------------------------------------------+
|
|
| NCC, PLMN colour code (octet 2)
|
| The
NCC
field
is
coded
as
the
binary
|
| representation of the PLMN colour code (see TS.
|
| GSM03.03)
|
|
|
| BCC, BS colour code (octet 2)
|
| The
BCC
field
is
coded
as
the
binary
|
| representation of the BS colour code (see TS.
|
| GSM03.03).
|
|
|
| BCCH ARFCN (octet 2, bits 7 and 8, and octet 3)
|
|
|
| The BCCH ARFCN number field is coded as the
|
| binary
representation
of
the BCCH carriers
|
| absolute RF channel number.
|
|
|
| Range: 0 to 1023
|
|
|
+------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.3
The purpose of the Cell Options (BCCH) information element is to provide a variety of information about a cell.
The Cell Options (BCCH) information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.21/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.21/GSM 04.08.
The Cell Options (BCCH) is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Cell Options (BCCH) IEI
| octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0 |PWRC |
DTX
|
RADIO-LINK-TIMEOUT |
|spare|
|
|
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.21/GSM 04.08: Cell Options (BCCH) information element
10.5.2.3a
The purpose of the Cell Options (SACCH) information element is to provide a variety of information about a cell.
The Cell Options (SACCH) information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.22 /GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.22/GSM 04.08.
The Cell Options (SACCH) is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
ETSI
403
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Cell Options (SACCH) IEI
| octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| DTX |PWRC |
DTX
|
RADIO-LINK-TIMEOUT |
|
|
|
|
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.22/GSM 04.08: Cell Options (SACCH) information element
Table 10.5.21/GSM 04.08: Cell Options (BCCH) information element
+------------------------------------------------------+
| PWRC Power control indicator (octet 2) Note 1
|
| bit 7
|
| 0 PWRC is not set
|
| 1 PWRC is set
|
|
|
| DTX, DTX indicator (octet 2) Note 3
|
| Bit
|
| 6 5
|
| 0 0 The MSs may use uplink discontinuous
|
|
transmission
|
| 0 1 The MSs shall use uplink discontinuous
|
|
transmission
|
| 1 0 The MS shall not use uplink discontinuous
|
|
transmission
|
|
|
| RADIO-LINK_TIMEOUT (octet 2) Note 2
|
|
Bits
|
| 4 3 2 1
|
| 0 0 0 0
4
|
| 0 0 0 1
8
|
| 0 0 1 0
12
|
|
.
|
|
.
|
|
.
|
| 1 1 1 0
60
|
| 1 1 1 1
64
|
+------------------------------------------------------+
NOTE 1: The precise meaning of the PWRC parameter can be found in GSM 05.08.
NOTE 2: The precise meaning of RADIO-LINK-TIMEOUT parameter can be found in GSM 05.08.
NOTE 3: The DTX indicator field is not related to the use of downlink discontinuous transmission.
ETSI
404
10.5.2.4
The purpose of the Cell Selection Parameters information element is to provide a variety of information about a cell.
The Cell Selection Parameters information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.23/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.23/GSM 04.08.
The Cell Selection Parameters information element is a type 3 information element with 3 octets length.
ETSI
405
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Cell Selection Parameters IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
| CELL-RESELECT |
MS-TXPWR-MAX-CCH
| octet 2
|
HYSTERESIS
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| ACS | NECI|
RXLEV-ACCESS-MIN
| octet 3
|
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.23/GSM 04.08: Cell Selection Parameters information element
ETSI
406
10.5.2.4a
The purpose of the MAC Mode and Channel Coding Requested information element is for the mobile station to indicate
to the network which channel coding rate the mobile station desires the network to use on the downlink.
The MAC Mode and Channel Coding Requested information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.24/GSM 04.08
and table 10.5.24/GSM 04.08.
The MAC Mode and Channel Coding Requested is a type 1 information element.
ETSI
407
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+----------------------------------------------+
|
|
MAC Mode and |
MAC 0 |
| octet 1
|
|Chan Cod Req IEI |
mode
|
CS
|
+----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.24/GSM 04.08: MAC Mode and Channel Coding Requested information element
Table 10.5.24/GSM 04.08: MAC Mode and Channel Coding Requested information element
+------------------------------------------------------+
| CS : Coding Scheme
|
| This field indicates to network the channel coding
|
| scheme (see GSM05.03) that the network should use
|
| on the downlink. The field is encoded according to
|
| the following table:
|
| bits
|
| 2 1
|
| 0 0 CS 1
|
| 0 1 CS 2
|
| 1 0 CS 3
|
| 1 1 CS 4
|
|
|
| MAC Mode (bits 3-4, octet 1)
|
| This field is encoded the same as the MAC_MODE field |
| in the PACKET RESOURCE REQUEST message described in |
| GSM 04.60.
|
+------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.5
Channel Description
The purpose of the Channel Description information element is to provide a description of an allocable channel together
with its SACCH.
The Channel Description information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.25/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.25/GSM 04.08.
The Channel Description is a type 3 information element with 4 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Channel Description IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Channel type
|
|
|
and TDMA offset
|
TN
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|H=1->|
MAIO (high part)
|
|
TSC
+- H -+- - - - - --- - - - - -|
|
|
|
| ARFCN
|
|
|
|
0
|
|
|
|H=0->| spare
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
MAIO
|
HSN
|
|(low part) |
|
+- - - - - --- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -|
|
ARFCN (low part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
ETSI
408
ETSI
409
10.5.2.5a
Channel Description 2
The purpose of the Channel Description 2 information element is to provide a description of an allocable channel
configuration together with its SACCH.
The Channel Description 2 information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.26 /GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.26/GSM 04.08.
The Channel Description 2 is a type 3 information element with 4 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Channel Description IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Channel type
|
|
|
and TDMA offset
|
TN
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|H=1->|
MAIO (high part)
|
|
TSC
+- H -+- - - - - --- - - - - -|
|
|
|
| ARFCN
|
|
|
|
0
|
|
|
|H=0->| spare
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
MAIO
|
HSN
|
|(low part) |
|
+- - - - - --- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -|
|
ARFCN (low part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
ETSI
410
ETSI
411
10.5.2.6
Channel Mode
The Channel Mode information element gives information of the mode on coding/decoding and transcoding. The exact
mode is determined by the contents of this IE and the channel type.
The Channel Mode information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.27/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.27/GSM 04.08.
The Channel Mode is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
ETSI
412
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Channel Mode IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Mode
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.27/GSM 04.08: Channel Mode information element
Table 10.5.27/GSM 04.08: Channel Mode information element
+----------------------------------------------------------+
| The mode field is encoded as follows:
|
| (octet 2)
|
| Bits
|
| 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
signalling only
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
speech full rate or half rate version 1|
| 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 1
speech full rate or half rate version 2|
| 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 1
speech full rate or half rate version 3|
| 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1
data, 14.5 kbit/s radio interface rate |
| 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1
data, 12.0 kbit/s radio interface rate |
| 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1
data, 6.0 kbit/s radio interface rate |
| 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1
data, 3.6 kbit/s radio interface rate |
|
|
| Other values are reserved for future use.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| Note 1: The speech full rate or half rate version 3 is
|
|
also referred as the adaptive multi-rate full rate|
|
or half rate speech version 1
|
+----------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.7
Channel Mode 2
The Channel Mode 2 information element gives information of the mode of coding/decoding and transcoding.
The Channel Mode 2 information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.28/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.28/GSM 04.08.
The Channel Mode 2 is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Channel Mode 2 IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Mode
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.28/GSM 04.08: Channel Mode 2 information element
ETSI
413
10.5.2.8
Channel Needed
The purpose of the Channel Needed information element is to indicate to up to two mobile stations which type of
channel is needed (for each mobile station) for the transaction linked to the paging procedure.
The Channel Needed information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.29/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.29/GSM 04.08.
The Channel Needed is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
Channel Needed
| CHANNEL | CHANNEL | octet 1
|
IEI
| (second) | (first) |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.29/GSM 04.08: Channel Needed information element
Table 10.5.29/GSM 04.08: Channel Needed information element
+--------------------------------------------------+
| CHANNEL (octet 1)
|
| Bits
|
| 2/4 1/3
|
| 0
0
Any channel.
|
| 0
1
SDCCH.
|
| 1
0
TCH/F (Full rate).
|
| 1
1
TCH/H or TCH/F (Dual rate).
|
|
|
| If this information element is used for only one |
| mobile station, then the first CHANNEL field is |
| used and the second CHANNEL field is spare.
|
+--------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.8a
The purpose of the Channel Request Description information element is to indicate to the network the type of requested
uplink resources or to indicate the type of paging that is being responded to.
The Channel Request Description information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.30/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.30/GSM 04.08.
The Channel Request Description is a type 3 information element with a length of 6 octets.
ETSI
=0->
MT/MO
=1->
0
414
5
4
3
2
1
Channel Request Description IEI
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
spare
- - - - - - - - - -- - - - - - - --- - -- - - - - - - - - -- - - - - - - --- - - - - - - - - --- - Spare
RLC
LLC
priority
mode
frame
type
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
spare
Requested bandwidth (MSB-Value field)
0
0
0
Spare
Requested bandwidth (LSB-Value field)
0
0
0
Spare
RLC Octet Count (MSB-Value field)
0
0
0
Spare
RLC Octet Count (LSB-Value field)
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
0
octet 4
0
octet 5
0
octet 6
ETSI
415
10.5.2.9
The purpose of the Cipher Mode Setting information element is to indicate whether stream ciphering shall be started or
not and if it is to be started, which algorithm to use.
The Cipher Mode Setting information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.31/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.31/GSM 04.08.
The Cipher Mode Setting is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
|
algorithm
|
| octet 1
|
|Ciph Mod Set IEI |
identifier
| SC |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.31/GSM 04.08: Cipher Mode Setting information element
ETSI
416
10.5.2.10
Cipher Response
The Cipher Response information element is used by the network to indicate to the mobile station which information
the mobile station has to include in the CIPHERING MODE COMPLETE message.
The Cipher Response information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.32/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.32/GSM 04.08.
The Cipher Response is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
| 0
0
0 |
| octet 1
|
|Cipher Resp. IEI |
Spare
| CR |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.32/GSM 04.08: Cipher Response information element
Table 10.5.32/GSM 04.08: Cipher Response information element
+------------------------------------------------------+
| CR Cipher Response (octet 1)
|
| Bit
|
| 1
|
| 0
IMEISV shall not be included
|
| 1
IMEISV shall be included
|
+------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.11
The purpose of the Control Channel Description information element is to provide a variety of information about a cell.
The Control Channel Description information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.33/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.33/GSM 04.08.
The Control Channel Description is a type 3 information element with 4 octets length.
ETSI
417
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Control Channel Description IEI
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0 | ATT |
|
|
|spare|
| BS-AG-BLKS-RES |CCCH-CONF
|
+-----+-----+-----------------+-----------------|
| 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 |
BS-PA-MFRMS
|
|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
T 3212
|
|
time-out value
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
ETSI
418
10.5.2.12
The purpose of the Frequency Channel Sequence information element is to provide the absolute radio frequency
channel numbers used in the mobile hopping sequence. This information element shall only be used for radio frequency
channels in the primary GSM band (see GSM 05.05).
The Frequency Channel Sequence information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.34/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.34/GSM 04.08.
The Frequency Channel Sequence is a type 3 information element with 10 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Frequency Channel Sequence IEI
| octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0 |
Lowest ARFCN
| octet 2
|spare|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| inc skip of ARFCN 01 | inc skip of ARFCN 02 | octet 3
|
|
|
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
:
:
:
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
| inc skip of ARFCN 15 | inc skip of ARFCN 16 |octet 10
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.34/GSM 04.08: Frequency Channel Sequence information element
ETSI
419
10.5.2.13
Frequency List
The purpose of the Frequency List information element is to provide the list of the absolute radio frequency channel
numbers used in a frequency hopping sequence.
The Frequency List information element is a type 4 information element.
There are several formats for the Frequency List information element, distinguished by the "format indicator" subfield.
Some formats are frequency bit maps, the others use a special encoding scheme.
ETSI
10.5.2.13.1
420
General description
Table 10.5.35/GSM 04.08: Frequency List information element, general format
+-----------------------------------------------------+
| FORMAT-ID, Format Identifier (part of octet 3)
|
|
|
| The different formats are distinguished by the
|
| FORMAT-ID field. The possible values are the
|
| following:
|
|
|
| Bit Bit Bit Bit Bit
format notation
|
|
8
7
4
3
2
|
|
|
|
0
0
X
X
X
bit map 0
|
|
1
0
0
X
X
1024 range
|
|
1
0
1
0
0
512 range
|
|
1
0
1
0
1
256 range
|
|
1
0
1
1
0
128 range
|
|
1
0
1
1
1
variable bit map |
|
|
|
|
| All other combinations are reserved for future use. |
| A GSM900 mobile station which only supports the
|
| primary GSMband P-GSM900 (cf. GSM05.05)
|
| may consider all values except the value for
|
| bit map 0 as reserved.
|
|
|
| The significance of the remaining bits depends on
|
| the FORMAT-ID. The different cases are specified in |
| the next sections.
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.13.2
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|ARFCN|ARFCN|ARFCN|ARFCN|ARFCN|ARFCN|ARFCN|ARFCN|octet 18
| 008 | 007 | 006 | 005 | 004 | 003 | 002 | 001 |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.35/GSM 04.08: Frequency List information element, bit map 0 format
ETSI
421
Table 10.5.36/GSM 04.08: Frequency List information element, bit map 0 format
+-----------------------------------------------------+
| ARFCN N, Absolute RF Channel
|
| Number N (octet 3 etc.)
|
|
|
| For a RF channel with ARFCN = N belonging to the |
| frequency list the ARFCN N bit is coded with a
|
| "1"; N = 1, 2, .. , 124.
|
|
|
| For a RF channel with ARFCN = N not belonging to |
| the frequency list the ARFCN N bit is coded
|
| with a "0"; N = 1, 2 .. , 124.
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.13.3
The information element contains a header, and W(1) to W(M) for some M. If, due to octet boundaries, some bits are
not used at the end of the last octet, these bits must be set to 0.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Frequency List IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of Frequency List contents
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 1
0 | 0 | 0 | 0 |
|
|
| FORMAT-ID |spare|spare|FORMA| F0 |
W(1)
|
|
|
|
|T-ID |
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
W(1) (low part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
W(2)
to W(3)
W(4)
to W(7)
W(8)
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
ETSI
422
Table 10.5.37/GSM 04.08: Frequency List information element, range 1024 format
+---------------------------------------------------------+
|
|
| F0, frequency 0 indicator (octet 3, bit 3):
|
|
|
| 0
ARFCN 0 is not a member of the set
|
| 1
ARFCN 0 is a member of the set
|
|
|
| W(i), i from 1 to M (octet 3 and next):
|
|
|
| Each W(i) encodes a non negative integer in binary
|
| format.
|
|
|
| If W(k) is null, W(i) for i>k must be null also.
|
|
|
| Each non null W(k) allows to compute, together with
|
| some previous W(i) the ARFCN F(k) of a frequency in
|
| the set. The first computation formulas are given
|
| hereafter, with the following conventions:
|
|
|
|
Wi denotes W(i);
|
|
Fi denotes F(i);
|
|
+ indicates the natural integer addition;
|
|
* indicates the natural integer multiplication;
|
|
n mod m indicates the remainder of the euclidian
|
|
division of n by m, ie 0 = (n mod m) = m-1 and
|
|
there exists k such that n = (k*m) + (n mod m);
|
|
|
|
n smod m indicates the offset remainder of the
|
|
euclidian division of n by m, ie
|
|
1 = (n smod m) = m and there exists k such that
|
|
n = (k*m) + (n smod m);
|
|
|
|
F1 = W1
|
|
F2 = (W1 - 512 + W2) smod 1023
|
|
F3 = (W1
+ W3) smod 1023
|
|
F4 = (W1 - 512 + (W2 - 256 + W4) smod 511) smod 1023 |
|
F5 = (W1
+ (W3 - 256 + W5) smod 511) smod 1023 |
|
F6 = (W1 - 512 + (W2
+ W6) smod 511) smod 1023 |
|
F7 = (W1
+ (W3
+ W7) smod 511) smod 1023 |
|
F8 = (W1 - 512 + (W2 - 256 + (W4 - 128 + W8 )
|
|
smod 255) smod 511) smod 1023
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
(continued...)
ETSI
423
Table 10.5.37/GSM 04.08 (concluded): Frequency List information element, range 1024 format
+---------------------------------------------------------+
|
F9 = (W1
+ (W3 - 256 + (W5 - 128 + W9 )
|
|
smod 255) smod 511) smod 1023
|
|
F10 = (W1 - 512 + (W2
+ (W6 - 128 + W10)
|
|
smod 255) smod 511) smod 1023
|
|
F11 = (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7 - 128 + W11)
|
|
smod 255) smod 511) smod 1023
|
|
F12 = (W1 - 512 + (W2 - 256 + (W4
+ W12)
|
|
smod 255) smod 511) smod 1023
|
|
F13 = (W1
+ (W3 - 256 + (W5
+ W13)
|
|
smod 255) smod 511) smod 1023
|
|
F14 = (W1 - 512 + (W2
+ (W6
+ W14)
|
|
smod 255) smod 511) smod 1023
|
|
F15 = (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7
+ W15)
|
|
smod 255) smod 511) smod 1023
|
|
F16 = (W1 - 512 + (W2 - 256 + (W4 - 128 +
|
|
(W8 - 64 + W16) smod 127)
|
|
smod 255) smod 511) smod 1023
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
+---------------------------------------------------------+
| More generally, the computation of F(K) can be done
|
| with the following program, using ADA language
|
| (declarative parts are skipped and should be obvious): |
|
|
|
|
| INDEX := K;
|
| J := GREATEST_POWER_OF_2_LESSER_OR_EQUAL_TO(INDEX);
|
| N := W(INDEX);
|
| while INDEX>1 loop
|
|
if 2*INDEX < 3*J then
|
|
INDEX := INDEX - J/2;
-- left child
|
|
N := (N + W(PARENT) - 1024/J - 1) mod
|
|
(2048/J - 1) + 1;
|
|
else
-- right child
|
|
INDEX := INDEX - J;
|
|
N := (N + W(PARENT) - 1) mod (2048/J - 1) + 1;
|
|
end if;
|
|
J := J/2;
|
| end loop;
|
| F(K) := N;
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.13.4
The information element contains a header, and W(1) to W(M) for some M. If, due to octet boundaries, some bits are
not used at the end of the last octet, these bits must be set to 0.
ETSI
424
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Frequency List IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of Frequency List contents
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 1
0 | 0 | 0 | 1
0
0 |ORIG-|
| FORMAT-ID |spare|spare|
FORMAT-ID
|ARFCN|
|
|
|
|
| high|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
ORIG-ARFCN (middle part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|ORIG-|
W(1)
|
|ARFCN|
(high part)
|
| low |
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
W(1)
|
W(2)
|
| (low part)|
(high part)
|
+-----------+-----------------------------------|
W(2)
to W(3)
W(4)
to W(7)
W(8)
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
ETSI
425
Table 10.5.38/GSM 04.08: Frequency List information element, range 512 format
+---------------------------------------------------------+
|
ORIG-ARFCN, origin ARFCN (octet 3, 4 and 5)
|
|
|
|
This field encodes the ARFCN of one frequency
|
|
belonging to the set. This value is also used to
|
|
decode the rest of the element.
|
|
|
|
|
| W(i), i from 1 to M (octet 5 and next):
|
|
|
| Each W(i) encodes a non negative integer in binary
|
| format.
|
|
|
| If W(k) is null, W(i) for i>k must be null also.
|
|
|
| Each non null W(k) allows to compute, together with
|
| some previous W(i) the ARFCN F(k) of a frequency in
|
| the set. The first computation formulas are given
|
| hereafter, with the following conventions:
|
|
|
|
Wi denotes W(i); W0 denotes the value of ORIG-ARFCN
|
|
Fi denotes F(i);
|
|
+ indicates the natural integer addition;
|
|
* indicates the natural integer multiplication;
|
|
n mod m indicates the remainder of the euclidian
|
|
division of n by m, ie 0 = (n mod m) = m-1 and
|
|
there exists k such that n = (k*m) + (n mod m);
|
|
|
|
n smod m indicates the offset remainder of the
|
|
euclidian division of n by m, ie
|
|
1 = (n smod m) = m and there exists k such that
|
|
n = (k*m) + (n smod m);
|
|
|
| F1 = (W0 + W1) mod 1024
|
| F2 = (W0 + (W1 - 256 + W2) smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F3 = (W0 + (W1
+ W3) smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F4 = (W0 + (W1 - 256 + (W2 - 128 + W4) smod 255)
|
|
smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F5 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 128 + W5) smod 255)
|
|
smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F6 = (W0 + (W1 - 256 + (W2
+ W6) smod 255)
|
|
smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F7 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ W7) smod 255)
|
|
smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F8 = (W0 + (W1 - 256 + (W2 - 128 + (W4 - 64 + W8 )
|
|
smod 127) smod 255) smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F9 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 128 + (W5 - 64 + W9 )
|
|
smod 127) smod 255) smod 511) mod 1024
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
(continued...)
ETSI
426
Table 10.5.38/GSM 04.08 (concluded): Frequency List information element, range 512 format
+---------------------------------------------------------+
| F10 = (W0 + (W1 - 256 + (W2
+ (W6 - 64 + W10)
|
|
smod 127) smod 255) smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F11 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7 - 64 + W11)
|
|
smod 127) smod 255) smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F12 = (W0 + (W1 - 256 + (W2 - 128 + (W4
+ W12)
|
|
smod 127) smod 255) smod 511) mod 1024
|
|
|
| F13 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 128 + (W5
+ W13)
|
|
smod 127) smod 255) smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F14 = (W0 + (W1 - 256 + (W2
+ (W6
+ W14)
|
|
smod 127) smod 255) smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F15 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7
+ W15)
|
|
smod 127) smod 255) smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F16 = (W0 + (W1 - 256 + (W2 - 128 + (W4 - 64 +
|
|
(W8 - 32 + W16)
|
|
smod 63) smod 127) smod 255) smod 511) mod 1024
|
| F17 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 128 + (W5 - 64 +
|
|
(W9 - 32 + W17)
|
|
smod 63) smod 127) smod 255) smod 511) mod 1024
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
+---------------------------------------------------------+
| More generally, the computation of F(K) can be done
|
| with the following program, using ADA language
|
| (declarative parts are skipped and should be obvious): |
|
|
|
|
| INDEX := K;
|
| J := GREATEST_POWER_OF_2_LESSER_OR_EQUAL_TO(INDEX);
|
| N := W(INDEX);
|
| while INDEX>1 loop
|
|
if 2*INDEX < 3*J then
-- left child
|
|
INDEX := INDEX - J/2;
|
|
N := (N + W(PARENT) - 512/J - 1) mod
|
|
(1024/J - 1) + 1;
|
|
else
-- right child
|
|
INDEX := INDEX - J;
|
|
N := (N + W(_INDEX) - 1) mod (1024/J - 1) + 1;
|
|
end if;
|
|
J := J/2;
|
| end loop;
|
| F(K) := (W(0) + N) mod 1024;
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.13.5
The information element contains a header, and W(1) to W(M) for some M. If, due to octet boundaries, some bits are
not used at the end of the last octet, these bits must be set to 0.
ETSI
427
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Frequency List IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of Frequency List contents
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 1
0 | 0 | 0 | 1
0
1 |ORIG-|
| FORMAT-ID |spare|spare|
FORMAT-ID
|ARFCN|
|
|
|
|
| high|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
ORIG-ARFCN (middle part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|ORIG-|
W(1)
|
|ARFCN|
(high part)
|
| low |
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
|W(1) |
W(2)
|
|low |
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
W(2)
to W(3)
W(4)
to W(7)
W(8)
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
ETSI
428
Table 10.5.39/GSM 04.08: Frequency List information element, range 256 format
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
|
|
| ORIG-ARFCN, origin ARFCN (octet 3, 4 and 5)
|
|
|
| This field encodes the ARFCN of one frequency belonging to
|
| the set. This value is also used to decode the rest of the
|
| element.
|
|
|
| W(i), i from 1 to M (octet 5 and next):
|
|
|
| Each W(i) encodes a non negative integer in binary format.
|
|
|
| If W(k) is null, W(i) for i>k must be null also.
|
|
|
| Each non null W(k) allows to compute, together with
|
| some previous W(i) the ARFCN F(k) of a frequency in
|
| the set. The first computation formulas are given
|
| hereafter, with the following conventions:
|
|
|
|
Wi denotes W(i); W0 denotes the value of ORIG-ARFCN
|
|
Fi denotes F(i);
|
|
+ indicates the natural integer addition;
|
|
* indicates the natural integer multiplication;
|
|
n mod m indicates the remainder of the euclidian
|
|
division of n by m, ie 0 = (n mod m) = m-1 and
|
|
there exists k such that n = (k*m) + (n mod m);
|
|
|
|
n smod m indicates the offset remainder of the
|
|
euclidian division of n by m, ie
|
|
1 = (n smod m) = m and there exists k such that
|
|
n = (k*m) + (n smod m);
|
|
|
|
|
| F1 = (W0 + W1) mod 1024
|
| F2 = (W0 + (W1 - 128 + W2) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F3 = (W0 + (W1
+ W3) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F4 = (W0 + (W1 - 128 + (W2 - 64 + W4) smod 127) smod 255)
|
|
mod 1024
|
| F5 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 64 + W5) smod 127) smod 255)
|
|
mod 1024
|
| F6 = (W0 + (W1 - 128 + (W2
+ W6) smod 127) smod 255)
|
|
mod 1024
|
| F7 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ W7) smod 127) smod 255)
|
|
mod 1024
|
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
(continued...)
ETSI
429
Table 10.5.39/GSM 04.08 (concluded): Frequency List information element, range 256 format
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
|
|
| F8 = (W0 + (W1 - 128 + (W2 - 64 + (W4 - 32 + W8 ) smod 63) |
|
smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F9 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 64 + (W5 - 32 + W9 ) smod 63) |
|
smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F10 = (W0 + (W1 - 128 + (W2
+ (W6 - 32 + W10) smod 63) |
|
smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F11 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7 - 32 + W11) smod 63) |
|
smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F12 = (W0 + (W1 - 128 + (W2 - 64 + (W4
+ W12) smod 63) |
|
smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F13 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 64 + (W5
+ W13) smod 63) |
|
smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F14 = (W0 + (W1 - 128 + (W2
+ (W6
+ W14) smod 63) |
|
smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F15 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7
+ W15) smod 63) |
|
smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F16 =(W0 + (W1 - 128 + (W2 - 64 + (W4 - 32 + (W8 - 16 + W16)|
|
smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F17 =(W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 64 + (W5 - 32 + (W9 - 16 + W17)|
|
smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F18 =(W0 + (W1 - 128 + (W2
+ (W6 - 32 + (W10 - 16 + W18)|
|
smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F19 =(W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7 - 32 + (W11 - 16 + W19)|
|
smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F20 =(W0 + (W1 - 128 + (W2 - 64 + (W4
+ (W12 - 16 + W20)|
|
smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
| F21 =(W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 64 + (W5
+ (W13 - 16 + W21)|
|
smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) smod 255) mod 1024
|
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
| More generally, the computation of F(K) can be done
|
| with the following program, using ADA language
|
| (declarative parts are skipped and should be obvious):
|
|
|
| INDEX := K;
|
| J := GREATEST_POWER_OF_2_LESSER_OR_EQUAL_TO(INDEX);
|
| N := W(INDEX);
|
| while INDEX>1 loop
|
|
if 2*INDEX < 3*J then
-- left child
|
|
INDEX := INDEX - J/2;
|
|
N := (N + W(INDEX) - 256/J - 1) mod
|
|
(512/J - 1) + 1;
|
|
else
-- right child
|
|
INDEX := INDEX - J;
|
|
N := (N + W(INDEX) - 1) mod (512/J - 1) + 1;
|
|
end if;
|
|
J := J/2;
|
| end loop;
|
| F(K) := (W(0) + N) mod 1024;
|
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.13.6
The information element contains a header, and W(1) to W(M) for some M. If, due to octet boundaries, some bits are
not used at the end of the last octet, these bits must be set to 0.
ETSI
430
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Frequency List IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of Frequency List contents
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 1
0 | 0 | 0 | 1
1
0 |ORIG-|
| FORMAT-ID |spare|spare|
FORMAT-ID
|ARFCN|
|
|
|
|
| high|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
ORIG-ARFCN (middle part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|ORIG-|
W(1)
|
|ARFCN|
(high part)
|
| low |
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
W(2)
to W(3)
W(4)
to W(7)
W(8)
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
ETSI
431
Table 10.5.40/GSM 04.08: Frequency List information element, range 128 format
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
|
|
| ORIG-ARFCN, origin ARFCN (octet 3, 4 and 5)
|
|
|
| This field encodes the ARFCN of one frequency belonging to
|
| the set. This value is also used to decode the rest of the
|
| element.
|
|
|
| W(i), i from 1 to M (octet 5 and next):
|
|
|
| Each W(i) encodes a non negative integer in binary format.
|
|
|
| If W(k) is null, W(i) for i>k must be null also.
|
|
|
| Each non null W(k) allows to compute, together with
|
| some previous W(i) the ARFCN F(k) of a frequency in
|
| the set. The first computation formulas are given
|
| hereafter, with the following conventions:
|
|
|
|
Wi denotes W(i); W0 denotes the value of ORIG-ARFCN
|
|
Fi denotes F(i);
|
|
+ indicates the natural integer addition;
|
|
* indicates the natural integer multiplication;
|
|
n mod m indicates the remainder of the euclidian
|
|
division of n by m, ie 0 = (n mod m) = m-1 and
|
|
there exists k such that n = (k*m) + (n mod m);
|
|
|
|
n smod m indicates the offset remainder of the
|
|
euclidian division of n by m, ie
|
|
1 = (n smod m) = m and there exists k such that
|
|
n = (k*m) + (n smod m);
|
|
|
|
|
| F1 = (W0 + W1) mod 1024
|
| F2 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + W2) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F3 = (W0 + (W1
+ W3) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F4 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2 - 32 + W4) smod 63) smod 127)
|
|
mod 1024
|
| F5 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 32 + W5) smod 63) smod 127)
|
|
mod 1024
|
| F6 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2
+ W6) smod 63) smod 127)
|
|
mod 1024
|
| F7 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ W7) smod 63) smod 127)
|
|
mod 1024
|
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
(continued...)
ETSI
432
Table 10.5.40/GSM 04.08 (concluded): Frequency List information element, range 128 format
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
| F8 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2 - 32 + (W4 - 16 + W8 ) smod 31)
|
|
smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F9 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 32 + (W5 - 16 + W9 ) smod 31) |
|
smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F10 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2
+ (W6 - 16 + W10) smod 31)
|
|
smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F11 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7 - 16 + W11) smod 31) |
|
smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F12 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2 - 32 + (W4
+ W12) smod 31)
|
|
smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F13 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 32 + (W5
+ W13) smod 31) |
|
smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F14 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2
+ (W6
+ W14) smod 31)
|
|
smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F15 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7
+ W15) smod 31) |
|
smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F16 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2 - 32 + (W4 - 16 + (W8 - 8 + W16) |
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F17 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 32 + (W5 - 16 + (W9 - 8 + W17)|
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F18 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2
+ (W6 - 16 + (W10 - 8 + W18) |
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F19 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7 - 16 + (W11 - 8 + W19)|
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F20 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2 - 32 + (W4
+ (W12 - 8 + W20) |
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F21 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 32 + (W5
+ (W13 - 8 + W21)|
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F22 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2
+ (W6
+ W(14 - 8 + W22) |
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F23 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7
+ (W15 - 8 + W23)|
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F24 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2 - 32 + (W4 - 16 + (W8
+ W24)|
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F25 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 32 + (W5 - 16 + (W9
+ W25)|
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F26 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2
+ (W6 - 16 + (W10
+ W26)|
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F27 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3
+ (W7 - 16 + (W11
+ W27)|
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F28 = (W0 + (W1 - 64 + (W2 - 32 + (W4
+ (W12
+ W28 |
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
| F29 = (W0 + (W1
+ (W3 - 32 + (W5
+ (W13
+ W29 |
|
smod 15) smod 31) smod 63) smod 127) mod 1024
|
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
|
|
| More generally, the computation of F(K) can be done
|
| with the following program, using ADA language
|
| (declarative parts are skipped and should be obvious):
|
|
|
|
|
| INDEX := K;
|
| J := GREATEST_POWER_OF_2_LESSER_OR_EQUAL_TO(INDEX);
|
| N := W(INDEX);
|
| while INDEX>1 loop
|
|
if 2*INDEX < 3*J then
-- left child
|
|
INDEX := INDEX - J/2;
|
|
N := (N + W(INDEX) - 128/J - 1) mod
|
|
(256/J - 1) + 1;
|
|
else
-- right child
|
|
INDEX := INDEX - J;
|
|
N := (N + W(INDEX) - 1) mod (256/J - 1) + 1;
|
|
end if;
|
|
J := J/2;
|
| end loop;
|
| F(K) := (W(0) + N) mod 1024;
|
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
ETSI
10.5.2.13.7
433
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN|RRFCN| octet k
|8k-40|8k-39|8k-38|8k-37|8k-36|8k-35|8k-34|8k-33|
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.40/GSM 04.08: Frequency List information element, variable bit map format
Table 10.5.41/GSM 04.08: Frequency List information element, variable bit map format
+---------------------------------------------------------+
| ORIG-ARFCN, origin ARFCN (octet 3, 4 and 5)
|
|
|
| This field encodes the ARFCN of one frequency belonging |
| to the set. This value is also used as origin of the
|
| bit map to generate all the other frequencies.
|
|
|
| RRFCN N, relative radio frequency channel number N
|
| (octet 5 etc.)
|
|
|
| For a RF channel with ARFCN = (ORIG-ARFCN + N) mod 1024 |
| belonging to the set, RRFCN N bit is coded with a
|
| "1"; N = 1, 2, .. , 8M+7 with 1 = M = 127
|
|
|
| For a RF channel with ARFCN = (ORIG-ARFCN + N) mod 1024 |
| not belonging to the set, RRFCN N bit is coded with a
|
| "0"; N = 1, 2, .. , 8M+7 with 1 = M = 127
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.14
The purpose of the Frequency Short List information element is to provide the list of the absolute radio frequency
channel numbers used in a frequency hopping sequence, in a small fixed length information element to obtain when
possible the HANDOVER COMMAND message in a single block.
The Frequency Short List information element is a type 3 information element of 10 octet length.
This element is encoded exactly as the Frequency List information element, except that it has a fixed length instead of a
variable length and does not contain a length indicator and that it shall not be encoded in bitmap 0 format.
10.5.2.14a
The purpose of the Frequency Short List 2 information element is to provide the list of the absolute radio frequency
channel numbers used in a frequency hopping sequence, in a small fixed length information element to obtain the
SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 11 and NOTIFICATION FACCH messages in a single block.
The Frequency Short List information element is a type 3 information element of 8 octet length.
This element is encoded exactly as the Frequency List information element, except that it has a fixed length instead of a
variable length and does not contain a length indicator and that it shall not be encoded in bitmap 0 format.
ETSI
10.5.2.14b
434
The purpose of the Group Channel Description information element is to provide a description of an allocable voice
group call or voice broadcast call channel together with its SACCH and that part of the RF channels belonging to the
cell allocation which is used in the mobile hopping sequence if applicable.
The Group Channel Description information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.41/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.42/GSM 04.08.
The Group Channel Description is a type 4 information element with 4 to 13 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Group Channel Description IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Length of mobile allocation contents
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Channel type
|
|
|
and TDMA offset
|
TN
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|H=1->|
MAIO (high part)
|
|
TSC
+- H -+- - - - - --- - - - - -|
|
|
|
| ARFCN
|
|
|
|
0
|
|
|
|H=0->| spare
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
MAIO
|
HSN
|
|(low part) |
|
+- - - - - --- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -|
|
ARFCN (low part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA |
| C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C |
| 8n |8n-1 |8n-2 |8n-3 |8n-4 |8n-5 |8n-6 |8n-7 |
+-----------------------------------------------|
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
| MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA |
| C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C |octet n+5
| 008 | 007 | 006 | 005 | 004 | 003 | 002 | 001 |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.41/GSM 04.08: Group Channel Description information element
ETSI
435
ETSI
436
ETSI
10.5.2.14c
437
GPRS Resumption
The purpose of the GPRS Resumption information element is to indicate whether the network has successfully resumed
GPRS services or not.
The GPRS Resumption information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.42/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.43/GSM 04.08.
The GPRS Resumption is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
| GPRS resumption |
spare
| ACK | octet 1
|
| IEI
| 0
0
0 |
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.42/GSM 04.08: GPRS Resumption information element
Table 10.5.43/GSM 04.08: GPRS Resumption information element
The ACK field (1 bit) is the binary acknowledge of a successful resumption of GPRS services:
0 resumption of GPRS services not successfully acknowledged;
1 resumption of GPRS services successfully acknowledged.
10.5.2.15
Handover Reference
The purpose of the Handover Reference information element is to provide a handover reference value used for access
identification.
The Handover Reference information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.43/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.44/GSM 04.08.
The Handover Reference is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Handover Reference IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
| octet 2
|
Handover reference value
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.43/GSM 04.08: Handover Reference information element
Table 10.5.44/GSM 04.08: Handover Reference information element
+------------------------------------------------------+
| Handover reference value (octet 2)
|
| The handover reference value field is coded using |
| binary representation.
|
|
|
| Range: 0 to 255.
|
+------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.16
IA Rest Octets
The IA Rest Octets information element contains spare bits and possibly either a packet uplink assignment construction,
a packet downlink assignment construction, a second part packet assignment construction or a frequency parameters,
before time construction.
The frequency parameters, before time construction combines a mobile allocation (see 10.5.2.21) and a MAIO (see the
channel description information element).
ETSI
438
The IA Rest Octets information element is coded according to the syntax specified below and described in
table 10.5.45/GSM 04.08.
The IA Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 1-12 octets length.
<IA Rest Octets> ::=
{ LL
| LH
| HL
< Length of frequency parameters : bit string (6) >
< Frequency Parameters, before time >
| HH
{ 00 < Packet Uplink Assignment >
| 01 < Packet Downlink Assignment >
|1
< Second Part Packet Assignment : null > }
}
<spare padding>;
< Packet Uplink Assignment > ::=
{0|1
< TFI_ASSIGNMENT : bit (5) >
< POLLING : bit >
{0
-- Dynamic Allocation
< USF: bit (3) >
< USF_GRANULARITY : bit >
{ 0 | 1 < P0 : bit (4) >
< PR_MODE : bit (1) > }
|1
-- Fixed Allocation
< ALLOCATION_BITMAP_LENGTH : bit (5) >
< ALLOCATION_BITMAP : bit (n) >
{ 0 | 1 < BTS_PWR_CTRL_MODE : bit (1) > }
< PR_MODE : bit (1) > }
}
< CHANNEL_CODING_COMMAND : bit (2) >
< TLLI_BLOCK_CHANNEL_CODING : bit >
}
{ 0 | 1 < ALPHA : bit (4) >
< GAMMA : bit (5) >
{ 0 | 1 < TIMING_ADVANCE_INDEX : bit (4) > }
{ 0 | 1 < TBF_STARTING_TIME : bit (16) > };
< Packet Downlink Assignment > ::=
< TLLI : bit (32) >
{0|1
< TFI_ASSIGNMENT : bit (5) >
< RLC_MODE : bit >
{0 | 1 < ALPHA : bit (4) >}
< GAMMA : bit (5) >
< POLLING : bit >
< TA_VALID : bit (1) >}
{ 0 | 1 < TIMING_ADVANCE_INDEX : bit (4) > }
{ 0 | 1 < TBF_STARTING_TIME : bit (16) > }
{ 0 | 1 < P0 : bit (4) >
< BTS_PWR_CTRL_MODE : bit (1) > } ;
< PR_MODE : bit (1) > }
< Frequency Parameters, before time > ::=
{ null
-- Length of frequency parameters = 0
| 00
< MAIO : bit string (6) >
< Mobile Allocation : octet (val (Length of frequency parameters) 1)
};
ETSI
439
The TFI_ASSIGNMENT field (5 bit) is the binary representation of the Temporary Flow Identity, see GSM 04.60.
Range: 0 to 31.
The USF field (3 bit) is the binary representation of the uplink state flag, see GSM 04.60. Range: 0 to 7.
The USF_GRANULARITY field (1 bit) indicates the USF granularity to be applied by the mobile station when it is
assigned a TBF using Dynamic Allocation, see GSM 04.60:
0
1
The ALLOCATION_BITMAP_LENGTH field (5 bit) specifies the number of bits in the ALLOCATION_BITMAP.
Range 0 to 31.
The ALLOCATION_BITMAP field (variable length field) represents uplink radio blocks, each bit representing one
radio block. Each bit indicates whether the mobile station is permitted to transmit during the corresponding uplink radio
block. The bitmap describes a one dimensional array of block periods, indexed as follows:
block period[z]
z=n
for n = 0 to L,
where:
L = number of bits in the ALLOCATION_BITMAP - 1;
z = block period relative to TBF_STARTING_TIME;
n = bit number index into the ALLOCATION_BITMAP, range 0 to L;
TBF_STARTING_TIME indicates the first block period of the assigned allocation
The value of each bit is encoded as:
0 block period[n] is not part of the assigned allocation
1 block period[n] is part of the assigned allocation
The CHANNEL_CODING_COMMAND field (2 bit) indicates the coding scheme to be used for transmission, see
GSM 05.03:
00
01
10
11
The TLLI_BLOCK_CHANNEL_CODING field (1 bit) indicates the channel coding to be used for RLC data block
comprising TLLI for contention resolution:
0
1
The ALPHA field (4 bit) is the binary representation of the parameter for MS output power control, see GSM 05.08:
0000
0001
:
1010
= 0.0
= 0.1
:
= 1.0
ETSI
440
The ALPHA field (4 bit) and the GAMMA field (5 bit) are the binary representations of the respective parameters
and CH for MS output power control, see Packet Uplink Assignment construction.
The POLLING field (1 bit) indicates if the MS is being polled for a PACKET CONTROL ACKNOWLEDGEMENT.
0
1
The TA_VALID field (1 bit) indicates the validity of the timing advance value given in the Timing Advance IE.
0
1
The TA_INDEX field (4 bit) is the binary representation of the timing advance index (TAI), see GSM 05.10 and
GSM 04.04. Range: 0 to 15.
The TBF_STARTING_TIME field (16 bit) defines a starting time for the packet downlink assignment. The TBF
starting time is coded using the same coding as the V format of the type 3 information element Starting Time
(10.5.2.38).
Second Part Packet Assignment
The presence of the Second Part Packet Assignment is the indication that this message is the second message of two
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT messages in an assignment of an uplink or downlink Temporary Block Flow (TBF).
Frequency parameters, before time
Length of frequency parameters (octet 2, bits 1 to 6)
This field is coded as the binary representation of the number of octets occupied by the frequency parameters, before
time field. If this length is 0, the frequency parameters, before time is not present.
The MAIO field (octet 3, bits 6 to 1) is coded as the binary representation of the mobile allocation index offset. Range:
0 to 63.
The Mobile Allocation field (octet 3 to k+2) contains a bitmap referring to the Cell Channel Description IE in SI 1
message. The length of the bitmap is 8k, where k = ((NF-1) div 8 + 1) and where NF denotes the number of ARFCNs
contained in the cell channel description. The different bit positions in the mobile allocation bitmap are assigned indices
i = 1 to 8k, starting with i = 8k in the most significant bit position and ending with i = 1 in the least significant bit
position. The bit position with index i corresponds to the i'th frequency in the cell channel description arranged in
ascending order of ARFCN (except that ARFCN = 0, if included, is put last) and numbered from 1 to NF. Each bit
ETSI
441
If NF mod 8 <> 0, then bit positions i = NF+1 to 8k in octet 3 shall each be coded with a "0".
P0 (4 bit field)
For description and encoding, see the Packet Uplink Assignment message.
BTS_PWR_CTRL_MODE (1 bit field)
For description and encoding, see the Packet Uplink Assignment message.
PR_MODE (1 bit field)
For description and encoding, see the Packet Uplink Assignment message.
10.5.2.17
The IAR Rest Octets information element contains only spare bits. Its purpose is to allow the upward compatible
introduction of new information on the AGCH in later phases.
The IAR Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 4 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
IAR Rest Octets IEI
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 1 |
|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
| 0 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 1 |
|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
| 0 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 1 |
|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
10.5.2.18
The IAX Rest Octets information element contains only spare bits only. Its purpose is to allow the upward compatible
introduction of new information on the AGCH in later phases.
The IAX Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 1-5 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
IAX Rest Octets IEI
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 1 |
|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
| 0 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 1 |
|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
.
.
.
.
.
.
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
| 0 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 1 |
|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|spare|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.45/GSM 04.08: IAX Rest Octets information element
ETSI
octet 1
octet 2*
octet 3*
octet n*
10.5.2.19
442
L2 Pseudo Length
The L2 Pseudo Length information element indicates the number of octets following it in the message which are to be
interpreted in the scope of the phase 1 protocol, i.e. the total number of octets (excluding the Rest Octets) for which T,
V, TV, LV, or TLV formatting is used (reference Table 11.1/GSM 04.07).
The L2 Pseudo Length information element is the first part of e.g. SYSTEM INFORMATION messages which are
mentioned as exceptions in section 10.1. It occupies the first octet of such messages.
For any of the SYSTEM INFORMATION messages sent on the BCCH, a mobile station should ignore the contents of
the L2 Pseudo Length value contained in the L2 Pseudo Length information element. For some specific messages,
further requirements are specified in section 9.
The L2 Pseudo Length Information element is an element with 2 octets length:
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
L2 Pseudo Length IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
L2 Pseudo Length value
| 0 | 1 |
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
10.5.2.20
Measurement Results
The purpose of the Measurement Results information element is to provide the results of the measurements made by the
mobile station on the serving cell and the neighbour cells.
The Measurement Results information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.47/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.47/GSM 04.08.
The Measurement Results is a type 3 information element with 17 octets length.
ETSI
443
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Measurement Results IEI
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| BA- | DTX |
RXLEV-FULL-SERVING-CELL
|
| USED|USED |
|
+-----+-----+-----------------------------------|
| 0 |MEAS-|
RXLEV-SUB-SERVING-CELL
|
|spare|VALID|
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0 |
|
| NO- |
|spare|
|
|NCELL|
|
|
RXQUAL-FULL
|
RXQUAL-SUB
| M |
|
|
SERVING-CELL |
SERVING-CELL |(high|
|
|
|
|part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|NO-NCELL-M |
|
|(low part) |
RXLEV-NCELL 1
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
BCCH-FREQ-NCELL 1
| BSIC-NCELL 1
|
|
| (high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| BSIC-NCELL 1
|
RXLEV-NCELL 2
|
|
(low part)
|
(high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|RXLEV|
|
|
|NCELL|
|BSIC-NCELL |
| 2 |
BCCH-FREQ-NCELL 2
|
2
|
|(low |
|(high part)|
|part)|
|
|
+-----+-----------------------------+-----------|
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 7
octet 8
(continued..)
Figure 10.5.47/GSM 04.08: Measurement Results information element
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
BSIC-NCELL 2
|
RXLEV-NCELL 3
|
|
(low part)
|
(high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| RXLEV|
|BSIC-|
| NCELL 3 |
|NCELL|
|
|
BCCH-FREQ-NCELL 3
| 3 |
| (low part)|
|(high|
|
|
|part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
BSIC-NCELL 3
| RXLEV-NCELL 4 |
|
(low part)
|
(high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| RXLEV-NCELL 4 |
BCCH-FREQ-NCELL 4
|
|
(low part)
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|RXLEV-NCELL|
|
BSIC-NCELL 4
|
5
|
|
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RXLEV-NCELL 5
|
BCCH-FREQ-NCELL 5
|
|
(low part)
|
(high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|BCCH-|
|RXLEV|
|FREQ-|
|NCELL|
|NCELL|
BSIC-NCELL 5
| 6 |
|5(low|
|(high|
|part)|
|part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RXLEV-NCELL 6
|BCCH-FREQ-NCELL 6|
|
(low part)
|
(high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|BCCH-FREQ- |
|
| NCELL 6 |
BSIC-NCELL 6
|
|(low part) |
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 9
octet 10
octet 11
octet 12
octet 13
octet 14
octet 15
octet 16
octet 17
ETSI
444
(continued...)
ETSI
445
001
1 "
"
"
"
010
2 "
"
"
"
011
3 "
"
"
"
100
4 "
"
"
"
101
5 "
"
"
"
110
6 "
"
"
"
111
(continued...)
ETSI
446
10.5.2.20a
The purpose of the GPRS Measurement Results information element is to provide the results of the GPRS
measurements made by the GPRS mobile station on the serving cell.
The GPRS Measurement Results information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.48/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.48/GSM 04.08.
The GPRS Measurement Results is a type 3 information element with 3 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
GPRS Measurement Results IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
C_VALUE
|
RXQUAL | octet 2
|
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|RXQ-L| 0 |
SIGN_VAR
| octet 3
|(low)|spare|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.48/GSM 04.08: GPRS Measurement Results information element
ETSI
447
10.5.2.21
Mobile Allocation
The purpose of the Mobile Allocation information element is to provide that part of the RF channels belonging to the
cell allocation (coded with a "1" in the cell channel description information element) which is used in the mobile
hopping sequence.
The Mobile Allocation information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.49/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.49/GSM 04.08.
The Mobile Allocation is a type 4 information element with 3 to 10 octets length except for the cases specified in
subclauses 9.1.18.1 and 9.1.19.2.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Mobile Allocation IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
| octet 2
|
Length of mobile allocation contents
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA |
| C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | octet 3
| 8n |8n-1 |8n-2 |8n-3 |8n-4 |8n-5 |8n-6 |8n-7 |
+-----------------------------------------------|
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
| MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA | MA |
| C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | octet n+2
| 008 | 007 | 006 | 005 | 004 | 003 | 002 | 001 |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.49/GSM 04.08: Mobile Allocation information element
ETSI
448
10.5.2.21a
A Mobile Time Difference information element encodes a time related to the synchronization difference between the
time bases of two base stations. This type of information is used in conjunction with the HANDOVER COMPLETE
message.
The Mobile Time Difference information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.50/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.50/GSM 04.08.
The Mobile Time Difference information element is a type 4 information element with 5 octets length.
8
5
4
3
Mobile Time Difference IEI
Length of Mobile Time difference contents
Mobile Time Difference value (high)
Mobile Time Difference value (contd)
Mobile Time Difference value (low)
0
spare
0
spare
0
spare
Octet 1
Octet 2
Octet 3
Octet 4
Octet 5
ETSI
449
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
Multirate speech configuration IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Length
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
MR version
|spare|ICMI |spare| Start mode|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Parameters for multirate speech
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet n
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 7
ETSI
450
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
|
Set of AMR codec modes
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Spare
|
|
| 0
0 |
Threshold 1
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
|
Hysteresis 1
|
Threshold 2
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| Threshold |
|Threshold 3 |
| 2 (cont.)| Hysteresis 2
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
|
Threshold (3)
|
Hysteresis 3
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 7
octet 8
Spare
Bit 4
1
Bit
3
0
Bits
21
Spare
Start Mode,
The initial codec mode is coded as in GSM 05.09 section
3.4.1
ETSI
451
10.5.2.21b
Multislot Allocation
The purpose of the Multislot Allocation information element is to provide a description of which channels are used in
downlink and uplink respectively, in a multislot configuration. It also groups the channels into channel sets, the channel
mode for each channel set can be defined by a separate information element.
The Multislot Allocation information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.51/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.51/GSM 04.08.
The multislot allocation information element is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 3 octets and a
maximum length of 12 octets.
ETSI
452
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Multislot alloction IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
| Length of the multislot allocation contents | octet 2
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
| 0/1 | DA | DA | DA | DA | DA | DA | DA | octet 3
| ext | 7 |
6 |
5 |
4 |
3 |
2 |
1 |
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
| 1 | UA | UA | UA | UA | UA | UA | UA | octet 3a*
| ext | 7 |
6 |
5 |
4 |
3 |
2 |
1 |
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Channel set 1
| octet 4*
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Channel set 2
|octet 5*
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
:
:
:
:
|
Channel set 8
| octet 11*
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.51/GSM 04.08: Multislot Allocation information element
ETSI
453
10.5.2.21c
NC mode
The purpose of the NC mode information element is for the network to inform the mobile station of the NC mode to be
implemented on the target cell.
The NC mode information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.52/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.52/GSM 04.08.
The NC mode is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+----------------------------------------------+
|
|
| 0
0 |
| octet 1
|
|
NC mode IEI |
spare
| NC mode |
+----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.52 /GSM 04.08: NC mode information element
ETSI
454
10.5.2.22
The purpose of the Neighbour Cells Description information element is to provide the absolute radio frequency channel
numbers of the BCCH carriers to be monitored by the mobile stations in the cell.
The Neighbour Cells Description information element is coded as the Cell Channel Description information element, as
specified in section 10.5.2.1b, with the exception of bits 5 and 6 of octet 2. figure 10.5.53/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.53/GSM 04.08 contains the difference of specifications.
The Neighbour Cells Description information element is a type 3 information element with 17 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Neighbour Cells Description IEI
| octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
|
|
| EXT-| BA- |
|
|
|
|
| Bit | Bit | IND | IND | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | octet 2
| 128 | 127 |
|
| 124 | 123 | 122 | 121 |
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | octet 3
| 120 | 119 | 118 | 117 | 116 | 115 | 114 | 113 |
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit |octet 17
| 008 | 007 | 006 | 005 | 004 | 003 | 002 | 001 |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.53/GSM 04.08: Neighbour Cells Description information element
ETSI
455
10.5.2.22a
The purpose of the Neighbour Cells Description 2 information element is to provide the absolute radio frequency
channel numbers of the BCCH carriers to be monitored by the mobile stations in the cell.
The Neighbour Cells Description 2 information element is coded as the Cell Channel Description information element,
as specified in section 10.5.2.1b, with the exception of bits 5 to 7 of octet 2. figure 10.5.54/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.54/GSM 04.08 contains the difference of specifications.
The Neighbour Cells Description 2 information element is a type 3 information element with 17 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Neighbour Cells Description IEI
| octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
|
| Multiband | BA |
|
|
|
|
| Bit | reporting | IND | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | octet 2
| 128 |
|
|
| 124 | 123 | 122 | 121 |
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | octet 3
| 120 | 119 | 118 | 117 | 116 | 115 | 114 | 113 |
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit |octet 17
| 008 | 007 | 006 | 005 | 004 | 003 | 002 | 001 |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.54/GSM 04.08: Neighbour Cells Description 2 information element
ETSI
456
format notation
bit map 0
1024 range
512 range
256 range
128 range
variable bit map
10.5.2.22b
Spare
10.5.2.22c
ETSI
10.5.2.23
457
P1 Rest Octets
The P1 Rest Octets information element contains information about the status of information on an existing NCH,
priority levels and packet page indications applied for mobile station identities and spare bits.
The P1 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 1-18 octets length.
<P1 Rest Octets> ::=
{L I H <NLN(PCH) : bit (2)> <NLN status : bit>}
{L I H <Priority1 ::= Priority>}
{L I H <Priority2 ::= Priority>}
{L | H <Group Call information>}
< Packet Page Indication 1 : {L | H} >
< Packet Page Indication 2 : {L | H} >
<spare padding>;
<Priority> ::= <bit (3)>;
<Group Call information>
See clause 9.1.21a
NOTE 1: The value 17h shall not be used as a value of the first octet when this information element is used in the
PAGING REQUEST TYPE 1 message. This will prevent mobile stations misinterpreting this information
as the Mobile Identity IEI.
Table 10.5.55/GSM 04.08: P1 Rest Octets information element
NLN(PCH) Notification List Number
The presence of the NLN(PCH) field indicates that if an NCH is present, reduced NCH monitoring can be used, and
gives the NLN(PCH) value, to be used as specified in 3.3.3.
Priority: Priority i relates to Mobile Station Identity i (i = 1, 2)
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
no priority applied
call priority level 4
call priority level 3
call priority level 2
call priority level 1
call priority level 0
call priority level B
call priority level A
The Packet Page Indication i field relates to Mobile Station Identity i (i = 1, 2) and indicates the kind of paging
procedure associated with the mobile station identity. If the identity is not IMSI the Packet Page Indication has no
meaning and is ignored.
L
H
10.5.2.24
P2 Rest Octets
The P2 Rest Octets information element contains information on the channel needed by the network and information
about the status of information on an existing NCH, priority levels and packet page indications applied for mobile
station identities and spare bits.
The P2 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 2-12 octets length.
ETSI
458
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
no priority applied
call priority level 4
call priority level 3
call priority level 2
call priority level 1
call priority level 0
call priority level B
call priority level A
The Packet Page Indication 3 field relates to Mobile Station Identity 3 and indicates the kind of paging procedure
associated with the mobile station identity. If the identity is not IMSI the Packet Page Indication has no meaning and is
ignored.
L
H
10.5.2.25
P3 Rest Octets
The P3 Rest Octets information element contains information on the channel needed by the network and information
about the status of information on an existing NCH, priority levels applied for mobile station identities and spare bits.
The purpose of the spare bits is to allow the upward compatible introduction of new information on the PCH in later
phases.
The P3 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 4 octets length.
ETSI
459
10.5.2.25a
The purpose of the Packet Channel Description information element is to provide a description of a packet data
physical channel (PDCH).
The Packet Channel Description information element is coded according to the syntax specified below and described in
table 10.58/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
460
The Packet Channel Description is a type 3 information element with 4 octets length.
< Packet Channel Description > ::=
< Channel type : bit (5) >
< TN : bit (3) >
< TSC : bit (3) >
{0
{ 0 < spare bit >
< ARFCN : bit (10) >
-- non-hopping RF channel configuraion
| 1 < spare bit >
< MAIO : bit (6) >
-- indirect encoding of hopping RF channel configuration
< MA_NUMBER_IND : bit >
{ 0 | 1 < CHANGE_MARK_1 : bit (2) > } }
|1
< MAIO : bit (6) >
-- direct encoding of hopping RF channel configuration
< HSN : bit (6) >
};
MA_NUMBER = 14
MA_NUMBER = 15
The CHANGE_MARK_1 field (2 bit) is the binary representation of the allowed value of the SI change mark
associated with the GPRS mobile allocation to which the MA_NUMBER refers. Range: 0 to 3.
If the indirect encoding is used, this information element may contain the CHANGE_MARK_1 field. If that is present,
the mobile station being assigned the TBF shall verify the validity of the SI change mark associated with the GPRS
mobile allocation to which this information element refers, see GSM 04.60. The CHANGE_MARK_1 field shall not be
included in this information element if MA_NUMBER = 15 is used.
Direct encoding of hopping RF channel configuration
The MAIO field (6 bit) is the binary representation of the mobile allocation index offset, see GSM 05.02.
Range: 0 to 63.
The HSN field (6 bit) is the binary representation of the hopping sequence number, see GSM 05.02. Range: 0 to 63.
ETSI
10.5.2.25b
461
The Dedicated mode or TBF information element is used by the network to indicate to the mobile station whether the
rest of the message shall be decoded as an IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message allocating a channel in dedicated
mode or whether the rest of the message shall be decoded as the allocation of a Temporary Block Flow.
This IE also indicates:
-
whether the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message relates to a downlink TBF for a mobile station in packet
idle mode; and
whether the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message is the first message of two IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
messages in a two-message assignment of an uplink or downlink TBF.
The Dedicated mode or TBF information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.55/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.59/GSM 04.08.
The Dedicated mode or TBF is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
| Dedicated mode |spare|
|down-|
|
|
| or TBF IEI
| 0 | TMA |link | T/D|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
10.5.2.25c
The RR Packet Uplink Assignment information element is sent by the network to the mobile station to indicate the
assigned uplink resources.
The RR Packet Uplink Assignment information element is coded as shown in tables 10.5.60/GSM 04.08 and
10.5.61/GSM 04.08.
The RR Packet Uplink Assignment is a type 4 information element.
Table 10.5.60: RR PACKET UPLINK ASSIGNMENT information element
< RR Packet Uplink Assignment message content > ::=
ETSI
462
ETSI
463
Editors note: This IE has a number of differences to the contents of the PACKET UPLINK ASSIGNMENT message
described in GSM 04.60:
- the PAGE_MODE is not included because this IE is sent on a DCCH, not on
the PCH/AGCH;
- the Referenced Address is not included because this IE is sent in a dedicated
mode message and hence has only one intended recipient;
- the CONTENTION_RESOLUTION_TLLI is not included because this IE is
sent after dedicated mode contention resolution;
- the GSM 04.60 Frequency Parameters are not included because the dedicated
mode message(s) carry this information in other information elements
(eg Mobile Allocation);
- the TBF_STARTING_TIME is not included because it duplicates the
information in the Starting Time IE;
- the ALLOCATION_REFERENCE is not included because this IE is in a
message sent in dedicated mode using a reliable data link.
ETSI
464
ETSI
465
4321
0 0 0 0 = 0.0
0 0 0 1 = 0.1
: : :
1 0 0 1 = 0.9
1 0 1 0 = 1.0
All other values are reserved.
TIMESLOT_NUMBER (3 bit field)
If present, this field is encoded as the TIMESLOT_NUMBER field in the PACKET UPLINK ASSIGNMENT message
in GSM 04.60.
GAMMA_TN (5 bit field)
The GAMMA_TN field is the binary representation of the parameter CH for MS output power control in units of 2 dB,
see GSM 05.08.
P0 and BTS_PWR_CTRL_MODE fields
These fields are optional downlink power control parameters and are encoded as in the PACKET UPLINK
ASSIGNMENT message in GSM 04.60.
Fixed Allocation struct
This information element contains parameters necessary to define the radio resources of a fixed allocation.
FINAL_ALLOCATION (1 bit field)
This field indicates whether this allocation is the last allocation of the TBF.
0 this allocation is not the last allocation of the TBF
1 this allocation is the last allocation of the TBF
DOWNLINK_CONTROL_TIMESLOT (3 bit field)
This information field indicates the downlink timeslot that mobile station operating in fixed allocation mode shall
monitor for downlink PACCH. This field is coded as the binary representation of the timeslot number as defined in
GSM 05.10.
Range 0 to 7
HALF_DUPLEX_MODE (1 bit field)
This information field indicates, for multislot class 19 to 29, whether the mobile station shall operate in half duplex
mode.
Bit
0
1
10.5.2.25d
The RR Packet Downlink Assignment information element is sent by the network to the mobile station to indicate the
assigned downlink resources.
ETSI
466
The RR Packet Downlink Assignment information element is coded as shown in tables 10.5.62/GSM 04.08 and
10.5.63/GSM 04.08.
The RR Packet Downlink Assignment is a type 4 information element.
For a mobile station assigned to operate in the fixed allocation MAC mode, the network may assign regularly repeating
intervals during which the mobile station shall measure neighbour cell power levels.
Table 10.5.62: RR PACKET DOWNLINK ASSIGNMENT information element
< RR Packet Downlink Assignment IE > ::=
< LENGTH_IN_OCTETS : bit (8) >
< MAC_MODE : bit (2) >
< RLC_MODE : bit (1) >
< TIMESLOT_ALLOCATION : bit (8) >
< Packet Timing Advance : Packet Timing Advance IE >
{ 0 | 1 < P0 : bit (4) >
< BTS_PWR_CTRL_MODE : bit(1) > }
{ 0 | 1 < Power Control Parameters : Power Control Parameters IE > }
{ 0 | 1 < DOWNLINK_TFI_ASSIGNMENT: bit (5) > }
{ 0 | 1 < MEASUREMENT_STARTING_TIME : bit (16) >
< MEASUREMENT_INTERVAL : bit (5) >
< MEASUREMENT_BITMAP : bit (8) > }
< N_SPARE_BITS : bit (N) > ;
Editors note: This IE has a number of differences to the contents of the PACKET DOWNLINK ASSIGNMENT
message described in GSM 04.60:
- the PAGE_MODE is not included because this IE is sent on a DCCH not on the
PCH/AGCH;
- Referenced Address is not included because this IE is sent in a dedicated
mode message and hence has only one intended recipient.
- the GSM 04.60 Frequency Parameters are not included because the dedicated
mode message(s) carry this information in other information elements
(eg Mobile Allocation);
- the TBF_STARTING_TIME is not included because it duplicates the
information in the Starting Time IE.
Table 10.5.63: RR PACKET DOWNLINK ASSIGNMENT information element details
LENGTH_IN_OCTETS (8 bit field)
This field encodes (in binary) the number that is equal to one eighth of the number of bits in the RR Packet Downlink
Assignment information element that follow the end of this field.
MAC_MODE (2 bit field)
This field is encoded as the MAC_MODE information field in the PACKET DOWNLINK ASSIGNMENT message in
GSM 04.60.
RLC_MODE (1 bit field)
This field is encoded as the RLC_MODE field in the PACKET DOWNLINK ASSIGNMENT message in GSM 04.60.
TIMESLOT_ALLOCATION (8 bit field)
This field is encoded as the TIMESLOT_ALLOCATION field in the PACKET DOWNLINK ASSIGNMENT message
in GSM 04.60.
Packet Timing Advance IE
This field is encoded as the Packet Timing Advance IE in the PACKET DOWNLINK ASSIGNMENT message in GSM
04.60.
P0 and BTS_PWR_CTRL_MODE fields
ETSI
467
These fields are optional downlink power control parameters and are encoded as in the PACKET UPLINK
ASSIGNMENT message in GSM 04.60.
Power Control Parameters IE
This field is encoded as the Power Control Parameters IE in the PACKET DOWNLINK ASSIGNMENT message in
GSM 04.60.
DOWNLINK_TFI_ASSIGNMENT (5 bit field)
If present, this field is encoded as the DOWNLINK_TFI_ASSIGNMENT information element in the PACKET
DOWNLINK ASSIGNMENT message in GSM 04.60.
MEAUREMENT_STARTING_TIME (16 bit field)
If present, this field is encoded as the MEASUREMENT_STARTING_TIME field in the PACKET DOWNLINK
ASSIGNMENT message in GSM 04.60.
MEASUREMENT_BITMAP (8 bit field)
If present, this field is encoded as the MEASUREMENT BITMAP information field in the PACKET DOWNLINK
ASSIGNMENT message in GSM 04.60.
MEASUREMENT_INTERVAL (5 bit field)
If present, this field is encoded as the MEASUREMENT_INTERVAL field in the PACKET DOWNLINK
ASSIGNMENT message in GSM 04.60.
N_SPARE_BITS (N bit field)
This field contains N spare bits. 0=< N< 8. The sender shall set the spare bits are set to 0. The receiver shall ignore the
value of these bits. N is chosen so that the RR Packet Downlink Assignment IE contains an integer number of octets.
10.5.2.26
Page Mode
The purpose of the Page Mode information element is to control the action of the mobile station belonging to the paging
subgroup corresponding to the paging subchannel.
The Page Mode information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.56/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.64/GSM 04.08.
The Page Mode is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
| 0 | 0 |
| octet 1
|
| Page Mode IEI |spare|spare|
PM
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.56/GSM 04.08: Page Mode information element
ETSI
468
10.5.2.26a
Spare
10.5.2.26b
Spare
10.5.2.26c
Spare
10.5.2.26d
Spare
10.5.2.27
NCC Permitted
The purpose of the NCC Permitted information element is to provide a definition of the allowed NCCs on the BCCH
carriers to be reported in the MEASUREMENT REPORT message by the mobile stations in the cell.
The NCC Permitted information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.57/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.65/GSM 04.08.
The NCC Permitted is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
NCC Permitted IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
NCC permitted
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.57/GSM 04.08: NCC Permitted information element
Table 10.5.65/GSM 04.08: NCC Permitted information element
+------------------------------------------------------+
| NCC permitted (octet 2)
|
| The NCC permitted field is coded as a bit map, i.e. |
| bit N is coded with a "0" if the BCCH carrier with
|
| NCC = N-1 is not permitted for monitoring and with a |
| "1" if the BCCH carrier with NCC = N-1 is permitted |
| for monitoring; N = 1,2,..,8.
|
+------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.28
Power Command
The purpose of the Power Command information element is to provide the power level to be used by the mobile station.
The Power Command information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.58/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.66/GSM 04.08.
The Power Command is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
ETSI
469
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Power Command IEI
| octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0 | 0 | 0 |
POWER LEVEL
|
|spare|spare|spare|
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.58/GSM 04.08: Power Command information element
Table 10.5.66/GSM 04.08: Power Command information element
+-------------------------------------------------------+
|
Power level (octet 2)
|
|
The power level field is coded as the binary |
|
representation of the "power control level", see TS |
|
GSM05.05.
|
|
This value shall be used by the mobile station
|
|
according to GSM05.08.
|
|
|
|
Range: 0 to 31.
|
+-------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.28a
The purpose of the Power Command and access type information element is to provide the power level to be used by
the mobile station and the indication that the mobile station can avoid the transmission of handover access.
The Power Command and access type information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.59/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.67/GSM 04.08.
The Power Command and access type is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Power Command and Access Type IEI
| octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| ATC | 0 | 0 |
POWER LEVEL
|
|
|spare|spare|
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.59/GSM 04.08: Power Command and access type information element
Table 10.5.67/GSM 04.08: Power Command and access type information element
+-------------------------------------------------------+
|
ATC (Access Type Control) (octet 2)
|
|
bit 8
|
|
0
Sending of Handover access is mandatory
|
|
1
Sending of Handover access is optional
|
|
|
|
Power level (octet 2)
|
|
The power level field is coded as the binary
|
|
representation of the "power control level", see TS |
|
GSM05.05.
|
|
This value shall be used by the mobile station
|
|
according to GSM05.08.
|
|
|
|
Range: 0 to 31.
|
+-------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.29
The purpose of the RACH Control Parameters information element is to provide parameters used to control the RACH
utilization. This information element is broadcast to mobile stations in SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 1, 2, 2bis, 3,
and 4 messages.
The RACH Control Parameters information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.60/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.68/GSM 04.08.
The RACH Control Parameters is a type 3 information element with 4 octets length.
ETSI
470
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
RACH Control Parameters IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
|
|
|Max retrans|
Tx-integer
|CELL |RE
|
|
|
|BARR |
|
|
|
|ACCESS|
|
+-----------+-----------------------------+-----|
| AC | AC | AC | AC | AC | EC | AC | AC |
| C15 | C14 | C13 | C12 | C11 | C10 | C09 | C08 |
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
| AC | AC | AC | AC | AC | AC | AC | AC |
| C07 | C06 | C05 | C04 | C03 | C02 | C01 | C00 |
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
ETSI
471
10.5.2.30
Request Reference
The purpose of the Request Reference information element is to provide the random access information used in the
channel request and the frame number, FN modulo 42432 in which the channel request was received.
The Request Reference information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.61/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.69/GSM 04.08.
The Request Reference is a type 3 information element with 4 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Request Reference IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
RA
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
T3
|
|
T1'
| (high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
T3
|
|
|
(low part)
|
T2
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
ETSI
472
10.5.2.31
RR Cause
The purpose of the RR Cause information element is to provide the reason for release or the reason for completion of an
assignment or handover.
The RR Cause information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.62/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.70/GSM 04.08.
The RR Cause is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
RR Cause IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
RR cause value
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.62/GSM 04.08: RR Cause information element
ETSI
473
10.5.2.32
SI 1 Rest Octets
The SI 1 Rest Octets information element contains the position about the NCH and spare bits.
The SI 1 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 1 octet length.
<SI1 Rest Octets> ::=
{L |H <NCH Position : bit (5)> };
<spare padding> ;
ETSI
474
10.5.2.33
The SI 2bis Rest Octets information element contains only spare bits. Its purpose is to allow the upward compatible
introduction of new information on the BCCH in later phases.
The SI 2bis Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with1 octet length.
<SI2bis Rest Octets> ::=
<spare padding> ;
10.5.2.33a
The SI 2ter Rest Octets information element contains only spare bits. Its purpose is to allow the upward
compatible introduction of new information on the BCCH in later phases.
ETSI
475
The SI 2ter Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 4 octets length.
<SI2ter Rest Octets> ::=
<spare padding> ;
10.5.2.34
SI 3 Rest Octets
The SI 3 Rest Octets information element is coded according to the syntax specified below and described in tables
10.5.72/GSM 04.08, 10.5.73/GSM 04.08 and 10.5.74/GSM 04.08(See section 10.5.2.35).
The SI 3 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 5 octets length.
Table 10.5.72/GSM 04.08: SI 3 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element
<SI3 Rest Octet> ::= <Optional selection parameters>
<Optional Power offset>
<System Information 2ter Indicator>
<Early Classmark Sending Control>
<Scheduling if and where>
{ L | H <GPRS Indicator> }
<spare padding> :
<Optional Selection Parameters> ::=
L | H <Selection Parameters>;
ETSI
476
ETSI
10.5.2.35
477
SI 4 Rest Octets
The SI 4 Rest Octets information element includes parameters which are used by the mobile station for cell selection
and reselection purposes. It may also include the POWER OFFSET parameter used by DCS 1800 Class 3 MS.
Its content is described in Table 10.5.73/GSM 04.08 and 10.5.74/GSM 04.08..
NOTE:
In the future evolution of this standard the values 64h and 72h shall not be used as values of the first octet
when this information element is used in the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 4 message. This will
prevent mobile stations misinterpreting this inforrmation as the CBCH IEIs .
The SI 4 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 1 to 11 octets length.
<SI4 Rest Octets> ::= <SI4 Rest Octets_O>
{L<Break indicator>| H<SI Rest Octets_S}
<spare padding> ;
<SI4 Rest Octets_O> ::= <Optional selection parameters>
<Optional Power offset>
{L | H < GPRS Indicator >};
<SI4 Rest Octets_S> ::= {L | H <LSA Parameters>}
{L | H <Cell Identity : bit(16)>}
{L | H <LSA ID information>} ;
<Break Indicator> : := 0 |1 ;
<SI7 Rest Octets> ::= <SI4 Rest Octets_O><SI4 Rest Octets_S> |<SI4 Rest Octets_S>;
<SI8 Rest Octets> ::= <SI4 Rest Octets_O><SI4 Rest Octets_S> |<SI4 Rest Octets_S>;
<Optional Selection Parameters> ::=
<Selection Parameters> ::=
L | H <Selection Parameters> ;
<LSA identity>
{0 | 1 <LSA_ID information>} ;
If "ACS " in the System information type 4 message is set to "1" then the SI 7 and SI 8 rest octets consists of
"SI4 Rest Octets_O" and "SI4 Rest Octets_S", otherwise of only "SI4 Rest Octets_S".
ETSI
478
ETSI
479
GPRS Indicator
The GPRS Indicator contains the RA COLOUR field and the SI13_POSITION field. If the GPRS Indicator is
contained in the information element, it indicates that GPRS is supported in the cell.
RA COLOUR (3 bit field)
If the mobile station receives different values of the RA COLOUR field in different cell, the mobile station shall
interpret the cell re-selection information as if the two cells belong to different routeing areas.
SI13_POSITION (1 bit field)
The SI13 POSITION field indicates the minimum schedule for where the SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 13
message is sent on BCCH, see GSM 05.02:
0 SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 13 message is sent on BCCH Norm;
1 SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 13 message is sent on BCCH Ext.
Break Indicator
The Break Indicator indicates if parameters in addition to those in SI 4 rest octets are sent in SI7 and SI8.
0 Additional parameters are not sent in SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 7 and 8.
1 Additional parameters, "SI4 Rest Octets_S" are sent in SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 7 and 8.
PRIO_THR (3 bit field)
The PRIO_THR field is a signal threshold used by the mobile station to determine whether prioritised cell re-selection
shall apply. The use and coding of this parameters is defined in GSM 05.08.
LSA_OFFSET (3 bit field)
The LSA_OFFSET field applies an offset for LSA reselection between cells with same LSA priorities. The use and
coding of this parameters is defined in GSM 05.08.
MCC and MNC (24 bit field)
If the escape PLMN is broadcast in SI3 and SI4 the cell is used for SoLSA exclusive access and the MCC and MNC
field shall be included. The MS shall then for all purposes use the MCC and MNC values received in the LSA
Parameters instead of the ones received in the Location Area information element in SI3 and 4, eg when deriving the
PLMN identity, the Location Area Identity and Cell Global Identity broadcast by the cell. The MCC and MNC value
field is coded as specified in Figure 10.5.3/GSM 04.08 and Table 10.5.3/GSM 04.08.
Cell Identity (16 bit field)
The purpose of the Cell Identity is to identify a cell within a location area. The Cell Identity is coded as shown in figure
10.2/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5/GSM 04.08.
LSA_ID (24 bit field)
The purpose of the LSA_ID field is to identify a LSA. The LSA ID value field is specified in GSM 03.03.
Short LSA_ID (10 bit field)
The purpose of the Short LSA_ID field is to identify a LSA. The LSA ID defined by the Short LSA_ID is a LSA_ID as
specified in GSM 03.03 with bit 0 set to "0" bit 1 to 10 set to the value of the Short LSA_ID field (LSB in bit 1, MSB in
bit 10) and bit 11 to 23 set to "0".
ETSI
10.5.2.35a
480
SI 6 Rest Octets
The SI 6 Rest Octet information element may contain information concerning the paging, notification channels, VBS
and VGCS services of the cell.
Mobile stations not supporting VGCS listening or VBS listening can ignore the information contained in this
information element.
The value part is as shown below:
<SI6 rest octets> ::=
L I H <PCH and NCH info>symbol 125 \f "Symbol" \s 10
L I H <VBS/VGCS options : bit(2)>}
<implicit spare >;
<PCH and NCH info> ::=
<Paging channel restructuring>
<NLN(SACCH) : bit(2)>
symbol 123 \f "Symbol" \s 100 I 1 <Call priority : bit (3)>symbol 125 \f "Symbol" \s 10
<NLN status : bit >;
<paging channel restructuring> ::=
1|
-- paging channel is restructured
0
-- paging channel is not restructured
<VBS/VGCS options> ::= <inband notifications>
<inband pagings>;
<inband notifications>::=
0|
-- the network does not provide notification on FACCH so that the mobile should
inspect the NCH for notifications
1
-- the mobile shall be notified on incoming high priority VBS/VGCS calls through
NOTIFICATION/FACCH, the mobile need not to inspect the NCH
<inband pagings>::=
0|
-- the network does not provide paging information on FACCH so that the mobile
should inspect the PCH for pagings
1
-- the mobile shall be notified on incoming high priority point-to-point calls
through NOTIFICATION/FACCH, the mobile need not to inspect the PCH
10.5.2.36
SI 7 Rest Octets
The SI 7 Rest Octets information element includes parameters which are used by the mobile station for cell selection
and reselection purposes. It may also include the POWER OFFSET parameter used by a DCS 1800 Class 3 MS.
The SI 7 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 21 octets length.
The SI 7 Rest Octets information element is coded as the SI 4 Rest Octets. Its contents is described in Table 10.5.2.35ab/GSM 04.08.
10.5.2.37
SI 8 Rest Octets
The SI 8 Rest Octets information element includes parameters which are used by the mobile station for cell selection
and reselection purposes. It may also include the POWER OFFSET parameter used by a DCS 1800 Class 3 MS.
ETSI
481
The SI 8 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 21 octets length.
The SI 8 Rest Octets information element is coded as the SI 4 Rest Octets. Its contents is described in Table
10.5.73/GSM 04.08 and 10.5.74/GSM 04.08.
10.5.2.37a
SI 9 Rest Octets
The SI 9 Rest Octets information element contains information about scheduling of some or all of the information on the
BCCH.
The SI 9 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 17 octets length.
<SI9 rest octets>
::=
{L | H <Scheduling info>}
<spare padding>;
<Scheduling info>
::=
<Info type> <Positions>
{0 | 1 <Scheduling info>};
<Info type>
::=
0 <Info_type_4: bit (4)>
| 1 0 <Info_type_5: bit (5)>
| 1 1 <Info_type_6: bit6)>;
<Positions>
::=
<Position> {0 | 1 <Position>}
<Position>
Attributes
The scheduling info indicates one or more information types (in info type) together with their positions. Here, a position
specifies at which relative position P (specified in relative_position) modulo a position modulus M (specified in
modulus) messages of the given information type are sent, on the BCCH norm or BCCH ext (see GSM 05.02) as
indicated in bcch_type. Precisely, messages of the given information type are sent in the multiframes for which
((frame number) DIV 51) mod (M)) = P.
If the position modulus M equals 0, the information type is not sent.
Field contents
The fields of the SI 9 Rest Octets information element are coded as shown in table 10.75/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
482
Info_type_4_(4 bits)
This field contains a binary encoded non-negative integer number assigned to a type of information sent on the BCCH.
All values indicate unknown, unnecessary information and are reserved for future use.
Info_type_5 (5 bits)
This field contains a binary encoded non-negative integer number assigned to a type of information sent on the BCCH.
All values except those defined below indicate unknown, unnecessary information and are reserved for future use.
Info_type_5:
0 0000 System Information type 1
0 0001 System Information type 2
0 0010 System Information type 2bis
0 0011 System Information type 2ter
0 0100 System Information type 3
0 0101 System Information type 4
0 0110 System Information type 7
0 0111 System Information type 8
0 1000 System Information type 9
0 1001 System Information type 13
0 1011 System Information type 16
0 1100 System Information type 17
Info_type_6_(6 bits)
This field contains a binary encoded non-negative integer number assigned to a type of information sent on the BCCH.
All values indicate unknown, unnecessary information and are reserved for future use.
modulus (4 bits)
This field encodes the position modulus, according to the following encoding method. Let N be the integer encoded in
binary in the modulus field; the position modulus is then defined as follows :
If N=0, the position modulus is 0,
if N>0, the position modulus is 2N+1.
relative position (0 bits if the non-negative integer n contained in the modulus field is 0; n+1 bits, if the non-negative
integer N encoded in the modulus field is > 0.
This field contains the N+1 bit binary encoding of a non-negative integer number < 2N+1.
bcch_type (1 bit)
0 BCCH norm(as defined in GSM 05.08)
1 BCCH ext (as defined in GSM 05.08)
ETSI
10.5.2.37b
483
SI 13 Rest Octets
The SI 13 Rest Octets information element is coded according to the syntax specified below and described in tables
10.5.76/GSM 04.08.
The SI 13 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 21 octets length.
< SI 13 Rest Octets > ::=
{L|H
< BCCH_CHANGE_MARK : bit (3) >
< SI_CHANGE_FIELD : bit (4) >
{ 0 | 1 < SI13_CHANGE_MARK : bit (2) >
< GPRS Mobile Allocation : GPRS Mobile Allocation IE > }
{0
< GPRS Power Control Parameters : GPRS Power Control Parameters struct >
|1
}
}
< spare padding > ;
< GPRS Power Control Parameters struct > ::=
< ALPHA : bit (4) >
< T_AVG_W : bit (5) >
< T_AVG_T : bit (5) >
< PC_MEAS_CHAN : bit >
< N_AVG_I : bit (4) >;
< PBCCH Description struct > ::=
<Pb : bit (4)
< TSC : bit (3) >
< TN : bit (3) >
{ 00 -- BCCH carrier
| 01 < ARFCN : bit (10) >
|1
< MAIO : bit (6) >} ;
ETSI
484
ETSI
485
BCCH;
PDCH.
The N_AVG_I field (4 bit) is the binary representation of the parameter NAVG_I for MS output power control, see
GSM 05.08: Range: 0 to 15.
PBCCH Description struct
The PBCCH description struct provides the channel description for the PBCCH. The frequency description for the
PBCCH may be specified by an ARFCN (non-hopping radio frequency channel) or a MAIO (hopping radio frequency
channel) field. In case of a hopping radio frequency channel, the PBCCH shall use the GPRS mobile allocation
specified in this message. If none of the ARFCN or MAIO fields are present, the PBCCH shall use the BCCH carrier.
Pb (4bit) (for encoding and description see the Global Power Control Parameters IE)
The TSC field (3 bit) is the binary representation of the training sequence code used for PBCCH and PCCCHs. Range:
0 to 7.
The TN field (3 bit) is the binary representation of the timeslot number for the PBCCH and the corresponding PCCCH.
Range: 0 to 7.
The ARFCN field (10 bit) is the binary representation of the absolute RF channel number. Range: 0 to 1023.
The MAIO field (6 bit) is the binary representation of the mobile allocation index offset. Range: 0 to 63.
ETSI
10.5.2.37c
[Spare]
10.5.2.37d
[Spare]
10.5.2.37e
SI 16 Rest Octets
486
The SI 16 Rest Octets information element includes parameters which are used by the mobile station for cell selection
and reselection purposes.
The SI 16 Rest Octets information element is coded according to the syntax specified below. Its contents is described in
Table 10.52c/GSM 04.08.
The SI 16 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 21 octets length.
<SI16 Rest Octets> ::=
{L | H <LSA Parameters>}
<spare padding> ;
<LSA identity>
{0 | 1 <LSA ID information>} ;
<LSA identity> : :=
ETSI
487
10.5.2.37f
SI 17 Rest Octets
The SI 17 Rest Octets information element includes parameters, which are used by the mobile station for cell selection
and reselection purposes.
The SI 17 Rest Octets information element is a type 5 information element with 21 octets length.
The SI 17 Rest Octets information element is coded as the SI 16 Rest Octets. Its contents is described in Table
10.52c/GSM 04.08.
10.5.2.38
Starting Time
The purpose of the Starting Time information element is to provide the start TDMA frame number, FN modulo 42432.
The Starting Time information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.65/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.79/GSM 04.08.
The Starting Time is a type 3 information element with 3 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Starting Time IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
T1'
|
T3
| octet 2
|
| (high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
T3
|
T2
| octet 3
|
(low part)
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.65/GSM 04.08: Starting Time information element
Table 10.5.79/GSM 04.08: Starting Time information element
+-------------------------------------------------------+
| T1' (octet 2)
|
| The T1' field is coded as the binary representation
|
| of (FN div 1326) mod 32.
|
|
|
| T3 (octet 2 and 3)
|
| The T3 field is coded as the binary representation
|
| of FN mod 51. Bit 3 of octet 2 is the most |
| significant bit and bit 6 of octet 3 is the least |
| significant bit.
|
|
|
| T2 (octet 3)
|
| The T2 field is coded as the binary representation
|
| of FN mod 26.
|
|
|
| NOTE 1: The frame number, FN modulo 42432 can be cal- |
|
culated as 51x((T3-T2) mod 26)+T3+51x26xT1'
|
|
|
+-------------------------------------------------------+
The starting time and the times mentioned above are with reference to the frame numbering in the concerned cell. They
are given in units of frames (around 4.615 ms).
The Starting Time IE can encode only an interval of time of 42 432 frames, that is to say around 195.8 seconds. To
remove any ambiguity, the specification for a reception at time T is that the encoded interval is (T-10808, T+31623). In
rigorous terms, if we note ST the starting time:
if 0 <= (ST-T) mod 42432 <= 31623, the indicated time is the next time when FN mod 42432 is equal to ST.
If 32024 <= (ST-T) mod 42432 <= 42431, the indicated time has already elapsed.
The reception time T is not specified here precisely. To allow room for various MS implementations, the limit between
the two behaviours above may be anywhere within the interval defined by
ETSI
488
10.5.2.39
Synchronization Indication
The purpose of Synchronization Indication information element is to indicate which type of handover is to be
performed.
The Synchronization Indication information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.66/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.80/GSM 04.08.
The Synchronization Indication is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
| NCI | ROT |
SI
| octet 1
|
|Synch. Indic. IEI|
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.66/GSM 04.08: Synchronization Indication information element
Table 10.5.80/GSM 04.08: Synchronization Indication information element
+------------------------------------------------------+
| ROT: Report Observed Time Difference (Octet1 bit 3) |
| 0
Mobile Time Difference IE shall not be included |
|
in the HANDOVER COMPLETE message
|
|
|
| 1
Mobile Time Difference IE shall be included in |
|
the HANDOVER COMPLETE message
|
|
|
| SI: Synchronization indication (octet 1)
|
| Bit
|
| 2 1
|
| 0 0 Non-synchronized
|
| 0 1 Synchronized
|
| 1 0 Pre-synchronised
|
| 1 1 Pseudo-synchronised
|
|
|
| NCI: Normal cell indication (octet 1, bit 4)
|
| 0
Out of range timing advance is ignored
|
| 1
Out of range timing advance shall trigger
|
|
a handover failure procedure
|
+------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.40
Timing Advance
The purpose of the Timing Advance information element is to provide the timing advance value.
The Timing Advance information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.67/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.81/GSM 04.08
The Timing Advance is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Timing Advance IEI
| octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0 | 0 |
| octet 2
|spare|spare|
Timing advance value
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.67/GSM 04.08: Timing Advance information element
ETSI
489
10.5.2.41
Time Difference
The purpose of the Time Difference information element is to provide information about the synchronization difference
between the time bases of two Base Stations. This type of information element is used in relation with the pseudosynchronization scheme, see GSM 05.10.
The Time Difference information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.68/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.82/GSM 04.08.
The Time Difference information element is a type 4 information element with 3 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+---------------------------------------------------+
|
|
Time Difference IEI
| octet 1
+---------------------------------------------------|
|
Length of Time Difference contents
| octet 2
+---------------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Time difference value
| octet 3
+---------------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.68/GSM 04.08: Time Difference information element
Table 10.5.82/GSM 04.08: Time Difference information element
+-------------------------------------------------------------+
|Time Difference value (octet 3)
|
|The coding of the time difference value field is the binary |
|representation of time difference in half bit periods,
|
|modulo 256 half bit periods;
|
|1/2 bit period = 24/13 as.
|
+-------------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.2.41a
TLLI
The purpose of the TLLI information element is to provide the Temporary Logical Link Identifier.
The TLLI information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.69/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.83/GSM 04.08.
The TLLI is a type 3 information element with 5 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
TLLI IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
TLLI value
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
TLLI value (contd)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
TLLI value (contd)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
TLLI value (contd)
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.69/GSM 04.08: TLLI information element
ETSI
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
490
10.5.2.42
TMSI/P-TMSI
The purpose of the TMSI/P-TMSI information element is to provide the Temporary Mobile Subscriber Identity for
paging purposes.
The TMSI/P-TMSI information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.70/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.84/GSM 04.08.
The TMSI/P-TMSI is a type 3 information element with 5 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
TMSI/P-TMSI IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
TMSI/P-TMSI value
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
TMSI/P-TMSI value (contd)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
TMSI/P-TMSI value (contd
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
TMSI/P-TMSI value (contd)
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
10.5.2.42a
For purposes other than paging the TMSI/P-TMSI should be provided using the mobile identity
information element.
The VGCS target mode Indication information element is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
VGCS target mode Indic. IEI
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
|
Length of VGCS target mode Indic.
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|Target mode|Group cipher key number| 1 | 1 |
|
|
|spare|spare|
+-----------+-----------------------+-----+-----+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
ETSI
491
10.5.2.43
Wait Indication
The purpose of the Wait Indication information element is to provide the time the mobile station shall wait before
attempting another channel request.
The Wait Indication information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.72/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.86/GSM 04.08.
The Wait Indication is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Wait Indication IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
T3122/T3142 timeout value
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.72/GSM 04.08: Wait Indication information element
Table 10.5.86/GSM 04.08: Wait Indication information element
+------------------------------------------------------+
| T3122/T3142 timeout value (octet 2)
|
| This field is coded as the binary representation of |
| the T3122/T3142 timeout value in seconds.
|
+------------------------------------------------------+
NOTE:
10.5.2.44
The timeout value is used for T3122 when received in IMMEDIATE_ASSIGNMENT REJECT message
for RR connection establishment. For GPRS MS the timeout value isused for T3142 when received in
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT message for TBF establishment.
The SI 10 rest octets information element contains information for cell re-selection in group receive mode.
The value part is coded as shown below.
ETSI
492
H;
ETSI
493
<la different>
as defined below.
6) For each occurrence of <further diff cell info>, a cell information is defined. This information is given by <la
different> and remaining cell information established as follows:
The remaining cell information defined for the first occurrence of <further diff cell info> consists of the cell
information given by its actual components plus the cell information specified by <further cell info>
corresponding to its missing components.
The remaining cell information defined for a later occurrence of <further diff cell info> consists of the cell
information given by its actual components plus the remaining cell information corresponding to its missing
components which is defined for the previous occurrence of <further diff cell info>.
Here, the
-
"actual components" of an occurrence of <further diff cell info> denotes those parameters among
"missing components" of an occurrence of <differential cell info> denote those parameters among
7) Each occurrence of <bsic : bitstring(6)> specifies a BSIC by encoding its binary representation.
<BCC : bitstring(3)> specifies a BCC by encoding its binary representation; it specifies the BSIC given by that
BCC and the NCC of the BSIC specified by the previous occurrence of <BCC : bitstring(3)> or
<bsic : bitstring(6)>. All occurrences of <bsic: bitstring(6)> and <BCC : bitstring(3)> establish a list of BSIC.
8) <first frequency : bitstring(5)> is the 5 bit binary coding of an integer n with 0 <= n <= 31. It specifies a first
frequency number n+1.
9) <SI10 rest octets> defines a correspondence between neighbour cell frequencies and sets of pairs (BSIC, cell
information) defining the parameters for cell re-selection of any corresponding neighbour cell with BCCH on
that frequency and having that BSIC:
ETSI
494
Let a(1),..., a(n) be the list of neighbour cell frequencies, in the order determined by the mobile station. Let i be
the first frequency number specified by <first frequency : bitstring(5)> (see above).
The first BSIC and the cell information specified by <cell info> build a pair belonging to the set corresponding
to a(i).
If an m-th occurrence of <info field> is present (where m >=2), having established the correspondence of the (m1)-th BSIC to a neighbour frequency a(k), the m-th BSIC and following <differential cell info>
-
belong to a(k), if <next frequency> is not present in the m-th occurrence of <info field>,
belong to a((smod(k+t)), if <next frequency> is present exactly t times in the m-th occurrence of <info field>.
10.5.2.45
The purpose of the Extended Measurement Results information element is to provide the results of the measurements
made by the mobile station on the carriers specified in the EXTENDED MEASUREMENT ORDER.
The Extended Measurement Results information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.73/GSM 04.08 and table
10.5.87/GSM 04.08.
The Extended Measurement Results is a type 3 information element with 17 octets length.
ETSI
495
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Extended Measurement Results IEI
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| SC |DTX |
|
|USED |USED |
RXLEV carrier 0
|
|
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
RXLEV
|
|
RXLEV carrier 1
| carrier 2 |
|
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RXLEV carrier 2
|
RXLEV carrier 3
|
|
(low part)
|
(high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| RXLEV
|
|
| carrier 3 |
RXLEV carrier 4
|
|(low part) |
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
RXLEV
|
|
RXLEV carrier 5
| carrier 6 |
|
|(high part)|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
RXLEV carrier 6
|
RXLEV carrier 7
|
|
(low part)
|
(high part)
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| RXLEV
|
|
| carrier 7 |
RXLEV carrier 8
|
|(low part) |
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
(continued...)
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 7
octet 8
octet 9
octet 10
octet 11
octet 12
octet 13
octet 14
octet 15
octet 16
octet 17
ETSI
496
10.5.2.46
The purpose of Extended Measurement Frequency List information element is to provide the absolute radio frequency
channel numbers of carriers to measure signal strength on.
The Extended Measurement Frequency List information element is coded as the Cell Channel Description information
element, as specified in section 10.5.2.1b, with the exception of bit 5 of octet 2. figure 10.5.74/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.88/GSM 04.08 contains the difference of specifications.
The Extended Measurement Frequency List information element is a type 3 information element with 17 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
| Extended Measurement Frequency List IEI | octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| Bit | Bit | 0 |SEQ- | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | octet 2
| 128 | 127 |spare|CODE | 124 | 123 | 122 | 121 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | octet 3
| 120 | 119 | 118 | 117 | 116 | 115 | 114 | 113 |
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit | Bit |octet 17
| 008 | 007 | 006 | 005 | 004 | 003 | 002 | 001 |
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.74/GSM 04.08: Extended Measurement Frequency List information element
Table 10.5.88/GSM 04.08: Extended Measurement Frequency List information element
SEQ-CODE, Sequence code (octet 2, bit 5).
Range 0 to 1.
ETSI
10.5.2.47
497
Suspension Cause
The purpose of the Suspension Cause information element is to provide the reason for the establishment of the
dedicated circuit which generated the GPRS suspension.
The Suspension Cause information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.2.47/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.2.47/GSM 04.08.
The Suspension Cause is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Suspension Cause IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Suspension cause value
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.2.47/GSM 04.08: Suspension Cause information element
Table 10.5.2.47/GSM 04.08: Suspension Cause information element
+--------------------------------------------------------+
| Suspension cause value (octet 2)
|
| Bits
|
| 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Mobile originating call
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
Location Area Update
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
MO Short message service
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1
MO Supplementary service activation |
| 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0
MO Voice broadcast or group call
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1
Mobile terminating CS connection
|
|
|
| All other cause values shall be treated as 0000 0000
|
|
|
+--------------------------------------------------------+
ETSI
10.5.3
10.5.3.1
498
The purpose of the Authentication Parameter RAND information element is to provide the mobile station with a nonpredictable number to be used to calculate the authentication response signature SRES and the ciphering key Kc.
The Authentication Parameter RAND information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.75/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.89/GSM 04.08.
The Authentication Parameter RAND is a type 3 information element with 17 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
Authentication parameter RAND IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
RAND value
| octet 2
:
:
|
| octet 17
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.75/GSM 04.08: Authentication Parameter RAND information element
Table 10.5.89/GSM 04.08: Authentication Parameter RAND information element
+-----------------------------------------------------+
| RAND value (octet 2, 3,... and 17)
|
| The RAND value consists of 128 bits. Bit 8 of octet |
| 2 is the most significant bit while bit 1 of octet |
| 17 is the least significant bit.
|
+-----------------------------------------------------+
10.5.3.2
The purpose of the authentication parameter SRES information element is to provide the network with the
authentication response signature calculated in the mobile station.
The Authentication Parameter SRES information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.76/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.90/GSM 04.08.
The Authentication Parameter SRES is a type 3 information element with 5 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
Authentication parameter SRES IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
SRES value
| octet 2
:
:
|
| octet 5
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.76/GSM 04.08: Authentication Parameter SRES information element
ETSI
499
10.5.3.3
CM service type
The purpose of the CM Service Type information element is to specify which service is requested from the network.
The CM Service Type information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.77/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.91/GSM 04.08.
The CM Service Type is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
| CM service type IEI |
service type
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.77/GSM 04.08: CM Service Type information element
Table 10.5.91/GSM 04.08: CM Service Type information element
+-----------------------------------------------------+
| Service type (octet 1)
|
| Bits
|
| 4 3 2 1
|
| 0 0 0 1 Mobile originating call establishment
|
|
or packet mode connection establishment
|
| 0 0 1 0 Emergency call establishment
|
| 0 1 0 0 Short message service
|
| 1 0 0 0 Supplementary service activation
|
| 1 0 0 1 Voice group call establishment
|
| 1 0 1 0 Voice broadcast call establishment
|
| 1 0 1 1 Location Services
|
|
|
| All other values are reserved.
|
+-----------------------------------------------------+
10.5.3.4
Identity type
The purpose of the Identity Type information element is to specify which identity is requested.
The Identity Type information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.78/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.92/GSM 04.08.
The Identity Type is a type 1 information element .
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
Identity type IEI
| 0 |type of identity | octet 1
|
|spare|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.78/GSM 04.08: Identity Type information element
ETSI
500
10.5.3.5
The purpose of the Location Updating Type information element is to indicate whether a normal updating, a periodic
updating or an IMSI attach is wanted. It may also indicate that a follow-on request has been received from the mobile
station CM layer.
The Location Updating Type information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.79/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.93/GSM 04.08.
The Location Updating Type is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
Location updating
| FOR | 0 |
LUT
| octet 1
|
type IEI
|
|spare|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.79/GSM 04.08: Location Updating Type information element
Table 10.5.93/GSM 04.08: Location Updating Type information element
+-----------------------------------------------+
| LUT (octet 1)
|
| Bits
|
| 2 1
|
| 0 0
Normal location updating
|
| 0 1
Periodic updating
|
| 1 0
IMSI attach
|
| 1 1
Reserved
|
|
|
| FOR (octet 1)
|
| The Follow-On Request bit (FOR) is coded as
|
| follows:
|
| Bit
|
| 4
|
| 0
No follow-on request pending
|
| 1
Follow-on request pending
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
10.5.3.5a
Network Name
The purpose of this information element is to pass a text string to the mobile station.
The Network Name information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.80/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.94/GSM 04.08.
The Network Name is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 3 octets. No upper length limit is
specified except for that given by the maximum number of octets in a L3 message (see GSM 04.06).
ETSI
501
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Network Name IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of Network Name contents
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| ext |
coding scheme |Add| Number of spare |
| 1 |
|CI |bits in last octet|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
|
|
Text String
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet n
The MS should not add the letters for the Country's Initials to the text string
The MS should add the letters for the Country's Initials and a separator
(e.g. a space) to the text string
10.5.3.6
Reject cause
The purpose of the Reject Cause information element is to indicate the reason why a request from the mobile station is
rejected by the network.
The Reject Cause information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.81/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.95/GSM 04.08.
The Reject Cause is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
Reject cause IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
reject cause value
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.81/GSM 04.08: Reject Cause information element
ETSI
502
10.5.3.7
Follow-on Proceed
The purpose of the Follow-on Proceed information element is to indicate that an MM connection may be established on
an existing RR connection.
The Follow-on Proceed information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.82/GSM 04.08.
The Follow-on Proceed is a type 2 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
Follow-on Proceed
IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.82/GSM 04.08: Follow-on Proceed information element
10.5.3.8
Time Zone
The purpose of this information element is to encode the local timezone in steps of 15 minutes.
The Time Zone information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.83/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.96/GSM 04.08.
The Time Zone is a type 3 information element with a length of 2 octets.
ETSI
503
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Time Zone IEI
|octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Time Zone
|
|
|octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.83/GSM 04.08: Time Zone information element
Table 10.5.96/GSM 04.08: Time Zone information element
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
|
|
| Time Zone (octet 2, bits 1-8)
|
| This field is encoded in exactly the same way as the Time
|
| Zone field of the TP-Service-Centre-Time-Stamp in GSM03.40 |
|
.
|
+--------------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.3.9
The purpose of this information element is to encode the local timezone in steps of 15 minutes and to indicate the time
at which this information element may have been sent by the network.
The Time Zone and Time information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.84/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.97/GSM 04.08.
The Time Zone and Time is a type 3 information element with a length of 8 octets.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Time Zone and Time IEI
|octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Year
|
|
|octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Month
|
|
|octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Day
|
|
|octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Hour
|
|
|octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Minute
|
|
|octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Second
|
|
|octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
Time zone
|
|
|octet
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.84/GSM 04.08: Time Zone and Time information element
ETSI
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
504
10.5.3.10
CTS permission
The purpose of the CTS permission information element is to indicate that the mobile station is allowed to use GSMCordless Telephony System in the Location Area. The CTS permission information element is coded as shown in
figure 10.5.84a/GSM 04.08.
The CTS permission is a type 2 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
CTS Permission IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.84a/GSM 04.08: CTS permission information element
10.5.3.11
LSA Identifier
octet
+-----------------------------------------------
LSA ID
octet
+-----------------------------------------------
LSA ID cont.
octet
+-----------------------------------------------
LSA ID cont.
octet
+-----------------------------------------------
Figure 10.68c/GSM 04.08: LSA Identifier information element
ETSI
1
2
3
4
5
505
If the Length = 0, then no LSA ID is included. This is used to indicate that the MS has moved to an area where there is
no LSA available for that MS.
Octets 3-5 are coded as specified in GSM 03.03, Identification of Localised Service Area. Bit 8 of octet 3 is the most
significant bit.
10.5.4
10.5.4.1
There is a certain number of possible information element identifier values using the formatting rules described in
subclause 10.5: 128 from the type 3 & 4 information element format and at least 8 from the type 1 & 2 information
element format.
One value in the type 1 format is specified for shift operations described below. One other value in both the type 3 & 4
and type 1 format is reserved. This leaves 133 information element identifier values available for assignment.
It is possible to expand this structure to eight codesets of 133 information element identifier values each. One common
value in the type 1 format is employed in each codeset to facilitate shifting from one codeset to another. The contents of
this shift information element identifies the codeset to be used for the next information element or elements. The
codeset in use at any given time is referred to as the "active codeset". By convention, codeset 0 is the initially active
codeset.
Two codeset shifting procedures are supported: locking shift and non-locking shift.
Codeset 5 is reserved for information elements reserved for national use.
Codeset 6 is reserved for information elements specific to the local network (either public or private).
Codeset 7 is reserved for user-specific information elements.
The coding rules specified in section 10.5 shall apply for information elements belonging to any active codeset.
Transitions from one active codeset to another (i.e. by means of the locking shift procedure) may only be made to a
codeset with a higher numerical value than the codeset being left.
An information element belonging to codeset 5, 6 or 7 may appear together with information elements belonging to
codeset 0, by using the non-locking shift procedure (see section 10.5.4.3).
A user or network equipment shall have the capability to recognize a shift information element and to determine the
length of the following information element, although the equipment need not be able to interpret and act on the content
of the information element. This enables the equipment to determine the start of the subsequent information element.
10.5.4.2
The locking shift procedure employs an information element to indicate the new active codeset. The specified codeset
remains active until another locking shift information element is encountered which specifies the use of another codeset.
For example, codeset 0 is active at the start of message content analysis. If a locking shift to codeset 5 is encountered,
the next information elements will be interpreted according to the information element identifiers assigned in codeset 5,
until another shift information element is encountered. This procedure is used only to shift to a higher order codeset
than the one being left.
The locking shift is valid only within that message which contains the locking shift information element. At the start of
every message content analysis, the active codeset is codeset 0.
The locking shift information element uses the type 1 information element format and coding shown in
figure 10.5.85/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.98/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
506
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
| 0 | New codeset
| octet 1
|
| Shift identifier|
| identification |
+--------------------------|--------------------+
|
"0" in this position indicates locking shift
Figure 10.5.85/GSM 04.08: Locking shift element
Table 10.5.98/GSM 04.08: Locking shift element
+---------------------------------------------------------+
| Codeset identification (octet 1):
|
| bits 3 2 1
|
|
0 0 0
not applicable
|
|
0 0 1
|
| to
1 0 0
reserved
|
|
1 0 1
codeset 5: information elements
|
|
for national use
|
|
1 1 0
codeset 6: information elements specific |
|
to the local network
|
|
(either public or private)
|
|
1 1 1
codeset 7: user-specific information
|
|
elements
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.4.3
The non-locking shift procedure provides a temporary shift to the specified lower or higher codeset. The non-locking
shift procedure uses a type 1 information element to indicate the codeset to be used to interpret the next information
element. After the interpretation of the next information element, the active codeset is again used for interpreting any
following information elements. For example, codeset 0 is active at the beginning of message content analysis. If a nonlocking shift to codeset 6 is encountered, only the next information element is interpreted according to the information
element identifiers assigned in codeset 6. After this information element is interpreted, codeset 0 will again be used to
interpret the following information elements. A non-locking shift information element indicating the current codeset
shall not be regarded as an error.
A locking shift information element shall not follow directly a non-locking shift information element. If this
combination is received, it shall be interpreted as though a locking shift information element had been received.
The non-locking shift information element uses the type 1 information format and coding shown in
figure 10.5.86/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.99/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
| 1 |Temporary codeset| octet 1
|
| Shift identifier|
| identification |
+--------------------------|--------------------+
|
"1" in this position indicates non-locking shift
Figure 10.5.86/GSM 04.08: Non-locking shift element
ETSI
507
10.5.4.4
Auxiliary states
The purpose of the auxiliary states information element is to describe the current status of the auxiliary states of a call in
the call control states "active" and "mobile originating modify" (see TSs GSM 04.83 and 04.84).
The auxiliary states information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.87/GSM 04.08, table 10.5.100/GSM 04.08
and table 10.5.101/GSM 04.08.
The auxiliary states is a type 4 information element with 3 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Auxiliary states IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of auxiliary states contents
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 1 | 0
0
0 | hold aux. | MPTY aux. |
| ext |
spare
| state
|
state
| octet 3
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.87/GSM 04.08: Auxiliary states information element
Table 10.5.100/GSM 04.08: Auxiliary states information element
+---------------------------------------------------------+
| Hold auxiliary state (octet 3)
|
|
|
| Bits
|
| 4 3
|
| 0 0
idle
Note 1
|
| 0 1
hold request
Note 1
|
| 1 0
call held
Note 1
|
| 1 1
retrieve request
Note 1
|
|
|
| Note 1: These states are defined in Rec GSM04.83.
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
Table 10.5.101/GSM 04.08: Auxiliary states information element
+---------------------------------------------------------+
| Multi party auxiliary state (octet 3)
|
| Bits
|
| 2 1
|
| 0 0
idle
Note 2
|
| 0 1
MPTY request
Note 2
|
| 1 0
call in MPTY
Note 2
|
| 1 1
split request
Note 2
|
|
|
|
|
| NOTE 2: These states are defined in Rec GSM04.84.
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
ETSI
10.5.4.5
508
Bearer capability
The purpose of the bearer capability information element is to describe a bearer service. The use of the bearer capability
information element in relation to compatibility checking is described in annex B.
The bearer capability information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.88/GSM 04.08 and
tables 10.5.102/GSM 04.08 to 10.5.115/GSM 04.08.
The bearer capability is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 3 octets and a maximum length of
15 octets.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Bearer capability IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of the bearer capability contents
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 0/1 |
radio
| co- |trans| information
|
| ext | channel |ding | fer |
transfer
| octet 3
|
|requirement| std |mode | capability
|
+-----+-----------------+-----------------------|
| 0/1 | 0 | 0
0 |
|
| ext | co- |
spare
| speech version
|octet 3a etc*
|
| ding|
|
indication
|
+-----+-----+-----------+-----------------------|
| 1 |comp-|
|dupl.|confi| NIRR|esta-|
| ext |ress.| structure |mode | gur.|
|bli. | octet 4*
+-----+-----------------------+-----------------|
| 0/1 | 0
0 |
rate
|
signalling
|
| ext |access id. | adaption | access protocol | octet 5*
+-----+-----------+-----------+-----------------|
| 0/1 |
| Other rate| 0
0
0 |
| ext | Other ITC | adaption |
Spare
| octet 5a*
+-----+-----------+-----------+-----------------|
| 1 |Hdr/ |Multi|Mode | LLI |Assig|Inb. | 0 |
| ext |noHdr|frame|
|
|nor/e|neg |Spare| octet 5b*
+-----+-----------+-----------------------+-----|
| 0/1 | 0
1 |
User information
|sync/|
| ext |layer 1 id.|
layer 1 protocol
|async| octet 6*
+-----+-----------+-----------------------------|
| 0/1 |numb.|nego-|numb.|
|
| ext |stop |tia- |data |
user rate
| octet 6a*
|
|bits |tion |bits |
|
+-----+-----------+-----+-----------------------|
| 0/1 | intermed. | NIC | NIC |
|
| ext |
rate
|on TX|on RX|
Parity
| octet 6b*
+-----+-----------+-----------------------------|
| 0/1 |connection |
|
| ext | element |
modem type
| octet 6c*
|
|
|
|
+-----+-----------+-----------------------------|
| 0/1 |
Other
| Fixed network user rate
| octet 6d*
| ext |modem type |
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0/1 |
Acceptable
|Maximum number of| octet 6e*
| ext |
channel
|traffic channels |
|
|
codings
|
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0/1 |
UIMI
| Wanted air interface | octet 6f*
| ext |
| user rate
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 1 | 1
0 |
User information
|
| ext |layer 2 id.|
layer 2 protocol
| octet 7*
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.88/GSM 04.08: Bearer capability information element
NOTE:
The coding of the octets of the bearer capability information element is not conforming to TS CCITT
Q.931.
ETSI
509
1 0 dual rate support MS/half rate speech version 1 preferred, full rate speech version 1 also
supported
1 1 dual rate support MS/full rate speech version 1 preferred, half rate speech version 1 also
supported
When information transfer capability (octet 3) indicates the value speech and speech version
indication(s) is(are) present in octet 3a etc.:
Bits
76
0 0 reserved
0 1 the mobile station supports at least full rate speech version 1 but does not support half rate
speech version 1. The complete voice codec preference is specified in octet(s) 3a etc.
1 0 The mobile station supports at least full rate speech version 1 and half rate speech version
1. The mobile station has a greater preference for half rate speech version 1 than for full
rate speech version 1. The complete voice codec preference is specified in octet(s) 3a etc.
1 1 The mobile station supports at least full rate speech version 1 and half rate speech version
1. The mobile station has a greater preference for full rate speech version 1 than for half
rate speech version 1. The complete voice codec preference is specified in octet(s) 3a etc.
Coding standard (octet 3)
Bit
5
0 GSM standardized coding as described below
1 reserved
(continued...)
ETSI
510
ETSI
511
ETSI
interface rate is
512
I.440/450
X.21
X.28 - dedicated PAD, individual NUI
X.28 - dedicated PAD, universal NUI
X.28 - non dedicated PAD
X.32
ETSI
513
ETSI
514
ETSI
515
ETSI
516
ETSI
517
ETSI
518
All other values shall be interpreted as "User initiated modification up to 4 TCH/F may be requested".
Wanted air interface user rate (octet 6f), MS to network direction:
Bits
4321
0 0 0 0 Air interface user rate not applicable/No meaning associated with this value
0 0 0 1 9.6 kbit/s
0 0 1 0 14.4 kbit/s
0 0 1 1 19.2 kbit/s
0 1 0 1 28.8 kbit/s
0 1 1 0 38.4 kbit/s
0 1 1 1 43.2 kbit/s
1000
57.6 kbit/s
1 0 0 1 interpreted by the network as 38.4 kbit/s in this version of the protocol
1 0 1 0 interpreted by the network as 38.4 kbit/s in this version of the protocol
1 0 1 1 interpreted by the network as 38.4 kbit/s in this version of the protocol
1 1 0 0 interpreted by the network as 38.4 kbit/s in this version of the protocol
All other values are reserved.
Wanted air interface user rate (octet 6f), network to MS direction:
Bits 1 to 4 are spare and shall be set to "0".
10.5.4.5.1
If the information transfer capability field (octet 3) indicates "speech", octets 4, 5, 5a, 5b, 6, 6a, 6b, 6c, 6d, 6e, 6f and 7
shall not be included.
ETSI
519
If the information transfer capability field (octet 3) indicates "speech", octet 3a etc. shall be included only if the mobile
station supports at least one speech version other than:
-
If the information transfer capability field (octet 3) indicates a value different from "speech", octets 4, 5, 6, 6a, 6b, and
6c shall be included, octets 6d, 6e and 6f are optional. In the network to MS direction in case octet 6d is included, octets
6e and 6f may be included. In the MS to network direction in case octet 6d is included octet 6e shall also be included
and 6f may be included.
If the information transfer capability field (octet 3) indicates "facsimile group 3", the modem type field (octet 6c) shall
indicate "none".
If the information transfer capability field (octet 3) indicates "other ITC" or the rate adaption field (octet 5) indicates
"other rate adaption", octet 5a shall be included.
If the rate adaption field (octet 5) indicates "other rate adaption" and the other rate adaption field (octet 5a) indicates
"V.120", octet 5b shall be included.
The modem type field (octet 6c) shall not indicate "autobauding type 1" unless the connection element field (octet 6c)
indicates "non transparent".
10.5.4.5a
The purpose of the Call Control Capabilities information element is to identify the call control capabilities of the mobile
station.
The Call Control Capabilities information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.89/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.116/GSM 04.08.
The Call Control Capabilities is a type 4 information element with a length of 3 octets.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Call Control Capabilities IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
| Length of Call Control Capabilities contents | octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 0
0
0
0
0
0 |
|
|
|
spare
| PCP |DTMF | octet 3
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.89/GSM 04.08: Call Control Capabilities information element
ETSI
520
10.5.4.6
Call state
The purpose of the call state information element is to describe the current status of a call, (see section 5.1).
The call state information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.90/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.117/GSM 04.08.
The call state is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
call state IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
coding |
|
| standard | call state value (coded in binary)| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.90/GSM 04.08: Call state information element
ETSI
521
10.5.4.7
The purpose of the called party BCD number information element is to identify the called party.
The called party BCD number information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.91/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.118/GSM 04.08.
The called party BCD number is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 3 octets and a maximum
length of 43 octets. For PCS 1900 the maximum length is 19 octets.
ETSI
522
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Called party BCD number IEI
|octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of called party BCD number contents |octet
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 1 |
type of
|
Numbering plan
|
| ext |
number
|
identification
|octet
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
|
|
|
Number digit 2
|
Number digit 1
|octet
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
|
|
|
Number digit 4
|
Number digit 3
|octet
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
|
|
:
2)
:
+-----------------------------------------------+
1
2
3
4*
5*
ETSI
523
10.5.4.8
The purpose of the Called party subaddress is to identify the subaddress of the called party of a call. For the definition
of a subaddress see Rec. CCITT I.330.
The Called party subaddress information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.92/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.119/GSM 04.08
The called party subaddress is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 2 octets and a maximum length
of 23 octets.
ETSI
524
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Called party Subaddress IEI
|octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of called party subaddress contents |octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 1 |
type of
|odd/ev| 0
0
0 |
| ext |
subaddress
|Indica|
spare
| octet 3*
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Subaddress information
| octet 4*
:
:
:
:
:
: etc.
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.92/GSM 04.08: Called party subaddress
Table 10.5.119/GSM 04.08: Called party subaddress
+-------------------------------------------------------+
| Type of subaddress (octet 3)
|
|
|
| Bits
|
| 7 6 5
|
| 0 0 0
NSAP (X.213/ISO 8348 AD2)
|
| 0 1 0
User specified
|
| All other values are reserved
|
|
|
| Odd/even indicator (octet 3)
|
| Bit
|
| 4
|
| 0
even number of address signals
|
| 1
odd number of address signals
|
|
|
| NOTE: The odd/even indicator is used when the type of |
| subaddress is "user specified" and the coding is BCD. |
|
|
| Subaddress information (octet 4, etc...)
|
| The NSAP X.213/ISO8348AD2 address shall be formatted |
| as specified by octet 4 which contains the Authority |
| and Format Identifier (AFI). The encoding is made ac- |
| cording to the "preferred binary encoding" as defined |
| in X.213/ISO8348AD2. For the definition of this type |
| of subaddress, see Rec. CCITT I.334.
|
|
|
|
|
| A coding example is given in ANNEX A.
|
|
|
| For User-specific subaddress, this field is encoded
|
| according to the user specification, subject to a
|
| maximum length of 20 octets. When interworking with
|
| X.25 networks BCD coding should be applied.
|
|
|
| NOTE: It is recommended that users apply NSAP subad- |
| dress type since this subaddress type allows the use |
| of decimal, binary and IA5 characters in a standar|
| dised manner.
|
+-------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.4.9
The purpose of the calling party BCD number information element is to identify the origin of a call.
The calling party BCD number information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.93/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.120/GSM 04.08.
The calling party BCD number is a type 4 information element. In the network to mobile station direction it has a
minimum length of 3 octets and a maximum length of 14 octets. (This information element is not used in the mobile
station to network direction.)
ETSI
525
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Calling party BCD number IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of calling party BCD number contents |
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 0/1 |
type of
|
Numbering plan
|
| ext |
number
|
identification
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 1 |presentat. | 0
0
0 | screening |
| ext | indicator |
spare
| indicator |
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
|
Number digit 2
|
Number digit 1
|
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
|
|
|
Number digit 4
|
Number digit 3
|
+-----------------------+-----------------------|
|
|
|
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 3a*
octet 4*
octet 5*
:
:
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.93/GSM 04.08: Calling party BCD number information element
The contents of octets 3, 4, etc. are coded as shown in table 10.5.118. The coding of octet 3a is defined in
table 10.5.120 below.
If the calling party BCD number contains an odd number of digits, bits 5 to 8 of the last octet shall be filled with an end
mark coded as "1111".
Table 10.5.120/GSM 04.08: Calling party BCD number
+--------------------------------------------------------+
| Presentation indicator (octet 3a)
|
| Bits
|
| 7 6
|
| 0 0
Presentation allowed
|
| 0 1
Presentation restricted
|
| 1 0
Number not available due to interworking
|
| 1 1
Reserved
|
|
|
|
|
| If octet 3a is omitted the value "00 - Presentation
|
| allowed" is assumed.
|
|
|
| Screening indicator (octet 3a)
|
|
|
| Bits
|
| 2 1
|
| 0 0
User-provided, not screened
|
| 0 1
User-provided, verified and passed
|
| 1 0
User-provided, verified and failed
|
| 1 1
Network provided
|
|
|
| If octet 3a is omitted the value "0 0 - User provided, |
| not screened" is assumed.
|
|
|
+--------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.4.10
The purpose of the Calling party subaddress is to identify a subaddress associated with the origin of a call. For the
definition of a subaddress see Rec. CCITT I.330.
The Calling party subaddress information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.94/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.121/GSM 04.08
The calling party subaddress is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 2 octets and a maximum length
of 23 octets.
ETSI
526
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Calling party Subaddress IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of calling party subaddress contents |
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 1 |
type of
|odd/ev| 0
0
0 |
| ext |
subaddress
|Indica|
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Subaddress information
|
:
:
:
:
:
:
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3*
octet 4*
etc.
10.5.4.11
Cause
The purpose of the cause information element is to describe the reason for generating certain messages, to provide
diagnostic information in the event of procedural errors and to indicate the location of the cause originator.
The cause information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.95/GSM 04.08 and tables 10.5.122 and
10.5.123/GSM 04.08.
The cause is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 4 octets and a maximum length of 32 octets.
The cause information element may be repeated in a message.
ETSI
527
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Cause IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of cause contents
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 0/1 | coding
| 0 |
|
| ext | standard |spare|
location
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 1 |
|
| ext |
recommendation
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 1 |
|
| ext |
cause value
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
diagnostic(s) if any
|
:
:
:
:
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 3a*
octet 4
octet 5*
octet N*
ETSI
528
ETSI
529
ETSI
530
ETSI
531
10.5.4.11a
CLIR suppression
The CLIR suppression information element may be sent by the mobile station to the network in the SETUP message.
The use is defined in GSM 04.81.
The CLIR suppression information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.96/GSM 04.08.
The CLIR suppression is a type 2 information element.
ETSI
532
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
CLIR suppression IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.96/GSM 04.08: CLIR suppression information element
10.5.4.11b
CLIR invocation
The CLIR invocation information element may be sent by the mobile station to the network in the SETUP message. The
use is defined in GSM 04.81.
The CLIR invocation information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.97/GSM 04.08.
The CLIR invocation is a type 2 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
CLIR invocation IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.97/GSM 04.08: CLIR invocation information element
10.5.4.12
Congestion level
The purpose of the congestion level information element is to describe the congestion status of the call.
The congestion level information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.98/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.124/GSM 04.08.
The congestion level is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|Congestion level |
| octet 1
|
|
IEI
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.98/GSM 04.08: Congestion level information element
Table 10.5.124/GSM 04.08: Congestion level information element
+-------------------------------------------------+
| Congestion level (octet 1)
|
| bits
|
| 4 3 2 1
|
| 0 0 0 0
receiver ready
|
| 1 1 1 1
receiver not ready
|
|
|
| All other values are reserved.
|
+-------------------------------------------------+
10.5.4.13
Connected number
The purpose of the connected number information element is to identify the connected party of a call.
The connected number information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.99/GSM 04.08
The connected number is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 3 octets and a maximum length of
14 octets.
ETSI
533
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+------------------------------------------------+
|
|
Connected number IEI
|
+------------------------------------------------|
|
Length of connected number contents
|
+------------------------------------------------|
| 0/1 | Type of number |
Number plan
|
| ext |
|
identification
|
+------+-----------------------------------------|
|
1 |Presentation 0
0
0 | Screening |
| ext | indicator |
Spare
| indicator |
+------------------------------------------------|
|
Number digit 2
|
Number digit 1
|
+------------------------+-----------------------|
|
Number digit 4
|
Number digit 3
|
+------------------------+-----------------------|
|
note 2)
|
|
+------------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
note 1)
octet 3a*
note 1)
octet 4*
note 1)
octet 5*
note 1)
:
:
10.5.4.14
Connected subaddress
The purpose of the connected subaddress information element is to identify a subaddress associated with the connected
party of a call.
The connected subaddress information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.100/GSM 04.08
The connected subaddress is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 2 octets and a maximum length of
23 octets.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+------------------------------------------------+
|
|
Connected subaddress IEI
|
+------------------------------------------------|
|
Length of connected subaddress contents
|
+------------------------------------------------|
| 1
|
Type of
odd/even 0
0
0 |
| ext |
subaddress indicator
Spare
|
+------------------------------------------------|
|
Subaddress information
|
:
:
:
:
:
:
+------------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3*
octet 4*
etc.
10.5.4.15
Facility
The purpose of the facility information element is to transport supplementary service related information. Within the
scope of GSM 04.08 the content of the Facility information field is an array of octets. The usage of this transportation
mechanism is defined in GSM 04.80.
The facility information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.101/GSM 04.08
The facility is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 2 octets. No upper length limit is specified except
for that given by the maximum number of octets in a L3 message (see GSM 04.06).
ETSI
534
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+------------------------------------------------+
|
|
Facility IEI
|
+------------------------------------------------|
|
Length of facility contents
|
+------------------------------------------------|
|
Facility information (see GSM04.80)
|
+------------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3-?*
10.5.4.16
The purpose of the high layer compatibility information element is to provide a means which should be used by the
remote user for compatibility checking. See annex B.
The high layer compatibility information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.102/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.125/GSM 04.08.
The high layer compatibility is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 2 octets and a maximum length
of 5 octets.
NOTE:
The high layer compatibility information element is transported transparently by a PLMN between a call
originating entity (e.g. a calling user) and the addressed entity (e.g. a remote user or a high layer function
network node addressed by the call originating entity). However, if explicitly requested by the user (at
subscription time), a network which provides some capabilities to realize teleservices may interpret this
information to provide a particular service.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
High layer compatibility IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of high layer compatibility contents | octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 1 | coding
|
|presentat. |
| ext | standard | interpretation |method of | octet 3*
|
|
|
|protocol
|
|
|
|
|profile
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 0/1 |
| octet 4*
| ext |High layer characteristics identification|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 1 | Extended high layer characteristics
|octet 4a*
| ext |
identification
| (note)
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.102/GSM 04.08: High layer compatibility information element
ETSI
535
10.5.4.16.1
Either the value part of the IE is empty, or it contains at least octet 3 and 4.
10.5.4.17
Keypad facility
The purpose of the keypad facility information element is to convey IA5 characters, e.g. entered by means of a terminal
keypad (note).
The keypad facility information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.103/GSM 04.08.
The keypad facility is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Keypad facility IEI
| octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
|Spare|
|
| 0 | Keypad information (IA5 character)
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.103/GSM 04.08: Keypad facility information element
NOTE:
10.5.4.18
In the GSM system this information element is only used to transfer one DTMF digit (0, 1, ... , 9, A, B, C,
D, *, #) as one IA5 character.
The purpose of the low layer compatibility information element is to provide a means which should be used for
compatibility checking by an addressed entity (e.g., a remote user or an interworking unit or a high layer function
network node addressed by the calling user). The low layer compatibility information element is transferred
transparently by a PLMN between the call originating entity (e.g. the calling user) and the addressed entity.
Except for the information element identifier, the low layer compatibility information element is coded as in ETS 300
102-1.
The low layer compatibility is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 2 octets and a maximum length
of 15 octets.
ETSI
536
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Low layer compatibility IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
| Length of the low layer compatibility contents| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
| octet 3*
|
The following octets are coded
|
|
as described in ETS 300 102-1
| :
|
|
|
| :
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.104/GSM 04.08: Low layer compatibility information element
If the value part of the IE is empty, the IE indicates "not applicable".
10.5.4.19
More data
The more data information element is sent by the mobile station to the network or to the network to the mobile station
in a USER INFORMATION message. The presence of the more data information element indicates to the destination
remote user/mobile station that another USER INFORMATION message will follow containing information belonging
to the same block.
The use of the more data information element is not supervised by the network.
The more data information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.105/GSM 04.08.
The more data is a type 2 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
More data IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.105/GSM 04.08: More data information element
10.5.4.20
Notification indicator
The purpose of the notification indicator information element is to indicate information pertaining to a call.
The notification indicator element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.106/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.126/ GSM 04.08.
The notification indicator is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Notification indicator IEI
| octet 1
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 1 |
| octet 2
| ext |
Notification description
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.106/GSM 04.08: Notification indicator information element
ETSI
537
10.5.4.21
Progress indicator
The purpose of the progress indicator information element is to describe an event which has occurred during the life of
a call.
The progress indicator information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.107/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.127/GSM 04.08.
The progress indicator is a type 4 information element with a length of 4 octets.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Progress indicator IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of progress indicator contents
|
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 1
| coding
| 0 |
|
| ext | standard |spare|
location
|
+-----+-----------------------------------------|
| 1 |
|
| ext |
progress description
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
ETSI
538
10.5.4.21a
The purpose of the recall type information element is to describe the reason for the recall.
The recall type information element is coded as shown in Figure 10.5.108/GSM 04.08 and Table 10.5.128/GSM 04.08.
The recall type is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
recall type IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
spare
|
recall type |
| 0
0
0
0
0 |
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.108/GSM 04.08: Recall type information element
ETSI
539
10.5.4.21b
The purpose of the redirecting party BCD number information element is to identify the redirecting party.
The redirecting party BCD number information element is coded as shown in Figure 10.88a.
The redirecting party BCD number is a type 4 information element. In the network to mobile station direction it has a
minimum length of 3 octets and a maximum length of 19 octets.
octet 1
octet 2
0/1
ext
octet 3
(note 1)
1
ext
type of
number
presentat.
indicator
Numbering plan
identification
0
0
spare
Screening
indicator
octet 3a*
(note 1)
Number digit 2
Number digit 1
octet 4*
(note 1)
Number digit 4
Number digit 3
octet 5*
(note 1)
:
Note 2)
:
Figure 10.88a/GSM 04.08:
Redirecting party BCD number information element
NOTE 1: The contents of octets 3, 4, etc. are coded as shown in Table 10.81. The coding of octet 3a is defined in
table 10.83.
NOTE 2: If the redirecting party BCD number contains an odd number of digits, bits 5 to 8 of the last octet shall be
filled with an end mark coded as "1111".
10.5.4.21c
The purpose of the Redirecting party subaddress is to identify a subaddress associated with the redirecting party. For the
definition of a subaddress see Rec. CCITT I.330.
The Redirecting party subaddress information element is coded as shown in Figure 10.88b and Table 10.84.
The Redirecting party subaddress is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 2 octets and a maximum
length of 23 octets.
ETSI
540
octet 1
octet 2
1
ext
octet 3*
type of
subaddress
odd/ev
Indica
Subaddress information
:
:
octet 4*
etc.
Figure 10.88b/GSM 04.08:
Redirecting party subaddress information element
10.5.4.22
Repeat indicator
The purpose of the repeat indicator information element is to indicate how the associated repeated information elements
shall be interpreted, when included in a message. The repeat indicator information element is included immediately
before the first occurrence of the associated information element which will be repeated in a message. "Mode 1" refers
to the first occurrence of that information element, "mode 2" refers to the second occurrence of that information element
in the same message.
The repeat indicator information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.109/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.129/GSM 04.08.
The repeat indicator is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|repeat indicator |
repeat indication
| octet 1
|
|
IEI
|
|
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.109/GSM 04.08: Repeat indicator information element
Table 10.5.129/GSM 04.08: Repeat indicator information element
+----------------------------------------------------------+
| Repeat indication (octet 1)
|
| Bits
|
| 4 3 2 1
|
| 0 0 0 1 Circular for successive selection
|
|
"mode 1 alternate mode 2"
|
| 0 0 1 1 Sequential for successive selection
|
|
"mode 1 and then mode 2"
|
|
|
| All other values are reserved.
|
|
|
+----------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.4.22a
This information element may be included in a MODIFY and MODIFY COMPLETE message to indicate that the
direction of the data call to which the MODIFY message relates is opposite to the call setup direction.
The reverse call setup direction information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.110/GSM 04.08.
The reverse call setup direction is a type 2 information element
ETSI
541
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
reverse call setup direction IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.110/GSM 04.08: Reverse call setup direction information element
10.5.4.22b
This information element contains the contents of a SETUP message (Mobile Station to Network). This means that the
Call Control protocol discriminator IE, the Transaction Identifier IE and the Setup message type IE are not included.
The SETUP Container information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.111/GSM 04.08
The SETUP Container is a type 4 information. No upper length limit is specified except for that given by the maximum
number of octets in a L3 message (see GSM 04.06).
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+------------------------------------------------+
|
|
SETUP Container IEI
|
+------------------------------------------------|
|
Length of SETUP container contents
|
+------------------------------------------------|
|
SETUP message
|
+------------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3-n
Figure 10.5.111/GSM 04.08: Octet j (j = 3, 4 ... n) is the unchanged octet j of the SETUP message
10.5.4.23
Signal
The purpose of the signal information element is to allow the network to convey information to a user regarding tones
and alerting signals (see sections 5.2.2.3.2 and 7.3.3.).
The signal information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.112/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.130/GSM 04.08.
The signal is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Signal IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Signal value
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.112/GSM 04.08: Signal information element
Table 10.5.130/GSM 04.08: Signal information element
+------------------------------------------------------+
| Signal value (octet 2)
|
| Bits
|
| 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
|
|
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
dial tone on
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
ring back tone on
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
intercept tone on
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1
network congestion tone on
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0
busy tone on
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1
confirm tone on
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0
answer tone on
|
| 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1
call waiting tone on
|
| 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
off-hook warning tone on
|
| 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1
tones off
|
| 0 1 0 0 1 1 1 1
alerting off
|
|
|
| All other values are reserved.
|
+------------------------------------------------------+
ETSI
10.5.4.24
542
SS Version Indicator
The purpose of the SS version indicator information element is to aid the decoding of the Facility information element
as described in GSM 04.10. Within the scope of GSM 04.08 the contents of the SS Version information field is an array
of one or more octets. The usage of the SS version information field is defined in GSM 04.80.
The SS version indicator information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.113/GSM 04.08
The SS version indicator is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 2 octets. No upper length limit is
specified except for that given by the maximum number of octets in a L3 message (see GSM 04.06).
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+------------------------------------------------+
|
|
SS version indicator IEI
|
+------------------------------------------------|
|
Length of SS version indicator contents
|
+------------------------------------------------|
|
SS version information (see GSM04.80)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
+------------------------------------------------+
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3*
: *
: *
10.5.4.25
User-user
The purpose of the user-user information element is to convey information between the mobile station and the remote
ISDN user.
The user-user information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.114/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.131/ GSM 04.08.
There are no restrictions on the content of the user-user information field.
The user-user is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 3 octets and a maximum length of either 35 or
131 octets. In the SETUP message the user-user information element has a maximum size of 35 octets in a
GSM PLMN. In the USER INFORMATION, ALERTING, CONNECT, DISCONNECT, PROGRESS, RELEASE and
RELEASE COMPLETE messages the user-user information element has a maximum size of 131 octets in a
GSM PLMN.
In other networks than GSM PLMNs the maximum size of the user-user information element is 35 or 131 octets in the
messages mentioned above. The evolution to a single maximum value is the long term objective; the exact maximum
value is the subject of further study.
NOTE:
ETSI
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4*
octet N*
543
10.5.4.26
The purpose of the Alerting Pattern information element is to allow the network to convey information related to the
alert to be used by the MS (see GSM 02.07).
The Alerting Pattern information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.115/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.132/GSM 04.08.
The Alerting Pattern IE is a type 4 information element with 3 octet length.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Alerting Pattern IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
length of alerting pattern content
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------|
| 0
0
0
0 |
Alerting Pattern
|
|
spare
|
value
| octet 3
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.115/GSM 04.08: Alerting Pattern information element
ETSI
544
10.5.4.27
The purpose of the Allowed actions information element is to provide the mobile station with information about further
allowed procedures.
The Allowed actions information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.116/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.133/GSM 04.08
The Allowed actions is a type 4 information element with 3 octets length
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
|
Allowed Actions IEI
| octet 1
+-----------------------------------------------|
|
|
|
Length of allowed actions contents
| octet 2
+-----------------------------------------------|
|CCBS | 0
0
0
0
0
0
0 |
|act. |
spare
| octet 3
+-----------------------------------------------+
Figure 10.5.116/GSM 04.08: Allowed actions information element
Table 10.5.133/GSM 04.08: Allowed actions information element
+---------------------------------------------------------+
| CCBS activation (octet 3)
|
|
|
| Bit
|
| 8
|
| 0
Activation of CCBS not possible
|
| 1
Activation of CCBS possible
|
+---------------------------------------------------------+
10.5.5
10.5.5.1
The purpose of the attach result information element is to specify the result of a GPRS attach procedure.
The attach result is a type 1 information element.
The attach result information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.117/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.134/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
545
Attach result
IEI
0
spare
Result of
attach
octet 1
10.5.5.2
Attach type
The purpose of the attach type information element is to indicate the type of the requested attach, i.e. whether the MS
wants to perform a GPRS or combined GPRS attach.
The attach type is a type 1 information element.
The attach type information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.118/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.135/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
Attach type
IEI
4
0
spare
Type of attach
octet 1
10.5.5.3
Ciphering algorithm
The purpose of the ciphering algorithm information element is to specify which ciphering algorithm shall be used.
The ciphering algorithm is a type 1 information element.
The ciphering algorithm information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.119/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.136/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
5
4
Ciphering algorithm
0
IEI
spare
3
2
1
Type of
algorithm
octet 1
ETSI
546
10.5.5.4
[Spare]TMSI status
The purpose of the TMSI status information element is to indicate whether a valid TMSI is available in the MS or not.
The TMSI status is a type 1 information element.
The TMSI status information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.120/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.137/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
TMSI status
IEI
3
0 0 0
spare
1
TMSI
flag
octet 1
10.5.5.5
Detach type
The purpose of the detach type information element is to indicate which type of detach is requested by the MS. In the
network to MS direction the detach type information element is used to indicate the reason why a detach request is sent.
The detach type is a type 1 information element.
The detach type information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.121/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.138/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
Detach type
IEI
4
Power
off
Type of detach
octet 1
ETSI
547
(octet 1)
ETSI
10.5.5.6
548
DRX parameter
The purpose of the DRX parameter information element is to indicate whether the MS uses DRX mode or not.
The DRX parameter is a type 3 information element with a length of 3 octets.
The value part of a DRX parameter information element is coded as shown in table 10.5.139/GSM 04.08.
8
1
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
ETSI
549
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
71
72
74
75
77
79
80
83
86
88
90
92
96
101
103
107
112
116
118
128
141
144
150
160
171
176
192
214
224
235
256
288
320
352
All other values are reserved and shall be interpreted as 1 by this version of the protocol.
SPLIT on CCCH, octet 3 (bit 4)
0 Split pg cycle on CCCH is not supported by the mobile station
1 Split pg cycle on CCCH is supported by the mobile station
non-DRX timer, octet 3
bit
3 2 1
0 0 0 no non-DRX mode after transfer
0 0 1 max. 1 sec non-DRX mode after
0 1 0 max. 2 sec non-DRX mode after
0 1 1 max. 4 sec non-DRX mode after
1 0 0 max. 8 sec non-DRX mode after
1 0 1 max. 16 sec non-DRX mode after
1 1 0 max. 32 sec non-DRX mode after
1 1 1 max. 64 sec non-DRX mode after
state
transfer
transfer
transfer
transfer
transfer
transfer
transfer
state
state
state
state
state
state
state
ETSI
10.5.5.7
550
Force to standby
The purpose of the force to standby information element is to force the MS to stop the READY timer in order to prevent
the MS to perform cell updates.
The force to standby is a type 1 information element.
The force to standby information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.123/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.140/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
Force to standby
IEI
4
0
spare
3
2
1
Force to
standby value
octet 1
10.5.5.8
P-TMSI signature
The purpose of the P-TMSI signature information element is to identify a GMM context of an MS.
The P-TMSI signature is a type 3 information element with 4 octets length.
The P-TMSI signature information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.124/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.141/GSM 04.08.
8
octet 1
octet 2
10.5.5.9
Identity type 2
The purpose of the identity type 2 information element is to specify which identity is requested.
The identity type 2 is a type 1 information element.
ETSI
551
The identity type 2 information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.125/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.142/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
Identity type 2
IEI
4
0
spare
3
2
1
Type of
identity
octet 1
10.5.5.10
IMEISV request
The purpose of the IMEISV request information element is to indicate that the IMEISV shall be included by the MS in
the authentication and ciphering response message.
The IMEISV request is a type 1 information element.
The IMEISV request information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.126/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.143/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
IMEISV request
IEI
4
0
spare
3
2
1
IMEISV request
value
octet 1
10.5.5.11
The purpose of the Receive N-PDU Numbers list information element is to specify the current SNDCP Receive N-PDU
Number values.
The Receive N-PDU Number list is a type 4 information element with a length of 4 to 17 octets.
The value part of a Receive N-PDU Number list information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.127/GSM 04.08
and table 10.5.144/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
552
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet n*
10.5.5.12
MS network capability
The purpose of the MS network capability information element is to provide the network with information concerning
aspects of the mobile station related to GPRS. The contents might affect the manner in which the network handles the
operation of the mobile station. The MS network capability information indicates general mobile station characteristics
and it shall therefore, except for fields explicitly indicated, be independent of the frequency band of the channel it is
sent on.
The MS network capability is a type 4 information element with a maximum of 3 octets length.
The value part of a MS network capabilityinformation element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.128/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.145/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
553
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
SS Screening Indicator
0 0 defined in GSM 04.80
0 1 defined in GSM 04.80
1 0 defined in GSM 04.80
1 1 defined in GSM 04.80
SM capabilities via dedicated channels
0 Mobile station does not support mobile terminated point to point SMS via
dedicated signalling channels
1 Mobile station supports mobile terminated point to point SMS via dedicated
signalling channels
SM capabilities via GPRS channels
0 Mobile station does not support mobile terminated point to point SMS via
GPRS packet data channels
1 Mobile station supports mobile terminated point to point SMS via GPRS
packet data channels
UCS2 support
This information field indicates the likely treatment by the mobile station of UCS2 encoded character strings.
0 the ME has a preference for the default alphabet (defined in GSM 03.38)
over UCS2.
1 the ME has no preference between the use of the default alphabet and the
use of UCS2.
GPRS Encryption Algorithm GEA/1
0 encryption algorithm GEA/1not available
1 encryption algorithm GEA/1 available
SoLSA Capability
0
1
ETSI
10.5.5.12a
554
The purpose of the MS RA capability information element is to provide the radio part of the network with information
concerning radio aspects of the mobile station. The contents might affect the manner in which the network handles the
operation of the mobile station.
The MS RA capability is a type 4 information element, with a minimum length of 6 octets and a maximum length of
14 octets.
The value part of a MS RA capability information element is coded a shown table 10.5.146/GSM 04.08:
-
SEMANTIC RULE: Among the three Access Type Technologies GSM 900-P, GSM 900-E and GSM 900-R
only one shall be present.
Error handling : If a received Access Technology Type is unknown to the receiver, it shall ignore all the
corresponding fields;
If within a known Access Technology Type a receiver recognizes an unknown field it shall ignore it.
See more details about error handling of MS radio access capability in TS GSM 08.18.
Due to shared radio frequency channel numbers between 1800 and 1900, the mobile should provide MS Radio
Access capability for either 900/1800 band(s) OR 1900 band.
Table 10.5.146/GSM 04.08: Mobile Station Radio Access Capability Information Element
ETSI
555
-- The presence of the Multislot capability struct is mandatory in the 1st Access capabilities struct within this IE.
< Multislot capability struct > ::=
{ 0 | 1 < HSCSD multislot class : bit (5) > }
{ 0 | 1 < GPRS multislot class : bit (5) > < GPRS Extended Dynamic Allocation Capability : bit > }
{ 0 | 1 < SMS_VALUE : bit (4) > < SM_VALUE : bit (4) > } ;
<A5 bits> ::= < A5/1 : bit> <A5/2 : bit> <A5/3 : bit> <A5/4 : bit> <A5/5 : bit> <A5/6 : bit> <A5/7 : bit>; -- bits for
circuit mode ciphering algorithms
Table 10.5.146/GSM 04.08 (continued): Mobile Station Radio Access Capability Information Element
Access Technology Type
This field indicates the access technology type to be associated with the following access capabilities.
Bits
4321
0000
GSM P
0001
GSM E --note that GSM E covers GSM P
0010
GSM R --note that GSM R covers GSM E and GSM P
0011
GSM 1800
0100
GSM 1900
All other values are treated as unknown by the receiver.
RF Power Capability
This field is coded as radio capability in Classmark 3 for the indicated band: it contains the binary coding of he power
class associated (see GSM 05.05 paragraph 4.1 output power and paragraph 4.1.1 Mobile Station).
A5/1
0 encryption algorithm A5/1 not available
1 encryption algorithm A5/1 available
A5/2
0 encryption algorithm A5/2 not available
1 encryption algorithm A5/2 available
A5/3
0 encryption algorithm A5/3 not available
1 encryption algorithm A5/3 available
A5/4
0 encryption algorithm A5/4 not available
1 encryption algorithm A5/4 available
A5/5
0 encryption algorithm A5/5 not available
1 encryption algorithm A5/5 available
A5/6
0 encryption algorithm A5/6 not available
1 encryption algorithm A5/6 available
A5/7
0 encryption algorithm A5/7 not available
1 encryption algorithm A5/7 available
ES IND (Controlled early Classmark Sending)
0 "controlled early Classmark Sending" option is not implemented
1 "controlled early Classmark Sending" option is implemented
PS (Pseudo Synchronisation)
0 PS capability not present
1 PS capability present
VGCS (Voice Group Call Service)
0 no VGCS capability or no notifications wanted
1 VGCS capability and notifications wanted
VBS (Voice Broadcast Service)
0 no VBS capability or no notifications wanted
1 VBS capability and notifications wanted
ETSI
556
Table 10.5.146/GSM 04.08 (concluded): Mobile Station Radio Access Capability Information Element
GPRS Extended Dynamic Allocation Capability
0 Extended Dynamic Allocation Capability for GPRS is not implemented
1 Extended Dynamic Allocation Capability for GPRS is implemented
10.5.5.13
Spare
10.5.5.14
GMM cause
The purpose of the GMM cause information element is to indicate the reason why a GMM request from the mobile
station is rejected by the network.
The GMM cause information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.129/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.147/GSM 04.08.
The GMM cause is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
ETSI
557
octet 1
Cause value
octet 2
value (octet 2)
5
0
0
0
4
0
0
0
3
0
0
1
2
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1
0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 1 0 0 1
0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0
0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1
0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0
0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1 0
1 0
1 0
1 0
to
0 0 1 1 1
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1 1 1
0 1 0 1 1 1 1 1
0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0
0 1 1 0 0 0 0 1
0 1 1 0 0 0 1 0
0 1 1 0 0 0 1 1
0 1 1 0 0 1 0 0
0 1 1 0 0 1 0 1
0 1 1 0 1 1 1 1
10.5.5.15
The purpose of the routing area identification information element is to provide an unambiguous identification of
routing areas within the area covered by the GSM system.
The routing area identification is a type 3 information element with 7 octets length.
The routing area identification information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.130/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.148/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
558
1
octet 1
MCC digit 2
MCC digit 1
octet 2
MNC digit 3
MCC digit 3
octet 3
MNC digit 2
MNC digit 1
octet 4
LAC
octet 5
LAC cont'd
octet 6
RAC
octet 7
ETSI
559
10.5.5.16
Spare
10.5.5.17
Update result
The purpose of the update result information element is to specify the result of the associated updating procedure.
ETSI
560
7
6
Update result
IEI
4
0
spare
3
2
1
Update result
value
octet 1
(octet 1)
Bits
3 2 1
0 0 0
0 0 1
RA updated
combined RA/LA updated
10.5.5.18
Update type
The purpose of the update type information element is to specify the area the updating procedure is associated with.
The update type is a type 1 information element.
The update type information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.132/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.150/GSM 04.08.
8
7
6
Update type
IEI
4
0
spare
3
2
1
Update type
value
octet 1
(octet 1)
Bits
3 2 1
0 0 0
0 0 1
0 1 0
0 1 1
RA updating
combined RA/LA updating
combined RA/LA updating with
IMSI attach
Periodic updating
10.5.5.19
The purpose of the A&C reference number information element is to indicate to the network in the
AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING RESPONSE message which AUTHENTICATION AND CIPHERING
REQUEST message the MS is replying to.
The A&C reference number is a type 1 information element.
The A&C reference number information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.123/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.140/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
561
8
7
6
5
A&C reference number
IEI
4
3
2
1
A&C reference number
value
octet 1
10.5.6
10.5.6.1
The purpose of the access point name information element is to identify the packet data network to which the GPRS
user wishes to connect and to notify the access point of the packet data network that wishes to connect to the MS.
The Access Point Name is a label or a full qualified domain name according to DNS naming conventions (see
GSM 03.03 [10]).
The access point name is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 3 octets and a maximum length of
102 octets.
The access point name information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.134/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.152/GSM 04.08.
8
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet n*
10.5.6.2
The purpose of the network service access point identifier information element is to identify the service access point
that is used for the GPRS data transfer at layer 3.
The network service access point identifier is a type 3 information element with a length of 2 octets.
The value part of a network service access point identifier information element is coded as shown in
figure 10.5.135/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.153/GSM 04.08.
8
NSAPI IEI
0 0 0 0
Spare
1
octet 1
NSAPI
value
octet 2
Figure 10.5.135/GSM 04.08: Network service access point identifier information element
ETSI
562
Table 10.5.153/GSM 04.08: Network service access point identifier information element
NSAPI value (octet 2)
Bit
4 3
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 1
0 1
0 1
0 1
1 0
1 0
1 0
1 0
1 1
1 1
1 1
1 1
10.5.6.3
2
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
reserved
reserved
reserved
reserved
reserved
NSAPI 5
NSAPI 6
NSAPI 7
NSAPI 8
NSAPI 9
NSAPI 10
NSAPI 11
NSAPI 12
NSAPI 13
NSAPI 14
NSAPI 15
The purpose of the protocol configuration options information element is to transfer external network protocol options
associated with a PDP context activation.
The protocol configuration options is a type 4 information element with a minimum length of 2 octets and a maximum
length of 253 octets.
The protocol configuration options information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.136/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.154/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
563
octet 1
octet 2
octet
octet
octet
octet
octet
3
4
5
6
7
Protocol ID 1 contents
Protocol ID 2
octet m
octet m+1
octet m+2
octet m+4
Protocol ID 2 contents
octet n
octet n+1
. . .
Protocol ID n-1
octet x
octet x+1
octet x+2
octet x+3
octet x+4
octet y
octet y+1
octet y+2
octet y+3
octet y+4
octet z
ETSI
564
The protocol identifier field contains the hexadecimal coding of the configuration
protocol identifier. Bit 8 of the first octet of the protocol identifier field contains
the most significant bit and bit 1 of the second octet of the protocol identifier field
contains the least significant bit.
If the configuration protocol options list contains a protocol identifier that is not
supported by the receiving entity the corresponding unit shall be discarded.
The length of the protocol identifier contents field contains the binary coded
representation of the length of the protocol identifier contents field of a unit. The
first bit in transmission order is the most significant bit.
The protocol identifier contents field of each unit contains information specific to
the configuration protocol specified by the protocol identifier.
PPP
At least the following protocol identifiers (as defined in RFC 1700) shall be
supported in this version of the protocol:
-
C021H (LCP;
C023H (PAP);
C223H (CHAP);and
8021H (IPCP).
10.5.6.4
565
The purpose of the packet data protocol address information element is to identify an address associated with a PDP.
The packet data protocol address is a type 4 information element with minimum length of 4 octets and a maximum
length of 20 octets.
The packet data protocol address information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.137/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.155/GSM 04.08.
8
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
Address information
octet n
Figure 10.5.137/GSM 04.08: Packet data protocol address information element
ETSI
566
organisation (octet 3)
network direction :
ETSI allocated address (e.g. X.121)
IETF allocated address
Empty PDP type
ETSI
567
If PDP type number indicates X.121, the Address information is coded as follows:
8
digit 2
digit 1
octet 5
digit 4
digit 3
octet 6
digit m+1
digit m
octet n*
Digit 1 contains the first BCD coded digit of the X.121 address. If the X.121 address has an odd number of digits, digit
m+1 shall be padded with HEX(F).
If PDP type number indicates IPv4, the Address information in octet 5 to octet 8 contains the IPv4 address. Bit 8 of
octet 5 represents the most significant bit of the IP address and bit 1 of octet 8 the least significant bit.
If PDP type number indicates IPv6, the Address information in octet 5 to octet 20 contains the IPv6 address. Bit 8 of
octet 5 represents the most significant bit of the IP address and bit 1 of octet 20 the least significant bit.
10.5.6.5
Quality of service
The purpose of the quality of service information element is to specify the QoS parameters for a PDP context.
The quality of service is a type 4 information element with a length of 5 octets.
The quality of service information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.138/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.156/GSM 04.08.
8
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
ETSI
568
ETSI
569
All other values are interpreted as Normal priority in this version of the protocol.
Bit 4 of octet 4 is spare and shall be coded as 0.
Peak throughput, octet 4
Bits
8765
In MS to network direction:
0 0 0 0 Subscribed peak throughput
In network to MS direction:
0 0 0 0 Reserved
In MS to network direction and in network to MS direction :
0 0 0 1 Up to 1 000 octet/s
0 0 1 0 Up to 2 000 octet/s
0 0 1 1 Up to 4 000 octet/s
0 1 0 0 Up to 8 000 octet/s
0 1 0 1 Up to 16 000 octet/s
0 1 1 0 Up to 32 000 octet/s
0 1 1 1 Up to 64 000 octet/s
1 0 0 0 Up to 128 000 octet/s
1 0 0 1 Up to 256 000 octet/s
1 1 1 1 Reserved
All other values are interpreted as Up to 1 000 octet/s in this
version of the protocol.
Mean throughput, octet 5
Bits
54321
In MS to network direction:
00000
Subscribed mean throughput
In network to MS direction:
00000
Reserved
In MS to network direction and in network to MS direction :
00001
100 octet/h
00010
200 octet/h
00011
500 octet/h
00100
1 000 octet/h
00101
2 000 octet/h
00110
5 000 octet/h
00111
10 000 octet/h
01000
20 000 octet/h
01001
50 000 octet/h
01010
100 000 octet/h
01011
200 000 octet/h
01100
500 000 octet/h
01101
1 000 000 octet/h
01110
2 000 000 octet/h
01111
5 000 000 octet/h
10000
10 000 000 octet/h
10001
20 000 000 octet/h
10010
50 000 000 octet/h
11110
Reserved
11111
Best effort
The value Best effort indicates that throughput shall be made available to the MS on a per need and availability basis.
All other values are interpreted as Best effort in this
version of the protocol.
Bits 8 to 6 of octet 5 are spare and shall be coded all 0.
ETSI
10.5.6.6
570
SM cause
The purpose of the SM cause information element is to indicate the reason why a session management request is
rejected.
The SM cause is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
The SM cause information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.139/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.157/GSM 04.08.
8
SM cause IEI
octet 1
Cause value
octet 2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
0 1 1 0 0 0 1 0
0 1 1 0 0 0 1 1
0 1 1 0 0 1 0 0
0 1 1 0 0 1 0 1
0 1 1 0 1 1 1 1
10.5.6.7
Spare
10.5.6.8
AA deactivation cause
The purpose of the AA deactivation cause information element is to indicate the reason why a AA PDP context was
deactivated by the network.
ETSI
571
The AA deactivation cause information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.140/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.158/GSM 04.08.
The AA deactivation cause is a type 1 information element.
8
7
6
5
4
AA deactivation
0
cause indicator IEI spare
3
2
1
AA deactivation
cause value
octet 1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Normal, unspecified
Server address violation
Network overload
Server not reachable
10.5.6.9
The purpose of the LLC service access point identifier information element is to identify the service access point that is
used for the GPRS data transfer at LLC layer.
The LLC service access point identifier is a type 3 information element with a length of 2 octets.
The value part of a LLC service access point identifier information element is coded as shown in
figure 10.5.141/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.159/GSM 04.08.
8
5
4
LLC SAPI IEI
0 0 0 0
Spare
LLC SAPI
value
1
octet 1
octet 2
Figure 10.5.141/GSM 04.08: LLC service access point identifier information element
Table 10.5.159/GSM 04.08: LLC service access point identifier information element
LLC SAPI value (octet 2
Bit
4 3
0 0
0 1
1 0
2
1
0
1
1
1 SAPI 3
1 SAPI 51 0 0 1 SAPI 9
1 SAPI 11
ETSI
10.5.7
572
10.5.7.1
[Spare]
10.5.7.2
Radio priority
The purpose of the radio priority information element is to specify the priority level that the MS shall use at the lower
layers for transmission of data related to a PDP context or for mobile originated SMS transmission.
The radio priority information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.143/GSM 04.08 and
table 10.5.161/GSM 04.08.
The radio priority is a type 1 information element.
8
4
0
spare
3
2
1
Radio priority
level value
octet 1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
priority
priority
priority
priority
level
level
level
level
1 (highest)
2
3
4 (lowest)
10.5.7.3
GPRS Timer
The purpose of the GPRS timer information element is to specify GPRS specific timer values, e.g. for the READY
timer.
The GPRS timer is a type 3 information element with 2 octets length.
The GPRS timer information element is coded as shown in figure 10.5.144/GSM 04.08 and table 10.5.162/GSM 04.08.
8
Timer value
1
octet 1
octet 2
ETSI
573
ETSI
11
574
The description of timers in the following table should be considered a brief summary. The precise details are found in
sections 3 to 6, which should be considered the definitive descriptions.
11.1
11.1.1
T3122:
This timer is used during random access, after the receipt of an IMMEDIATE ASSIGN REJECT
message.
Its value is given by the network in the IMMEDIATE ASSIGN REJECT message.
T3124:
This timer is used in the seizure procedure during a hand-over, when the two cells are not
synchronized.
Its purpose is to detect the lack of answer from the network to the special signal.
Its value is set to 675 ms if the channel type of the channel allocated in the HANDOVER
COMMAND is an SDCCH (+ SACCH); otherwise its value is set to 320 ms.
T3126:
T3128:
This timer is started when the mobile station starts the uplink investigation procedure and the
uplink is busy.
It is stopped at receipt of the first UPLINK FREE message.
At its expiry, the uplink investigation procedure is aborted.
The value of this timer is set to 1 second.
T3130:
This timer is started after sending the first UPLINK ACCESS message during a VGCS uplink
access procedure.
It is stopped at receipt of a VGCS ACCESS GRANT message.
At its expiry, the uplink access procedure is aborted.
The value of this timer is set to 5 seconds.
T3110:
This timer is used to delay the channel deactivation after the receipt of a (full) CHANNEL
RELEASE. Its purpose is to let some time for disconnection of the main signalling link.
Its value is set to such that the DISC frame is sent twice in case of no answer from the network. (It
should be chosen to obtain a good probability of normal termination (i.e. no time out of T3109) of
the channel release procedure.)
ETSI
T3134
575
This timer is used in the seizure procedure during an RR network commanded cell change order
procedure. Its purpose is to detect the lack of answer from the network or the lack of availability of
the target cell.
Its value is set to 5 seconds.
T3142:
The timer is used during packet access on CCCH, after the receipt of an IMMEDIATE
ASSIGNMENT REJECT message.
Its value is given by the network in the IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT message.
T3146:
T3164:
This timer is used during packet access using CCCH. It is started at the receipt of an IMMEDIATE
ASSIGNMENT message.
It is stopped at the transmission of a RLC/MAC block on the assigned temporary block flow, see
GSM 04.60.
At expire, the mobile station returns to the packet idle mode.
The value of the timer is 5 seconds.
T3190:
The timer is used during packet downlink assignment on CCCH. It is started at the receipt of an
IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT message or of an PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message
when in dedicated mode.
It is stopped at the receipt of a RLC/MAC block on the assigned temporary block flow, see
GSM 04.60.
At expiry, the mobile station returns to the packet idle mode.
The value of the timer is 5 seconds.
11.1.2
T3101:
NOTE 1: It could be higher than the maximum time for a L2 establishment attempt.
T3103:
This timer is started by the sending of a HANDOVER message and is normally stopped when the
MS has correctly seized the new channel. Its purpose is to keep the old channels sufficiently long
for the MS to be able to return to the old channels, and to release the channels if the MS is lost.
Its value is network dependent.
ETSI
576
NOTE 2: It could be higher than the maximum transmission time of the HANDOVER COMMAND, plus the value
of T3124, plus the maximum duration of an attempt to establish a data link in multiframe mode.)
T3105:
This timer is used for the repetition of the PHYSICAL INFORMATION message during the handover procedure.
Its value is network dependent.
NOTE 3: This timer may be set to such a low value that the message is in fact continuously transmitted.
T3107:
This timer is started by the sending of an ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message and is normally
stopped when the MS has correctly seized the new channels.
Its purpose is to keep the old channel sufficiently long for the MS to be able to return to the old
channels, and to release the channels if the MS is lost.
Its value is network dependent.
NOTE 4: It could be higher than the maximum transmission time of the ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message
plus twice the maximum duration of an attempt to establish a data link multiframe mode.
T3109:
This timer is started when a lower layer failure is detected by the network, when it is not engaged
in a RF procedure. It is also used in the channel release procedure.
Its purpose is to release the channels in case of loss of communication.
Its value is network dependent.
NOTE 5: Its value should be large enough to ensure that the MS detects a radio link failure.
T3111:
This timer is used to delay the channel deactivation after disconnection of the main signalling link.
Its purpose is to let some time for possible repetition of the disconnection.
Its value is equal to the value of T3110.
T3113:
This timer is started when the network has sent a PAGING REQUEST message and is stopped
when the network has received the PAGING RESPONSE message.
Its value is network dependent.
NOTE 6: The value could allow for repetitions of the Channel Request message and the requirements associated
with T3101.
T3115:
This timer is used for the repetition of the VGCS UPLINK GRANT message during the uplink
access procedure.
Its value is network dependent.
NOTE 7: This timer may be set to such a low value that the message is in fact continuously transmitted.
T3117:
This timer is started by the sending of a PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND message and is
normally stopped when the MS has correctly accessed the target TBF.
Its purpose is to keep the old channel sufficiently long for the MS to be able to return to the old
channels, and to release the channels if the MS is lost.
Its value is network dependent.
NOTE 8: It could be higher than the maximum transmission time of the PDCH ASSIGNMENT COMMAND
message plus T3132 plus the maximum duration of an attempt to establish a data link in multiframe
mode.
T3119:
This timer is started by the sending of a RR-CELL CHANGE ORDER message and is normally
stopped when the MS has correctly accessed the new cell. Its purpose is to keep the old channels
sufficiently long for the MS to be able to return to the old channels, and to release the channels if
the MS is lost.
ETSI
577
This timer is started when a temporary block flow is allocated with an IMMEDIATE
ASSIGNMENT message during a packet access procedure. It is stopped when the mobile station
has correctly seized the temporary block flow.
Its value is network dependent.
11.1.3
Other parameters
Ny1:
The maximum number of repetitions for the PHYSICAL INFORMATION message during a
handover (see section 3.4.4.2.2). The value is network dependent.
Ny2:
The maximum number of repetitions for the VGCS UPLINK GRANT message during an uplink
access procedure (see section 3.3.1.2.2). The value is network dependent.
ETSI
11.2
578
ETSI
579
11.2.1
Timer T3240
the mobile station receives a LOCATION UPDATING ACCEPT message completing a location updating
procedure in the cases specified in subclauses 4.4.4.6 and 4.4.4.8;
the mobile station receives a LOCATION UPDATING REJECT message in the cases specified in
subclause 4.4.4.7;
the mobile station has sent a CM SERVICE ABORT message as specified in subclause 4.5.1.7;
the mobile station has released or aborted all MM connections in the cases specified in subclauses 4.3.2.5,
4.3.5.2, 4.5.1.1, and 4.5.3.1.
ETSI
11.2.2
580
TIMER
NUM.
T3310
TIMER
VALUE
15s
STATE
CAUSE OF START
ON THE
NORMAL STOP
st
nd
rd
th
1 ,2 ,3 ,4
EXPIRY Note 3
GMMREG-INIT
ATTACH ACCEPT
received
Retransmission of
ATTACH REQ
ATTACH REJECT
received
T3311
Change of the
routing area
Restart of the
Attach or the RAU
procedure with
updating of the
relevant attempt
counter
DETACH ACCEPT
received
Retransmission of
the DETACH REQ
ROUTING AREA
UPDATE ACC
received
Retransmission of
the ROUTING
AREA UPDATE
REQUEST
message
15s
GMM-REG
ATTEMPTING
TO UPDATE
T3321
15s
GMMDEREG-INIT
T3330
GMMROUTINGUPDATINGINITIATED
15s
ROUTING AREA
UPDATE REJ
received
TIMER
VALUE
T3302
T3212
Note 4
T3312
Default
54 min
T3314
READY
Default
44 sec
Note 2
T3316
AAREADY
Default
44 sec
Note 2
STATE
CAUSE OF START
Note1
All except GMM- Transmission of a PTP PDU
DEREG
-
ON
EXPIRY
NORMAL STOP
GPRS attach
procedure
or
RAU procedure
No cell-updates are
performed
NOTE 1: The value of this timer is used if the network does not indicate another value in a GMM signalling
procedure.
NOTE 2: The default value of this timer is used if neither the MS nor the Network send another value, or if the
Network sends this value, in a signalling procedure.
ETSI
581
NOTE 3: Typically, the procedures are aborted on the fifth expiry of the relevant timer. Exceptions are described in
the corresponding procedure description.
NOTE 4: T3302 is loaded with the same value which is used to load T3212.
Table 11.4/GSM 04.08: GPRS Mobility management timers - network side
TIMER
NUM.
TIMER
VALUE
STATE
CAUSE OF START
ON THE
NORMAL STOP
st
nd
rd
th
1 ,2 ,3 ,4
EXPIRY Note 3
T3322
6s
GMMDEREG-INIT
T3350
6s
GMMCOMMONPROC-INIT
ATTACH ACCEPT
sent with P-TMSI and/or TMSI
ATTACH
COMPLETE
received
RAU COMPLETE
received
P-TMSI REALLOC
COMPLETE
received
Retransmission of
the same message
type, i.e. ATTACH
ACCEPT, RAU
ACCEPT or
REALLOC
COMMAND
T3360
6s
GMMCOMMONPROC-INIT
Retransmission of
AUTH AND CIPH
REQUEST
T3370
6s
GMMCOMMONPROC-INIT
IDENTITY
RESPONSE
received
Retransmission of
IDENTITY
REQUEST
TIMER
VALUE
Note1
T3314
Default
44 sec
Note 2
READY
STATE
GMM_REG
CAUSE OF START
Paging procedure initiated
Mobile Default 4
All except GMM- Change from READY to
Reachable min greater
DEREG
STANDBY state
than T3312
NORMAL STOP
Paging procedure
completed
Forced to Standby
ON
EXPIRY
Network dependent
The network shall
page the MS if a
PTP PDU has to be
sent to the MS
Network dependent
but typically paging
is halted on 1st
expiry
ETSI
11.2.3
582
TIMER
NUM.
T3380
TIMER
VALUE
30s
STATE
CAUSE OF START
ON THE
NORMAL STOP
st
1
PDPACTIVE-PEND
ACTIVATE
PDP CONTEXT
ACCEPT received
nd
rd
th
,2 ,3 ,4
EXPIRY
Retransmission of
ACTIVATE PDP
CONTEXT REQ
ACTIVATE
PDP CONTEXT
REJECT received
T3390
PDPINACT-PEND
8s
NOTE: Typically, the procedures are aborted on the fifth expiry of the relevant timer. Exceptions are described in the
corresponding procedure description.
Table 11.2d/GSM 04.08: Session management timers - network side
TIMER
NUM.
TIMER
VALUE
STATE
CAUSE OF START
ON THE
NORMAL STOP
st
nd
rd
th
,2 ,3 ,4
EXPIRY
T3385
8s
PDPACT-PEND
ACTIVATE PDP
CONTEXT REQ
received
Retransmission of
REQUEST PDP
CONTEXT
ACTIVATION
T3386
8s
PDPMOD-PEND
MODIFY PDP
CONTEXT ACC
received
Retransmission of
MODIFY PDP
CONTEXT REQ
T3395
8s
PDPINACT-PEND
T3397
8s
PDPINACT-PEND
DEACTIVATE AA PDP
CONTEXT REQUEST sent
DEACTIVATE AA
PDP CONTEXT
ACCEPT received
NOTE:
Retransmission of
DEACTIVATE AA
PDP CONTEXT
REQUEST
Typically, the procedures are aborted on the fifth expiry of the relevant timer. Exceptions are described in
the corresponding procedure description.
ETSI
11.3
583
NOTE 1: T310 is not started if progress indicator #1, #2, or #64 has been delivered in the CALL PROCEEDING
message or in a previous PROGRESS message.
ETSI
584
ETSI
585
Annex A (informative):
Example of subaddress information element coding
This annex is informative.
This annex gives an example of how the Called Party Subaddress IE is encoded to carry subaddress digits that use IA5
characters. This example is also applicable to the Calling Party Subaddress IE.
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
octet
+-----------------------------------------------------+
| 0 | 1
1
0
1
1
0
1 |
1
|
|
called party subaddress IEI
|
+-----------------------------------------------------|
| 0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1 |
2
|
Length
|
+-----------------------------------------------------|
| 1 | 0
0
0
| X
| 0
0
0 |
3
| not |
NSAP
|odd/ev|
|
| ext |(X.213/ISO 8348 AD2)|note 1|
note 2
|
+--------------------------+--------------------------|
| 0
1
0
1
0
0
0
0 |
4
|
AFI (note 3)
|
+--------------------------+--------------------------|
|
IA5 Character (note 4)
|
5
+--------------------------+--------------------------|
|
IA5 Character (note 4)
|
6
+--------------------------+--------------------------|
.
.
.
.
+--------------------------+--------------------------|
|
IA5 Character (note 4)
|
9,
+-----------------------------------------------------+ note 5
NOTE 1: The value of this bit has no significance when the type of subaddress is "NSAP".
NOTE 2: These bits are spare.
NOTE 3: The Authority and Format Identifier code 50 (in BCD) indicates that the subaddress consists of IA5
characters (see ISO standard 8348 AD2).
NOTE 4: IA5 character as defined in CCITT Recommendation T.50/ISO 646 and then encoded into two semioctets according to the "preferred binary encoding" defined in X.213/ISO 8348 AD2. (Each character is
converted into a number in the range 32 to 127 using the ISO 646 encoding with zero parity and the parity
bit in the most significant position. This number is then reduced by 32 to give a new number in the range
0 to 95. The new number is then treated as a pair of decimal digits with the value of each digit being
encoded in a semi-octet.)
NOTE 5: the number of IA5 characters in the subaddress may vary, subject to an upper limit of 19 IA5 characters.
ETSI
586
Annex B (normative):
Compatibility checking
This annex is normative.
B.1
Introduction
This annex describes the various compatibility checks which shall be carried out to ensure that the best matched MS and
network capabilities are achieved on a call between a PLMN and the ISDN.
Three different processes of compatibility checking shall be performed:
i) at the user-to-network interface on the calling side (see clause B.2);
ii) at the network-user interface on the called side (see subclause B.3.2);
iii) user-to-user (see subclause B 3.3).
NOTE:
In this context and throughout this annex the term "called user" is the end point entity which is explicitly
addressed.
For details on the coding of the information required for compatibility checking, see annex C.
B.2
B.2.1
The network shall check if the service requested in the CM SERVICE REQUEST message is permitted for that
subscriber.
B.2.2
At the calling side the network shall check that the basic service(s) requested by the calling MS in the Bearer Capability
information element(s) match(es) with the basic services provided to that subscriber by the PLMN. If for at least one
bearer capability information element contained in the SETUP message a mismatch is detected, then the network shall
proceed as follows:
-
if the SETUP message contained two bearer capability information elements for only one of which a mismatch is
detected, the network shall either:
-
under the conditions specified in GSM 07.01 (e.g. TS 61 and TS 62), accept the SETUP message with a
CALL PROCEEDING message containing the, possibly negotiated, bearer capability information element
for which no mismatch is detected, or
otherwise the network shall reject the call using one of the causes listed in annex H.
Network services are described in GSM 02.02 and GSM 02.03 as bearer services and teleservices, respectively.
ETSI
B.3
587
In this section, the word "check" means that the MS examines the contents of the specified information element.
B.3.1
If an incoming SETUP message is offered to the MS with addressing information (i.e. sub-address or called party
number) the following shall occur:
a) if the MS has a DDI number or a sub-address, then the information in any Called Party BCD Number or any
Called Party subaddress information elements of the incoming SETUP message shall be checked by the MS
against the corresponding part of the number assigned to the user (e.g. for DDI) or the user's own sub-address.
In the cases of a mismatch, the MS shall release the call. In the case of a match, the compatibility checking
described in B.3.2 and B.3.3 shall be performed.
b) if the MS has no DDI number and no sub-address, then the Called Party BCD Number and Called Party Subaddress information element shall be ignored for the purposes of compatibility checking. The compatibility
checking described in B.3.2 and B.3.3 shall be performed.
NOTE:
B.3.2
According to the user's requirements, compatibility checking can be performed in various ways from the
viewpoint of execution order and information to be checked, e.g. first DDI number/sub-address and then
bearer capability or vice versa.
When the network is providing a basic service at the called side, the MS shall check that the basic service(s) offered by
the network in the Bearer Capability information element(s) match(es) the basic services that the MS is able to support.
If a mismatch is detected, then the MS shall proceed as follows:
-
if the SETUP message contained two bearer capability information elements for only one of which a mismatch is
detected, the MS shall either:
-
under the conditions specified in GSM 07.01 (e.g. TS 61 and TS 62), accept the SETUP message with a
CALL CONFIRMED message containing the, possibly negotiated, bearer capability information element for
which no mismatch is detected, or
otherwise the MS shall reject the offered call using a RELEASE COMPLETE message with cause No. 88
"incompatible destination".
When interworking with existing networks, limitations in network or distant user signalling (e.g. in the case of an
incoming call from a PSTN or a call from an analogue terminal) may restrict the information available to the called MS
in the incoming SETUP message (e.g. missing Bearer Capability Information Element or missing High Layer
Compatibility Information Element). For compatibility checking, and handling of such calls see GSM 07.01.
B.3.3
B.4
ETSI
588
Annex C (normative):
Low layer information coding principles
This annex is normative.
C.1
Purpose
This annex describes principles that shall be used when the calling MS specifies information during call setup regarding
low layer capabilities required in the network and by the destination terminal. Refer also to GSM 07.01.
NOTE:
In this context and throughout this annex the term "called user" is the end point entity which is explicitly
addressed. This may also be an explicitly addressed interworking unit (IWU) (see CCITT I.500-Series
Recommendations and CCITT Recommendation X.31 case a).
C.2
Principles
C.2.1
There are three different types of information that the calling PLMN user may specify during call setup to identify low
layer capabilities needed in the network and in the destination terminal:
a) type I information is information about the calling terminal which is only used at the destination end to allow a
decision regarding terminal compatibility. An example would be the user information layer 3 protocol. Type I
information is encoded in octets 5 to 7 of the low layer compatibility information element;
b) type II information is only used by the network (PLMN) to which the calling user is connected for selection of
PLMN specific network resources, e.g. channel type or specific functionality within the interworking function
(IWF, see TS 09.07). This type of information is always present. An example is the connection element. Type II
information is coded in:
i) octet 3 of the bearer capability information element when the information transfer capability required by the
calling user is speech ;
ii) octets 3, 4, 5, and optionally octet 7 of the bearer capability information element when the information
transfer capability required by the calling user is not speech;
c) type III information is required for selection of a basic service from the choice of basic services offered by the
network and together with type II information for selection of an appropriate interworking function (IWF, see
GSM 09.07), as well as for terminal compatibility checking at the destination terminal . An example is the
information transfer capability. Type III information is always present and is encoded in:
i) octet 3 of the bearer capability information element when the information transfer capability required by the
calling user is speech ;
ii) octets 3, 5, 6, 6a, 6b and 6c of the bearer capability information element when the information transfer
capability required by the calling user is not speech;
C.2.2
Examination by network
Type I information is user-to-user (i.e. at the calling side not examined by network) while type II and III information
should be available for examination by the destination user and the network.
NOTE:
In the case of a mobile terminated call, if the type II and type III information is not sufficient for the
selection of an appropriate interworking function, the type I information will also examined by the
network.
ETSI
C.2.3
589
Type I information (i.e. terminal information only significant to the called user) shall, when used, be included in the low
layer compatibility information element.
C.2.4
Type II information is included in the bearer capability information element. Type III information is also included in
the bearer capability information element. The network may use and modify type III information (e.g. to provide
interworking).
In any case a modification of the bearer capability information element has to be performed when interworking to the
fixed network (e.g. ISDN) is required, where the signalling of the radio interface has to be mapped to fixed network
signalling (e.g. mapping of GSM BCIE to ISDN BCIE, see GSM 09.07).
C.2.5
There shall be no contradiction of information between the low layer compatibility and the bearer capability at the
originating side. However, as some bearer capability code points may be modified during the transport of the call
(e.g. by the interworking function), this principle implies that there should be minimal duplication of information
between the bearer capability information element and the low layer compatibility information element.
NOTE:
If as a result of duplication, a contradiction occurs at the terminating side between the bearer capability
information element and the low layer compatibility information element at the terminating side, the
receiving entity shall ignore the conflicting information in the low layer compatibility information
element.
ETSI
590
Annex D (informative):
Examples of bearer capability information element coding
This annex is informative.
This annex gives examples of the coding of bearer capability information elements for various telecommunication
services. This annex is included for information purposes only. In the case of any inconsistency between this annex and
GSM 07.01 then GSM 07.01 shall take precedence over this annex.
D.1
D.1.1
D.1.2
ETSI
591
D.2
D.2.1
ETSI
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 6a
octet 6b
octet 6c
D.2.2
592
ETSI
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 6a
octet 6b
octet 6c
593
D.3
D.3.1
ETSI
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 6a
octet 6b
octet 6c
D.3.2
594
ETSI
octet 1
octet 2
octet 3
octet 4
octet 5
octet 6
octet 6a
octet 6b
octet 6c
595
Annex E (informative):
Comparison between call control procedures specified in
GSM 04.08 and CCITT Recommendation Q.931
This annex is informative.
This annex summarizes a comparison of the procedures for call control as specified in CCITT Recommendation Q.931
(blue book) and GSM 04.08.
If no comment is given, it means that the procedures specified in CCITT Recommendation Q.931 and GSM 04.08 are
similar. However, it should be noted that even in such cases the procedures may be described in slightly different ways
in the two documents.
Table E.1/GSM 04.08: Circuit-switched call control procedures
+-------------------------------------------------------------+
|
Procedure
|
Q.931
|
GSM 04.08
|
+----------------------+-------------+------------------------|
|Call establishment at | 5.1
| 5.2.1
|
|the originating
|
|
|
|interface
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| - call request
| 5.1.1
| 5.2.1.1.1
|
|
|
| en-bloc sending only
|
|
|
|
|
| - B-channel selection| 5.1.2
| not applicable
|
|
originating
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| - overlap sending
| 5.1.3
| not supported
|
|
|
|
|
| - invalid call
| 5.1.4
| 5.2.1.1.2
|
|
information
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| - call proceeding,
| 5.1.5.1
| 5.2.1.1.3
|
|
en-bloc sending
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| - call proceeding,
| 5.1.5.2
| not supported
|
|
overlap sending
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| - notification of
| 5.1.6
| 5.2.1.1.4
|
|
interworking at the|
|
|
|
originating interf.|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| - call confirmation | 5.1.7
| 5.2.1.1.5
|
|
indication
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| - call connected
| 5.1.8
| 5.2.1.1.6
|
|
|
|
|
| - call rejection
| 5.1.9
| 5.2.1.1.7
|
|
|
|
|
| - transit network
| 5.1.10
| 5.2.1.1.8
|
|
selection
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
+-------------------------------------------------------------+
ETSI
596
ETSI
597
ETSI
598
ETSI
599
Annex F (informative):
GSM specific cause values for radio resource management
This annex is informative.
Cause value = 0 Normal event;
indicates that the channel is released because of a normal event or that an assignment or handover is
successfully, and normally, completed.
Cause value = 1 Abnormal release, unspecified;
indicates that the channel is released because of an abnormal event without specifying further reasons.
Cause value = 2 Abnormal release, channel unacceptable;
indicates that the channel type or channel characteristics are not acceptable.
Cause value = 3 Abnormal release, timer expired;
indicates that the release is caused by a timer expiry.
Cause value = 4 Abnormal release, no activity on the radio path;
indicates that some supervisory function has detected that the channel is not active.
Cause value = 5 Pre-emptive release;
indicates that the channel is released in order to be allocated to a call with priority (e.g. an emergency call).
Cause value = 8 Handover impossible, timing advance out of range;
indicates that a handover is unsuccessful because the target BTS is beyond the normal range and the target BTS
would not accept an out of range timing advance.
Cause value = 9 Channel mode unacceptable
indicates that the MS does not have the capability to handle the requested mode or type of channel.
Cause value = 10 Frequency not implemented
indicates that the MS does not have the capability to operate on (at least one of) the requested frequency(ies).
Cause value = 65 Call already cleared;
indicates that a handover is unsuccessful because the connection has been released by the network or the remote
user.
Cause value = 95 Semantically incorrect message;
See annex H, section H5.10.
Cause value = 96 Invalid mandatory information;
See annex H, section H6.1.
Cause value = 97 Message type non-existent or not implemented;
See annex H, section H6.2.
Cause value = 98 Message type not compatible with protocol state;
See annex H, section H6.3
Cause value = 100 Conditional IE error;
ETSI
600
ETSI
601
Annex G (informative):
GSM specific cause values for mobility management
This annex is informative. It describes the cause values for the mobility management procedures for non-GPRS services
(MM) and GPRS services (GMM). Sections G1 to G5 are valid for both MM and GMM. However, the following codes
are applicable for non-GPRS services only:
#38 Call cannot be identified
Section G.6 applies only for GMM procedures.
G.1
G.2
ETSI
G.3
602
G.4
G.5
ETSI
603
G.6
ETSI
604
Annex H (informative):
GSM specific cause values for call control
This annex is informative.
H.1
Normal class
H.1.1
This cause indicates that the destination requested by the mobile station cannot be reached because, although the
number is in a valid format, it is not currently assigned (allocated).
H.1.2
This cause indicates that the called user cannot be reached because the network through which the call has been routed
does not serve the destination desired.
H.1.3
This cause indicates the channel most recently identified is not acceptable to the sending entity for use in this call.
H.1.4
This cause indicates that the MS has tried to access a service that the MS's network operator or service provider is not
prepared to allow.
H.1.5
This cause indicates that the call is being cleared because one of the users involved in the call has requested that the call
be cleared.
Under normal situations, the source of this cause is not the network.
H.1.6
This cause is used when the called user has indicated the inability to accept another call.
It is noted that the user equipment is compatible with the call.
H.1.7
This cause is used when a user does not respond to a call establishment message with either an alerting or connect
indication within the prescribed period of time allocated (defined by the expiry of either timer T303 or T310).
H.1.8
This cause is used when a user has provided an alerting indication but has not provided a connect indication within a
prescribed period of time.
ETSI
H.1.9
605
This cause indicates that the equipment sending this cause does not wish to accept this call, although it could
have accepted the call because the equipment sending this cause is neither busy nor incompatible.
H.2
H.2.1
This cause indicates that there is no appropriate circuit/channel presently available to handle the call.
H.2.2
This cause indicates that the network is not functioning correctly and that the condition is likely to last a relatively long
period of time; e.g., immediately re-attempting the call is not likely to be successful.
ETSI
H.2.3
606
This cause indicates that the network is not functioning correctly and that the condition is not likely to last a long period
of time; e.g., the mobile station may wish to try another call attempt almost immediately.
H.2.4
This cause indicates that the switching equipment generating this cause is experiencing a period of high traffic.
H.2.5
This cause indicates that the network could not deliver access information to the remote user as requested; i.e., a userto-user information, low layer compatibility, high layer compatibility, or sub-address as indicated in the diagnostic.
It is noted that the particular type of access information discarded is optionally included in the diagnostic.
H.2.6
This cause is returned when the circuit or channel indicated by the requesting entity cannot be provided by the other
side of the interface.
H.2.7
This cause is used to report a resource unavailable event only when no other cause in the resource unavailable class
applies.
H.3
H.3.1
This cause indicates to the mobile station that the requested quality of service, as defined in CCITT Recommendation
X.213, cannot be provided.
H.3.2
This cause indicates that the requested supplementary service could not be provided by the network because the user
has no completed the necessary administrative arrangements with its supporting networks.
H.3.3
This cause indicates that although the called party is a member of the CUG for the incoming CUG call, incoming calls
are not allowed within this CUG.
H.3.4
This cause indicates that the mobile station has requested a bearer capability which is implemented by the equipment
which generated this cause but the mobile station is not authorized to use.
ETSI
H.3.5
607
This cause indicates that the mobile station has requested a bearer capability which is implemented by the equipment
which generated this cause but which is not available at this time.
H.3.6
This cause is used to report a service or option not available event only when no other cause in the service or option not
available class applies.
H.3.7
This cause is used by the mobile to indicate that call clearing is due to ACM being greater than or equal to ACMmax.
H.4
H.4.1
This cause indicates that the equipment sending this cause does not support the bearer capability requested.
H.4.2
This cause indicates that the equipment sending this cause does not support the requested supplementary service.
H.4.3
This cause indicates that one equipment has requested an unrestricted bearer service, but that the equipment
sending this cause only supports the restricted version of the requested bearer capability.
H.4.4
This cause is used to report a service or option not implemented event only when no other cause in the service or
option not implemented class applies.
H.5
H.5.1
This cause indicates that the equipment sending this cause has received a message with a transaction identifier
which is not currently in use on the MS-network interface.
H.5.2
This cause indicates that the called user for the incoming CUG call is not a member of the specified CUG.
ETSI
H.5.3
608
This cause indicates that the equipment sending this cause has received a request to establish a call which has
low layer compatibility, high layer compatibility, or other compatibility attributes (e.g., data rate) which cannot
be accommodated.
H.5.4
H.5.5
This cause is used to report receipt of a message with semantically incorrect contents (see subclause 8.8).
H.6
H.6.1
This cause indicates that the equipment sending this cause has received a message with a non-semantical
mandatory IE error (see subclause 8.5).
H.6.2
This cause indicates that the equipment sending this cause has received a message with a message type it does
not recognize either because this is a message not defined, or defined but not implemented by the equipment
sending this cause.
H.6.3
This cause indicates that the equipment sending this cause has received a message not compatible with the
protocol state (subclause 8.4).
H.6.4
This cause indicates that the equipment sending this cause has received a message which includes information
elements not recognized because the information element identifier is not defined or it is defined but not
implemented by the equipment sending the cause. However, the information element is not required to be
present in the message in order for the equipment sending the cause to process the message.
H.6.5
This cause indicates that the equipment sending this cause has received a message with conditional IE errors (see
subclause 8.7.2).
ETSI
H.6.6
609
This cause indicates that a message has been received which is incompatible with the protocol state or that a
STATUS message has been received indicating an incompatible call state.
H.6.7
This cause indicates that a procedure has been initiated by the expiry of a timer in association with TS 04.08
error handling procedures.
H.6.8
This cause is used to report a protocol error event only when no other cause in the protocol error class applies.
H.7
Interworking class
H.7.1
This cause indicates that there has been interworking with a network which does not provide causes for actions it
takes; thus, the precise cause for a message which is being sent cannot be ascertained.
ETSI
610
Annex I (informative):
GSM specific cause values for session management
This annex is informative.
I.1
ETSI
611
I.2
ETSI
612
Annex J (informative):
Algorithm to encode frequency list information elements
This annex is informative.
J.1
Introduction
Some information elements encode frequency lists with a special method. The main specification specifies the meaning
of the fields and hence the way to decode them, but the corresponding encoding algorithm is difficult to infer from the
decoding algorithm. This annex is intended as an aid for implementers of the encoding algorithm.
It could be shown that any set of frequency with less or the same number of frequencies as the number of words can be
encoded with a careful choice of F1, F2, and so on, i.e. that a set of Wi can be found so that the decoding algorithm
given in the main section will give back the frequency set. The right order is not the order of the frequency values.
J.2
General principle
The encoding algorithm is based on a recursive dichotomy of both the range (i.e. the set of values that are possible) and
the subset (the values to encode).
512
511
1022
1023
0
1
2
3
The dichotomy is best understood if the range is seen as a circle. For instance, for the 1023 range:
ETSI
613
50
90
250
290
650
480
600
Figure J.2: Example of dichotomy
The pivot value is part of the information field, then the two sub-subsets are renumbered and the same algorithm is
applied again on each of them. Because the range is halved at each step, the number of bits needed to encode a pivot
value is 1 bit less than the number of bits needed to encode the parent pivot value.
The convention is that if the number of values is even, the left sub-subset (that is to say the values that can be expressed
as the pivot value minus some integer between 1 and half the range) will have 1 element more than the right subset.
At each step the subset is numbered from 0 to the range minus 1. The coding in the information field of the pivot value
is its value as renumbered, plus 1. Value 0 is reserved to indicate no element.
The order of appearance in the information field of the successive pivot values is particular. If we present the values as
organized as a tree, with the left child being the pivot of the left sub-subset and the right child the pivot of the right subsubset, the order of appearance is given by the following tree:
1
2
12
10
14
13
11
15
(and so on)
This order has been chosen so that
a) whatever the number N of elements in the set, the meaningful nodes are the first N and the value for all nodes
from N+1 on are null (if sent),
b) the tree and all subtrees are balanced.
Important properties of these trees are used in the algorithms (with generation 1 corresponding to the root):
Generation g contains 2g-1 nodes, and their indices are 2g-1 to 2g-1;
For generation g, nodes 2g-1 to 2g-1+2g-2-1 are left children, the others are right children;
If node k belongs to generation g, its left child is node k + 2g-1 , and its right child is k + 2g;
ETSI
614
Reciprocally, if k is a left child from generation g, its parent node is node k - 2g-2, and if k is a right child of
generation g, its parent is node k - 2g-1.
J.3
Performances
The number of bits needed to encode a given set of values depends on the number of values and on the range they can
span.
For the application on the BCCH and the SACCH (CA and BA information ) 16 octets are available, and the number of
frequencies that can be encoded in one information element is the following:
Range
Number
of frequencies
513 to 1024
257 to 512
129 to 256
113 to 128
up to 112
With two messages (for the BA) the number of frequencies that can be encoded is the following:
Range
Number
of frequencies
513 to 1024
257 to 512
225 to 256
up to 224
2 to 36 (note 1)
2 to 40 (note 2)
2 to 51 (note 3)
any
NOTE 1: A 1024 range can be split cyclically in to two 512 ranges each with less than 18 frequencies; each subset
is coded in one message with 512 range format.
NOTE 2: A 512 range can be split in to two consecutive 256 ranges. If both sub-ranges contain 22 frequencies or
less, it is possible to code each of these in a messages using the 256 range format. Otherwise one of the
two ranges contains 23 frequencies or more: 22 of them can be coded in one message using the 256 range
format and the remaining frequencies (numbering less than or equal to 18) can be coded in the other
message using the 512 range format.
NOTE 3: The principles described in notes 1 and 2, above apply in this case.
The frequency short list information element allows the following:
Range
Number
of frequencies
513 to 1024
257 to 512
129 to 256
57 to 128
up to 56
2 to 7 (8 if frequency 0 is in)
2 to 8
2 to 9
2 to 12
any
The number of frequencies as a function of the range and the length in octets of the variable length frequency list
information element (including the message type and length fields) is given by the following table:
ETSI
615
Table J.1/GSM 04.08: Performance of the variable length frequency list information element
Range
129 to 256
up to
128
variable bit
map
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
9
10
11
12
13
14
16
17
18
20
21
22
24
25
26
28
29
30
32
33
35
1
3
4
5
6
8
9
11
13
14
16
18
20
22
24
26
28
30
32
34
37
40
42
45
48
50
53
56
1
3
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
21
24
26
29
32
--
8
16
24
32
40
48
56
64
72
80
88
96
104
112
120
128
136
144
152
160
168
176
184
192
200
208
216
224
octets
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
J.4
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
9
11
12
13
15
16
18
19
21
22
24
26
27
29
30
32
34
36
38
40
42
Encoding algorithm
The choice is done recursively as given by the following programs, written in ADA:
Let us define the recursive procedure:
procedure ENCODE_SUBTREE(in INDEX : INTEGER;
in SET : SET_OF_VALUE;
in RANGE : INTEGER);
This procedure is given a set of integer values and an index. It chooses one of those values and computes the
corresponding W(INDEX) (considered as a global variable), it splits the set less the value in two equal or nearly equal
subsets, and calls itself recursively for each of those subsets, with suitable INDEX.
Assumption: all values in SET lie (inclusively) between 0 and RANGE-1, and they are all distinct.
As written, the program does not assume special values for the range. With a range such as 2k-1, some expressions can
be simplified.
Declarative part:
INDEX_IN_SET : INTEGER;
begin
First the program tests the leaf conditions :
if SET'SIZE=0 then
W(INDEX) := 0;
return;
elsif SET'SIZE=1 then
W(INDEX) := 1 + SET(1);
ETSI
616
return;
end if;
The following program finds a value in the set such that exactly (SET'SIZE-1)/2 values from the set
are between this value plus 1 and this value plus half the range :
declare
N : INTEGER;
J : INTEGER;
begin
for I in 1..SET'SIZE loop
N:=0;
for J in 1..SET'SIZE loop
if (SET(J)-SET(I)) mod RANGE <= (RANGE-1)/2 then
N := N+1;
end if;
end loop;
The test compares N-1 because the possible pivot value is counted.
if N-1 = (SET'SIZE-1)/2 then
INDEX_IN_SET := I;
exit;
end if;
end loop;
end;
INDEX_IN_SET is then the index in the list of the pivot value.
The following sets W(INDEX)
W(INDEX) := SET(INDEX_IN_SET) + 1;
Then the program does the same thing for the two halves of the range delimited by W(INDEX) and
W(INDEX)+RANGE/2. First the left subset:
declare
SUBSET : SET_OF_VALUE(1..SET'SIZE/2);
SUBSET_INDEX : INTEGER;
ORIGIN_VALUE : INTEGER;
begin
ORIGIN_VALUE := (SET(INDEX_IN_SET] + (RANGE-1)/2
+ 1) mod RANGE;
SUBSET_INDEX:=1;
for I in 1..SET'SIZE loop
if (SET(I)-ORIGIN_VALUE) mod RANGE) < RANGE/2 then
SUBSET(SUBSET_INDEX) :=
(SET(I) - ORIGIN_VALUE) mod RANGE;
SUBSET_INDEX := SUBSET_INDEX + 1;
end if;
end loop;
ENCODE_SUBTREE(
INDEX := INDEX +
GREATEST_POWER_OF_2_LESSER_OR_EQUAL_TO(INDEX),
SET := SUBSET,
RANGE := RANGE/2);
end;
Then the right subset:
declare
SUBSET : SET_OF_VALUE(1..(SET'SIZE-1)/2);
SUBSET_INDEX : INTEGER;
ORIGIN_VALUE : INTEGER;
begin
ORIGIN_VALUE := (SET(INDEX_IN_SET] + 1) mod RANGE;
SUBSET_INDEX:=1;
for I in 1..SET'SIZE loop
if (SET(I)-ORIGIN_VALUE) mod RANGE) < RANGE/2 then
SUBSET(SUBSET_INDEX) :=
(SET(I) - ORIGIN_VALUE) mod RANGE;
SUBSET_INDEX := SUBSET_INDEX + 1;
end if;
end loop;
ENCODE_SUBTREE(
INDEX := INDEX +
2*GREATEST_POWER_OF_2_LESSER_OR_EQUAL_TO(INDEX),
SET := SUBSET,
RANGE := (RANGE-1)/2);
ETSI
617
end;
end ENCODE_SUBTREE;
The initial call of the procedure depends on the format. Given some set to encode, the first problem is to verify that it
can be encoded, and by so doing to choose the format.
First the encoding process must find the minimum range of the set, that is to say the minimum value R such that there
exists one frequency F0 in the set such that all frequencies in the set can be written (F0 + N) mod 1024, with some N, 0
= N = R-1. The choice of the format depends on R and the number of frequencies : the 512 range format can be chosen
only if R512, the 256 range format can be chosen only if R=256, the 128 range format can be chosen only if R128.
If the chosen format is "1024 range", then the program must first check if frequency 0 is in the set. If so the F0 subfield
is set to 1, and frequency 0 is removed from the set. Otherwise, the F0 subfield is set to 0. Then ENCODE_SUBTREE
is called with INDEX := 1, SET set to the set of values equal to the ARFCN of all frequencies minus 1, and RANGE :=
1023.
If the chosen format is "512 range", "256 range" or "128 range", F0 is chosen as ORIG-ARFCN and
ENCODE_SUBTREE is called with INDEX := 1, SET set to the set of values equal to the ARFCN of all frequencies
except F0, minus F0+1, and RANGE set respectively to 511, 255 or 127.
J.5
Decoding
The decoding algorithm, as given below, is the inverse transform of the program given in the previous section, for the
specific case where the original range is a power of 2 minus 1. It is given a set of integer values W(i), and an original
range R, and it builds a set of values from 0..R-1.
The program is here written so that the fact that it is the inverse of the encoding program needs no more proof.
procedure DECODE(in W : array <> of INTEGER;
out SET : SET_OF_VALUE;
in ORIGINAL_RANGE : INTEGER);
-- local variables
INDEX : 1..W'SIZE;
N : INTEGER;
RANGE : INTEGER;
begin
for K in 1..W'SIZE loop
The next loop follows the tree from child to parent, from the node of index K to the root (index 1). For each iteration the
node of index INDEX is tackled. The corresponding range is RANGE, and N is the value of the element in the range
defined by the node.
The data are set to their initial values :
INDEX := K;
RANGE := ORIGINAL_RANGE / GREATEST_POWER_OF_2_LESSER_OR_EQUAL_TO(INDEX);
N := W(INDEX) - 1;
while INDEX>1 loop
Due to the assumption that the original range is a power of two minus one, the range for the parent node can be easily
computed, and does not depend upon whether the current node is a left or right child :
RANGE := 2*RANGE + 1;
Let us note J := 2g-1, g being the generation of node INDEX. We have J =
GREATEST_POWER_OF_2_LESSER_OR_EQUAL_TO(INDEX). The numbering used in the tree is such that the nodes
ETSI
618
of index J to J + J/2 - 1 are left children, and the nodes of index J/2 to J+J-1 are right children. Hence an easy test to
distinguish left and right children:
if 2*INDEX <
3*GREATEST_POWER_OF_2_LESSER_OR_EQUAL_TO(INDEX)
then
-- left child
The next computation gives the index of the parent node of the node of index INDEX, for a left child :
INDEX := INDEX GREATEST_POWER_OF_2_LESSER_OR_EQUAL_TO(INDEX)/2;
The next formula is the inverse of the renumbering appearing in the encoding for a left child. It gives the value of the
parent node in the range defined by the grand-parent node:
N := (N + W(INDEX) - 1 + (RANGE-1)/2 + 1)
mod RANGE;
else
-- right child
The next computation gives the index of the parent node of the node of index INDEX, for a right child :
INDEX := INDEX - GREATEST_POWER_OF_2_LESSER_OR_EQUAL_TO(INDEX);
The next formula is the inverse of the renumbering appearing in the encoding for a right child:
N := (N + W(INDEX) - 1 + 1) mod RANGE;
end if;
end loop;
F(K) := N;
end loop;
end;
A careful study will show that the programs given in the main part of the Technical Specification are equivalent to the
one presented here. The main difference is the use of different remnant variables to remove most of the calls to the
function giving the greatest power of 2 less than or equal to some integer.
The decoding must be terminated by the correction specific to the format.
J.6
A detailed example
Let us take the following subset of 16 elements of the set [0..1023] : [13, 71, 122, 191, 251, 321, 402, 476, 521, 575,
635, 701, 765, 831, 906, 981]
Range 1024 format will be used. Frequency 0 is not in the set, thus field F0 is set to 0. The set is renumbered, so as to
give a subset of 0..1022 : [12, 70, 121, 190, 250, 320, 401, 475, 520, 574, 634, 700, 764, 830, 905, 980].
For the first node (corresponding to W(1)), the value 121 satisfies the requirements. The opposite value is 121 + 511 =
632. There are 8 values between 633 and 120 (namely the left-hand subset 634, 700, 764, 830, 905, 980, 12 and 70),
and 7 values between 122 and 632 (namely the right-hand subset 190, 250, 320, 401, 475, 520 and 574).
The encoded value W(1) is 121 + 1, i.e. 122.
The second node (corresponding to W(2)) is the left-hand child of the first node. The corresponding subtree has to
encode for the left-hand subset, renumbered beginning at 633. This gives the following 8 element subset of 0..510,
ordered as resulting from the example of algorithm : [402, 460, 1, 67, 131, 197, 272, 347]. Out of these values, 1 splits
the set in 4 and 3, and the encoded value W(2) is 2.
Similarly, the third node (W(3)) is the right-hand child of the first node and then the corresponding subtree encodes for
the right-hand subset, renumbered starting at 122. This gives the following set of 0..510 : [68, 128, 198, 279, 353, 398,
452]. Out of these values, 68 splits the set into 3 and 3, and the encoded value W(3) is 69.
ETSI
619
The same method is applied for all nodes, giving the following encoded values per node:
node
value
node
value
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
122
2
69
204
75
66
60
70
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
83
3
24
67
54
64
70
9
ETSI
620
Annex K (informative):
Default Codings of Information Elements
This annex is informative.
The information in this annex does NOT define the value of any IEI for any particular message. This annex exists to aid
the design of new messages, in particular with regard to backward compatibility with phase 1 mobile stations.
K.1
For the common information elements types listed below, the default coding of information element identifier bits is
summarized in table K.1/GSM 04.08.
Table K.1/GSM 04.08: Default information element identifier coding
for common information elements
Reference
section
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 : : : - - - -
Type 1 info
elements
1 1 1 1 - - - -
Note 1
0 : : : : : : :
0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1
0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1
Note 1
Location Area
Identification
Mobile Identity
Note 1
Note 1
Mobile Station
classmark 3
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
10.5.1.3
10.5.1.4
10.5.1.7
10.5.1.8
NOTE 1: These values were allocated but never used in earlier phases of the protocol.
NOTE 2: For GPRS common information elements no default values are defined:
K.2
For the Radio Resource management information elements listed below, the default coding of the information element
identifier bits is summarized in table K.2/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
621
Table K.2/GSM 04.08 (page 1 of 2): Default information element identifier coding
for Radio Resource management information elements
Reference
section
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 : : : - - - 1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
1 1 1 0 - - - 0 : : : : : : :
0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1
0 1 1 0 0 0 0 1
0 1 1 0 0 0 1 0
0 1 1 0 0 0 1 1
0 1 1 0 0 1 0 0
0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0
0 1 1 0 1 0 0 0
0 1 1 0 1 0 0 1
0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0
0 1 1 0 1 0 1 1
0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0
Type 1 info
elements
Cipher Mode Setting
Cipher Response
Note
Synchronization
Indication
Channel Needed
10.5.2.9
10.5.2.10
10.5.2.39
10.5.2.8
10.5.2.14
10.5.2.13
10.5.2.1b
10.5.2.6
10.5.2.5
10.5.2.7
10.5.2.12
Table K.2/GSM 04.08 (page 2 of 2): Default information element identifier coding
for Radio Resource management information elements
Reference
section
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
NOTE:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Note
Mobile Allocation
BA range
Note
Note
Note
Mobile Time difference
Note
Note
Note
Time Difference
Starting Time
Timing Advance
TMSI
Note
These values were allocated but never used in earlier phases of the protocol.
ETSI
10.5.2.21
10.5.2.1
10.5.2.21a
10.5.2.41
10.5.2.38
10.5.2.40
10.5.2.42
K.3
622
For the mobility management information elements listed below, the default coding of the information element
identifier bits is summarized in table K.3/GSM 04.08.
Table K.3/GSM 04.08: Default information element identifier coding
for mobility management information elements
Reference
Section
8
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
Type
- - - -
1 info elements
- - Note
- - Note
- - Note
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Type
0 0
0 0
0 1
10.5.3.7
10.5.3.10
K.4
These values were allocated but never used in earlier versions of the protocol
For the call control information elements listed below, the default coding of the information element identifiers is
defined in table K.4/GSM 04.08.
ETSI
623
NOTE:
+-------------------------------------------------+
|
|Reference |
|
| section |
|
|
|
+--------------------------------------+----------|
|8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
|
|
|1 : : : - - - - Type 1 info elements |
|
| 0 0 1 - - - - shift
|10.5.4.2 |
|
| and .3 |
| 0 1 1 - - - - Note
|
|
| 1 0 1 - - - - Repeat indicator
|10.5.4.22 |
|
|
|
|1 0 1 0 : : : : Type 2 information
|
|
|
elements
|
|
|
0 0 0 0 More data
|10.5.4.19 |
|
0 0 0 1 CLIR Suppression
|10.5.4.11a|
|
0 0 1 0 CLIR Invocation
|10.5.4.11b|
|
0 0 1 1 Reverse call setup
|10.5.4.22a|
|
direction
|
|
|
|
|
|0 : : : : : : : Type 3 & 4 info
|
|
|
elements
|
|
| 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 Bearer capability
|10.5.4.5 |
| 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 Cause
|10.5.4.11 |
| 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 Note
|
|
| 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 Call Control
|10.5.4.5a |
|
Capabilities
|
|
| 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 Facility
|10.5.4.15 |
| 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 Progress indicator
|10.5.4.21 |
| 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 Auxiliary states
|10.5.4.4 |
| 0 1 0 0 1 1 1 Note
|
|
| 0 1 0 1 1 0 0 Keypad facility
|10.5.4.17 |
| 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 Signal
|10.5.4.23 |
| 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 Connected number
|10.5.4.13 |
| 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 Connected subaddress |10.5.4.14 |
| 1 0 1 1 1 0 0 Calling party BCD
|
|
|
number
|10.5.4.9 |
| 1 0 1 1 1 0 1 Calling party subad |10.5.4.10 |
| 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 Called party BCD
|
|
|
number
|10.5.4.7 |
| 1 1 0 1 1 0 1 Called party subad
|10.5.4.8 |
| 1 1 1 0 1 0 0 Redirecting Party BCD|10.5.4.21a|
| 1 1 1 1 1 0 1 Redirecting Party
|
|
|
subaddress
|10.5.4.21b|
| 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 Low layer compatib. |10.5.4.18 |
| 1 1 1 1 1 0 1 High layer compatib. |10.5.4.16 |
| 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 User-user
|10.5.4.25 |
| 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 SS version indicator |10.5.4.24 |
+-------------------------------------------------+
These values were allocated but never used in earlier phases of the protocol.
ETSI
624
Annex M (normative):
Additional Requirements for backward compatibility with
PCS 1900 for NA revision 0 ME
This annex is normative and provides additional requirements to support network mechanisms for backward
compatibility with PCS 1900 for NA revision 0 mobile equipments (applicable until July 1, 1998).
PCS 1900 for NA revision 0 mobile equipments are defined to understand Mobile Network Codes made of up to 2
digits. However federal regulation mandates that a 3-digit MNC shall be allocated by each administration to network
operators. Therefore each network operator is identified by a 3-digit Mobile Country Code and a 3-digit Mobile
Network Code. An operator whose network code complies to the allocation principle specified for PCS 1900 for NA
and wants to achieve for a transition period of time the backward compatibility with PCS 1900 for NA revision 0
mobile equipments shall apply the following:
-
The network shall send over the air interface the 3-digit Mobile Country Code and only the two most significant
digits of the Mobile Network Code (the value of the "digit" sent instead of the 3rd digit is specified in
GSM 04.08, subclause 10.5.1.3) (see note).
When a PCS 1900 for NA (revision greater than 0) mobile equipment recognizes over the air the Mobile Country Code
and the two most significant digits of the Mobile Network Code as being the HPLMN codes of the current IMSI, the
mobile equipment shall take into account the value of the sixth IMSI digit read from the SIM. If this value matches to a
value contained in the limited set of values for the least significant MNC digit assigned by the number administration
bodies for PCS 1900 for NA then the following applies for the mobile equipment:
-
The value sent over the air instead of the 3rd MNC digit in the Location Area Identification (for coding see
GSM 04.08, subclause 10.5.1.3) shall be interpreted as the value of the sixth IMSI digit read from the SIM.
NOTE:
It is still a network operator option to apply this requirement after July 1, 1998. However, in this case the
following shall be considered:
1. Network selection considerations for overlapping networks:
Networks overlapping to the HPLMN, identified over the radio interface by an identical combination
MCC1 MCC2 MCC3 MNC1 MNC2 (possible after July 1, 1998) may be selectable by PCS 1900 for NA
mobile equipments revision 0 with the same priority as the HPLMN or presented to the user as the
HPLMN
2. Roaming considerations:
Roamers (SIM) from networks identified by an identical combination MCC1 MCC2 MCC3 MNC1
MNC2 (possible after July 1, 1998) when roaming into the operator network with PCS 1900 for NA
mobile equipments revision 0, may cause these equipments to exhibit an unpredictable behaviour
(e.g. looping in the HPLMN selection and registration procedures).
Home subscribers (SIM) roaming with PCS 1900 for NA mobile equipments revision 0 into networks
identified by an identical combination MCC1 MCC2 MCC3 MNC1 MNC2 (possible after July 1, 1998),
may consider being attached to the HPLMN.
ETSI
625
Annex N (informative):
Change Record
Creation of v 7.0.1
Based on v6.3.0 including CRs A384, A396r2, A412, A457r1, A427r2, A495, A493
Creation of v 7.1.0
A358
A414
A419
A460
A464
A466
A468
A484
A486
A488
A490
A494
A496
A498
A502
A504
A506
A534
A540
A542
A546
A546
A548
A552
A558
A578
A584
A584
A591
A594
A598
A600
A602
A604
A606
A701
A751
A753
A755
A757
A759
A761
A763
A765
A767
A769
A771
A773
8
1
5
2
1
2
2
1
2
3
3
1
3
2
2
2
1
1
1
2
4
2
3
ETSI
A775
A777
A779
A781
A783
A785
A787
A789
A791
A793
A797
A799
A801
A803
A805
A807
A809
A811
A813
A815
A817
A819
A821
A823
A825
A827
A829
A831
A833
A835
A837
A839
A841
A371
2
1
1
2
1
1
2
4
2
1
1
1
3
2
4
2
1
1
2
626
Creation of v 7.1.1 Editorial correction to remove unnecessary double Spare Half Octets from section 9.4.9.
Version 7.1.2 Editorial corrections of Table 10.5.144/GSM04.08 the bit-string " Receive N-PDU Number value "
Creation of v 7.2.0
A620
A622
1
A626
1
A632
A636
A640
1
A644
A648
1
A652
1
A658
A662
2
T3172 attempt
A664
A666
A670
1
A843
A847
A851
A855
ETSI
627
A937
Non power down caused Detach during Attach/ was approve as A859-collision with other CR
A860r1
CM request and combined GMM procedures
A863
"Receive N-PDU Number list" IE padding bits
A867r1
TMSI status indication
A875
PDP context deactivation caused by LLC failure
A887
RAU Complete not returned for TMSI deallocation. Some alignments and editorials
A894
Clarification of the Detach Type "re-attach required" or "re-attach not required" in the network
initiated Detach procedure
A901r1
CR clash in sec. 4.7.3.2.6
A905
CR clash in sec. 4.7.3.2.3.2 and 4.7.5.2.3.2
A909r1
T3212 restart after RAU reject
A913
New State GMM-REGISTERED.IMSI-DETACH-INITIATED
A917
Deactivate AA PDP context request message
A921r2
Coding Scheme in Network Name IE
A933
T3212 restart after GPRS detach
A897r1
Addition of Access Point Name in Request PDP Context Activation message
Creation of version 7.3.0
A684
A694
ETSI
628
History
Document history
V7.1.2
August 1999
V7.1.3
December 1999
Publication
V7.4.0
January 2000
V7.4.2
September 2000
Publication
ETSI
OAP 9954:
1999-08-11 to 1999-12-10
OAP 200019:
2000-01-12 to 2000-05-12